Ira c5051 5045 5035 5030-sm

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 1383

Rev. 10.

imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5051/C5045/C5035/C5030 Series


Service Manual

Product Overvew
Technology
Periodical Service
Parts Replacement and Cleaning
Adjustment
Troubleshooting
Error Code
Service Mode
Installation Appendix
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Application
This manual has been issued by Canon Inc. for qualified persons to learn technical theory, The following paragraph does not apply to any countries where such provisions are
installation, maintenance, and repair of products. This manual covers all localities where the inconsistent with local law.
products are sold. For this reason, there may be information in this manual that does not
apply to your locality. Trademarks
The product names and company names used in this manual are the registered trademarks
Corrections of the individual companies.
This manual may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors due to improvements
or changes in products. When changes occur in applicable products or in the contents of this Copyright
manual, Canon will release technical information as the need arises. In the event of major This manual is copyrighted with all rights reserved. Under the copyright laws, this manual may
changes in the contents of this manual over a long or short period, Canon will issue a new not be copied, reproduced or translated into another language, in whole or in part, without the
edition of this manual. consent of Canon Inc.

© CANON INC. 2010

Caution
Use of this manual should be strictly supervised to avoid disclosure of confidential
information.
Explanation of Symbols The following rules apply throughout this Service Manual:
The following symbols are used throughout this Service Manual.

Symbols Explanation Symbols Explanation 1. Each chapter contains sections explaining the purpose of specific functions and the
relationship between electrical and mechanical systems with reference to the timing of
operation.
Check. Remove the claw.
In the diagrams, represents the path of mechanical drive; where a signal
name accompanies the symbol, the arrow indicates the direction of the
electric signal.
The expression "turn on the power" means flipping on the power switch, closing the
Check visually. Insert the claw.
front door, and closing the delivery unit door, which results in supplying the machine with
power.

Check the noise. Use the bundled part. 2. In the digital circuits, '1' is used to indicate that the voltage level of a given signal is
"High", while '0' is used to indicate "Low". (The voltage value, however, differs from
circuit to circuit.) In addition, the asterisk (*) as in "DRMD*" indicates that the DRMD
signal goes on when '0'.
Disconnect the connector. Push the part.
In practically all cases, the internal mechanisms of a microprocessor cannot be checked
in the field. Therefore, the operations of the microprocessors used in the machines
are not discussed: they are explained in terms of from sensors to the input of the DC
controller PCB and from the output of the DC controller PCB to the loads.
Connect the connector. Plug the power cable.

The descriptions in this Service Manual are subject to change without notice for product
improvement or other purposes, and major changes will be communicated in the form of
Remove the cable/wire
Service Information bulletins.
from the cable guide or wire Turn on the power.
saddle. All service persons are expected to have a good understanding of the contents of this Service
Manual and all relevant Service Information bulletins and be able to identify and isolate faults
in the machine.
Set the cable/wire to the
cable guide or wire saddle.

Remove the screw.

Tighten the screw.


Blank Page
Contents
Pickup------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-8
Name of Parts-------------------------------------------------------------------1-9
External View------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-9
Cross Sectional View-------------------------------------------------------------1-10
Operation----------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-11
0 Safety Precautions Power Switch----------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-11
CDRH Act------------------------------------------------------------------------0-2 Types of power switch--------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-11
Laser Safety---------------------------------------------------------------------0-2 How to turn ON / OFF the power and points to note------------------------------ 1-11

Handling of Laser System---------------------------------------------------0-2 Description of Control Panel----------------------------------------------------1-12


Control Panel--------------------------------------------------------------------------------1-12
Turn power switch ON--------------------------------------------------------0-3
Main Menu------------------------------------------------------------------------------------1-12
Safety of Toner------------------------------------------------------------------0-3
Difference of main menu------------------------------------------------------------------1-13
About Toner-------------------------------------------------------------------------- 0-3
Settings / Registration menu-------------------------------------------------------------1-13
Toner on Clothing or Skin--------------------------------------------------------- 0-3
Difference of Settings / Registration menu-------------------------------------------1-13
Notes When Handling a Lithium Battery---------------------------------0-4 Service Mode-----------------------------------------------------------------------1-14
Notes Before it Works Serving----------------------------------------------0-4 Service mode menu------------------------------------------------------------------------1-14
Points to Note at Cleaning---------------------------------------------------0-4 Description display of service mode item---------------------------------------------1-14
Enhancement of I/O information--------------------------------------------------------1-15
1 Product Overvew Subdivide COPIER > OPTION > BODY items--------------------------------------1-16
Product Lineup------------------------------------------------------------------1-2 Security measure---------------------------------------------------------------------------1-16
Host machine------------------------------------------------------------------------ 1-2 Screen display switch (level1 <-> level2)---------------------------------------------1-16
Host machine configuration--------------------------------------------------------------- 1-2
Model type------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-2 2 Technology
Option---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-3 Basic Configuration------------------------------------------------------------2-2
Pickup delivery / image reading options----------------------------------------------- 1-3 Functional Configuration---------------------------------------------------------- 2-2
Function expanding option---------------------------------------------------------------- 1-4 Basic sequence ----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-2
Feature---------------------------------------------------------------------------1-5 Controller System -------------------------------------------------------------2-5
Product feature---------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-5 Overview------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-5
Product feature------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-5 Features---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-5
Features at servicing--------------------------------------------------------------- 1-5 Specifications / configuration------------------------------------------------------------- 2-5
Improvement on upgrade operation---------------------------------------------------- 1-5 HDD--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-9
New type connector is adopted---------------------------------------------------------- 1-5 Boot sequence------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-9
Specification---------------------------------------------------------------------1-6 Shutdown sequence-----------------------------------------------------------------------2-10
Specification-------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-6 Controls------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-11
Weight / Size------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-7 Flow of Image Data------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-11
Productivity (Print speed)--------------------------------------------------------- 1-7 Security Features (Encryption Key, Certificate, Password Protection)--------2-12
Paper type---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 1-8 High capacity HDD (Option)-------------------------------------------------------------2-20
HDD mirroring feature (option)----------------------------------------------------------2-21 Transfer/separation------------------------------------------------------------------------2-55
Removable HDD (option)-----------------------------------------------------------------2-25 Drum cleaning-------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-60
HDD Encryption/ Mirroring Kit (optional)----------------------------------------------2-26 Image stabilization control----------------------------------------------------------------2-61
Service Operations----------------------------------------------------------------2-29 Toner supply assembly--------------------------------------------------------------------2-72
When Replacing Parts --------------------------------------------------------------------2-29 Waste toner feeding assembly----------------------------------------------------------2-75
Consumables--------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-29 Other controls--------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-77
Points to note at servicing----------------------------------------------------------------2-29 Service work------------------------------------------------------------------------2-78
Laser Exposure System---------------------------------------------------- 2-30 Periodically replaced parts---------------------------------------------------------------2-78
Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-30 Consumable parts--------------------------------------------------------------------------2-78
Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-30 List of periodical service works----------------------------------------------------------2-78
Specification---------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-31 Fixing System----------------------------------------------------------------- 2-79
Various Controls--------------------------------------------------------------------2-32 Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-79
Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-32 Features---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-79
Laser ON / OFF control-------------------------------------------------------------------2-33 Specifications--------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-80
Horizontal scanning synchronous control--------------------------------------------2-33 Major parts configuration-----------------------------------------------------------------2-80
Vertical Scanning Synchronous Control----------------------------------------------2-34 Controls------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-82
APC (Auto Power Control) control-----------------------------------------------------2-35 Fixing temperature control: overview--------------------------------------------------2-82
Laser scanner motor control-------------------------------------------------------------2-36 Standby temperature control------------------------------------------------------------2-82
BD correction control----------------------------------------------------------------------2-38 Print temperature control-----------------------------------------------------------------2-83
Laser shutter control-----------------------------------------------------------------------2-39 Down sequence control-------------------------------------------------------------------2-85
Image tilt correction control--------------------------------------------------------------2-40 Fixing film edge cooling control---------------------------------------------------------2-87
Service Works----------------------------------------------------------------------2-42 Detection of fixing assembly-------------------------------------------------------------2-87
Periodically replaced parts---------------------------------------------------------------2-42 Film unit engagement / disengagement control-------------------------------------2-88
Consumables--------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-42 Protection features-------------------------------------------------------------------------2-88
Periodical service list----------------------------------------------------------------------2-42 Service work------------------------------------------------------------------------2-89
Operation at parts replacement---------------------------------------------------------2-42 Periodically replaced parts---------------------------------------------------------------2-89
Points to note at servicing----------------------------------------------------------------2-42 Consumable parts--------------------------------------------------------------------------2-89
Image Formation System-------------------------------------------------- 2-43 List of periodical service works----------------------------------------------------------2-89
Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-43 When replacing parts----------------------------------------------------------------------2-89
Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-43 Pickup Feed System-------------------------------------------------------- 2-91
Specifications--------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-43 Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-91
Parts configuration-------------------------------------------------------------------------2-44 Features---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-91
Print process---------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-44 Specification---------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-91
Controls------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-46 Parts Configuration-------------------------------------------------------------------------2-92
Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-46 Paper Path-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-94
Pre-exposure--------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-46 Interval Speed Up--------------------------------------------------------------------------2-95
Primary charging----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-47 Various Controls--------------------------------------------------------------------2-96
Developing/drum----------------------------------------------------------------------------2-49 Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------2-96
Cassette Pickup Assembly---------------------------------------------------------------2-96 2-122
Multi-Purpose Tray Pickup Assembly------------------------------------------------ 2-101 Login by Password Authentication--------------------------------------------------- 2-122
Fixing / Registration Assembly-------------------------------------------------------- 2-102 Login by RLS Authentication----------------------------------------------------------- 2-123
Duplex / Delivery Assembly------------------------------------------------------------ 2-103 Initial Display Languages of SMS---------------------------------------------------- 2-125
JAM Detection----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-105 Setting the method to login to SMS----------------------------------------- 2-125
Service Works-------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-106 Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-125
Periodically replacement parts-------------------------------------------------------- 2-106 Setting for login by Password Authentication-------------------------------------- 2-126
Consumables------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-106 Setting for login by RLS Authentication--------------------------------------------- 2-127
Periodical service------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-106 Checking MEAP Application Management Page------------------------ 2-128
External Auxiliary System------------------------------------------------ 2-107 About MEAP Application Management Page-------------------------------------- 2-128
Various Controls------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-107 Starting and Stopping a MEAP Application-------------------------------- 2-129
Software Counter------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-107 Procedure to start and stop a MEAP application--------------------------------- 2-129
Fan------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-107 Checking the Platform Information------------------------------------------ 2-130
Power Supply Control------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-110 The check procedure of the platform information-------------------------------- 2-130
Service Operations-------------------------------------------------------------- 2-113 MEAP Specifications------------------------------------------------------------ 2-130
When Replacing Parts------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-113 What is MEAP Specifications (MEAP Spec Version)?-------------------------- 2-130
Consumables------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-113 About Name-------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-130
Points to note at servicing-------------------------------------------------------------- 2-113 Mechanism--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-130
MEAP--------------------------------------------------------------------------2-114 MEAP Application System Information------------------------------------- 2-132
Changes---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-114 Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-132
Overview------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-114 Checking the System Information of a MEAP Application with SMS-------- 2-132
SSL Always Enabled--------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-114 Printing the System Information of a MEAP Application------------------------ 2-133
Message Display by USB Driver Setting Change-------------------------------- 2-114 Content of MEAP system information----------------------------------------------- 2-133
Addition of Functions-------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-114 Installing an Application-------------------------------------------------------- 2-134
Differences in MEAP Application Data Management when Using New Resource------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-134
Functions----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-115 Procedure to install applications------------------------------------------------------ 2-135
Addition of SMS Functions------------------------------------------------------------- 2-115 Adding a License File----------------------------------------------------------- 2-136
Authentication Information Sharing Function-------------------------------------- 2-116 Procedure adding a license file------------------------------------------------------- 2-136
Function Supporting Deep Sleep Mode-------------------------------------------- 2-117 Disabling a License File-------------------------------------------------------- 2-138
Checking the Operating Environment-------------------------------------- 2-117 Procedure disabling a license file (suspending a license)---------------------- 2-138
Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-117 Downloading / Removing an Invalidated License File------------------ 2-139
SMS------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-117 Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-139
SSO-H Management-------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-118 Procedure downloading / removing an invalidated license file---------------- 2-139
Setting Up the Network--------------------------------------------------------- 2-120 Reusable license----------------------------------------------------------------- 2-141
Network configuration process-------------------------------------------------------- 2-120 Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-141
Login to SMS---------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-121 License for forwarding---------------------------------------------------------- 2-141
Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-121 Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-141
Key Pair and Server Certificate when Using Encrypted SSL Communication---- Procedure to create license for forwarding----------------------------------------- 2-141
Uninstalling an Application----------------------------------------------------- 2-144 USB Device report print----------------------------------------------------------------- 2-164
Procedure to uninstall an application------------------------------------------------ 2-144 Reference material-------------------------------------------------------------- 2-167
Login Service--------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-145 Glossary------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-167
About Login Service--------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-145 Option for exclusive individual measure----------------------------------- 2-169
Default Authentication overview------------------------------------------------------ 2-145 Display Setting of Copy Icon (level2)------------------------------------------------ 2-169
SSO-H (Single Sign-On-H) overview------------------------------------------------ 2-145 Error at starting up the MEAP application/Setting to hide JAM screen (level 2)--
Authentication methods of SSO-H--------------------------------------------------- 2-146 2-169
Access Mode in Sites-------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-147 Setting of Screen Transition from MEAP Screen to the Standard Screen
Environment confirmation-------------------------------------------------------------- 2-149 (level2)--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-170
Specification of SSO-H------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-149 Embedded RDS------------------------------------------------------------ 2-171
Changing Login Services------------------------------------------------------ 2-150 Product Overview---------------------------------------------------------------- 2-171
Steps to Change Login Services----------------------------------------------------- 2-150 Overview------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-171
Initializing the Password------------------------------------------------------- 2-151 Features and benefits------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-171
Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-151 Major Functions--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-171
Procedure to initialize the SMS login password---------------------------------- 2-151 Limitations------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-172
Backup of the MEAP Application Area and Recovery of the Backup Service Mode Menu Transmission Function--------------------------------------- 2-172
Data Using SST------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-151 Service cautions------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-173
Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-151 E-RDS Setup---------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-173
HDD model and Flash model---------------------------------------------------------- 2-152 Confirmation and preparation in advance------------------------------------------ 2-173
Backup Item Automatically Copied--------------------------------------------------- 2-152 E-RDS-related setting items (service mode)-------------------------------------- 2-177
Requirements for Backup Using the SST------------------------------------------ 2-153 Steps to E-RDS settings---------------------------------------------------------------- 2-178
Procedure for backing up the MEAP application area using SST------------ 2-153 Steps to Service Call button settings------------------------------------------------ 2-181
Procedures to Restore Backup Data------------------------------------------------ 2-155 Steps to Service Browser settings--------------------------------------------------- 2-183
Formatting and Replacing the HDD/Flash PCB-------------------------- 2-155 Initializing E-RDS settings-------------------------------------------------------------- 2-184
Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-155 FAQ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-185
Formatting the HDD/Flash PCB------------------------------------------------------ 2-156 Troubleshooting------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-187
HDD/ Flash PCB replacement procedure------------------------------------------ 2-156 Error code and strings---------------------------------------------------------- 2-190
MEAP Safe Mode (level 2)---------------------------------------------------- 2-157 Updater----------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-193
Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-157 Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-193
Starting in Safe Mode------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-157 Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-193
How to cancel MEAP SAFE mode--------------------------------------------------- 2-159
Installing MEAP Application/System Option------------------------------- 2-194
Setting HTTP port for MEAP application (level 2)----------------------- 2-159 System Configuration-------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-195
Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-159 List of Functions--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-195
Port setup procedure of HTTP Server----------------------------------------------- 2-160 Distribution Flow-------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-196
Port setup procedure of HTTPS Server--------------------------------------------- 2-161
Limitations and Cautions------------------------------------------------------- 2-197
Using USB Devices------------------------------------------------------------- 2-162 Limitations---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-197
USB Driver--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-162 Cautions------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-197
Initialization of MEAP driver priority registration---------------------------------- 2-164
Preparation------------------------------------------------------------------ 2-198 Switch---------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-34
Overview of Preparation---------------------------------------------------------------- 2-198 PCB-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-37
Setting Sales Company’s HQ---------------------------------------------------------- 2-198 Conector-----------------------------------------------------------------------------4-43
Network Settings-------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-199 Main Controller--------------------------------------------------------------- 4-65
Enabling UGW Link---------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-202 Removing the HDD----------------------------------------------------------------4-65
Enabling [Update Firmware] Button of User Mode------------------------------- 2-203 How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-65
Enabling [Install Application/Options] Button of User Mode------------------- 2-203
Removing the Main Controller PCB 1----------------------------------------4-67
Enabling [Manual Update] Button of User Mode (Remote UI)---------------- 2-204
Before removing the Main Controller PCB 1-----------------------------------------4-67
Enabling [Scheduled Update] Button of User Mode----------------------------- 2-204
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-67
System Management Operations-------------------------------------------- 2-206 Removing the Main Controller PCB 2----------------------------------------4-68
Various Setting---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-206
Before Removing the Main Controller PCB 2---------------------------------------4-68
Displaying Logs--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-208
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-69
Communication Test--------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-211
Opening the Controller Box-----------------------------------------------------4-70
Maintenance----------------------------------------------------------------- 2-213 Before opening the Controller Box-----------------------------------------------------4-70
Upgrading Updater----------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-213
How to open----------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-70
Formatting Hard Disk-------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-213
Removing the DC Controller PCB---------------------------------------------4-71
How to Replace Controller Boards--------------------------------------------------- 2-213
Before Removing the DC Controller PCB--------------------------------------------4-71
How to Replace Devices---------------------------------------------------------------- 2-213
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-71
FAQ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 2-214
Removing the Main Power Unit------------------------------------------------4-72
FAQ on Installing Firmware------------------------------------------------------------ 2-214
Before removing the Main Power Unit------------------------------------------------4-72
FAQ on Installing MEAP Application/System Option---------------------------- 2-215
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-73
FAQ on General Matters of Updater------------------------------------------------- 2-216
Removing the AC Driver---------------------------------------------------------4-74
3 Periodical Service Before removing the AC Driver----------------------------------------------------------4-74
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-74
Consumable Parts and Cleaning Parts-----------------------------------3-2 Removing the Control Panel----------------------------------------------------4-75
Cleaning Parts------------------------------------------------------------------3-8 How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-75
Laser Exposure System---------------------------------------------------- 4-77
4 Parts Replacement and Cleaning Cleaning the Dust-blocking Glass---------------------------------------------4-77
List of Parts----------------------------------------------------------------------4-2 Before Cleaning the Dust-blocking Glass--------------------------------------------4-77
List of Cover-------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-2 How to Clean--------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-77
List of Main Unit--------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-5 Removing the Dust-blocking Glass Cleaning Pad-------------------------4-77
Unit Layout------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-5 Before Removing the Dust-blocking Glass Cleaning Pad------------------------4-77
Clutch / Solenoid-------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-9 How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-77
Motor----------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-12 Removing the Laser Scanner Unit---------------------------------------------4-78
Fan------------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-19 Before Removing the Laser Scanner Unit--------------------------------------------4-78
Sensor--------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-23 How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-81
Heater / Other-----------------------------------------------------------------------4-31 Image Formation System-------------------------------------------------- 4-84
Removing the Toner Filter-------------------------------------------------------4-84 Pulling Out the Process Unit-------------------------------------------------- 4-106
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-84 Before pulling out the Process Unit-------------------------------------------------- 4-106
Removing the ITB Unit-----------------------------------------------------------4-84 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-106
Before Removing the ITB Unit----------------------------------------------------------4-84 Removing the Process Unit--------------------------------------------------- 4-108
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-85 Before removing the Process Unit--------------------------------------------------- 4-108
Cleaning the Patch Sensor------------------------------------------------------4-87 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-108
Before cleaning the patch sensor------------------------------------------------------4-87 Reinstalling the Process Unit------------------------------------------------- 4-109
How to Clean--------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-87 Before reinstalling the Process Unit------------------------------------------------- 4-109
Remove the Patch Sensor (front,center,rear)------------------------------4-87 How to reinstall---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-109
Before cleaning the patch sensor------------------------------------------------------4-87 Removing the Drum Unit--------------------------------------------------------4-111
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-87 Before removing the Drum Unit------------------------------------------------------- 4-111
Removing the ITB Cleaning Unit-----------------------------------------------4-89 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-111
Before removing the ITB Cleaning Unit-----------------------------------------------4-89 Reinstalling the Drum Unit----------------------------------------------------- 4-112
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-89 Before reinstalling the Drum Unit----------------------------------------------------- 4-112
Removing the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit--------------------------------------4-90 How to reinstall---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-112
Before removing the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit--------------------------------------4-90 Removing the Developing Assembly---------------------------------------- 4-114
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-90 Before removing the Developing Assembly---------------------------------------- 4-114
Installing the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit----------------------------------------4-90 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-114
Before installing the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit---------------------------------------4-90 Installing a new Developing Assembly------------------------------------- 4-115
How to Install--------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-90 Before installing a new Developing Assembly------------------------------------- 4-115
Removing the ITB------------------------------------------------------------------4-92 How to install------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-115
Before removing the ITB------------------------------------------------------------------4-92 Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller and Secondary Transfer
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-92 Separation Guide Unit---------------------------------------------------------- 4-117
Removing the Primary Transfer Roller (Bk)---------------------------------4-95 Before removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller and Secondary Transfer
Before removing the Primary Transfer Roller (Bk)---------------------------------4-95 Separation Guide Unit------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-117
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-95 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-117
Removing the Primary Transfer Roller (C,M,Y)----------------------------4-97 Reinstalling the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller and Secondary
Before removing the Primary Transfer Roller (C,M,Y)----------------------------4-97 Transfer Separation Guide Unit---------------------------------------------- 4-119
How to remove------------------------------------------------------------------------------4-97 Before reinstalling the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller and Secondary
Removing the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller-------------------------- 4-100 Transfer Separation Guide Unit------------------------------------------------------- 4-119
Before removing the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller-------------------------- 4-100 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-119
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-100 Removing the Toner Bottle manually--------------------------------------- 4-120
Reinstalling the ITB-------------------------------------------------------------- 4-102 Before Removing the Toner Bottle manually--------------------------------------- 4-120
Before reinstalling the ITB-------------------------------------------------------------- 4-102 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-122
How to reinstall---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-102 Removing the Main Drive Unit------------------------------------------------ 4-123
Removing the Recycle Toner Bottle----------------------------------------- 4-106 Before Removing the Main Drive Unit----------------------------------------------- 4-123
Before removing the Recycle Toner Bottle----------------------------------------- 4-106 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-124
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-106 Removing the Toner Container Front Inner Cover----------------------- 4-127
Before remove the Toner Container Front Inner Cover------------------------- 4-127 Before cleaning the Registration Roller--------------------------------------------- 4-144
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-127 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-144
Removing the Hopper (M)----------------------------------------------------- 4-129 Cleaning the Pre-registration Guide Assembly--------------------------- 4-144
Before remove the Hopper (M)-------------------------------------------------------- 4-129 Before cleaning the Pre-registration Guide Assembly--------------------------- 4-144
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-129 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-144
Removing the Hopper (Y)------------------------------------------------------ 4-130 Cleaning the Transparency Sensor----------------------------------------- 4-145
Before remove the Hopper (Y)-------------------------------------------------------- 4-130 Before cleaning the Transparency Sensor----------------------------------------- 4-145
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-130 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-145
Removing the Hopper (C)----------------------------------------------------- 4-132 Cleaning the Vertical Path Sensor and the Lightproof Sheet--------- 4-145
Before remove the Hopper (C)-------------------------------------------------------- 4-132 Before cleaning the Vertical Path Sensor and the Lightproof Sheet--------- 4-145
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-132 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-145
Removing the Hopper (Bk)---------------------------------------------------- 4-135 Cleaning the Fixing Delivery Guide Assembly---------------------------- 4-146
Before remove the Hopper (Bk)------------------------------------------------------- 4-135 Before cleaning the Fixing Delivery Guide Assembly--------------------------- 4-146
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-135 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-146
Fixing System--------------------------------------------------------------- 4-137 Cleaning the Post-fixing Roller----------------------------------------------- 4-146
Removing the Fixing Assembly----------------------------------------------- 4-137 Before cleaning the Post-fixing Roller----------------------------------------------- 4-146
Before removing the Fixing Assembly----------------------------------------------- 4-137 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-146
How to Remove--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-137 Cleaning the Fixing Delivery Roller------------------------------------------ 4-147
Removing the Film Unit-------------------------------------------------------- 4-138 Before cleaning the Fixing Delivery Roller----------------------------------------- 4-147
Before removing the Film Unit--------------------------------------------------------- 4-138 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-147
How to Remove--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-138 Cleaning the Duplex Feed Upper Roller, Wheel------------------------- 4-147
Cleaning the Fixing Separation Guide-------------------------------------- 4-140 Before cleaning the Duplex Feed Upper Roller, Wheel------------------------- 4-147
Before Cleaning the Fixing Separation Guide------------------------------------- 4-140 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-147
How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-140 Cleaning the Duplex Feed Lower Roller, Wheel------------------------- 4-148
Cleaning the Shutter Cover--------------------------------------------------- 4-140 Before cleaning the Duplex Feed Lower Roller, Wheel------------------------- 4-148
Before Cleaning the Shutter Cover-------------------------------------------------- 4-140 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-148
How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-140 Cleaning the First, Second and Third Delivery Roller------------------ 4-148
Removing the Pressure Roller and Pressure Roller Bearing--------- 4-141 Before cleaning the First, Second and Third Delivery Roller------------------ 4-148
Before removing the Pressure Roller and Pressure Roller Bearing--------- 4-141 How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-148
How to Remove--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-141 Removing the Second and Third Delivery Unit--------------------------- 4-149
Pickup Feed System------------------------------------------------------ 4-143 Before removing the Second and Third Delivery Unit--------------------------- 4-149
Cleaning the Secondary Transfer Guide----------------------------------- 4-143 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-149
Before cleaning the Secondary Transfer Guide----------------------------------- 4-143 Removing the First Delivery Unit--------------------------------------------- 4-151
How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-143 Before removing the First Delivery Unit--------------------------------------------- 4-151
Cleaning the Feed Contact Point Guide----------------------------------- 4-143 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-151
Before cleaning the Feed Contact Point Guide----------------------------------- 4-143 Removing the Duplex Unit----------------------------------------------------- 4-152
How to Clean------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-143 Before removing the Duplex Unit----------------------------------------------------- 4-152
Cleaning the Registration Roller--------------------------------------------- 4-144 How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-152
Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller------------------------- 4-154 5 Adjustment
Before removing the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller------------------------- 4-154
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-154 Main Controller-----------------------------------------------------------------5-2
HDD------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 5-2
Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Separation Roller------------------- 4-155
Before removing the Multi-purpose Tray Separation Roller-------------------- 4-155 Main controller PCB 1------------------------------------------------------------- 5-2
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-155 Main controller PCB 2------------------------------------------------------------- 5-3
Removing the Pickup Roller--------------------------------------------------- 4-156 DC controller PCB------------------------------------------------------------------ 5-3
Before removing the Pickup Roller--------------------------------------------------- 4-156 TPM PCB----------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-3
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-157 Image Formation System----------------------------------------------------5-4
Removing the Feed Roller----------------------------------------------------- 4-157 Developing Assembly-------------------------------------------------------------- 5-4
Before removing the Feed Roller----------------------------------------------------- 4-157 Patch sensor------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-4
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-157 ITB Unit-------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-4
Removing the Separation Roller--------------------------------------------- 4-158 ITB-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-4
Before removing the Separation Roller--------------------------------------------- 4-158 Secondary Transfer Outer Roller----------------------------------------------- 5-4
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-158 Hopper Unit--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 5-4
Removing the Pickup Assembly Idler Gear------------------------------- 4-158 Pickup Feed System----------------------------------------------------------5-5
Before removing the Pickup Assembly Idler Gear-------------------------------- 4-158 Method of Setting 8K and 16K (Chinese Paper)---------------------------- 5-5
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-158
Method of Setting Special Paper------------------------------------------------ 5-5
Removing the Right Lower Cover------------------------------------------- 4-159
Before removing the Right Lower Cover-------------------------------------------- 4-159 6 Troubleshooting
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-159
Removing the Cassette 1 Pickup Unit-------------------------------------- 4-161 Initial Check---------------------------------------------------------------------6-2
Before removing the Cassette 1 Pickup Unit-------------------------------------- 4-161
Initial check items list-------------------------------------------------------------- 6-2
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-161 Test Print-------------------------------------------------------------------------6-3
Removing the Cassette 2 Pickup Unit-------------------------------------- 4-162 Overview------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 6-3
Before removing the Cassette 2 Pickup Unit-------------------------------------- 4-162 Steps to select the test print TYPE--------------------------------------------- 6-3
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-163 How to use the test print---------------------------------------------------------- 6-4
Removing the Cassette Size Detection Unit------------------------------ 4-164 16 gradations (TYPE=4)------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-4
Before remove the Cassette Size Detection Unit--------------------------------- 4-164 Full half tone (TYPE=5)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-4
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-164 Grid (TYPE=6)-------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-5
MCYBk horizontal stripe (TYPE=10)--------------------------------------------------- 6-5
Option------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-165
64-gradations (TYPE=12)----------------------------------------------------------------- 6-6
Removing the ADF Unit-------------------------------------------------------- 4-165
Full color 16-gradations (TYPE=14)---------------------------------------------------- 6-6
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-165
Height Adjustment------------------------------------------------------------------------ 4-168 Troubleshooting items--------------------------------------------------------6-7
Adjustment procedure------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-169 Troubleshooting items list--------------------------------------------------------- 6-7
Right Angle Adjustment----------------------------------------------------------------- 4-170 Image Faults------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-7
Removing the Reader Unit---------------------------------------------------- 4-171 Image fogging due to the electrostatic charge failure ----------------------------- 6-7
How to remove---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 4-171 35-mm pitch ghost due to toner deterioration --------------------------------------- 6-8
The 35-mm uneven image density due to the periodic deflection of the Download Menu 2--------------------------------------------------------------------------6-51
developing cylinder ------------------------------------------------------------------------- 6-9 Other Menu-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-51
Uneven Image Density at 95 mm of Paper Leading Edge ----------------------- 6-9 Troubleshooting--------------------------------------------------------------------6-52
Missing color due to the laser exposure failure ------------------------------------6-10 Error Code: E753-0001-------------------------------------------------------------------6-52
Blank area cased by poor secondary transfer -------------------------------------- 6-11 Version Upgrade via CDS-------------------------------------------------------6-54
Fixing wrinkle due to deterioration of rib on Fixing Inlet Guide------------------6-12 Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-54
Soiled image due to the oil attached to the Fixing Separation Guide---------6-13 Preparation-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-55
Operation Error---------------------------------------------------------------------6-14 a. UGW-linked Download and Update (Full-remote Update)--------------------6-61
Noise around the Fixing Film Unit------------------------------------------------------6-14 b. UGW-linked Download (Remote Distribution Update)-------------------------6-61
Cannot close the Process Unit----------------------------------------------------------6-15 c. Manual Download and Update (On-site Update from Service Mode)------6-64
Productivity decrease at stack delivery in thin paper (52g/m2 ~ 63g/m2) mode Deleting Firmware Distribution Schedule---------------------------------------------6-70
< Staple Finisher C1/Saddle Stitch Finisher C1>-----------------------------------6-16 Updating Downloaded Firmware (Applying Firmware)----------------------------6-71
Version upgrade-------------------------------------------------------------- 6-17 Deleting Downloaded Firmware--------------------------------------------------------6-72
Overview-----------------------------------------------------------------------------6-17 Troubleshooting on Firmware Installation--------------------------------------------6-74
Overview of Version Upgrade-----------------------------------------------------------6-17 Information required for Reports--------------------------------------------------------6-75
Writing System Software------------------------------------------------------------------6-18 Debug Logs----------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-76
Download Mode-----------------------------------------------------------------------------6-20 Error Messages-----------------------------------------------------------------------------6-77
System Software Components----------------------------------------------------------6-21 Error Codes----------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-83
Note on Download Process--------------------------------------------------------------6-22 Controller Self Diagnosis---------------------------------------------------------6-88
Version Upgrade via SST--------------------------------------------------------6-23 Introduction-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-88
Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-23 Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-88
Copying System Software----------------------------------------------------------------6-24 Layout Drawing------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-89
Connection-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-25 Basic Flowchart-----------------------------------------------------------------------------6-90
Downloading System Software (Assist mode)--------------------------------------6-27 Prerequisite----------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-91
Downloading System Software (Single mode)--------------------------------------6-28 Operation-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-91
Formatting HDD-----------------------------------------------------------------------------6-31 Boot System Error Diagnosis------------------------------------------------------------6-91
Backup----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-35 Controller System Error Diagnosis-----------------------------------------------------6-93
Version Upgrade using USB memory Storage Device-------------------6-38 Restrictions-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-97
Relation between SST and USB memory storage device Storage Device--6-38
Copying System Software----------------------------------------------------------------6-39 7 Error Code
Connection-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-43 Overview-------------------------------------------------------------------------7-2
Upgrading System Software-------------------------------------------------------------6-44 Outline--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-2
Downloading/Writing System Software (Automatic)-------------------------------6-45 Outline------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 7-2
Downloading System Software (Confirmation)--------------------------------------6-46 Location code--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-2
Downloading System Software (Overwriting)---------------------------------------6-48 Location code--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-2
Formatting HDD-----------------------------------------------------------------------------6-49 Points to Note When Clearing MN-CON----------------------------------------------- 7-3
Backup----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------6-51 Points to Note When Clearing HDD---------------------------------------------------- 7-3
Clearing Download File-------------------------------------------------------------------6-51 Measures for E747-------------------------------------------------------------------------- 7-3
Error Code-----------------------------------------------------------------------7-4 Main Device (DCON > P004 to 029)---------------------------------------------------8-55
Error Code Details------------------------------------------------------------------ 7-4 Color Image Reader Unit (RCON > P001 to 005)----------------------------------8-62
Jam Code---------------------------------------------------------------------7-114 Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 (FEEDER > P001 to 007)----------------8-63
image RUNNER ADVANCE C5051/C5045/C5035/C5030------------ 7-114 Color Image Reader Unit-B2 (FEEDER > P001 to 006)--------------------------8-65
Inner Finisher-A1(SORTER>P001 to P014)-----------------------------------------8-67
Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 / Color Image Reader Unit-B2-------
Staple Finisher-C1/Booklet Finisher-C1(SORTER>P001, P007 to P031)---8-70
7-116
External 2 Hole Puncher-B1(SORTER>P013, P032 to P036, P039)---------8-77
Staple Finisher-C1 / Booklet Finisher-C1---------------------------------- 7-117
ADJUST------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-79
Inner Finisher-A1----------------------------------------------------------------- 7-119
ADJ-XY----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-79
Alarm Code------------------------------------------------------------------ 7-120 CCD--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-80
Alarm Code------------------------------------------------------------------------ 7-120 IMG-REG-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-90
DENS------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-93
8 Service Mode BLANK-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-98
Overview-------------------------------------------------------------------------8-2 V-CONT---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-99
Service Mode Menu---------------------------------------------------------------- 8-2 PASCAL------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-104
Service mode item explanations------------------------------------------------ 8-2 COLOR-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-105
I/O information enhancement---------------------------------------------------- 8-3 HV-PRI-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-110
Display of Error Code/Alarm Code description------------------------------ 8-3 HV-TR--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-114
FEED-ADJ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-126
COPIER > OPTION > BODY, Item Segmentation-------------------------- 8-4
CST-ADJ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-131
Security features-------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-4
MISC----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-131
Related service modes--------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-4
EXP-LED------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-134
Switching Screen (Level 1 < - > 2)--------------------------------------------- 8-5
FUNCTION------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-135
Language switch-------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-6
INSTALL------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-135
Back-up of service mode---------------------------------------------------------- 8-6 CCD------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-140
COPIER--------------------------------------------------------------------------8-7 LASER--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-142
DISPLAY------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-7 DPC------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-143
VERSION-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-7 CST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-145
USER------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-25 CLEANING--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-145
ACC-STS-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-25 FIXING-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-146
ANALOG--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-27 PANEL--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-147
CST-STS--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-28 PART-CHK--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-147
HV-STS----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-28 CLEAR-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-149
CCD--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-29 MISC-R-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-153
DPOT------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-32 MISC-P-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-158
DENS------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-35 SYSTEM------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-159
MISC-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-39 OPTION---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-161
HT-C-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-40 FNC-SW------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-161
IO--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------8-55
DSPLY-SW--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-170 SORTER--------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-258
NETWORK--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-174 ADJUST---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-258
SOUND-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-182 FUNCTION------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-262
ENV-SET------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-182 OPTION---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-263
CLEANING--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-183
BOARD----------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-264
FEED-SW----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-183
OPTION---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-264
IMG-SPD------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-184
IMG-RDR----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-186
9 Installation
IMG-MCON--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-187
IMG-DEV------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-192 How to Check this Installation Procedure--------------------------------9-2
IMG-TR-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-195 When Using the Parts Included in the Package---------------------------- 9-2
IMG-FIX------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-196 Symbols in the Illustration-------------------------------------------------------- 9-2
CUSTOM----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-201 Things to do Before Installation--------------------------------------------9-2
USER---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-203 Selecting an Installing Location------------------------------------------------- 9-2
CST------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-219 Points to Note Before Installation------------------------------------------9-3
ACC------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-222 Combination Table of Accessory Installation----------------------------9-4
INT-FACE----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-226 Combination of the Options installing to the Right Side of the Host
LCNS-TR----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-227
Machine------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-4
TEST-------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-237
Checking the Contents-------------------------------------------------------9-4
PG-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-237
Unpacking------------------------------------------------------------------------9-7
NETWORK--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-239
Installation Procedure------------------------------------------------------- 9-10
COUNTER------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-240
Installing the Drum Unit----------------------------------------------------------9-10
TOTAL--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-240
PICK-UP------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-241
Fixing the Machine in Place-----------------------------------------------------9-18
FEEDER------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-241 Setting the Environment Heater Switch--------------------------------------9-19
JAM------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-242 Turning the Main Power ON / Setting the Toner Container-------------9-20
MISC----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-242 Turning OFF the Main Power Switch-----------------------------------------9-22
JOB------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-243 Setting for K Paper (China only)-----------------------------------------------9-22
DRBL-1-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-244 Cassette Setting--------------------------------------------------------------------9-23
DRBL-2-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-247 Checking after the Installation--------------------------------------------------9-25
T-CNTR------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-251 Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection---------------------------9-25
V-CNTR------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-251 Auto Adjust Gradation------------------------------------------------------------9-25
V2-CNTR----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-252 When "Plain" paper is used--------------------------------------------------------------9-25
LF--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-252 When "Heavy1/Heavy2" paper is used-----------------------------------------------9-26
FEEDER---------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-253 When "Heavy3" paper is used-----------------------------------------------------------9-26
DISPLAY--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-253 Adjusting Image Position---------------------------------------------------------9-27
ADJUST---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 8-254 Margin Adjustment (1st side; Mechanical Adjsutment)----------------------------9-27
FUNCTION------------------------------------------------------------------------ 8-255 Margin Adjustment (2nd side)-----------------------------------------------------------9-30
Margin Adjustment with Multi Purpose Tray (1st side; mechanical adjustment)-- Installation Procedure-------------------------------------------------------------9-61
9-30 When installing the Keyboard---------------------------------------------------9-63
Margin Adjustment with Multi Purpose Tray (2nd side)---------------------------9-32 Key Switch Unit-A2---------------------------------------------------------- 9-64
Lead-edge Margin Adjustment (1st side)---------------------------------------------9-32 Checking the Content-------------------------------------------------------------9-64
Lead-edge Margin Adjustment (2nd side)--------------------------------------------9-33
Turning OFF the power of the Host Machine-------------------------------9-64
Installing Other Parts--------------------------------------------------------------9-34 Installation Procedure-------------------------------------------------------------9-65
Checking Network Connection-------------------------------------------------9-37 Checking after installation-------------------------------------------------------9-70
Overview--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------9-37
Voice Operation Kit C1----------------------------------------------------- 9-71
Checking Network Connection----------------------------------------------------------9-37
Checking the Contents-----------------------------------------------------------9-71
Ping Operation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------------9-37
Points to note when Installing---------------------------------------------------9-72
Checking with Remote Host Address--------------------------------------------------9-37
Turning OFF the Host Machine------------------------------------------------9-72
Troubleshooting of Network-----------------------------------------------------9-38
Checking Connection of the Network Cable-----------------------------------------9-38 Installation Procedure-------------------------------------------------------------9-72
Ping Operation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------------9-38 Setting Check-----------------------------------------------------------------------9-80
Checking Network Setting of the Host Machine------------------------------------9-38 Operation Check-------------------------------------------------------------------9-80
Checking Network Function on the Main Controller-------------------------------9-38 When using-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------9-80
Turning OFF the Main Power Switch-----------------------------------------9-39 To stop the use------------------------------------------------------------------------------9-80
Installation Procedure ------------------------------------------------------------9-39 Voice Guidance Kit-F1------------------------------------------------------ 9-81
Reader Heater Unit (EUR onry)------------------------------------------ 9-42 Checking the Contents-----------------------------------------------------------9-81
Checking the contents------------------------------------------------------------9-42 Points to note when Installing---------------------------------------------------9-82
Turning OFF the power of the Host Machine.------------------------------9-42 Turning OFF the Host Machine------------------------------------------------9-82
Installation Procedure-------------------------------------------------------------9-43 Installation Procedure-------------------------------------------------------------9-83
Checking after the installation--------------------------------------------------9-48 Checking after installation-------------------------------------------------------9-90
Cassette Heater Unit-------------------------------------------------------- 9-49 Operation Check ------------------------------------------------------------------9-90
Checking the Contents (ASIA only)-------------------------------------------9-49 <During use>--------------------------------------------------------------------------------9-90
Cassette Heater Unit-37------------------------------------------------------------------9-49 <To stop the use>--------------------------------------------------------------------------9-90
Checking the Parts to be Installed (EUR only)-----------------------------9-49 Card Reader-C1/Copy Card Reader-F1------------------------------- 9-91
Cassette Heater Unit----------------------------------------------------------------------9-49 Points to Note at Installation----------------------------------------------------9-91
Turning OFF the Main Power Switch-----------------------------------------9-50 Checking the Contents-----------------------------------------------------------9-91
Installation Procedure-------------------------------------------------------------9-50 Card Reader-C1/Copy Card Reader-F1----------------------------------------------9-91
Card Reader Attachment-B1-------------------------------------------------------------9-92
Checking After the Installation--------------------------------------------------9-52
Card Reader Attachment-B2-------------------------------------------------------------9-93
Cassette Heater Unit-32---------------------------------------------------- 9-53
Turning OFF the Host Machine------------------------------------------------9-95
Checking Bundled Components-----------------------------------------------9-53
Installation Procedure-------------------------------------------------------------9-95
Turning OFF the Main Power Switch-----------------------------------------9-53
Setting After Installation-------------------------------------------------------- 9-104
Installation Procedure-------------------------------------------------------------9-54
Copy Tray-J1---------------------------------------------------------------- 9-105
Utility Tray-A1/A2------------------------------------------------------------- 9-60
Checking the contents---------------------------------------------------------- 9-105
Checking the Contents-----------------------------------------------------------9-60
Turning OFF the host machine----------------------------------------------- 9-105 Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation----------------------------------------- 9-143
Installation procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-106 [TYPE-2] Removable HDD Kit------------------------------------------ 9-144
Setting after installation-------------------------------------------------------- 9-107 Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-144
Inner 2-way Tray-F1------------------------------------------------------- 9-108 Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-145
Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-108 Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-145
Turning Off the Main Power Switch----------------------------------------- 9-108 Removing the HDD Unit, Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable------------ 9-145
Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-109 Assembling and Installing the Removable HDD---------------------------------- 9-150
Setting after installation-------------------------------------------------------- 9-110 [TYPE-3] Option HDD (250GB) + Removable HDD Kit---------- 9-160
Additional Memory TypeB (512MB)------------------------------------9-111 Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-160
Checking the contents-----------------------------------------------------------9-111 Option HDD (250GB)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-160
Pre-Check--------------------------------------------------------------------------9-111 Removable HDD Kit--------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-161
Turning OFF the Host Machine-----------------------------------------------9-111 Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-163
Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-112 Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-164
Checking after installation----------------------------------------------------- 9-115 Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-167
Expansion Bus-F1/F2, IPSec Board-B2, Wireless LAN Board-B1 Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-168
Removing the HDD Unit, Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable------------ 9-168
Installation Procedure------------------------------------------------------9-116
Installing the Removable HDD Kit---------------------------------------------------- 9-173
Points to Note when Installing------------------------------------------------ 9-116
Assembling and Installing the Option HDD---------------------------------------- 9-177
Checking the contents---------------------------------------------------------- 9-117
Installing the System Software Using the SST--------------------------- 9-181
Expansion Bus-F1------------------------------------------------------------------------ 9-117
Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation----------------------------------------- 9-181
IPSec Board-B2--------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-117
Wireless LAN Board-B1----------------------------------------------------------------- 9-118 [TYPE-8] HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit-------------------- 9-182
Turning the Host Machine OFF---------------------------------------------- 9-119 Points to Note when HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit has been
Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-120 Installed---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-182
Removing the Main Controller PCB 1----------------------------------------------- 9-120 Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-182
To install Expansion Bus-F1/F2 and IPSec Board-B2 in the same time---- 9-122 HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit------------------------------------------------ 9-182
To install the Expansion Bus-F1/F2, Cordless Wireless LAN Board-B1 and Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-184
IPSec Board-B2 in the same time.--------------------------------------------------- 9-124 Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-185
Checking after installation----------------------------------------------------- 9-132 Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-188
Combination of HDD Options------------------------------------------- 9-133 Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-189
[TYPE-1] Option HDD (250GB)---------------------------------------- 9-134 Removing the Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable-------------------------- 9-189
Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-134 Installing the LED Board------------------------------------------------------- 9-193
Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-135 Installing the Encryption Board-------------------------------------------------------- 9-194
Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-136 Installing the System Software Using the SST--------------------------- 9-200
Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-139 Checking the Security Version------------------------------------------------ 9-200
Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-140 Checking the Security Mark--------------------------------------------------- 9-200
Installing the System Software Using the SST--------------------------- 9-143 Reporting to the System Administrator at the End of the Work------ 9-201
Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation----------------------------------------- 9-201
[TYPE-9] Removable HDD Kit + HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Checking the Security Version------------------------------------------------ 9-251
Kit------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 9-202 Checking the Security Mark--------------------------------------------------- 9-251
Points to Note when HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit has been Reporting to the System Administrator at the End of the Work------ 9-252
Installed---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-202 Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation----------------------------------------- 9-252
Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-202 [TYPE-11] Option HDD (250GB) + Removable HDD Kit + HDD
Removable HDD Kit--------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-202 Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit----------------------------------------- 9-253
HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit------------------------------------------------ 9-204 Points to Note when HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit has been
Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-206 Installed---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-253
Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-207 Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-253
Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-210 Option HDD (250GB)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-253
Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-211 Removable HDD Kit--------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-254
Removing the Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable-------------------------- 9-211 HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit------------------------------------------------ 9-256
Installing the Removable HDD Kit------------------------------------------- 9-215 Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-258
Assembling and Installing the Removable HDD---------------------------------- 9-217 Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-259
Installing the LED Board------------------------------------------------------- 9-221 Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-262
Installing the Encryption Board-------------------------------------------------------- 9-222 Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-263
Installing the System Software Using the SST--------------------------- 9-228 Removing the Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable-------------------------- 9-263
Checking the Security Version------------------------------------------------ 9-228 Installing the Removable HDD Kit------------------------------------------- 9-267
Checking the Security Mark--------------------------------------------------- 9-228 Assembling and Installing the Option HDD---------------------------------------- 9-269
Reporting to the System Administrator at the End of the Work------ 9-229 Installing the LED Board------------------------------------------------------- 9-273
Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation----------------------------------------- 9-229 Installing the Encryption Board-------------------------------------------------------- 9-274
[TYPE-10] Option HDD (250GB) + HDD Data Encryption & Installing the System Software Using the SST--------------------------- 9-280
Mirroring Kit------------------------------------------------------------------ 9-230 Checking the Security Version------------------------------------------------ 9-280
Points to Note when HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit has been Checking the Security Mark--------------------------------------------------- 9-280
Installed---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-230 Reporting to the System Administrator at the End of the Work------ 9-281
Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-230 Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation----------------------------------------- 9-281
Option HDD (250GB)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-230 [TYPE-4] Option HDD (80GB) + HDD Mirroring Kit or HDD Data
HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit------------------------------------------------ 9-231 Encryption & Mirroring Kit------------------------------------------------ 9-282
Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-233 Points to Note when HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit has been
Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-234 Installed---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-282
Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-237 Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-282
Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-238 Option HDD (80GB)---------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-282
Assembling and Installing the Option HDD---------------------------------------- 9-238 HDD Mirroring Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit-------------------- 9-283
Removing and Installing the HDD Unit---------------------------------------------- 9-239 Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-285
Installing the LED Board------------------------------------------------------- 9-244 Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-286
Installing the Encryption Board-------------------------------------------------------- 9-245 Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-289
Installing the System Software Using the SST--------------------------- 9-251
Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-290 Reporting to the System Administrator at the End of the Work (Only
Assembling the Option HDD----------------------------------------------------------- 9-290 when installing HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------- 9-328
Removing and Installing the HDD Unit---------------------------------------------- 9-291 Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation----------------------------------------- 9-328
Installing the LED Board---------------------------------------------------------------- 9-296 [TYPE-6] Option HDD (80GB) + Removable HDD Kit + HDD
Installing the Mirroring Board or Encryption Board------------------------------- 9-297
Mirroring Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit------------- 9-329
Installing the System Software Using the SST (Only when installing Points to Note when HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit has been
HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit)-------------------------------------- 9-303 Installed---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-329
Checking the Security Version (Only when installing HDD Data Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-329
Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------------------------------------------- 9-303 Option HDD (80GB)---------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-329
Checking the Security Mark (Only when installing HDD Data Encryption Removable HDD Kit--------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-330
& Mirroring Kit)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-303 HDD Mirroring Kit HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit----------------------- 9-332
Setting the Mirroring------------------------------------------------------------- 9-304 Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-334
Reporting to the System Administrator at the End of the Work (Only Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-335
when installing HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------- 9-304 Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-338
Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation (Only when installing HDD Data Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-339
Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------------------------------------------- 9-304 Removing the HDD Unit, Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable------------ 9-339
[TYPE-5] 2 Option HDDs (250GB) + HDD Mirroring Kit or HDD Installing the Removable HDD Kit---------------------------------------------------- 9-344
Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit----------------------------------------- 9-305 Disassembling/Assembling and Installing the HDD Removed from the Host
Points to Note when HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit has been Machine (First HDD)--------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-346
Installed---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-305 Assembling and Installing the Option HDD (Second HDD)-------------------- 9-349
Installing the LED Board---------------------------------------------------------------- 9-352
Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-305
Installing the Mirroring Board or Encryption Board------------------------------- 9-353
Option HDD (250GB)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-305
HDD Mirroring Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit-------------------- 9-306 Installing the System Software Using the SST (Only when installing
Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-308 HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit)-------------------------------------- 9-359
Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-309 Checking the Security Version (Only when installing HDD Data
Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-312 Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------------------------------------------- 9-359
Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-313 Checking the Security Mark (Only when installing HDD Data Encryption
Assembling the Option HDD----------------------------------------------------------- 9-313 & Mirroring Kit)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-359
Removing and Installing the HDD Unit---------------------------------------------- 9-314 Setting the Mirroring------------------------------------------------------------- 9-360
Installing the LED Board---------------------------------------------------------------- 9-320 Reporting to the System Administrator at the End of the Work (Only
Installing the Mirroring Board or Encryption Board------------------------------- 9-321 when installing HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------- 9-360
Installing the System Software Using the SST--------------------------- 9-327 Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation (Only when installing HDD Data
Checking the Security Version (Only when installing HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------------------------------------------- 9-360
Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------------------------------------------- 9-327 [TYPE-7] 2 Option HDDs (250GB) + Removable HDD Kit + HDD
Checking the Security Mark (Only when installing HDD Data Encryption Mirroring Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit------------- 9-361
& Mirroring Kit)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-327 Points to Note when HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit has been
Setting the Mirroring------------------------------------------------------------- 9-328 Installed---------------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-361
Checking the Contents--------------------------------------------------------- 9-361 General Circuit Diagram (4/16)-------------------------------------------------- XVI
Option HDD (250GB)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-361 General Circuit Diagram (5/16)------------------------------------------------- XVII
Removable HDD Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit----------------- 9-362 General Circuit Diagram (6/16)------------------------------------------------ XVIII
HDD Mirroring Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit-------------------- 9-364 General Circuit Diagram (7/16)-------------------------------------------------- XIX
Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export-------------------------- 9-366 General Circuit Diagram (8/16)---------------------------------------------------XX
Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)-------------------------- 9-367 General Circuit Diagram (9/16)-------------------------------------------------- XXI
Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power----------------------- 9-370 General Circuit Diagram (10/16)----------------------------------------------- XXII
Installation Procedure----------------------------------------------------------- 9-371 General Circuit Diagram (11/16)---------------------------------------------- XXIII
Removing the HDD Unit, Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable------------ 9-371 General Circuit Diagram (12/16)---------------------------------------------- XXIV
Installing the Removable HDD Kit---------------------------------------------------- 9-376
General Circuit Diagram (13/16)-----------------------------------------------XXV
Assembling and Installing the Option HDD (First HDD)------------------------ 9-378
General Circuit Diagram (14/16)---------------------------------------------- XXVI
Assembling and Installing the Option HDD (Second HDD)-------------------- 9-381
General Circuit Diagram (15/16)--------------------------------------------- XXVII
Installing the LED Board---------------------------------------------------------------- 9-384
General Circuit Diagram (16/16)-------------------------------------------- XXVIII
Installing the Mirroring Board or Encryption Board------------------------------- 9-385
Installing the System Software Using the SST--------------------------- 9-391 List of User Mode----------------------------------------------------------- XXIX
Environment Settings------------------------------------------------------------ XXIX
Checking the Security Version (Only when installing HDD Data
Paper Settings------------------------------------------------------------------------------ XXIX
Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------------------------------------------- 9-391
Display Settings---------------------------------------------------------------------------- XXIX
Checking the Security Mark (Only when installing HDD Data Encryption
Timer/Energy Settings---------------------------------------------------------------------XXX
& Mirroring Kit)-------------------------------------------------------------------- 9-391
Network---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------XXX
Setting the Mirroring------------------------------------------------------------- 9-392 External Interface----------------------------------------------------------------------- XXXVII
Reporting to the System Administrator at the End of the Work (Only Accessibility------------------------------------------------------------------------------ XXXVII
when installing HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit)----------------- 9-392 Adjustment/Maintenance----------------------------------------------------- XXXVII
Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation----------------------------------------- 9-392 Adjust Image Quality------------------------------------------------------------------- XXXVII
Adjust Action---------------------------------------------------------------------------- XXXVIII
Appendix Maintenance---------------------------------------------------------------------------- XXXVIII
Service Tools---------------------------------------------------------------------- II Function Settings------------------------------------------------------------- XXXVIII
Special Tools---------------------------------------------------------------------------- II Common--------------------------------------------------------------------------------- XXXVIII
Solvents and Oils--------------------------------------------------------------------- IV Copy-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- XLI
Printer------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ XLII
General Timing Chart----------------------------------------------------------- V
Send------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------- XLII
General Timing Chart-----------------------------------------------------------------V
Receive/Forward--------------------------------------------------------------------------- XLVI
A4 single-sided 2 prints full color-----------------------------------------------------------V
Store/Access Files-------------------------------------------------------------------------XLVII
A4 single-sided 2 prints Bk color---------------------------------------------------------- VI
Encrypted Secure Print-----------------------------------------------------------------XLVIII
General Circuit Diagram Signal Input/Output List---------------------- VII
Set Destination-------------------------------------------------------------------XLVIII
General Circuit Diagram -----------------------------------------------------XIII
Set Destination----------------------------------------------------------------------------XLVIII
General Circuit Diagram (1/16)-------------------------------------------------- XIII
Management Settings----------------------------------------------------------- XLIX
General Circuit Diagram (2/16)-------------------------------------------------- XIV
User Management------------------------------------------------------------------------- XLIX
General Circuit Diagram (3/16)---------------------------------------------------XV
Device Management---------------------------------------------------------------------- XLIX
License/Other----------------------------------------------------------------------------------- LI
Data Management---------------------------------------------------------------------------- LII
Backup Data--------------------------------------------------------------------- LIII
Detail of HDD partition--------------------------------------------------------LVI
Soft counter specifications-------------------------------------------------- LVII
Soft counter specifications--------------------------------------------------------LVII
Safety Precautions

■CDRH Act

■Laser Safety

■Handling of Laser System

■Turn power switch ON

■Points to Note About
Turning Off the Main imageRUNNER ADVANCE
Power Switch C5051/5045/5035/5030

■Safety of Toner
Series

■Notes When Handling a
Lithium Battery

■Notes Before it Works
Serving
CDRH Act Handling of Laser System
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health of the US Food and Drum Administration put When servicing the area around the laser assembly, be sure to turn off the main power.
into force regulations concerning laser products on August 2, 1976. These regulations apply The machine's covers that can reflect laser light are identified by means of a warning label
to laser products manufactured on and after August 1, 1976, and the sale of laser products (Figure). If you must detach a cover showing the label, be sure to take extra caution during
not certified under the regulations is banned within the Untied States. The label shown here the work.
indicates compliance with the CDRH regulations, and its attachment is required on all laser
products that are soled in the United States.

CANON INC.
30-2,SHIMOMARUKO,3-CHOME,OHTA-KU,TOKYO,JAPAN

MANUFACTURED:
THIS PRODUCT CONHORMS WITH DHHS RADIATION
PERFORMANCE STANDARD 21CFR CHAPTER 1
SUBCHAPTER J.

F-0-1

A different description may be used for a different product.

F-0-2

Laser Safety
Laser beam radiation may pose a danger to the human body. A laser scanner mounted on the
machine is sealed with the protection housing and external cover to prevent the laser beam
from leaking to the outside. The laser beam never leaks out of the scanner as far as users
operate the machine normally.
Turn power switch ON Safety of Toner
The machine is equipped with 2 power switches: main power switch and control panel power
switch. About Toner
The machine goes on when the main power switch is turned on (i.e., other than in low power The machine's toner is a non-toxic material made of plastic, iron, and small amounts of dye.
mode, sleep mode).

CAUTION:
Do not throw toner into fire. It may cause explosion.
CAUTION:
Do not turn off the main power switch while the progress bar is indicated, during which
access is made to the HDD. If deprived of power, the HDD can suffer a fault (E602). Toner on Clothing or Skin
• If your clothing or skin has come into contact with toner, wipe it off with tissue; then, wash it
off with water.
• Do not use warm water, which will cause the toner to jell and fuse permanently with the
fibers of the cloth.
• Tonner is easy to react with plastic material, avoid contact with plastic.
Notes When Handling a Lithium Battery

CAUTION:
RISK OF EXPLOSION IF BATTERY IS REPLACED BY AN INCORRECT TYPE.
DISPOSE OF USED BATTERIES ACCORDING TO THE INSTRUCTIONS.

The following warnings are given to comply with Safety Principles (EN60950).

CAUTION:
Wenn mit dem falschen Typ ausgewechselt, besteht Explosionsgefahr.
Gebrauchte Batterien gemäß der Anleitung beseitigen.

Notes Before it Works Serving

CAUTION:
At servicing, be sure to turn OFF the power source according to the specified steps and
disconnect the power plug.

Points to Note at Cleaning

CAUTION:
When performing cleaning using organic solvent such as alcohol, be sure to check that
the component of solvent is vaporized completely before assembling.
1 Product Overvew

■Product

■Feature
Lineup


■Specifications

■Name of Parts

1
1
1-2

Product Lineup ■■Host machine configuration


Host machine configuration
Printer only
Host machine T-1-1

■■Model type
C5051 C5045 C5035 C5030
Print Speed (BW /
51 / 51ppm 45 / 45ppm 35 / 35ppm 30 / 30ppm
Color)
Positioning High-speed / high-quality Middle-Office Cost-prioritized Standard-Office model
model Target machine :
Target machine : iRC3380 / 2880Series,
iRC5180 / 4580 / 3880Series iRC6800Series, iRC3100Series
T-1-2

imageRUNNER ADVANCE C50 51


A B

A: Product category (90: Production model, 50 : Office model)


B: Print speed (unit is ppm : print per minutes)
F-1-2

F-1-1

1-2
1
1
1-3
Option No. Brand name Remarks and condition
1 Inner Finisher Additional Tray-A1 -
■■Pickup delivery / image reading options 2 Inner Finisher-A1 Built-in finisher
3 Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 ADF-XD (1 Path Duplex Type DADF) + Reader
【6】 4 Reader Heater Kit-G1 For USA,CCI,CLA, this is provided as a service
part.
【4】 5 Color Image Reader Unit-B1 ADF-SU (Reverse Duplex Type DADF) + Reader
【5】
6 Color Image Reader Unit-B2 Copyboard + Reader
7 Printer Cover-C1 -
8 Copy Tray-J1 -
9 Cassette Heater Unit-32 Deck Heater for Paper Deck Unit-B1.
【3】
10 Paper Deck Unit-B1 -
11 Envelope Feeder Attachment-D1 Cassette Attachment for envelope
12 FL Cassette-AG1 -
【8】
13 FL Cassette-AH1 -
14 Cassette Heater Unit-37 Cassette Heater for host machine, 2-Cassette
【9】 Pedestal-AD1
【7】
【2】 15 Cassette Feeding Unit-AD1 -
16 Buffer Pass Unit-G1 -
17 Inner 2Way Tray-F1 For host machine delivery additional tray
【1】 18 External 2 Hole Puncher-B1 External 2/3 Hole Puncher-B1(USA,CAN,CLA),
External 2/4 Hole Puncher-B1(EUR,FRA,CA),
External 4 Hole Puncher-B1(EUR)
19 Booklet Finisher-C1 Buffer Path Unit G1 is required
【17】 【10】 20 Staple Finisher-C1 Buffer Path Unit G1 is required
【11】 T-1-3

【16】

【15】

【20】 【12】
【18】

【19】 【14】 【13】


F-1-3

1-3
1
1
1-4
■■Function expanding option No. Brand name Remarks and condition
14 Additional Memory Type B (512MB) -
【6】 15 Image Data Analyzer Board-A1 Document Scan Lock Kit-A1 is required
16 Super G3 FAX Board-AE1 -
17 Super G3 2nd Line Fax Board-AE1 1-line FAX board is required
【5】 18 Super G3 3rd/4th Line Fax Board-AE1 1-line FAX board + additional 2nd line FAX Board
【7】
【4】 is required (A European region is excluded. )
【2】
【3】
【1】 19 imagePASS-B1 -
Voice 20 IPSec Board-B2 PCI bus expansion kit-F1 is required
Voice Guidance 21 Wireless LAN Board-B1 -
Operation Unit 22 Signal Interface Kit-A1 -
【8】
Unit 23 Serial Interface Kit-K1 -
【11】【10】 24 PCL Printer Kit-AE1 -
Direct Print Kit (for PDF/XPS)-H1 -
Voice
Operation
【24】 Barcode Printing Kit-D1 -
Voice Encrypted Secure Print Software-D1 -
PCB
Guidance 【12】
IMPOSE(Ver2.7) Roman Number of license: 1, 3, 7
PCB
【23】 【13】 Universal Send Digital User Signature -
【22】 Kit-C1
【14】 Universal Send Advanced Feature Set-D1 -
【21】 Universal Send Security Feature Set-D1 -
【20】 【9】 Remote Operators Software Kit-B1 -
【15】 Remote Operators Software Kit-A3 -
HOTFOLDER VER.2 -
【16】 HDD Data Erase Kit-A1 -
【17】 Remote Fax Kit-A1 -
【19】 PS Printer Kit-AE1 -
【18】
Secure Watermark-A1 -
F-1-4 Document Scan Lock Kit-A1 -
No. Brand name Remarks and condition ACCESS MANAGEMENT SYSTEM Kit-B1 -
1 Voice Operation Kit-C1 Note Web Access Software-H1 -
2 Voice Guidance Kit-F1 Note T-1-4
3 Removable HDD Kit-AC1 -
4 2.5inch/80GB HDD-C1 - MEMO:
2.5inch/250GB HDD-D1 Only when Mirroring Kit is extended There is a combination restriction when installing No1,2,5 to 6. (Part No5 can be
5 Copy Card Reader-C1 Note installed with any of those. Other than No5, only one of them can be installed.)
Copy Card Reader Attachment-B1 Note
6 Utility Tray-A1 Note
7 Multimedia Reader/Writer-A1 USB device port-B1 is required
8 USB Device Port-B1 -
9 ColorPASS-GX300/PS-GX300 -
10 Key Switch Unit-A2 -
11 HDD Mirroring Kit-D1 -
12 HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit-C1 -
13 Expansion Bus-F1 -

1-4
1
1
1-5

Feature Features at servicing


■■Improvement on upgrade operation
Product feature
It is possible to upgrade options through the host machine.
■■Product feature Same as conventional way, use SST (service support tool) to upgrade.

■■New type connector is adopted


Fixing Assembly
・Color on-demand fixing
 method is adopted.
Toner Container
・New toner is adopted. High-speed support

High image quality ITB


・Primary Transfer Roller
Y M C Bk  detaching control is
adopted.
Developing Assembly
Low running cost
・ACR control is adopted.
・Developing Assembly/Drum
Unit are separated.
・Highly-durable drum is
adopted(BK only). Laser Scanner Unit
・Twin Laser Scanner Unit
High image quality ・Capable of 1200 dpi

Low running cost


High image quality

High-speed support
Main Controller
・Next generation controller
is adopted.

High image quality

High-speed support

To prevent the communication error due to following factors, new type connector is adopted.
• Loose connector / disconnection due to vibration during transportation
• Imperfect connection of connector at service operation

F-1-5

1-5
1
1
1-6

Specification Paper size (upper cassette) B4,A4,A4R,B5,B5R,A5R,LGL,LTRR,LTR,EXEC,Custom size (Min


139.7mm x 182mm to Max 304.8mm x 390mm),K8,K16,K16R
Paper size (lower cassette) A3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, B5R, A5R, 12”×18”(305mm×457mm), 11” x
Specification 17”, LGL, LTR, LTRR, STMTR, EXEC, Custom size (Min 139.7mm
x 182mm to Max 304.8mm x 457.2mm), K8, K16, K16R, Envelope
(COM10, Monarch, DL, ISO-B5, ISO-C5)
Host machine installation Desktop type Paper size (multi-purpose tray A3, B4, A4, A4R, B5, A5,A5R,12””×18””(305mm×457mm),11””×17””,
method pickup) LGL, LTR, LTRR, STMT, STMTR, EXEC, K8, K16, K16R, FLS,
Photosensitive medium Phi 30 OPC 305×457, 320×450(SRA3), Custom size (Min 99mm x 139.7mm to
Exposure method Laser exposure Max 320 mm x 457.2mm),Postcard, Envelope (COM10, Monarch,
Charging method Roller charging DL, ISO-B5, ISO-C5)
Developing method Dry type 2-component jumping development Pickup capacity Cassette: 550 sheet (80g/m2), multi-purpose tray pickup: 100 sheet
Transfer method Intermediate belt transfer (80g/m2)
(Primary transfer: roller transfer, secondary transfer: roller transfer) Duplexing method Through path duplexing
Separation method Curvature separation + static eliminator Memory capacity Main controller PCB: 1 GB
Pickup method Separation retard Main controller PCB2: 1GB/1.5GB (differs depending on destination
Fixing method On demand fixing (Ceramic nitride heater + Phi 30 elastic film) and model)
Delivery method Facedown (inner delivery) Note:
Drum cleaning method Cleaning blade Option (additional memory 512MB) can be extended to main
Transfer cleaning method Cleaning blade controller PCB 2.
Toner type Non-magnetic negative toner HDD capacity 80GB (Option 80GB C1/ 250GB D1)
Toner supply method Toner container method Operation noise 75dB or less (during printing)
Toner level detection function Yes Ozone amount Maximum: 0.01 ppm or less
Leading edge image margin 4.0+1.5/-1.0mm Power rating AC120V/20A (image RUNNER ADVANCE C5051/C5045 Series)
Left edge image margin 2.5+/-1.5mm AC120V/15A (image RUNNER ADVANCE C5035/C5030 Series)
AC220-240V/10A
Leading edge blank width 4.0+1.5/-1.0mm
Maximum power consumption image RUNNER ADVANCE C5051/C5045 Series: 1.8kW or less
Left edge blank width 2.5+/-1.5mm
image RUNNER ADVANCE C5035/C5030 Series: 1.3kW or less
Warm-up time At power-ON, 38 sec or less
Power consumption during 120V:1.1KW or less
First print time image RUNNER ADVANCE C5051/C5045 Series B/W :4.0sec
copy 220V-240:1.3KW or less
Color : 6.5sec
Power consumption during 120V: 120W or less
image RUNNER ADVANCE C5035/C5030 Series B/W :5.5sec
standby 220V-240: 150W or less
Color : 8.9sec
Dimension (W x D x H) 620mm x735mmx 801mm (printer only)
Image gradation 256 gradation Grammage Approx. 133kg (printer only)
T-1-5
Print resolution 1200 x 1200dpi
Maximum image guaranteed 300 x 450.5mm
area
Maximum printable area 305 x 450.5mm
Paper type (cassette) Thin paper (52 to 63g/m2), Recycled paper (64 to 81g/m2), Color
paper, Pre-Punched paper, Bond paper, Plain paper (64 to 105g/
m2), Heavy paper (106 to 209g/m2), Textured paper, Transparency
film, Tab paper, Envelope
Paper type (multi-purpose tray) Thin paper (52 to 63g/m2), Recycled paper (64 to 81g/m2), Color
paper, Pre-Punched paper, Bond paper, Plain paper (64 to 105g/
m2), Heavy paper (106 to 256g/m2), Textured paper, Tracking
paper, Coater paper,Labels paper, Washi paper,Transparency film,
Tab

1-6
1
1
1-7
Weight / Size ImageRUNNER ADVANCE
Paper C5051 C5045
Width Depth Height WeightApprox. basis Multi- Multi-
Product name Size Mode Paper type
(mm) (mm) (mm) (Kg) weight(g/ Cassette purpose Cassette purpose
iR ADVANCE C5051/C5045 620 735 806 153 m2) tray tray
iR ADVANCE C5035/C5030 620 735 806 170 Color, B/W Color, B/W Color, B/W Color, B/W
Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 618 588 251 38.8 52-81 25.5 19.5 25.5 19.5
Color Image Reader Unit-B1 620 536 207 23 Plain paper
82-105 25.5 19.5 25.5 19.5
Color Image Reader Unit-B2 620 564 72 13.7 1-sided 105-163 12.5 9.8 12.5 9.8
Cassette Feeding Unit-AD1 620 700 251 27.5 Thick paper 164-209 10.0 9.8 10.0 9.8
Paper Deck Unit-B1 372 603 473 37 210-256 - 6.5 - 6.5
Envelope Feeder Attachment-D1 439 307 81 1.2 A3 / LDR
52-81 25.5 19.5 25.5 19.5
Inner Finisher-A1 602 540 234 13.5 Plain paper
82-105 25.5 19.5 25.5 19.5
Staple Finisher-C1 545 656 1071 47 2-sided 105-163 12.5 9.8 12.5 9.8
Booklet Finisher-C1 756 656 1071 76 Thick paper 164-209 10.0 9.8 10.0 9.8
Buffer Pass Unit-G1 489 493 184 4 210-256 - - - -
External 2 Hole Puncher-B1 107 623 908 7.2 T-1-7
External 2/3 Hole Puncher-B1 756 656 1071 76
T-1-6 ImageRUNNER ADVANCE
Paper C5035 C5030
Productivity (Print speed) Size Mode Paper type
basis Multi- Multi-
weight(g/ Cassette purpose Cassette purpose
ImageRUNNER ADVANCE m2) tray tray
Paper Color, B/W Color, B/W Color, B/W Color, B/W
C5051 C5045
basis 52-81 35.0 20.0 30.0 20.0
Multi- Multi- Plain paper
Size Mode Paper type 82-105 35.0 20.0 30.0 20.0
weight(g/ Cassette purpose Cassette purpose
1-sided 105-163 17.0 10.0 17.0 10.0
m2) tray tray Thick paper 164-209 17.0 10.0 17.0 10.0
Color, B/W Color, B/W Color, B/W Color, B/W 210-256 - 10.0 - 10.0
52-81 51.0 31.0 45.0 31.0 A4 / LTR
Plain paper 52-81 35.0 20.0 30.0 20.0
82-105 51.0 31.0 45.0 31.0 Plain paper
82-105 35.0 20.0 30.0 20.0
1-sided 105-163 25.5 15.5 25.5 15.5 2-sided 105-163 17.0 10.0 17.0 10.0
Thick paper 164-209 20.0 15.5 20 15.5 Thick paper 164-209 17.0 10.0 17.0 10.0
210-256 - 10.0 - 10.0 210-256 - - - -
A4 / LTR
52-81 51.0 31.0 45.0 31.0 52-81 17.5 13.0 17.5 13.0
Plain paper Plain paper
82-105 51.0 31.0 45.0 31.0 82-105 17.5 13.0 17.5 13.0
2-sided 105-163 25.5 15.5 25.5 15.5 1-sided 105-163 8.5 6.5 8.5 6.5
Thick paper 164-209 20.0 15.5 20 15.5 Thick paper 164-209 8.5 6.5 8.5 6.5
210-256 - - - - 210-256 - 6.5 - 6.5
A3 / LDR
52-81 17.5 13.0 17.5 13.0
Plain paper
82-105 17.5 13.0 17.5 13.0
2-sided 105-163 8.5 6.5 8.5 6.5
Thick paper 164-209 8.5 6.5 8.5 6.5
210-256 - - - -
T-1-8

1-7
1
1
1-8
Paper type ■■Pickup
Usable paper types are shown on the next page and later. Multi- Cassette Cassette
Paper type(g/ Cassette Cassette Paper
Size purpose Feeding Feeding
For irregular-sized paper, refer to the table below. m2) 1 2 Deck
tray Unit 1 Unit 2
Type Feeding direction (mm) Width direction (mm) • Plain 1 (52 to A4, LTR Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
Irregular size 1-1 182.0 to 209.9 139.7 to 181.9 81) B4, A4R, A5R, Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No
Irregular size 1-2 210.0 to 279.2 - Thin, Recycled, B5, B5R, EXEC,
Irregular size 1-3 279.3 to 432.0 - Pre-Punched, LGL, LTRR,
Irregular size 1-4 432.1 to 487.7 - Color STMTR, 16K,
Irregular size 2-1 182.0 to 209.9 182.0 to 210.0 16KR
Irregular size 2-2 210.0 to 279.2 - • Plain 2 (82 to A3, LDR, EXE, Yes No Yes Yes Yes No
105) 12”No18”, 8K
Irregular size 2-3 279.3 to 432.0 -
Bond A5, STMT, Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes No
Irregular size 2-4 432.1 to 487.7 -
Irregular size 3-1 182.0 to 209.9 210.1 to 297.0 OFFICIO,
• Heavy 1 (106 E-OFFICIO,
Irregular size 3-2 210.0 to 279.2 - to 163) B-OFFICIO,
Irregular size 3-3 279.3 to 432.0 - Textured M-OFFICIO,
Irregular size 3-4 432.1 to 487.7 - • Heavy 2 (164 A-OFFICIO,
Irregular size 4-1 182.0 to 209.9 297.1 to 330.2 to 209) A-LTR, A-LTRR,
Irregular size 4-2 210.0 to 279.2 - Labels, Tab GLTR-R, GLTR,
Irregular size 4-3 279.3 to 432.0 - GLGL, AFLS,
Irregular size 4-4 432.1 to 487.7 - FLS, Irregular
Irregular size 5 487.8 to 630.0 139.7 to 330.2 size 1-1, Irregular
T-1-9 size 1-2, Irregular
size 1-3, Irregular
size 1-4, Irregular
size 2-1, Irregular
size 2-2, Irregular
size 2-3, Irregular
size 2-4, Irregular
size 3-1, Irregular
size 3-2, Irregular
size 3-3, Irregular
size 3-4, Irregular
size 4-1, Irregular
size 4-2, Irregular
size 4-3, Irregular
size 4-4, Irregular
size 5
SRA3, EXEC-R Yes No No No No No
Transparency A4, LTR Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes

1-8
1
1
1-9

Paper type(g/
Multi-
Cassette Cassette
Cassette Cassette
Paper Name of Parts
Size purpose Feeding Feeding
m2) 1 2 Deck
tray Unit 1 Unit 2
• Special paper A4, LTR, B4, Yes No No No No No External View
Tracing, Coated, A4R, A5R, B5,
Washi B5R, EXEC,
1
LGL, LTRR,
• Heavy 3 (210 STMTR, 16K,
to 258) 16KR, A3, LDR,
EXE, 12”No18”,
8K, A5, STMT,
SRA3, OFFICIO, 11
E-OFFICIO,
B-OFFICIO, 10
M-OFFICIO,
A-OFFICIO, 9
A-LTR, A-LTRR, 8 2
GLTR-R, GLTR, 12
GLGL, AFLS,
7
FLS, F4A,
6
Irregular size 1-1,
5
Irregular size 1-2,
4 13
Irregular size 1-3,
Irregular size 1-4,
Irregular size 2-1,
Irregular size 2-2,
Irregular size 2-3, 3 11
Irregular size 2-4, F-1-6
Irregular size 3-1,
Irregular size 3-2, [1] DADF [8] Front Cover
Irregular size 3-3, [2] Main Power Switch [9] Front Upper Cover
Irregular size 3-4, [3] Stack Bypass Tray [10] Output Tray
Irregular size 4-1, [4] Paper Drawer4 [11] Control Panel
Irregular size 4-2, [5] Paper Drawer3 [12] Rear Cover
Irregular size 4-3, [6] Paper Drawer2 [13] Rear Rower Cover
Irregular size 4-4, [7] Paper Drawer1 [14] Breaker
Irregular size 5
Postcard A6 irregular Yes No No No No No
Envelope COM10, Yes No Yes* No No No * : Be sure to perform the following procedure for checking the breaker.
Monarch, ISO-C5, 1) Turn OFF the main power switch and check that the Control Panel LED is off.
ISO-B5, DL, 2) Using a pen point, press the test button of the breaker on the rear side of the machine.
* When Envelope Feeder Attachment-D1 is installed T-1-10
3) Check that the breaker switch is OFF (O side).
4) Return the breaker switch to ON (I side).
5) Turn ON the main power switch.

1-9
1
1
1-10
Cross Sectional View [1] Reversal roller [16] Fixing separration guide [31] Cassette 2 feeding roller
[2] 2-side delivery / delivery [17] Pressure roller [32] Cassette 2 separation
unit roller
[3] Secondary delivery roller [18] Film unit [33] Casset 2 pick-up roller
[4] Second delivery entrance [19] ITB unit [34] Casset pick-up unit
flapper
[5] Second delivery flapper [20] Registration roller [35] Laser scanner unit (BK /
[1] C)
[2] [6] Third delivery roller [21] 2-side delivery lower [36] Laser scanner unit (M / Y)
roller
[3]
[7] Second / third delivery [22] Registration roller [37] Developing unit (Bk) +
[4]
entrance roller Drum unit (Bk)
[5] [8] 2-side entrance roller [23] Bypass feeding roller [38] Developing unit (C) +
[45] [6] Drum unit (C)
[7] [9] Primary delivery roller [24] Bypass pick-up roller [39] Developing unit (M) +
[44] [8] Drum unit (M)
[9]
[43] [10] [10] Primary delivery flapper [25] Bypass separration roller [40] Developing unit (Y) +
[11] Drum unit (Y)
[42] [12] [11] Fixing inner delivery [26] Vertical path roller 1 [41] ITB cleaning unit
[13] opposed roller
[14] [12] Fixing inner delivery roller [27] Cassette 1 feeding roller [42] Hopper unit (Y)
[15] [13] Fixing unit [28] Cassette 1 separation [43] Hopper unit (M)
[16] roller
Y M C Bk [17] [14] Post-fixing roller [29] Casset 1 pick-up roller [44] Hopper unit (C)
[41]
[18] [15] 2-side delivery upper [30] Vertical path roller 2 [45] Hopper unit (BK)
[19] rollerr
[20]
[21]
[40] [22]
[23]
[24]
[39]
[38] [25]
[37] [26]
[27]
[28]
[36] [29]
[35] [30]
[31]

[32]
[34]
[33]
F-1-7

1-10
1
1
1-11

Operation ■■How to turn ON / OFF the power and points to note


• While progress bar is kept displayed at power-on, HDD access is processing; thus, never
Power Switch turn OFF the Main Power Switch.
• To turn off the power, turn off the Main Power Switch. (Conventional shutdown sequence
■■Types of power switch operation is not required.)
• After power-OFF (after the Main Power Switch is turned OFF), do not reactivate the Main
Environmnet Control Panel Power Switch until a screen disappears.
Heater Switch Power Switch
• Do not turn OFF the power while download is processing.

CAUTION: Points to Note on Completion Process at Problem Occurrence


When a problem occurs, the normal shutdown screen may not be displayed regardless
of turning OFF the main power switch.
In such a case, the power is turned OFF in 110 seconds at a maximum, so do not turn
ON the power again during this time.

Main Power Switch

F-1-8
This machine is equipped with the Main Power Switch, Control Panel Power Switch and
Environment Heater Switch.

[1] Main Power Switch


This switch is used to turn OFF / ON the power of host machine.
[2] Control Panel Power Switch
This switch is to shift the machine to power-save mode or to restore it to normal mode.
[3] Environment Heater Switch
Environment Heater Switch is to supply and shut the power to Cassette Heater and
Reader Heater.

1-11
1
1
1-12
Description of Control Panel ■■Main Menu
iR ADVANCE C5051 / 5045 / 5035 / 5030 Series
■■Control Panel
iR ADVANCE C5051 / 5045 / 5035 / 5030 Series

1 2

15 1 2 3 4

14
3 Scan and Send
4 5 6 7 8

Fax / I-Fax
Inbox
9

13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5
F-1-9

[1] Control Panel Power Switch [9] ID (authentication) Key


[2] USB Insertion Slot [10] Touch Panel Display
[3] Settings / Registration Key [11] Screen Brightness Adjustment Dial
[4] Counter Check Key [12] FAX Volume Adjustment Key
[5] Operation Pen [13] Status Check / Stop Key F-1-10
[6] Main Power Lamp [14] Custom Menu Key [1] Copy [6] Secured Print
[7] Error Lamp [15] Main Menu Key [2] Scan and Send [7] Scanner
[8] Execution / Memory Lamp [3] Scan and Store [8] Set / Regi. Short Cut
[4] Access Stored Files [9] Tutorial
[5] Fax / I-Fax Inbox

1-12
1
1
1-13
■■Difference of main menu ■■Settings / Registration menu
iR ADVANCE iR ADVANCE C5051 / 5045 / 5035 / 5030 Series
iRC 3380 / 2880 Series
C5151/5045/5035/5030 Series
Copy Copy Settings/Registration
Send Scan and Send
Mail BOX Scan and Store Select an item to set
Access Stored Files
Fax / I-Fax Inbox
Menu Change Key ----- TOP Preferences 1
Print Job Secured Print
Scan Scanner Adjustment/Maintenance
----- Set / Regi. Short Cut 2
(Help) Tutorial Function Settings
T-1-11 3

Set Destination 1/1


4

Management Settings
5

Log in OK

F-1-11

[1] Preferences [4] Set Destination


[2] Adjustment / Maintenance [5] Management Settings
[3] Function Settings

■■Difference of Settings / Registration menu


iR ADVANCE
iRC 3380 / 2880 Series
C5151/5045/5035/5030 Series
Common Settings Preferences
Timer Settings
Adjustment / Cleaning Adjustment / Maintenance
System Settings Set Destination
Report Settings Function Settings
Copy Settings
Communication Settings
Mail Box Settings
Printer Settings
Address Book Settings Management Settings
T-1-12

1-13
1
1
1-14
Service Mode ■■Description display of service mode item
It is possible to browse the usage method of service mode items in service mode. Enables to display the description of initial screen, large category, middle category and small
Following is the changed and added items compared to a conventional machine. category.
Select any from initial screen > large category > middle category > small category, and press [i]
(information button) so that the description of selected item (hereinafter called service mode
■■Service mode menu
contents) is displayed.
In the stanbay condition, press in this order: key -> 2+8 key -> key, and the e.g.) COPIER > DISPLAY > Version screen
screen will switch as on the below:

TOP screen

1) Press [i]

4) A detailed explanation on the


item will be displayed (usage
scenarios, instructions,
settings range, etc.).
2) Minor item titles
are displayed.

F-1-12
[MODELIST] :
This mode is newly added from this machine.
This mode has the function to browse the usage method of service mode items etc.
New functions described later are available in MODELIST mode.

[MODELIST CLASSIC] :
This is the same mode with a conventional machine.
New functions described later are not available in MODELIST CLASSIC mode.
3) Select the desired
When [MODELIST] or [MODELIST CLASSIC] is pressed, initial screen of each mode is minor item and
displayed. press [i]

F-1-13
• Service mode contents can be displayed in J / E / F / I / G / S.
• Alike other system software, service mode contents can be upgrade with SST.

1-14
1
1
1-15
■■Enhancement of I/O information Device classification

This mode is to check the signal input / output status of used electrical parts (sensor / motor /
fan etc.).
Searchability for target electrical parts has been improved in COPIER > I / O.
In addition, it is possible to check the signal input / output status on a screen. 1) Press the button.
Electrical parts
classification Which button to press, will depend on which
electrical parts intended and its device
classification. For instance, if the host
machine uses paper pass detection sensor,
then press the button on the "COPIER" and
"P-Sensor" position.

2) Then the selected electrical


parts classification's mark,
name, port number and 0/1
content will appear.

3) If the "i" button is pressed,


the screen displaying the
electrical parts array will appear.

F-1-14

1-15
1
1
1-16
■■Subdivide COPIER > OPTION > BODY items Middle category classification
Middle
Details
category name
COPIER DISPLAY COPIER DISPLAY FNC-SW Feeding (pickup / delivery) FEED-SW Stack performance, motor speed fine-adjustment,
FEEDER FEEDER delivery function etc.
I/O I/O DSPLY-SW
SORTER SORTER Noise reduction SOUND Noise related
ADJUST ADJUST NETWORK Network NETWORK Network setting, IFAX, SEND, E-RDS etc.
BOARD BOARD
FUNCTION FUNCTION SOUND Individual measure CUSTOM For individual measure
OPTION BODY OPTION ENV-SET T-1-13

TEST TEST CLEANING


■■Security measure
COUNTER COUNTER FEED-SW
To prevent illegal access to service mode, a password can be specified.
ING-SPD
Related service mode
ING-RDR
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > PSWD-SW (level 1)
ING-MCON
ING-LSR
Password type setting when entering the service mode
ING-DEV
ING-TR
<Setting range>
ING-FIX
0: No password [Default]
CUSTOM
1: Service engineer
F-1-15
2: System administrator + Service engineer
With current machines, it is quite difficult to find out the target item since there are large
number of items in COPER > OPTION > BODY (related to host machine specification).
With this machine, all items in BODY are classified into 15 categories by usage to reach a ■■Screen display switch (level1 <-> level2)
target item. Screen can be switched between level 1 screen and level 2 screen.
Middle When the level 1 screen is displayed and <Level 1> on the upper right screen is pressed, a
Middle category classification Details
category name screen is switched to level 2 screen.
Function switch FNC-SW Language, cassette, paper type, NAVI / DA
connection, count up specification, original size
detection, dust detection level
Display switch / display timing DSPLY-SW UI display related
Image related (fixing) IMG-FIX Fixing related
Image related (transfer) IMG-TR Primary transfer, secondary transfer, ITB
Image related (development) IMG-DEV Development related
Image related (laser / latent) IMG-LSR Laser, latent image related
Image related (reader / ADF) IMG-RDR Reader, ADF image related
Image related (controller, IMG-MCON MN-CON image related and image related items
others) other than above
Image quality / copy speed IMG-SPD Down sequence
Cleaning CLEANING Cleaning of Charging Assembly / Drum / Transfer
Roller / ITB etc.
Environment settings ENV-SET Temperature / Humidity, Environment Heater / due
condensation / log acquisition

1-16
1
1
1-17

Display I/O Adjust Function Option Test Counter

<VERSION > < 1/ 8 > < READY > <LEVEL 1 >

DC-CON 43.44
R-CON 00.52
PANEL 4C.50
FEEDER 44.46
SORTER 54.53
NIB 42.4E
DECK --.--
MN-CONT 4E.4D

Display I/O Adjust Function Option Test Counter

<VERSION > < 1/ 2 > < READY > <LEVEL 2 >

LANG-CS 53.43
LANG-DA 41.44
LANG-EL 4C.45
LANG-ES 53.45
LANG-ET 54.45
LANG-FI 49.46
LANG-HU 55.48
LANG-KO 4F.4B

i
F-1-16

1-17
1
2 Technology

■Basic

Configuration
■Controller System

■Laser Exposure System

■Image Formation System

■Fixing System

■Pickup Feed System
■■ MEAP

■Embedded RDS

2
2
2-2

Basic Configuration ■■Basic sequence


●● Sequence at Power-On
Functional Configuration • Reader

The machine may broadly be divided into the following functional system blocks; document Main power switch ON

exposure system block, controller system block, laser exposure system block, image SREADY SSTBY
Forwarding
formation system block, fixing system block and pickup/feed system block. Reader Motor Forwarding Shift shading
Fixing shading
Backwarding Backwarding
Scanning Lamp White plate dust
Document exposure system detection control
HP Sensor Shading correction
Reader controller CCD Exposure lamp
Optical unit position
HP (Shading position) HP (Shading position)
Controller system Gain correction
Offset correction
HDD Main Delivery
F-2-2
controller
Option 1/2 Duplexing • Printer Unit
board feed
DC Power ON
controller
Fixing WMUP WMUPR PSTBY
system Fixing Fixing heater: Fixing heater:
100 degree C 160 degree C(51/45ppm machine)
Image formation system Target temperature 135 degree C(35/30ppm machine)
ITB Transfer
Engage
Fixing motor(M21)

Fixing heater(H3)
Laser exposure system
Pickup Auto adjustment
Laser scanner Laser scanner
unit1 unit2
[1] Secondary transfer ATVC
Pickup/
[2] Patch sensor correction control
feed
Cassette1 [3] Discharge current correction
system [4] Drum thickness detection
[5] Primary transfer ATVC
Flow of paper Cassette2
[6] Color displacement correction control
Flow of signal [7] ARCDAT control
Laser beam [8] ATR control
[9] Secondary transfer clearning control
F-2-1
F-2-3

2-2
2
2
2-3

Period Definition Definition ●● Print sequence


SREADY An interval in which the shading correction is executed after the Start • Reader
(Scanner Ready) key is pressed. Start Key ON
SSTBY An interval between the completion of the shading correction and SSTBY SREADY SCRW SCFW SSTBY
(Scanner Standby) switching the Start key ON / turning the main power OFF. Forwarding Backwarding Backwarding Forwarding Forwarding Forwarding
Reader Motor
WMUP An interval in which the drive system stops, and it ends when the Backwarding Forwarding Backwarding
Scanning Lamp
(Warm-up) completion requirements of the fixing assembly startup is fulfilled.
HP Sensor ON ON
WMUPR An interval in which the drive system starts, and the bias adjustment
(Warm-up Rotation) is executed. End of the image
Optical unit position HP (Shading) Stream reading position HP (Shading)
PSTBY An interval in which the copy/print request signal can be accepted.
F-2-4
(Printer Standby)
T-2-1
• Printer
Start key ON

PSTBY PINTR PRINT LSTR PSTBY


Fixing heater:
175 degree C(51/45ppm machine)
Target temperature 155 degree C(35/30ppm machine)

Fixing motor(M21) disengage

Fixing heater(H3)

Auto adjustment

The following adjustments to work, depending on the status of the product.


[1] Discharge current corrections
[2] Patch sensor correction control
[3] ATR control
[4] Primary transfer ATVC control
[5] Secondary transfer ATVC control
[6] Secondary transfer clearning
[7] D-max control
[8] ARCDAT control
[9] D-Half control
[10] Color displacement correction control

F-2-5

2-3
2
2
2-4

Period Definition Definition


SREADY An interval in which the shading correction is executed after the Start key
(Scanner Ready) is pressed.
SSTBY An interval between the completion of the shading correction and
(Scanner Standby) switching the Start key ON / turning the main power OFF.
PSTBY An interval in which the copy / print request signal can be accepted.
(Print Standby State)
PRINTR An interval between the reception of the print request signal and the state
(Printer Intial Rotation) the image signal is sent.
PRINT An interval in which all toner is transferred on the paper, and the paper is
delivered.
LSTR An interval between the completion of the paper delivery and the stop of
(Last Rotation) all drives.
T-2-2

2-4
2
2
2-5

Controller System ■■Specifications / configuration


●● PCBs
Overview
■■Features
Using a new controller enables high speed PDL processing, high image quality and high
functionality.

F-2-8

Parts name Function, specifications, features


Main controller CPU: 1.2GHz, Control of the entire system
Main Controller PCB 1 Riser PCB Main Controller PCB 2
PCB 1 Various controls (memory, control panel, electric power, voice), I/Fs (PCI, USB (host),
F-2-6 RTC
Main controller PCB 1 controls the entire system. Main controller PCB 2 mainly controls Flash PCB Boot program
image processing. TPM PCB To generate and save encryption key
Available only when TPM settings is ON: Management Settings > Data Management
Main controller PCBs 1 and 2 are connected through the riser PCB. > TPM Settings (default: OFF)
Not available with China models
This configuration improves installability / removability of the main controller PCBs.
Main controller CPU: 400 MHz, Image control
(Slot-in / out) PCB 2 Various image processing (color space conversion, enlarge, reduction, rotation,
composition, compression, rasterizing, resolution conversion, image binarization),
delay memory control between drums, HDD control, I/Fs (reader, FAX, USB (device))
Bypass PCB Internal bus connection
Remove this PCB when using ColorPASS-GX300 (server type) or imagePASS-B1 (to
be attached to the main unit) and install the open I/F PCB.
Riser PCB I/F (main controller 1 - 2, main controller - HDD, main controller - DC controller)
HDD 2.5 inch SATA I/F Standard: 80 GB
Up to 2 HDDs can be mounted in the case of mirroring configuration.
BOX data, Address book, security information (password, certificate)
Op.: 2.5 inch / 80GB HDD-C1, 2.5 inch / 250 GB HDD-D1
T-2-3
F-2-7

2-5
2
2
2-6
●● Memory Main controller PCB 2
Main controller PCB 1

J2032
BAT1
J2031

DDR2-SDRAM DDR2-SDRAM (M0)


512 MB + 512 MB 512 MB
J13

J11
DDR2-SDRAM (M1)
1 GB

J12 BAT1

F-2-9 DDR2-SDRAM (P)


512 MB
Parts name Function, specifications, features
F-2-10
DDR2-SDRAM 2 slot / 1GB (standard)
J2031: 512 MB Parts name Function, specifications, features
J2032: 512 MB DDR2-SDRAM (M1) 1 GB (standard) / clock frequency: 200MHz
Clock frequency: 333 MHz Rasterizing, rendering, resolution conversion, coding / decoding
Used for saving image, program data DDR2-SDRAM (M0) 512 MB (standard / Op.*) / clock frequency: 200MHz
Lithium battery (BAT1)) For RTC Product name: Additional Memory Type B (512MB)
Life: approx. 10 years Rasterizing, rendering, resolution conversion, coding / decoding
T-2-4 To be used when using the following options:
PS Printer Kit-AE1, Direct Print Kit (for PDF / XPS)-H1, imagePASS-B1,
ColorPASS-GX300
DDR2-SDRAM (P) 512 MB (standard) / clock frequency: 200MHz
Print image processing, delay processing between drums
SRAM 16 Mbit
To save data in Settings / Registration Mode / Service Mode and image
data management information in HDD
Lithium battery (BAT1) For SRAM backup, Life: approx. 10 years
T-2-5

* The capacity differs according to the location or model

2-6
2
2
2-7
●● I/F, connector Main controller PCB 2
Main controller PCB 1
External I/F
J1002
Bypass I/F Internal I/F
Voice External I/F
/ open I/F J1010
UI Internal I/F
J1003

Mini-USB Reader
J1007 J3003

Fan Image
analysis I/F J1000
J1015

LAN USB (D)


J1017 Riser J13
J1019

USB (H) Flash


J1021 FAX
Riser (1 line)
J1020 J14 J17
J1022 TPM

PCI J1025
FAX-USB
J1026 J1027 (2-4 line)
CC-VI Coin
J16
F-2-11
F-2-12
No. Function, specifications No. Function, specifications
Jack No. Function, specifications
J1002 Voice I/F (Op.) J1020 Flash PCB I/F
J14 Riser PCB I/F
J1003 Control panel I/F J1021 USB I/F (Host) *1
J16 Mini-USB I/F for 2 to 4-lines FAX
For MEAP, For USB keyboard (Op.)
Product name: Advanced G3 2nd Line Fax Board-AE1, Advanced G3 3rd / 4th Line
J1007 Mini-USB I/F (Op.) J1022 TPM PCB I/F
Fax Board-AE1
Connect USB Device Port-B1
J17 FAX-USB I/F for 1-line FAX
USB Device Port-B1 is required when
Product name: Advanced G3 FAX Board-AE1
using Mobile Connect Kit-A1 (sold
separately). J1000 Image analysis PCB I/F
Product name: Image Data Analyzer Board-A1
J1015 Fan I/F J1025 PCI expansion PCB I/F (Op.)
J1010 Bypass PCB I/F
J1017 LAN I/F J1026 I/F for control interface kit (Op.)
Mount the open I/F PCB when using ColorPASS-GX300 / imagePASS-B1
1000BASE-T / 100BASE-TX / 10BASE-T
Also to be used as I/F for imagePASS-B1 J1027 I/F for card reader, I/F for serial interface J3003 Reader I/F
/ ColorPASS-GX300 (Op.) kit, I/F for coin manager (all Op.) T-2-7

J1019 Riser PCB I/F


T-2-6

*1: There is 1 port on the control panel as well

2-7
2
2
2-8
●● Function expansion options Main controller PCB 2
Main controller PCB1

Voice
Operation/
Voice Open I/F PCB
Guidance
PCB

Expansion Bus
PCB

Image
Wireless LAN PCB analysis PCB
IPSec PCB

IPSec PCB
F link PCB (main) F link PCB (sub)

Open I/F PCB


Wireless LAN PCB Expansion Bus PCB

F-2-13
Main controller PCB 2
Name Function, specifications, features
F-2-14
Voice operation PCB Product name: Voice Operation Kit-C1, Voice Guidance Kit-F1 (only for non-
Voice guidance PCB Japanese models) Name Function, specifications, features
Expansion Bus PCB Product name: Expansion Bus -F1 Open I/F PCB imagePASS-B1 / ColorPASS-GX300
Required when PCI option (Wireless LAN Board-B1, IPSec Board-B2) is F link PCB (main)
installed F link PCB (sub)
Wireless LAN PCB Product name: Wireless LAN Board-B1 Image analysis PCB Product name: Image Data Analyzer Board-A1
Expansion Bus -F1 is required. Only for non-Japanese models. Scan protection for output original (Copy / SEND / BOX)
Parallel use with imagePASS-B1 / ColorPASS-GX300 is NOT available T-2-9
IPSec PCB Encryption / composition processing of packet data
Product name: IPSec Board -B2
Expansion Bus -F1 is required.
Parallel use with imagePASS-B1 / ColorPASS-GX300 is NOT available
T-2-8

2-8
2
2
2-9
■■HDD ■■Boot sequence
The partitions for Advanced Box and the distribution server are added.
[ ]: program storage location
User Box (same as the existing machine) area is 23GB and Advanced Box area is 9GB.
Advanced Box area can be increased by installing the high-capacity HDD option. - Initialization process of hardware
- Starting BIOS
[Main controller PCB 1]

- Starting IPL, OS
FSTDEV Image data (User Box) [Flash PCB]
TMP_GEN Universal data (temporary file)
TMP_PSS For PDL spooling
TMP_FAX FAX data
APL_SEND Address book, filter
APL_MEAP MEAP application - Starting system software for main/sub CPU
APL_GEN Universal data [HDD -> DDR2-SDRAM]
APL_KEEP MEAP saving data [Main controller PCB 2]
APL_LOG System log
- Starting application
IMG_MNG Text management table
PDLDEV PDL-related file (font, registration form, etc.)
FSTCDEV Job archiving (chasing)
THUMDEV Thumbnail
BOOTDEV System software (System, language, RUI, etc.)
Standby screen display
CRBDEV For Advanced Box
APL_CDS For distribution server F-2-16

F-2-15
NOTE :
Due to the high speed startup, the progress bar and the activating PCB are not synchronized.
For this reason, the progress bar cannot be utilized for troubleshooting.
See the following error code list for the troubleshooting.

2-9
2
2
2-10
Related Error Codes (major error codes): ■■Shutdown sequence
Error
Error description Before turning OFF the main power switch, it is necessary to perform HDD completion
Code
processing (to prevent damage on the HDD), cooling of the internal printer (to prevent fixed
E602 Error in HDD
     0001 Failure in recognizing HDD toner due to high temperature) and exhaust (to prevent smeared image due to chemical
Boot partition (BOOTDEV) is not found at startup. reaction of ozone in the machine and photosensitive drum). This sequential processing is
0002 There is no system software for the main CPU. called “shutdown sequence” and was executed on the legacy models manually (by holding
0006 There is no system software for the sub CPU.
down the power supply switch on the Control Panel for a specific duration).
E604 Failure in memory (main controller PCB 1)
     1024 Capacity shortage of DDR2-SDRAM (1GB required)
E613 Failure in memory (main controller PCB 2) When the main power switch is turned OFF on the main body, Main Controller PCB 1 detects
     1024 Capacity shortage of DDR2-SDRAM (M0, M1) (1GB required) this operation and then the shutdown sequence starts / executes automatically.
1536 Capacity shortage of DDR2-SDRAM (M0, M1) (1.5GB required)
E748 Error in board (Flash PCB)
In addition, hardware shutdown sequence exists. If shutdown sequence is not executed
     2010 IPL (Initial Program Loader) is not found.
2011 OS is not found.
normally due to occurrence of software trouble, the machine is shut down in 110 seconds at a
T-2-10 maximum by the timer in the AC Driver PCB. If it is not shut down within 110 seconds, failure
of the AC Driver PCB is suspected.
.

2-10
2
2
2-11
Controls ●● SEND

■■Flow of Image Data


HDD
Network
●● Copy Reader

To DC Controller HDD Image processing


HDD writing/reading
Reader Resolution
  conversion,
Image
  rotation,
 
JPEG compression/extension
Data conversion
HDD  Tile raster conversion
I/F  JPEG encode
writing/reading
LAN Image data buffer
Controller (memory)
Image processing
R esolution conversion,
I 
mage rotation,
Print type image  
JPEG compression/extension
processing
Extension processing
Tile raster conversion Main Controller Riser PCB Main Controller
PCB 1 PCB 2
Image data buffer
(memory)
F-2-19

Main Controller Riser PCB Main Controller ●● Box


PCB 1 PCB 2

To DC Controller
F-2-17 HDD
FAX
●● Print
Network To DC Controller I/F

HDD Image data buffer


HDD
writing/reading (memory)

I/F Rendering Print type image Image processing


processing
Color space conversion,
HDD Extension
  processing Image 2 level cell,
writing/reading Tile
  raster conversion Image multi level cell,
Image composition,
Resolution conversion,
Image data buffer Main Controller Riser PCB Main Controller Image rotation,
(memory) PCB 1 PCB 2 Pixel skipping with 7x7 filter

F-2-20
LAN
Controller

Main Controller Riser PCB Main Controller


PCB 1 PCB 2

F-2-18

2-11
2
2
2-12
■■Security Features (Encryption Key, Certificate, Password ●● Configuration of Security Information
The security functionality behaves differently depending on the TPM setting on the UI.
Protection) This machine provides the two types of TPM settings. See the figure below for the security
●● Overview information flow in each setting.
The main controller PCB 1 of the host machine holds a new PCB named “TPM PCB”. “TPM”
stands for “Trusted Platform Module”, which collectively refers to the chip set for generating - When the TPM setting is ON
and storing encryption keys and computing public key encryption.

TPM Key
Main Controller PCB 1 TPM PCB
(Temporarily stored in HDD)
TPM PCB
Public Key
USB flash drive
Backup Key
for TPM failure

Common Backup
Key
Backup for
Common Key

Password Password

SRAM HDD
F-2-22

F-2-21
When the TPM setting is ON, the TPM key is enabled to secure information with the three
The TPM PCB protects security information (passwords, certificates, and encryption keys) keys. Therefore, the security information held in each machine is safely protected.
stored in the HDD and SRAM. Note that this PCB does not protect set, registered or stored The security information in this setting can be accessed by the three keys and multiple
data other than security information. passwords stored in the SRAM and HDD.
The TPM key embedded in the chip is used to encrypt / decrypt security information. The Each data is stored in the specified location (enclosed with blue dots in the figure above).
TPM key is protected from illegal access in a virtually perfect manner, thus the security Since the data in the upper layer are linked to those in the lower layer, security information is
information of the host machine is securely protected even in the following conditions. activated only when data in all the layers are linked.
• When the HDD and / or the main controller PCB is taken out from the host machine and For the backup purpose, the backup key is temporarily stored also in the HDD to be prepared
installed in the MFP with the different serial number (the model information held in the TPM for a TPM failure (only for the initial failure after the TPM setting is ON).
PCB is specific to the machine originally enabled the TPM setting) This key can be backed up using the USB flash drive. Once backed up, the backup key is
• When the system of the host machine is hacked via the network deleted from the HDD.
The common key information is stored in the HDD as well as the SRAM. The common key
Enable this function in Setting / Registration mode. stored in the SRAM is cleared when the main controller PCB 2 (SRAM) is replaced or after
Management Setting > Data Management > TPM Setting -> ON (OFF by default) MN-CON clear. However, the common key stored in the HDD automatically restores that in
the SRAM so that the security information is decodable even after servicing. Note that the

2-12
2
2
2-13
security information is not decodable correctly in case the HDD is failed or formatted because ●● Preparation before Installing TPM
the public key information stored in the HDD is cleared. If this occurs, execute “Initialize All Before installing TPM, ask the user to back up data.
Data / Settings” in user mode to set the TPM setting to OFF. This will maintain the password Follow the steps below to back up data.
information in the SRAM even after the password information is initialized. 1) From Remote UI, execute Setting / Registration > Management Setting > Data
- When the TPM setting is OFF: Management > Import / Export. The following data types should be backed up.
• Address book (see *1)
• Device settings (transfer settings, address book, frequently-used Send functions) (see *2)
Backup
Common • Setting / Registration
Key
• Printer settings can be exported
Backup of
Common Key • Favorites stored in the web browser (only when the web browser is enabled) (see *3)
Password Password

*1 Each of address books can be exported. If the address book is seen as a part of device
SRAM HDD settings, this step can be disregarded.
F-2-23 *2 Among settings in the main menu, only “Frequently-used Setting” under “Scan and
When the TPM setting is OFF, the TPM key is disabled. Thus, the security information is Send” can be backed up.
protected only by the common key. *3 These are available only in the specific models or configurations.
Under this setting, the security information held in this machine is protected at the level
equivalent to the conventional machines. 2) Select “Export” from Custom Menu of the Remote UI to back up “Custom Menu Setting
The security functionality in this setting is configured by the common key and multiple Information”.
passwords stored in the SRAM and HDD.
When the TPM setting is set to OFF, the security information is protected by the common key 3) Log in to the system as Administrator from User Management of Advanced Box on Remote
and multiple passwords stored in SRAM and HDD. UI. Then, execute “Export” to back up “User Information of Advanced Box”.
The common key information is stored in the HDD as well as the SRAM. The common
key stored in the SRAM is cleared when the main controller PCB 2 (SRAM) is replaced or
after MN-CON clear. Since the common key stored in the HDD will automatically restore
the common key in the SRAM, the security information is decodable correctly even after
servicing. Unlike the case that the TPM setting is set to ON, the password information stored
in the HDD is initialized when the HDD is replaced or formatted. However, the password
information is maintained in the SRAM.

TPM Setting for Security Information


The security information can be protected with or without TPM by switching between TPM
settings in Setting / Registration mode.
• When the TPM setting is ON
The security functionality is enabled in 4 levels (TPM key, public key, common key and
password).
• When the TPM setting is OFF
The security functionality is enabled in 2 levels (common key and password).

2-13
2
2
2-14
●● Works before / after introduction 1. Enable Functionality
Execute the following in Setting / Registration mode (“TPM setting” is OFF by default).
MEMO: Setup of “System Management PIN”
1. Enable the feature
It is recommended for users (administrators) to set the system management PIN
2. Backup the TPM key before installing TPM. The TPM key is backed up after the TPM setting is set to “ON”.
3. Restore the TPM key However, the key backup is permitted only once. Unless the key is properly backed up,
4. Disable the feature users other than administrators may illegally obtain the backup file. To avoid such risks
effectively, the system management PIN should be set.

The works above are basically done by users.


1)Set Management Setting > Data Management > TPM Setting to “ON”.
CAUTION: Setting / Registration
When the TPM setting is set to “ON”, advice users on the following:
Back up the TPM key swiftly after the setting is ON
Keep the password used at backup securely
Never lose the USB flash drive with the backup TPM key file saved
The TPM key should be restored after the TPM PCB is replaced due to failures or the
like.
(TPM key restoration is enabled only at TPM PCB replacement.)
Unless the key is restored, the security information (passwords, encryption key, and
certificates) cannot be used.
When the key restoration is failed due to the USB flash drive lost or others, “Initialize All
Data / Settings” should be executed to reactivate TPM functionality. The security may F-2-24

be undermined if the old Setting / Registration data are maintained as it is. 2) Click “Yes”, and restart the machine.

F-2-25
This setting is enabled after the machine is restarted.

2-14
2
2
2-15
2.TPM Key Backup 3) Click [Password] to enter the password (4-12 digits). Then, enter the password for
The TPM key backup file can be stored only in USB flash drive (supported file system: confirmation.
FAT32).
Note that this file requires the memory free space of several MBs.

F-2-26
1) Insert the USB flash drive to the machine.
The USB I/F (host) is found at the side of the control panel as well as the main
controller PCB.

CAUTION:
Ensure to insert only one USB flash drive.
If the backup job is started with 2 or more USB flash drives connected, the message is
shown to notify that the backup is failed.

F-2-28
MEMO:
The USB flash drive holds the TPM key backup files by serial number. Thus, backup 4) Click [OK] to initiate TPM key backup.
files for multiple machines can be saved in a USB flash drive.

2)Click [Back up TPM Key] in Management Setting > Data Management > TPM Setting.

F-2-27

F-2-29
5) Click [OK] on Backup Completion Screen and remove the USB flash drive.

2-15
2
2
2-16
3. Restore of TPM key
CAUTION: The following may cause failures in backup.
Procedure is about the same as the backup work.
If any of the following is detected, the backup process is aborted and the message Difference between restore work and backup work:
and the cause for the failure are shown on the screen. Take an appropriate measure to Rebooting is necessary (turn OFF and then ON the main power) after completion of restore
recover this.
work.
• The USB flash drive is not inserted to the machine
• 2 or more USB flash drives are inserted to the machine 1) Connect the USB memory that saves TPM key.
• The USB flash drive has insufficient free memory space 2) Select the following: Management setting > Data management > TPM setting; and
• The USB flash drive is write-protected click [Restore TPM key].

• No key is found

CAUTION: The USB flash drive should be securely stored.


Give advice users on the following points.
• The USB flash drive should be securely stored
• Once the TPM key backup file is saved in the USB flash drive, never save the
backup file on a server or the like accessible to unanimous users.

MEMO: Name of TPM key backup file F-2-30

The serial number for the machine is automatically assigned as the backup file name. 3) Enter the password set in the backup process.
4) Click [OK] on Start Restoration Screen. The restoration process is started.
5) Click [OK] on Restoration Completion Screen. Remove the USB flash drive and turn
OFF/ ON the main power switch.

2-16
2
2
2-17
4. Disable the feature
CAUTION: The following may cause failures in restoration.
To set “OFF” for the TPM setting, execute [Initialize All Data / Settings].
If any of the following is detected, the restoration process is aborted and the message
and the cause for the failure are shown on the screen. Take an appropriate measure for
recovery.
• The USB flash drive is not inserted to the machine
• 2 or more USB flash drives are inserted to the machine
• The USB flash drive is security-protected
• No TPM key is saved in the USB flash drive
• The TPM key saved in the USB flash drive is not for the machine
• The wrong password is entered
• After the TPM key was backed up, [Initialize All Systems/ Settings] was executed
• SRAM (the main controller PCB 1) or HDD is crashed
F-2-31

CAUTION: Points to note when disabling functionality


To disable the use of TPM, all data and settings should be initialized. If this is executed,
user information saved in the HDD/ SRAM is totally cleared. Ensure to back up the data
before disabling TPM settings.

List of data to be cleared


• Data saved in BOX/ Advanced Box
• Data saved in Inbox (Fax Box/ System Box)
• Destination data registered in Address Book
• Read mode registered using Send function
• Mode memory registered using Copy/ Box function
• MEAP applications and their license files
• Data saved using MEAP applications
• Password for MEAP SMS (Service Management Service)
(The password is returned to default if any change is made.)
• User authentication information registered by local device authentication via SSO-H (Single
Sign-On H)
• Unsent documents (documents for scheduled transmission and reserved transmission)
• Job logs
• Contents set in Setting / Registration
• Image-composite registration form
• Registered transfer settings

2-17
2
2
2-18
Key pair and server certificate registered in Management Setting (Setting/ Registration) > ●● Overview of Actions taken against Troubles
[Device Management] > [Certificate Settings]
Location
TPM Setting = ON TPM Setting = OFF Relevant Error Code
with failure
Steps of data restoration after recovery TPM PCB 1. Check the TPM PCB connection N/A (TPM PCB is Initially E746-0031 is
The restoration process triggers Setting/ Registration > Management Setting > Data 2. Replace the TPM PCBs not in use when the shown on the screen.
Management > Import/ Export > Import/ Export Setting/ Registration on the UI. 3. Turn OFF/ ON the power TPM setting is set to When the power is turned
4. See the section of “Restoring TPM OFF.) OFF/ON after the TPM
The data listed below cannot be restored, thus should be set again. Key” to restore the TPM key. PCB is replaced, E746-
5. Turn OFF/ ON the main power for 0032 is shown (only when
Environment Settings recovery the TPM setting is set to
ON).
• Paper settings
HDD 1.Replace the HDDs. 1. Replace the Initially E602-xxxx is shown
• Display settings in the destination to save 2.Format the HDD. HDDs. (the different extension is
• Time fine-adjustment for timer/ power settings 3.Download the system software. 2. Format the HDD. shown depends on cases).
• Date/ time settings (excluding time zone and daylight-saving settings) 4.See the section of “Disabling 3. Download the After the system software
Functionality” to execute “Initialize system software. is reinstalled, E746-0033 is
• User settings for SNMPv3 All Data/ Settings”. 4. Restore the shown.
• Context settings 5.Turn OFF/ON the power. The TPM password
• Firewall settings (excluding MAC address filter) setting is automatically set to OFF. information stored
6.Set the TPM setting to ON (the in the HDD.
public key and the common key
Function Settings are automatically set).
• Image-composite form for the common print operation Main 1. Replace the main controller PCB 2. 1. Replace the main E747-xxxx (the different
• Printer settings Controller 2. The common key backed up in the controller PCB 2. extension is shown
PCB 2 HDD will be automatically restored 2. The common depends on cases).
• Transfer settings for the common receipt/ transfer settings (SRAM) in the SRAM. key backed up
• Inbox settings 3. The TPM setting on the control in the HDD will
• Frequently-used Copy settings panel is reset to OFF. Manually be automatically
set the TPM setting to ON (the restored in the
• Registered short-cuts in “Other Functions” machine is operated in the TPM SRAM.
• Frequently-used Send settings setting ON). 3. Restore the
• Frequently-used settings for saving/ using files 4. Restore the password information password
stored in the SRAM (see *1). information stored
in the SRAM (see
Address Settings *1).
• Address Book T-2-11

*1 If “No” is indicated in the field of Backup Column in the table of “Security Information
Management Settings Storage Location”, the relevant information should be set manually again.
• Sheet counts in Department ID Management
• Settings for device information distribution
• Certificate settings
• License registration
• Remote operation settings
• Box backup/ restoration
• TPM Settings

2-18
2
2
2-19
●● Related Error Code ●● Security Information Storage Location
Error Storage Backup
Error description, Assumed cause, remedy Data Type Function Name of Data
Code Location Availability
E746 Error in encryption HDD Password/ BOX BOX Password Yes
    0031 Error in hardware PIN
Assumed cause The TPM PCB is not mounted; the TPM PCB for the other machine is HDD Password/ BOX Password for Fax BOX Yes
mounted; the TPM chip is crashed. PIN
Remedy Mount the TPM PCB for the machine; replace with the new TPM PCB HDD Password/ SEND Password for a file destination of Address Book Yes
0032 Error occurred but the system is recoverable PIN
Assumed cause Keys are unmatched HDD Password/ MEAP Authentication information registered by local device Yes
Remedy Restore the TPM key PIN authentication via SSO-H
0033 Error occurred and the system is unrecoverable HDD Certificate/ SSL,AMS Device key pair (SSL, AMS) No
Assumed cause Security information cannot be found in the HDD/ SRAM Secret Key
Remedy Execute “Initialize All Data/ Settings” HDD Certificate/
Signature User key pair No
Secret KeySEND
T-2-12
HDD Others User Key information linked to user (password) No
setting
information
SRAM Password/ BOX Password for encryption at BOX backup No
PIN
SRAM Password/ BOX Password for SMS server at BOX backup No
PIN
SRAM Password/ Advanced Password for Advanced BOX backup No
PIN BOX
SRAM Password/ Advanced Password for SMS server at Advanced BOX backup No
PIN BOX
SRAM Password/ SEND Password for LDAP server Yes
PIN
SRAM Password/ SEND Password for POP3 server Yes
PIN
SRAM Password/ SEND Password for time-stamped PDF Yes
PIN
SRAM Password/ SEND Password for Adobe ES Rights Management Server Yes
PIN
SRAM Password/ SEND PIN for destination list (in destination setting) Yes
PIN
SRAM Password/ UI Password for service mode No
PIN
SRAM Password/ Network Password for IPP authentication Yes
PIN
SRAM Password/ Network Password for FTP authentication Yes
PIN
SRAM Password/ Network User name and password for client in Proxy Yes
PIN authentication
SRAM Password/ Network Login password for Netware print server Yes
PIN

2-19
2
2
2-20
Storage
Data Type Function Name of Data
Backup ■■High capacity HDD (Option)
Location Availability
SRAM Password/ Network Policy common key for IPSec Yes The HDD capacity mounted on this machine is 80GB as standard. Mounting a 2.5 inch /
PIN 250GB HDD-D1 (option) makes 250GB in HDD capacity. High capacity is required in the case
SRAM Password/ Network User name and password for PEAP/TTLS Yes of saving large amounts of data with “Advanced Box.”
PIN authentication
SRAM Password/ Others Password for FAX receipt Yes
PIN Mounting this option increases capacity for Advanced Box.
SRAM Password/ Others Department management data (including System Yes 9GB: in the case of 80GB HDD capacity
PIN Manager password) 114GB: in the case of 250GB HDD capacity
SRAM Encryption MIB Authentication and encryption keys for SNMPv3 No
key
T-2-13
FSTDEV Image data (Box, etc.)
TMP_GEN Universal data (temporary file)
●● Security Information Storage Location (data managed under the TMP_PSS For PDL spooling
mechanism other than TPM management) TMP_FAX FAX data
APL_SEND Address book, filter
Storage Backup APL_MEAP MEAP application
Data Type Function Name of Data
Location Availability APL_GEN Universal data
HDD Password/ MEAP SMS login password No APL_KEEP MEAP saving data
PIN APL_LOG System log
HDD Password/ Advanced User information in Advanced BOX Yes IMG_MNG Text management table
PIN BOX PDLDEV PDL-related file (font, registration form, etc.)
T-2-14 Job archiving (chasing)
FSTCDEV
THUMDEV Thumbnail
BOOTDEV System software (System, language, RUI, etc.)
CRBDEV For Advanced Box
APL_CDS For distribution server

F-2-32
Although simple calculation says: 250GB - 80GB = 170GB, it requires 20% of snapshot area
and the data area to be used for internal processing in the system. Therefore, 114GB can be
actually used for text storage area.

2-20
2
2
2-21
■■HDD mirroring feature (option) ●● Works before using this functionality (installation)
●● Overview Install the mirroring PCB and LED PCB HDD1 is connected to Ch A on the
for HDD1 mirroring PCB
This option enables HDD data mirroring (RAID1).
When one HDD is crashed, the other HDD backs up the operation. This minimizes the Slot.2 (HDD2)
downtime due to crash, thus enhancing the reliability as the document server.
Slot.1 (HDD1)

Mirroring is performed in the following 2 ways depending on HDD capacities (80GB or


CH B
250GB).
CH A
The mirroring PCB controls the reading / writing timing of HDD data.
The LED PCB indicates HDD operation statuses by LED.
Turn ON the main power
Master (HDD1)
(Lv.1) COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
HDD Mirroring Kit – D1 Turn ON the mirroring feature > W/RAID ---> “1”
80 GB This Service Mode needs to be specified
Standard Mirroring PCB before installing the 2nd HDD.
LED PCB
Ch A
Turn OFF the main power
Backup (HDD2)
Ch B

80 GB HDD2 is connected to Ch B on the


Option Install HDD2 mirroring PCB.
2.5inch/80GB HDD - C1 Slot.2 (HDD2)

Slot.1 (HDD1)
Master (HDD1) 2.5inch/250GB HDD - D1
CH B
HDD Mirroring Kit - D1
250 GB CH A
Option Mirroring PCB
LED PCB
Ch A
Backup (HDD2) Turn ON the main power
Ch B

250 GB The storage data of the 1st HDD is


Option Start “Rebuild” automatically copied to the 2nd HDD (this
operation is called “Rebuild”.
2.5inch/250GB HDD - D1

F-2-33 Time needed:


Complete “Rebuild” 80 GB HDD --- Approx. 20 minutes
250GB HDD ---Approx. 60 minutes
F-2-34
Rebuild progress is shown as messages on the status line of the control panel.
“Copying data to HDD. xx%”

2-21
2
2
2-22
●● List of operation status (LED)
MEMO:
• This machine can be used even during “rebuild” process (operation is performed with HDD operation statuses are indicated with 4 LEDs mounted on the LED PCB.
HDD1) The green LED shows that the operation is normally in progress, while the red LED indicates
• The HDD will not be damaged even if turning OFF the power during “rebuild” process. any failures.
“Rebuild” is resumed once the power is turned ON the next time. This does not apply in
the case of blackout or disconnecting the power code during “rebuild” process

●● HDD reading / writing operation


Ch A Ch B
At reading: At writing: (HDD2)
(HDD1)
Data is read by HDD1 (master HDD) The same data is written to each HDD at
only the same timing

Main controller PCB 2 Main controller PCB 2


F-2-36
The table below lists HDD statuses indicated by each LED.
Mirroring PCB Mirroring PCB
For example, when HDD1 is in access, the green LED on the side of HDD1 (ChA) blinks in a
high speed.

HDD 1 (Ch A) HDD 2 (Ch B) Name of


Status
Green LED Red LED Green LED Red LED Mode
Normal (standby) --- --- --- --- Mirror mode
HDD HDD Accessing to HDD1 A (*1) --- --- ---
HDD HDD Accessing to HDD2 --- --- A (*1) ---
1 2 1 2 HDD1 failed --- A --- --- Degrade
mode
F-2-35
HDD2 is faulty --- --- --- A Degrade
The ACT LED (green) on the LED PCB is lighted up / blinking if reading / writing to each HDD mode
is performed properly. Copying data to HDD1 (Rebuild) --- / A B --- / A --- Rebuild
mode
Copying data to HDD2 (Rebuild) --- / A --- --- / A B Halt mode
In the case of failure:
• The LED (red) on the LED PCB is blinking. If only one HDD is faulty, the operation is Both HDDs failed or Master HDD --- (*2) A --- (*2) A Halt mode
continued by the other HDD. failed
• If both two HDDs are faulty, E602 error is shown on the control panel to stop the operation. T-2-15

--- : Not lit A : Lit B : Blinking at an interval of 0.5 seconds

*1: The LED is blinking in a high speed


*2: The green LED may be lit

2-22
2
2
2-23
●● Description of Modes Mode Flow at Start-up
The mirroring system of this machine consists of 4 modes.
Turn ON Main Power Switch
The modes in parentheses show the mirroring system statuses.
The status flows among the modes below during operation. Flow to Mode at Previous Job Completion
The table below lists descriptions of modes and operational overview.
Halt Mode Mirror Mode Degrade Mode Rebuild Mode

Name of Mode Description Master HDD Status Backup HDD Status


Mirror Mode Both HDDs are normally In normal operation In normal operation Trouble See Overview of Trouble
Trouble Recovery
operated
Degrade Mode Any trouble occurred in In normal operation With troubles (HDD not Backup HDD
Both HDDs Either HDD
the backup HDD suspends installed/ HDD in trouble) In which HDD? In which HDD?
mirroring operation. The
machine can be used under this Degrade Mode Degrade Mode
Master HDD
condition, however, the backup
HDD should be replaced at the See Overview of See Overview of
earliest convenience. Trouble Recovery Trouble Recovery
Rebuild mode The data of the master HDD is In normal operation In recovery from the
copied (rebuilt) to the backup trouble (Copying data of Unable to detect Unable to detect
HDD. The machine can be Master HDD) Master HDD at Start-up Master HDD at Start-up
Halt Mode
used under this condition.
Halt mode Both HDDs are in trouble (see In trouble (HDD not With troubles (HDD not Halt Mode Halt Mode Halt Mode
*1) installed/ HDD installed installed/ HDD installed
not registered/ HDD not registered/ HDD
See Overview of Trouble Recovery
disconnected while the disconnected while the
mirroring board is in mirroring board is in
operation) operation) Mirror Mode
T-2-16
F-2-37
*1: Turn OFF/ ON the power in this mode, the mode returns to the previous mode.

2-23
2
2
2-24
Mode Flow during Operation ●● Overview of Trouble Recovery
When any trouble occurs in the mirroring system, take the action for recovery appropriate to
each mode.
Mirror Mode
The HDD in trouble can be located by the red LED on the LED PCB.
Trouble
In case the master HDD cannot be located, turn OFF/ ON the power to check whether the
green LED is lit on the LED PCB.
Either HDD The firstly blinked green LED (ChA or ChB) in a high speed tells the Master HDD, which is
In which HDD?
accessed firstly.
Both HDDs Degrade Mode The green LED not lit on a channel tells the location of Backup HDD.
See Overview of
Trouble Recovery
HDD1 HDD2
Halt Mode Name of (ChA) (ChB)
Master HDD Status Action for Recovery
In which HDD? Mode Red Red
LED LED
Backup HDD
Halt Mode Mirror Mode Normal (at standby) Under normal operation --- ---
Degrade HDD1 in trouble 1. Check the connection between HDD1 and A ---
Rebuild Mode Mode (see*1) Mirroring Board or Main Controller PCB 2.
2. When the trouble is not recovered,
Trouble
replace the HDD1.
HDD2 in trouble 1. Check the connection between HDD2 and --- A
Unable to detect Unable to detect
Master HDD Backup HDD Mirroring Board or Main Controller PCB 2.
HDD Status? 2. When the trouble is not recovered,
When successfully Degrade Mode replace HDD2.
Rebuilt
Rebuild mode Copying data to HDD1 Copying (under Rebuild) B ---
Halt Mode
Unable to detect Master HDD
(Rebuild)
Copying Data to HDD2 Copying (under Rebuild) --- B
(Rebuild)
Halt Mode Halt mode Both HDDs in trouble 1. Check Master HDD and Backup HDD (see A A
See Overview of
Trouble Recovery *2)
2. When the trouble is not recovered,
replace the two HDDs (format the
Mirror Mode
replaced HDD and download the system
software).
F-2-38
T-2-17

---: Not lit A: Lit B: Blinking at an interval of 0.5 seconds


*1: This mode shows the message, “Need to replace hard disks (contact your service
engineer)”, on the control panel. In addition, “310006” is indicated in CODE field of Alarm Log
in service mode (COPIER > DISPLAY > ALARM-2).
*2: Never install the HDD used in the other model. The used HDD holds the ID specific to
the firstly-installed machine, thus this machine is unable to recognize it. If done, you need to
reinstall the HDD recognized in this machine.

2-24
2
2
2-25
●● Points to Note in Servicing concerning Mirroring Functionality ■■Removable HDD (option)
1. The modes other than Mirror Mode indicate troubles, which require swift recovery.
This option enables easier HDD mounting (slot-out/ in) at power-OFF (see *1). In addition, the
The power can be turned OFF even during Rebuild process. However, it is recommended
HDD slot can be locked.
not to turn off the power and wait until the mode flows to Mirror Mode. In addition, HDD
Potential use case: To enhance information securities in government offices or enterprises
removal after power-OFF is guaranteed only in Mirror Mode.
• Remove the HDD after business hours to store in a safe box.
• Mount the HDD before business hours. Lock the slot during operation.
2. The mirroring board controls Master HDD and Backup HDD. This control is performed
based on the HDD serial number and the model serial number instead of slot locations.
*1: The following conditions are required to replace HDDs at power-ON.
If HDDs are replaced in a careless manner during servicing in the field, the Master and
• - Removable HDD is extended
Backup HDDs may be switched.
• - Either HDD is in trouble
Ex) When the master HDD is in trouble, the mirroring board automatically recognizes
the backup HDD as the master. Thus, the master and backup HDDs are switched
even without changing the slot locations.
If the Master HDD cannot be located, turn OFF/ ON the power to check on which channel
the green LED is lit on the LED PCB.
The firstly-blinked LED (ChA or ChB) shows the Master HDD, which is accessed firstly after
power-on.

3. For users who intend to use the removable and mirroring functionality concurrently, instruct
them not to change the removable HDD location in advance.
Change of HDD locations after power-OFF is allowed as specifications only in Mirror Mode.
Otherwise, HDD removal or change of location is not guaranteed.

4. The following conditions are required to replace HDDs at power-ON.


• Removable HDD is extended
Removable HDD Kit-AC1
• Either HDD is in trouble
F-2-39

MEMO:
CAUTION:
• To use this option, no setting is required with the software.
Be sure to use a new HDD when replacing the HDD. • The user needs to prepare a key because there is no key with this kit.

5. Upgrading should be done only in Mirror Mode while mirroring in ongoing. Upgrading in
Degrade or Rebuild mode is basically prohibited. Always prioritize Mirror Mode when you
take any actions.

2-25
2
2
2-26
■■HDD Encryption/ Mirroring Kit (optional) ●● Compatibility among Device, Encryption Board and HDD
E602-2000 error may occur if the unmatched authentication information is found between the
This option enables to generate the encryption key inside the encryption board and to encrypt
controller and the HDD encryption board and the encryption board is mounted.
the whole HDD including the system software. Encryption allows leaks of confidential data,
The device, the encryption board and HDD can be connected in 4 use cases.
even when the HDD is stolen, including image data (temporarily generated at Copy or Print
The following shows the statuses for each use case.
jobs) and user data stored in BOX/ Advanced BOX. In addition, the data written into the two
Case 1: Normally operated
hard disks are also encrypted when the HDD mirroring functionality is enabled. The following
Case 2: HDD-related error occurs because the system on the HDD cannot be read (other
descriptions focus on the HDD encryption function. See the previous section for the mirroring
than E602-2000 error)
functionality.
Case 3: E602-2000 is triggered by failure in mutual authentication
Case 4: Unable to decode properly due to unmatched key for the encryption board
●● HDD Encryption Functionality
The HDD of the host machine holds temporary image data including scanned images or PDL Encryption
data as well as user data in BOX and Advanced BOX. Such images or user file information Correct Correct HDD
Correct
encryption (Protection property)
are saved in the HDD only with system information cleared. Under this condition, the data controller
board
or images can be restored by accessing directly to the stolen HDD using the access editor two-way authentication
and the like. To counter such threats against securities, data written to the disk should be
always encrypted to protect them from illegal restoration of image data or others. This product Correct Correct HDD
employs an unconventional approach to achieve HDD encryption and mirroring functionality controller (Protection property)
with the dedicated chipset on a board (Canon MFP Security Chip Version 2.00). Since the two It is not possible to decode.
Encryption
functions are operated in a HDD, the encryption functionality can be independently enabled.
Controller Correct
Correct HDD
not authorized encryption
board (Protection property)
●● Data Encryption Mechanism
It is not possible two-way authentication
The encryption board receives signals transmitted from the controller board, and encrypts
and saves them in the HDD. Encryption board Correct HDD
The encryption board receives the encrypted data saved in the HDD to decode and send not authorized (Protection property)
them to the controller. It is not possible to decode.
The encryption board can be configured with a HDD and an encryption/ mirroring board, or F-2-40
with 2 HDDs and an encryption/ mirroring board.

●● Conditions for Encryption Board Operation


The encryption board has the function to recognize and authenticate the host machine. An
error is triggered if a second-hand HDD encryption/ mirroring board is installed to the other
machine.

2-26
2
2
2-27
●● Actions against Troubles – Overview <Points to Note in Initialization using USB>
The screen below is shown on the control panel when E602-2000 occurred and the machine
Servicing User data Recovery Action
HDD cleared Replace HDDs 1) Format the HDD is started in safe mode using the USB flash memory with system data stored.
replacement 2) Install the system software The message as shown in the figure below is displayed.
Encryption cleared Install HDD encryption 1) Replace encryption board Select “0” when you are ready to initialize the encryption board.
board Kit 2) Initialize Encryption Board (see *1)
replacement 3) Format the HDD
4) Install the system Encryption board
error occurred.
Main controller cleared Clear the key for HDD 1) Initialize the encryption board (see *1) Check connection
2 replacement data encryption kit 2) Format the HDD of the board.
Initialize
(SRAM) 3) Install the system the board.
All data is deleted
Main controller not cleared N/A N/A at initialization.
[0]=Initialization
1 replacement [other key]=exit
Main controller Information After MN-CON clear MN-CON clear does not clear
clear held in SRAM process is done authentication information; no work is
cleared required specifically for HDD encryption kit F-2-42
T-2-18 The figure below shows the final screen in initializing the encryption board.
*1: How to Initialize Encryption Board The message as shown in the figure below is shown on the screen.
1. Initialize the encryption board via SST. Select “2” when you initialize the encryption board.
This step makes the disk unformatted (E602-0001 is triggered if the unformatted disk is We recommend checking the board connection before starting initialization
started).
2. Format the HDD and reinstall SYSTEM via SST. Attention!
When you start the HDD formatting, the message is automatically shown to confirm Once initialization
is started,you
cannot cancel it.
whether to initialize the encryption board (Key Clear). is that OK?
[2]= Yes
Key Clear will disable accesses to HDD data permanently. Cautions should be taken in Key [other keys]=No
Clear execution.

<Points to Note in Initialization via SST>


F-2-43
The screen below is shown when you gain access to SST in safe mode due to E602-2000.
Poor board connection also causes this error. Check the board connection to seek error
recovery. Initialization of the encryption board will disable accesses to HDD data permanently.
Cautions should be taken in initialization.

F-2-41

2-27
2
2
2-28
●● Relevant Error Codes E610 and detailed codes
E602 and detailed codes Detailed
E code Cause (Detected Error) Actions
Detection Code
E code Description Cause Actions E610 Failure in the HDD encryption key
Timing
0001 Failure in the HDD encryption key Ask the user to check the hardware
E602 Authentication Error Error in authentication Start-up Check connections between
(Error in hardware configuration). No configuration.
-2000 between the host the encryption board and
encryption board is installed.
machine and the the HDD and between the
0002 Failure in the HDD encryption key Ask the user to check the hardware
encryption board encryption board and the main
(Error in hardware configuration). configuration.
controller 2. This error may be
Failure in Encryption Error in recognition of The memory space is insufficient for
triggered after replacement
Board the encryption board encryption operation.
of the encryption board or the
main controller 2. At any rate, 0101 Failure in the HDD encryption key (Error Turn OFF/ON the power. If the error is
this error disables accesses to in initialization). Failed to initialize the not recovered, this may be caused by
HDD data. When no problem memory space where the key is stored. hardware-related factors.
Device Error Failure in the 0102 Failure in the HDD encryption key (Error Turn OFF/ON the power. If the error is
is found in connections, use
encryption board in initialization). Failed to initialize the not recovered, this may be caused by
SST to execute Key Clear >
Format > Install System. encryption processing unit. hardware-related factors.
0201 Failure in the HDD encryption key. Turn OFF/ON the power. If the error is
Error in the encryption processing unit. not recovered, this may be caused by
T-2-19
hardware-related factors.
0202 Failure in the HDD encryption key. Turn OFF/ON the power. If the error is
Error in the encryption processing unit. not recovered, this may be caused by
hardware-related factors.
0301 Failure in the HDD encryption key (Error Turn OFF/ON the power. If the error is
in the encryption key). Failed to create not recovered, this may be caused by
the encryption key. hardware-related factors.
0302 Failure in the HDD encryption key (Error Turn OFF/ON the power. If the error is
in the encryption key). Detected the not recovered, this may be caused by a
failure in the encryption key. hardware-related factor (SRAM). Note
that this error initializes the HDD.
0303 Failure in the HDD encryption key (Error Turn OFF/ON the power. If the error is
in the encryption key). Detected the not recovered, this may be caused by a
failure in the encryption key. hardware-related factor (SRAM). Note
that this error initializes the HDD.
0401 Failure in the HDD encryption key (Error Turn OFF/ON the power. If the error is
in the encryption processing). Error is not recovered, this may be caused by a
detected during the encryption process. hardware-related factor (the encryption
board).
0402 Failure in the HDD encryption key (Error Turn OFF/ON the power. If the error is
in the encryption processing). Error is not recovered, this may be caused by a
detected during the decoding process. hardware-related factor (the encryption
board).
T-2-20

2-28
2
2
2-29
Service Operations
■■When Replacing Parts
Parts name Remedy Reference
HDD Backup of the set/registered data
HDD format
Downloading system software
Restoring the backup data
Executing “Auto Adjust Gradation (Full Adjust)”
Main Controller PCB 1 Transferring the parts from old PCB to new PCB
Main Controller PCB 2 Backup of the set/registered data
Transferring the parts from old PCB to new PCB
Restoring the backup data
TPM PCB When TPM setting is “ON”:Restoring the TPM key
T-2-21

■■Consumables
N/A

■■Points to note at servicing


N/A

2-29
2
2
2-30

Laser Exposure System


Laser Scanner Unit 1 Laser Scanner Unit 2

Overview Imaging Lens

■■Overview Reflection Mirror


To realize the high-speed printing, this machine adopts the 2 Laser Scanner Units and the
Laser Driver of each color executes laser scanning with 4-beam.
imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5051 / C5045 employs 4 beam and C5035 / 5030 employs 2
beam.

Imaging Lens
Skew Correction Motor C (M33)
Skew Correction Motor Bk (M34) Reflection Mirror
Scanner
Skew Correction Motor Y (M31) Laser Scanner Unit 2 Mirror
C
Imaging Lens
Skew Correction
Motor M (M32) Laser Laser Laser Laser
Bk Driver Driver Driver Driver
Y (M) (Y) (Bk) (C)

Scanner
BD Sensor (C, Bk)
M Mirror

Scanner Reflection Y M C Bk Reflection


Mirror Mirror
Mirror Laser Driver PCB C (UN15)
Imaging Imaging
Laser Scanner Unit 1 Laser Driver PCB Bk (UN14) Lens Lens
BD Sensor (Y, M)
Laser A Reflection Reflection
Mirror Mirror
Laser B Laser Driver PCB Y (UN13)
Laser C Laser Driver PCB M (UN12) Laser Laser Laser Laser
Scanner Scanner
Laser D Driver Driver Driver Driver
Mirror Mirror
(M) (Y) (Bk) (C)
F-2-44
F-2-46
This machine emits the laser to the image area on the drum negatively-charged.

Image area
Non-image area Non-image area

Laser ON

Enlarged view
F-2-45

2-30
2
2
2-31
■■Specification
Item Description
Wavelength 775 to 800nm
Laser type Red color laser (non-visible light)
Laser output 10mW
Number of laser scanner unit 2
Number of laser light imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5051 / C5045: 4 beam for each color
imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5035 / C5030: 2 beam for each color
Resolution 1200dpi
Motor type Brushless motor
Number of motor rotation imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5051 / C5045: Approx. 29100rpm
imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5035 / C5030: Approx. 37800rpm
Number of scanner mirror facet 6 facet (phi 40)
Control list Laser ON / OFF control
Horizontal scanning synchronous control
Vertical scanning synchronous control
APC control
Laser scanner motor control
BD correction control
Laser shutter control
Image tilt correction control
T-2-22

2-31
2
2
2-32
Various Controls
DC Controller (UN1)
Laser Driver PCB
■■Overview
Laser ON/OFF control
Item Operation description Laser Driver PCB
Laser ON / OFF control Laser light is turned ON / OFF according to the combination of
laser control signal
Horizontal scanning Scanner Motor
Horizontal scanning To align the writing start position in horizontal scanning direction. synchronous control
synchronous control
Vertical scanning synchronous To align the writing start position in vertical scanning direction.
control Vertical scanning
APC control To make the laser light per 1 line consistent amount. synchronous control
Laser Scanner Motor Control To rotate the scanner mirror by the specified speed.
BD correction control To correct the gap BD timing gap due to the angle variation of
Scanner Mirror.
APC control
Laser shutter control To prevent the laser light from being emitted to the machine inside. Laser Scanner Unit 1
Image tilt correction control To correct the image tilt in vertical scanning direction (this control Main
is operated based on the result of color displacement correction Controller
control). Laser scanner motor control Laser Driver PCB
T-2-23

Laser Driver PCB

Laser shutter control


Scanner Motor

BD correction control

Image tilt correction control

Laser Scanner Unit 2

F-2-47

2-32
2
2
2-33
■■Laser ON / OFF control ■■Horizontal scanning synchronous control
●● Purpose ●● Purpose
Laser light is turned ON / OFF according to the combination of laser control signals. This is to align the writing start position in horizontal scanning direction.

●● Execution timing ●● Execution timing


After the power ON Per 1 line

●● Control detail ●● Execution time


DC Controller switches the 4 modes (forcible OFF mode, APC mode, Print mode and standby Approx. 7.5µs
mode) according to the laser control signal.
●● Control detail
Laser control signal 1) DC Controller forcibly emits the laser diode on M-laser driver PCB by setting the laser
control signal of M -laser to APC mode. Also, DC controller forcibly emits the laser diode of
DC Controller (UN1) Laser Driver Scanner mirror Bk laser driver PCB by setting the Bk laser control signal to APC mode.
PCB
Video signal Laser beam 2) Concerning the laser beam of M laser, there is a BD sensor (Y, M) on the scanning light
path and the laser bean is emitted to the BD sensor (Y, M). Regarding the laser beam of Bk
laser, there is a BD sensor (C, Bk) on the scanning light path and the laser beam is emitted
to the BD sensor (C, Bk) as well.
F-2-48
3) Two BD sensors detect the laser beam, create the BD signal (BD_YM, BD_CBk) and send
Mode Laser status Remark it to the DC controller.
Forcible OFF mode OFF Light intensity setting decided on APC is cleared.
4) DC Controller executes synchronous control based on this signal and sends the standard
APC mode ON Laser light intensity adjustment
BD signal to Main Controller as a horizontal scanning synchronous signal (BD) per 1 line.
Print mode ON / OFF Laser is emitted according to the video signal.
Standby mode OFF Host machine is in standby status. 5) When Main Controller receives those signals, it outputs the video signal (VDO_Y, VDO_
T-2-24 M, VOD_C, VDO_Bk) to DC Controller. As a result of this, the Laser Driver emits the laser
beam from the specified position for each line.
Print Image formation
instruction ready timing

PSTBY PINTR PRINT LSTR PSTBY


At 1st line (APC)
LaserA
At 2nd line (APC)
LaserB
At 3rd line (APC)
LaserC
At 4th line (APC)
LaserD

Mode Standby Forcible Standby


APC mode APC mode / Print mode
name mode OFF mode mode

F-2-49

2-33
2
2
2-34
Laser Scanner Unit 1 ■■Vertical Scanning Synchronous Control
Y Laser
VDO_Y Y Laser Driver
PCB
●● Purpose
BD_YM This is to align the writing start position in vertical scanning direction.
BD Sensor (Y, M)

●● Execution timing
VDO_M M Laser
M Laser Driver Per printing
PCB

DC
Main Controller
Controller (UN1) ●● Execution time
Laser Scanner Unit 2
500ms
C Laser Driver C Laser
VDO_C
PCB
BD_CBk
BD Sensor (C, Bk) ●● Control detail
1) When DC Controller receives the print instruction, it detects the reference signal.
Based on this signal, it creates the vertical scanning synchronous signal (PVREQ) and
VDO_Bk sends to Main Controller.
Bk Laser Driver Bk Laser
PCB 2) Main Controller is synchronized with PVREQ signal and sends VDO signal to DC Cotnroller.
3) DC Controller creates the laser drive signal based on VDO signal and sends it to the Laser
F-2-50 Scanner Unit. The Laser Scanner Unit conform the image leading edge with the paper
leading edge by emitting the laser in this timing.
Reference DB
1)
PVREQ Reference
Signal
VDO_Y
Print
VDO
instruction

VDO_M Main DC Controller


VDO Controller2 (UN1)
Laser Laser Laser Laser

VDO_C
VDO

VDO Laser drive signal


VDO_Bk 2) 3)
VDO
F-2-52
F-2-51

2-34
2
2
2-35
Print instruction ■■APC (Auto Power Control) control
Reference ●● Purpose
signal This is to make the laser light for 1 line consistent amount.

Video request signal


(PVREQ) T1 ●● Execution timing
About15ms Per each line (before image writing)
Video signal
(VDO) T2 ●● Execution time
About15ms Approx. 2 µs
Y M C Bk
F-2-53
●● Control details
1) DC Controller outputs the laser control signal to the Laser Driver IC on the Laser Driver
PCB.
2) APC mode is specified to the Laser Driver IC and it forcibly emits the laser diode of each
color. At the same time, each laser driver IC monitors the laser diode (LD) on the photo
diode (PD) and adjusts the output of laser diode until the light intensity becomes consistent
amount.

2-35
2
2
2-36
Laser Scanner Unit 1 ■■Laser scanner motor control

Y Laser
●● Purpose
Y laser control signal This is to rotate the scanner mirror by the specified speed.
Y Laser Driver LD
PCB PD
●● Execution timing
At power-ON, per printing

M Laser
M laser control signal M Laser Driver LD
●● Execution time
PCB PD Approx. 3s (at power-ON), approx. 1s (at printing)

●● Control detail
DC Controller
(UN1) Laser Scanner Unit 2 1) DC Controller forcibly rotates the motors in the two Laser Scanner Units.
2) It detects the speed detection signal (FG1 to 2, BD_YM, BD_CBk) and compares the signal
C Laser with the standard signal in DC Controller and then, controls the acceleration signal (ACC1
C laser control signal C Laser Driver LD to 2) and the deceleration signal (DEC1 to 2) to make the specified speed.
PCB PD

Bk Laser
Bk laser control signal Bk Laser Driver LD
PCB PD

F-2-54

2-36
2
2
2-37

Laser Scanner Unit 1 Related error code

ACC1 Scanner Motor E100-0100: BD error (laser scanner unit 1)


(Y, M) When the Laser Scanner Unit 1 (YM laser) is started or print operation is processing, if the BD
DEC1 signal cannot be detected after the specified time.

FG1 E100-0300: BD error (laser scanner unit 2)


When the Laser Scanner Unit 2 (CBk laser) is started or print operation is processing, if the BD
signal cannot be detected after the specified time.

E100-B000: BD error (laser scanner unit 1/2)


When the Laser Scanner Unit 1/2 is started or print operation is processing, if the BD cycle
BD_YM cannot be detected after the specified time.
BD Sensor (Y, M)

Y Laser Driver M Laser Driver


E102-0100: EEPROM error (laser scanner unit 1)
PCB PCB
Reading error of EEPROM on Laser Driver (Y) occurs.
DC Controller
(UN1) E102-0300: EEPROM error (laser scanner unit 2)
Laser Scanner Unit 2 Reading error of EEPROM on Laser Driver (C) occurs.

ACC2 Scanner Motor


(C, Bk)
DEC2

FG2

BD_CBk
BD Sensor (C, Bk)

C Laser Driver Bk Laser Driver


PCB PCB

F-2-55

2-37
2
2
2-38
■■BD correction control START

●● Purpose
This is to correct the displacement of writing start position of each color laser due to the angle Scanner motor
variation of scanner mirror facet. control finish
(Constant-speed
rotation detection)
●● Execution timing
At power-ON, per printing BD interval
measurement Constant interval Constant interval
Narrow interval Constant interval
●● Execution time
Within approx. 0.5s or less BD1 BD2 BD3 BD4
Writing start correction
value calculation
●● Control detail α
1) DC Controller measures the BD interval after the constant-speed rotation control of
Scanner Motor is completed. BD1 BD2 BD3 BD4
2) DC Controller calculates the correction value according to the gap of BD interval. Writing start position
3) Based on the foregoing correction value, image writing position is corrected. correction α

BD1 VDO BD2 VDO BD3 VDO BD4 VDO

END

F-2-56

2-38
2
2
2-39
■■Laser shutter control Bk Laser Shutter Color Laser Shutter

●● Purpose Bk Shutter Lever


This is to prevent the residue toner from sticking to the dust-prevention glass. Or to prevent
the laser light from emitting to the machine inside when the front cover / right cover is opened.
Color
Shutter Lever
●● Execution timing
After power-ON

Bk Shutter Cam
●● Execution time
Drive Shaft
Approx. 3s (at power-ON), approx. 1s (when scanner motor is started or cover is opened) Laser Shutter Motor (M28)

Color Shutter Cam


●● Control detail Laser Shutter Sensor (PS29)
While the Laser Scanner Motor is operating, the Laser Shutter is opened. During other period, Sensor Lever
the laser shutter is closed.
Front Cover Sensor (PS26)
Also, the Front Cover Sensor (PS18) or the Right Cover Sensor (PS20) works together and
it stops the output signal of laser driver. At the same time, if the Front Cover or Right Cover is DC Controller (UN1)
opened, the Shutter is closed and the laser light path is forcibly blocked. Right Cover Sensor (PS26)
F-2-57

Those operations are controlled by the DC Controller.

2-39
2
2
2-40
Laser shutter position Relation of shutter lever and cam ■■Image tilt correction control
Sensor lever position
For Bk For color For Bk For color
●● Purpose
This is to prevent the gap of laser emission.
(PS29)
Close Close Shutter Sensor ●● Execution timing
Lever Lever
At power-ON, per total 360 sheets printing
Shutter Cam
Laser
Shutter
●● Execution time
Approx. 3 sec

Open Close
●● Control detail
1) DC Controller creates the patch pattern of each color on the ITB.
2) DC Controller compares the patch pattern with the standard value backed up in the
DC Controller by reading this patch pattern at the Patch Sensor and detects the color
displacement amount.
Open Open 3) Based on the foregoing detection result, the laser emission position (tilt degree) of Laser
Scanner Unit is changed.

F-2-58

Related error code

E0112-0000: Laser shutter motor error (not in home position)


If the Laser Shutter Sensor (PS29) is not in the home position at initial operation.

E0112-0001: Laser shutter motor error (operation failure at shutter close)


If the Laser Shutter Sensor (PS29) is not in the home position after approx. 10 sec from the
shutter close operation.

E0112-0002: Laser shutter motor error (operation failure at shutter open)


If the Laser Shutter Sensor (PS29) is still in the home position after approx. 10 sec from the
shutter open operation.

2-40
2
2
2-41

Photosensitive Drum Imaging Lens


Cam
Skew
Correction
Motor Arm
Position relation of
imaging lens and arm
Skew Correction Motor
Imaging Lens
Imaging Lens
Before correction Arm Cam

Photosensitive Drum Imaging Lens


Cam
Cam
Arm Skew
Correction
Motor Arm
Position relation of
imaging lens and arm

Imaging Lens
After correction Arm Cam

F-2-59

Imaging Lens Cam

Skew
Correction
Motor

Scanner Mirror

Reflection
Mirror

Arm
F-2-60

2-41
2
2
2-42
Service Works
■■Periodically replaced parts
There is no periodically replaced part.

■■Consumables
No. Parts Name Parts Number Qty Estimated Life
1 Dust-blocking Glass cleaning pad FL2-9476 1 150k
T-2-25

■■Periodical service list


Parts name: Dust-blocking Glass
Expected life: per 50K sheet
Operation: Clean it with the Dust-blocking Glass Cleaning tool stored in the machine.

Dust-blocking glass
cleaning tool

F-2-61

■■Operation at parts replacement


N/A

■■Points to note at servicing


N/A

2-42
2
2
2-43

Image Formation System ■■Specifications


Item Function/Method
Photosensitive Material OPC
Overview Drum O/D of drum 30mm
Cleaning Cleaning blade
■■Overview Process speed imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5051=246mm/s,
imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5045=215mm/s,
Image formation system of this machine uses the magnetic 2-component jumping developing
imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5035/5030=160mm/s
method for developing and the intermediate transfer method for transfer to create toner Drum heater Mounted with Bk drum as a standard.
image. Assigned as an option for color drums.
To increase life of the image formation unit, this machine uses the primary transfer Developing Developing cylinder 1pc (single developing)
assembly Developing method Dry, 2-component jumping
disengagement method as a new technology.
Toner Non-magnetic negative toner
Following shows major improved points compared to the previous iRC3880/2880 series. Toner level detection Not available
O/D of cylinder 20mm
Purpose : Improved points : Primary Charging method Roller charging
Lower running cost Separating developing assembly from drum unit charging O/D of roller 14mm
Improved life of drum unit Introducing Bk drum (highly-durable type) Cleaning Brush roller
Improved life of developing assembly Introducing ACR (Auto Carrier Refresh) technology Toner Toner amount (the life value imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5051/5045
Improved productivity Separating the laser scanner unit into 2 units container is based on A4 size with 5% Bk: approx. 940g (Life: approx. 40k)
(4-beam for each laser driver) (see Note) image ratio) Color: approx. 590g (Life: approx. 30k)
imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5035/5030
Detection of toner container Not Available
Secondary transfer (presence)
ITB cleaner unit Primary transfer roller inner roller
ITB belt Post-secondary Availability to replace a toner Available
transfer static eliminator container (during continuous
print)
Secondary transfer Transfer method Intermediate Transfer (ITB)
outer roller ITB unit Material PI (Polyimide)
ITB unit
Circumferential length 893mm
Y M C Bk Cleaning Cleaning blade
Patch sensor
Belt displacement correction Available (photosensitive sensor)
Developing
assembly Primary Transfer method Transfer roller
Laser Laser Laser Laser transfer Disengagement mechanism Available
O/D of roller 16mm
Developing Secondary Transfer method Transfer roller
cylinder
transfer Disengagement mechanism Not available
Charging Photosensitive Cleaning Electrostatic cleaning
roller drum
drum unit O/D of secondary transfer inner 16mm
Laser scanner unit 2
Laser scanner unit 1 roller
O/D of secondary transfer outer 24mm
F-2-62
roller
Separating method Curvature separation + static eliminator
Note : Patch sensor Yes
4-beam for iR ADVANCE 5051/5045, 2-beam for iR ADVANCE 5035/5030 T-2-26

2-43
2
2
2-44
■■Parts configuration ■■Print process
●● Major Parts Delivery

Fixing block
Toner container ITB cleaning block 8. Fixing

Transfer block
Y M C Bk Transfer 9. ITB cleaning
assembly ITB
7. Separation
Toner supply 6. Secondary transfer
5. Primary transfer 5. Primary transfer 5. Primary transfer 5. Primary transfer
assembly
Y M C Bk
4. Developing
Waste toner case Developing block 10. Drum cleaning
Y 1.Pre-exposure M C Bk
3. Laser exposure Photosensitive Photosensitive Photosensitive Photosensitive Registration
Developing assembly drum drum drum drum
Laser scanner unit + Drum unit
2. Primary charging Drum
F-2-63 Static latent image cleaning
formation block block Pickup

Flow of print paper


Rotating direction of ITB, photosensitive drum

F-2-64

●● Overview
Static latent 1 Pre-exposure To remove residual charge on the surface of photosensitive
image drum by exposure of pre-exposure LED light
formation block 2 Primary charging To charge the surface of photosensitive drum to be
uniformed negative potential
3 Laser exposure To create static latent image on the surface of
photosensitive drum by emitting laser light (image exposure:
laser exposure area becomes image area)
Developing 4 Developing To attach negatively-charged toner from the developing
block cylinder to the photosensitive drum by non-negative
2-component jumping developing method.
Transfer block 5 Primary transfer To apply positively-charged potential from the back surface
of ITB to transfer toner on the surface of photosensitive
drum to ITB.
6 Secondary transfer To apply positively-charged potential to the secondary
transfer outer roller to transfer toner on the ITB to the paper.
7 Separation To separate paper from the ITB by curvature separation
method. In the case of thin paper which has low elastic
force, the static eliminator reduces potential on the surface
of paper to separate thin paper more easily.
Fixing block 8 Fixing To fix toner on the paper with heat and pressure.
ITB cleaning 9 ITB cleaning To remove residual toner on the ITB by the cleaning blade.
block
Drum cleaning 10 Drum cleaning To remove residual toner on the photosensitive drum by the
block cleaning blade.
T-2-27

2-44
2
2
2-45
●● Bias Types
There are the following 8 types biases used on this machine.
Bias value
Bias name Bias type Application destination
(Reference value)
Primary charging bias (DC) DC Approx. –600V Primary Charging Roller
Primary charging bias (AC) AC Approx. 1.5kVpp
Flying toner blocking bias (DC) DC Approx. -1.3kV Toner Blocking Terminal Plate
Developing bias (DC) DC Approx. -400V Developing Cylinder
Developing bias (AC) AC Approx. 1.6kVpp
Primary transfer bias DC Approx. 1.5kV Primary Transfer Roller
Secondary transfer bias DC Approx. 3kV Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
Secondary transfer cleaning bias DC Approx. -1.0kV
T-2-28

Aforementioned biases are created by 3 HVT and are supplied to the loads used in the
printing process.

Developing Developing Developing Developing


subhigh subhigh subhigh subhigh
voltage voltage voltage voltage
PCB Y PCB M PCB C PCB Bk
(UN43) (UN44) (UN45) (UN46)

Secondary
transfer
Primary Secondary outer roller
Photosensitive transfer transfer
drum roller inner roller

Toner-blocking
electrode plate
Y M C Bk
Y M C Bk Developing AC
monitoring signal
Primary transfer DC HVT2
(UN17)
Developing AC+DC
Developing Primary Charging AC+DC
cylinder charging
roller
monitoring signal
HVT3 DC controller
Secondary transfer DC (UN18) (UN1)

Charging AC+DC
HVT1
Developing AC+DC (UN16)

F-2-65

2-45
2
2
2-46
Controls ■■Pre-exposure
■■Overview ●● Pre-exposure control
Removing residual potential on the photosensitive drum before executing the primary
Pre-exposure Image stabilization control
       Pre-exposure control        Drum film thickness detection charging prevents drum ghost during continuous print.
D-max control According to the command from the DC controller PCB, the pre-exposure unit exposes (emits)
Primary charging
D-half control LED when the photosensitive drum is rotated.
       Primary charging bias control
ARCDAT control Emitting LED light through the light guide removes residual potential on the photosensitive
Discharge current control
PASCAL control
Primary charging cleaning control drum.
Color displacement correction control
ATVC control To make up for the lack of LED’s light intensity, two (2) pre-exposure LEDs are used in total:
Developing/drum
       Developing bias control one at the front of the main unit, and the other at the rear of the main unit.
Toner supply
ACR (Auto Carrier Refresh) control Pre-exposure LED (rear)
       Toner cap automatic opening control
Toner-blocking bias control (UN24 / 26 /28 / 30)
Toner level detection/toner supply control
Drum (presence) detection
New/old detection of drum unit Waste toner feeding
Drum life detection        Waste toner full level detection
Drum heater control Waste toner case (presence) detection
Drum Drum rotation speed control T-2-29

Transfer/separation Light guide


       Primary transfer disengagement control
Primary transfer bias control
Secondary transfer bias control
ITB displacement correction control
ITB cleaning control
Secondary transfer outer roller cleaning Photosensitive drum
control

Drum cleaning Charging roller cleaning brush


       Drum cleaning control Pre-exposure LED (front)
(UN23 / 25 /27 / 29)

Primary charging roller


DC controller
(UN1)

F-2-66

2-46
2
2
2-47
■■Primary charging ●● Primary charging bias control
To charge the surface of photosensitive drum to be uniform negatively-charged potential
●● Overview
The primary charging bias (AC+DC negative), generated by HVT1/2 PCB, is applied to the
This machine uses the roller charging method for primary transfer.
primary charging roller.
To prevent image fault (white spot/missing image) caused by residual toner, the cleaning
brush roller is added to clean the primary charging roller. DC controller(UN1)

Photosensitive Drum
drum cleaner HVT1 /2(UN16/17)
AC + DC negative
Photosensitive
drum

Cleaning brush Primary charging


roller roller
F-2-67
Cleaning brush roller Primary charging roller
F-2-68

●● Discharge current control


To apply optimal primary charging bias according to the environmental change or use
condition of photosensitive drum

Execution timing
1) When the power is turned ON, at sleep recovery
2) At post-rotation after the total reaches 250 prints (see Note1)

Note1: The total print is counted separately between the color mode and the Bk mode. This
control is executed when the counter of either mode reaches the specified number.

Detection description
To detect the current monitoring value of the primary charging AC bias

2-47
2
2
2-48
Execution time ●● Primary charging cleaning control
Within 1 second This machine may not be able to collect residual toner on the drum because this machine
uses fine-grain toner, which possibly results in image fault (white spot/missing image) due to
Operation of the main unit residual toner attached on the primary charging roller.
1) Current monitoring value of the primary charging AC bias is detected To prevent this symptom, the cleaning brush roller is added to forcibly remove residual toner
2) Optimal primary charging current value is determined according to the result of the attached on the primary charging roller.
environment sensor (UN22) and the current monitoring value The drive of the brush roller is engaged with the primary charging roller.
3) The primary charging AC bias is determined to apply to the primary charging roller
Photosensitive Drum
drum cleaner
Primary charging AC
Current monitoring signal HVT1
(UN16)

Y M C Bk Primary charging AC DC controller


(UN1)

HVT2
(UN17)
Primary charging roller
Current monitoring signal

F-2-69

Related error codes:


E061-0X01: Current monitor value error other than initial detection (current monitor value is
lower limit or less, or drum unit is absent)
Cleaning brush Primary charging
E061-0XE0: Current monitor value error at initial detection (current monitor value is upper limit roller roller
or more) F-2-70
E061-0XF0: Current monitor value error at initial detection (current monitor value is lower limit
or less)
E061-0XF1: Change amount error of current monitor value (change amount is abnormal after
time elapsed)

x indicates the corresponding color. (1=Y, 2=M, 3=C, 4=Bk)

2-48
2
2
2-49
■■Developing/drum ●● Developing bias control
To create toner image on the photosensitive drum after the toner has been attached on the
●● Developing overview
photosensitive drum
Toner-blocking Developing Control description
electrode plate cylinder
The developing bias (AC, DC negative) generated by HVT1/2 (UN16/17) is applied to the
developing cylinder
• Developing DC bias: bias for generating potential difference from the photosensitive drum
Bias value is determined based on detection result of the drum film thickness
Toner feeding screw B
• Developing AC bias: bias for improving image quality

DC controller(UN1)

HVT1/2(UN16/17)
Developing motor M5 M8
AC+DC

Developing
cylinder
ATR sensor
(TS5 TS8)

Toner feeding screw A


Waste toner delivery
discharge outlet
F-2-71

Parts name Function


Developing assembly To develop toner fed from the hopper unit on the photosensitive drum
Developing cylinder To develop toner in the developing assembly on the photosensitive drum
Toner feeding screw A/B To stir developer (toner and carrier) in the toner container to supply to
the developing cylinder
Toner-blocking electrode To apply DC bias to the electrode plate to increase retention strength of
plate toner on the developing cylinder
T-2-30

●● Drive configuration
F-2-72
Parts name Function
M5 to M8 Developing motor To rotate the developing cylinder and the toner feeding screw
TS5 to TS8 ATR sensor To detect the ratio of developer (toner + carrier) in the developing
assembly
T-2-31

2-49
2
2
2-50
●● ACR (Auto Carrier Refresh) control ●● Toner-blocking bias control
This machine introduced a method to supply developer (toner + carrier) to improve life (longer This control prevents scattering of toner on the developing cylinder due to deterioration of the
life) of the developing assembly. developing assembly.
This is a control to supply developer to the developing assembly and also discharge Developing AC bias which has been generated by HVT1 (UN16) is generated to be negative
developer to keep optimal developer amount in the developing assembly. DC bias on the developing sub high voltage PCB (UN43 to 46).
This control prevents deterioration of carrier, which had been occurred due to reuse of The generated bias is applied to the toner-blocking electrode plate. This improves retention
developer in the developing assembly. strength of toner on the developing cylinder.
The Toner Feed Screw A & B drive when the Developing Motor (M5 to 8) drives so that the
DC controller(UN1)
developer will be exhausted. The developer is supplied at the right time based on the ATR
control result.
HVT1/2 (UN16/17)
Flow of toner Toner feeding screw A Return screw

Toner discharge outlet Developing sub high voltage PCB Y/M/C/Bk (UN43 46)
DC
Toner-blocking
electrode plate
Toner supply inlet Toner feeding screw B ATR sensor Toner feeding screw C Developing
cylinder
Toner supply inlet

Toner feeding screw A


Toner feeding screw B

Return screw
Toner feeding screw C
Toner discharge outlet

F-2-73

Toner feeding screw B Toner feeding screw A


F-2-74

2-50
2
2
2-51
●● Drum overview ●● Drive configuration
Photosensitive drum Pre-exposure LED light guide Drum motor
M1 M4
Drum rotation sensor1
Drum rotation sensor2 (UN31 / 33 / 35 / 37) Pre-exposure LED
(UN32 / 34 / 36 / 38) light guide
Photosensitive drum

Waste toner screw


Waste toner screw

Drum cleaning blade


Drum cleaning blade

Cleaning brush roller Primary charging roller Cleaning brush roller Primary charging roller

F-2-75 F-2-76

Parts name Function Parts name Function


Drum unit To create toner image by the toner from the developing cylinder after the M1 to M4 Drum motor To rotate the photosensitive drum, the waste toner screw
static latent image has been created on the photosensitive drum. UN31 to UN38 Drum rotation sensor 1/2 To detect rotation of the photosensitive drum
Light guide To expose pre-exposure LED light on the photosensitive drum T-2-33
Photosensitive drum To create toner image on the photosensitive drum
Primary charging roller To make the surface of photosensitive drum to be evenly-charged potential
Charging cleaning To remove residual toner on the primary charging roller
brush roller
Drum cleaning blade To remove residual toner on the photosensitive drum
Waste toner screw To feed residual toner
T-2-32

2-51
2
2
2-52
●● Detection of drum (presence) ●● Old/new detection of drum unit
To detect if the drum unit is installed or not To detect whether the drum unit is new or old

Execution timing Detection timing


1) When the power is turned ON 1) When the power is turned ON
2) At recovery from sleep mode 2) At recovery from sleep mode

Detection description Detection description


To be determined by current monitoring value of the primary charging AC bias To check state of the fuse that is attached to each drum unit
In case that current monitor value is less than the specified value (1mA): no Drum Unit There is a fuse: new drum
In case that current monitor value is the specified value (1mA) or more: Drum Unit present Fuse is blown: used drum

Execution timing Operation of the main unit


Within 1 second 1) The main unit checks presence of the fuse attached to each drum (the fuse detection signal
is monitored)
Operation of the main unit 2) If there is a fuse, the main unit clears the drum film thickness detection data of the
Operation of the main unit is stopped while “No drum unit” is shown on the control panel. applicable drum unit, which is kept in SRAM (IC2).
3) The main unit cuts the fuse (to make the fuse cut signal “H”)
Primary charging AC
HVT1 Drum unit
Current monitoring signal
(UN16)

DC controller
Y M C Bk Primary charging AC DC controller (UN1)
(UN1)

HVT2
(UN17)
Primary charging roller +24V
Current monitoring signal

F-2-77 SRAM Fuse detection signal


(IC2)
Fuse cut signal

Fuse
F-2-78

2-52
2
2
2-53
●● Drum life detection
MEMO:
Fuse cut operation is executed when the power is turned ON after a new Drum Unit is To detect life of the Photosensitive Drum.
installed. The life data is stored in the SRAM (IC2) of the DC Controller.
Thus, if replacing a Drum Unit to another one (new one) to identify a cause of failure at The drum life value can be checked from the service mode.
a field, fuse is blown and the drum thickness data is cleared.
As a result, even though the original Drum Unit is installed to the host machine again,
the host machine identifies it as like-new one and correct print image may not be output. Data storage Reference service
With consideration to above matter, do not use a new Drum Unit when identifying a Target drum Detection items Unit
location mode
cause of failure.
Color drum Primary Charging AC Bias SRAM (IC2) Drum counter life % (To be
(YMC) Monitor value (For details, of the DC display counted up
refer to "Drum film thickness Controller (COPIER > DISPLAY at every 7%)
detection".) > MISC > YDRM-LF,
Related service mode M-DRM-LF, C-DRM-LF)
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > AINR-OFF (fuse cut extend on new drum unit) Bk drum Drum rotation time + Primary Drum counter life % (To be
This is to disable the Drum Unit initialization to be executed when a new Drum Unit is charging AC bias applying display counted up
inserted. Also, fuse meltdown after Drum Unit initialization will not be executed. time (COPIER > DISPLAY > at every 1%)
This is used when replacing a Drum Unit temporarily and checking the image to identify MISC > KDRM-LF)
a cause of a trouble etc. T-2-34
0: Initialization is executed when a new one is installed. Fuse meltdown is executed.
[Default]
1: Initialization is not executed when a new one is installed. Fuse melt down is not CAUTION: The life data varies according to the image type, paper type, use
executed. environment, etc.
Make sure to set this service mode to “1” only when it is necessary at servicing. Be sure
to reset this service mode to “0” when service works are completed. For this reason, the value written in the service mode (drum counter life display) is for
reference, so this is not the accurate value.

2-53
2
2
2-54
●● Drum heater control ●● Drum rotation speed control
The drum heater is attached below the photosensitive drum to keep stabilized charging and This control is performed to keep a uniform drum rotation speed in order to increase accuracy
exposure according to the environmental change in the machine. of the image position (color displacement).
This heater works only when the main power switch is turned OFF while the environment
switch is turned ON. Execution timing
1) The drum rotates, driven by the drum motors (M1 to M4).
2) There is an encoder on the drum shaft, of which rotation is monitored by the two sensors (Y:
Photosensitive
drum UN31/32, M: UN33/34, C: UN35/36, Bk: UN37/38,).
3) This sensor counts the drum count based on a pulse, and feeds back the drum rotation
speed to the drum DC controller to perform speed control.

Photosensitive drum
Drum motor
(M1~M4)

Drum heater

F-2-79
Drum rotation sensor2
(UN32 / 34 / 36 / 38)

Drum rotation sensor1


(UN31 / 33 / 35 / 37)

DC controller (UN1)
F-2-80

2-54
2
2
2-55
■■Transfer/separation ●● Drive configuration
●● Overview ITB motor
M13 M14 ITB displacement control motor
Post-secondary transfer ITB steering
Drive roller static eliminator position sensor(PS24)
(steering roller) ITB displacement
ITB scraper sensor 1 to 4 (PS25 28)
ITB Cleaning
blade Primary transfer
Drive roller disengagement sensor(PS23)
(steering roller) ITB scraper Idol roller
Primary transfer
disengagement sensor(PS22) Secondary transfer
Waste toner outer roller
feeding screw

Primary transfer Waste toner


auxiliary roller Primary transfer Primary transfer Secondary transfer feeding screw
Tension roller outer roller
Primary transfer roller Primary transfer roller ITB cleaning
roller (M) roller (Bk) blade Primary
(C) transfer Primary transfer
(Y) roller(C)
auxiliary roller Primary transfer Primary transfer Patch sensor
F-2-81 Tension roller
Primary transfer roller(M) roller(Bk) (Front/Center/Rear)
roller(Y) (UN47 / UN48 / UN49)
Toner on the photosensitive drum is transferred on paper M15 Primary transfer disengagement motor

Parts name Function F-2-82


ITB unit To transfer toner on the photosensitive drum to the paper
      ITB (Intermediate Transfer Belt) To transfer toner on the photosensitive drum Parts name Function
Primary transfer roller To attract toner on the photosensitive drum to the ITB M13 ITB motor To rotate the ITB and the waste toner screw
Primary Transfer Auxiliary Roller To make the contact surface of Primary Transfer Roller (Y) with M14 ITB displacement To move the drive roller (steering roller)
the ITB horizontal. control motor
Static eliminator To drive ITB. To correct the displacement of ITB. M15 Primary transfer To make the tension roller and the primary transfer roller (Y/M/C)
ITB scraper To scrape toner inside the ITB disengagement motor engaged/disengaged
Tension roller To keep appropriate tension of the ITB PS24 ITB steering position To detect position of the drive roller (steering roller)
Cleaning blade To scrape toner on the ITB sensor
Waste toner feeding screw To feed residual toner inside the ITB cleaner unit PS22 Primary Transfer To detect whether the Tension Roller and Primary Transfer
Secondary transfer unit To transfer toner on the ITB to the paper Pressure Sensor Roller (Y/M/C) are pressurized condition.
      Secondary transfer outer roller To attract toner on the ITB to the paper and feed the paper PS23 Primary Transfer To detect whether the Tension Roller and the Primary Transfer
Disengage Sensor Roller (Y/M/C) is disengaged condition.
Static eliminator To eliminate electric charge on the paper after secondary
transfer PS25 to 28 ITB displacement To detect position of the ITB
sensor
T-2-35
UN47 to 48 Patch Sensor (front/ To detect color displacement level (amount)
rear)
UN49 Patch Sensor (center) To detect patch density for image stabilization control (D-max,
D-half, etc.) and to detect the color displacement amount
UN54 ITB HP sensor To detect home position of the ITB
T-2-36

2-55
2
2
2-56
●● Primary transfer disengagement control
The primary transfer roller for color is engaged or disengaged to keep longer life of the image
formation parts (photosensitive drum, ITB)

Execution timing Primary transfer


auxiliary roller
• Roller to be engaged: when making color prints (If 2 and more sheets of Bk continues
Support arm
within a job at Color + Bk mix printing, disengage the Primary Transfer Roller when printing
color) Cam
Drive shaft
• Roller to be disengaged: anytime other than the above timing

Sensor flag
Control description ITB

1) Drive of the primary transfer disengagement motor (M15) rotates the cam. Primary transfer
2) Rotation of the cam moves the support arm up/down, which separates (disengages) the roller(M)

color primary transfer roller from the ITB.


Primary transfer Primary transfer
3) Position of the primary transfer roller is detected by the primary transfer disengagement disengagement
roller(Y)
sensor (PS22/23). motor(M15)
Primary transfer
disengagement
MEMO: sensor (PS22)
• At standby, the color’s primary transfer roller is disengaged. Primary transfer
Support arm disengagement
sensor(PS23)

Drive shaft

Primary transfer
roller(C)

F-2-83

Related error code


E074-0001: ITB pressurized operation error
E074-0002: ITB disengaged operation error
E074-0003: Breakdown of Primary Transfer Pressure Sensor and Primary Transfer Disengage
Sensor.

2-56
2
2
2-57
●● Primary transfer bias control ●● Secondary transfer bias control
This control transfers toner on the photosensitive drum to the ITB. This control transfers toner on the ITB to the paper.
The primary transfer bias (DC), which has been generated by HVT2 (UN17), is applied to the The secondary transfer bias (DC), which has been generated by HVY3 (UN18), is applied to
primary transfer roller. the secondary transfer outer roller.
Bias value is determined by the measurement value of environment sensor 1 (UN22) Bias value is determined by the measurement value of environment sensor 2 (UN50) and the
paper type.
DC controller(UN1)
DC controller(UN1)

HVT2 (UN17)
HVT3 (UN18)
DC DC DC DC
DC
Drive roller
(steering roller)

Secondary transfer outer roller

F-2-85
Primary transfer Primary transfer Primary transfer Primary transfer
roller(Y) roller(M) roller(C) roller(Bk)
F-2-84

2-57
2
2
2-58
●● ITB displacement correction control
Related Error Codes
This control prevents damage on the ITB due to displacement of the ITB. E075-0002: failure in ITB steering position sensor
E075-0003: failure in ITB displacement control (full displacement to the rear)
Execution timing E075-0004: failure in ITB displacement sensor
When the ITB is rotated E075-0103: failure in ITB displacement control (full displacement to the front)

Control description
MEMO:
1) The ITB displacement sensors (PS25 to 28) detect displacement of the ITB.
Following table shows detection result of the ITB displacement sensor and operation of
2) Drive of the ITB displacement control motor (M14) rotates the cam. the main unit.
The cam position is detected by the steering position sensor (PS24).
3) Rotation of the cam moves the drive shaft up/down to tilt the steering roller.
State of ITB displacement sensor
4) Tilt of the steering roller generates tension difference of the ITB to move the ITB to the front Edge state of ITB belt Operation of main unit
PS25 PS26 PS27 PS28
or rear. Full displacement to the rear Error code (E075-0003) stops
OFF OFF OFF OFF
5) Repeating steps 1) through 4) corrects displacement of the ITB. (approx. 5.8mm or more) the main unit.
Displacement to the rear Steering roller (rear) is moved
ITB steering OFF OFF OFF ON
position sensor(PS24)
(approx. 4.0mm to 5.7mm) down.
Displacement to the rear
OFF OFF ON ON
Drive shaft (approx. 2.1mm to 3.9mm)
ITB displacement control
motor(M14) Cam OFF ON ON ON
Reference position
ITB displacement ON ON ON ON Steering roller (rear) is moved
sensor2(PS26) Displacement to the front up.
ON ON ON OFF
ITB displacement (approx.2.1mm to 3.9mm)
ITB
sensor1(PS25) Displacement to the front
Drive roller ON ON OFF OFF
(steering roller) (approx.4.0mm to 5.7mm)
Full displacement to the front Error Code (E075-0103) stops
ON OFF OFF OFF
(approx.5.8mm or more) the main unit.
ITB displacement T-2-37
sensor3(PS27)
ITB displacement
The “ON” state of the sensors above indicates that the light is blocked
sensor4(PS28)

Sensor flag

Support arm

F-2-86

2-58
2
2
2-59
●● ITB cleaning control ●● Secondary transfer outer roller cleaning control
To remove residual toner on the ITB To prevent soil on the back of the sheet caused by soil on the secondary transfer outer roller

Control description Execution timing


1) The ITB cleaning blade scrapes toner on the ITB. 1) At warm-up rotation (fixing temperature is less than 50 deg C, jam recovery)
2) Scraped toner is fed to the waste toner case by the waste toner feeding screw. 2) At the post-rotation
3) After executing image stabilization control (creating patch image on the ITB)
ITB motor

M13
Control description
The secondary transfer bias (see Note 1), which has been generated by HVT3 (UN18), is
applied to the secondary transfer outer roller.
Residual toner on the secondary transfer outer roller is attached to the ITB, and then collected
by the ITB cleaning unit.

Caution:
Waste toner
feeding screw Both positive bias and negative bias are applied:

ITB cleaning blade Drive roller Because of polarized-charged (positive and negative) residual toner, both types of
(steering roller) residual toner need to be removed.
F-2-87 Therefore, positively-charged bias is applied on the 1st cycle of ITB while negatively-
charged bias is applied on the 2nd cycle of ITB.

ITB cleaning blade

Cleaning bias2
Waste toner
feeding screw
Drive roller Secondary transfer
(steering roller) outer roller
F-2-88

Related Service Mode


Forced execution of the secondary transfer outer roller cleaning
COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEANING > 2TR-CLN

2-59
2
2
2-60
●● Separation ■■Drum cleaning
Paper is separated from the ITB due to paper’s elastic force.
●● Overview
In the case of thin paper which has low elastic force, the static eliminator reduces potential on
To clean residual toner on the photosensitive drum
the back surface of paper. This reduces electrostatic adsorption of paper so that thin paper is
Residual toner on the drum is scraped by the drum cleaning blade.
separated from the ITB more easily.
Then, rotation of the waste toner screw feeds the residual toner to the waste toner case.
Post-secondary transfer
static eliminator Photosensitive drum
Secondary transfer
inner roller

Secondary transfer Waste toner screw


outer roller

F-2-89
Drum cleaning blade

MEMO:
On this machine, by reducing the diameter of Secondary Transfer Inner Roller, contact
surface of the paper with the ITB is reduced. This prevents the thin paper from sticking
onto the ITB.
Cleaning brush roller Primary charging roller
F-2-90

2-60
2
2
2-61
■■Image stabilization control
●● Overview
To prevent image fault due to environmental change or deterioration of photosensitive drum
to make stable print image
DC controller(UN1)
Main controller 2
ATVC control
ATR control

PASCAL control

Toner Toner Toner Toner

Y M C Bk

Patch sensor D-half control


(Front/Center/Rear)
(UN47 / UN48 / UN49) Color displacement
correction control

D-max control
Laser scanner unit ARCDAT control
Drum film thickness
detection

F-2-91

●● Control timing
Execution items for image stabilization control differ according to the environment or the
condition of image-formation parts.
Following shows the control items to be executed by each sequence as well as the downtime
(estimation).

2-61
2
2
2-62

Control types

Startup correction (*1)

correction
Discharge current

detection
Drum thickness

detection)
ATR control (patch

Primary transfer ATVC

ATVC
Secondary transfer

cleaning
Secondary transfer

D-Max control

ARCDAT control

D-Half control

correction control
Color displacement
Execution
Execution condition Required time (sec)
timing

At power ON At normal condition Model A: approx 20.9 Model B: approx 29.5 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○


H/H environment Model A: approx 46.0 Model B: approx 68.1 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
At recovery Sleep is less than 8 hours Model A: approx 12.1 Model B: approx 17.6 ○ ○ ○ ○
from sleep Sleep is 8 hours or more Model A: approx 20.9 Model B: approx 29.5 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
Sleep is 8 hours or more (in H/H Model A: approx 46.0 Model B: approx 68.1
○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
environment)
At pre-rotation At normal condition Model A: approx 1.1 Model B: approx 1.7 ○
At environment change Model A: approx 12.1 Model B: approx 17.6 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
Per total of 500 sheets Model A: approx 2.7 Model B: approx 4.0 ○
At sheet During printing per total of 100 sheets Model A: approx 8.4 Model B: approx 12.8 ○ ○ ○
interval During printing per total of 250 sheets Model A: approx 3.3 Model B: approx 4.3 ○
During printing per total of 700 sheets Model A: approx 11.1 Model B: approx 16.8 ○ ○ ○ ○
During printing per total of 360 sheets Model A: approx 6.1 Model B: approx 9.3
○ ○
(model A) or total of 240 sheets (Model B)
During printing per total image ratio 2000% Model A: approx 2.8 Model B: approx 4.3 ○ ○
At post- After printing per total of 25 sheets Model A: approx 6.1 Model B: approx 9.3 ○ ○
rotation After printing per total of 125 sheets Model A: approx 11.7 Model B: approx 17.1 ○ ○ ○ ○
After printing per total of 180 sheets (model Model A: approx 5.0 Model B: approx 7.6

A) or total of 120 sheets (model B)
After printing per total image ratio 800% Model A: approx 2.8 Model B: approx 4.3 ○ ○
After printing per total of 1000 sheets Model A: approx 42.6 Model B: approx 65.7 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
After printing per total of 5000 sheets Model A: approx 47.6 Model B: approx 72.1 ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○ ○
T-2-38
Model A: imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5051/5045
Model B: imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5035/5030
*1: ITB dirt correction, patch sensor correction etc.

Related service mode


COPIER>OPTION>CLEANING>OHP-PTH(setting of the number of sheet to execute ITB
cleaning sequence after transparency feed)
COPIER>OPTION>CLEANING>ITBB-TMG (setting of ITB cleaning interval)

2-62
2
2
2-63
●● Drum film thickness detection ●● D-max control
To detect use condition of the photosensitive drum This control determines optimal developing DC bias, primary charging DC bias, laser power
output.
Execution timing
1) When the power is turned ON. Execution timing
2) Every time making print 1) When replacing a drum unit or developing assembly.
2) At every post-rotation after the total reaches 1000 prints.
Control description 3) Power ON (High temperature and humidity)and corrects the each color developing DC
1) The drum count value is calculated by the monitor signal of the primary charging AC bias. bias, primary charging DC bias, laser power output to realize the target density.
2) The count value calculated in step 1) above is added to the drum count value that has been
kept in SRAM. Detection details
3) The latest count value determined in step 2) above is classified to be one of the 10 levels 1) DC controller creates the patch pattern in corresponding color on the ITB.
as the drum film thickness detection data. 2) DC Controller measures the patch density with the Patch Sensor (center) (UN49)
4) The determined data is compared to the existing drum film thickness detection data kept in
ITB
the other area in SRAM. If there is any difference between both data, the newly-determined
data is overwritten on SRAM as the latest drum film thickness detection data. If there is no
difference in both data, the newly-determined data is not overwritten, but disposed.
DC controller
(UN1)
SRAM(IC2) Photosensitive
Drum count drum
data
Developing
cylinder
Y Primary

Primary charging DC bias


M
C charging roller
Y M C Bk

Laser Power output


Developing DC bias
Photosensitive Drum film
drum Monitor signal thickness data Patch sensor
HVT1 (Center)
Primary charging (UN16)
roller Primary charging (UN49)
AC bias Y
drive signal M
C

F-2-92
HVT2 Laser scanner
HVT1(UN16) (UN17) unit 1/2
MEMO:
Bk Drum for highly-durable type, the drum is no shave.
Therefore, Bk drum is not the thickness detection. Patch image date
The result of drum thickness detection is reflected to the following data.
• Developing bias D-max control
DC controller(UN1)
• Primary transfer bias
• ATR patch detection result F-2-93
• Laser output

2-63
2
2
2-64
●● PASCAL control
Start
This control stabilizes gradation density characteristics of the image
This control is executed when selecting [“Auto gradation correction” > “Full correction”] in
User Mode.
DC controller(UN1)
Density characteristics of the patch pattern made by test print is scanned by the reader to
Patch pattern is created create the image density correction table. Using this table corrects image gradation density
characteristics, which vary according to the environmental change or deterioration of
photosensitive drum.
Patch sensor(Center)(UN49)
Main Controller 2 DC Controller (UN1) ITB
(Y)D-max correction table Patch scanning
PASCAL PG
1st Sheet
PS49
(D-maxPASCAL)
Target
Density

Patch Sensor (Center)


Y10 DC controller(UN1) Density
Vdc Reader

Target Y3 D-max correction table is created(Y,M,C,Bk) PG


Y2
Y1 Paper
2nd~4th Sheet
(Gradation Reader
DC controller(UN1)
PASCAL) LUT
0
Developing DC bias,
Vdc
Primary charging DC bias, PG
Laser Power output is determined Paper

F-2-94 Standard data PG


for D-half - 10 Patch
- 3 Screen x 4 color
PS49
Target Patch Sensor (Center)
density value
Standard data PG
for ARCDAT - 3 Patch
- 3 Screen x 4 color
PS49
Target Patch Sensor (Center)
density value

F-2-95
Execution timing
When executing calibration (during execution of [“Auto gradation correction” > “Full
correction”] in User Mode)

Control description
1) When the specified conditions are satisfied, the main controller prints 4 types of memorized
test prints (patch pattern).
2) Set the test print on the reader.
3) The reader scans gradation density of patch pattern from the test prints.
4) Main controller 2 creates the image gradation density correction table from the gradation
density data scanned by the reader.

2-64
2
2
2-65

MEMO: Start
This control creates 4 types of patch patterns as follows:
• Patch pattern for copy (64 patches for each color)
• Patch pattern for text (64 patches for each color) Main controller2
• Patch pattern for photo (64 patches for each color)
Output of patch pattern data
• Patch pattern for D-max (64 patches for each color)

DC controller(UN1)

Patch pattern is created


Reader

Patch image date Patch patterns (4 types)


are printed on paper
Printer
PASCAL control

Printed test patterns


F-2-96
are scanned by the reader

(Y)PASCAL correction table Patch sensor(Center)(UN49)


Actual gradation
Patch scanning
characteristics
Y63Y64
100
DC controller(UN1)

Density data(D-CON)
Output of density data

Ideal gradation Main controller2


Y2 characteristics
Y1 PASCAL correction table is
0 100 created(Y,M,C,Bk)
Data output(M-CON)

100
Ideal gradation
characteristics

Density data(D-CON)

Actual gradation
characteristics
0 100
Data output(M-CON)

F-2-97

2-65
2
2
2-66
●● D-half control 4) The Main Controller 2 executes the gradation correction to realize the ideal halftone image
This control determines optimal image gradation based on this data.
Also, this control creates the standard patch used at ARCDAT control and stores the
Execution timing standard data for ARCDAT according to the measurement result of UN49. (refer to MEMO.)
1) When replacing a drum unit or developing assembly ITB
2) At post-rotation every time the total reaches 1000 prints
3) At execution of PASCAL control

Control details
1) The Main Controller 2 outputs the patch data of each color (Y, M, C, Bk) to the DC
Controller.
2) DC Controller creates the patch pattern of each color (Y, M, C, Bk) on the ITB based on this
data.
3) DC Controller measures the patch pattern with the Patch Sensor (center) (UN49) and
returns the result to the Main Controller 2.

Laser Power output


Patch sensor
(center)
(UN49)

Laser scanner unit 1/2

Video data Patch image date

DC controller(UN1)

Density data

D-half Control
Main controller2
F-2-98

2-66
2
2
2-67
Correction value calculation flow for ARCDAT control
Start
Start
Main controller2

Output of patch pattern data DC controller(UN1)


Reference patch pattern for
DC controller(UN1) ARCDAT is created(3Patch)

example)Reference data for


Patch pattern is created Patch sensor(center)(UN49)
ARCDAT of copy pattern
Patch scanning
(Y)D-half correction table Patch sensor(Center)(UN49)

Density data(D-CON)
Actual gradation 100
Patch scanning DC controller(UN1)
characteristics
Y9 Y10
100 Output of density data (INT)
DC controller(UN1)
40 INT
Density data(D-CON)

Output of density data


20

Y2 Ideal gradation Main controller2 10 40 Main controller2


characteristics 100
Y1 D-half correction table is Data output(D-CON) Saved as reference
0 100 created(Y,M,C,Bk) data for ARCDAT
Data output(V-CON)
F-2-100

100
Ideal gradation
characteristics
Density data(D-CON)

Actual gradation
characteristics
0 100
Data output(V-CON)

F-2-99

MEMO:
Following 4 types of patch patterns are created on this control.
• Copy pattern (10 patch per each color)
• Letter priority pattern (10 patch per each color)
• Photo priority pattern (10 patch per each color)
• Standard pattern for ARCDAT control (3 patch per each color)

2-67
2
2
2-68
●● ARCDAT control ITB
This control obtains ideal gradation characteristics while reducing down time

Execution timing
1) When replacing a drum unit or developing assembly
2) At post-rotation every time the total reaches 25 prints (when continuously making prints,
printing is interrupted for every 100 prints to execute this control)

Control details
1) DC Controller creates the patch pattern of each color (Y, M, C, Bk) on the ITB.
(3 patterns per each color, total 12 patterns)
2) DC Controller measures the patch pattern with the Patch Sensor (center) (UN49) and
returns the result to the Main Controller 2. Patch sensor
3) The Main Controller 2 compares the actual measured data with the backed up standard (center)
(UN49)
data for ARCDAT control. Difference after comparison is reflected to D-half result as offset
value.

Laser scanner unit 1/2

Video data Patch image date

DC controller(UN1)

Density data

ARCDAT Control
Main controller2
F-2-101

2-68
2
2
2-69
●● Color displacement correction control
Start
This control corrects uneven exposure of the laser scanner unit or color displacement caused
by uneven rotation of the drum or ITB
DC controller(UN1)
ITB belt
Patch pattern formation

Patch sensor(center)(UN49)

Patch scanning

DC controller(UN1)

Measurement data (SIN) transmission

Main controller2
Comparison of measurement data (SIN)
and reference data (INT)
Density data(D-CON)

INT
40
α
Registration sensor
20 SIN (rear)
Patch sensor (UN48)
Main controller2
10 40 (Center)
Offset value (alpha) determination (UN49)
Data output(D-CON)
(i.e., difference between SIN and INT)
Patch sensor
(front) DC controller(UN1)
(UN47)
Main controller2
F-2-103
Inclusion of result in
D-half correction table
Current gradation
Density data(D-CON)

100
characteristics

60 Gradation characteristics
after correction
40
α
20

40
Data output(V-CON)

F-2-102

2-69
2
2
2-70
Control detail ●● ATR control
1) DC Controller creates the patch pattern of each color on the ITB. This control supplies developer to the developing assembly to keep ideal ratio of developer in
2) DC Controller compares those patterns with the standard value backed up in the DC the developing assembly
Controller by reading the patch sensor (front, center, rear) (UN47 to 49) and detects the
color displacement amount. Timing to start
3) Based on the detected result as above, the DC Controller executes correction depending When replacing with a new drum unit (ATR sensor)
on the color displace amount. At every print (Developing Assembly Toner Supply Count, ATR sensor)
Timing to start In the case of post-rotation every time the total reaches 150 prints or continuous print, the job
During During is interrupted when the total reaches 250 prints to execute this control (patch sensor)
print print
At for for Control description
Control type Control description
power every every
Developer is supplied to the drum unit while the supplying amount of the developer for
ON 360 100
each color is calculated by the above-mentioned start timing. The DC controller determines
prints prints
supplying amount of toner by 3 types of data as follows.
in total in total
Correction in Write-start Change write-start timing in main • Developing Assembly Toner Supply Count
Yes Yes Yes
main scanning correction scanning direction • ATR sensor
direction Correction Increase/reduce the number of pixels in • Patch sensor
of overall Yes Yes No main scanning direction (at both edges
When the DC controller determines that it is necessary to supply toner, the developing motors
magnification ratio of image)
Correction of odd Increase/reduce the number of pixels (M5 to M8) and the toner supply clutches (CL2 to CL5) are turned ON. This operation rotates
magnification ratio Yes Yes No in main scanning direction (at center of the toner feeding screw A/B so that the specified amount of developer is supplied to the
image) developing assembly.
Correction in Write-start Change write-start timing in sub
Yes Yes No
sub scanning correction scanning direction Hopper assembly Toner feeding
direction screw
Correction of Change position of laser exposure by Developing Toner supply Developing assembly
Yes Yes No
skewed image the laser scanner unit motor clutch
T-2-39 M5~M8 CL2~CL5 Developing cylinder

Toner supply levelsensor


(PS1~PS4) Toner feeding ATR sensor
screwA/B (TS5~TS8)
DC controller(UN1)
Developing assembly toner supply Count
ATR sensor Result Patch sensor
(center)(UN49)
Patch sensor Result

F-2-104

2-70
2
2
2-71
●● ATVC control
Related Error Codes
E020-001x: Error in patch sensor of developing assembly (at initial state) (more than the upper
This control prevents transfer failure due to environmental change or deterioration of the
limit) primary transfer roller or the secondary transfer roller
E020-002x: Error in patch sensor of developing assembly (at initial state) (less than the lower
limit) • Primary transfer ATVC
E020-010x: Error in patch sensor (more than the upper limit) Execution timing
E020-020x: Error in patch sensor (less than the lower limit) 1) When the power is turned ON
E020-0x90: Error in ATR sensor (less than the lower limit) 2) When replacing with a new drum unit
E020-0x91: Error in ATR sensor (more than the upper limit) 3) At recovery from sleep mode
E020-0xB0: Error in developer ratio when making prints (less than the lower limit) 4) At post-rotation after the total reaches 500 prints
E020-0xB1: Error in developer ration when making prints (more than the upper limit)
5) When the environment is changed

x indicates the target color (1=Y, 2=M, 3=C, 4=Bk)


Catuion:
The total print is counted separately between the color mode and the Bk mode. This
control is executed when the counter of either mode reaches the specified number.

Control description
1) Monitoring current value of the primary transfer DC bias is detected
2) Optimal primary charging current value is determined based on the temperature/
humidity data of Environment sensor 1.
3) The primary transfer DC bias is determined to apply to the primary transfer roller

2-71
2
2
2-72
• Secondary transfer ATVC ■■Toner supply assembly
Execution timing
1) When the power is turned ON ●● Overview
2) At every print job To supply toner in the toner container to the developing assembly

Cap release Cap drive


holder link holder Toner supply drive unit
Control description
Toner container
1) Monitoring current value of the secondary transfer DC bias is detected
2) Optimal primary charging current value is determined based on the temperature/
humidity data of environment sensor 2.
3) The secondary transfer DC bias is determined to apply to the secondary transfer roller

Primary transfer DC Bias


Current monitoring
signal

Toner stirring plateA


Secondary transfer
outer roller

Current monitoring Hopper unit


signal

Secondary transfer DC controller(UN1) Toner stirring plateB


DC Bias
Environment
sensor1
Primary transfer (UN22)
Developing assembly
roller
Environment
sensor2
(UN50) Toner supply screw
F-2-106

Parts name Function


F-2-105
Toner supply drive unit To supply toner in the toner container to the hopper unit
      Cap drive link holder To open/close the toner cap and rotate the toner container
Cap release holder To release the toner cap
Hopper unit To supply toner in the hopper unit to the developing assembly
      Toner stirring plate A, B To stir toner in the hopper unit
Toner supply screw To supply toner in the hopper unit to the developing assembly
T-2-40

2-72
2
2
2-73
●● Toner cap automatic opening control
MEMO:
This control automatically opens/closes the cap of toner container Following shows detection result of toner cap position sensor and the operational
relationship with the main unit.
Toner container driver motor
M9~M12 State of toner cap Toner cap position sensor 1 Toner cap position sensor 2
Released OFF ON
Cap release holder Cap drive
link holder Toner cap In motion(released → sealed) OFF OFF
Toner container Sealed ON ON
In motion(sealed → released) ON OFF
T-2-41

●● Toner supply control/toner level detection


Supplies the toner in the Toner Container to the Developing Assembly. At the same time, it
Toner cap Toner cap detects the toner level inside the Hopper Unit.
position sensor1 position sensor2
(PS9 PS12) (PS5 PS8) Toner container driver motor
Toner supply drive unit
M9~M12
F-2-107 Toner container
CCW

Execution timing
When replacing a toner container

Control description (e.g.: release of toner cap)


1) Toner cap position sensor 1 and 2 (PS5 to 12) detect the state of toner cap.
2) Operation of the toner container drive motors (M9 to 12) moves the cap drive link holder Toner stirring plateA
DC controller(UN1)
and the cap release holder to the right (toner container side). Piezo sensor
(TS1 TS4) Hopper unit Toner supply
3) The toner cap is secured with the cap drive link holder. Developing clutch Developing motor
supply count CL2~CL5 M5~M8
<Hold the toner cap> Toner stirring plateB

4) Operation of the toner container drive motors (M9 to 12) moves the cap drive link holder to Toner supply
level sensor
the left. <Release the toner cap> ATR control
(PS1~PS4) Developing assembly
Toner feeding
screw
Related Error Codes
E025-0100: Error in lock of toner container drive motor (Y)
E025-0200: Error in lock of toner container drive motor (M) F-2-108

E025-0300: Error in lock of toner container drive motor (C)


E025-0400: Error in lock of toner container drive motor (Bk)
E025-0110: Error in timeout of toner cap position sensor (for Y toner container)
E025-0210: Error in timeout of toner cap position sensor (for M toner container)
E025-0310: Error in timeout of toner cap position sensor (for C toner container)
E025-0410: Error in timeout of toner cap position sensor (for Bk toner container)

2-73
2
2
2-74
• Toner supply control • Transition of Toner Level
Title Description Timing to supply Operation of main unit The following table shows the transition of toner level (Toner Container, Hopper Unit)
Supply to To supply developer in When the output result of The toner container drive motors according to each detection item.
hopper the toner container to piezo sensors (TS1 to 4) is (M9 to 12) are driven for 2
the hopper unit changed from H to L seconds (*1) Detection state
Supply to To supply developer in Toner supply is determined The developing motors (M5 to8) Empty toner warning 1 Empty toner warning 2 Empty toner
Toner level
developing the hopper unit to the to be necessary by the result and the toner supply clutches
assembly developing assembly of ATR control (CL2 to 5) are driven for the
specified period.
Toner Container
T-2-42 10% remaing 0% remaing 0% remaing

*1: If the output result of piezo sensors TS1 to 4 keeps L despite drive of M9 to 12, make M9
to 12 driven for 2 seconds and then stopped for 2 seconds and repeat this procedure up to
20 times. Hopper Unit 100% remaing 100% remaing 0% remaing

• Toner level detection


F-2-109
Message Whether Toner Supplementary explanation:
Detecting to
Detection description Detection timing (machine Container can When replacing to a new Toner Container after "empty toner warning 2", this machine
(location)
operation) be removed recognizes that the container was replaced by opening and closing the Toner Replacement
Empty toner warning 1 Prediction from the Developing Please prepare Disabled
Cover. Then, the machine starts the toner supply operation and judges that the container
(Level of toner in the Developing Assembly Assembly a toner container
Toner Container is toner supply count supply count (continuous print was replaced to a new one from the Piezo Sensor detection result in the Hopper Unit. (When
approx. 10%.)*1 (Judged from the *2 is available) replacing to a new Toner Container, the detection result of Piezo Sensor is changed from L to
number of supplying H.)
toner to the Hopper
Unit.)
Empty toner warning 2 When the sensor output Piezo sensor The toner Enabled
(Level of toner in the result is changed from container can Related Error Codes
Hopper Unit is approx. H to L be replaced E025-0100: Error in toner container drive motor (Y)
100%.) (continuous print E025-0200: Error in toner container drive motor (M)
is available)
E025-0300: Error in toner container drive motor (C)
Empty toner (Level of After approx. 1000 Developing Please replace a Enabled
toner in the Hopper sheets are printed Assembly toner container E025-0400: Error in toner container drive motor (K)
Unit is approx. 0%.) from the point that the supply count (the main E027-0100: Error in supply to developing assembly (Y)
Developing Assembly *2 unit stops the E027-0200: Error in supply to developing assembly (M)
toner supply count is operation) E027-0300: Error in supply to developing assembly (C)
started after the empty
E027-0400: Error in supply to developing assembly (K)
toner warning 2 (in
case of A4 and dot ratio
at 5% image for each
color) Related service mode
T-2-43
COPIER>OPTION>DSPLY-SW>T-CRG-SW (Toner Container replacement mode
display switch)
*1: It is 5% for Europe. COPIER>OPTION>CLEANING>T-LW-LVL (No toner warning display timing changing
*2: Developing Assembly supply count shows the level of toner supplied from the Hopper Unit switch)
to the Developing Assembly.

2-74
2
2
2-75
■■Waste toner feeding assembly ●● Waste toner case full level detection
To detect toner level accumulated in the waste toner case
●● Overview
ITB cleaner
To feed waste toner of the drum cleaning unit and the ITB cleaning unit to the waste toner unit
case ITB unit

ITB cleaner unit


ITB unit

Drum
unit

Drum unit Waste


toner DC controller
stirring Developing (UN1)
M26 plate assembly
motor

Waste toner
Developing screw1 Waste toner
assembly feeding screw
UN21

Waste
Waste toner screw1 toner
Waste toner feeding screw Waste toner case
detect
Waste toner signal
Waste toner case Waste toner screw2 case sensor
[There is not [There is
waste toner case : Sensor ON] waste toner case : Sensor OFF]
Waste toner

Waste toner case Waste toner screw2

F-2-110

Parts name Function


Waste toner feeding unit To feed waste toner in each unit to the waste toner case
F-2-111
      Waste toner feeding screw To feed waste toner from the drum cleaning unit
Waste toner case To keep waste toner
      Waste toner screw 1, 2 To stir toner in the waste toner case Detection Detection Message
Detection timing
T-2-44 description source (operation of main unit)
Waste toner full level When the output result of sensor is Waste toner Please prepare a waste
warning (approx. 7% changed from H to L full level toner case (continuous
until the waste toner sensor print is available)
level is full)
Waste toner full level After the Developing Assembly toner Developing Please replace a waste
warning (approx. 0% supply count is started from full alert, Assembly toner case (the main unit
until the waste toner when a total of approx. 1000 sheets toner supply stops the operation)
level is full) is printed (in case of image on A4, count
dot ratio of each color is 5%)
T-2-45

2-75
2
2
2-76
In order to prevent the toner leakage at removal of Waste Toner Case, the Shutter is
Related Error Code
prepared.
E013-0001: error in lock of waste toner feeding path
This Shutter has a mechanical mechanism, so when the Waste Toner Case is installed/
removed, the Shutter is opened/closed.
Waste Toner Ejection Mouth Shutter of the main body is linked with the Waste Toner Case
●● Detection of waste toner case
Shutter, so when the Waste Toner Case is installed/removed, this Ejection Mouth Shutter is
To detect if the waste toner case is installed
also opened/closed simultaneously.
Execution timing
1) When the power is turned ON
2) When the front cover is open

Detection description
The waste toner case sensor (UN21) detects the presence of waste toner case.
ON: there is a waste toner case
OFF: there is no waste toner case (user message is displayed)
ITB cleaner
unit
ITB unit

Drum
unit

Waste
toner DC controller
stirring Developing (UN1)
M26 plate assembly
motor

Waste toner
screw1 Waste toner
feeding screw
UN21

Waste
toner
Waste toner case
detect
Waste toner signal
Waste toner case Waste toner screw2 case sensor
[There is not [There is
waste toner case : Sensor ON] waste toner case : Sensor OFF]

F-2-112
2-76
2
2
2-77
■■Other controls
●● Special control
Following sequences are assigned as special sequence with this machine
ITB cleaning blade ITB cleaning blade ITB cleaning blade Solid color band
Solid black band Solid black band (Y/M/C/Bk)

ITB ITB ITB

F-2-113

Sequence for black band


In the case of continuous prints while no toner is fed to the ITB cleaning blade, the ITB
cleaning blade can be removed. Therefore, toner (width = full width of ITB, length = 1mm
solid black band) is transferred on the ITB to supply toner to the ITB cleaning blade.

<Execution timing>
At post-rotation after the total reaches 100 prints

Sequence for transparency black band


When resistance adjustment agent on the transparency is attached on the ITB, it reduces
transfer efficiency on the attached area. If considerable amount of resistance adjustment
agent is attached on the ITB, it can cause fusion in the ITB cleaning assembly. To prevent this
symptom, toner (width = full width of ITB, length = 80mm solid black band) is supplied to the
ITB cleaning blade.

<Execution timing>
Sheet-to-sheet interval after 15 sheets of transparency are printed continuously
At post-rotation after 7 sheets are printed continuously since the last execution

Sequence for color band


Making prints with low image ratio can deteriorate toner and reduces developing performance.
To prevent this symptom, average image ratio for each color is calculated by ATR control and
appropriate amount of toner (width = A4, length = solid color band appropriate for deteriorated
toner amount) determined by the calculation is transferred to the ITB.

<Execution timing>
When average image ratio per sheet is 2% or less

2-77
2
2
2-78
Service work
■■Periodically replaced parts
Not applicable

■■Consumable parts
No. Parts name Parts number Qty Estimated life Remarks
1 ITB FC8-4400 1 500k
2 Primary transfer roller FC8-4401 4 500k
3 Secondary transfer inner roller FC8-4402 1 500k
4 Secondary transfer outer roller FC8-4876 1 500k
5 ITB cleaning blade FM3-6018 1 150k
6 Transfer separation guide unit FM3-8893 1 500k
7 Developing assembly (Y) FM3-8977 1 500k imageRUNNER ADVANCE
C5051/5045
Developing assembly (M) FM3-8978 1 500k imageRUNNER ADVANCE
Developing assembly (C) FM3-8979 1 500k C5035/5030
Developing assembly (Bk) FM3-8939 1 500k
8 Developing assembly (Y) FM3-8973 1 500k
Developing assembly (M) FM3-8974 1 500k
Developing assembly (C) FM3-8975 1 500k
Developing assembly (Bk) FM3-8976 1 500k
9 Toner filter FC6-9817 1 100k
T-2-46

■■List of periodical service works


No. Parts name Execution timing Work Remarks
1 Secondary transfer guide 50k Cleaning
2 Feeding contact guide 50k Cleaning
3 Patch sensor 50k Inspection
T-2-47

2-78
2
2
2-79

Fixing System 1. Saving energy


Fast warm-up reduces standby electric power thanks to low heat capacity.

Overview 2. High speed


51ppm is enabled by introducing a new toner and the film capable of high heat transfer.
■■Features
This machine introduces the on-demand fixing method. 3. Supported media
Feeding 52g/m2 paper is available due to the modification of film path and Separation
Separation guide Fixing delivery roller
Guide, and image quality has been improved as well.

Fixing film

Inner delivery
roller

Fixing heater

Pressure roller
Fixing inlet guide
F-2-114

2-79
2
2
2-80
■■Specifications ■■Major parts configuration
Item Function/method
Fixing method On-demand fixing
Fixing speed 51 / 45ppm 246 mm/s (1/1-speed, plain paper) Pressure roller
machine 123 mm/s (1/2-speed, thick paper)
82 mm/s (1/3-speed, coated paper, transparency)
35 / 30ppm 160 mm/s (1/1-speed, plain paper)
machine 80 mm/s (1/2-speed, thick paper, coated paper, transparency)
Heater Ceramic heater
Individual drive of Main Heater (heat-generation distribution:
high in center) / Sub Heater (heat-generation distribution: high in
edges).
Purpose: to control temperature rise at the edge
Control temperature Target temperature at printing (plain paper 1 (64 to 81 g/m2))
51 / 45 ppm machine: 169~180 deg C Film unit
35 / 30 ppm machine: 150~163 deg C
Temperature By the main thermistors (2pc) and the sub thermistors (2pc) F-2-115
detection
Protection feature Thermistors Main
To block power supply to the fixing heater when a failure is thermistor 1
detected (TH1)
Temperature fuse Shutter HP sensor Fixing heater
Fixing heater (H1)
Rated operation temperature: 228 +0/-6 deg C (PS31) (H1)
T-2-48
Main
thermistor 2
(TH1)

Fixing pressure
sensor (PS30)
Inner delivery
sensor (PS37)

Sub thermistor 2
(TH1)
Shutter position sensor
(PS32)
Temperature fuse
(TP1)
Main thermistor 2
(TH1)
Main thermistor 1
(TH1)
Sub thermistor 1
(TH1)
F-2-116

2-80
2
2
2-81

Shutter
Fixing cooling fan (front)
(FM5)

M27
Shutter motor

Shutter position sensor(PS32)

Shutter HP sensor
(PS31)

Fixing cooling fan (rear)


(FM6)
F-2-117

Parts name Function / method


--- Film unit Applying heat and pressure makes the toner image on paper fixed
--- Pressure roller (fused).
H1 Fixing heater Ceramic heater
TH1 Main thermistor 1 To be in contact with the heater
Temperature control, detection of abnormal temperature rise
Main thermistor 2 To be in contact with the film
Temperature control, detection of abnormal temperature rise
Sub thermistor 1 To be in contact with the heater (non-feeding area)
Temperature control, detection of abnormal temperature rise,
temperature detection / cooling control on the edge
Sub thermistor 2 To be in contact with the heater (non-feeding area)
Temperature control, detection of abnormal temperature rise,
temperature detection / cooling control on the edge
TP1 Temperature fuse Noncontact type with the heater
To block AC electric power supply when a failure is detected.
PS30 Fixing pressure sensor Detection of engagement / disengagement of the film unit
PS31 Shutter HP sensor Detection of shutter’s home position
PS32 Shutter position sensor Detection of shutter’s position
PS37 Internal delivery sensor Jam detection
T-2-49

2-81
2
2
2-82
Controls ■■Standby temperature control
■■Fixing temperature control: overview Fixing
temperature
Fixing STBY INTR PRNT
temperature
STBY INTR PRNT Flaying start
control
Flying start Startup During-print Sheet-t temperature
control (warm-up control o-sheet
temperature rotation) temperature control
control temperature
temperature

15 sec Time

Time Command for


flying start
Command for Command for
F-2-119
flying start print start
F-2-118 ●● Flying start temperature control
Purpose:
●● Standby temperature control
to reduce print time (FPOT) of the 1st sheet
To preheat the fixing assembly to reduce time for starting print
• Flying start temperature control Starting conditions:
• When pressing the numeric key on the control panel
●● Print temperature control • When pressing the button / key on the touch panel
To increase temperature to meet the fixing target temperature and keep the target • When opening / closing the cassette
temperature during printing • At recovery from sleep mode to standby mode
• Startup (warm-up rotation) temperature control Control description:
• Print temperature control Temperature rises to a certain point (150 degrees Centigrade: Main Thermistor 2).
• Sheet-to-sheet temperature control This operation takes for 15 seconds after the last operation.

●● Down sequence control


To prevent fixing failure due to rising temperature at the edge or fall in temperature.
This control causes reduced through-put.
• Down sequence when feeding small size paper
• Down sequence when switching paper size
2-82
2
2
2-83

Related Service Mode


■■Print temperature control
(Lv.2) COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX> FLYING
(To enable/disable Flying start (pre-mature start) Fixing
temperature
<Setting value> STBY INTR PRNT
0: Enable Flying start [default]
1: Disable Flying start Startup During print Sheet-to
(warm-up control -sheet
rotation) temperature control
control temperature
temperature

Time

Command for Command for


Flying start print start
F-2-120

• Startup (warm-up rotation) temperature control


To increase fixing temperature to be ready for printing once the print-start command is
received.

• Print temperature control


To set optimal target temperature to prevent fixing failure or offset, and keep the
specified target temperature during printing
A. Setting target temperature → see the table on the next page
Target temperature is specified depending on the paper type, environment
(temperature), fixing speed, elapsed time since the last control of fixing temperature
and fixing temperature at the start of warm-up control.
B. Temperature control during printing
Temperature is controlled according to the detection result of main thermistors 1 and 2.

2-83
2
2
2-84
• Sheet-to-sheet distance temperature control Target temperature during printing
If the distance between sheets is longer than usual*1, temperature between sheets is Print speed (ppm)
Target
reduced to prevent temperature rise. Paper type Paper length in width direction
Model Speed temperature
Temperature between sheets = target temperature during printing – (30 to 50 deg C)*2 () : paper weight g / m2 216.1 431.9 457.3
(deg C) ~216.0
~431.8 ~457.2 ~630.0
*1:At down sequence 51 / 45 Plain 1(64~81) / Color 1 / 1-speed 169~180 51 25.5 20 16
st nd ppm (64~81) / Recycled (64~81) / 246 mm /
Between the 1 side and the 2 side when making 2-sided print machine Pre-Punched / Tracing paper sec.
When controls are executed (ATR control, registration control, ATVC control) / Japanese paper (93)
*2:To be determined according to the elapsed time since the last control of fixing temperature Thin (52~63) 148~164 51 25.5 20 16
(including standby control) and fixing temperature at the start of warm-up control Plain 2 (82~105) / Bond 181~197 51 25.5 20 16
(80~90) Except Japan
Plain 2 (82~105) / Bond 181~197 40 20 17 14
(80~90) Japan
Heavy 1 (106~163) / Label 1 / 2-speed 162~179 25.5 12.5 10 8
(151~180) 123 mm /
Heavy 2 (164~209) / sec. 166~179 20 10 8 7.5
Embossed(150) / Postcard, 4
on 1 postcard(190) / Tab
Envelope 149 20 10 8 7.5
Coated 1(106~163) 1 / 3-speed 165 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
Heavy 3(210~256) 82 mm / 160 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
Coated 2 (164~209) sec. 170~172 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
Transparency (151~180) 159 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
35 / 30 Plain 1(64~81) / Color 1 / 1-speed 150~163 35 17.5 15 12
ppm (64~81) / Recycled (64~81) / 160 mm /
machine Pre-Punched / Tracing paper sec.
/ Japanese paper (93)
Thin (52~63) 135~153 35 17.5 15 12
Plain 2 (82~105) / Bond 165~185 35 17.5 15 12
(80~90) Except Japan
Coated 1(106~163) 1 / 2-speed 165 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
Heavy 3(210~256) 80 mm / 160~172 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
Heavy 1 (106~163) / Label sec. 150~167 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
(151~180)
Heavy 2 (164~209) / 155~170 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
Embossed(150) / Postcard, 4
on 1 postcard(190) / Tab
Coated 2 (164~209) 170 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
Transparency (151~180) 159 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
Envelope 149 17 8.5 7.5 5.5
T-2-50

2-84
2
2
2-85

Related Service Mode


■■Down sequence control
• Display of thermistor detection temperature • Down sequence when feeding small size paper
(Lv.1) COPIER > DISPLAY > ANALOG
> FIX-C (detected temperature of main thermistor 2)
Purpose:
> FIX-E (detected temperature of main thermistor 1) To prevent temperature rise of non-feeding area in the case of continuous print
> FIX-E2 (detected temperature of sub thermistor 1) of small size paper (less than A4R of length in width direction), fixing offset or
> FIX-E3 (detected temperature of sub thermistor 2)
deterioration of fixing film.
• Offset of fixing control temperature Starting conditions:
(Lv.1) COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX
> TEMP-TBL (plain paper 1) When the detected temperature of sub thermistor 1 or 2 reaches the specified
> TMP-TBL2 (thick paper 1) temperature or higher (250 to 260 deg C) during printing
> TMP-TBL3 (thick paper 2)
> TMP-TBL4 (thick paper 3) Operation:
> TMP-TBL5 (thin paper) Temperature is reduced by making wider sheet-to-sheet distance to control the
> TMP-TBL6 (envelope)
temperature at slightly lower than the target temperature for normal print.
> TMP-TBL7 (plain paper 2)
> TMP-TBL8 (transparency) Target Print
> TMP-TBL9 (coated paper 1)
Model Paper type () : paper weight g / m2 temperature speed
> TMP-TB10 (coated paper 2)
(deg C) (ppm)
<Setting value> 51 / 45 Plain 1(64~81) / Color (64~81) / Recycled (64~81) / Pre-Punched / 165~180 12~4
ppm Tracing paper / Japanese paper (93)
-2: -10 deg C machine Thin (52~63) 144~164
-1: -5 deg C Plain 2 (82~105) / Bond (80~90) Except Japan 175~192
0: 0 deg C [default] Plain 2 (82~105) / Bond (80~90) Japan 175~192
+1: +5 deg C Heavy 1 (106~163) / Label (151~180) 158~179 9~3
+2: +10 deg C Heavy 2 (164~209) / Embossed(150) / Postcard, 4 on 1 162~179
postcard(190) / Tab (160~203)
Envelope 145~149
Coated 1(106~163) 176~180 6~2
Heavy 3(210~256) 163~179
Coated 2 (164~209) 181~185
Transparency (151~180) 155~159
35 / 30 Plain 1(64~81) / Color (64~81) / Recycled (64~81) / Pre-Punched / 146~163 12~4
ppm Tracing paper / Japanese paper (93)
machine Thin (52~63) 131~153
Plain 2 (82~105) / Bond (80~90) 161~185
Coated 1(106~163) 176~180 6~2
Heavy 3(210~256) 163~179
Heavy 1 (106~163) / Label (151~180) 146~167
Heavy 2 (164~209) / Embossed(150) / Postcard, 4 on 1 151-170
postcard(190) / Tab (160~203)
Coated 2 (164~209) 181~185
Transparency (151~180) 155~159
Envelope 145~149
T-2-51

2-85
2
2
2-86
Starting conditions:
Related Service Mode
If the detected temperature of sub thermistor 1 or 2 exceeds the specified temperature
• Setting for down sequence start temperature when feeding small size paper
(Lv.1) COPIER > OPTION > IMG-SPD > FX-D-TMP (250~260 deg C) when switching to the paper which has longer width than the
preceding paper.
<Setting value>
Operation:
-3: -15 deg C Pickup of the succeeding paper and power distribution to the heater are stopped as
-2: -10 deg C
well.
-1: -5 deg C
0: 0 deg C [Default] Completion conditions:
+1: +5 deg C This down sequence is completed if any of the following conditions is satisfied:
+2: +10 deg C • When the detected temperature of sub thermistor 1 or 2 reaches the specified
+3: +15 deg C temperature or less.
• When the specified period of time*1 has passed since the preceding paper went
through the fixing nip.

*1: Specified period of time differs whether the fan has cooled the preceding paper or not.
• Down sequence when switching paper size • If the preceding paper is A4R or larger and A3 or smaller (the fan has cooled the
Purpose: paper)
This down sequence prevents temperature rise of non-feeding area: there can be → 15 seconds
possible fixing offset or wrinkle of the succeeding paper due to increased temperature • If the preceding paper is smaller than A4R (the fan has not cooled the paper)
of non-feeding area of the preceding paper when continuously making prints or → 30 seconds
feeding wider length of paper than the preceding paper.

Non-feeding area
Film

A4R A4

Non-feeding area
F-2-121

2-86
2
2
2-87
■■Fixing film edge cooling control ■■Detection of fixing assembly
Temperature at the edge of the film is increased when continuously making prints. Excessive The thermistor connection signal, which is input to the DC controller, detects presence of
temperature rise can deteriorate the film. When small size paper (A4R or shorter size in width fixing assembly at warm-up rotation (when the power is turned ON, the cover is open).
direction) is printed, the mode changes to the down sequence. An error code “E004-0000” is displayed to stop the operation if no fixing assembly is detected.
When making prints with paper that is A4R or longer and A3 or shorter in width direction while Signal Detection result
the film temperature exceeds the specified temperature (sub thermistor 1,2), the fan attached Thermistor connection signal (THRM_CNNT) High: No fixing assembly is found.
near the fixing assembly sends air and cools the film to control temperature rise. Unlike down Low: There is a fixing assembly.
T-2-52
sequence, this control will not reduce the through-put because this control is executed while
printing is continued.

Shutter
Fixing cooling fan (front)
(FM5)

M27
Shutter motor

Shutter position sensor (PS32)

Shutter HP sensor
(PS31)
Fixing cooling fan (rear)
(FM6)

Direction of movement
Shutter HP sensor Shutter Shutter position sensor
(PS31) (PS32)

M27
Shutter motor

A4-RLTR-R B4 EXE 8K LTRA4

F-2-122

There is a shutter at the air vent, which moves (opens) in 7 levels according to the size of
feeding paper. This feature enables to send air to optimal area on the film.

2-87
2
2
2-88
■■Film unit engagement / disengagement control ■■Protection features
To prevent deformation of the fixing film / pressure roller caused by heat and pressure when Error
Code Description
the drive of pressure roller is stopped, and also to improve jam recovering performance, the Clear
E001 Detection of abnormal high temperature
film unit is disengaged from the pressure roller under the following conditions:
0000 When main thermistor 1/2 detects 255 deg C or more for 0.2 sec. Clear
0001 When sub thermistor 1/2 detects 275 deg C or more for 0.2 sec Clear
Fixing pressure sensor (PS30) Fixing pressure sensor (PS30)
0003 When the thermistor detects temperature beyond the upper value: Clear
Sensor flag Cam Main thermistor 2 = 265 deg C
Fixing Motor Fixing Motor Main thermistor 1 = 264 deg C
M21 M21 Sub thermistor 1 = 280 deg C
Sub thermistor 2 = 280 deg C
Cam E003 Detection of low temperature
Sensor flag
0000 When main thermistor 1/sub thermistor 1/sub thermistor2 detects 21 Clear
Film unit Film unit to 50 deg C for 3 sec.
0001 When main thermistor 1 detects “(target temperature – 70 deg C)” or Clear
less for 5 sec.
0002 When the thermistor detects disconnection (any thermistor detects 20 Clear
Pressure Pressure deg C or less for 3 sec)
plate plate
0003 When the control fails to be completed 60 sec after the start of warm- Clear
Pressure roller Pressure roller up rotation.
Engaged Disengaged E004 Detection of abnormal fixing heater drive circuit
0000 When disconnection of the thermistor is detected. Unnecessary
F-2-123 E808 Detection of abnormal fixing drive circuit/power supply
Execution conditions / timing Execution conditions / timing 0000 Zero-cross error (faulty low voltage circuit) Unnecessary
• The film unit is disengaged when the power is • When the power is turned OFF T-2-53
turned ON • At jam detection when the power is turned ON
• At recovery from sleep mode • When the mode is shifted to sleep mode (when
• At recovery from jam removal the power switch on the control panel is OFF,
• When the front cover/right cover is closed. when the specified period of time has passed
since the mode has shifted to sleep mode)
• When a jam occurs
• When an error occurs

Related Error Codes


E009 (Error in engagement/disengagement of film unit)
• 0000 Error in engagement
• 0001 Error in disengagement

2-88
2
2
2-89
Service work ■■List of periodical service works
Parts Estimated
■■Periodically replaced parts Parts name
number
Qty
life (print)
Remarks

No parts are assigned to be replaced periodically. 1 Fixing Separation Cuide FC8-4906 1 300,000 Replace the Film Unit at the same time
2 Shutter Cover XG9-0172 1 300,000 Replace the Film Unit at the same time
T-2-55
■■Consumable parts
■■When replacing parts
Parts Estimated life Counter
Parts name Qty Adjustment Remarks
number (print) (DRBL-2) ●● Film unit, pressure roller
1
1 Film unit FM3-5949 1 300,000 FX-UP-FR N.A. * 100V Check that the fixing nip width is within the specified range.
FM3-5950 120V
FM3-5951 230V
2 Pressure roller FC8-4906 1 300,000 FX-LW-RL N.A. *1
3 Fixing bearing XG9-0172 2 300,000 FX-LW-BR N.A. Paper to be used: A4 / LTR size (plain paper, 80 to 105 g/m2)
*1: Be sure to check if nip width is appropriate after replacement. T-2-54

1) Set paper on the manual feed pickup tray.


Bearing
2) Execute output of fixing nip paper in Service Mode:
(Lv.1) COPIER > FUNCTION > FIXING > NIP-CHK
Paper is picked up to make 2-sided print.
1st side: solid image in Magenta, 2nd side: no image (blank)
Pressure Roller The paper is stopped at the nip area when fixing is performed on the 2nd side, and then
delivered outside the machine approx. 15 sec later.
3) Measure the nip width and check that the measured value is within the specified range.

Bearing

Film Unit (100V)


(120V)
(230V)

F-2-124

2-89
2
2
2-90
Specified value (range):
Center: 9.0 -/+ 1.0mm
Edge (145mm from the center of feeding paper): 9.0 -/+ 1.0mm

Edge

145 mm

Center

Feeding direction 145 mm

Edge

F-2-125
If measured value is out of the specified range, reinstall the replaced parts (film unit or
pressure roller) and then measure the nip width again.

MEMO:
Fixing nip width cannot be adjusted in the field

2-90
2
2
2-91

Pickup Feed System ■■Specification


Item Description
Paper storage method Front loading method
Overview Pickup method Cassette 1, 2 Separation retard method
Multi-purpose tray Simple retard method
■■Features Paper stack capacity Cassette 1, 2 550 sheets (80g / m2 paper), 650 sheets (64g / m2 paper)
Multi-purpose tray 100 sheets (80g / m2 paper, 100 sheets (64g / m2 paper)
• Improvement of productivity (33 sheets / min → 51 sheets / min)
Paper feed reference Center reference
The number of circulation sheets is changed to 5 in 1 set at 2-sided feeding. As a
Paper size Cassette 1 Standard (universal) B4, A4, B5, LGL, LTR, EXE, A4R,
result, although the motor speed is slowed down reducing the motor loads and noise, B5R, LTRR, A5R, STMTR, 8K, 16K, 16KR,
productivity is improved. Cassette 2 Standard (universal) A3, B4, A4, B5, LDR, LGL, LTR,
• Increase of supported paper size and types for printing A4R, B5R, LTRR, EXE, A5R, STMTR, 12” x 18”, 8K,
16K, 16KR,
The curve of feed path is made gentler and the curl occurrence is reduced by Envelope (when an option is installed.)
changing the fixing temperature depending on the paper grammage. As a result, it is Multi-purpose tray A3, B4, A4, B5, LDR, LGL, LTR, A4R, B5R, LTRR, EXE,
realized to feed the paper with 52g / m2 to 256g / m2. A5R, STMTR, 12”x18”, SRA3, 8K, 16K, 16KR, postcard,
envelope, non-standard size (99mm x 140mm to 320mm
• Auto paper size identification in cassette
x 457.2mm)
By using the 2 size switches and the guide plate, auto size identification is realized. Paper grammage Cassette 1, 2 52 to 209g / m2
Users do not have to configure the size setting. Multi-purpose tray 52 to 256g / m2, For 210g / m2 or more, multi-purpose
• Increase of Multi-Purpose Tray pickup capacity (50 sheets → 100 sheets) tray 1-sided only.
Paper size switch Cassette 1, 2 Size auto detection
Simple retard method is applied for the pickup method. The tray is lifted up and down
Multi-purpose tray Input from the operation panel by uses
at paper pickup, so stack capacity of the tray is increased from 50 sheets to 100
2-sided print method Through path method
sheets. Paper level display Yes (displayed in 3 levels on LCD panel)
OHP detection Yes
Lead edge margin 4.0mm –1 ~ + 1.5mm
Right edge margin 2.5mm –1.5 ~ +1.5mm
T-2-56

2-91
2
2
2-92
■■Parts Configuration [1] Reverse Roller [13] Cassette 1 Separation Roller
[2] Second Delivery Roller [14] Cassette 1 Feed Roller
●● Roller Layout Drawing [3] Third Delivery Roller [15] Cassette 1 Pickup Roller
[4] Duplex Inlet Roller [16] Vertical Path Roller 1
[1] [2]
[5] Duplex Feed Upper Roller [17] Registration Roller
[6] Duplex Feed Lower Roller [18] Secondary Transfer Roller
[7] Multi-Purpose Tray Pickup / Feed Roller [19] Pressure roller
[8] Multi-Purpose Tray Separation Roller [20] Post-Fixing Roller
[3]
[9] Vertical Path Roller 2 [21] Fixing Inner Delivery Roller
[10] Cassette 2 Feed Roller [22] First Delivery Roller
[11] Cassette 2 Separation Roller [23] Second / Third Delivery Inlet Roller
[23]
[12] Cassette 2 Pickup Roller
[22] [4]

[21]

[20] [5]

[19]

[18]

[17]
[6]

[7]
[16] [8]

[15]

[9]

[10]
[11]

[14] [13] [12]


F-2-126

2-92
2
2
2-93
●● Sensor / Switch Layout Drawing PS33 Registration sensor PS49 Cassette 1 Paper Presence Sensor
PS34 Fixing Inlet Sensor PS50 Cassette 2 Paper Presence Sensor
[PS39]
PS35 Fixing Loop Sensor 1 PS51 Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor A
PS36 Fixing Loop Sensor 2 PS52 Cassette 1 Paper Level Sensor B
[PS45] PS37 Inner Delivery Sensor PS53 Cassette 2 Paper Level Sensor A
PS38 Duplex Paper Sensor PS54 Cassette 2 Paper Level Sensor B
PS39 Reverse Sensor PS55 Cassette 1 Pre-Registration Sensor
[PS42] [PS43]
[PS40] PS40 Duplex Inlet Sensor PS56 Cassette 2 Pre-Registration Sensor
PS41 First Delivery Sensor UN51 OHP Sensor
[PS44] PS42 Second Delivery Sensor UN53 Vertical Path Sensor
[PS41] PS43 Third Delivery Sensor SW6 Cassette 1 Size Switch A
PS44 First Delivery Tray Full Sensor SW7 Cassette 1 Size Switch B
[PS37]
PS45 Second Delivery Tray Full Sensor SW8 Cassette 2 Size Switch A
PS47 Multi-Purpose Tray Paper Presence Sensor SW9 Cassette 2 Size Switch B

[PS34][PS35] [PS36]
[UN52]
[PS38]
[PS47]
[PS33]
[UN51]
[UN53]

[PS49] [PS55]
[SW7] [PS52] [PS51]
[SW6]

[PS50] [PS56]
[SW9] [PS54][PS53]
[SW8]

F-2-127

2-93
2
2
2-94
●● Load Driving Drawing ■■Paper Path
M24 SL6 SL7 R40
Reverse mouth
M25 Third delivery

Second delivery

First delivery
M23
Meandering
SL5
is reduced
M22

M20

Multi-purpose
M21 tray pickup

R40

M19 CL1 M18

SL4 Side deck


Cassette 1 pickup pickup

SL2 M16
Cassette 2 pickup

SL3 M17 Option Cassette pickup


F-2-129
F-2-128

M16 Cassette 1 Pickup Motor M24 Reverse Roller Motor To support the heavy paper feeding, the feed path at Duplex Feed Assembly is made a gentle
M17 Cassette 1 Pickup Motor M25 Third Delivery Motor curve and damage on the paper is reduced.
M18 Multi-Purpose Tray Motor SL2 Cassette 1 Pickup Solenoid
M19 Registration Motor SL3 Cassette 2 Pickup Solenoid
M20 2-Sided Feed Motor SL5 First Delivery Flapper Solenoid
M21 Fixing Motor SL6 Second Delivery Flapper Solenoid
M22 Fixing Delivery Motor SL7 Third Delivery Flapper Solenoid
M23 First / Second Delivery Motor CL1 Multi-Purpose Pickup Clutch

2-94
2
2
2-95
■■Interval Speed Up
Reverse sensor [PS39]

246mm/sec
(C5051,C5045) 400mm/sec
(C5035,C5030) 300mm/sec
(C5051,C5045) 340mm/sec
(C5035,C5030) 300mm/sec

Delivery speed up position

Inner delivery sensor [PS37]

Duplex paper
sensor [PS38]

Duplex re-pickup position

Registration position

Pre-registration sensor [PS33]


Vertical path sensor [UN53] Pre-registration position

Cassette 2 pre-registration
Pre-registration
sensor [PS56]
position

F-2-130

2-95
2
2
2-96
Various Controls ■■Cassette Pickup Assembly
■■Overview ●● Overview
Parts Configuration

Cassette 1 Pre-registration sensor


Duplex / Delivery
Assembly Cassette 2
Cassette 1 Pre-registration sensor
paper presence sensor
Cassette 1 feed roller
Cassette 1 pickup solenoid
Cassette 1
Cassette 1 detachment roller
paper level sensor A

Cassette 2 feed roller


Cassette 1
paper level sensor B
Fixing / Registration A ssembly Cassette 2
detachment roller
Cassette 2 Pickup assembly
Cassette 2 Idler gear
paper level sensor B pickup solenoid
Multi-Purpose Pickup Cassette 2 Cassette 2
Assembly paper level sensor A paper presence sensor
F-2-132

Cassette 1 size switch B

Cassette 1 size switch A


Cassette Pickup
Assembly

F-2-131

Area Detection, Control


Cassette Pickup Assembly Paper Level / Presence Detection
Paper Size / Cassette Presence Detection
Pre-Registration Control
Multi-Purpose Pickup Assembly Paper Presence Detection
Paper Size Detection
Fixing / Registration Assembly OHP Control
Registration Control Cassette 2 size switch A
Fixing Arch Control
Duplex / Delivery Assembly Duplex Feed Control
Duplex Wait Control
JAM Detection JAM Detection Cassette 2 size switch B
T-2-57 F-2-133

2-96
2
2
2-97
●● Drive Configuration ●● Detection
Vertical path Roller1
Paper Level / Presence Detection
Pickup Roller1 There are 3 sensors to detect the paper level and paper presence in the cassette.
Feed Roller1
Paper level is displayed on the operation panel.
Detachment Roller1
Lifter
Vertical path Roller2 If the paper is full
SL2 M16 Cassette paper level sensor A
Feed Roller2
Pickup Roller2 Cassette paper level sensor B Paper
Detachment Roller2
Lifter
SL3 M17

F-2-134

M16 Cassette 1 Pickup Motor OFFOFF


M17 Cassette 2 Pickup Motor
If the paper is approx. half Cassette paper level sensor A Paper
SL2 Cassette 1 Pickup Solenoid
SL3 Cassette 2 Pickup Solenoid
Cassette paper level sensor B

OFFON
Paper
If the paper is a little Cassette paper level sensor A

Cassette paper level sensor B

ON ON Cassette paper Presence sensor


Fulg
Paper tray
If the paper is absent

F-2-135

2-97
2
2
2-98
Sensor Sensor Paper Presence Cassette size
Display Remaining Level A B Sensor switch A
100% to approx. 50% of capacity OFF OFF OFF Rear detection
Approx. 50% of capacity to rink
ON OFF OFF
approx. 50 sheets Rear guide plate
Approx. 50 sheets or less ON ON OFF
No paper - - ON
F-2-136
Paper Size Detection / Cassette Presence Detection
Paper size of the cassette can be automatically detected by adjusting the position of the
guide plate.
Concavo-convex area of the cassette dial is switched when the guide plate is shifted and two
Size Switches on a printer are switched. Length and width are detected according to the ON
/ OFF combination of switches. As long as standard paper, both AB type and inch type can Cassette size
be used. However, size should be found manually on the check screen for the combination of switch B
A5-Rand STMT-R or the combination of B5-R and EXEC. Detection dial

Side guide plate


Detection dial
Cassette 2 size switch B

F-2-137

2-98
2
2
2-99
Multi-purpose tray pickup 1 sheet feed list
Width detection Length detection
Width Length 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 Be sure to set the following paper sheet-by-sheet to the Multi-purpose Tray.
B5 257 182 0 ON ON 0 0 0 0 0 If fails to set the paper sheet-by-sheet, it may cause troubles.
EXEC 267 184 0 ON ON 0 0 0 0 0
Paper type Basis weight/name
16K 270 195 0 ON ON 0 ON 0 0 0
Glossy paper (coated paper) Overall
A5-R 148.5 210 ON 0 ON 0 ON ON 0 0
Tracing paper Overall
A4 297 210 0 ON 0 0 ON ON 0 0
Washi Overall
STMT-R 139.7 215.9 ON 0 ON 0 ON ON 0 0
Extra long paper (up to 1200mm) Pickup can be enabled at service setting. Overall
LTR 279.4 215.9 0 ON ON 0 ON ON 0 0
T-2-60
B5-R 182 257 ON 0 ON 0 0 ON ON ON
LTR-R 215.9 279.4 0 0 ON 0 ON 0 0 ON Paper that requires extra caution at setting
A4-R 210 297 0 0 ON 0 0 ON ON 0 Paper type Basis weight/name Caution
LGL 215.9 355.6 0 0 ON 0 ON ON 0 ON Envelope Overall Let out the air of envelope and disperse the glued tabs
B4 257 364 0 ON ON 0 ON ON ON 0 Since there are size variations, non-image area appears in
8K 270 390 0 ON ON 0 ON ON ON ON Washi Overall
case of full copy. Handle this by free size setting.
A3 297 420 0 ON 0 0 0 0 ON ON T-2-61
LDR 279.4 431.8 0 ON ON 0 0 0 ON ON
12x18 304.8 457.2 0 ON 0 0 0 0 0 ON ●● .Method of Setting 8K and 16K (Chinese Paper)
T-2-58 1) Set the original detection size to AB configuration.r
Also, the cassette presence is detected when the size switch is pushed. (If no switch is (Lv.1) COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > MODEL-SZ = 0
pushed, it is determined as no cassette.) 2) Enable detection and display of Chinese paper (K size paper: 8K and 16K).
(Lv.2) COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > KSIZE-SW = 1
Separation paper list 3) Change the setting of Cassette 1 from EXEC to 16K.
It is recommended to separate the following paper depending on the paper status (especially (Lv.2) COPIER > OPTION > CST > CST-K-SW = 1
moisture absorption) and paper trimming state when setting the paper. 4) (Lv.2) COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW >MODELSZ2 = 0.
This ""separation"" can avoid troubles. 5) Turn OFF and then ON the main power.

Paper type Basis weight/name etc Main area


Carbonless paper Overall -
Transparency Overall -
Labels Overall -
Tub paper Overall -
Pre-punched paper Overall -
Especially thin paper, 52 gsm JPN
OK Prince Joshitsu
etc.
Canon Europe Canon Recycled 80 EUR
Overall
(Vision Classic White)
Canon Europe Canon High Grade Especially heavy paper 220/250 EUR
(Mondi Business Paper) gsm etc.
Canon Digital Office Colour Especially heavy paper 160 gsm EUR
(Stora Enso MultiCopy Special Colour Laser) etc.
T-2-59

2-99
2
2
2-100
●● Method of Setting Special Paper ●● Pre-Registration Control
• Service mode To correct the feed variation at pickup and to perform the stabilized paper feed, pre-
COPIER > OPTION > CST > CSTX-UY > Setting number registration control is executed.
X: Cassette number, Y: Size category (X: 1 to 4, Y: 1 to 4) When the paper leading edge is detected at the Pre-Registration Sensor (at Vertical Path
Sensor on cassette 1 only) on each cassette, the machine determines whether to stop the
Size category pre-registration or not.
Pre-registration stop is determined when the following conditions are true.
Size category Size
U1 FLSC, A-FLS, OFI, E-OFI, A-LTRR, A-LGL, G-LGL, A-OFI, M-OFI, FA4, FB4 • There is preceding paper.
U2 K-LGLR, G-LTRR • The preceding paper has not reached the Registration Sensor.
U3 K-LGL, A-LTR, G-LTR • Time until the Registration Sensor of preceding paper is turned OFF > / = time until the
U4 B-OFI Registration Sensor of succeeding paper is turned ON
T-2-62

Setting No. Size ●● Cassette Heater Control


22 K-LGL
23 K-LGLR
24 FLSC
25 A-FLS
26 OFI
27 E-OFI
28 B-OFI
29 A-LTR
30 A-LTRR
31 G-LTR
32 G-LTRR
33 A-LGL
34 G-LGL
36 A-OFI
37 M-OFI
42 FA4
43 FB4
T-2-63

Example: When setting G-LTR to Cassette 2


COPIER> OPTION> CST> CST2-U3> 3

2-100
2
2
2-101
■■Multi-Purpose Tray Pickup Assembly Drive Configuration

●● Overview
Parts Configuration

Multi-purpose tray
Multi-purpose Multi-purpose
pickup clutch (CL1) size sensor (UN52)

Multi-purpose
motor (M18)

Multi-purpose
motor
M18 CL1 Multi-purpose tray
lifting solenoid
Multi-purpose SL4
pickup clutch
Multi-purpose tray
lifting solenoid (SL4) Multi-Purpose Tray
Detachment Roller

Multi-purpose pickup / feed roller

F-2-139

●● Detection
Multi-purpose Paper Presence Detection
paper sensor (PS47)
The paper presence is detected by the Multi-Purpose Tray Paper Presence Sensor.
F-2-138 When the paper absence is detected, if there is the same size & same type paper exists in
other cassette, auto cassette change is executed.

Paper Size Detection


The paper width is detected according to output value from the variable resistor that works in
conjunction with the side guide. Since the length cannot be detected, users have to specify
the setting.

2-101
2
2
2-102
■■Fixing / Registration Assembly ●● Registration Control
OHP Detection
●● Overview
As the countermeasure for when the paper other than transparency film is fed in transparency
Parts / Drive Configuration
mode, OHP sensor is used as white paper detection to identify whether the fed paper is
transparency or not. However, since this is not used to identify the transparency for CLC, jam
will occur when CLC paper is fed.

Registration motor(M19)
Registration Control
To make the paper straight-enter the transfer assembly, registration control is executed.
After the paper passes through the Registration Sensor, the drive of the Pickup Motor (Multi-
Purpose Tray Pickup Motor, Duplex Pickup Motor) is turned OFF to stop the paper by the
distance from the Registration Sensor to the Registration Roller with arch amount added.
Registration sensor Registration roller To reduce the noise when the paper enters the Registration Roller, speed is decreased by
(PS33) 200mm / sec upon Registration Sensor ON.
However, if the distance with the preceding paper is too far, productivity cannot be satisfied.
Registration sensor flug
Moreover, the paper may be late for the image. In such case only, the speed is changed by
Cassette 1 pre-registration 246mm / sec when the paper enters the Registration Roller.
sensor(PS55)

Pre-registration sensor flug ●● Fixing Arch Control


Transparency sensor(UN51) Vertical path sensor(UN53) To always feed the paper to the Fixing Unit in optimal status, this control is to monitor the
Vertical path roller paper slack (arch) condition and to switch the feed speed at the Fixing Motor according to the
status.
This is executed between the Secondary Transfer Unit and the Fixing Unit. When the
Pressure Roller of the Fixing Unit expands with heat, circumference of roller is also increased.
F-2-140
Thus, even though the number of rotation is consistent, the feed speed at the fixing side is
faster than the feed speed at the secondary transfer side. To fix this, change the speed of the
Fixing Motor according to the arch condition using the Fixing Arch Sensor 1&2.

2-102
2
2
2-103
■■Duplex / Delivery Assembly
●● Overview
Big arch detection Parts / Drive Configuration

Reverse roller M24 Second delivery roller

SL6 SL7

Third delivery roller


Fixing inlet sensor On
Fixing arch sensor 2
Fixing motor feed speed up M25

M23 Duplex inlet roller

Second & third


First delivery roller delivery Inlet roller

SL5 Duplex feed upper roller

M20

Fixing inlet sensor Duplex paper sensor


Small arch detection Fixing motor feed speed down

Duplex feed lower roller

F-2-142

M20 Duplex Feed Motor SL5 First Delivery Flapper Solenoid


M23 First / Second Delivery Motor SL6 Second Delivery Flapper Solenoid
M24 Reverse Motor SL7 Third Delivery Flapper Solenoid
M25 Third Delivery Motor
Fixing arch sensor 1

F-2-141

2-103
2
2
2-104
●● Duplex Control Duplex Wait Control
Duplex Feed Control To realize 5-sheet circulation, there are 2 duplex wait positions. Following is the duplex wait
On this machine, the paper is revered outside the machine with using the reverse mouth. position for small paper.
After that, feed operation is performed by 340mm / sec on imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5051
/ C5045 (300mm / sec on imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5035 / C5030).The paper fed to the
duplex path is transferred to the duplex re-pickup position unless there is paper on the path
at the downstream side. If there is paper on the downstream path, it is delivered from the
reverse path or it stops at the duplex upstream.
In case of output to the First / Second Delivery Mouth, 5-sheet circulation is used for small
size (LTR or smaller); however, 3-sheet circulation is used for large size (larger than A4R). Duplex inlet wait position
This is because 2 sheets of paper cannot wait on the duplex feed path.
In case of output to third delivery mouth, 3-sheet circulation is used for middle size (A4R
or smaller); however, 1-sheet circulation is used for large size (larger then A4R) since the 42.4mm
succeeding paper enters the reverse path before the preceding paper goes through the
reverse path and jam will occur.
Following is the each duplex reverse position and the number of sheet circulation by size.
First / Second Delivery Third Delivery
Small size (LTR or smaller) 5 3
Middle size (A4R or smaller) 3 3
Large size (larger than A4R) 3 1
T-2-64

Compared to the conventional model (imageRUNNER C3380), feed speed at the duplex feed
50mm
assembly is slowed down. This is to get the precise feed, to reduce the noise and the motor
loads. However, by changing the circulation algorism, the speed is accelerated when printing
Duplex wait position
a number of sheets and 51 sheets / min speed is achieved. 両面入口待機位置

F-2-143
Since the curve of duplex path shape gets steeper at the leading end, as duplex wait position
gets closer to the registration, curl tends to occur frequently. For the paper smaller than A3,
the duplex wait position is 50mm away from the Registration Sensor toward upstream in due
consideration with the productivity. In case of A3 paper or larger, the sheet interval is wide
enough to satisfy the productivity, so the position which avoids curl occurrence and is 85mm
away from the Registration Sensor on the upstream side is to be the duplex wait position.

2-104
2
2
2-105
■■JAM Detection
At the cassette pickup assembly, since the feed speed is increased, detection cannot catch
up with it. Thus, delay and stationary jam detection are not executed at the Cassette 1 Pre-
Registration Sensor. Instead of it, the Vertical Path Sensor executes the delay and stationary
jam detection. Since the residual jam should be detected on each cassette, the Cassette 1
Pre-Registration Sensor detects it. Because the Vertical Path Sensor is too close and it is
unnecessary to execute detection, the Vertical Path Sensor does not execute residual jam
detection.
Sensor XX
02: Stationary 03: Residual
01: Delay jam
Jam jam jam
code Name Code C5051 C5035 C5051 C5035 C5051 C5035
/ / / / / /
C5045 C5030 C5045 C5030 C5045 C5030
XX01 Cassette 1 pre-registration sensor PS55 N N N N Y Y
XX02 Cassette 2 pre-registration sensor PS56 Y Y Y Y Y Y
XX13 Vertical path sensor UN53 Y Y Y Y N N
XX05 Registration sensor PS33 Y Y Y Y Y Y
XX06 Fixing inlet sensor PS34 Y Y Y Y Y Y
85mm XX07 Inner delivery sensor PS37 Y Y Y Y Y Y
Duplex wait position
XX08 First delivery sensor PS41 Y Y Y Y Y Y
F-2-144
XX09 Second delivery sensor PS42 Y Y Y Y Y Y
XX0A Reverse sensor PS39 Y Y Y Y Y Y
XX0B Third delivery sensor PS43 Y Y Y Y Y Y
XX0C Duplex inlet sensor PS40 Y Y Y Y Y Y
XX0D Duplex paper sensor PS38 Y Y Y Y Y Y
T-2-65

Y: Detected
N: Not detected

2-105
2
2
2-106
Service Works
■■Periodically replacement parts
N/A

■■Consumables
Parts Number of used Replacement
No. Parts Name Remarks
Number part timing
1 Cassette Feed Roller FC6-7083 2 120K -
2 Cassette Detachment Roller FC6-6661 2 120K -
3 Multi-Purpose Feed Roller FB1-8581 1 120K -
4 Multi-Purpose Tray Detachment DC6-6661 1 120K -
Roller
5 Pickup Assembly Idler Gear FU3-0280 2 120K For
Chinese
model only
T-2-66

■■Periodical service
Execution
No. Parts Name Work Remarks
timing
1 Registration roller 50k Cleaning -
2 Pre-registration guide 50k Cleaning -
3 Transparency sensor 50k Cleaning -
4 Fixing delivery guide 50k Cleaning -
5 Post-fixing roller 50k Cleaning -
6 Fixing delivery roller 50k Cleaning -
7 First delivery roller 50k Cleaning -
8 Second delivery roller 50k Cleaning -
9 Third delivery roller 50k Cleaning -
10 Duplex feed upper roller 50k Inspection -
11 Duplex feed lower roller 50k Inspection -
12 Vertical path sensor 150k Cleaning
13 Lightproof sheet 150k Cleaning
T-2-67

2-106
2
2
2-107

External Auxiliary System ■■Fan


●● Overview
Various Controls Fan Layout

■■Software Counter Controller fan 3(FM13)


HDD cooling fan(FM14)
Count-up timing differs depending on the following conditions.
• Print mode (1-sided / 2nd side of 2-sided, 1st side of 2-sided) Controller fan 1(FM11)
• Delivery position (built-in tray, finisher) Controller fan 2(FM12) Fixing heat exhaust fan 2(FM2)
Print mode
Fixing heat exhaust fan 1(FM1)
Delivery position 1-side / 2nd side of 1-sided 1st side of 2-sided
Count-up timing
1 Host machine First delivery tray First Delivery Sensor (PS41) Duplex Paper Sensor
Second delivery tray Second Delivery Sensor (PS42) (PS38) Delivery fan 1 (FM7)
Power supply cooling fan(FM3) Delivery fan 2(FM9)
Third delivery tray Third Delivery Sensor (PS43)
2 In case finisher is installed. Finisher Delivery Sensor
T-2-68

Fixing cooling
fan (rear)(FM6)
Secondary transfer
exhaust fan(FM8)
Fixing cooling fan (front)(FM5)
Process cartridge fan (rear)(FM4)

Process cartridge fan (front)(FM10)

F-2-145

2-107
2
2
2-108
Air Flow
No. Name Function Error code
FM1 Fixing Exhaust Fan 1 Heat exhaustion around Fixing Assembly E805-0000 Air flow around the Main Controller and the Power Supply
FM2 Fixing Exhaust Fan 2 Heat exhaustion around Fixing Assembly E805-0001
FM3 Power Cooling Fan Cooling down of Power Supply Assembly E804
FM4 Process Cartridge Fan (rear) Heat exhaustion around Process Cartridge E807-0000
FM5 Fixing Cooling Fan (front) Cooling down of Fixing Assembly
FM6 Fixing Cooling Fan (rear) Cooling down of Fixing Assembly
FM7 Delivery Fan 1 Preventing delivery paper adhesion E806-0000
FM8 Secondary Transfer Delivery Fan Heat exhaustion around Secondary Transfer E806-0002
Unit
FM9 Delivery Fan 2 Preventing delivery paper adhesion E806-0001
FM10 Process Cartridge Fan (front) Heat exhaustion around Process Cartridge E807-0001
FM11 Controller Fan 1 Cooling down of Controller
FM12 Controller Fan 2 Cooling down of Controller
FM13 Controller Fan 3 Cooling down of Controller
FM14 HDD Cooling Fan Cooling down of HDD
T-2-69

Toner Filter is installed at the Ventilation Hole of the Process Cartridge Fan (rear) (FM4).

F-2-146

2-108
2
2
2-109
Air flow of fixing system Air flow around the operation system

F-2-147 F-2-148

2-109
2
2
2-110
2-speed control ■■Power Supply Control
Among the fans installed in this machine, the Power Cooling Fan (FM3) and the Delivery Fan
1 (FM7) perform the 2-speed control. Rotation speed is switched when the Voltage switching ●● Power supply inside the printer
PCB of Fan switches the voltage. 3VR

All-night 3VR Main


Main switch controller
Operation Sequence power PCB
PCB 1
Fixing heater
Fan name Pre Initial Stand Copy/pint Post Jam Reader Low Sleep 3VR 3VR
rotation rotation by 1- 2- rotation error power TP AC 12VA2 Main
Process Cartridge Fan sided sided interlock 12VA1 controller
switch 12V 12VB1 PCB 2
(front)
power 12VB1 DC controller PCB
Process Cartridge Fan supply
(rear) PCB 24VA Laser
5VB driver
Fixing Exhaust Fan 1 24V Front Right PCB
Right switch switch 24VA
switch power
AC driver PCB supply Relay PCB 24VA
Fixing Exhaust Fan 2 PCB 2
12VC 12VB1
5VA
3VA
Fixing Cooling Fan (front)
HVT 1 PCB
24VC HVT 2 PCB
24V
Fixing Cooling Fan (rear) power HVT 3 PCB
Leakage breaker supply
PCB 1 24VB1 Drum driver
Secondary Transfer PCB
Exhaust Fan 24VB2 Cassette feed

Deck heater
Cassette pedestal heater
Cassette heater
Drum heater
Reader heater
Delivery Fan 1 driver PCB
24VB3 Pickup feed
Delivery Fan 2 driver PCB

24V2 12VB2 24V1 12VA3


Power Cooling fan
Reader
Controller Fan 1 Option Controller Control
Controller Control PCB panel
Controller Fan 2
Controller Control
Controller Fan 3 F-2-150
Controller Control
HDD Cooling Fan
Controller Control

: Full speed : Half speed


F-2-149

2-110
2
2
2-111
●● Power supply of Reader Unit ●● Power connection with each option
24V Reader / ADFUnit
Motor
24V
Fan
5V
Sensor
24V 24V
Staple Finisher・C1
Reader 6V CMOS PCB 24V LED Lamp
Printer Controller 4.5V (Reader) Unit
PCB
12V 24V
6V CMOS PCB 24V LED Lamp
4.5V (DADF) Unit
Paper Deck Unit・B1
Built-in wiring
24V
5V DADF driver PCB

F-2-151

Cassette Feeding Unit・AD1


F-2-152
Connector inside the cover is used for the connection with DADF Unit and the 2-Cassette
Pedestal. External Cable is used for the connection with the Side Paper Deck and the
Finisher.

2-111
2
2
2-112
●● Power save function

Standby

* When option setting


is specified.

Control panel
Switch of control panel switch is
is turned off turned on. Sleep Standby
or or
5 min is elapsed. Sleep1
Backlight is
turned off.
Job end

Job submission

Deep Sleep

F-2-153
* When options are installed, the machine does not enter Sleep Standby but enters Sleep1
mode.

Standby
In this mode, the machine is either operating or ready to start operation immediately and all
power is supplied.

Sleep Standby or Sleep1


Control panel is turned OFF.
Power supply other than the control panel is the same with Standby mode.

Deep Sleep
3V for all-night power PCB is only supplied.
• Print job is submitted : The machine moves to Sleep Standby or Sleep1 mode.
• Control panel power switch is pressed : The machine moves to Standby mode..

2-112
2
2
2-113
Service Operations
■■When Replacing Parts
N/A

■■Consumables
No. Parts Name Parts number Qty Execution timing Remark
100k(B / W)
1 Toner filter FC6-9817 1
25k(CL)
T-2-70

■■Points to note at servicing


N/A

2-113
2
2
2-114

MEAP ■■Addition of Functions


●● 3 functions
Changes For the built-in applications in iR-ADV models, 3 functions (services) were added.
These functions support the platform which was reinforced in terms of management. In detail,
■■Overview information which the MEAP applications manage respectively (setting information, user
Functions and specifications which were added in Ver.50.xx or later firmware are introduced setting information, a bunch of keys, and log) can be managed effectively and collectively.
here. These 3 functions are shown below.

1) MEAP User Preference Service (MEAP Spec Ver 56)


■■SSL Always Enabled
Management service of customized information for each user which MEAP application
Although SSL setting of the device is disabled, SSL is always enabled when accessing to retains
SMS.
Due to this specification change, URL for accessing to SMS was changed as follows. 2) MEAP Application Configuration Service (MEAP Spec Ver 57)
Old URL http://< Device IP Address>:8000/sms/ Management service of the application’s setting information
New URL https://< Device IP Address>:8443/sms/
When accessing to the old URL, the new URL is redirected. 3) MEAP Application Log Service (MEAP Spec Ver 58)
Service to collect the application log (debug log and authentication log)
■■Message Display by USB Driver Setting Change
Note:
By starting, stopping and uninstalling the MEAP application, driver settings of the USB device • Registration method of application data to each service and its usage method are
may be changed. Due to this setting change, when the device needs to be restarted, a disclosed in MEAP SDK V.4.3.
message prompting to restart is displayed. However, as for the authentication log only, they are disclosed in MEAP Login SDK V.3.1.

Management service of the application data which was stored in each service is provided.
• iW EMC Plug-in(DAM Plug-in)、 RUI、 SMS

F-2-154

2-114
2
2
2-115
■■Differences in MEAP Application Data Management when Using ■■Addition of SMS Functions
New Functions Due to the foregoing additional 3 functions, functions for MEAP application were added to
SMS.
By using the 3 functions which were newly added, MEAP applications can be managed
collectively as follows. (Only for MEAP applications which support new functions)
●● Management of the MEAP application’s setting information
MEAP application’s setting information management function which the application data can
Devices and MEAP applications which do not support new functions
be deleted was added.
App1 App2
Dedicated management tool Dedicated management tool

Setting and reference Setting and reference

App1 App2
Device

Setting and reference Setting and reference

Config data Pref data Log data Config data Pref data Log data
(App1 format) (App1 format) (App1 format) (App2 format) (App2 format) (App2 format)

F-2-155
Devices and MEAP applications which support new functions
F-2-157

General-purpose management tool ●● Log management of MEAP application


Setting and reference Log management function which the MEAP application log can be downloaded and/or deleted
Log: logging only
was added.
App1 App2
Device
Screen example: Download of MEAP application log

Configuration Preference Log Platform


management service management service management service

Config data Preference data Log data


(common format) (common format) (common format)

F-2-156

F-2-158

2-115
2
2
2-116
Screen example: Deletion of MEAP application log ●● Persistent Credential
Persistent Credential is used to help entry of authentication information when logging in
(authenticating) to a different security domain.
Credential is registered using a general MEAP application, so the authentication information
can be reused when the same user logs in for the second time or later.

●● Comparison of functions
Volatile Credential Persistent Credential
Registered information Character strings and arbitrary Java Character strings only User ID/
object Password/Domain/Arbitrary character
strings
Lifetime Registration At login (login application), and at At any timing registered by
any timing registered by application application
F-2-159 Deletion Can be used until logout/shutdown. Can be used until deletion by
application or management tool.
Encryption of Not supported Data retained on the HDD is
■■Authentication Information Sharing Function Credential data encrypted.
Store (Save) to Memory in the device HDD in the device
●● Sharing the authentication information T-2-71
Authentication information at login and authentication information for MEAP application were
●● Service mode
managed separately, so it was very inconvenient because authentication was executed many
For the reason of security, if not preferring to use Volatile Credential, it can be disabled using
times.
the service mode. (Persistent Credential cannot be disabled.)
In the MEAP environment, the unified authentication function which authentication information
Service switch can be found in the following.
can be shared even between MEAP applications was added.
[SERVICE MODE] LEVEL1 > [COPIER] > [Option] > [FNC-SW] > [UA-OFFSW]
Supported MEAP Specifications is Ver.59 and both device and MEAP application need to
Setting value: 0 = Enabled, 1 = Disabled
support this version in order to use this function.
There are 2 types for authentication information sharing: Volatile Credential which the
registered information is discarded at logout or shutdown of the device, and Persistent
Credential which the registered information is not discarded even at logout.

●● Volatile Credential
Volatile Credential is used when sharing the authentication information between applications
which log in (authenticate) to the same security domain.
Credential is registered using a login application, so the application which accesses to the
security domain used for authentication by login application can use the Credential.

F-2-160

2-116
2
2
2-117
■■ Function Supporting Deep Sleep Mode Checking the Operating Environment
Once the device shifted to the deep sleep mode, the USB device could not be controlled
■■Outline
after recovery from the deep sleep mode. For this reason, it was necessary to control the
application not to shift to the deep sleep mode. This section lists the requirements on the operating environment for the maintenance.
With this function, the USB device control is enabled after recovery from the deep sleep mode
as in the case when the USB device is inserted and removed (occurrence of disconnection/ Note:
• Cookies must be enabled for each session.
connection event) at recovery from the deep sleep mode. • Java Script must be enabled in all environments.
In addition, this function enables the USB device control after shifting to the deep sleep mode, • The required web server functions for each server are built into the MEAP device, so
so the application needs to perform reconnection processing. there is no need to configure them separately.

This function can be used with the device which MEAP Specifications Ver.54 is supported.

CAUTION:
For the following operations in the combined environment of Windows XP and Internet
Explorer 6, Java 2 Runtime Environment Standard Edition 1.5 or later is required.
• User registration / edit in SSO-H local device
• Use of remote login in SSO-H.

■■SMS
The following system environments are required in order to enable SMS access.

Operating System Supported browser


Windows 2000 Professional Microsoft Internet Explorer 6 SP1
Windows XP Professional Microsoft Internet Explorer 7
Windows Vista SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
Windows 7 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
Mac OS X 10.3 Safari 1.3.2
Mac OS X 10.4 Safari 2.0.4
Mac OS X 10.5 Safari 3.1.2
Mac OS X 10.6 Safari 4.0.3
T-2-72

2-117
2
2
2-118
■■SSO-H Management System environments for administrator and ordinary user

When using SSO-H for the login service, required system environments are different in Java Runtime
Operating System Supported browser
Environment
domain authentication or local device authentication.
See the following for system requirements in each of authentication methods: Windows 2000 Professional SP4 Microsoft Internet Explorer 6 SP1 Sun Java Runtime
Windows XP Professional SP3 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7 Environment 1.4 or later

Note: Windows Vista SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8


• In case either of the following OS is installed in a client computer, Java Runtime Windows 7 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
Environment should be installed separately.
- Windows 2000 Professional Japanese version (Service Pack 4 and later) Windows Server 2003 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7
- Windows XP Professional Japanese version (Service Pack 1a and later) Windows Server 2003 R2 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7
- Windows Server 2003 Japanese version, Windows Server 2003 R2 Japanese version
Windows Server 2008 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
• Visit the URL of Sun Microsystems (US) to learn how to obtain Java Runtime
Environment. Windows Server 2008 R2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
• Accesses via IPv6 communication from a client computer require Java 2 Runtime Mac OS X v10.3 Safari 1.3.2 Sun Java Runtime
Environment Standard Edition 1.5 and later. Environment 5.0
Mac OS X v10.4 Safari 2.0.4
• If [Internet Option]>[Securities]>[Customizing Levels]>[Run ActiveX controller and Plug-in]
is disabled in a computer, Internet Explorer prompts the warning message, “Java Runtime Mac OS X v10.5 Safari 3.1.2
Environment not Installed”. Mac OS X v10.6 Safari 4.0.3
• Use Update 6 or later for Java Runtime Environment 6. T-2-73

System environments for administrator and ordinary user (when using IPv6 communication)

●● Domain authentication management Operating System Supported browser Java Runtime Environment
In order to use domain authentication in SSO-H, the following system environments are Windows XP Professional SP3 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7 Sun Java Runtime Environment
Windows Vista SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8 1.5 or later
required.
• The following Windows servers are installed under Active Directory, and DNS server for Windows 7 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
name resolution. Windows Server 2003 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7
• Microsoft Windows 2000 Server SP4 Windows Server 2003 R2 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7
• Microsoft Windows Server 2003 SP2 Windows Server 2008 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
• Microsoft Windows Server 2003 R2 SP2 Windows Server 2008 R2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
• Microsoft Windows Server 2008 SP2 T-2-74

• Microsoft Windows Server 2008 R2


• Windows 2000/2003 Domain Name System (DNS) access privileges
• Domain controller access privileges

2-118
2
2
2-119
●● Local Device Authentication Management
Note:
• Visit the URL of Sun Microsystems (US) to learn how to obtain Java Runtime For user registration / edit in Local Authentication, following system requirements must be
Environment. satisfied.
• Accesses via IPv6 communication from a client computer require Java 2 Runtime
Environment Standard Edition 1.5 and later.
• Use “User Logon Name (Windows 2000 or older)” registered in Active Directory as the System environments for administrator and ordinary user
user name for domain authentication.
Operating System Supported browser Java Runtime Environmen
• For domain authentication, set a user name only with 1-byte alphanumeric characters
and symbols of - (hyphen), _ (underbar), and % (percent). iR device will reject login with a Windows 2000 Professional SP4 Microsoft Internet Explorer 6 SP1 Sun Java Runtime
user name including a forbidden character. Windows XP Professional SP3 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7 Environment 1.4 or later
• For domain authentication, the time setting should be synchronized between Active
Windows Vista SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
Directory server and the device (as well as the PC to be logged in). If the time is different
for 5 minutes or more, a login error is triggered in domain authentication (the setting of Windows 7 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
allowable time difference can be changed). Windows Server 2003 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7
• A domain authentication manager should be registered when domain authentication is
used. If not registered, setting or management is disabled for some applications. How to Windows Server 2003 R2 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7
register the manager depends on system environments. Windows Server 2008 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
- When not using imageWARE/iW Accounting Manager, a user belonging to “Canon Windows Server 2008 R2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
Peripheral Admins” group on Active Directory will be authorized as the domain
authentication manager. Follow Active Directory Operation Manual to create “Canon Mac OS X v10.3 Safari 1.3.2 Sun Java Runtime
Peripheral Admins” group before registering the manager. Mac OS X v10.4 Safari 2.0.4 Environment 5.0

Mac OS X v10.5 Safari 3.1.2


Mac OS X v10.6 Safari 4.0.3
Network ports used T-2-76

Port No. Application System environments for administrator and ordinary user (when using IPv6 communication)
53 Communication with DNS server (fixed)
Operating System Supported browser Java Runtime Environment
88 Kerberos authentication with KDC (Key Distribution Center)
Windows XP Professional SP3 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7 Sun Java Runtime Environment
389 Communication with directory service using LDAP (default is 389, may be changed to 1.5 or later
Windows Vista SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
any port on LDAP service side)
T-2-75 Windows 7 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
Windows Server 2003 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7
Windows Server 2003 R2 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 7
Windows Server 2008 SP2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
Windows Server 2008 R2 Microsoft Internet Explorer 8
T-2-77

Note:
• Visit the URL of Sun Microsystems (US) to learn how to obtain Java Runtime
Environment.
• Accesses via IPv6 communication from a client computer require Java 2 Runtime
Environment Standard Edition 1.5 and later.

2-119
2
2
2-120
Setting Up the Network Note:
In iR-ADV series, the System Manager ID and the System PIN are configured by
■■Network configuration process default, so “Network” and the items that follow are grayed out and cannot be selected.
Return to the top screen, press “Login” button at the lower left of the screen, login as
To support a MEAP-enabled iR device via network (SMS, etc.), set up the network setting on the system manager, and configure the settings.
the touch panel of the iR device (this setting is [ON] by default). The default setting for the System Manager ID is “7654321”, and the password is”
7654321”.
1) Press [Settings/Registration] button, select [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] >
[Use HTTP] and press [On] button.

F-2-162

Note:
When using SSL, press [Settings/ Registration] button, select [Management
Settings]>[License / Other] > [MEAP Settings] > [SSL Settings] and press [On] button.
(This setting is applied to SSL setting on RUI. Vice versa, [On] set for SSL on RUI is
also applied to the touch panel.)
When [Use SSL] is set to On, the message dialog, [The Default Key is not set. Check
the Key and Certificate List settings in Certificate Setting.], is shown. Press [OK] button
for this message.

F-2-161

F-2-163

2) Press [OK] button to return to Main Menu screen.


3) Restart the device.

2-120
2
2
2-121

CAUTION: Login to SMS


• The setting [ Use HTTP ] is not actually enabled/disabled until you have restarted the ■■Outline
device.
SMS login may be done by entering a password for authentication, or by authentication via
• You cannot make a connection through a proxy server. If a proxy server is in use,
the Remote Login Service (RLS) login window (RLS authentication). Settings can be changed
enter the IP address of the MEAP device in the Exceptions field for the browser.
Open Internet Options dialog of Internet Explorer and select Connections tab, LAN to allow either only one of these methods or both of them.
Settings button, Use a proxy server option, and Advanced button of Proxy server
group. Proxy Settings dialog will opens. The Exceptions field is in the dialog. As SMS login window (password auth) RLS login window (user name/ password auth)
network settings vary among environments, consult the network administrator.
• If Cookie and JavaScript are not enabled in the Web browser, you will not be able to
use SMS.
• To type text using the Web browser, use the characters compatible with the MEAP
device’s touch panel display. The MEAP device may not properly recognize some
characters.
• When [Use SSL] is made available, it is necessary to set the key and the certificate F-2-164
necessary for the SSL communication. Set the key and the certificate by SSL with
Authentication
[SSL Settings] that exists in [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [SSL Login method Authentication service name Users who may log in
method
Settings] on the iR device.
Password Password SMS Installer Service (Password Users who know the SMS
authentication authentication Authentication) login password
RLS login SSO-H SMS Installer Service (Remote Users registered as
Login Service Authentication) administrators with SSO-H
T-2-78

Note:
If Default Authentication is selected as the device authentication method, ‘RLS
Authentication’ is not selectable as SMS Login method. Also, if ‘RLS Authentication’ is
selected, the device authentication method (Default Authentication, SDL, SSO) cannot
be changed.

2-121
2
2
2-122
■■Key Pair and Server Certificate when Using Encrypted SSL ■■Login by Password Authentication
Communication In the SMS login window, enter the password for authentication. Only one password can be
registered with SMS. The login procedures are as follows.
●● SSL Connection for SMS
SMS is always SSL-connected, so it is required to set a key pair and server certificate as the 1) Access SMS from the browser of a PC on the same network as the MEAP device. The
Default Key. When deleting [Default Key] (pre-installed key pair and server certificate) from URL is as follows.
the Default Key, SMS cannot be accessed. URL: https://<MEAP Device IP address>:8443/sms/
Ex.) https://172.16.188.240:8443/sms/
●● When SMS Cannot Be Accessed
If [Default Key] is deleted by mistake or setting [Default Key] is forgotten, URL which SMS Note:
• To encrypt the password information input when logging in, SSL of the login screen was
can be accessed (http:// <IP address of the machine> :8443/sms/) cannot be accessed. made effective. However, it is redirected to new URL (effective SSL) even when accessing
In this case, perform the following. with URL (non-SSL) before.
1. Try to access from http:// <IP address of the machine> :8000/sms/.
2. Check whether to display “HTTP 500 internal server error”.
3. When the message is displayed, set a key pair and server certificate required for encrypted Note:
The default password is “MeapSmsLogin.” (The password is case-sensitive.) When
SSL communication with the following procedures. you want to change the display original language, change in the box in the right of the
1) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [SSL screen.
Settings]. This setting is not affect by the setting of the language of the device.
2) Select [Key and Certificate].
3) After selecting [Default Key] (pre-installed key pair and server certificate), select [ Set
as the Default Key ].
4) Select [Yes] > [OK].

Note:
• For detailed procedures of the Default Key setting, refer to [e-Manual > Security].
• As for SMS, by setting a Default Key, encrypted SSL communication is always executed
regardless of the following setting: [Management Settings] (Settings/Registration) > [MEAP
Settings] > [SSL Settings]: ON/OFF.

F-2-165

2-122
2
2
2-123
2) If the wrong password is entered, the following window is displayed. The user's system ■■Login by RLS Authentication
administrator may have changed the password, so confirm the password with the system
Login without using the SMS login window but by entering the user ID and password for
administrator. Note that there is no special password for service.
authentication in the RLS (Remote Login Service) window. The user information (user
name and password) used is the information for domain authentication or local device
authentication. The login procedures are as follows.

1) Access SMS by RLS Authentication from the PC browser on the same network as the
MEAP device.
URL: https://<IP address of MEAP device>:8443/sms/rls/
Ex.) https://172.16.188.240:8443/sms/rls/

Note:
• To encrypt the password information input when logging in, SSL of the login screen was
made effective. However, it is redirected to new URL (effective SSL) even when accessing
with URL (non-SSL) before.

F-2-166

F-2-167

Note:
• When the device authentication method used is domain authentication, enter the user
name, password and login destination registered with Active Directory and then click ‘Log
In’.
• If the authentication method used is local device authentication, enter the user name,
password and login destination registered in the device and click ‘Log In’. - When using
SDL as the login service, enter the user information registered in the device, as per local
device authentication.
• The user information is set as below for local device authentication by default. Both are
case sensitive.
- User Name: Administrator
- Password: password

2-123
2
2
2-124

Note: CAUTION:
• Only the following users may us SMS via RLS.
In case that the login method to a device is set to SSO-H, if you log in SMS with RLS
- In the case of domain authentication, users belonging to the Canon Peripheral Admins
Group. authentication, no selection is displayed although it is the screen to change the login
- For local device authentication, users with Administrator or Device Admin authority. method.
• SMS Access can be gained also from Remote UI.
Access Remote UI and click on SMS shortcut shown on the lower left of the screen to gain
access to SMS.
When only the password authentication is enabled, the password authentication screen is
shown.
When only the RLS authentication is enabled, no further authentication is needed to
access SMS. This is because users have already authorized upon accessing to Remote
UI.

F-2-169
This is the specification to prevent the inconsistent setting which enables to stop SMS
Installer Service (Password Authentication) by changing the login method to Default
Authentication.
When you want to change the login method to a device, log in the SMS with the
password authentication.

F-2-168

2-124
2
2
2-125
■■Initial Display Languages of SMS Setting the method to login to SMS
SMS supports English and Japanese. Display language can be changed with selecting by the
■■Outline
drop down list on a login page.
The initial display language at the time of accessing SMS depends on the setting. The SMS login method settings are done by setting the login Start/ Stop via the other login
In former SMS, the language setting of "initial setting/registration (user mode)" was used. method. In other words, the password authentication Start/ Stop setting is done by first
However, when the language setting is other than English or Japanese, it displays in English. logging in with RLS authentication, and the RLS authentication Start/ Stop setting is done by
After changed, it will be as follows. first logging in with password authentication. The Start/ Stop combinations of the two login
methods are as follows.
Start

Combination of Login Methods


Refer to the value of
Logged in by RLS Yes portalLang stored in
Cookie. Start RLS Authentication Stop RLS Authentication
authentication.
Start Password Authentication Login available with either method Login available only with
No Remote UI display English or Japanese Stop Password Authentication Login available only with RLS Setting unavailable
setup language
Authentication
Refer to the setting of the
Accept-Language header, T-2-79
which a browser sends out. Except English or Japanese
Language English or Japanese
priority setting of a CAUTION:
browser
If only login via RLS is programmed, login may be disabled for the following reasons.
Refer to the setting of a language Except English or Japanese
displaying in registration/initial • Authentication server is down
setting [Additional Function].
Display setting English or Japanese
• Network problem, no communication with authentication server
of a device
Except English or Japanese
In the event of either of these cases, try the following.
Display in the 1. If local device authentication is active, try logging in with local device
Display in English. language configured.
authentication.
F-2-170
2. If only domain authentication is active, launch in MEAP safe mode from the device
●● When accessing by SMS Installer Service (Password Authentication) service mode.
It is referred in order of the language priority (setting of the Accept-Language header which a After launching in MEAP safe mode, the Default Authentication will become active, and
browser sends out) and the display-language setting in the "user mode". When the language you will be able to login to SMS with password authentication. After logging into SMS,
setup is other than English or Japanese, it is displayed in English. set the password authentication login to ON (active) and restore the device from MEAP
safe mode to normal mode. Until the problem blocking authentication is resolved, log
●● When accessing by SMS Installer Service (Remote Login Service into SMS with password authentication.

Authentication).
Initial display language is set by the language setting (value of portalLang storing in Cookie)
selected by the remote UI screen. When the setting is other than English or Japanese,
Selection of display language is performed in a similar way with the SMS Installer Service
(Password Authentication) mentioned above.

2-125
2
2
2-126
■■Setting for login by Password Authentication 3) Click [Start] or [Stop] button shown in Status field of SMS Installer Service (Password
Authentication) to check if the status is changed.
The procedures for changing the password authentication Start/ stop settings are as follows.

1) Access SMS by RLS Authentication from the PC browser on the same network as the
MEAP device.
URL: https://<IP address of MEAP device>:8443/sms/rls/
Ex.) https://172.16.188.240:8443/sms/rls

Login screen (In case authentication method is SSO-H)

F-2-173
4) Logout once and login again to check to see that the setting is applied properly.
When clicking [Stop] to change the status to [Start], another password authentication login
screen is firstly shown. When trying to access the password authentication screen after
clicking [Start] to change the status to [Stop], the user is automatically redirected to RLS
F-2-171
authentication screen.
2) Select [System Application Management]

Password authentication started screen and Password authentication stopped screen

F-2-174

F-2-172

2-126
2
2
2-127
■■Setting for login by RLS Authentication 3) Click on [Start] or [Stop] button shown on Status field of SMS Installer Service (Remote
Login Service Authentication) to check if the status is changed.
The procedures for changing the RLS authentication Start/ Stop settings are as follows.

1) In order to make a setting for Login by RLS Authentication, you need to Login by Password
Authentication.
URL: https://<IP address of MEAP device>:8443/sms/rls/
Ex.) https://172.16.188.240:8443/sms/rls

Login screen by Password Authentication

F-2-177
4) Log out and then log in again and access via the RLS authentication login window.
When RLS authentication is set to [Start], another RLS login screen is firstly shown. When
accessing to RLS status screen with the setting of [Stop], the user will be redirected to the
password authentication screen.
F-2-175
2) Select [System Application Management] on System Management menu. RLS authentication started screen and RLS authentication stopped screen

F-2-178

F-2-176

2-127
2
2
2-128

CAUTION: Checking MEAP Application Management Page


In case that the login method to a device is set to SSO-H, if you log in SMS with RLS ■■About MEAP Application Management Page
authentication, no selection is displayed although it is the screen to change the login
method. Application Management page shows [resource information] for information of the whole
device resources including Amount Used, Remaining, and Percent Used.
This function enables users to judge the remaining resources before installing the additional
application. Such resource information is shown based on the manifest header stated at the
top of each application, which declares the resources required in the application. Therefore,
the information does not necessarily show the resources actually in use.
The following resource information is shown:
• hard disk / Flash PCB
• memory
• thread
• socket
• file descriptor
You will not be able to install an application if the size of the remaining disk space or flash
memory falls short of the size declared by the application. Moreover, the specifications have
F-2-179 been designed so that an application will not be able to start up if there is a shortage of
This is the specification to prevent the inconsistent setting which enables to stop SMS memory for any of the foregoing items (i.e., memory, thread, socket, file descriptor).
Installer Service (Password Authentication) by changing the login method to Default Follow the steps below to check the remaining memory:
Authentication.
1) Log in to SMS.
When you want to change the login method to a device, log in the SMS with the 2) Click [MEAP Application Management].
password authentication.
3) Check [Resource Information] for information of the whole device resources.
• Amount Used
• Remaining
• Percent Used

2-128
2
2
2-129
Starting and Stopping a MEAP Application
■■Procedure to start and stop a MEAP application
1) Log in to the SMS. (Refer to 'Login to SMS' in this manual.)
2) Click [Application List]. (If the Application List is already being displayed, this operation is
not necessary.)
3) Click [Start] or [Stop] button shown for the MEAP application to be started or stopped.

F-2-180

Note:
Older iR models show resource information required in each application in List of
Application page (corresponding to MEAP Application Management page of this model).
When checking the resource information of each application in this model, click on the
application name in MEAP Application Management page.

F-2-182
4) Check to see that the status of the MEAP application in question is either [Started] or
[Stopped.]

F-2-181

F-2-183

2-129
2
2
2-130
Checking the Platform Information MEAP Specifications
■■The check procedure of the platform information ■■What is MEAP Specifications (MEAP Spec Version)?
This screen allows users to check MEAP-Contents versions, MEAP Specifications for the MEAP Specifications is one of the information required to judge whether MEAP applications
device and others. can be operated or not. With MEAP Specifications, you can prevent an application that uses
a specific function of device from being installed onto the device that does not have the
CAUTION: function.
• Some applications may not be installed to some MEAP devices of specific
specifications. (See ‘MEAP Specifications ‘). ■■About Name
MEAP Specification is shown as 'MEAP Specifications' in the screen to check the version
1) Log in to SMS. on the side of device that supports MEAP (counter confirmation button) and MEAP
2) Click [System Management] > [System Info] tab. platform (SMS). On the other hand, in the manifest file of MEAP application, it is shown as
'MeapSpecVersion' (described in the same way in the SDK document)
(Note) 'MEAP Specifications' hereafter in this document.

■■Mechanism
MEAP platform judges whether MEAP applications can be operated on it using on the 2
information below:
• Device Specification ID
• MEAP Specifications
Device Specification ID shows information such as the original functions of MFP (including
print, scan, and copy), and one that differs by model such as maximum copy number,
thus each model has a different ID. (It is easy to determine the IDs for this reason.) MEAP
application declares 1 or more Device Specification ID required for its execution. Declaration
of multiple Device Specification IDs means that the application is operable in all the models
declared. Upon installation of MEAP application in (using) SMS or MEAP Enterprise Service
F-2-184 Manager, matching of Device Specification ID is executed on the side of MEAP platform
machine. The machine which doesn't support the ID declared by the application rejects
installation of such an application.
Meanwhile, MEAP Specifications shows other information than defined by Device
Specification
ID above, including network and security. Thus each model does not always have the same
version.

MEAP application declares 1 or more MEAP Specifications required for its execution.
Declaration of multiple Device Specification IDs means that the application is operable
in all the environments declared. Upon installation of MEAP application in SMS or MEAP

2-130
2
2
2-131
Enterprise Service Manager, matching of MEAP Specifications is executed on the side of MEAP Specifications List
MEAP platform machine. The machine which doesn't support the version declared by the Ver Description
application rejects installation of such an application. 1 MEAP basic function
2 MEAP Spec Version 1 function and SSL/TSL + Proxy
MEAP Specifications for each model 5 MEAP Spec Version 1 function and CPCA V2 + ERS (Error Recovery Service) + New SSL/TSL
6 Reserved
Product Name Initial MEAP SpecVer Remarks 7 MEAP Spec Version 5 function and Compact PDF + OCR PDF (Text Searchable) + USB Host
iR-ADV C5051 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, Ver.37.xx or later (Buffering of Interrupt Transfer)
iR-ADV C5045 19, 25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 19, 9 Reserved
iR-ADV C5035 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 10 MEAP Spec Version 5 function and USB-Host (Exception + Clear Feature + Set Feature+ Hot
iR-ADV C5030 44, 45 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 44, 45, 46 Plug) + WINS address acquisition using MIB Agent + Timer Service + SSL client authentication
11 MEAP Spec Version 5 function and AMS
Ver.38.xx or later 13 MEAP Spec Version 5 function and J2ME1.1 Support + Encrypted PDF + Trace and smooth
5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 19, PDF + CTK2.0
25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 14 Device signature PDF
36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 44, 45, 46, 15 IMI + ERS (API addition for IMI) , IPv6, Extended encryption function (AES/RC4)
49 17 Acquiring images of JBIG format
18 Parsing XML documents (XML parser)
Ver.50.xx or later
19 Enhancement of IMI function (IMI Version1.2 series)
5,6,7,9,10,11,13,14,15,17,18,19,25,26,
27,29,30,31,32,33,34,35,36,37,38,39,4 25 API to access the HID/Mass Storage class devices.
0,41,42,44,45,46,47,49,50,51,52,53,54, 26 MEAP driver preference function
55,56,57,58,59 27 Symbols that can be used with MibAgent added. (symbols for IPv6 address acquisition)
iR-ADV C9075 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, Ver.37.xx or later 29 IMI API added (IMI version 1.2.1 enabled)
iR-ADV C9070 19, 25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 19, 30 Extended address book function. (e-mail/group/i-FAX/file)
iR-ADV C9065 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 31 Integrated ERS function
iR-ADV C9060 44, 45 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 44, 45, 46 32 Extended Imaging function (function to generate PDF/OOXML (PowerPoint) with visible
iR-ADV C7065 signature)
iR-ADV C7055 Ver.38.xx or later 33 Extended function for imageRUNNER / iR ADVANCE series (API for address book/ CTK/
5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 19, TopMenu)
25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 34 Extended IMI Box function (v1.3.0)
36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 44, 45, 46, 35 Extended SIS function (function to check the network cable status, function to check PS print
49 server unit status)
iR-ADV 6075 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 36 Reserved
iR-ADV 6065 19, 25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, 37 CLS (Contextual Login Service) Supporting API Added
iR-ADV 6055 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 44,
38 imageRUNNER / iR ADVANCE Series administrative privileges supported
45, 46, 49
39 MEAP Specifications added according to Jcrypto API Specification Change
iR-ADV 8105 PRO 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18,
40 ImagingAPI (Creation API of Visible Signature PDF) added
iR-ADV 8095 PRO 19, 25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33,
iR-ADV 8085 PRO 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 44, 41 Reserved
45, 46, 49 42 Reserved
iR-ADV C2030 5, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 44 imageRUNNER / iR ADVANCE Series Remote Address Book Supported, RemoteFAX
iR-ADV C2025 19, 25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33, Supported.
iR-ADV C2020 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 45 Addition of API that allows acquisition of the HID installation status
44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 49 46 Multilingualization of the USB keyboard of the System Driver
T-2-80 47 Addition of API which executes a print order from the MEAP application of the IMI encryption
PDF document
48 ID expressing the scan function for iR-ADV C2030/C2025/C2020 series

2-131
2
2
2-132
Ver Description MEAP Application System Information
49 Reserved
50 SecurityOptionalPackage ■■Outline
51 IMI function expansion of iR-ADV C5051 series (Ver.50.xx or later) or later
52 (iR-ADV C5051 series (Ver.50.xx or later)) Addition of registered API to enable SSL Information about an application installed in the device is called MEAP application system
communication setting (On/Off) for each URL information. This information should be obtained for reporting troubles because multiple
53 Disclosure of registration/deletion function to/from Quick Menu
information items can be collectively confirmed.
54 Function to notify an event to the application at recovery from the sleep mode.
55 System account release function
The following sections describe the details of information items. Each item is shown or printed
56 MEAP User Preference Service by application.
57 MEAP Application Configuration Service
58 MEAP Application Log Service Note:
59 Authentication information sharing function The system information shown on the screen and the system information printed in the
T-2-81 MEAP device’s user mode are exactly the same.

■■Checking the System Information of a MEAP Application with


SMS
1) Log in to SMS.
2) On System Management menu, click [System Info].
3) Click [Details] button.

F-2-185
4) System information of each application (including system applications) is shown in
anadditional window. Copy and paste all the information in a file to attach to AR reports as
text information. This function is useful to check status information of each application.

2-132
2
2
2-133
■■Printing the System Information of a MEAP Application ■■Content of MEAP system information
MEAP system information can be printed out with iR device for confirmation. Application System Information
Follow the steps below when confirming information: Application Name: C-Cabinet Gateway for MEAP
Application ID/System Application Name: 03a46668-63e4-4636-9cbb-492b6cef05d5
Application Version: 1.0.0
1) Select [ Settings/ Registration] > [ Management Settings] > [ License/ Other] > [MEAP
Status: Resolved
Settings] > [ Print System Information] . Installed on: Tue Oct 21 14:00:11 GMT+09:00 2003
Vendor : Canon Inc.
Note: License Status : Installed
When System Manager ID and PIN are set, go to Top screen and log in as System Maximum Memory Usage : 1024
Manager to continue jobs. Registered Service :

2) Press[ Yes] button. ●● Application Name


It is the name (bundle-name) declared in a statement within the application program. It may
not necessarily be identical to the name of the program.

●● Application ID/System Application Name


Application ID (application-id) items which are declared on the declaration statement in the
application program are printed.

●● Application Version
It is the version of the application (bundle-version) declared in a statement within the
F-2-186 application program.

Note: ●● Status
MEAP system information was printed out in PDL format conventionally. However,
the information has been printed out in text format instead of PDL format, enabling iR It indicates the status of the application in question; specifically, Installed: the application has
devices without PDL installation to print out information (iR C3220 and later). been installed.
Active: the application is being in use. Resolved: the application is at rest.

●● Installed On
It indicates the date on which the application was installed.

●● Vendor
It is the name of the vendor that developed the application, and is the name (bundle-vendor)
declared in a statement within the application program.

2-133
2
2
2-134
●● License Status Installing an Application
It indicates the status of the license; specifically, None: no license is needed.
Not Installed: no license has been installed. ■■Resource
Installed: the appropriate license has been installed. Invalid: the license has been invalidated. When 1 MEAP application operates, the resource volume allocated to each device is as
Overlimt: the license has been used beyond its permitted limit. follows (loaded resource list). Since the following value is an estimate, when installing the
MEAP applications, it needs to check the available resource of SMS.
●● License Expires After Since the indication of SMS resource volume fluctuates by the login service (authentication
It indicates the date after which the license expires. If the status of the license is 'none', this function) and configuration (future model), which the user selected, it may show a bigger
item will not be printed. value than the following values.

●● License Upper Limit List of Available Resources


It indicates the limit imposed on individual counter readings. If the status of the license is HDD/ File
Product Name Memory Thread Socket
'none', this item will not be printed. Flash PCB Description
iR-ADV C5051 series 1024MB 128MB 256 256 256
●● Counter Value iR-ADV C9075 series 1024MB 128MB 256 256 256
It is the current counter reading of a specific counter. If the status of the license is 'none', this iR-ADV 6075 series 1024MB 128MB 256 256 256
item will not be printed. iR-ADV 8105 PRO series 1024MB 128MB 256 256 256
iR-ADV C2030/ Flash model 220MB 32MB 162 128 128
C2025/ C2020 Series
●● Maximum Memory Usage HDD model 1024MB 128MB 256 256 256
T-2-82
It indicates the maximum amount of memory that the application uses. It is the amount
(maximum memory usage) declared in a statement within the application program, and is
expressed in kilobytes. Note:
• As for memory, check the available resource when starting up the application. For other
resources other than memory, check them when installing.
●● Registered Service • Some applications call for a specific set of conditions for installation. For details, see the
User’s Guide that comes with the individual applications.
It is a list of services that have been registered by the application with the MEAP framework.
• Maximum installable application is up to 20 even if the remaining resource is adequate.
Some services may not have printable data. (However, the Send function consumes 1, it must be 19 in practice.) Authentication
application is not included in this number.
• The MEAP application, which can be started simultaneously, is up to 19. (Authentication
application is not included in this number.)

CAUTION:
To install an application, the user needs to use the following URL when accessing the
license control system to obtain a license file. In doing so, he/she needs to register the
license access number of the application and the serial number of the device.
http://www.canon.com/meap/

2-134
2
2
2-135
■■Procedure to install applications CAUTION:
1) Long on to SMS. • You cannot install only the license.
2) Click [Install MEAP Application] on the menu. • You will not be able to install the application without using the appropriate license.
Be sure to select its license file.
• If you are adding a license to an existing application, see Chapter 0, “Adding a
License File.” in this manual.
• If you are updating an existing application, stop the application; then, install the new
application or its license file. You will not be able to update an application while it is
running.

5) Check the contents of the Confirm page; then, click [OK] button.

F-2-187
3) Check [ Install MEAP Application/License ]page appears.
4) Click [Browse..] button, and select the application file and the license file of the application;
then, click [OK] button.

Note:
Application File: identified by the extension “jar”.
License File: identified by the extension “lic”.

F-2-189
6) Some applications show a screen to indicate the terms of agreement. Read the terms, and
click [OK].
7) Check the message "Installing...Please wait." appears, beginning the installation.

F-2-188 F-2-190

2-135
2
2
2-136
8) Upon installation completed, click [To MEAP Application Management] button shown on
Adding a License File
the screen to view MEAP Application Management page.
■■Procedure adding a license file
1) Log on to SMS.
2) On MEAP Application Management, click the name of the application to which you want to
add a license file.

F-2-191

Note:
To use the application that you have just installed, you must make sure that the
application status is Started.

Note:
The license file is provided in text file format, enabling to view in a text editor. The
application ID and device serial number shown in the file allow users to confirm which
device to install with the license file.
Note that any changes added to the license file may disable installation. Cares should
be taken when confirming the contents of the license file.

Sample file
F-2-193
License File ID
Application ID
Serial Number
Validated Period
Counter informations

F-2-192

2-136
2
2
2-137
3) In [Application / License Information] page shown on the screen, click [License 4) Click [ Browse ] button, and select the license file you want to install.
Management ] button.

F-2-195
5) Click [ Install ] button.

F-2-194

F-2-196
6) Check the content of the confirmation page, and click [OK] button

2-137
2
2
2-138
Disabling a License File 2) Click the name of the application that you want to disable.

■■Procedure disabling a license file (suspending a license)

CAUTION:
• To invalidate (or suspend) a license, you must first stop the application in question.
• Once suspended, the status of the license will be ‘Not Installed’, and its application
will no longer be available for use.
• You can later restore a suspended license file as long as you are doing so on the
same iR, the device with the same device serial number.
• When replacing the device due to lease up or trouble, use the license for forwarding
(see Chapter 0, “License for forwarding.”).

1) Stop the application you want to uninstall on MEAP Application Management page.

F-2-198
3) On Application/ License Information page, click [License Management] button.

F-2-199

F-2-197

2-138
2
2
2-139
4) License Management page appears. Click [Disable] button.
Downloading / Removing an Invalidated License File
■■Outline
You must remove the invalidated license file before uninstalling an application. If reinstallation
is a possibility, you may download the license file to a PC for storage. To download or delete
a license file, first disable it.

WARNING:
Once you have removed an invalidated license file, you will no longer be able to
download it form the MEAP device.

■■Procedure downloading / removing an invalidated license file


The downloaded license file can be used for reinstallation only in the same iR device (with the
same device serial number).
1) Login to SMS.
2) Application List page appears. On MEAP Application Management page , click the name of
the application you want.

F-2-200
5) Click [Yes].

F-2-201

F-2-202

2-139
2
2
2-140
3) Check Application/ License Information page appears. 7) To delete, click [Delete] button.
4) On Application / License Information page, click [License Management] button.

F-2-203
5) License Management page appears. To download, click [Download] button.

F-2-205
8) When the dialog to confirm deletion is shown, click [Yes] button.

F-2-206

WARNING:
F-2-204 Without the license file, an application cannot be reinstalled even to the MEAP de-vice
6) When you have selected [Download] button, specify where you want to store the file by that the application had been installed last time. Download and save the license file
following the instructions on the screen. before deleting the application.

2-140
2
2
2-141
Reusable license License for forwarding
■■Outline ■■Outline
When reinstalling, Disable License file should be downloaded (see Chapter 0, “Disabling a When the device is replaced due to lease up or trouble, it is possible to continue using the
License File .” and see Chapter 0, “Downloading / Removing an Invalidated License File.” in current license information of MEAP application by forwarding it to a new device. Service
this manual) or a license for reinstallation should be obtained from LMS, before reinstallation. engineers are responsible for license transfer as this task requires the SMS hidden page (not
This specification aims to prevent misuse of applications. open to users).
To increase convenience of users, only application with unlimited validity date and application
counter (e.g. Portal Service, SDL, SSO) has been made to be able to install as many times ■■Procedure to create license for forwarding
as needed by the same license file. This kind of license is called 'Reusable license'.
1) Log in to SMS, stop the application to be forwarded (see Chapter 0, “Starting and Stopping
a MEAP Application.” in this manual).

F-2-207
2) Move to the download page of license forwarded for the device as sender (https:// IP
address of device: 8443/sms/ForwardLicense).

F-2-208

2-141
2
2
2-142
3) Specify the application to be forwarded. 5) The window to confirm whether to create a transfer licence will be displayed. Click [OK].

F-2-211
6) Icon of license file for forwarding is displayed in the box of license file downloading. Click
[Download].
F-2-209
4) Click [Create] at Create Transfer License File.

F-2-212

F-2-210

2-142
2
2
2-143
7) The dialogue [File Download] is displayed. Click [Save]. 11) Since this downloaded transfer license is the file only to prove the license invalidation,
it cannot be used for installation to the other device as it is. Send the transfer license to
the service support contact of your nearest sales company to request issuance of the new
license for installation in the new device.

Note:
When requesting issuance of license for forwarding, inform the sales company of the
name of product name and serial No. of the device as sender, and of the name of
product name and serial No. of the forwarding destination.

12) Install application using the license for forwarding issued by the sales company.

F-2-213
8) Specify the download destination, click [Save].

F-2-214
9) After downloading the license file for forwarding, click [Delete] to display the confirmation
screen and click [Yes] to delete the file (in consideration of breakage of license for
forwarding, deleting disabled license can be executed after all steps have been completed).

F-2-215
10) Log out of SMS.

2-143
2
2
2-144
Uninstalling an Application 3) Click [Uninstall] button for the application to be uninstalled.

■■Procedure to uninstall an application

CAUTION:
• To uninstall a MEAP application, the license status should be set to “Not Installed” (to
be deleted). When a user tries to uninstall an application before deleting the license,
the following message is shown. Refer to the sections of “Disabling a License File “
and “Downloading / Removing an Invalidated License File” of this manual to delete
the license file.

F-2-217
4) Check the application name to be uninstalled shown on the screen to click [Yes] button.
Upon [Yes] button clicked, uninstallation process is started.

F-2-216
• Dimmed [Uninstall] button shows that the selected application cannot be removed.
• If the application you are uninstalling is associated with another application, a
message will appear to indicate that the package exported by the application will no
loner be available. Uninstalling such an application may also disable its associated
applications.

1) Log in to SMS to click [MEAP Application Management] on the menu.


F-2-218
2) [MEAP Application Management] page is shown.

2-144
2
2
2-145
Login Service ■■Default Authentication overview
This login service is selected when the department ID management is enabled or no
■■About Login Service
authentication function is set. Set the department ID management to [ON] on Setting /
The login service is started up to authenticate the user when MEAP-enabled iR device is Registration (Additional Functions mode) of this device and register 7-digit ID and PIN by
booted up. Login service changes and install/ uninstall are carried out from the 'System department. This setting restricts the use of this device only to users keying the registered
Management' page. The pre-install applications and those provided on the accessory CD ID and PIN. Department IDs/ and PINs can be registered on the touch panel of this device or
are as follows. Default Authentication is used as the default at the time of shipment from the Remote UI.
factory.

■■SSO-H (Single Sign-On-H) overview


CAUTION: This is a merger of the existing SDL and SSO login services and has the following features.
• When the login service is set to SSO-H, Department ID management needs to be • Both the domain authentication and local device authentication login services can be used.
[OFF] before changes can be made. To use SSO-H local device authentication and • There is no need to have a separate SA server.
Department ID management at the same time, after allocation of the department ID to • Login is not via SA, so SSO-H refers directly to DNS for authentication.
the Administrator, switch the authentication method to local device authentication and • Kerberos and NTML protocols are supported.
then turn Department ID management ON. • The following three authentication methods may be selected from.
• To use Department ID management in domain authentication, the option image- • Domain authentication
WARE accounting manager is required. • Local device authentication
• When the setting is SSO-H, the card reader for the option controller card cannot be • Domain authentication + local authentication
used.
CAUTION:
• When using SSO-H, the clock settings of the server managing the Active Directory
and the MEAP device (and the PC used to log in), must be matched. If there is a time • The system configuration is different from previous SSO, so individual management
difference of greater than five minutes in the clock settings, an error will be generated is required.
when login is attempted. • Data porting of user information that was being used with the earlier SSO local
• When the setting is SSO-H, start up takes a little longer when compared to Default device authentication and SDL can be done by exporting/ importing. However,
Authentication (because of the time required for object initialization). application settings information cannot be ported.
• To use the SEND function when the setting is for SSO-H, when sending email, mail
addresses need to be programmed against each user. If they are not, email cannot
be sent. Note, however, that when sending i-Fax, the mail addresses set in the device
are used.
• This device does not support SDL, conventional SSO and Security Agent. In addition
these are not packaged in Administrator’s CD.

2-145
2
2
2-146
■■Authentication methods of SSO-H Differences from conventional SSO

SSO-H can use multiple authentication methods, and the user can toggle between them Domain B Domain C Domain B Domain C
from a Web browser. (Refer to the MEAP Authentication System Settings Guide 'User DC
DC DC DC
Authentication Method Settings'.)
DC DC
CAUTION:
The factory shipment setting is ‘Domain authentication + local device authentication’.
In order to provide increased security, as soon as SSO is used, it is recommended that
SA
the administrator’s user name and password in local device authentication be changed
from the factory shipment settings as soon as possible.

Device Device
●● Local device authentication
Domain A Domain A
This is an authentication method that is used for single iR devices. The authenticating SSO SSO-H
users are registered in the iR device's database. User management is performed on the
F-2-219
Web application provided by the device, or from the imageWARE Enterprise Management
Console/ iW Management Console. The login destination is [This device].
●● Domain authentication + local device authentication
This is a user authentication method that provides both domain authentication and local
device authentication functionalities. Principally, domain users who are registered/ managed
●● Domain authentication
by the Active Directory are authenticated by domain authentication, and local device
This is a form of user authentication which operates in collaboration with the domain controller
authentication can be used when it is necessary to authenticate a temporary user that cannot
on the Active Directory environment network and, as soon as the iR device is logged into,
be added to the Active Directory. Also, should there be any kind of a problem with the domain
carries out authentication of the domain on the network. In addition to users belonging to
controller or Security Agent (SSO only), local device authentication can be used in emergency
the domain that includes the iR device, users belonging to domains that have a reliable
situations, while waiting for normal status to be restored.
relationship with the domain (multi-domain) can also be authenticated. The domain name of
In the figure shown below, users belonging to Domain A, which includes the iR device,
the login destination can be selected by the users themselves upon login.
and users belonging to Domain B, which has a reliable relationship with Domain A, can be
authenticated, and users registered with the iR device itself can also be registered. The login
The function makes use of options iW EMC Accounting Management Plig-in to enable
destination (domain name or [This device]) is se lected by the user upon login.
analysis and management of the iR device usage status.
Domain A Domain B

The protocol used is as follows. Domain Controller


Domain Controller ( Active Directory )
• Kerberos:LLS/RLS/ILS ( Active Directory )

• NTLMV2:WLS(Web Service Login Service)


User information acquisition is done by LADP, so the Active Directory LDAP port needs to be
made accessible. If LDAP connection fails, the authentication will end in error. Domain A User iR Device Domain B User
No. of supported domains: 200 (unchanged from SSO) Site access supported.

F-2-220

2-146
2
2
2-147
●● System Manager Linkage (automatic ID allocation to System
CAUTION:
• To run domain authentication and Department ID management at the same time,
Managers)
the options Net Spot Accountant, iW Accounting Manager or iW EMC Accounting SSO provided the automated function conventionally on Security Agent (hereinafter “SA”) to
Management Plug-in are required. If domain authentication is selected as the authenticate System Manager by allocating IDs set on SA to domain authentication managers
authentication method without linkage to these systems, login will be disabled and (users belonging to Canon Peripheral Admins group). However, SSO-H does not support this
Department ID management will not come ON. If Department ID management function.
cannot be turned ON when using domain authentication and login is disabled, switch
the login service to Default Authentication and turn Department ID management
■■Access Mode in Sites
OFF.
• In order to link local device authentication and Department ID management and With SSO-H, access to Active Directory within site can be prioritized or restricted, so there
manage print pages and scan pages per department ID, Department ID management is a setting called 'Access Mode in Sites'. Sites programmed in Active Directory comprise
must be set ON. To run local device authentication and Department ID management multiple subnets. In this mode, SSO-H uses site information to access the same site as the
at the same time, the information registered in local device authentication must device, or the subnet Active Directory.
match the Department ID management user information (department ID and • The SSO-H default setting is with the site internal access mode OFF.
password). • Access Active Directory within same site only.
• In local device authentication the card reader for the option control card cannot be • If there is no Active Directory within the same site, or if connection fails, there will be an
used. authentication error.
• Access another site if Active Directory within the same site cannot be located.
• If there is no Active Directory within the same site, or if connection fails, an Active Directory
external to the site will be accessed.
●● Linkage with Department ID management when using SSO-H • If all attempts to access Active Directory fail, there will be an authentication error.
SSO-H has collaborative linkage with imageWARE/iW Enterprise Management Console
Access Management Plug-in, imageWARE/iW Enterprise Management Console Accounting
The operating specifications of the site internal access mode are as described below.
Management Plug-in. Only when used with 'Local device authentication', can department ID/
When first logging in to the login service after booting iR, the domain controller (DC) is
passwords be allocated to users.
obtained from the site list.
In the event that these are allocated, authentication can be performed even when the main
However, upon the first login, even if the site functionality is active, connection to DC is
unit's department management is ON. Department ID and department passwords are not
random. (This is because, if connection to DC should fail, the site to which the device belongs
allocated to domain users.
cannot be ascertained.)
When the main unit's department management function is ON, domain users cannot be
If the device IP address or the domain name are changed, the site settings are acquired once
authenticated.
more.

Note:
With SSO, linkage with imageWARE/iW Enterprise Management Console Accounting In this mode, at the first login (first authentication of domain to which the device belongs)
Management Plug-in was assumed and department management linkage was enabled LDAP-Bind is performed directly to DC and site information acquired by LDAP from DC.
even in domain authentication, but with SSO-H, this is now unsupported.
From the acquired site list, the site to which the device subnet belongs is extracted and this
becomes the site to which device belongs. Active Directory address is acquired (retrieved
from DNS)

2-147
2
2
2-148
●● Settings for access mode in sites
Note:
• The Active Directory subnet is assumed to be the same subnet as the device sub-net. Switching between site internal access mode/ non site internal access mode, as well as
• In the Active Directory addresses, the Active Directories of the same site are listed. detailed mode settings, are done via DMS or iWEMC.
• Active Directories of the same subnet as the device are listed first.
• If there is no Active Directory with the same subnet as the device, Active Directories
belonging to different subnets than the device are listed. Site internal access mode settings window (DMS)
• The Active Directories within the same site are accessed in order. Note, however, that
where there are multiple Active Directories within the same site, access to those Active
Directories will be in the order in which the address list was obtained.
• If there is no Active Directory within the same site, if access outside of the site is
programmed, Active Directories outside of the site will be accessed in the order in which
the address list was obtained.

●● Site list acquisition


F-2-221
After booting up, upon the first login by LLS or ILS/ RLS, the site list is obtained from the
The figure below shows a sample of processing Access Mode in Sites.
Active Directory. In order to obtain the site list from the Active Directory, Active Directory
Sample of Processing Access Mode in Sites
needs to be accessed in LDAP, so SASL-Kerberos-Bind is used by the login user account. If
authentication by Active Directory should fail, an authentication error will be generated and
the site list will be acquired again from Active Directory upon the next login. Domain X
4.Access Active
Directory of same Site:Tokyo::
DNS Server A Repllic 172.24.12.0/24
In SSO-H, the Active Directory to be accessed when acquiring the site list cannot be site ation
records: DC-Tokyo/DNS 172.24.35.0/24
specified. In other words, if there is no site list, which site's Active Directory is accessed AD 192.168.1.2

n
172.24.12.2 1. When making initial

io
at
AD 172.24.12.2 Site:Osaka::
settings, obtain site list

lic
depends upon the order of the Active Directory addresses returned by DNS. Therefore, when AD 172.24.35.2

pl
and ascertain which 192.168.1.0/24

Re
AD 211.111.1.30 2.Get Active site the device
acquiring the site list, LDAP may access the Active Di rectory of a different site. Therefore, in SSO-Tokyo 172.24.12.80 Directory list belongs to. Site:Hakata::
SSO-Osaka 192.168.1.90 SSO-Tokyo 211.111.1.0/24
such cases, it is sometimes necessary to access across sites or subnets, which means that SSO-Hakata 211.111.1.3 N 172.24.12.80 WAN
WA3. Access Active
LDAP protocol needs to have continuity across sites (subnets) (normally, LDAP is port No. Directory of same
subnet
389). Further, if connection with Active Directory fails when acquiring site information, another
Site:Tokyo
Active Directory will be accessed. DC-Osaka/DNS 172.12.12.0/24 DC-Hakata/DNS
172.168.1.2 172.24.35.0/24 211.111.1.30
Site information, once it has been acquired, is cached within the device. The life settings of
the cache can be set so that site information in the cache is updated upon the first login after
the device boots up, or so that the cache is not updated once acquired. SSO-Tokyo SSO-Tokyo
Site:Osaka 192.168.1.90 Site:Hakata 211.111.1.3
192.168.1.0/24 211.111.1.0/24

F-2-222

2-148
2
2
2-149
1) SSO-Tokyo acquires site lists from Active Directories. ■■Specification of SSO-H
Note, however, that the Active Directories accessed in order to acquire site lists are in the
Item Specification
order in which they were returned by DNS, so there is no guarantee that the same Active
No. of local device users Up to 5000
Directory will be accessed as in the initial settings (upon device settings or changes to NW
settings, etc.). Maximum number of domains 200 domains (“this device” not included)

[Site subnet list] Supported device All the MEAP-enabled iR devices (different SSO-H versions
are supported depending on machine types)
Site: Tokyo: = 172.24.12.0/24, 172.24.35.0/24
IPv6 Authentication provided in IPv6 supports AD/KDC/DNS of
Site: Osaka: = 192.168.1.0/24
Windows Server 2008 only)
Site: Hakata: = 211.111.1.0/24
Memory (KB) / thread (numbers) 3584/33
As a result, since SSO-Tokyo is 172.24.12.80, the subnet is 172.24.12.0/24, and is judged
Supported Active Directory Windows 2000 Server SP4/ Windows Server 2003 SP1/
as belonging to site Tokyo. Windows
2) The DNS server obtains its Active Directory list from the primary or secondary DNS, as set Server 2003 R2/ Windows 2008 Server(64BitOS not
in the device. supported)
[Active Directory] Availability of Department Available only in local authentication
Management Linkage
172.24.12.2, 172.24.35.2, 192.168.1.2, 211.111.1.30
Site access Supported
3) Of the Active Directories in 2), above, the ones that belong to the same site (Tokyo) are
T-2-83
172.24.12.2 and 172.24.35.2.
Of these, the Active Directory that is the same subnet as SS-Tokyo is 172.24.12.2. ●● SSO/SDL handling
Therefore, this one will be accessed. Conventional SSO and SDL are not packaged in Administrator's CD of this model. In addition,
4) If access fails at step 3), above, the other Active Directory of the same site, 172.24.35.2, this model does not support older versions of SSO or SDL released in the past.
will be accessed.
5) If access fails at step 4), above, also, SSO-Osaka and SSO-Hakata will be accessed (the
order will depend on the order of the Active Directories in DNS). Note, however, that this is
an optional operation.

●● Logging into other domains at multi-domain


At multi-domain, if another domain is logged into, based on the site/ subnet information
retrieved in the home domain, the Active Directories of the login destination domain/ KDC
address list are computed. In the event that the domain controller IP addresses of other
domains are outside of the site access range, and only the domain controller within the site
is programmed for access, an error message will be displayed to the effect that the site
information is incorrect.

■■Environment confirmation
Refer to the section of “Checking the Operating Environment” of this manual for system
requirements needed in each login service.

2-149
2
2
2-150
Changing Login Services 3) When login service application you have selected turns to Start after Restart, restart the
device.
■■Steps to Change Login Services
1) Click [ Enhanced System Application Management] on [System Management ].

F-2-225

CAUTION:
In case that the login method to a device is set to SSO-H, if you log in SMS with RLS
authentication, no selection is displayed although it is the screen to change the login
F-2-223 method.
2) A page will appear showing the various selections you can make for the login service. Click
[SWITCH] button for the login service to be used.

F-2-226

This is the specification to prevent the inconsistent setting which enables to stop SMS
F-2-224 Installer Service (Password Authentication) by changing the login method to Default
Authentication.
When you want to change the login method to a device, log in the SMS with the
password authentication.

2-150
2
2
2-151
Initializing the Password Backup of the MEAP Application Area and Recovery of
■■Outline the Backup Data Using SST
When a user forgets the password to log in to SMS, initialize it to the default value of ■■Outline
“MeapSmsLogin” using the switch license for initializing passwords. Follow the steps below:
When replacing the Flash PCB of Flash model or when replacing or formatting the hard disk
of HDD model, the data in the MEAP application area needs to be temporarily saved to your
■■Procedure to initialize the SMS login password PC.
1) Get the switch license for initializing the password. This chapter describes information on backing up the data in the MEAP application area and
Request the support of the regional headquarters of the Canon for switch license for recovering the backup data.
initializing the password presenting the device serial number.
In the case of MEAP-installed devices, the application is license-managed, so the application
2) Click [Login] button leaving Password field blank or entering incorrect password. The needs to be reinstalled and reconfigured when replacing the Flash PCB of Flash model or
Return to install Password Settings area appears. Click [Browse..] button and select the when replacing or formatting the hard disk of HDD model.
switch license file prepared in advance. In that case, a license for reinstallation needs to be downloaded and the customer data and
configuration information need to be recovered, and these procedures pose heavy burdens
on the service technician.

The area used for the MEAP application can be easily saved/recovered by using the backup
function of SST (Service Support Tool).
This greatly reduces the work burden on the service technician.
Please note that the application cannot be illegally copied because the backup data can be
recovered only when the iR device has the same serial number.

Note:
Only HDD can be formatted.

WARNING:
You must not perform any other work (including checking operation) until the HDD/ the
Flash PCB has been backed up. This arrangement is to prevent a mismatch of MEAP
F-2-227
3) When you click [Initialize] button, the confirmation message appears. Click [OK] button. counter readings and the HDD/ the Flash PCB contents, and any fault in operation
arising as the result of failure to observe this will not be covered by the guarantee of
Then Login page opens. Enter the default password 'MeapSmsLogin' to log in. The
operation.
password is case-sensitive.

Note: Note:
If you click [Cancel] button, the Login page opens without initializing the password. The application that is installed with a reusable license can be reinstalled by using the
same license.

2-151
2
2
2-152
■■HDD model and Flash model ■■Backup Item Automatically Copied
●● Data storage area ●● The following data are backed up using SST:
In the case of iR-ADV C2030/C2020, there are HDD model provided with a Flash PCB and The following data are backed up (saved as Meapbackup.bin) using SST.
an HDD and Flash model provided with a Flash PCB only. • MEAP applications.
The System files are stored in the Flash PCB in both models, but the location where the • Setup data generated by MEAP applications (Note that image data stored in BOX will not
MEAP application area is stored differs according to the model. be saved for MEAP applications using BOX function).
• User information data registered for local device authentication in SSO-H
Flash PCB
System
System Area
Area • SMS password
Flash PCB
System
System Area
Area
User
User Area
Area ●● Data backed up using SST in the case of iR-ADV devices
HDD In the case of iR-ADV devices, menus are implemented as MEAP application. Therefore the
User
User Area
Area User
User Area
Area
following items can be also backed up (stored as Meapbackup.bin).
MEAP Application Area MEAP Application Area • Setting items of each menu in the main menu ( Copy, Scan and Send, Fax, Scan and
Store, Access Stored Files, Fax/I-Fax Inbox, ).
• Favorite settings
• Default settings
F-2-228
• Settings of option shortcuts
The procedures for backing up and restoring the MEAP application area are the same with
• Previous settings
conventional devices.
• Settings of quick menu
• Button size information
●● Data storage area when adding an HDD to Flash model • Wallpaper settings
When an HDD is added to Flash model, most of the data on the MEAP application area on • Quick menu button information
the user area that exists on the Flash PCB is automatically copied to the HDD. It is therefore • Restrict quick menu use
unnecessary to back up/recover the data when adding an HDD.

Flash PCB
System
System Area
Area

User
User Area
Area
MEAP Application Area
Flash PCB
System
System Area
Area

User
User Area
Area
Add
Add HDD
HDD
HDD
User
User Area
Area
MEAP Application Area
MEAP Application Area

F-2-229

2-152
2
2
2-153
■■Requirements for Backup Using the SST ■■Procedure for backing up the MEAP application area using SST
The following conditions must be met for use of the function: 1) Switching Login Service / Backup of Login User Information
If SSO-H is used for the login service, switch to default authentication before backing
1) Device Firmware Version up the user information. Although SST will back up local device user information, it is
Device Firmware Version for SST (Ver4.2x) recommended to export the user information just in case. For local device user information
backup, go to User Management page of SSO-H site and export the data. (The SSO-H
Boot ROM System SST
login page opens with the URL "https://<device IP address>:8443/sso/").
iR-ADV C2030/C2020 series Boot ROM is not Already supported The version supporting
equipped. since the 1st the corresponding
version. devices. CAUTION:
imageRUNNER ADVANCE Already supported Already supported The version supporting • If a hard disk of a system that uses SSO-H is formatted without changing the login
series other than iR-ADV since the 1st since the 1st the corresponding service to the default authentication, the error message “The login service must be
C2030/C2020 series version. version. devices.
set again with SMS” appears and the system cannot start up when you attempt to
T-2-84
restart the system after formatting.
2) SST Version • If this problem occurs, change the login service to SSO-H with SMS. If you cannot
Version 4.2.x or later. An earlier version will not permit the use of the function. If needed, access to SMS since you do not have the IP address of the device, start the system
upgrade the SST. with FIXIP mode -hold down the numeric keys 1 and 7 and turn the power switch on.
The IP address “172.16.1.100” will be automatically assigned for the device. Then log
3) Space for backup in to SMS specifying the address.
To back up the HDD/ the Flash PCB of the iR, the PC must have approx 1024MB of free
space at maximum. Sizes of backup files depend on actual data capacities to be backed
up. 2) Starting the device in Download Mode
Press [2] and [8] buttons at the same time on the control panel and turn on the main power
Note:
switch to start the device in Download Mode. Note that SST backup function is enabled
The backup data of Flash model cannot be recovered in HDD model.
Also, the backup data of HDD model cannot be recovered in Flash model. only in Download Mode.

3) Connecting the main unit to the PC to start SST


Connect the main unit to the PC with SST installed using the crossing cable and the like to
start SST on the PC.

2-153
2
2
2-154
4) Connecting the device using SST 6) Saving backup data
When starting SST, select the target device type as Single and click [Start] button. Upon the backup data transferred to the PC, enter an appropriate file name and click [OK]
to save the backup data on the PC.

F-2-232
When the file is successfully saved, click [OK] button, and then click [Return to Menu]
button.

F-2-230
5) Generating backup data to transfer it to the PC (uploading)
Click [Upload Data] button of SST and select “Meapback.bin” as the item to be backed up
to click [ Start ] button.

F-2-233

F-2-231

2-154
2
2
2-155
■■Procedures to Restore Backup Data Formatting and Replacing the HDD/Flash PCB
1) Connecting to the device
■■Outline
Connect the device using SST by following step 1 to step 4 of the Procedure for backing up
the MEAP application area using SST. If the Flash PCB or the HDD is broken or does not function correctly due to failure of the
system (excluding the MEAP application), it needs to be formatted or replaced.
2) Restoring backup file When the Flash PCB is replaced or when the HDD is formatted or replaced, the files of the
Click [Upload Data] button and select the data backed up in the previous step (Meapback. MEAP application stored in it will be lost, so make a backup of the MEAP application area
bin) to click [Start Restoring Data]. Note that the data backed up in a different version according to “Procedure for backing up the MEAP application area using SST” if possible. If a
cannot be restored. backup cannot be made, the MEAP application and the license files need to be reinstalled.
As for the MEAP counter information, it will not be lost because it is backed up just like the
conventional counter.

If a backup cannot be made, a special license file (a license file for installation with the
expiration date carried over from the current counter value) is required to reinstall the MEAP
application. This special license file is treated as a service tool and cannot be obtained by a
general user.
F-2-234 In order to obtain a special license file, a service technician needs to contact a person in
3) Transferring Data charge of support of a sales company.
When the data is successfully transferred, click the [OK] button shown on the screen. To When contacting the person in charge of support, the service technician also needs to
continue other jobs, click [Return to Menu] button. provide the serial number of the device and the name of the MEAP application installed.

In the support departments of regional headquarters of Canon, all license files of the
applications that have been issued are filed according to device serial numbers, enabling you
to obtain a series of license files through a single screen as long as you can identify the serial
number of the device in question.

Note:
The application that is installed with a reusable license can be reinstalled by using the
F-2-235
same license.
4) Turn off and on the main power switch of the device to gain access in SMS to check that
MEAP applications are surely restored.

5) Restore the backup data and setting saved. Note that the user information of the local
device is included in the backup data, thus does not need to be restored.

2-155
2
2
2-156
■■Formatting the HDD/Flash PCB ■■HDD/ Flash PCB replacement procedure
●● Formatting the HDD ●● Outline
Follow the following procedure to format the HDD. The procedure for replacing the HDD or the Flash PCB differs according to whether the HDD
or the Flash PCB functions normally or not.
1) Connecting to the device
Connect the device using SST by following step 1 to step 4 of "Procedure for backing up
●● If the MEAP application area cannot be backed up
the MEAP application area using SST".
If the HDD or the Flash PCB does not function correctly due to failure or for other reason,
the MEAP application area cannot be backed up. It is therefore necessary to reinstall the
2) Formatting the HDD
application after replacing the HDD or the Flash PCB. The procedure is shown below.
Select “Format HDD” from SST menu to format the HDD.

1) Preparation for replacement


Note:
HDD can be formatted also by starting Download mode using the USB memory and Copy a set of license files for reinstalling the MEAP application (special licenses and
executing formatting from the displayed menu. reusable licenses) to a laptop for service operation.
Register a set of System files, Language files, Remote UI files, HDD format files, Meap
Contents files of a target product to SST. (Make sure the compatibility of the each file
●● Formatting the Flash PCB version.)
The Flash PCB is not formatted in service work. If there is a problem in the system, solve the
problem by performing a remedy according to the error code or replacing the Flash PCB. 2) Replacing the drive
Please note that only minimum system files are installed in a Flash PCB supplied as a service Prepare the necessary service parts of the HDD/Flash PCB, and replace the drive.
part. It is therefore necessary to install (download) the system files using the SST/USB
memory when replacing the Flash PCB. 3) Formatting HDD
Format the HDD referring to Formatting the HDD if you replace the HDD.

4) Installing the system files


Use SST or USB memory drive and install(download) the System file complete set when
you replace Flash PCB.

5) Reinstalling the MEAP application


When the device has started normally, obtain the jar files of the MEAP applications from the
user, and install them using the license files for reinstallation.
Installation method is the same as normal installation.

6) Importing user information


As necessary, make login service selections and import user information.

2-156
2
2
2-157

Note: MEAP Safe Mode (level 2)


When you replace the HDD without uninstalling MEAP applications, make sure to
reinstall the previously installed applications. Unless reinstalling them, MEAP counter ■■Outline
will not be released and the message “The number of applications that can be installed
has exceeded the limit. Try to install this application after uninstalling other applications.” Use safe mode if you need to start up the system without worrying about extra applications. It
is displayed so that the installation of new applications may not be accepted. If you will start up only those system software files (including SMS) that normally start up as default
want to install new applications in this case, once reinstall the applications in-stalled files while preventing MEAP applications and the like from starting up.
before formatting and uninstall unnecessary applications.
When you have made changes and restart the device, the control panel will indicate 'MPSF'
in its lower right corner. The MEAP applications that may have been active before you shut
●● If the MEAP application area can be backed up down the equipment will not start up on their own. Make use of safe mode when restoring
If the MEAP application area can be backed up, it can be recovered after replacing the HDD the system software as when MEAP applications or services cause a fault as the result of a
or the Flash PCB, so it is not necessary to prepare the special licenses for reinstallation. conflict or wrong sequence of registration/use. You can access to SMS in this condition so
that you can take necessary measures, for example, you can stop application that may cause
1) Preparation for replacement the trouble.
Back up the MEAP application area of the device according to the procedure for backing up If default authentication has been selected, the mode of authentication remains valid;
the MEAP application area using SST. otherwise, the message "The login service must be set again with SMS" ap pears. Change
the login service as necessary.
2) Replacing the drive
Prepare the necessary service parts of the HDD/Flash PCB, and replace the drive. ■■Starting in Safe Mode
1) Startup level 2 of [SERVICE MODE] . The start procedure of [SERVICE MODE] level 2 is
3) Formatting HDD
as follows.
Format the HDD referring to Formatting the HDD if you replace the HDD.
1. Press [Settings /Registration] button n control panel.
2. Press [2] button and [8] button at the same time on control panel.
4) Installing the system files
3. Press [Settings /Registration] button.
Use SST or USB memory drive and install(download) the System file complete set when
4. [SERVICE MODE] screen is displayed.
you replace Flash PCB.
5. Press [Mode List] or [Mode List Classic] button.
6. Press [Settings /Registration] button.
5) Restorering the backup file
7. Press [2] button.
Restore the backup data referring to the Procedures to Restore Backup Data.

6) Importing user information


As necessary, make login service selections and import user information.

2-157
2
2
2-158
2) Press [COPIER] >[Option] > [USER] buttons. 4) Press the 1 key on the control panel keypad to change the setting to '1'; then, click [OK]
button.

F-2-236
3) Press or button for several times until [MEAPSAFE] button is shown. Click
[MEAPSAFE] button. F-2-238
5) Check that the notation ‘MPSF’ has appeared in the upper left corner of the screen; then,
restart the device.

F-2-237

F-2-239

2-158
2
2
2-159
■■How to cancel MEAP SAFE mode Setting HTTP port for MEAP application (level 2)
If you want to end safe mode, repeat the steps but change '1' to '0' in step -4 and restart the
■■Outline
device.
For the ports in which the MEAP application uses, the default is 8000 for the port on HTTP
Note: server, and 8443 for the port on HTTPS server. In the case that these ports have already
If accessed to SMS in MEAP SAFE mode, the device started mode is shown on the title used by the customer who is to introduce this application, the MEAP application cannot use
bar of the browser.
the HTTP (or HTTPS) server(s).
When normally started: By changing the following ports to use, however, the MEAP application can be used as well
Service Management Service : <Device Name>: <Product Name> as the existing system.

When starting in MEAP SAFE mode:


Service Management Service : <Device Name>:<Product Name>: Safe Mode ●● HTTP server
Setting value is 0 through 65535 [the value at factory shipment/after clearing RAM: 8000]

Note:
Do not use port number “8080” when PS print server unit is connected. If the port
is used, you can not see the page for RUI of the device with MEAP authentication
application. (port “8080” is reserved for redirecting from PS print server unit to device.)

●● HTTPS server
Setting value is 0 through 65535 [the value at factory shipment/after clearing RAM: 8443]

Note:
As for port on HTTPS server, it only applies to the device that supports SSL function.

F-2-240

2-159
2
2
2-160
■■Port setup procedure of HTTP Server 4) Press the port number to specify on the control panel (the numerical value input in the field
is displayed), and press [OK] button.
1) Startup level 2 of [SERVICE MODE] . The start procedure of [SERVICE MODE] level 2 is
as follows.
1. Press [Settings /Registration] button n control panel.
2. Press [2] button and [8] button at the same time on control panel.
3. Press [Settings /Registration] button.
4. [SERVICE MODE] screen is displayed.
5. 5. Press [Mode List] or [Mode List Classic] button.
6. Press [Settings /Registration] button.
7. Press [2] button.

2) Press [COPIER] >[Option] > [NETWORK] buttons.


F-2-243
5) Check to see that it is reflected in setting field, and turn off the main power, and then,
restart the device.

F-2-241
3) Press or button until [MEAP-PN] is shown on the screen. Press [MEAP-PN]
button.
F-2-244

F-2-242

2-160
2
2
2-161
■■Port setup procedure of HTTPS Server 4) Press the port number to specify on the control panel (the numerical value input in the field
is displayed), and press [OK] button.
1) Startup level 2 of [SERVICE MODE] . The start procedure of [SERVICE MODE] level2 is
as follows.
1. Press [Settings /Registration] button n control panel.
2. Press [2] button and [8] button at the same time on control panel.
3. Press [Settings /Registration] button.
4. [SERVICE MODE] screen is displayed.
5. 5. Press [Mode List] or [Mode List Classic] button.
6. Press [Settings /Registration] button.
7. Press [2] button.

2) Press [COPIER] >[Option] > [NETWORK] buttons. F-2-246


5) Check to see that it is reflected in setting field, and turn off the main power, and then,
3) Press or button until [MEAP-SSL] is shown on the screen. Press [MEAP-SSL] restart the device.
button.

F-2-247

F-2-245

2-161
2
2
2-162
Using USB Devices Operating mode
Conventional USB
Software keyboard
System driver
settings [Use MEAP application
keyboard enabled MEAP supported MEAP
■■USB Driver driver as USB input
application
(System Driver/
application
device] MEAP Driver)
●● Two types of USB drivers ON Can use USB keyboard. Cannot use USB Cannot use USB
While the USB driver that can be used in iR series is only the USB driver designed exclusively * MEAP driver Can work only on the keyboards. (Device keyboards.
(conventional conventional applications cannot be detected.)
for MEAP application (hereinafter referred to as “MEAP driver”), not only MEAP driver but
compatibility mode) that support the MEAP
also USB system driver (hereinafter referred to as “system driver”) can be used in iR-ADV application driver.
series. OFF (*default) Cannot use USB Can use USB Can use USB
System driver and MEAP driver cannot be used together. When either of them is used, the * Native driver keyboards. (Device cannot keyboards. keyboards. Via software
be detected.) keyboards only.
other driver cannot be used.
T-2-85

●● USB driver setting (iR-ADV series): Note:


System driver is active by default in iR-ADV series. When any settings changes are made, the device must be restarted.
The driver can be changed in Settings/Registration (user mode).
Usually, It is not necessary to change the setting because it is specified in the MEAP
application side. ●● Setting the USB driver for each USB device (MEAP driver preference
Only in the case of a special MEAP application, it is necessary to change the USB driver registration)
setting. If it is set to use the system driver, the conventional applications that support the MEAP
For details, refer to specifications of MEAP application side. application driver cannot use the USB input device.
Therefore, for the USB drivers used by USB devices/MEAP applications, there is setting
function (MEAP driver preference registration) to give priority to the MEAP driver.
If you register the ID of the USB device by using this function, the USB device can use the
MEAP driver despite the Additional Function settings.

Using this function requires the conditions below:


• Supported MEAP SpecVer: 26
• Describe the idVendeor(VID) and idProdutc(PID) of USB device in the manifest or activate/
deactivate the VID and PID by calling API from MEAP applications.

The driver setting that is used in a manifest file is reflected in the following timing.
When registering from a manifest file.
• The registration will be enabled when an application is activated and device is
F-2-248 restarted.
• The registration will be disabled when an application is stopped and device is
restarted.

2-162
2
2
2-163
●● Specifications for the use of USB keyboards
Note:
You can display/check the used driver setting at “USB device report print” described Characters that could be entered on the software keyboard displayed on the conventional
below regardless of whether it is registered from a manifest file or is registered from control panel can be entered using a USB connected keyboard.
API. • When the software keyboard window is displayed, characters can be entered from the USB
keyboard (in-line entry not possible).
• When the software keyboard window is not displayed, entered characters will not be
Availability for MEAP application of the USB device A (either HID keyboard or Mass Storage)
remembered.
plugged to iR device
• The characters, which can be entered from a USB keyboard, is only a character, which can
MEAP application be entered from the software keyboard.
USB Setting
Registration System driver
[Use MEAP Native System driver Application with • Even if characters are entered from the USB keyboard, the software keyboard window will
status of USB not supported/
driver for USB application supported VID/PID declared not change (the corresponding key does not invert or change color).
device A conventional
input device] application in Manifest for x • Input from the USB keyboard can be accepted at the same time as input from the software
application
Not registered OFF YES YES NO keyboard or numeric keys.
ON NO NO YES • Since the device supports Plug and Play, the USB keyboard can be disconnected/
Registered OFF NO NO YES YES connected freely. However, do not disconnect and connect during in deep sleep (when
ON NO NO YES YES in sleep with setting "low" at "the power consumption in sleep"). It is out of an operation
T-2-86
YES: USB device available NO: USB device not available guarantee to disconnect and connect the USB keyboard in deep sleep.
• When USB device is attached to iR device, iR devices do not shift to deep sleep mode.
Availability for MEAP applications of USB devices B and C (either HID keyboard or Mass • Keyboard layout changes according to the keyboard layout settings in the Settings/
Storage) plugged to iR device Registration screen. In addition, function keys and ten keys which are not displayed in the
Setting to use MEAP application software keyboard cannot be used. (Keyboard which the operation check was conducted
Registration is 84-key Keyboard, but this does not mean that the operation of all 84-key Keyboards is
MEAP driver System System driver Application
status of USB Native
(Additional driver not supported with VID/PID guaranteed.)
USB device device application
Functions supported / conventional declared in
B
mode) application application Manifest for B Note:
Registered Not used B YES YES NO The factory shipment default setting is to enable the use of native (main unit
(Native driver to C YES YES NO functionality) USB keyboards. Therefore, in order to use MEAP application keyboards,
be used) [Use MEAP driver for USB input device] under [System management settings (initial
To be used B NO NO YES settings/ registration)] needs to be set to ON (factory shipment setting is OFF).
Operations change as described below in accordance with ON/ OFF settings.
C NO NO YES • ON: when using MEAP application keyboard
Not Not used B NO NO YES YES • OFF: when using native (main unit functionality) keyboard (factory shipment default)
registered (Native driver to C YES YES NO NO
be used)
To be used B NO NO YES YES
C NO NO YES YES
T-2-87
YES: USB device available NO: USB device not available

2-163
2
2
2-164
■■Initialization of MEAP driver priority registration 4) Press [OK] button to restart this device.

When any trouble occurs regarding USB driver settings and it is necessary to reset the setting
information, you can reset the MEAP driver preference registration by using service mode.

●● Steps to initialize preference use registration


1) Start [SERVICE MODE] in Level 1.
2) Press [COPIER] > [Function] > [CLEAR] > button.

F-2-251

■■USB Device report print


To check the vendor IDs (idVendor) and the product IDs (idProduct) registered in this device
by means of declaration in Manifest file of MEAP applications, output the USB Device repot
report print.

●● Steps to output the USB Device report print


1) Start [SERVICE MODE] in Level 1.

F-2-249 2) Press [COPIER] > [Function] > [MISC-P] > button.


3) Press or button for several times until [USBM-CLR] is shown on the screen.
Press [USBM-CLR] button.

F-2-252

F-2-250

2-164
2
2
2-165
3) Press or button for several times until [USBH-PRT] is shown. Press [USBH-PRT] Example of output result
button.
********************************
*** USB Device report print ***
********************************

USB device information

T: Bus=05 Lev=01 Prnt=01 Port=01 Cnt=01 Dev#= 4 Spd=480 MxCh= 0


D: Ver=2.00 Cls=00(>ifc) Sub=00 Prot=00 MxPS=64 #Cfgs= 1
P: Vendor=04bb ProdID=0c2a Rev=bb.03
S: Manifacturer=I-O DATA
S: Product=USB Flash Disk
S: SerialNumber=A0C0470407000073
C:* #Ifs= 1 Cfg#= 1 Atr=80 MxPwr=200mA
I: If#= 0 Alt=0 #EPs=2 Cls=08(stor.) Sub=06 Prot=50 Driver=sub-storage
F-2-253 E: Ad=81(I) Atr=02(Bulk) MxPS=512 Ivl=0ms
4) When pressing [OK] button, [ACTIVE] blinks on the status field. E: Ad=02(O) Atr=02(Bulk) MxPS=512 Ivl=31875us

MEAP oreferred device information

AppID=8c72686b-29c2-46c5-a07a-a6c4177a6le3 VID=04A9 PID=2680


AppID=8c72686b-29c2-46c5-a07a-a6c4177a6le3 VID=1234 PID=5678
AppID=8c72686b-29c2-46c5-a07a-a6c4177a6le3 VID=4321 PID=8765

Application ID Vendor ID Product ID

F-2-254
F-2-256
5) When [OK] is shown on the status field, the status print is output. Check the contents of the
print.
●● USB device information Content
Display the information of the USB device, which the device recognized.
If not displayed, there may be some fault occurred.
Some of standard optional devices are not displayed on a report.
The details of each item are as follows.

T : Topology
Internal hierarchical structure, which a USB device is connected, is shown. The number of a
connected bus, the hierarchical structure and connection speed can be indicated.

D : Device
Information of USB devices is shown.
F-2-255

2-165
2
2
2-166
P : Product Right or wrong of report output
Product information of USB devices is shown. Vendor ID and Product ID can be recognized
Connecting device User installation Report printing
here.
HID Available Yes
S : String Storage Available Yes
The character string embedded in a USB device is shown. A manufacture name and a FAX Not available No
product name can be recognized here. USB Device Port IrDA Not available Yes
Multimedia Card Reader Not available Yes
C : Configure
The configuration information of a USB device is shown. * mark is to know whether it is IC Card Reader Not available Yes

active. Image Data Analyzer Board-A1 Not available No


Hub Internal Hub* Not available No
I : Interface
External Hub Available Yes
The interface information of a USB device is shown. Interface class and the driver to handle T-2-89
can be recognized.
* USB Device Port-B1 Hub for device ports installed at the introduction

The value and the content of Driver are as follows.


●● The content of MEAP preferred device information
Labeling Content
Display the information of the application or a USB device, which preferentially registered with
usbhid It is displayed when the USB system driver is assigned to the input device
MEAP application.
connected.
By seeing this information, it can check which Application ID of the MEAP application is in the
usb-storage It is displayed when storage devices (USB memory storage etc.) are connected.
status using a specific USB device.
irda-usb IrDA It is displayed when the dongle is connected.
hub It is displayed when HUB is connected.
AppID : Application ID
gpusb It is displayed when the USB driver only for MEAP application is assigned to the
VID : Vendor ID
input device connected.
PID : Product ID
gpusbex It is displayed when a USB device, which specific vendor ID/ Product ID are
preferentially registered using a manifest and MEAP API, is connected and the
USB driver only for MEAP application is assigned.
T-2-88

E:Endpoint
The Endpoint information of a USB device is shown.

2-166
2
2
2-167
Reference material Terms & Acronyms Definitions and Explanations
J2ME Java 2 Platform Micro Edition. One of Java Platforms licensed by Sun
■■Glossary (Java2 Platform Micro Microsystems, Inc. It is applied for MEAP. Other devices such as cellular
Edition) phones and PDA.
Terms & Acronyms Definitions and Explanations
J2RE A set of basic programs to run applications developed in the programming
Application A program unit to provide users with solutions. (Java 2 Runtime language of Java2. This set includes Java virtual machine providing
Application ID An identifier assigned to each application. Environment) runtime environment for Java applications among others. Java applets do
A unique ID is assigned to each MEAP application. not require J2RE since these are executed on Web browsers using Java
runtime environment provided on browsers. However, standalone Java
Applet (Applet Type A MEAP application type created in Java.
applications require Java runtime environment such as J2RE for execution.
Application) This type of applications show buttons on the touch panel display.
Runtime environments can be downloaded for free of charge from the Web
Code Sign Information to check if an application is genuine. An application marketed site of Sun Microsystems, the Java developer.
in the normal procedure has a code sign assigned by LMS. MEAP platform
Java A programming language developed by Sun Microsystems, in the U. S. A.
rejects applications without Canon code signs for being installed or
Low dependent on models and OSes and runs on various platforms. Taking
executed on the device.
advantage of this feature, many applications that runs on web servers uses
CPCA Common Peripheral Controlling Architecture. CPCA defines an object Java. The MEAP platform uses J2ME - a type of Java.
(Common Peripheral model of peripheral deices. A client can control a device by creating or
JavaScript A script language developed by Netscape Communications, in the U.S. A.,
Controlling modifying objects in the device.
runs on web browsers such as Netscape Navigator and Internet Explorer.
Architecture)
Allows web designers to create interactive pages with HTML files such as
CPCA Java CL CPCA Java Class Library. A Java class library, which is used to control a animated buttons and display of timetables.
(Class Library) device.
Java VM JAVA Virtual Machine. The Java byte code interpreter. The Virtual Machine
Default Authentication The login service used when the department ID control is used but other (Java Virtual Machine) acts as an interpreter for processing the byte code using the native
-Department ID authentication controls are not used. When the Department ID control is instruction set.
Management turned on, the login dialog prompts the users to enter the department ID
License Access A number issued for accessing license file. The Licensing server requires
and password. The dialog appears the initial screen of both the control
Number entries of application ID, expiration date/times information, and the number
panel on the MEAP device and Remote UI
of access numbers, to issue license access numbers
Device Specification ID allocated to each device type. This represents CPCA API specification
Licensae File A software manufacture of a MEAP application provides the users with the
ID and the version number to use MFP generic functions or obtain information
license files. Specifies the terms of agreement that a user concludes with
including maximum allowable copies.
the manufacturer. Required for installing a MEAP application.
Esplet A MEAP application type created in Java. This type of applications do
LMS The license is required for installing a MEAP application in a MEAPenabled
(Esplet Type not show user interfaces either on Local UI or Web. Esplet is a coined
(License Management iR device. LMS is the server issuing [License Files] as well as license
Application) word created by Canon, consisting of [Espresso] or Italian coffee and [let]
System) access numbers.
derived from Applet/Service.
Login Service Manages user information of MEAP device. Authenticates users with user
File Description An identifier for the OS to identify the destination file requested by a
names and passwords. Three login services are available for MEAP device
program. A program descriptor includes an identifier and information such
- Default Authentication, which provides department ID control, SDL (Simple
as a file name and size, which helps OS to judge the file to be edited.
Device Login) and SSO (Single Sign-On).
HID class HID stands for Human Interface Device, representing man-machine
Mass Storage class Mass Storage means a storage device with large capacity, generally
interfaces of PC components and peripheral devices. HID class means
secondary storage devices. Mass Storage class means USB class
USB class classified as HID.
classified in the secondary storage device group.
iR Native application The functionalities that existing imageRUNNER has such as Copy,
MEAP (Multifunction Multifunctional Embedded Application Platform. Provides an environment
Universal Send and Mailbox.
Embedded Application for executing application programs on a peripheral device. Uses the Java
ISV Independent Software Vender. Software manufacturer who develops and/or Platform) platform (J2ME - Java 2 platform Micro Edition) to run Java application for
(Independent sells applications and tools but does not entire computer systems. Refers MEAP.
Software Vendor) application developer in this document.
MEAP Contents Required to install an MEAP application to a MEAP device.

2-167
2
2
2-168
Terms & Acronyms Definitions and Explanations Terms & Acronyms Definitions and Explanations
MEAP Specifications MEAP Spec Version, the term used for the SDK. The version number that SDK The kit containing information and tools required for software development.
(MEAP Spec Version) shows the APIs of the MEAP platform other than CPCA, such as network (Software
and security. The version number is not assigned for each device model. Development Kit)
MEAP Application Runs on MEAP platform. Consists of application files Service A functional unit or an application program working on MEAP platform.
(*.jar) and the license file (*.lic). [Applications] are generally termed [Services] in Java world.
MEAP-enabled iR imageRUNNER (iR) devices with built-in MEAP platform. Servlet A MEAP application type created in Java. This type of applications is
device (Servlet Type designed to show user interface on the Web browser.
MFP Multi Function Peripheral. Peripheral device that supports more than one Application)
(Multi Function function, such as digital copier, printer, scanner, and fax. SMS The web-base service to provide user interfaces for application life cycle
Peripheral) (Service Management management.
OSGi Open Service Gateway Initiative. See "http://www.osgi.org/". Service)
(Open Service Socket A virtual interface of an application for network communication. A user
Gateway Initiative) only needs to specify a socket as a unit of an address and a port from an
Portal Service The web portal to gain access to a MEAP-enabled device. This service has application. This establishes the network connection for data transmission,
been integrated in Remote UI top page in iR ADVANCE series. eliminating complication related to detailed communication procedures.
Protocol A set of rules applied to data transmission procedures over network. Major SSO-H (Single Sign- Login service providing features of both local device authentication
communication protocols include: On H) and domain authentication. The former is the method that iR device
• FTP: File Transfer Protocol. This is a communication protocol or independently authorizes users; whereas the latter is that iR device links to
protocolimplemented commands to provide file transfer between a host the domain controller on the network in the Active Directory environment to
and clients over TCP/IP network. authorize users.
• DHCP: An upward compatible protocol of BOOTP. This communication Thread A unit for program execution. A multi-task system allowing multiple
protocol allocates a dynamic IP address to each client machine upon programs to run concurrently assigns a memory space and other resources
communication startup on TCP/IP network and collects the allocated IP independently to each program, providing users with a feel as if only a
address when communication is completed. The server allocates one of program is running. At least one thread is generated upon a program
multiple IP addresses and notifies the setup information to a client. generated.
• BOOTP: A communication protocol to automatically load setup
information including IP address and a domain name from the server to a URL The method to denote Web page locations on Internet and the like. For
client on TCP/IP network. (Uniform Resource instance, a URL on the Web is denoted as [http://www.w3.org/default. html].
• RARP: A communication protocol to request IP address information via Locator) [http] at the beginning means that an address following this is in a web
the network adaptor address (MAC address) of a client. page on the Internet.
• IPP: A communication protocol to execute remote printing between the USB Abbreviation of Universal Serial Bus. This is the interface standard to link
print server and clients via Internet. between information devices.
• TCP/IP: A standard communication protocol required to access to
USB system driver The general-purpose driver that control the behavior of the device, there
Internet and other large-scale network.
are HID class driver, Mass Storage class driver and so on.
Proxy Server Provides functions to store data fetched from remote servers. When a T-2-90
user request to display a web page that has been displayed and stored
in the proxy, the proxy server read the stored data but does not access
the remote server where the original page is present, for efficient access
services. When a proxy server receives a URL from a PC, it searches the
file in the cache and sends it to the PC if the requested file is found. If the
requested file is not stored in the cache, it accesses the remote server of
the URL to acquire the file and, at the same time, stores the acquired file
in the cache so that the proxy server can quickly send the file at the next
request.
Redistribution module A built-in module of an application created with SDK. Applications without
this module cannot work on MEAP platform.

2-168
2
2
2-169
Option for exclusive individual measure ■■Error at starting up the MEAP application/Setting to hide JAM
■■Display Setting of Copy Icon (level2) screen (level 2)
Make a setting as to whether to display/hide the copy screen (copy tab) on the control panel. In the case that operation is restricted by MEAP application, hide the warning screen of error/
This is the specification for users who want to customize hiding it on control panel. JAM (such as JAM screen, door opening, no-toner). In the case that these errors occur, there
will be a display indicating 'call the service personnel' etc.
Default value
Note:
1: display
Part of the warning screens is displayed if shifting to the device screen.
Setting range, item • As for the screens for jam and no-toner, the warning screen (animation) can be displayed
0: hide 1: display by pressing the followings: [Device Screen] > [Recovery Procedure]
• As for the screen for door opening, the warning screen cannot be displayed because
there is no display for [[Device Screen] > [Recovery Procedure]
●● Setting Procedure
1) Press [Settings /Registration] button n control panel.
2) Press [2] button and [8] button at the same time on control panel. Default value
3) Press [Settings /Registration] button. 1: No activation of warning display
4) [SERVICE MODE] screen is displayed.
5) Press [Mode List] or [Mode List Classic] button. Setting range, item
6) Press [Settings /Registration] button. 0: display warning screen 1: hide warning screen
7) Press [2] button.
8) Press [COPIER] button. ●● Setting Procedure
9) Press [Option] button. 1) Press [Settings /Registration] button n control panel.
10) Press [DSPLY-SW] button. 2) Press [2] button and [8] button at the same time on control panel.
11) Press or (arrow) button. 3) Press [Settings /Registration] button.
12) Press [UI-COPY]. 4) [SERVICE MODE] screen is displayed.
13) Press either 0 (hide) or 1 (display) on control panel (the numerical value input in the field 5) Press [Mode List] or [Mode List Classic] button.
is displayed), and press [OK] button.
6) Press [Settings /Registration] button.
14) Check to see that it is reflected in setting field, and restart the device.
7) Press [2] button.
8) Press [COPIER] button.
9) Press [Option] button.
10) Press [DSPLY-SW] button.
11) Press or (arrow) button.
12) Press [ANIM-SW] button.
13) Press either 0 (display warning screen) or 1 (hide warning screen) on control panel (the
numerical value input in the field is displayed), and press [OK] button.
14) Check to see that it is reflected in setting field, and restart the device.

2-169
2
2
2-170
■■Setting of Screen Transition from MEAP Screen to the Standard
Screen (level2)
In the case that the operation is restricted by MEAP application, make a setting to hide Native
applications such as Copy/Send/Box. With this setting, disable screen transition with => key.
Default value
0: OFF (transit to Native screen)
Setting range, item
0: OFF (transit to Native screen) 1: ON (No-transition to Native screen)

●● Setting Procedure
1) Press [Settings /Registration] button n control panel.
2) Press [2] button and [8] button at the same time on control panel.
3) Press [Settings /Registration] button.
4) [SERVICE MODE] screen is displayed.
5) Press [Mode List] or [Mode List Classic] button.
6) Press [Settings /Registration] button.
7) Press [2] button.3) Press [COPIER] button.
8) Press [Option] button.
9) Press [DSPLY-SW] button.
10) Press or (arrow) button.
11) Press [MEAP-DSP] button.
12) Press either 0 (transit to Native screen) or 1 (no-transition to Native screen) on control
panel (the numerical value input in the field is displayed), and press [OK] button.
13) Check to see that it is reflected in setting field, and restart the device.

2-170
2
2
2-171

Embedded RDS ■■Features and benefits


E-RDS embedded with a network module in advance can realize a front-end processing
Product Overview of e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system without attaching any extra hardware
equipment.
■■Overview
Embedded RDS (hereafter, referred to as E-RDS, which stands for EMBEDDED-RDS) ■■Major Functions
is a network module embedded with a customer’s device and enables e-Maintenance/
●● Service Call Button
imageWARE Remote (Remote Diagnosis System), which can collect and transmit status
If a user touches Service call button when corrupt image, paper jam, or/ and other problems
changes, counter values, error logs, and consumable information such as the toner low/ out
has occurred, E-RDS generates an alarm and notifies it to UGW.
of the device to a remote maintenance server called UGW (Universal Gateway Server) via
Moreover, E-RDS also notifies cancellation and the completion of the request
Internet.

The following device information/ status can be monitored. ●● Service Browser


• Service mode counter (Billing counts) Service browser is a web browsing functionality only for service persons in charge, and is
• Global click counter used for referring to the FAQ contents which is connected to UGW.
• Parts counter To grasp a device of which service browser has been enabled, E-RDS sends browser
• Mode counter information to UGW in the following cases.
• Firmware info • When the service browser is enabled in the condition where it had been disabled (OFF)
• Environment log • When a license for Web Browser option is entered/ transferred
• Service call error log
• Jam log
●● Service mode menu Transmission
• Alarm log
E-RDS sends the target service mode menu data to UGW in the following cases:
• Status changes (Toner low/ out, etc.)
• When a specific alarm and service call error are detected
• When the setting is changed in service mode
Since high confidentiality is required for the information shown above, it performs
communication between a device and the UGW using HTTPS/ SOAP protocol.
The following shows the transmission timing and the target data for transmission in service
mode menu:
Communication with UGW using HTTPS / SOAP Transmission timing Transmitting data Error retry
When the following alarm is detected. COPIER Display ANALOG No
Internet HV-STS
Alarm codes for transmission: CCD
UGW
0x060002,                     // Fixing
DPOT
0x060004 - 0x069999,  // Fixing
DENS
0x090005 - 0x099999,  // Dram
FIXING
Firewall

DNS Server Proxy Server 0x100006 - 0x109999,  // Development


0x300001 - 0x309999   // High voltage SENSOR
Device
MISC
Intranet
HT-C
HV-TR
The e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system using E-RDS
F-2-257 P-PASCAL

2-171
2
2
2-172
Transmission timing Transmitting data Error retry Limitations
When the following service call error is detected. COPIER Display ANALOG No

Error codes for transmission:


HV-STS ■■Service Mode Menu Transmission Function
CCD
E000 - E00F,  // Fixing 1) At the time of transmission when an alarm/ service call error is detected, even if the alarm
DPOT
E020,              // Development ATR
DENS log or service call log detected is the target code for service mode menu transmission,
E060 - E06F   // High voltage
FIXING transmission of service mode menu data is not performed in the following cases.
SENSOR • An alarm log or service call log which has been detected by E-RDS as an unsent log
MISC
at the time of power-on
HT-C
• An alarm log or service call log waiting for retry after its transmission failed
HV-TR
P-PASCAL • When service mode menu transmission (when an alarm log or service call error was
When a value is set to [COPIER - Adjust] COPIER Adjust Yes detected) failed
subordinate’s Service mode menu. • Service mode menu data of which processing for acquisition has been already
(Transmission will be done at 60 min, later of
performed when an alarm or service call error subject to service mode menu
setting)
transmission occurred
When the first communication test is done. COPIER Display ANALOG Yes
(For transmission process, 5 minutes after the HV-STS
execution) 2) When an alarm/ service call error occurred continuously AND when time correction/ change
CCD
DPOT was performed to the device main unit during the target log transmission processing, a link
DENS number may be applied to the old log although it should be applied to the new log.
FIXING
SENSOR 3) Transmission of the data of changes made in service mode menu settings is not performed
MISC instantly, but performed when a specified period of 60 minutes elapse after the change of
HT-C
service mode menu settings is detected or when a communication test is performed at the
HV-TR
time of power-on. (There is a time lag.)
P-PASCAL
Adjust
T-2-91 4) When service mode menu settings ([COPIER] > [Adjust]) are made, transmission is
performed even when no change is made in the target data to be transmitted.
NOTE: Transmission of service mode data is also performed when changes are made in the
Target transmission data are only the items under LEVEL1 and 2 in the service mode. service mode setting value not subject to transmission (items other than Level 1, 2) or
when settlement of a value is performed without changing the setting value.
.

2-172
2
2
2-173
Service cautions E-RDS Setup
1) After performing the following service actions, it is necessary to perform initializing E-RDS ■■Confirmation and preparation in advance
settings (ERDS-DAT) and communication test (COM-TEST).
To monitor a device with e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote, the following settings are
Failure to do so will result that the counter transmitting value to the UGW may become
required.
unusual.
• System upgrade
(1) Advance confirmation
• HDD format and system installation
Confirm with the UGW administrator that the device to be monitored with e-Maintenance/
• RAM clear of MNCON PCB SRAM Board :
imageWARE Remote is registered in the UGW.
[SERVICE MODE] > [COPIER] > [Function] > [CLEAR] > [MN-CON]
Also, after replacing the main controller board, all settings must be reprogrammed.

(2) Advance preparations


Interview the user’s system administrator in advance to find out the following information
2) The following settings in service mode must not be change unless there are specific
about the network.
instructions to do so. Changing these values will cause error in communication with UGW.
• Set port number of UGW
Information item 1
[SERVICE MODE] > [COPIER] > [Function] > [INSTALL] > [RGW-PORT]
IP address settings
Default : 443
• Automatic setting : DHCP, RARP, BOOTP
• Manual setting : IP address, subnet mask and gateway address to be set
• URL setting of UGW
[SERVICE MODE] > [COPIER] > [Function] > [INSTALL] > [RGW-ADR]
Information item 2
Default : https://a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif010
Is there a DNS server in use?
If there is a DNS server in use, find out the following.
• Primary DNS server address
• Secondary DNS server address

Information item 3
Is there a proxy server?
If there is a proxy server in use, find out the following.
• Proxy server address
• Port No. for proxy server

Information item 4
Is proxy server authentication required?
If proxy server authentication is required, find out the following.
• User name and password required for proxy authentication

2-173
2
2
2-174
(3) Network settings 3. When DNS settings and proxy settings are not made, touch the [Close] button to
Based on the results of the information obtained in (2) Advance preparations, make the reboot the device.
device network related settings in accordance with the following procedures.

1) Displaying the Settings/ Registration screen


1. Touch the [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] button.
2. When a system management department ID and system management password are
set up, touch the [Log In] button and enter the System Management ID and System
PIN to perform a log-in.

F-2-260

3) DNS Settings
1. Select [TCP/IP Settings] from breadcrumbs of the left columns, and then Touch it.
F-2-258
2) Setting IP address-related items
1. Touch the [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [IPv4 Settings] > [IP
Address Settings] buttons.
2. Set the IP address based on the result obtained in “(2) Advance preparations -
Information item 1”, and touch the [OK] button.
• For automatic acquisition, select from [DHCP], [RARP], [BOOTP].
• For manual setting, set the IP address, subnet mask and gateway address.

F-2-261

2. Touch the [TCP/IP Settings] > [DNS Settings] > [DNS Server Address Settings]
buttons.

F-2-259

2-174
2
2
2-175
3. Set the DNS server address based on the result obtained in “(2) Advance preparations 4) Proxy Settings
- Information item 2” and touch the [OK] button. 1. Select [TCP/IP Settings] from breadcrumbs of the left columns, and then Touch it.
• Select [Primary DNS Server] and make settings.
• When the secondary DNS server is installed, select [Secondary DNS Server] and
make settings.

F-2-264

2. Touch the [TCP/IP Settings] > [Proxy Settings].

F-2-262 3. Set the proxy server based on the result obtained in “(2) Advance preparations -
Information item 3”.
4. When proxy settings are not made, touch the [Close] button to reboot the device. a) Use Proxy to [On].
b) Enter the server address.
c) Enter port Number (Validation: 1 to 65,535).

a)
b)
c)

d)

F-2-263

F-2-265

d) If proxy server authentication is required, Touch [Set Authentication].(see figure


above)

2-175
2
2
2-176
e) Set the following items based on the result obtained in “(2) Advance preparations 4. Touch the [Close] button.
- Information item 4”.
• Set Use Proxy Authentication to [On].
• Enter User name and Password, and touch the [OK] button.

F-2-268

5. Reboot the device.


F-2-266
CAUTION:
f) Touch the [OK] button. When changes are made to the above-mentioned network settings, be sure to reboot
the device.

F-2-267

2-176
2
2
2-177
■■E-RDS-related setting items (service mode) ●● SERVICE CALL BUTTON setting items
Item Description
●● E-RDS setting items
SCALL-SW Display/ hide of Service Call button
Item Description ([Lv.1] COPIER > Option > USER) 0: Hide / 1: Display
E-RDS Set use/ no use of Embedded-RDS function To set whether to display or hide the Service Call button on
([Lv.1] COPIER > Function > INSTALL) 0: Function not used / 1: Function used the Control Panel.
e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system to send Default : 0 (Hide)
device information, counter data, error statuses to the SCALLCMP Set of service call completion notice
UGW. ([Lv.1] COPIER > Option > USER) When this item is set, service call completion is notified
Note that the operation (such as global click counter, error to UGW and the service call status retained internally is
information, etc.) can be restricted with the server settings. cleared.
Default : 0 (Function not used) Default : 0
RGW-ADR URL setting of UGW T-2-93
([Lv.1] COPIER > Function > INSTALL) Max 128 characters
Default : https://a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif01
RGW-PORT Set port number of UGW ●● SERVICE BROWSER setting items
([Lv.1] COPIER > Function > INSTALL) Validation : 1 to 65535
Item Description
Default : 443
BRWS-ACT Execution of activation/ inactivation of service browsing
COM-TEST Execution of a communication test with UGW / Display of
([Lv.1] COPIER > Function > INSTALL) Browsing info is sent to UGW when OFF (BRWS-ACT=0) is
([Lv.1] COPIER > Function > INSTALL) the result
changed to ACTIVE.
Perform Communication test with UGW and set "OK!" or
Setting result is displayed as "OK!" or "NG!".
"NG!" as the result.
BRWS-STS Display of Service Browser use status
COM-LOG Display of detailed information about a communication error
([Lv.1] COPIER > Display > USER) 0: OFF / 1: Active / 2: Suspend
([Lv.1] COPIER > Function > INSTALL) with UGW
The status is changed from 0 to 1, from 1 to 2, and from 2
Error information of a connection failure with UGW is
to 1 by execution of BRWS-ACT.
displayed.
Default : 0 (OFF)
Error occurrence date and time, error code, and detailed
T-2-94
error information are displayed.
Max 30 latest loggings retained
Max 128 characters for Error information. NOTE:
ERDS-DAT Initialization of E-RDS SRAM data Generally, once service browsing is enabled, it cannot be disabled again.
([Lv.1] COPIER > Function > CLEAR) SRAM data of E-RDS is initialized and returned to the To disable service browsing, clear SRAM.
factory setting value at shipment.
CA-KEY Initialization of CA certificate
([Lv.2] COPIER > Function > CLEAR) When the power is turned OFF/ ON after execution, the CA
certificate in the factory setting is automatically installed.
T-2-92

2-177
2
2
2-178
■■Steps to E-RDS settings 2. Select [COPIER] > [Function] > [CLEAR] > [ERDS-DAT] and touch the [OK] button.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1. NOTE:


1) Press [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel. This operation initializes the E-RDS settings to factory setting values.
2) Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel. For the setting values to be initialized, see the section of “Initializing E-RDS settings”.
3) Press [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4) [Service Mode] screen is shown. Touch the [Mode List] button.

F-2-270

F-2-269

NOTE:
When [Mode List] is selected, touching the button at the center of the lower side of
the screen displays explanation of each item or detailed operation guide.In case of [Mode
List Classic], this button is not appeared.

2-178
2
2
2-179
3. Perform installation or deletion of the CA certificate if necessary, and reboot the device. “OK!” is displayed if the CA certificate is initialized. When “NG!” is displayed, see the
• Installation of the CA certificate: Perform installation from SST. section of “Troubleshooting” to execute the remedy, and then perform initialization of
• Deletion of the CA certificate: When the following operation is performed, the CA certificate the CA certificate again and check to see if the CA certificate is initialized.
in the factory setting is automatically installed.
(1) Start [Service Mode] at Level 2.
1) Press [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2) Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3) Press [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4) Touch the [Mode List] button on the [Service Mode] screen.
5) Press [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
6) Press [2] button on the control panel.

(2) Select [COPIER] > [Function] > [CLEAR] > [CA-KEY] and touch the [OK] button.

F-2-272

(3) Reboot the device.

4. Activate [SERVICE MODE] in LEVEL 1. (See 1. for the procedure.)

5. Select [COPIER] > [Function] > [INSTALL] > [E-RDS].

F-2-271

F-2-273

2-179
2
2
2-180
6. Touch the numeric button [1] on the control panel (the setting value is changed to 1) and 7. Select [COM-TEST] and then touch [OK].
touch the [OK] button. (The data is reflected to the setting value field.)
NOTE:
NOTE: This initiates the communication test between the device and the UGW.
This operation enables the communication function with UGW.

F-2-274

F-2-275
CAUTION:
If the communication is successful, “OK!” is displayed. If “NG!” (failed) appears, refer to the
The following settings i.e. RGW-PORT and RGW-ADR in Service mode must not be
“Troubleshooting“ and repeat until “OK!” is displayed.
change unless there are specific instructions to do so.
Changing these values will cause error in communication with UGW.

F-2-276

NOTE:
The communication results with UGW can be distinguished by referring to the COM-
LOG. By performing the communication test with UGW, E-RDS acquires schedule
information and starts monitoring and meter reads operation.

2-180
2
2
2-181
■■Steps to Service Call button settings NOTE:
When the function is enabled, the [Service Call] button is displayed on the bottom of the
●● Steps for settings to display the service call button counter check screen (displayed by touching the counter check button).
In the case of supporting a service by the service call button, follow the instructions described
below to display the service call button.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


For the procedures, see “Steps to E-RDS settings - step 1.“.

2. Select [COPIER] > [Option] > [USER] > [SCALL-SW].

●● Steps for settings of service call completion


When the service technician completes the work for the service call, follow the instruction as
described below to execute the service call completion work.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


F-2-277
For the procedures, see “Steps to E-RDS settings - step 1.“.

3. Touch the numeric button [1] on the control panel (the setting value is changed to 1) and
2. Select [COPIER] > [Option] > [USER] > [SCALLCMP].
touch the [OK] button. (The data is reflected to the setting value field.)

F-2-278

F-2-279

2-181
2
2
2-182
3. Touch the numeric button [1] on the control panel (the setting value is changed to 1) and 2. Touch the [Select/ Request] button.
touch the [OK] button. (The data is reflected to the setting value field.)

NOTE:
E-RDS generates an alarm of service call completion at this timing, and sends the
alarm to UGW.

F-2-282

CAUTION:
F-2-280
When a service call has been already requested, another service call cannot be sent.
The previous service call needs to be canceled, or a service person needs to perform
●● Steps for service call request processing for service call completion.
Users should follow the instructions as described below to request a service call.

1. Touch the [Counter Check] button on the control panel to display the counter check screen, 3. Select the request details and touch the [Request] button.
and touch the [Service Call] button.
NOTE:
E-RDS generates an alarm of service call request at this timing, and sends the alarm to
UGW.

F-2-281

F-2-283

2-182
2
2
2-183
●● Steps for service call cancellation ■■Steps to Service Browser settings
To cancel the service call, follow the instructions as described below.
1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.
1. Touch the [Counter Check] button on the control panel to display the counter check screen, For the procedures, see “Steps to E-RDS settings - step 1.“.
and touch the [Service Call] button.
2. Select [COPIER] > [Function] > [INSTALL] > [BRWS-ACT] and then touch [OK].

NOTE:
E-RDS sends browser information to UGW at this timing.

F-2-284

2. Touch the [Cancel] button, and touch the [Yes] button in the check screen.

NOTE:
F-2-286
E-RDS generates an alarm of service call cancellation at this timing, and sends the
alarm to UGW. If the connection is established with UGW successfully, “OK!” is displayed. When “NG!” is
displayed, perform the steps referring to “Troubleshooting” until connection is established
with UGW.

F-2-285

F-2-287

2-183
2
2
2-184
3. Reboot the device. ■■Initializing E-RDS settings
It is possible to return E-RDS Settings to factory-shipments value.
4. Make sure that “1 (: ACTIVE)” is set under [COPIER] > [Display] > [USER] > [BRWS-STS].

●● Initialization procedure
1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.
For the procedures, see “Steps to E-RDS settings - step 1.“.

2. Select [COPIER] > [Function] > [CLEAR] > [ERDS-DAT] and then touch [OK].

F-2-288

5. When the above-shown setting values are enabled, [Service Browser] is displayed in the
Service Mode screen.

F-2-290

●● Setting values and data to be initialized


The following E-RDS settings, internal data, and Alarm filtering information are initialized.
• COPIER > Function > INSTALL > E-RDS
• COPIER > Function > INSTALL > RGW-ADR
• COPIER > Function > INSTALL > RGW-PORT
• COPIER > Function > INSTALL > COM-LOG

CAUTION:
In case of replacing the CA certificate file, even if initialization of E-RDS is executed, the
F-2-289 status is not returned to the factory default.
When installing the certificate file other than the factory default CA certificate file, it is
required to delete the certificate file after E-RDS initialization and install the factory
default CA certificate file.
For detailed procedures, see "Steps to E-RDS settings - step 3.".

2-184
2
2
2-185
FAQ In the case that the device is rebooted while the retry information is specified, however,
another browser information is obtained to be sent.
No.1
Q: In what case does a communication test with UGW fail? NOTE:
A: The following cases can be considered in the becoming “NG!“ case. The retry data will be sent at interval of 5*n minutes. (n: retries, 5, 10, 15 minutes…up
to 30 minutes)
1. Name resolution was failed due to an incorrect host name or DNS server has been
halted.
2. Network cable is blocked off.
No.4
3. Proxy server settings is not correct.
Q: How many log-data can be stored?
A: Up to 30 log data can be saved. The data size of error information is maximum 128
No.2
characters.
Q: I want to know the interval of data transmitting from E-RDS to the UGW, and what data
size is sent to the UGW?
No.5
A: The schedule of data transmitting, the start time are determined by settings in the UGW
Q: Although Microsoft ISA as a proxy server is introduced, the authentication check is failed.
side. The timing is once per 16 hours by default, and counter data volume could be maximum
Can E-RDS adopt with Microsoft ISA?
250 bytes.
A: E-RDS must comply with “Basic” while “Integrated” authentication is used for Microsoft
ISA (as default); therefore, authentication with E-RDS is available if you change the setting to
No.3
“Basic” authentication on the server.
Q: Does error-retry carry out at the time of a communication error with the UGW?
A: Retry of SOAP communication is performed as follows.
No.6
• In the case of an error in SOAP communication (i.e. a trouble at UGW side) at transmission
Q: Can I turn the device power off during the e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system
of the alarm code list and the service mode counter (postAlert) due to change of device
operation?
status, the data failed in transmission equivalent to 3 retries is to be stored in the HDD. In
A: While operating the e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system, the power of the device
the case of anther transmission error (the 4th error), the oldest data of the stored data is
must be ON. If power OFF is needed, do not leave the device power OFF for long time.
deleted and the newly-generated retry data is stored in the HDD.
It will become “Device is busy, try later” errors if the power supply of network equipment such
• In the case of SOAP transmission errors as described below, the unsent (and remaining)
as HUB is made prolonged OFF.
data is sent again depending on the storage status of CPCA data:
• At transmission of a jam log and service mode counter (postJamLog) when the jam
No.7
log was obtained from the device.
Q: Although a Service call error may not be notified to UGW, the reason is what?
• At transmission of a service call log and service mode counter (postServiceCallLog)
A: If a service technician in charge turns off the power supply of a device immediately after
when the service log was obtained from the device.
error occurred once, It may be unable to notify to UGW because data processing does not
• At transmission of an alarm log and service mode counter (postAlarmLog) when the
take a time from the controller of the device to NIC though, the data will be saved on the
alarm log was obtained from the device.
RAM.
• In the case of a SOAP transmission error at transmission of a service mode menu list
If the power supply is blocked off while starting up, the data will be inevitably deleted.
(postServiceModeMenu) due to change of the setting value in the service mode menu, the
service mode data is obtained at every retry to be sent.
• In the case of a SOAP transmission error at transmission of browser information
(postBrowserInfo) due to change of the license status of the device’s web browser option,
the browser information is stored in the retry information to send the stored data again.

2-185
2
2
2-186
No.8 Transmission timing Detailed procedure Transmission Error occurs
Q: How does E-RDS operate while the device is placed in the sleep mode? information
A: While being in Real Deep Sleep, and if data to be sent is in E-RDS, the system wakes up When the WEB browser 1) When the power is turned Service browser mode: Retransmission
option license is entered/ ON, check the license Enabling [Active] or is repeated
asleep, then starts to send the data to the UGW. The system also waits for completion of data
transferred condition of the WEB Stopping [Suspend] until it finishes
transmission and let the device to shift to asleep status again. *1) browser option. successfully.
However, transition time to the Real Deep Sleep depends on the device, and the transition to 2) Send browser information WEB browser option:
sleep won’t be done if the next data transmission will be done within 10 minutes. to UGW when the license [ON] or [OFF] according
status is turned ON (from to the license status
OFF) due to entry of a
No.9 license or when the license
Q: Is E-RDS compatible with Section counter (Department counter)? status is turned OFF (from
ON) due to license transfer.
A: No, E-RDS does not support Section counter.
T-2-95

*1) Except when the service browser is disabled [OFF]


No.10
Q: Is there any setting to be made on the device side to enable the service mode menu
No.12
transmission function? Moreover, what is Service mode menu set as the object of
Q: Can I make another service call request when I have already requested a service call?
transmission?
A: No, you cannot make another service call request if you have already made a service call
A: No steps peculiar to Transmitting Service mode menu. As for the data that applies to
request.
transmission of the service mode, see the “Service mode menu Transmission”.
Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the service call which you’d made. Or the service
technician performs a service call request completion process.
No.11
Q: What service browser data is transmitted to UGW by E-RDS in what timing?
No.13
A: The service browser data to be transmitted and the transmission timing are shown below.
Q: Is the “Requesting” status cancelled when the device is rebooted?
Transmission timing Detailed procedure Transmission Error occurs
A: The requesting status is not cancelled even if the device is rebooted. The information of
information
the notified service call request (the time that the request was made, the service call request
When the service browser 1) Specify the service browser Service browser mode: Retransmission
is enabled from the setting in the service mode [Register] is not performed. description) is also retained during the “Requesting” status.
disabled state [OFF] menu.
2) Send browser information to WEB browser option: ("Disabling No.14
UGW. [ON] or [OFF] according [OFF]" continues
3) Once obtaining OK to the license status to be set.) Q: Some part of information seems to be suppressed as screens passes: Settings/
response from UGW, enable Registration > Preferences > Network > TCP/ IP Settings, when the device is connected
the service browser mode with a PS server unit. How the authentication information such as CA certificate is dealt
[ACTIVE].
(To use the setting, it is
A: Although the device’s been connected with the PS server unit, the data of the
necessary to reboot the e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system is able to pass through to the PS server unit.
device) Therefore the e-Maintenance/ imageWARE Remote system functions normally even if the
PS server unit is connected.The screen of IP Address settings is disabled though, the item
related to authentication can be enabled.

2-186
2
2
2-187
Troubleshooting
No.1
Symptom: A communication test (COM-TEST) results NG!
Cause: Initial settings or network conditions is incomplete.
Remedy 1: Check and take actions mentioned below.
1) Check network connections
Is the status indicator LED for the HUB port to which the main unit is connected ON?
YES: Proceed to Step 2).
NO: Check that the network cable is properly connected.

2) Confirm loop back address


Select [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings]
F-2-292
> [IPv4 Settings] > [PING Command], enter “127.0.0.1”, and touch the [Start] button.

3) Confirmation from another PC connected to same network.


Request the user to ping the main unit from a PC connected to same network.
Does the main unit respond?
YES: Proceed to Step 4).
NO: Confirm the details of the main unit’s IP address and subnet mask settings.

4) Confirm DNS connection


(a) Select [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP
Settings] > [DNS Settings] > [DNS Server Address Settings], write down the primary
and secondary addresses of the DNS server, and touch the [Cancel] button.

F-2-291

Does the screen display “Response from the host.”? (See the next figure.)
YES: Proceed to Step 3).
NO: There is a possibility that the main unit’s network settings are wrong. Check the
details of the IPv4 settings once more.

F-2-293

2-187
2
2
2-188
(b) Select [TCP/IP Settings] from breadcrumbs of the left columns, and then Touch it. Remedy 2: Troubleshooting using communication log (COM-LOG)
1) Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.
1) Press [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2) Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3) Press [Settings/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4) [Service Mode] screen is shown. Touch the [Mode List] button.

2) Select [COPIER] > [Function] > [INSTALL] > [COM-LOG] and touch the blank field on the
right side. The communication log list screen is displayed.

F-2-294

(c) Select [TCP/IP Settings] > [IPv4 Settings] > [PING Command], enter the primary DNS
server noted down in step a) as the IP address, and touch the [Start] button.

Does the screen display “Response from the host.”?


YES: Proceed to Remedy 2.
NO: Enter the secondary DNS server noted down in step a) as the IP address,
and then touch Start.

Does the screen display “Response from the host.”?


YES: Proceed to Remedy 2.
NO: There is a possibility that the DNS server address is wrong. Reconfirm the
address with the user’s system administrator.

F-2-295

NOTE:
• Only the initial part of error information is displayed in the communication log list screen.
• “*” is added to the top of the error text in the case of an error in communication test (method
name: getConfiguration or communicationTest) only.

2-188
2
2
2-189
3) When each line is selected, the communication log detailed screen is displayed as shown No.3
in the figure below. (Example: No. 05) Symptom: Registration information of an E-RDS is once deleted from the UGW server, and is
re-registered after that. If a communication test is not performed, then device information
on the UGW becomes invalid.
Causes: When registration of the E-RDS is deleted from the UGW, the status will be changed
to that the communication test has not completed because related information has lost from
a database.
So, device information will also become invalid if that condition will be left for seven days
without performing the communication test.
Remedy: Perform a communication test before becoming the invalidity state.

No.4
Symptom: There was a log, indicating “Device is not ready, try later” in error details of COM-
LOG list.
Cause: A certain problem occurred in networking.
F-2-296
Remedy: Check and take actions mentioned below.
1) Check networking conditions and connections.
NOTE:
• A detailed description of the error appears below 'Information'. (Max 128 characters) 2) Turn on the power supply of a device and perform a communication test about 60 seconds
• Touch the [OK] button to return to the log screen. later.

No.5
4) When a message is displayed, take an appropriate action referring to “Error code and Symptom: “Unknown error” is displayed though a communication test (COM-TEST) has done
strings”. successfully.
Cause: It could be a problem at the server side or the network load is temporarily faulty.
Remedy: Try again after a period of time. If the same error persists, check the UGW status
No.2 with a network and UGW administrator.
Symptom: A communication test results NG! even if network setting is set properly.
Causes: The network environment is inappropriate, or RGW-ADR or RGW-PORT settings for No.6
E-RDS have been changed. Symptom: Enabling Service Browser (BRWS-ACT) results NG!
Remedy: The following points should be checked. Cause: A communication test with UGW has not been performed, or a communication test
1) Check network conditions such as proxy server settings and so on. result is NG!
2) Check the E-RDS setting values. Remedy: Perform a communication test, and check that the test with UGW finishes
• Check the communication log from COM-LOG. successfully.
• Check whether RGW-ADR or RGW-PORT settings has changed. If RGW-ADR or RGW-
PORT settings has changed, restore initial values. For initial values, see “E-RDS setting
items”.

2-189
2
2
2-190
No.7
Error code and strings
Symptom: I cannot make a service call request.
Cause: There has been already a service call request. The following error information is output in the communication error log details display screen.
Remedy: Perform either of the following remedy works: (Here, “a server” means UGW.)
• Touch the [Cancel] button to cancel the service call request that has been made. • The error information are displayed in the following form.
• A service technician performs a complete processing for the service call request that has [*] [Error strings] [Method name] [Error details provided by UGW]
been made.
NOTE:
No.8 “*” is added to the top of the error text in the case of an error in communication test
Symptom: Initializing the CA certificate (CA-KEY) results in NG! (method name: getConfiguration or communicationTest) only.
Cause: Initialization process of the CA certificate has completed abnormally.
Remedy: Initialize the HDD. No. Code Error strings Cause Remedy
1 0000 0000 SUSPEND: mode Unmatched Operation Mode Clear E-RDS
changed.
2 0500 0003 SUSPEND: Rebooting the device while Perform a communication test
Communication test the communication test had (COM-TEST).
is not performed. not been performed although
E-RDS is enabled.
3 0xxx 0003 E-RDS switch is A communication test has Set E-RDS switch (E-RDS)
setted OFF been attempted with the to 1, and then perform a
E-RDS switch being OFF. communication test (COM-
TEST).
4 0xxx 0003 Server schedule is Blank schedule data have Check the device settings status
not exist been received from UGW. with the UGW administrator.
5 0xxx 0003 Communication test Communication test has not Perform and complete a
is not performed completed. communication test (COM-
TEST).
6 8000 0002 Event Registration Processing (event processing) Turn the device OFF/ ON.
8000 0003 is Failed within the device has failed. If the error persists, replace
8000 0101 the device system software.
8000 0201 (Upgrade)
8000 0305
8000 0306
8000 0401
8000 0403
8000 0414
8000 0415
7 8000 0101 Server response Communication with UGW has Try again after a period of time.
error (NULL) been successful, but an error If the error persists, check the
of some sort has prevented UGW status with the UGW
UGW from responding. administrator.
When (Null) is displayed
at the end of the message,
this indicates that there has
been an error in the HTTPS
communication method.

2-190
2
2
2-191
No. Code Error strings Cause Remedy No. Code Error strings Cause Remedy
8 8300 0306 SRAM version Improper value is written Turn the device OFF/ ON. 20 8xxx 2003 Network is not Communication attempted Check the network
unmatch! in at the head of the Main ready, try later without confirming network connection, as per the initial
Controller PCB 2 SRAM connection, just after booting procedures described in the
domain of E-RDS. up a device in which the troubleshooting.
9 8300 0306 SRAM AeRDS Improper value is written Turn the device OFF/ ON. network preparations are not Perform a communication test
version unmatch! in at the head of the Main ready. (COM-TEST) about 60 seconds
Controller PCB 2 SRAM later, after turn on the device.
domain of Ae-RDS. 21 8xxx 2004 Server Communication with UGW has Try again after a period of time.
10 8xxx 0004 Operation is not Method which E-RDS is not Contact help desk response error been successful, but an error Check detailed error code
supported supporting attempted. ([Hexadecimal]) of some sort has prevented (Hexadecimal) and [Error
11 8xxx 0201 Server schedule is During the communication When the error occurs, report [Error detailed in UGW from responding. details in UGW] from UGW
8xxx 0202 invalid test, there has been some the details to the support the UGW] *1) displayed after the message.
8xxx 0203 kind of error in the schedule section. 22 8xxx 200A Server connection • TCP/IP communication fault Check the network
8xxx 0204 values passed from UGW. And then, after the UGW error • The IP address of device is connection, as per the initial
8xxx 0206 side has responded, try the not set. procedures described in the
communication test again. troubleshooting.
12 8xxx 0207 Internal Schedule is The schedule data in the Perform a communication test 23 8xxx 200B Server address Server address name Check that the value of URL of
8xxx 0208 broken inside of E-RDS is not right. (COM-TEST). resolution error resolution has failed. UGW (RGW-ADR) is https://
13 8xxx 0221 Server specified list Alert filtering error: The Specify the number of elements a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/
is too big number of elements of the list of alert filtering correctly. agentif010.
specified by the server is over (Alarm filtering is not supported) 24 8xxx 2014 Proxy connection Could not connect to proxy Check proxy server address
restriction value. error server due to improper and re-enter as needed.
14 8xxx 0222 Server specified list Alert filtering error: Unjust Specify the element of alert address.
is wrong value is included in the filtering with the right value. 25 8xxx 2015 Proxy address Could not connect to proxy Check that the proxy server
element of the list specified by (Alarm filtering is not supported) resolution error server due to name resolution name is correct. If the proxy
the server. error of proxy address. server name is correct, check
15 8xxx 0304 Device is busy, try The semaphore consumption Try again a communication test the DNS connection, as per the
later error at the time of a after a period of time. initial procedures described in
communication test. the troubleshooting.
16 8xxx 0709 Tracking ID is not When upgrading firmware, Contact help desk 26 8xxx 201E Proxy Proxy authentication is failed. Check the user name and
match the Tracking ID notified by authentication error password required in order to
Updater differs from the thing login to the proxy, and re-enter
of UGW designates. as needed.
17 8xxx 2000 Unknown error Some other kind of Try again after a period of time. 27 8xxx 2028 Server certificate • No route certificate installed Install the latest device system
communication error has If the error persists, check the error in device. software. (Upgrade)
occurred. UGW status with the UGW • Certificate other than
administrator. that initially registered
18 8xxx 2001 URL Scheme error The header of the URL of the Check that the value of URL of in the user’s operating
(not https) registered UGW is not in https UGW (RGW-ADR) is https:// environment is being used,
format. a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/ but has not been registered
agentif010. with the device.
19 8xxx 2002 URL server A URL different to that Check that the value of URL of 28 8xxx 2029 Server certificate The server certificate Check that the value of URL of
specified is illegal specified by the UGW has UGW (RGW-ADR) is https:// verify error verification error occurred. UGW (RGW-ADR) is https://
been set. a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/ a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/
agentif010. agentif010.

2-191
2
2
2-192
No. Code Error strings Cause Remedy
29 8xxx 2046 Server certificate • The route certificate Check that the device time and
expired registered with the device date are correctly set.
has expired. If the device time and date are
• Certificate other than correct, upgrade to the latest
that initially registered system software.
in the user’s operating
environment is being used,
but has not been registered
with the device.
• The device time and date
is outside of the certificated
period.
30 8xxx 2047 Server response Due to network congestion, If this error occurs when the
time out etc., the response from UGW communication test is being run
does not come within the or Service Browser is being set,
specified time. (HTTPS level try again after a period of time.
time out)
31 8xxx 2048 Service not found There is a mistake in the Check that the value of URL of
UGW URL, and UGW cannot UGW (RGW-ADR) is https://
be accessed. (Path is wrong) a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/
agentif010.
32 8xxx 2052 URL error The data which is not URL is Check that the value of URL of
inputted into URL field. UGW (RGW-ADR) is https://
a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/
agentif010.
33 8xxx 2063 SOAP Fault SOAP communication error Check that the value of port
has occurred. number of UGW (RGW-PORT)
is 443.
34 xxxx xxxx Device internal An internal error, such as Turn the device OFF/ ON.
error memory unavailable, etc., Or replace the device system
has occurred during a device software. (Upgrade)
internal error phase.
35 xxxx xxxx SUSPEND: Internal error occurred at the Turn the device OFF/ ON.
Initialize Failure! initiating E-RDS.
T-2-96

*1) [Hexadecimal]: indicates an error code returned from UGW.


[Error details in UGW]: indicates error details returned from UGW.

2-192
2
2
2-193

Updater a. UGW-linked Download and Update (Full-Remote Update)


If the device is linked to UGW and the distribution schedule and update setting
are registered on UGW in advance, full remote firmware update is available on an
Overview imageRUNNER ADVANCE-series device. Upon downloaded from CDS, the firmware is
updated on the device.
■■Outline
1) Set up customers, Sales Company
Updater provides functions that enable network communication with Content Delivery System 3) Give a firmware distribution
UGW device types, distribution / Partner
schedule and the
V1.0 (hereinafter CDS) to install firmware, MEAP applications and system options. command to e-ROS.
command for download

• Firmware Installation UGW Operator

Updater function enables users to distribute firmware through CDS via Internet. Particularly
2) Notify distribution
on e-Maintenance/UGW (called NETEYE in Japan)-enabled devices, firmware can be e-RDS information to CDS.

updated remotely, which effectively slashes costs incurred in field services. 4) Download CDS
firmware Canon Inc.
Updater Firmware
Firmware Upload
• MEAP Application/System Option Installation
By linking devices to CDS and License Management System (providing the function to imageRUNNER 5) Writing process is
manage licenses; hereinafter LMS), applications can be installed in devices via Updater, ADVANCE automatically started upon
download completed.
regardless of those not embedded (MEAP application) or embedded (system options) in
F-2-297
devices.
b. UGW-linked Download (Remote Distribution / Update)
If the device is linked to UGW and the distribution schedule is registered on UGW in
●● Installing Firmware advance, firmware can be distributed to an imageRUNNER ADVANCE-series device before
With link to Updater, service technicians provide firmware install services in the following 3
a service technician actually visits the customer site. This allows the service technician to
methods.
update the firmware manually immediately after completing device inspection.
Download Downloadable Firmware Versions
Update 1) Set up customers, Sales Company
Distribution Method Commanded Previous Current Newer UGW device types, distribution / Partner
Timing 3) Give a firmware distribution
by: Ver Ver Ver command to e-ROS.
schedule and the
command for download
a. UGW-linked Download / Update UGW Auto No Yes Yes*1
(Full-remote update)
b. UGW-linked Download UGW Manual Yes Yes Yes UGW Operator

(Remote Distribution / Update)


2) Notify distribution
c. Manual Download / Update Local UI Auto No Yes Yes*1 e-RDS information to CDS.
(On-site Update via Service mode) Manual Yes Yes Yes 4) Download CDS
*1:You can select the version allowed Remote Update. T-2-97 firmware Canon Inc.
Updater Firmware
Firmware Upload

imageRUNNER
ADVANCE
5) Writing process is started by
Service manually executing Updater.
Technician

F-2-298

2-193
2
2
2-194
c. Manual Download and Update (On-site Update via Service Mode) service technician can gain access to CDS from User mode to install a MEAP application
If an imageRUNNER ADVANCE-series device has connection with the external network, or a system option.
a service technician can gain access to CDS via Service mode to download and update Installing MEAP Application
firmware. This allows service technicians to update the firmware as needed on the Sales
customer site even without PCs. LAN Company
LAN LMS

1) Manually execute CDS


Updater.
Canon Inc.
Updater Firmware
Firmware Upload
5) Manuals, etc. 2) License
User Authentication MEAP
imageRUNNER Application
LAN
ADVANCE Manual
2) Firmware distribution CDS 3) Create LF
Service Upload
Technician 1) Enter LAN

F-2-299
Application Canon Inc.

4) Transmit MEAP
NOTE: imageRUNNER Application/LF
“External network” here means the network connecting the device to CDS via Internet. ADVANCE

If a customer enters LAN LAN: License Access Number


purchased from the sales company LF: License File
NOTE: to an imageRUNNERADVANCE- (DSN: Device Serial Number,
series device, MEAP application/LF automatically sent to CDS upon LAN
Users are able to gain firmware distribution in the following 4 methods by introducing can be installed. entered.)
CDS. See User Manual for detailed information.
F-2-300
Download Downloadable Firmware Versions
Update Installing System Option
Distribution Method Commanded
Timing Previous Ver Current Ver Newer Ver
by Sales
LAN Company
Manual download/ Auto No No Yes *1 LAN LMS
Local UI
update via Local UI Manual No No Yes *1
Manual download/ Auto No No Yes *1
Remote UI
upload via Remote UI Manual No No Yes *1
Special download/ Specific version only 5) Manuals, etc. 2) License
Remote UI - User Authentication
upload via Remote UI (Obtain it separately)
Periodical update via LAN
Local UI Auto No No Yes *1 CDS Manual
Local UI 3) Create LF
Upload
1) Enter LAN
*1: Only the latest version of Remote update-enabled version is downloadable.
Application Canon Inc.

4) Transmit LF
imageRUNNER
ADVANCE
Installing MEAP Application/System Option
LAN: License Access Number
If a customer enters LAN
The following is the installation method of MEAP application/system option which is enabled purchased from the sales company
LF: License File
(DSN: Device Serial Number,
to an imageRUNNERADVANCE-
by applying CDS. series device, a LF can be installed.
automatically sent to CDS upon LAN
entered.)

a. LMS-linked MEAP Application/System Option Installation F-2-301

If an imageRUNNER ADVANCE-series device is connected to the external network, user or

2-194
2
2
2-195
■■System Configuration ■■List of Functions
The figure below schematically shows the system configuration. The matrix below shows the list of functions provided by Updater.
Service User Remote UGW-
Category Function
Mode Mode UI linked
MEAP application
Dealer LMS Manual Checking firmware compatibility Yes - - -
Checking special firmware Yes - - -

Internet
User Sales
License Manual Company Checking latest firmware
Access No. Readme - Yes Yes -
version
CDS Registering/deleting firmware
Application/License Yes Yes Yes -
distribution schedule
Updater Firmware Application Business Confirming and downloading
eRDS Firmware Yes Yes Yes Yes
Group firmware
UGW Firmware Updating downloaded firmware Yes Yes Yes -
Cancelling downloaded
Service Command for Firmware Distribution QA Yes Yes Yes -
Technician firmware
Canon Inc. Acquiring firmware distribution
information registered from - - - Yes
F-2-302
UGW
Notifying firmware version
- - - Yes
information
Periodical update - Yes - -
Inquiring license for MEAP
- Yes Yes -
MEAP application/ application/system option
system option Installing MEAP application /
- Yes Yes -
system option
Settings Yes - - -
System Testing communications Yes Yes Yes -
Management Displaying update logs Yes Yes Yes -
Displaying system logs Yes Yes Yes -
Internal system Notifying internal system error
Yes Yes Yes Yes
error notification occurrence to distribution server
T-2-98

*Functioning supports periodical update with a device after firmware version V50.00.

2-195
2
2
2-196
■■Distribution Flow ●● MEAP Application/System Option Installation Flow
MEAP application/system option installation method using service mode is not provided.
●● Firmware Installation Flow
Be sure to use the user mode to install.
Service technicians provide firmware install services in the following 4 methods.
: Operator of each company : User operation

a: UGW-linked download and update


b: UGW-linked download
Application
c: Manual download and update Market Release
d: Update via SST

License Access
: Operator of each company : User operation
Number Acquisition
(packaged with the
product)

Firmware
Market Release

Device Serial No.


a d Acquisition
(from the device)
b
c
Distribution
Setting to UGW Firmware acquisition
(UGW-linked)*1 License Key License File
Acquisition Acquisition
(from LMS) (from LMS)
*2

Distribution setting & Distribution setting & Distribution setting &


Download Download Download
Automatic download Via Service mode Scheduled download Via User mode Via User mode Download via SST
(Local UI) (Local UI) (Remote UI)
Install distributed System Option System Option MEAP Application
Install
application Install Manual Install Manual Install
Via User mode
Via User mode Via User mode Via User mode Via User mode
(Local UI)
(Remote UI) (Local UI) (Remote UI) (Remote UI)

F-2-304

Apply (Update) Apply (Update) Apply (Update)


Automatic update Via Service mode Scheduled update Via User mode Via User mode Update via SST
(Local UI) (Local UI) (Remote UI)

F-2-303
*1: Schedules for UGW-linked distribution are maintained on CDS.
*2: Functioning supports periodical update with a device after firmware version V50.00.

2-196
2
2
2-197
Limitations and Cautions Job/Function Receiving Printing Queued print Sending Queued send
type jobs jobs
■■Limitations COPY - Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ - -
PRINT Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ - -
Changing Date/Time on Device (end of job)
When a user changes the date/time setting on the device (including change of the setting FAX Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ
according to daylight saving time), the firmware distribution may not be performed as I-FAX Receipt Cancel Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ
processing to
scheduled. trigger update *
But there is not the problem if it is time adjustment of several minutes with NTP servers. Report Print - Wait for EOJ Wait for EOJ - -
SEND - - - Cancel Cancel
Change of Setting from Service mode processing to processing to
trigger update * trigger update *
Any settings from Service mode will be enabled after restarting the device.
T-2-99

*The data are guaranteed even if cut off in the middle of a job.It becomes the recovery object
■■Cautions after the device reboot and carry out send / reception again.
Concurrent use of Updater functions
Multiple users cannot use Updater functions on a device concurrently by using it together with
Remote UI. Even during transfer, Pull SCAN job processing is cancelled soon after scanning is
completed.
Coexistence of Remote UI and other tools Firmware update is cancelled if the jobs are not completed within 10 minutes. If this occurs,
Users logged in SMS (Service Management Service) are unable to use Update functions the error code, 8x001106, will be returned (different numbers will be shown for x depending
from Remote UI. on the execution modes).
Firmware update is executed if the jobs stated above are not in the queue.
Using Updater function from Remote UI Follow the shutdown sequence to reboot the device after the firmware is updated.
Upon the following operations done, Updater functions are suspended from Remote UI for
certain duration.
• When a user exits Web browser without clicking [Portal] or [Log Out] button in the setting of Caution:
Remote Login Service via SMS The following firmware versions do not support Wait for EOJ Function.
• When a user exits Web browser without clicking [Portal] button in the setting of not to use
Remote Login Service via SMS.
• iR-ADV V5000 series: V40.17 or earlier
• When a user exits Web browser without clicking [Log out from SMS] or [To Remote UI]
• iR-ADV V7000/9000 series: V40.18 or earlier
button.

Wait for EOJ (end of job) Function For the versions above, triggering firmware update will cancel all COPY/PDL jobs
submitted and/or queued. Only jobs with power-off safeguard (Fax/ I-Fax/ Auto-Report
Firmware update will be triggered only after the following jobs are completed.
Print) are recovered after reboot.
This is the Updater-specific specification.

2-197
2
2
2-198

Preparation ■■Setting Sales Company’s HQ


When using devices input in the markets listed below, the default setting of Sales Company’s
■■Overview of Preparation HQ should be changed before obtaining firmware distributed from CDS. Unless the setting is
The following should be prepared before using Updater. changed properly, the desired firmware may not be able to be selected.
• For updating of firmware Default Setting of Sales Setting of Sales Company's
Market
Enabling Company's HQ HQ after Change
Enabling Canada US CA
Setting [Manual
[Update Enabling Latin America US/SG LA
Installation Sales Network Enabling Update]
Firmware] [Scheduled Hong Kong SG HK
Method Company’s Settings UGW Link Button of
Button of User Update] T-2-102
HQ User Mode
Mode Go to the following screen to change the setting of Sales Company's HQ.
(Remote UI)
UGW-linked Service Setting of Device Service Mode COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > CDS-CTL
Download and Yes Yes Yes - - - Technician (Level 1)
Update
UGW-linked
Yes Yes Yes - - -
Download
Manual NOTE:
Download and Yes Yes - - - - The list below shows the setting of Sales Company’s HQ for CDS-CTS by market.
Update Check and adhere to the appropriate setting for your market.
Manual <List of Sales Company’s HQ and the settings for CDS-CTL>
Download and Japan = JP China = CN
Yes Yes - Yes - -
Update via
USA = US Hong Kong = HK
Local UI
Singapore = SG Australia = AU
Manual
Europe = NL Canada = CA
Download and
Yes Yes - Yes - - Korea = KR Latin America= LA
Update via
Remote UI
Special
Download and
Yes - - - Yes -
Update via
Remote UI
Scheduled
Yes Yes - - - Yes
update
T-2-100

• For Install of Application


Enabling [Install Application/
Installation Method Network Settings
Options] Button of User Mode
LMS-linked Installation Yes -
LMA-linked installation via Local UI Yes Yes
LMS-linked installation via Remote UI Yes Yes
T-2-101

2-198
2
2
2-199
■■Network Settings ●● Confirming URL Setting of Distribution Server
This section describes how to confirm the URL setting of the distribution server.
●● Connecting to External Network
The method of connecting to external network is similar to a normal network connection
1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.
method. Refer to user manual of the device for details.
1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
NOTE:
• See User Manual for how to connect the device to the external network. 4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.
• Before using UGW link or User mode, see the sections below to prepare as required.
“Enabling UGW Link” 2. Press [Updater] button.
“Enabling [Update Firmware] Button of User Mode”
“Enabling [Install Application/Options] Button of User Mode”

NOTE:
“External Network” here means the network connecting the device to CDS via Internet.

F-2-305

2-199
2
2
2-200
3. Press [Software Management Settings] button. 5. Ensure to enter “https://device.c-cdsknn.net/cds_soap/updaterif” in the field beside the
[Delivery Server URL] button.
If the URL is not entered or a wrong URL is entered in the field, click [Delivery Server URL]
button to show the virtual keypad. Check the URL and enter the correct one.

F-2-306
4. Press [Settings] button.

F-2-308
6. Press [OK] to set the entered items. Now the URL of the distribution server is successfully
set.

F-2-307

2-200
2
2
2-201
●● Communication Test 3. Press [Software Management Settings] button.
This section describes how to check if the communication is normally done to the distribution
server and/or the file server.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

F-2-310
4. Press [Test Communication] button.

F-2-309

F-2-311

2-201
2
2
2-202
5. Press [Yes] button. ■■Enabling UGW Link
When installing the firmware in the method of “UGW-linked Download and Update” or “UGW-
linked Download”, the following should be set before actually using UGW link.
Setting of Device
COPIER >OPTION >FNC-SW >CDS-UGW
Service Mode
(0 -> 1)
Service Technician (Level 1)
Setting of UGW In [Customer Management] screen, set [Do not
WebPortal distribute firmware] to [Distribute firmware].
See "Analysis>Firmware Distribution
Setting of Authorities on
Sales Company's HQ Information" to grant the appropriate authorities
UGW WebPortal
to each account.

NOTE:
• See “imageWARE Remote Operator’s Manual / e-Maintenance Business Operation
Manual“ for how to operate UGW WebPortal.
F-2-312 • [Distribute Firmware] should be set on [Customer Management] screen for staff in charge
Obtain the download file information for communication test from the distribution server of setting for [Enter customer information] or [Command for firmware distribution] in order
to allow them to select the desired device on [Firmware Distribution Information] screen.
(to execute the communication test to the distribution server).
• If [Distribute Firmware] is not shown on [Customer Management] screen of UGW
Using the download file information for communication test, the contents for test are WebPortal, appropriate authorities may not be set to each account in Firmware
downloaded from the file server (for the communication test to the file server). Distribution Information. Contact the Sales Company HQ concerned for confirmation.

6. Upon the communication test completed, the communication test result screen is shown.
Press [OK] button to exit this operation.

F-2-313

2-202
2
2
2-203
■■Enabling [Update Firmware] Button of User Mode ■■Enabling [Install Application/Options] Button of User Mode
To allow users to install firmware using Updater, the setting of firmware installation should be To allow users to install applications using Updater, the setting of application installation
set to ON for users in advance. should be set to ON for users in advance.
Service Setting of Device Service Mode COPIER >OPTION >FNC-SW >CDS-FIRM Service Setting of Device Service Mode COPIER >OPTION >FNC-SW >CDS-MEAP
Technician (Level 1) (0 -> 1) Technician (Level 1) (0 -> 1)

• User Mode screen for Updater when the setting is not enabled (CDS-FIRM(0)): • User Mode screen of Updater when the setting is not enabled (CDS-MEAP(0)):

F-2-314 F-2-316

• User Mode screen for Updater when the setting is enabled (CDS-FIRM(1)): • User Mode screen of Updater when the setting is enabled (CDS-MEAP(1)):

F-2-315
F-2-317

2-203
2
2
2-204
■■Enabling [Manual Update] Button of User Mode (Remote UI) ■■Enabling [Scheduled Update] Button of User Mode
To allow users to install firmware from Updater using the file on Local PCs, the setting of Service Setting of Device Service Mode COPIER >OPTION >FNC-SW >CDS-LVUP
Technician (Level 1) (0 -> 1)
firmware installation should be set to ON for users in advance.
Service Setting of Device Service Mode COPIER >OPTION >FNC-SW >LOCLFIRM
Technician (Level 1) (0 -> 1)

• Remote UI screen of Updater when the setting is not enabled (LOCLFIRM (0)):

F-2-318
• Remote UI screen of Updater when the setting is enabled (LOCLFIRM (1)):
F-2-320

F-2-319

F-2-321

2-204
2
2
2-205

F-2-322

F-2-323

2-205
2
2
2-206
System Management Operations 4. Press [Settings] button.

■■Various Setting
●● Setting URL of Distribution Server
This section describes how to set URL of the distribution server.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

3. Press [Software Management Settings] button.

F-2-325
5. Press [Delivery Server URL] to show the virtual keypad. Enter the URL.

F-2-326
• [Delivery Server URL]:
Enter the "https://device.c-cdsknn.net/cds_soap/updaterif"
F-2-324

6. Press [OK] to set the entered items. Now the URL of the distribution server is successfully
set.

2-206
2
2
2-207
●● Setting Log Level 4. Press [Settings] button.
This section describes how to set system log levels.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

3. Press [Software Management Settings] button.

F-2-328
5. Select a log level from [Log Level] dropdown list.

F-2-327

F-2-329
• [Log Level]:
Select one of 5 levels ranging from [0] to [4].
See the table below for logs output in each level.
Log Output
Log Level
Trace Information Important Message Ordinary Error System Error
0 - - - - Yes
1 - - - Yes Yes
2 - - Yes Yes Yes
3 - Yes Yes Yes Yes
4 Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes
T-2-103

2-207
2
2
2-208

NOTE:
■■Displaying Logs
This list shows the contents of the Log Output.
●● Update Logs
Log Output Description This section describes how to confirm System Option/MEAP Application Installation Logs and
Trace Detailed logs for debug
Firmware Update Logs.
Information Logs related to operations done on the system
Important Message Update logs output by firmware type
Installation logs by MEAP application 1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.
Logs related to enabled functions by system option 1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
Ordinary Error Logs for ordinary errors
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
System Error Logs for internal system errors
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.
6. Press [OK] button to set the selected log level. Now the log level is successfully set.
2. Press [Updater] button.

3. Press [Software Management Settings] button.

F-2-330

2-208
2
2
2-209
4. Press [Select Log Display] button. 6. System Option/MEAP Application Installation Logs and Firmware Update Logs are shown.
Press [OK] button to exit this operation.

F-2-331
5. Press [Display Update Logs] button. F-2-333

F-2-332

2-209
2
2
2-210
●● System Logs 4. Press [Select Log Display] button.
This section describes how to confirm System Logs.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

3. Press [Software Management Settings] button.

F-2-335
5. Press [Display System Logs] button.

F-2-334

F-2-336

2-210
2
2
2-211
6. Updater internal logs are displayed. ■■Communication Test
Press [OK] button to exit this operation.
This section describes how to check if the communication is normally done to the distribution
server and/or the file server.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

3. Press [Software Management Settings] button.

F-2-337

NOTE:
See the section of "Debug Logs" under “Version Upgrade via CDS”, “Version Upgrade”
of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual for more detailed information.

F-2-338

2-211
2
2
2-212
4. Press [Test Communication] button. 6. Upon the communication test completed, the communication test result screen is shown.
Press [OK] button to exit this operation.

F-2-341
F-2-339
5. Press [Yes] button.
Caution:
Carry out the communication test with both Embedded RDS and CDS.

F-2-340
Obtain the download file information for communication test from the distribution server (to
execute the communication test to the distribution server).
Using the download file information for communication test, the contents for test are
downloaded from the file server (for the communication test to the file server).

2-212
2
2
2-213

Maintenance ■■How to Replace Controller Boards


The steps are different depending on which of 2 controller boards are to be replaced.
■■Upgrading Updater • Main Controller Board PCB 1
The firmware installed in the device should be also upgraded when upgrading Updater. See No steps follow.
the section of “Version upgrade” , Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual for how to
update firmware. • Main Controller Board PCB 2 (including SRAM)
The setting information and logs (update logs/system logs) are inherited in the upgraded The network and service mode setting should be set again after initialization. See
version. "Preparation" in chapter 2 of this manual for details.

■■Formatting Hard Disk ■■How to Replace Devices


Since Updater is a MEAP application, its contents can be temporarily saved in the MEAP All settings should be set again because no data are inherited. See "Preparation" in chapter 2
application storage area on PC via SST during formatting or replacing HDD. See MEAP of this manual for details.
Service Manual for further information.
The settings initialized in format or replacement should be restored. See "Preparation" in
chapter 2 of this manual for details.

NOTE:
When formatting or replacing HDD, distribution schedule, downloaded firmware (not
updated yet) and logs (update/system logs) will be deleted.

2-213
2
2
2-214
FAQ No.4
Q: In the course of “UGW-linked download”, what will happen if the user downloads the
■■FAQ on Installing Firmware firmware before the service technician update the firmware downloaded with “UGW-linked
download” before?
No.1
A: The previously downloaded firmware in the method of “UGW-linked download” will be
Q: Is it also possible to downgrade firmware with using CDS?
overridden by the subsequently downloaded one.
A: Firmware can be downgraded in some methods shown in the table below.
This is because only one downloaded firmware can be held on the device.
If download and update are performed consecutively, firmware can’t be downgraded.
The firmware downloaded in the method of “Service mode-linked download” and “UGW-
linked download” can be checked/deleted from User mode, but cannot be updated, so it
Distribution Method Downgrade Possibility
cannot be updated by the user unnoticed by the service technician.
UGW-linked Download and Update No
UGW-linked Download Yes
Manual Download and Update(Timing to Apply : Manual) Yes No.5
Manual Download and Update(Timing to Apply : Automatic) No Q: What happens if the user registers another distribution schedule when the distribution
T-2-104 schedule has been set in “manual download and update”?
No.2 A: The distribution schedule subsequently registered by the user will override the existing
Q: When installing firmware, does it take less time in “manual download and update” schedule. This is because only one distribution schedule can be held. Any existing
compared to “update via SST”? distribution schedule is deleted and the newly registered distribution schedule is made
A: It depends on the number of devices to update firmware. valid.
When updating the firmware on a device, it takes more time in “manual download and
update” compared to “update via SST” (It depend on network environment.). No.6
As for the time to update firmware to multiple devices, “manual download and update” Q: How is an individual response edition of firmware distributed?
takes less time compared to “update via SST” because updating the firmware to multiple A: Any individual response edition of firmware can be installed in all the methods provided by
devices can be executed simultaneously. service technicians. Before installing the individual response edition, ensure to obtain the
ID and password separately.
No.3
Q: How can we confirm that the firmware is properly updated after “UGW-linked download No.7
and update” done? Q: If the device is down during firmware update, can the device be started using the older
A: You can confirm this in E-mail or the Device List on UGW-linked screen. firmware version?
E-mail to notify firmware update will be sent from CDS server to the addresses set as A: No, it is impossible to start the device using older versions. If this occurs, the service
destinations at the time of distribution setting to notify update completion. technician in charge should reinstall the firmware via SST. See “Troubleshooting on
On UGW-linked screen, search the device of your interest on [Select Device] screen to find Firmware Installation” in chapter 6 of this manual for details.
the distribution status per device as shown in the search result.
No.8
Q: If the device is down during firmware download, is it possible to download the firmware
again?
A: Firmware cannot be downloaded again automatically. Instead, the error is notified in E-mail.
The user should register the firmware distribution schedule again accordingly.

2-214
2
2
2-215
No.9 ■■FAQ on Installing MEAP Application/System Option
Q: Can we cancel the operation during firmware download?
No.1
A: Yes. [Cancel] button is shown.
Q: What happens if a MEAP application is installed in the system with insufficient HDD free
space?
A: An error message is shown. Upon starting installation, the MEAP application checks the
required space against free space to judge installation availability.

No.2
Q: Can we cancel the operation during installation of MEAP application?
A: Yes: [Cancel] button is shown.

No.3
Q: Is the device automatically restarted after the system option is enabled?
A: The device is not automatically restarted. Users should restart the device manually.

F-2-342
No.10
Q: E-mail is sent to users to notify update completion. Can service technicians also receive
such a notification?
A: Yes. The notification E-mail is also set for the service technician in charge if the user enters
his/her E-mail address at the time of firmware distribution setting.
Multiple E-mail addresses can be entered in the field.Delimit each E-mail address with “,”
(comma) or “;” (semicolon) when you enter multiple E-mail addresses in the field.

No.11
Q: How long does the firmware update take?
A: Approx. 30 min. However, this does not include the download time. Download time relies
on the network environment.

2-215
2
2
2-216
■■FAQ on General Matters of Updater No.2
Q: How can operations using Updater be masked on the users' side?
No.1
A: Be sure to perform the following from the service mode.
Q: What preparation is needed in each installation method?
• Masking Firmware Installation
A: See the table below for preparation required in each installation method.
Setting Device Service Mode COPIER >OPTION >FNC-SW >CDS-FIRM
• For updating firmware (Level 1) (1 -> 0)
Enabling Enabling Setting Device Service Mode COPIER >OPTION >FNC-SW >LOCALFIRM
Setting (Level 1) (1 -> 0)
Enabling [Update [Manual Periodical
Installation Sales Network
UGW Firmware] Update] Button update
Method Company’s Settings
Link Button of User of User Mode validation • Masking Application Installation
HQ
Mode (Remote UI)
Setting Device Service Mode COPIER >OPTION >FNC-SW >CDS-MEAP
UGW-linked (Level 1) (1 -> 0)
Download and Yes Yes Yes - - -
Update
UGW-linked No.3
Yes Yes Yes - - -
Download
Q: Can the communication be cancelled during the communication test?
Manual
Download and Yes Yes - - - - A: Yes. During the communication test, “Cancel” button is displayed.
Update
Manual
Download and
Yes Yes - Yes - -
Update via
Local UI
Manual
Download and
Yes Yes - Yes - -
Update via
Remote UI
Special
Download and
Yes - - - Yes -
Update via
Remote UI
Periodical
Yes Yes - - - Yes
update
T-2-105

• For install Application


Enabling [Install Application/
Installation Method Network Settings
Options] Button of User Mode
LMS-linked Installation Yes -
LMA-linked installation via Local UI Yes Yes
LMS-linked installation via Remote UI Yes Yes
T-2-106

2-216
2
3 Periodical Service

■Consumable Parts and Cleaning Parts

3
3
3-2

Consumable Parts and Cleaning Parts


●: Replacement (Consumable parts) Δ: Cleaning ■: Inspection
Interval
No.

Category

Part Name

Part No

Number

Counter

Adjustment (Yes/No)

Remark

Reference
At installation

20K

50K

100K

120K

150K

300K

500K
1 Dust-blocking glass - 1 Δ - Cleaning with Dust-blocking glass Cleaning tool
Body
2 Dust-blocking glass cleaning pad 1 ● - - - Replacing when replace ITB cleaning blade
3 Developing unit (Y) FM3-5926 1 ● DRBL-1 DV-UNT-Y - For C5051 / C5045
4 Developing unit (M) FM3-5941 1 ● DRBL-1 DV-UNT-M - For C5051 / C5045
5 Developing unit (C) FM3-5942 1 ● DRBL-1 DV-UNT-C - For C5051 / C5045
6 Developing unit (Bk) FM3-5943 1 ● DRBL-1 DV-UNT-K - For C5051 / C5045
Process Unit
7 Developing unit (Y) FM3-5973 1 ● DRBL-1 DV-UNT-Y - For C5035 / C5030
8 Developing unit (M) FM3-5974 1 ● DRBL-1 DV-UNT-M - For C5035 / C5030
9 Developing unit (C) FM3-5967 1 ● DRBL-1 DV-UNT-C - For C5035 / C5030
10 Developing unit (Bk) FM3-5968 1 ● DRBL-1 DV-UNT-K - For C5035 / C5030
11 Primary transfer roller (Color) FC8-4401 3 ● DRBL-1 TR-ROLC -

12 Primary transfer roller (Bk) FC8-4401 1 ● DRBL-1 TR-ROLK -

Replacing when replace secondary transfer outer


13 Secondary transfer inner roller FC8-4402 1 ● - - -
roller
14 Secondary transfer outer roller FC8-4402 1 ● DRBL-1 2TR-ROLL -
Image Formation
15 Transfer separation guide unit FM3-8893 1 ● DRBL-1 T/S-UNIT -
System
16 ITB (intermediary transfer belt) FC8-4400 1 ● DRBL-1 TR-BLT -

Cleaning when replace intermediary transfer belt (ITB)


17 Patch sensor FK2-7316 1 ■ - Clean with lint-free paper moistened with water 3
times in one direction
18 ITB cleaning blade FM3-6018 1 ● DRBL-1 T-CLN-BD -

19 Film unit (100V) FM3-5949 1 ● DRBL-1 FX-UNIT - For 100V


20 Film unit (120V) FM3-5950 1 ● DRBL-1 FX-UNIT - For 120V
21 Film unit (230V) FM3-5951 1 ● DRBL-1 FX-UNIT - For 230V
22 Fixing System Pressure roller FC8-4906 1 ● DRBL-1 FX-LW-RL -

23 Fixing bearing XG9-0172 2 ● PRDC-1 FX-LW-BR -

24 Shutter cover FC8-5043 1 Δ Cleaning when replace Film Unit


25 Fixing separation guide FC8-5046 1 Δ Cleaning when replace Film Unit

3-2
3
3
3-3
Interval
No.

Category

Part Name

Part No

Number

Counter

Adjustment (Yes/No)

Remark

Reference
At installation

20K

50K

100K

120K

150K

300K

500K
26 Cassette 1 feeding roller FC6-7083 1 ● DRBL-1 C1-FD-RL -

27 Cassette 2 feeding roller FC6-7083 1 ● DRBL-1 C2-FD-RL -

28 Cassette 1 separation roller FC6-6661 1 ● DRBL-1 C1-SP-RL -

29 Cassette 2 separation roller FC6-6661 1 ● DRBL-1 C2-SP-RL -

30 Multi-Purpose Tray Feed Roller FB1-8581 1 ● DRBL-1 M-PU-RL


31 Multi-Purpose Tray Separation Roller FC6-6661 1 ● DRBL-1 M-SP-RL
For Chinese model only. Replacing when replace
32 Pickup assembly idler gear FU3-0280 2 ● - - -
feeding roller and separation roller.
33 First delivery roller - 1 Δ - - - If necessary cleaning with alcohol
34 Second delivery roller - 1 Δ - - - If necessary cleaning with alcohol
35 Third delivery roller - 1 Δ - - - If necessary cleaning with alcohol
Pickup/
36 Registration roller - 1 Δ - - - If necessary cleaning with alcohol
Feeding System
37 Pre-registration guide - 1 Δ - - - If necessary cleaning with lint-free paper
38 Transparency sensor RH7-7129 1 Δ - - - Cleaning with lint-free paper
39 Fixing delivery guide - 1 Δ - - - If necessary cleaning with lint-free paper
40 Post-fixing roller - 1 ■ - - - If necessary cleaning with alcohol
41 Fixing delivery roller - 1 ■ - - - If necessary cleaning with alcohol
42 Duplex feed upper roller - 1 ■ - - - If necessary cleaning with alcohol
43 Duplex feed lower roller - 1 ■ - - - If necessary cleaning with alcohol
44 Secondary transfer guide 1 Δ Cleaning with lint-free paper
45 Feeding contact guide - 1 Δ - - - Cleaning with lint-free paper
46 Vertical path sensor FK2-6470 1 Δ Cleaning with lint-free paper
47 Lightproof Sheet 1 Δ Cleaning with lint-free paper
48 Filter Toner filter FC6-9817 1 ● DRBL-1 TN-FIL1 -

User maintenance. Reference in A4 size, image ratio


49 - Recycle toner container FM3-5945 1 ● DRBL-1 WSR-TNR -
5%
T-3-1

3-3
3
3
3-4

Toner filter

Recycle toner bottle

Dust-blocking glass cleaning pad

F-3-1

3-4
3
3
3-5

Developing unit(Bk)

Developing unit(C)

Developing unit(M)

Developing unit(Y)

Transfer Separation guide unit

ITB

Secondary transfer outer roller

Secondary transfer inner roller

ITB cleaning blade Primary transfer roller

F-3-2

3-5
3
3
3-6

Fixing bearing

Roller pressure

Fixing bearing

Film unit(100V)
(120V)
(230V)

F-3-3

3-6
3
3
3-7

Multi-Purpose Tray
Feed Roller
Multi-Purpose Tray
Separation Roller

Cassette feeding 1 roller

Pickup idler gear

Cassette separation 1 roller Cassette feeding 2 roller

Cassette separation 2 roller

Pickup idler gear

F-3-4

3-7
3
3
3-8

Cleaning Parts
[1]

[2]

[3]

[19]

[4]
[1] Second Delivery Roller
[18] [5] [2] Third Delivery Roller
[3] Second/Third Delivery Inlet Roller
[17]
[4] Fixing Inner Delivery Roller
[6] [5] Duplex Feed Upper Roller
[16] [6] Fixing Delivery Guide Assembly
[7] Duplex Feed Lower Roller
[15] [8] Registration Roller
[9] Pre-registration Guide Assembly
[7]
[14] [10] Lightproof Sheet
[11] Vertical path sensor
[12] Transparency Sensor
[8]
[13] Dust-blocking Glass
[9] [14] Secondary Transfar Guide Assembly
[15] Feed Contact Point Guide Assembly
[10] [16] Shutter cover
[17] Fixing separation guide
[18] Post-Fixing Roller
[19] First Delivery Roller

[13] [13] [13] [13] [12] [11]

3-8
3
4 Parts Replacement and Cleaning

■Main

■Laser
Controller
Exposure System

■Image Formation System

■Fixing System

■Pickup Feed System

■Option

4
4
4-2

List of Parts No. Name Service Parts No. Refarence


1 Reader right retaining cover FL2-9815
2 Reader front cover FC8-6095 / 6074*
List of Cover 3 Control panel under cover FC8-7842
4 Control panel upper cover FC8-7818
[21] 5 Control panel side cover 1 FC8-7819
[1] 6 Control panel side cover 2 FC8-7820
[20]
[2] 7 Front right cover FM3-6104
[19]
[3] 8 Front upper cover FM3-6096
[18] 9 Toner replacement cover FC8-4111
[4]
10 Front cover FC8-4123
[5] 11 Left grip cover FC8-4143
[17]
12 Left duct cover FC8-4140
[6] 13 Left lower cover FC8-4138
14 Left upper cover FC8-4139
[16]
15 Inner bottom cover FC8-4149
[7] 16 Reader left cover FC8-6098 / 6077*
17 Reader left retaining cover -
[15] 18 DF base left cover FC8-6115
19 Jamp base cover FC8-6120
[8] 20 Reader cable cover -
21 DF base right cover FC8-6114
[14] T-4-1
[9] * Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 / Color Image Reader Unit-B1

[11]
[10]
[13]

[12]
[11]

F-4-1

4-2
4
4
4-3
[51] No. Name Service Parts No. Refarence
[50] 22 Reader rear cover FL2-9826 / 9827*
23 Reader rear under cover FC8-6099 / 6085*
24 Left rear sub cover FC8-4142
[49] [22] 25 Left rear cover FL3-3167
26 Rear cover FL3-3166
[48] 27 Rear lower cover FM3-6105
[23]
28 Filter cover FC8-4130
[47] 29 Right rear cover 1 FC8-5377
[24] 30 Conector cover FC8-5200
[46] 31 Right rear cover 2 FC8-4131
32 Heater switch cover FC8-4137
[45] [25]
33 Right rear cover 3 FC8-4135
[44] 34 Right lower sub cover 2 FC8-5298
[26] 35 Right lower sub cover 3 FC8-5335
[43] 36 Right lower cover FC8-4875
37 casset right upper sub cover 2 -
[42]
[27] 38 Right lower sub cover 1 FC8-4922
39 Casset grip -
[41]
40 casset right upper cover 2 -
[40] [28] 41 casset right upper sub cover 1 FC8-4861
[39] 42 casset right upper sub cover 3 -
[29] 43 Right front cover 3 FC8-4134
[38]
[37] 44 Stack bypass tray sub cover FC8-5105
[30]
[36] 45 Right front cover 2 FC8-4921
[35] [31] 46 Stack bypass tray FC8-5100
[34] 47 Right front cover 1 FC8-4153
[33] [32] 48 Grip FC8-4835
49 Right output frame cover -
F-4-2
50 Right upper cover FL3-1186
51 Reader right cover FL2-9818 / 9817*
T-4-2

* Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 / Color Image Reader Unit-B1

4-3
4
4
4-4
[59]Inner rear cover 1 [61]Inner rear cover 1
[52]Inner output cover
[58]Inner rear cover 2

[57]Inner rear cover 3

[53]Output frame [60]Inner right cover

[56]Output stopper
[55]Output tray

[54]Output tray guide

F-4-3

No. Name Service Parts No. Refarence


[52] Inner output cover -
[53] Output frame FC8-5363
[54] Output tray guide -
[55] Output tray FC8-4144
[56] Output stopper FC8-4766
[57] Inner rear cover 3 FC8-4917
[58] Inner rear cover 2 FC8-4145
[59] Inner rear cover 1 FC8-4915
[60] Inner right cover -
[61] Inner output sensor cover FC8-4916
T-4-3

4-4
4
4
4-5
List of Main Unit
■■Unit Layout

Control Panel

Hopper Unit

Recycle toner container

F-4-4

4-5
4
4
4-6

Developing unit(Bk)

Developing unit(C)

Developing unit(M)

Developing unit(Y)

Transfer Separation guide unit

ITB

Secondary transfer outer roller

Secondary transfer inner roller

ITB cleaning blade Primary transfer roller

F-4-5

4-6
4
4
4-7

ITB Unit

Toner container[Bk]
ITB Cleaning Unit Toner container[C]
Toner container[M]
Toner container[Y]

Drum Unit[Bk]

Developing Assembly[Bk]
Laser Scanner Unit
Drum Unit[C]

Developing Assembly[C]

Drum Unit[M]

Developing Assembly[M]

Drum Unit[Y]

Developing Assembly[Y]

Process Unit

F-4-6

4-7
4
4
4-8
No. Name Service Parts No. Refarence
[1] Control Panel FM3-7992
[2] Recycle toner container FM3-5945
[3] Hopper Unit NPN
[4] Toner container(Y) NPN
[5] Toner container(M) NPN
[6] Toner container(C) NPN
[7] Toner container(Bk) NPN
[8] ITB Unit NPN
[9] ITB Cleaning Unit FM3-5932
[10] Drum Unit (Y)
[11] Drum Unit (M)
[12] Drum Unit (C)
[13] Drum Unit (Bk)
[14] Developing Assembly (Y) (C5051/C5045) FM3-8977
[15] Developing Assembly (M) (C5051/C5045) FM3-8978
[16] Developing Assembly (C) (C5051/C5045) FM3-8979
[17] Developing Assembly (Bk) (C5051/C5045) FM3-8939
[18] Developing Assembly (Y) (C5035/C5030) FM3-8973
[19] Developing Assembly (M) (C5035/C5030) FM3-8974
[20] Developing Assembly (C) (C5035/C5030) FM3-8975
[21] Developing Assembly (Bk) (C5035/C5030) FM3-8976
[22] Process Unit NPN
[23] Laser Scanner Unit (C5051/C5045) FM3-5420
[24] Laser Scanner Unit (C5035/C5030) FM3-5425
[25] Second and Third Delivery Unit FM3-5999
[26] Multi-purpose Delivery Unit FM3-6013
[27] First Delivery Unit FM3-5977
Main Drive Unit [28] Right Door Unit FM3-6006
F-4-7
[29] Fixing Assembly NPN
[30] Cassette 1 Pickup Unit FM3-5935
[31] Cassette 2 Pickup Unit FM3-9230
[32] Cassette 1 NPN
[33] Cassette 2 NPN
[34] Main Drive Unit NPN
T-4-4

4-8
4
4
4-9
Clutch / Solenoid

Third delivery flapper solenoid (SL7)


Second delivery flapper solenoid (SL6)
Cassette 1 pickup
solenoid (SL2) First delivery flapper solenoid (SL5)

Cassette 2 pickup
solenoid (SL3)
F-4-8

No. Name Main Unit Service Parts No. Refarence


SL2 Cassette 1 pickup solenoid Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0408
SL3 Cassette 2 pickup solenoid Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0408
SL5 First delivery flapper solenoid Second and Third Delivery Unit FL3-4274
SL6 Second delivery flapper solenoid Second and Third Delivery Unit FL3-1169
SL7 Third delivery flapper solenoid Second and Third Delivery Unit FL3-1169
T-4-5

4-9
4
4
4-10

Multi-purpose
pickup clutch (CL1)

Multi-purpose tray
lifting solenoid (SL4)
Registration shutter
solenoid (SL1)

F-4-9

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


CL1 Multi-purpose pickup clutch Device Parts (rear) FH6-5076
SL1 Registration shutter solenoid Device Parts (rear) FK2-6871
SL4 Multi-purpose tray lifting solenoid Device Parts (rear) FK2-7310
T-4-6

4-10
4
4
4-11

Toner supply clutch (Bk)(CL5)

Toner supply clutch (C)(CL4)

Toner supply clutch (M)(CL3)

Toner supply clutch (Y)(CL2)

F-4-10

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


CL2 Toner supply clutch (Y) Main Drive Unit FK2-7285
CL3 Toner supply clutch (M) Main Drive Unit FK2-7285
CL4 Toner supply clutch (C) Main Drive Unit FK2-7285
CL5 Toner supply clutch (Bk) Main Drive Unit FK2-7285
T-4-7
4-11
4
4
4-12
Motor

Toner container motor (Bk) (M12)

Toner container motor (C) (M11)

Toner container motor (M) (M10)


Duplex feed motor (M20)
Toner container motor (Y) (M9)

Registration
motor (M19)
Cassette 1 pickup
motor (M16)
Multi-purpose
motor (M18)
Cassette 2 pickup
motor (M17)

F-4-11

4-12
4
4
4-13

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


M9 Toner container motor (Y) Device parts (rear) FK2-7895
M10 Toner container motor (M Device parts (rear) FK2-7895
M11 Toner container motor (C) Device parts (rear) FK2-7895
M12 Toner container motor (Bk) Device parts (rear) FK2-7895
M16 Cassette 1 pickup motor Device parts (rear) FK2-7326
M17 Cassette 2 pickup motor Device parts (rear) FK2-7326
M18 Multi-purpose motor Device parts (rear) FK2-7304
M19 Registration motor Device parts (rear) FK2-7327
M20 Duplex feed motor Device parts (rear) FK2-7326
T-4-8

4-13
4
4
4-14

Fixing delivery motor (M22)

Fixing motor (M21)

Shutter motor
(M27)

Laser shutter
motor (M28)

F-4-12

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


M21 Fixing motor Device parts (center) FK2-7302
M22 Fixing delivery motor Device parts (center) FK2-7304
M27 Shutter motor Device parts (center) FK2-2069
M28 Laser shutter motor Device parts (center) FK2-2069
T-4-9
4-14
4
4
4-15
Primary transfer separation motor (M15)

Third delivery motor (M25)

Reverse roller
motor (M24)

ITB displacement First & Second


control motor (M14) delivery motor (M23)
ITB motor (M13)

Image skew correction


motor (C) (M33)
Image skew correction Recycle toner stirring motor (M26)
motor (Bk) (M34)
Image skew correction Scanner motor (CBk) (M30)
motor (Y) (M31)

Image skew correction


motor (M) (M32)

Scanner motor (YM) (M29)

F-4-13

4-15
4
4
4-16

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


M13 ITB motor ITB Unit FK2-7300
M14 ITB displacement control motor ITB Unit FK2-7365
M15 Primary transfer separation motor ITB Unit FK2-7365
M23 First & Second delivery motor Second and Third Delivery Unit FK2-7304
M24 Reverse roller motor Second and Third Delivery Unit FK2-7304
M25 Third delivery motor Second and Third Delivery Unit FK2-7304
M26 Recycle toner stirring motor Process Unit FK2-7328
M29 Scanner motor (YM) Laser Scanner Unit -
M30 Scanner motor (CBk) Laser Scanner Unit -
M31 Image skew correction motor (Y) Laser Scanner Unit -
M32 Image skew correction motor (M Laser Scanner Unit -
M33 Image skew correction motor (C) Laser Scanner Unit -
M34 Image skew correction motor (Bk) Laser Scanner Unit -
T-4-10

4-16
4
4
4-17

Drum motor (Bk) (M4)

Drum motor (C) (M3)

Drum motor (M) (M2)

Drum motor (Y) (M1)

Developing
motor (Bk) (M8)
Developing
motor (C) (M7)
Developing
motor (M) (M6)
Developing
motor (Y) (M5)

F-4-14

4-17
4
4
4-18

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


M1 Drum motor (Y) Main Drive Unit FK2-7298
M2 Drum motor (M) Main Drive Unit FK2-7298
M3 Drum motor (C) Main Drive Unit FK2-7298
M4 Drum motor (Bk) Main Drive Unit FK2-7298
M5 Developing motor (Y) Main Drive Unit FK2-7303
M6 Developing motor (M) Main Drive Unit FK2-7303
M7 Developing motor (C) Main Drive Unit FK2-7303
M8 Developing motor (Bk) Main Drive Unit FK2-7303
T-4-11

4-18
4
4
4-19
Fan

Fixing heat exhaust


fan 2 (FM2)

Fixing heat exhaust


fan 1 (FM1)

Delivery fan 2 (FM9)

F-4-15

4-19
4
4
4-20

Delivery fan 1 (FM7)

Fixing cooling
fan (front) (FM5)
Process cartridge Fixing cooling
fan (rear) (FM4) fan (rear) (FM6)

Secondary transfer
exhaust fan (FM8)

Process cartridge
fan (front) (FM10)

F-4-16

4-20
4
4
4-21

Controller
fan 3 (FM13)
Controller
fan 1 (FM11)

Controller
fan 2 (FM12)

HDD cooling fan (FM14)

Power supply
cooling fan (FM3)

F-4-17

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


FM1 Fixing heat exhaust fan 1 Device parts (rear) FK2-7286
FM2 Fixing heat exhaust fan 2 Device parts (rear) FK2-3679
FM3 Power supply cooling fan Electric FK2-7286

4-21
4
4
4-22
FM4 Process cartridge fan (rear) Device parts (center) FK2-0360
FM5 Fixing cooling fan (front) Device parts (center) FK2-3679
FM6 Fixing cooling fan (rear) Device parts (center) FK2-3679
FM7 Delivery fan 1 Device parts (center) FK2-7362
FM8 Secondary transfer exhaust fan Device parts (center) FK2-7290
FM9 Delivery fan 2 Device parts (front) FK2-7291
FM10 Process cartridge fan (front) Device parts (center) FK2-3679
FM11 Controller fan 1 Electric FK2-8372
FM12 Controller fan 2 Electric FK2-8372
FM13 Controller fan 3 Electric FK2-8372
FM14 HDD cooling fan Electric FK2-7363
T-4-12

4-22
4
4
4-23
Sensor

Second delivery
tray full sensor (PS45)
Third delivery sensor (PS43)

Fixing pressure
sensor (PS30)
Inner delivery
sensor (PS37)

Second delivery sensor (PS42)


Shutter HP sensor (PS31)
Duplex inlet sensor (PS40)
Reverse sensor (PS39)
Shutter position sensor (PS32)

Primary transfer detachment


sensor 2 (PS23)
Primary transfer detachment
sensor 1 (PS22)
ITB steering
sensor (PS24)

ITB displacement
sensor 3 (PS27)
ITB displacement
sensor 4 (PS28)
ITB displacement
sensor 1 (PS25)

ITB displacement
sensor 2 (PS26)

F-4-18

4-23
4
4
4-24
No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence
PS22 Primary transfer detachment sensor 1 ITB Unit WG8-5848
PS23 Primary transfer detachment sensor 2 ITB Unit WG8-5848
PS24 ITB steering sensor ITB Unit WG8-5848
PS25 ITB displacement sensor 1 ITB Unit WG8-5848
PS26 ITB displacement sensor 2 ITB Unit WG8-5848
PS27 ITB displacement sensor 3 ITB Unit WG8-5848
PS28 ITB displacement sensor 4 ITB Unit WG8-5848
PS30 Fixing pressure sensor Fixing Assembly WG8-5783
PS31 Shutter HP sensor Fixing Assembly WG8-5783
PS32 Shutter position sensor Fixing Assembly WG8-5783
PS37 Inner delivery sensor Fixing Assembly WG8-5783
PS39 Reverse sensor Second and Third Delivery Unit WG8-5848
PS40 Duplex inlet sensor Second and Third Delivery Unit WG8-5848
PS42 Second delivery sensor Second and Third Delivery Unit WG8-5848
PS43 Third delivery sensor Second and Third Delivery Unit WG8-5848
PS45 Second delivery tray full sensor Second and Third Delivery Unit WG8-5848
T-4-13

4-24
4
4
4-25

[16] [1]
[15]
[14] [2]
[13]
[12]

[11]

[3]

[10]
New/old detection
[4] fuse (Bk) (UN59)
Bk drum rotation sensor 2 (UN38) New/old detection
[9] [5] fuse (C) (UN58)
[6] Bk drum rotation sensor 1 (UN37)
New/old detection
C drum rotation sensor 2 (UN36) fuse (M) (UN57)
[7]
C drum rotation sensor 1 (UN35) New/old detection
fuse (Y) (UN56)
[8] M drum rotation sensor 2 (UN34)
M drum rotation sensor 1 (UN33)
Y drum rotation sensor 2 (UN32)
Y drum rotation sensor 1 (UN31)

ATR sensor (Bk) (TS8)

ATR sensor (C) (TS7)

ATR sensor (M) (TS6)

ATR sensor (Y) (TS5)


F-4-19

4-25
4
4
4-26
INDEX No. No. Name Main Unit Service Parts No. Refarence
[1] PS8 Toner container cam HP sensor (Bk) Hopper Unit WG8-5848
[2] TS4 Piezo sensor (Bk) Hopper Unit -
[3] PS4 Toner supply sensor (Bk) Hopper Unit WG8-5783
[4] TS3 Piezo sensor (C) Hopper Unit -
[5] PS3 Toner supply sensor (C) Hopper Unit WG8-5783
[6] TS2 Piezo sensor (M) Hopper Unit -
[7] PS2 Toner supply sensor (M) Hopper Unit WG8-5783
[8] PS1 Toner supply sensor (Y) Hopper Unit WG8-5783
[9] TS1 Piezo sensor (Y) Hopper Unit -
[10] PS5 Toner container cam HP sensor (Y) Hopper Unit WG8-5848
[11] PS9 Toner cap position sensor (Y) Hopper Unit WG8-5783
[12] PS10 Toner cap position sensor (M) Hopper Unit WG8-5783
[13] PS6 Toner container cam HP sensor (M) Hopper Unit WG8-5848
[14] PS11 Toner cap position sensor (C) Hopper Unit WG8-5783
[15] PS7 Toner container cam HP sensor (C) Hopper Unit WG8-5848
[16] PS12 Toner cap position sensor (Bk) Hopper Unit WG8-5783
T-4-14
No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence
TS5 ATR sensor (Y) Developing Assembly -
TS6 ATR sensor (M) Developing Assembly -
TS7 ATR sensor (C) Developing Assembly -
TS8 ATR sensor (Bk) Developing Assembly -
UN31 Y drum rotation sensor 1 Main Drive Unit FM3-7944
UN32 Y drum rotation sensor 2 Main Drive Unit FM3-7944
UN33 M drum rotation sensor 1 Main Drive Unit FM3-7944
UN34 M drum rotation sensor 2 Main Drive Unit FM3-7944
UN35 C drum rotation sensor 1 Main Drive Unit FM3-7944
UN36 C drum rotation sensor 2 Main Drive Unit FM3-7944
UN37 Bk drum rotation sensor 1 Main Drive Unit FM3-7944
UN38 Bk drum rotation sensor 2 Main Drive Unit FM3-7944
UN56 New/old detection fuse (Y) Drum Unit -
UN57 New/old detection fuse (M) Drum Unit -
UN58 New/old detection fuse (C) Drum Unit -
UN59 New/old detection fuse (Bk) Drum Unit -
T-4-15

4-26
4
4
4-27

Right door sensor (PS20)

First delivery tray Second & third delivery


full sensor (PS44) door sensor (PS21)
First delivery sensor (PS41)

Fixing inlet sensor (PS34)

Transparency
Fixing arch sensor 1 (PS35)
sensor (UN51)
Fixing arch sensor 2 (PS36)
Registration
sensor (PS33)

Environment Patch sensor (rear) (UN48)


sensor 1 (UN22)

Laser shutter
sensor (PS29) Patch sensor (center) (UN49)

Vertical path sensor (UN53) Toner container outer


cover sensor (PS17)
Patch sensor (front) (UN47)

Environment sensor 2 (UN50)

Front door sensor (PS18)


Toner container inner cover sensor (Bk) (PS16)

Toner container inner cover sensor (C) (PS15)

Toner container inner cover sensor (M) (PS14)

Toner container inner cover sensor (Y) (PS13)


F-4-20
4-27
4
4
4-28
No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence
PS13 Toner container inner cover sensor (Y) Device Parts(front) WG8-5783
PS14 Toner container inner cover sensor (M) Device Parts(front) WG8-5783
PS15 Toner container inner cover sensor (C) Device Parts(front) WG8-5783
PS16 Toner container inner cover sensor (Bk) Device Parts(front) WG8-5783
PS17 Toner container outer cover sensor Device Parts(front) WG8-5848
PS18 Front door sensor Device Parts(front) WG8-5848
PS20 Right door sensor Device Parts(center) WG8-5848
PS21 Second & third delivery door sensor Device Parts(center) WG8-5848
PS29 Laser shutter sensor Device Parts(center) WG8-5783
PS33 Registration sensor Device Parts(center) WG8-5848
PS35 Fixing arch sensor 1 2-side Unit WG8-5848
PS36 Fixing arch sensor 2 2-side Unit WG8-5848
PS41 First delivery sensor Device Parts(center) WG8-5783
PS44 First delivery tray full sensor Device Parts(center) WG8-5783
UN22 Environment sensor 1 Device Parts(center) FM3-7941
UN47 Patch sensor (front) Device Parts(center) FK2-7315
UN48 Patch sensor (rear) Device Parts(center) FK2-7315
UN49 Patch sensor (center) Device Parts(center) -
UN50 Environment sensor 2 Electric FM3-6049
UN51 Transparency sensor Device Parts(center) -
UN53 Vertical path sensor Device Parts(center) FK2-6470
T-4-16

4-28
4
4
4-29

Multi-purpose size
sensor (UN52)

Duplex paper sensor (PS38)

Multi-purpose paper
sensor (PS47)

Right lower door


sensor (PS19)

Cassette 1 pre-registration sensor (PS55)

Cassette 1 paper sensor (PS49)

Cassette 2 pre-registration
Cassette 1 paper level sensor A (PS51) sensor (PS56)

Cassette 1 paper level sensor B (PS52)

Cassette 2 paper sensor (PS50)


Cassette 2 paper level sensor A (PS53)
Cassette 2 paper level sensor B (PS54)

F-4-21

4-29
4
4
4-30
No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence
PS19 Right lower door sensor 2-side Unit WG8-5848
PS38 Duplex paper sensor 2-side Unit WG8-5848
PS47 Multi-purpose paper sensor Multi-purpose Delivery Unit WG8-5783
PS49 Cassette 1 paper sensor Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0149
PS50 Cassette 2 paper sensor Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0149
PS51 Cassette 1 paper level sensor A Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0149
PS52 Cassette 1 paper level sensor B Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0149
PS53 Cassette 2 paper level sensor A Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0149
PS54 Cassette 2 paper level sensor B Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0149
PS55 Cassette 1 pre-registration sensor Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0149
PS56 Cassette 2 pre-registration sensor Cassette Pickup Unit FK2-0149
UN52 Multi-purpose size sensor Multi-purpose Delivery Unit FH7-7600
T-4-17

4-30
4
4
4-31
Heater / Other
Fixing heater (H1)

Sub thermistor 2 (TH1)

Temperature fuse (TP1)

Main thermistor 2 (TH1)


Main thermistor 1 (TH1)
Sub thermistor 1 (TH1)

Drum heater (Bk) (H2)

F-4-22

4-31
4
4
4-32
Speaker (SP1)

Leakage breaker
(ELCB1)

F-4-23

4-32
4
4
4-33

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


ELCB1 Leakage breaker Electric FH7-7626 (100/120V) / 7625 (230V)
H1 Fixing heater Fixing Assembly -
H2 Drum heater (Bk) Process Unit FK2-7295 (100/120V) / 7296 (230V)
SP1 Speaker Electric FK2-0428
TH1 Main thermistor 2 Fixing Assembly -
TH1 Main thermistor 1 Fixing Assembly -
TH1 Sub thermistor 1 Fixing Assembly -
TH1 Sub thermistor 2 Fixing Assembly -
TP1 Temperature fuse Fixing Assembly -
T-4-18

4-33
4
4
4-34
Switch

AC interlock
switch (SW5)

Cassette 1 size
switch B (SW7)
DC interlock
Cassette 1 size switch 1 (SW3)
switch A (SW6)

DC interlock
switch 2 (SW4)

Cassette 2 size switch B (SW9)

Cassette 2 size switch A (SW8)

F-4-24

4-34
4
4
4-35

Main power supply switch (SW1)

Environment
switch (SW2)

F-4-25

4-35
4
4
4-36

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


SW1 Main power supply switch Electric FM3-7799
SW2 Environment switch Electric FM3-7792
SW3 DC interlock switch 1 Device Parts (front) FM3-7808
SW4 DC interlock switch 2 Device Parts (front) FM3-7808
SW5 AC interlock switch Device Parts (rear) FM3-7800
SW6 Cassette 1 size switch A Cassette FM3-5933
SW7 Cassette 1 size switch B Cassette FM3-5933
SW8 Cassette 2 size switch A Cassette FM3-5933
SW9 Cassette 2 size switch B Cassette FM3-5933
T-4-19

4-36
4
4
4-37
PCB

Hub PCB

Toner sensor relay PCB (Bk) (UN42)

Toner sensor relay PCB (C) (UN41) Ten key PCB

Toner sensor relay PCB (M) (UN40) Inverter PCB

Sub key PCB CPU PCB


Toner sensor relay PCB (Y) (UN39)
Volume PCB

Laser driver PCB (C) (UN15)

Laser driver PCB (Bk) (UN14)

Laser driver PCB (Y) (UN13)

Laser driver PCB (M) (UN12)

F-4-26

4-37
4
4
4-38

No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence


C5051/C5045
UN12 Laser driver PCB (M) Laser Scanner Unit FM3-5420
UN13 Laser driver PCB (Y) Laser Scanner Unit FM3-5420
UN14 Laser driver PCB (Bk) Laser Scanner Unit FM3-5420
UN15 Laser driver PCB (C) Laser Scanner Unit FM3-5420
C5035/C5030
UN12 Laser driver PCB (M) Laser Scanner Unit FM3-5425
UN13 Laser driver PCB (Y) Laser Scanner Unit FM3-5425
UN14 Laser driver PCB (Bk) Laser Scanner Unit FM3-5425
UN15 Laser driver PCB (C) Laser Scanner Unit FM3-5425
UN39 Toner sensor relay PCB (Y) Hopper Unit FM3-7948
UN40 Toner sensor relay PCB (M) Hopper Unit FM3-7948
UN41 Toner sensor relay PCB (C) Hopper Unit FM3-7948
UN42 Toner sensor relay PCB (Bk) Hopper Unit FM3-7948
T-4-20

4-38
4
4
4-39
Developing sub bias PCB (Bk) (UN46)

Developing sub bias PCB (C) (UN45)

Developing sub bias PCB (M) (UN44)

Developing sub bias PCB (Y) (UN43)

Bk pre-exposure LED PCB (rear) (UN30)

C pre-exposure LED PCB (rear) (UN28)

M pre-exposure LED PCB (rear) (UN26)

Y pre-exposure LED PCB (rear) (UN24)


Drum unit new/old
detection PCB (UN19)
Bk pre-exposure LED
PCB (front) (UN29)

Recycle toner sensor PCB (UN21)

C pre-exposure LED PCB (front) (UN27)

Process unit relay PCB (UN20)

M pre-exposure LED PCB (front) (UN25)

Y pre-exposure LED PCB (front) (UN23)

F-4-27

4-39
4
4
4-40
No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence
UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB Process Unit FM3-7940
UN20 Process unit relay PCB Process Unit FM3-7938
UN21 Recycle toner sensor PCB Process Unit FM3-7949
UN23 Y pre-exposure LED PCB (front) Process Unit FM3-7945
UN24 Y pre-exposure LED PCB (rear) Process Unit FM3-7945
UN25 M pre-exposure LED PCB (front) Process Unit FM3-7945
UN26 M pre-exposure LED PCB (rear) Process Unit FM3-7945
UN27 C pre-exposure LED PCB (front) Process Unit FM3-7945
UN28 C pre-exposure LED PCB (rear) Process Unit FM3-7945
UN29 Bk pre-exposure LED PCB (front) Process Unit FM3-7945
UN30 Bk pre-exposure LED PCB (rear) Process Unit FM3-7945
UN43 Developing sub bias PCB (Y) Developing Assembly -
UN44 Developing sub bias PCB (M) Developing Assembly -
UN45 Developing sub bias PCB (C) Developing Assembly -
UN46 Developing sub bias PCB (Bk) Developing Assembly -
T-4-21

4-40
4
4
4-41

HDD DC controller
PCB (UN1)
Riser PCB

Main controller PCB 1 Main controller PCB 2

HVT 2 PCB (UN17)

HVT 3 PCB (UN18)

Cassette feed
driver PCB (UN3) HVT 1 PCB (UN16)
Relay PCB (UN5)
Pickup feed
driver PCB (UN2) Drum driver PCB (UN4)
24V power supply
PCB 2 (UN10)

AC driver
PCB (UN6)
AC sub driver
PCB (UN7)
All-night
power PCB (UN9)
12V power
supply PCB (UN11) 24V power
supply PCB 1 (UN8)
F-4-28

4-41
4
4
4-42
No. Name Main Unit Service parts No. Refarence
UN1 DC controller PCB Electric FM3-7931
UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB Electric FM3-7932
UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB Electric FM3-7933
UN4 Drum driver PCB Electric FM3-7934
UN5 Relay PCB Electric FM3-7935
UN6 AC driver PCB Electric FM3-7936 (C5051/C5045:100V)
FM3-7953 (C5051/C5045:120V)
FM3-7937 (C5051/C5045/C5035/C5030:100V)
FM3-7952 (C5035/C5030:100V)
FM3-7954 (C5035/C5030:120V)
UN7 AC sub driver PCB Electric FM3-7950
UN8 24V power supply PCB 1 Electric FM3-7955
UN9 All-night power PCB Electric FK2-6324 (100/120V)
FK2-6325 (230V)
UN10 24V power supply PCB 2 Electric -
UN11 12V power supply PCB Electric -
UN16 HVT 1 PCB Electric FK2-7348
UN17 HVT 2 PCB Electric FM3-6038
UN18 HVT 3 PCB Electric FK2-7350
- Main controller PCB 1 Electric FM4-3830 (C5051)
FM4-3831 (C5045)
FM4-3832 (C5035)
FM4-3833 (C5030)
- HDD Electric Fk2-8418
- Riser PCB Electric FM4-0795
- Main controller PCB 2 Electric FM4-0780
T-4-22

4-42
4
4
4-43
Conector

24

23
10 22

25

1 25
9 25
26 2 13 25
3 8
4
5
17 6
12 7
31 28
16
19
18
27
14
30

29

20
21

11

F-4-29

4-43
4
4
4-44

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J102 UN1 DC controller PCB 11 J822 - ECO-ID
2 J103 UN1 DC controller PCB 12 J202 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB
3 J104 UN1 DC controller PCB J5076 J5066 13 J1300 UN22 Environment sensor 1
3 J104 UN1 DC controller PCB J5076 14 J810 UN50 Environment sensor 2
3 J104 UN1 DC controller PCB - J3002 - Cassette feeding Unit-AD1
4 J106 UN1 DC controller PCB 16 J231 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB
5 J107 UN1 DC controller PCB 17 J201 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB
5 J107 UN1 DC controller PCB 18 J311 UN4 Drum driver PCB
6 J109 UN1 DC controller PCB 19 J313 UN4 Drum driver PCB
7 J110 UN1 DC controller PCB J5044 20 J654 UN16 HVT 1 PCB
7 J110 UN1 DC controller PCB J5044 21 J653 UN16 HVT 1 PCB
8 J111 UN1 DC controller PCB 22 J656 UN17 HVT 2 PCB
8 J111 UN1 DC controller PCB 23 J655 UN17 HVT 2 PCB
9 J112 UN1 DC controller PCB J5026 J5036 24 J5061 SW1 Main power supply switch
9 J112 UN1 DC controller PCB J5026 J5036 J5075 J5012 25 J42 TH1 Main thermistor 1
9 J112 UN1 DC controller PCB J5026 J5036 J5075 J5012 25 J42 TH1 Main thermistor 2
9 J112 UN1 DC controller PCB J5026 J5036 J5075 J5012 25 J42 TH1 Sub thermistor 1
9 J112 UN1 DC controller PCB J5026 J5036 J5075 J5012 25 J42 TH1 Sub thermistor 2
9 J112 UN1 DC controller PCB 26 J657 UN18 HVT 3 PCB
10 J114 UN1 DC controller PCB 27 J863 UN14 Laser driver PCB (Bk)
10 J114 UN1 DC controller PCB 28 J864 UN15 Laser driver PCB (C)
10 J114 UN1 DC controller PCB 29 J853 UN12 Laser driver PCB (M)
10 J114 UN1 DC controller PCB 30 J854 UN13 Laser driver PCB (Y)
T-4-23

4-44
4
4
4-45

34

33

35

19
24 21
20

31
32

15
16
13
14

1
2
11
8
3 7
12

30 6
10 5
4
9

25

18
17

F-4-30

4-45
4
4
4-46

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J118 UN1 DC controller PCB J825 13 J102 UN13 Laser driver PCB (Y)
1 J118 UN1 DC controller PCB J825 14 J203 UN12 Laser driver PCB (M)
2 J119 UN1 DC controller PCB J823 15 J102 UN15 Laser driver PCB (C)
2 J119 UN1 DC controller PCB J823 16 J203 UN14 Laser driver PCB (C)
3 J121 UN1 DC controller PCB 17 J401 UN5 Relay PCB
4 J122 UN1 DC controller PCB 18 J402 UN5 Relay PCB
5 J123 UN1 DC controller PCB J5028 J5068 19 J6087 PS34 Fixing inlet sensor
5 J123 UN1 DC controller PCB J5028 J5068 20 J6086 PS36 Fixing arch sensor 2
5 J123 UN1 DC controller PCB J5028 J5068 21 J6085 PS35 Fixing arch sensor 1
6 J124 UN1 DC controller PCB J5045 24 J6084 M21 Fixing motor
7 J125 UN1 DC controller PCB 25 J203 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB
8 J126 UN1 DC controller PCB J5071 - J815 - Buffer Pass Unit-G1
8 J126 UN1 DC controller PCB J5071 - J816 - Inner Finisher-A1
9 J127 UN1 DC controller PCB J5037 - J809 - Booklet Finisher-C1/Staple Finisher-C1
9 J127 UN1 DC controller PCB - J813 - Paper Deck Unit-B1
10 J132 UN1 DC controller PCB 30 J5042 - Key Switch Unit
11 J136 UN1 DC controller PCB J5053 31 J2111 SW3 DC interlock switch 1
11 J136 UN1 DC controller PCB J5053 32 J2111 SW4 DC interlock switch 2
12 J138 UN1 DC controller PCB J5031 33 J6140 M25 Third delivery motor
12 J138 UN1 DC controller PCB J5031 34 J6141 M24 Reverse roller motor
12 J138 UN1 DC controller PCB J5031 35 J6142 M23 First & Second delivery motor
T-4-24

4-46
4
4
4-47

20

26

19 25
24 9
21 8
23
22 28
11 7
31

29
27
17
13
16
10 18
12

14
15

1
4

5
3
2

F-4-31

4-47
4
4
4-48

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J204 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5003 J5109 6 J6058 M22 Fixing delivery motor
1 J204 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5003 7 J6091 PS44 First delivery tray full sensor
1 J204 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5003 8 J6088 PS41 First delivery sensor
1 J204 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5003 J5110 9 J6099 PS21 Second & third delivery door sensor
1 J204 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5003 - J6070 - -
1 J204 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5003 11 J6062 FM9 Delivery fan 2
2 J205 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5050 J5051 J755 J601 12 J900 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB
2 J205 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5050 J5051 J755 J601 10 J901 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB
2 J205 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5050 J5051 J755 13 J600 UN20 Process unit relay PCB
2 J205 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5050 J5051 J755 14 J6111 M26 Waste toner stirring motor
2 J205 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5050 J5051 J755 15 J6110 UN21 Waste toner sensor PCB
3 J207 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5048 J5046 16 J6108 UN49 Patch sensor (center)
3 J207 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5048 J5046 17 J6107 UN48 Patch sensor (rear)
3 J207 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5048 J5046 18 J6106 UN47 Patch sensor (front)
4 J210 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5032 J5108 19 J6076 PS40 Duplex inlet sensor
4 J210 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5032 20 J6075 PS43 Third delivery sensor
4 J210 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5032 J5097 21 J6074 SL7 Third delivery flapper solenoid
4 J210 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5032 J5097 22 J6073 SL6 Second delivery flapper solenoid
4 J210 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5032 J5106 J5083 23 J6065 SL5 First delivery flapper solenoid
4 J210 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5032 J5106 J5083 24 J6089 PS42 Second delivery sensor
4 J210 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5032 J5106 25 J6090 PS39 Reverse sensor
4 J210 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5032 26 J6092 PS45 Second delivery tray full sensor
5 J212 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5028 J5054 27 J6077 PS38 Duplex paper sensor
5 J212 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5028 J5099 28 J6081 UN52 Multi-purpose size sensor
5 J212 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5028 J5099 29 J6171 PS47 Multi-purpose paper sensor
5 J212 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5028 31 J5100 PS19 Right lower door sensor
T-4-25

4-48
4
4
4-49

14
13
12
33
11
10

20
21

32 18 7
22
31 17 8
26 15 9 23
30 19
34
24 16
29

27
25

6
4 1

3
2
5

F-4-32

4-49
4
4
4-50
KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J213 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5086 7 J6082 CL1 Multi-purpose pickup clutch
1 J213 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5086 8 J6083 M18 Multi-purpose motor
1 J213 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5086 9 J6072 SL4 Bypass tray lifter solenoid
1 J213 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J6056 10 J6157 M19 Registration motor
1 J213 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J6057 11 J6158 M20 Duplex feed motor
1 J213 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB 12 J6066 FM1 Fixing heat exhaust fan 1
1 J213 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB 13 J6067 FM2 Fixing heat exhaust fan 2
1 J213 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB 14 J5004 PS20 Right door sensor
2 J214 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5049 15 J6060 M28 Laser shutter motor
2 J214 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5049 16 J6123 FM10 Process cartridge fan (front)
2 J214 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5049 17 J6097 PS29 Laser shutter sensor
3 J215 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB 18 J6155 M16 Cassette 1 pickup motor
3 J215 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB 19 J6156 M17 Cassette 2 pickup motor
4 J216 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5036 J5075 J5012 20 J6103 PS31 Shutter HP sensor
4 J216 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5036 J5075 J5012 21 J6102 PS32 Shutter position sensor
4 J216 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5036 J5075 J5012 J5060 22 J6104 PS30 Fixing pressure sensor
4 J216 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5038 J5075 J5012 J5060 23 J6101 PS37 Inner delivery sensor
5 J217 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5055 - J5059 - -
5 J217 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5055 J5041 24 J6093 UN51 Transparency sensor
5 J217 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5055 J5056 25 J6064 SL1 Registration shutter solenoid
5 J217 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5055 J5057 26 J6095 PS33 Registration sensor
5 J217 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5055 J5058 27 J6096 PS18 Front door sensor
5 J217 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5055 J5114 29 J6094 UN53 Vertical path sensor
6 J218 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5034 30 J6071 FM8 Secondary transfer exhaust fan
6 J218 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5034 31 J6069 FM6 Fixing cooling fan (rear)
6 J218 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5034 32 J6068 FM5 Fixing cooling fan (front)
6 J218 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5034 33 J6061 FM7 Delivery fan 1
6 J218 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB J5034 34 J6059 M27 Shutter motor
T-4-26

4-50
4
4
4-51

14
17
13
16
15
19 6
20 7
22 21 9
25 23
24

12
8
11
10
4
5

3
2

F-4-33
4-51
4
4
4-52
KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J234 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5073 4 J6127 SW9 Cassette 2 size switch B
1 J234 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5073 5 J6128 SW8 Cassette 2 size switch A
1 J234 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5074 6 J6125 SW7 Cassette 1 size switch B
1 J234 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5074 7 J6126 SW6 Cassette 1 size switch A
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5065 8 J6138 SL3 Cassette 2 pickup solenoid
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5065 9 J6137 PS56 Cassette 2 pre-registration sensor
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5065 10 J6136 PS54 Cassette 2 paper level sensor B
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5065 11 J6135 PS53 Cassette 2 paper level sensor A
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5065 12 J6134 PS50 Cassette 2 paper sensor
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5064 13 J6133 SL2 Cassette 1 pickup solenoid
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5064 14 J6132 PS55 Cassette 1 pre-registration sensor
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5064 15 J6131 PS52 Cassette 1 paper level sensor B
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5064 16 J6130 PS51 Cassette 1 paper level sensor A
2 J235 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5040 J5064 17 J6129 PS49 Cassette 1 paper sensor
3 J237 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5011 J5052 - J5067 - -
3 J237 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5011 J5052 19 J6032 PS23 Primary transfer detachment sensor 2
3 J237 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5011 J5052 20 J6031 PS22 Primary transfer detachment sensor 1
3 J237 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5011 J5052 J5062 21 J6030 PS28 ITB displacement sensor 4
3 J237 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5011 J5052 J5062 22 J6029 PS27 ITB displacement sensor 3
3 J237 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5011 J5052 J5062 23 J6028 PS26 ITB displacement sensor 2
3 J237 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5011 J5052 J5062 24 J6027 PS25 ITB displacement sensor 1
3 J237 UN3 Cassette feed driver PCB J5011 J5052 25 J6026 PS24 ITB steering sensor
T-4-27

4-52
4
4
4-53

43
44
45
42 41

40

39 37

14

38 34
15

36
35
16

33

26
27 30
25
31
24 10
28
23 32
11
22
29
21
12
13
8 17
7 18
9
19
1 20
3 2
6
5 4

F-4-34

4-53
4
4
4-54

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J303 UN4 Drum driver PCB 10 J6008 CL5 Toner supply clutch (Bk)
1 J303 UN4 Drum driver PCB 11 J6007 CL4 Toner supply clutch (C)
1 J303 UN4 Drum driver PCB 12 J6006 CL3 Toner supply clutch (M)
1 J303 UN4 Drum driver PCB 13 J6005 CL2 Toner supply clutch (Y)
2 J304 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5078 J5027 J5070 14 J6004 M15 Primary transfer separation motor
2 J304 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5078 J5027 J5070 15 J6003 M14 ITB displacement control motor
2 J304 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5078 J5027 J5070 16 J6025 M13 ITB motor
3 J305 UN4 Drum driver PCB 17 J6011 M8 Developing motor (Bk)
3 J305 UN4 Drum driver PCB 18 J6012 M7 Developing motor (C)
3 J305 UN4 Drum driver PCB 19 J6013 M6 Developing motor (M)
3 J305 UN4 Drum driver PCB 20 J6015 M5 Developing motor (Y)
4 J306 UN4 Drum driver PCB 21 J6024 UN31 Y drum rotation sensor 1
4 J306 UN4 Drum driver PCB 22 J6023 UN32 Y drum rotation sensor 2
4 J306 UN4 Drum driver PCB 23 J6022 UN33 M drum rotation sensor 1
4 J306 UN4 Drum driver PCB 24 J6021 UN34 M drum rotation sensor 2
4 J306 UN4 Drum driver PCB 25 J6020 UN35 C drum rotation sensor 1
4 J306 UN4 Drum driver PCB 26 J6019 UN36 C drum rotation sensor 2
4 J306 UN4 Drum driver PCB 27 J6018 UN37 Bk drum rotation sensor 1
4 J306 UN4 Drum driver PCB 28 J6017 UN38 Bk drum rotation sensor 2
5 J307 UN4 Drum driver PCB 29 J6010 M1 Drum motor (Y)
6 J308 UN4 Drum driver PCB 30 J6009 M4 Drum motor (Bk)
6 J308 UN4 Drum driver PCB 31 J6014 M3 Drum motor (C)
6 J308 UN4 Drum driver PCB 32 J6016 M2 Drum motor (M)
7 J309 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5079 J5029 J5030 33 J6053 PS13 Toner container inner cover sensor (Y)
7 J309 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5079 J5029 J5030 34 J6052 PS14 Toner container inner cover sensor (M)
7 J309 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5079 J5029 J5030 35 J6050 PS15 Toner container inner cover sensor (C)
7 J309 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5079 J5029 J5030 36 J6048 PS16 Toner container inner cover sensor (Bk)
7 J309 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5079 J5029 37 J6046 PS17 Toner container outer cover sensor
8 J310 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5015 J5016 38 J5017 UN39 Toner sensor relay PCB (Y)
8 J310 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5018 J5019 39 J5020 UN40 Toner sensor relay PCB (M)
8 J310 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5021 J5022 40 J5023 UN41 Toner sensor relay PCB (C)
8 J310 UN4 Drum driver PCB J5024 J5025 41 J5035 UN42 Toner sensor relay PCB (Bk)
9 J312 UN4 Drum driver PCB J1180 42 J2 M9 Toner container motor (Y)
9 J312 UN4 Drum driver PCB J1181 43 J5 M12 Toner container motor (Bk)
9 J312 UN4 Drum driver PCB J1182 44 J4 M11 Toner container motor (C)
9 J312 UN4 Drum driver PCB J1184 45 J3 M10 Toner container motor (M
T-4-28

4-54
4
4
4-55

31

23 18

24

2 19
5
11 6
16 1 21
34
3
20
15
12 4
7 9 32
8 10

22
14
30

F-4-35
4-55
4
4
4-56
KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J411 UN5 Relay PCB 14 J835 UN11 12V power supply PCB
2 J412 UN5 Relay PCB 15 J834 UN10 24V power supply PCB2
34 J426 UN5 Relay PCB - J5101 - Reader controll PCB
3 J413 UN5 Relay PCB 16 J691 UN9 All-night power PCB
5 J422 UN5 Relay PCB 18 J129 UN1 DC controller PCB
6 J423 UN5 Relay PCB 19 J211 UN2 Pickup feed driver PCB
7 J424 UN5 Relay PCB 20 J301 UN4 Drum driver PCB
7 J424 UN5 Relay PCB 21 J302 UN4 Drum driver PCB
8 J425 UN5 Relay PCB J5043 22 J650 UN16 HVT 1 PCB
8 J425 UN5 Relay PCB 23 J651 UN17 HVT 2 PCB
8 J425 UN5 Relay PCB 24 J652 UN18 HVT 3 PCB
9 J427 UN5 Relay PCB J5081 - J802 - USB Device Port-B1
10 J428 UN5 Relay PCB J5080 - J804 - Inner Finisher-A1
10 J428 UN5 Relay PCB - J805 - Cassette feeding Unit-AD1
10 J428 UN5 Relay PCB - J803 - Booklet Finisher-C1/Staple Finisher-C1
11 J432 UN5 Relay PCB 30 J6122 FM3 Power supply cooling fan
11 J432 UN5 Relay PCB 31 J6124 FM4 Process cartridge fan (rear)
12 J451 UN5 Relay PCB 32 J662 UN8 24V power supply PCB1
T-4-29

4-56
4
4
4-57

22

21

26

25

32

3
4
8 29
12
18
13
14 19
10
15 30
2

1
5
6
9
7 20
32
11 31
27

F-4-36

4-57
4
4
4-58

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J1001 UN6 AC driver PCB - - - AC in cable
2 J1002 UN6 AC driver PCB - J866 - GND
2 J1002 UN6 AC driver PCB - J833 - GND
3 J1003 UN6 AC driver PCB - - SW5 AC interlock switch
4 J1004 UN6 AC driver PCB 18 J1021 UN7 AC sub driver PCB
4 J1004 UN6 AC driver PCB 19 J1020 UN7 AC sub driver PCB
5 J1005 UN6 AC driver PCB 20 J681 UN9 All-night power PCB
- - SW5 AC interlock switch J5006 J5087 J5012 J5007 21 J5013 H1 Fixing heater
- - - - 22 J5014 H1 Fixing heater
- - SW5 AC interlock switch J5006 J5087 J5012 J5007 - - TP1 Temperature fuse
6 J1006 UN6 AC driver PCB J5006 J5010 - - SW1 Main power supply switch
7 J1007 UN6 AC driver PCB 32 J5005 H4 Cassette heater
32 J1008 UN6 AC driver PCB - - - Cassette Feeding Unit-AD1
8 J1009 UN6 AC driver PCB - - SW2 Environment switch
9 J1010 UN6 AC driver PCB - J5102 - Reader controll PCB
10 J1011 UN6 AC driver PCB J5038 25 J5088 H3 Drum heater (YMC)
10 J1011 UN6 AC driver PCB 26 J5039 H2 Drum heater (Bk)
11 J1012 UN6 AC driver PCB - - - Cassette heater unit-31/32
12 J2001 UN6 AC driver PCB 27 J431 UN5 Relay PCB
13 J2002 UN6 AC driver PCB - J5002 - -
14 J2003 UN6 AC driver PCB 29 J2020 UN7 AC sub driver PCB
15 J1022 UN7 AC sub driver PCB J5077 30 J1102 UN10 24V power supply PCB2
15 J1022 UN7 AC sub driver PCB J5077 31 J1101 UN11 12V power supply PCB
T-4-30

4-58
4
4
4-59

13
14
12
10
9
5

2
8
11
4
6
7
1
3

F-4-37

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J202 UN12 Laser driver PCB (M) 7 J103 UN13 Laser driver PCB (Y)
2 J204 UN12 Laser driver PCB (M) 8 J6159 M32 Image skew correction motor (M
2 J204 UN12 Laser driver PCB (M) 9 J6160 M31 Image skew correction motor (Y)
3 J205 UN12 Laser driver PCB (M) 10 J6161 M29 Scanner motor (YM)
4 J202 UN14 Laser driver PCB (Bk) 11 J103 UN15 Laser driver PCB (C)
5 J204 UN14 Laser driver PCB (Bk) 12 J6166 M33 Image skew correction motor (C)
5 J204 UN14 Laser driver PCB (Bk) 13 J6165 M34 Image skew correction motor (Bk)
6 J205 UN14 Laser driver PCB (Bk) 14 J6167 M30 Scanner motor (CBk)
T-4-31

4-59
4
4
4-60

21
20
17
16

4
14
3
13
2
12
1
11

10
8 22
9 19
7 18
5
6 15

F-4-38

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J902 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB J5093 11 J6114 TS5 ATR sensor (Y)
1 J902 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB 11 J5093 UN43 Developing sub bias PCB (Y)
2 J903 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB J5094 12 J6116 TS6 ATR sensor (M)
2 J903 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB 12 J5094 UN44 Developing sub bias PCB (M)
3 J904 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB J5095 13 J6118 TS7 ATR sensor (C)
3 J904 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB 13 J5095 UN45 Developing sub bias PCB (C)
4 J905 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB J5096 14 J6120 TS8 ATR sensor (Bk)
4 J905 UN19 Drum unit new/old detection PCB 14 J5096 UN46 Developing sub bias PCB (Bk)
5 J601 UN20 Process unit relay PCB 15 J6115 UN23 Y pre-exposure LED PCB (front)
6 J602 UN20 Process unit relay PCB 16 J6147 UN24 Y pre-exposure LED PCB (rear)
6 J602 UN20 Process unit relay PCB 17 J6148 UN26 M pre-exposure LED PCB (rear)
7 J603 UN20 Process unit relay PCB 18 J6117 UN25 M pre-exposure LED PCB (front)
8 J604 UN20 Process unit relay PCB 19 J6119 UN27 C pre-exposure LED PCB (front)
9 J605 UN20 Process unit relay PCB 20 J6149 UN28 C pre-exposure LED PCB (rear)
9 J605 UN20 Process unit relay PCB 21 J6150 UN30 Bk pre-exposure LED PCB (rear)
10 J606 UN20 Process unit relay PCB 22 J6121 UN29 Bk pre-exposure LED PCB (front)
T-4-32

4-60
4
4
4-61

18
14 17
10 13
6 9
5

4
3 20
2 16
19
1 12
15
8
11
7

F-4-39

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J658 UN39 Toner sensor relay PCB (Y) 5 J6154 PS5 Toner container cam HP sensor (Y)
1 J658 UN39 Toner sensor relay PCB (Y) 6 J6035 PS9 Toner cap position sensor (Y)
1 J658 UN39 Toner sensor relay PCB (Y) 7 J6034 PS1 Toner supply sensor (Y)
1 J658 UN39 Toner sensor relay PCB (Y) 8 J6033 TS1 Piezo sensor (Y)
2 J659 UN40 Toner sensor relay PCB (M) 9 J6151 PS6 Toner container cam HP sensor (M)
2 J659 UN40 Toner sensor relay PCB (M) 10 J6038 PS10 Toner cap position sensor (M)
2 J659 UN40 Toner sensor relay PCB (M) 11 J6037 PS2 Toner supply sensor (M)
2 J659 UN40 Toner sensor relay PCB (M) 12 J6036 TS2 Piezo sensor (M)
3 J660 UN41 Toner sensor relay PCB (C) 13 J6152 PS7 Toner container cam HP sensor (C)
3 J660 UN41 Toner sensor relay PCB (C) 14 J6041 PS11 Toner cap position sensor (C)
3 J660 UN41 Toner sensor relay PCB (C) 15 J6040 PS3 Toner supply sensor (C)
3 J660 UN41 Toner sensor relay PCB (C) 16 J6039 TS3 Piezo sensor (C)
4 J661 UN42 Toner sensor relay PCB (Bk) 17 J6153 PS8 Toner container cam HP sensor (Bk)
4 J661 UN42 Toner sensor relay PCB (Bk) 18 J6044 PS12 Toner cap position sensor (Bk)
4 J661 UN42 Toner sensor relay PCB (Bk) 19 J6043 PS4 Toner supply sensor (Bk)
4 J661 UN42 Toner sensor relay PCB (Bk) 20 J6042 TS4 Piezo sensor (Bk)
T-4-33

4-61
4
4
4-62

2
4 3
40
8 14
11 15
9
41 34
30 39
6 33
7 29
38
5 21
26
10
17 19
42
13 27
12 25
1
43 46
16
45 18
44
37
31 50
36
35
32 23
49
28
48 22
47
20
24

F-4-40

4-62
4
4
4-63

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J1020 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - Flash PCB
2 J1004 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - DDR2-SDRAM (M1)
3 J1000 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - DDR2-SDRAM (M0)
4 J1002 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - Voice Operation (Option A)
4 J1002 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - Voice Guidance (Option B)
5 J1018 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - USB(D)
6 J1015 - Main controller PCB 1 - - FM13 Controller fan 3
7 J1017 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - Ethernet
8 J1003 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - Operation part
9 J1019 - Main controller PCB 1 37 J103 - Riser PCB
10 J1021 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - USB(H)
11 J1007 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - Device Port Hub (Option)
12 J1027 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - Card Reader IF kit Card Reader(Option A)
12 J1027 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - RS Conv (USA only)(Option B)
12 J1027 - Main controller PCB 1 - - -
13 J1026 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - CC-VI I/F cable (TBD) (Option)
14 J1006 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - USB-FLASH (no use)
15 J1013 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - POSTPONE I/F (dealer only)
16 J1025 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - YON-RISER(PCI-Bridge) (option)
17 J1022 - Main controller PCB 1 - - - TPM
18 J11 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - DDR2-SDRAM (M1)
19 J12 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - DDR2-SDRAM (M0)
20 J13 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - DDR2 DIMM (P)
21 J14 - Main controller PCB 2 38 J101 - Riser PCB
22 J16 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - G3 FAX BOX (Option)
23 J17 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - G3 FAX BOX (Option)
24 J18 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - FRAM Counter
25 J1000 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - Image data analyzer PCB
26 J1010 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - Bypass PCB
26 J1010 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - EFI controller (option)
27 J3003 - Main controller PCB 2 - - - Reader controll PCB
28 JJ1xxx - Main controller PCB 2 - - - Debug SRAM (debug only)
29 J102 - Riser PCB - - UN1 DC controller PCB
30 J104 - Riser PCB - - - -
31 J105 - Riser PCB - - - HDD
32 J107 - Riser PCB - - - HDD
33 J108 - Riser PCB - - FM11 Controller fan 1
34 J109 - Riser PCB - - FM12 Controller fan 2
35 J110 - Riser PCB 39 J6174 FM14 HDD cooling fan
36 J111 - Riser PCB - - - SATA-Op
T-4-34

4-63
4
4
4-64

10
3 12
5 13

9
1
2
7 6
14 4

F-4-41

KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name Intermediate Connector KeyNo. J No. Symbol Parts Name
1 J1002 - CPU PCB - - Relay PCB
2 J1003 - CPU PCB 8 J4001 - Sub key PCB
2 J1003 - CPU PCB 9 J9001 - Inverter PCB
3 J1006 - CPU PCB 10 J2002 - Hub PCB
4 J1007 - CPU PCB 11 J1 - LCD
5 J1008 - CPU PCB 12 J3002 - Ten key PCB
6 J1009 - CPU PCB 13 J3001 - Ten key PCB
7 J4002 - Sub key PCB 14 J5001 - Volume PCB
T-4-35

4-64
4
4
4-65

Main Controller 3) Remove the signal cable and the power cable from the HDD.

Removing the HDD x2


■■How to remove Signal cable

1) Open the Right Rear Cover 1.

Power cable

F-4-44
4) Insert the signal cable and the power cable into the hole of the Controller Box.

F-4-42
2) Open the HDD Lid.
• 1 screw

F-4-45

F-4-43

4-65
4
4
4-66
5) Remove the HDD Unit. 7) Remove the HDD.
• 2 screws • 4 screws
• 1 grounding plate
• 4 spacers
• 4 vibration-prevention dumpers
x2

HDD
x4

HDD fixing plate

Spacers

F-4-46
Vibration-prevention dumpers
6) Remove the plate. HDD grounding plate

• 2 screws
F-4-48

Caution:
x2 At installation, install the grounding plate inside the [A] part of HDD Fixing Plate.

F-4-47
[A] [A]
Grouding Plate Grouding Plate

F-4-49

4-66
4
4
4-67
Removing the Main Controller PCB 1 2) Remove the USB cable and the control panel communication cable.
Control panel
■■Before removing the Main Controller PCB 1 communication cable USB cable

• Remove the Right Rear Cover x2


• 1 screw (RS tight; M4)
• 2 screws (TP; M3)
• 1 claw

x3
F-4-52
3) Remove the 2 screws and lift the grip.

x2

Claw

F-4-50

■■How to remove
1) If the Reader is installed, remove the Reader Power Cable. Grips
• 2 connectors F-4-53

• 2 wire saddles 4) Hold the grip and remove the Main Controller PCB 1.
• 1 cable guide Main controller PCB 1

Reader power cable


x2

x2
Cable guide

Wire saddles

F-4-54

Connectors
MEMO:
F-4-51
If option PCB is installed, remove it.

4-67
4
4
4-68

Caution: Removing the Main Controller PCB 2


At installation, lift the grip, insert the Main Controller PCB 1 until it stops, then tilt the ■■Before Removing the Main Controller PCB 2
grip and install it with 2 screws.
• Remove the Left Rear Cover and the Left Rear Sub Cover.
1) Remove the Left Rear Cover.
• 2 rubber caps
x2
• 2 screws
• 5 claws

Rubber cap

x2
Grips Claws

F-4-55 x5

MEMO:
If the Reader Unit is installed, handle the reader power cable from the connector side, Rubber cap
make the cable slack in the upper area and install it.

F-4-57
Reader power cable
x2 2) If the Reader Unit is installed, remove the reader signal cable.
• 1 connector

x2
Cable guide

Wire saddles

Connectors

F-4-56

MEMO:
Make sure that the Main Controller PCB 1 is fixed to the device.
F-4-58

4-68
4
4
4-69
3) Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover.
MEMO:
• 1 screw
When the option PCB is installed, remove it.
• 1 hook

Hook Caution:
At installation, avoid the harness, hold the grip in raised condition, put the Main
Controller PCB 2 all the way in, tilt the grip, and install it.

x2

Left rear sub cover

■■How to remove F-4-59 Grip

1) If the FAX Unit is installed, remove the connector of communication cable.

MEMO:
If the FAX Unit is installed, install the connector.

MEMO:
Make sure that the Main Controller PCB 2 is fixed to the device.

F-4-60
2) Hold the grip and remove the Main Controller PCB 2.
• 2 screws

x2

Grip

F-4-61

4-69
4
4
4-70
Opening the Controller Box ■■How to open
1) When the Reader is installed, remove the reader power cable.
■■Before opening the Controller Box
• 2 connectors
• Remove the Right Rear Cover • 2 wire saddles
• Remove the Left Rear Cover • 1 cable guide
• Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover
• Remove the Rear Cover
• 2 rubber caps x2 Reader power cable
• 2 screws
• 1 claw
x2
Cable guide

x2 Wire saddles

Connectors

F-4-63
Rubber caps
2-1) Avoid the harness and open the Controller Box.
Claw • 2 screws

x2
Rear cover
F-4-62

F-4-64

4-70
4
4
4-71
2-2) When the FAX Unit is installed, avoid the harness and open the Controller Box and the
Removing the DC Controller PCB
FAX Unit.
• 3 screws ■■Before Removing the DC Controller PCB

MEMO:
x3 When replacing the DC Controller PCB, execute the following Service Mode to backup
the DC Controller PCB SRAM.
Execute COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > DSRAMBUP (LEVEL2).
After “ACTIVE” is displayed for approx. 2 minutes, “OK!” is displayed.
After the above execution is completed, turn OFF the main power supply.

• Remove the Right Rear Cover


• Remove the Left Rear Cover
• Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover
F-4-65
• Remove the Rear Cover
3) Close the Controller Box while pressing the cable with afinger. Check that the cable is
• Open the Controller Box
stored when closeing the box.

■■How to remove
1) Remove the DC Controller PCB
• 28 connectors
Cable • 7 screws

x28

x7

F-4-67
F-4-66

4-71
4
4
4-72

Caution: Removing the Main Power Unit


There is a connector on the backside of the DC Controller PCB. When removing the DC ■■Before removing the Main Power Unit
Controller PCB, be careful about the connecter.
• Remove the Right Rear Cover
• Remove the Left Rear Cover
Connector
• Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover
• Remove the Rear Cover
• Remove the Rear Lower Cover

1) Remove the Connector Cover.


• 1 screw

2) Turn ON the main power supply and restore the DC Controller PCB SRAM.
Execute COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > DSRAMRES (LEVEL2).
After the above execution, “ACTIVE” is displayed for approx. 2 minutes, then “OK!” is
displayed. Restoration is completed now. F-4-68
2) When the Cassette Pedestal is installed, remove the connector.
• 6 harness guides
• 5 connectors

Connectors

x6

x5

Harness guides

F-4-69

4-72
4
4
4-73
3) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. ■■How to remove
• 2 rubber caps
1) Open the Drum Driver Unit.
• 2 screws
• 1 screw
• 2 claws
• 2 hooks

Drum Driver Unit


x2
Claw
x2
Claw Screw

Hook
F-4-71
2) Remove the FIN Lattice Connector Unit.
• 2 connectors
Hook • 1 wire saddle
• 2 screws

Wire saddle Connector

x2
Connector

F-4-70
Finisher laffice Screws
x2 connector unit

F-4-72

4-73
4
4
4-74
3) Pull out the Main Power Unit.
Removing the AC Driver
• 3 connectors
• 3 screws ■■Before removing the AC Driver
• Remove the Right Rear Cover
Connectors • Remove the Left Rear Cover
• Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover
x3 Main power unit
• Remove the Rear Cover
• Remove the Rear Lower Cover
x3
■■How to remove
1) Remove all the connector on the PCB and remove the AC Driver.
• 6 wire saddles
Screw
Screw Screw • 13 connectors (12 pieces for overseas model)
F-4-73
• 3 screws
4) Remove the Main Power Unit. Wire saddles AC Driver Screw
• 15 connectors
• 5 wire saddles
x6
Connectors
x13
x15 12 Connectors Screw
13 Connectors
x3
Wire saddles Screw
x5
Wire saddles F-4-75

Connector
Wire saddles Main power unit
F-4-74

4-74
4
4
4-75
Removing the Control Panel 3) Stand the Control Panel as indicated.

■■How to remove
1) Pull out the Control Panel and remove the mold.

Control panel

Mold

F-4-78
4) Remove the cover.
• 1 seal
• 1 screw
F-4-76
2) Remove the stopper.
Cover
• 2 screws Seal

x2

Stopper

F-4-79

F-4-77

4-75
4
4
4-76
5) Remove the cable.
• 2 wire saddles
• 2 connectors

Connector

x2

x2
Connector
Wire saddles

F-4-80

4-76
4
4
4-77

Laser Exposure System Removing the Dust-blocking Glass Cleaning Pad


■■Before Removing the Dust-blocking Glass Cleaning Pad
Cleaning the Dust-blocking Glass
• Open the Front Cover.
■■Before Cleaning the Dust-blocking Glass
• Open the Front Cover. ■■How to remove
1) Remove the Glass Cleaning Tool.

F-4-81

■■How to Clean F-4-83


2) Remove the Dust-blocking Glass Cleaning Pad.
1) Take out the Dust-blocking Cleaning Tool and clean the Dust-blocking Glass from the 4
holes of the Waste Toner Container.

Dust-blocking glass
cleaning tool

F-4-84

F-4-82

4-77
4
4
4-78
Removing the Laser Scanner Unit ●● Remove the ITB Unit
1) Check that the arrow of ITB Sub Pressure Release Lever is aligned with the triangle mark.
■■Before Removing the Laser Scanner Unit (If it is not aligned, adjust the arrow of lever to the triangle mark.)
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover.

Triangle mark Triangle mark

ITB sub pressure ITB sub pressure


release lever release lever

F-4-85 F-4-87

●● Remove the ITB Cover. 2) Turn the ITB Pressure Release Lever in the right direction until the protrusion of grip is
• 2 screws (loosen) aligned with the triangle mark on the plate to release the pressure.

ITB pressure release lever

F-4-88

F-4-86
Caution:
Caution: Before operating the ITB Pressure Release Lever, check that the Right Lower Cover is
• When installing the ITB Cover, be sure to push it to the left. If the pushing is open.
insufficient, the plate is not inserted to the slit of the ITB Cover, which may cause the
damage of the sensor.

4-78
4
4
4-79
3) Remove the 2 connectors.
Caution:
When pulling out the ITB Unit, it may drop because it does not click at stop position if
pulled out while lifting it. Thus, be careful of pulling it out.
x2

F-4-90

F-4-89 4) Pull out the ITB Unit up to the stop label position flatly.
• 2 screws
Caution:
When pulling out the ITB Unit, be sure not to lower the ITB Pressure Release Lever
x2
below the position where clicky sense is felt. If the ITB Unit is pulled out while the lever
is lowered, the ITB is scraped by the Plate and this may cause to make scratches on Stop label position
the ITB surface.

ITB pressure
release lever
F-4-91

Click position

Not to lower the ITB Pressure Releace Lever


below the position where clicky sense is felt.

4-79
4
4
4-80
5) Hold the ITB Unit as show in the below figure, and remove in the direction of the arrow ●● Removing the Process Unit

Caution:
When installing/removing the Process Unit, do not remove the Waste Toner Container.

1) Remove the 4 stepped screws fixed on the right and left rails.

x4

F-4-92

Caution:
When installing the ITB Unit, align the ITB Unit with the 2 positions at the lead edge of
rail.

Rails F-4-94
2) Hold the front and rear of Process Unit and remove it flatly.

ITB unit

F-4-93

F-4-95

4-80
4
4
4-81
3) Place the paper onto the Process Unit to protect the Drum Unit from the light. ■■How to remove
Paper

Caution:
When Replacing the Laser Scanner Unit
When removing the Laser Scanner Unit, be sure to check the serial numbers affixed on
both units and installation position of the units before operation.
Before installing the units, be sure to see the foregoing serial numbers and install each
unit to the original position.
If the unit is installed reversely, the image displacement might occur.

F-4-96
4) Take the 2 rails of Process Unit back to the host machine.
Memo:
This procedure describes the removal of Bk,C Laser Scanner Unit. Go through the
same procedure for removing the M,Y Laser Scanner Unit.

1) Remove the Drum Heater.


• 1 screw

Drum heater

F-4-97

Screw

F-4-98

4-81
4
4
4-82
2) Remove the Image Formation Suction Duct. 4) Remove the Left Duct Unit.
• 1 screw • 2 screws
• 1 claw

x2

Image formation suction duct

Screw

Left duct unit

Claw F-4-101
5) Remove the Scanner Fixing Spring.
• 1 screw

F-4-99

Memo:
When removing the Laser Scanner Unit 1 (Y/M laser),

3) Remove the Left Upper Cover.


Fixing spring Screw
• 5 rubber caps
• 5 screws F-4-102

• 3 hooks 6) Remove the Laser Scanner Unit.


• 5 claws • 4 connectors

Laser scanner unit


Left upper cover Connectors Connectors
x5 x5 x2 x2

x3
Claws
Claws

F-4-103
Rubber caps

F-4-100

4-82
4
4
4-83

Caution:
Since the Laser Scanner Unit needs adjustment, do not disassemble it.

Caution:
At installation, push the protrusion of Laser Scanner Unit into the hole of rear plate and
adjust the front boss with the plate hole and install it.

Protrusion Laser scanner unit

Hole

Boss
Protrusion

Caution:
At installation, pass the harness through the Sheet Guide and install it.

Sheet guide Sheet guide

4-83
4
4
4-84

Image Formation System Removing the ITB Unit


■■Before Removing the ITB Unit
Removing the Toner Filter
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
■■How to remove
1) Remove the Toner Filter Cover.
• 1 claw

Claw

F-4-106
• Remove the ITB Cover.
• 2 screws (loosen)

F-4-104
2) Remove the Fan Protection Plate and the Toner Filter.

Toner filter

Fan protection plate

F-4-107

CAUTION:
• Do not touch the ITB surface.
F-4-105 • When installing the ITB Cover, be sure to push it to the left. If the pushing is
insufficient, the plate is not inserted to the slit of the ITB Cover, which may cause the
damage of the sensor.

4-84
4
4
4-85
■■How to remove 3) Remove the 2 connectors.

1) Check that the arrow of ITB Sub Pressure Release Lever is aligned with the triangle mark.
(If it is not aligned, adjust the arrow of lever to the triangle mark.) x2

Triangle mark Triangle mark

ITB sub pressure F-4-110


ITB sub pressure
release lever release lever
CAUTION:

F-4-108
When pulling out the ITB Unit, be sure not to lower the ITB Pressure Release Lever
below the position where clicky sense is felt. If the ITB Unit is pulled out while the lever
2) Turn the ITB Pressure Release Lever in the arrow direction until the protrusion of grip is
is lowered, the ITB is scraped by the Plate and this may cause to make scratches on
aligned with the triangle mark on the plate to release the pressure.
the ITB surface.

ITB pressure
release lever

Click position

Not to lower the ITB Pressure Releace Lever


ITB pressure release lever
below the position where clicky sense is felt.

F-4-109

CAUTION:
Before operating the ITB Pressure Release Lever, check that the Right Lower Cover is
open.

4-85
4
4
4-86
5) Hold the ITB Unit as show in the below figure, and remove in the direction of the arrow
CAUTION:
When pulling out the ITB Unit, it may drop because it does not click at stop position if
pulled out while lifting it. Thus, be careful of pulling it out.

F-4-112

4) Pull out the ITB Unit up to the stop label position flatly. CAUTION:
• 2 screws
When installing the ITB Unit, align the ITB Unit with the 2 positions at the lead edge of
rail.
x2
Rails
Stop label position

F-4-111

ITB unit

6) To execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection, make the main body in standby state.
7) Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection Service Mode (COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-
P>ITB-INIT) (Level 1). This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.

4-86
4
4
4-87
Cleaning the Patch Sensor Remove the Patch Sensor (front,center,rear)
■■Before cleaning the patch sensor ■■Before cleaning the patch sensor
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover • Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover • Remove the ITB Cover
• Remove the ITB Unit • Remove the ITB Unit
• Remove the Process Unit
■■How to Clean
1) While pushing the shutter, clean the surface of Patch Sensor with a cotton swab moistened
■■How to remove
with water and tightly wrung by wiping it in one direction. After cleaning, make sure that 1) Release the hook and remove the Shutter of the sensor.
there is no toner contamination on the sensor surface.. • 2 Claws

CAUTION: Shutter
Do not use the alcohol since it melts the sensor window and causes while turbidity.

CAUTION:
Do not dry-wipe it since the sensor window is charged and attracts the toner.
Claw

Patch sensor
Hook

F-4-114

Patch sensor shutter

F-4-113

4-87
4
4
4-88
2)Remove the Pre-secondary Transfer Guide. Be sure not to put too much force on the Pre- 4) Remove the Wire Saddle, Reuse band, and Edge Saddle to make the Sensor Assembly
secondary Transfer Guide when removing it. moving freely.
• 2 screws • 2 Wire Saddles
• 1 Reuse Band
• 1 Edge Saddle

Secondary Transfer Guide


Grounding Cable

Edge Saddle

Wire Saddle

Reuse Band
F-4-115
3) Remove the mold.
• 4 screws F-4-117
• 4 bosses 1) Remove the sensor desired to be replaced. (Patch Sensor (Rear) as an example)
• 2 Screws
• 1 Connector
Boss

F-4-116
Connector

F-4-118

MEMO:
When replace the Patch Senosor (center),Initialization of Patch sensor (center) is
necessary
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON > P-ALPHA Input Patch Sensor alpha value

4-88
4
4
4-89
Removing the ITB Cleaning Unit 2) Place the removed ITB Cleaning Unit on the paper.

■■Before removing the ITB Cleaning Unit


• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Remove the ITB Unit

■■How to remove

CAUTION:
When removing/installing it, do not contact the ITB Cleaning Unit to the ITB. F-4-120
3) To execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection, make the main body in standby state.
4) Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection Service Mode (COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-
P>ITB-INIT) (Level 1). This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.

1) Hold the left and right grip and remove the ITB Cleaning Unit in the direction of the arrow.
• 2 screws

x2

F-4-119

4-89
4
4
4-90
Removing the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit Installing the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit
■■Before removing the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit ■■Before installing the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover • Removing the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Remove the ITB Unit ■■How to Install
• Remove the ITB Cleaning Unit

CAUTION:
■■How to remove Do not touch the ITB Cleaning Blade.
1) Remove the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit and put it on the paper.
• 1 screw

F-4-121

1) Insert an A4 size paper between the Blade Unit installation position of the ITB Cleaning
MEMO: Unit and the sheet.
Hold the screw area of 2 screws on the ITB Cleaning Blade Unit so that it is easy to
remove.

Paper

Sheet

F-4-122

4-90
4
4
4-91
2) Check that the Blade Alignment Plate is installed, and then install the ITB Cleaning Blade 3) While paying attention not to bend the Protection Sheet, lift the sheet using a screwdriver.
Unit.At this time, be sure to move the paper inserted in step 1 toward the direction shown in After that, check that the sheet that is being lifted is above the pad.
the figure to prevent the sheet from flipping before the installation.

F-4-123

Paper

Sheet

F-4-125
F-4-124

4-91
4
4
4-92
4) After installing the ITB Cleaning Unit to the ITB Unit, apply tospearl on the whole area
Removing the ITB
indicated in the figure below.
■■Before removing the ITB
• Upgrade the machine to the following version or later.
MN-CON: Ver.34.05 D-CON: Ver.18.01
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Remove the ITB Unit
• Remove the ITB Cleaning Unit

CAUTION:
Do not tough the surface of ITB. (If needed, hold the ITB within 10mm from both edge
of the belt.)

F-4-126

CAUTION: ■■How to remove


When applying tospearl, be careful not to scatter it on inside of the ITB, the Drive Roller
1) Turn over the ITB Unit.
and the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller.
2) Remove the Push Slider.
If it is scattered on inside of the ITB, the Drive Roller or the Secondary Transfer Inner
• 1 stop ring
Roller, wipe it with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol while rotating the motor by
hand. At this time, turn the motor counterclockwise and do not turn it clockwise.

5) To execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection, make the main body in standby state.
6) Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection Service Mode (COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-
P>ITB-INIT) (Level 1). This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.

F-4-127
3) Pull the ITB Pressure Release Lever to the front.

4-92
4
4
4-93
4) Remove the harness. 6) Lift the ITB and stand it on the ITB Cover.
• 3 wire saddles
• 1 edge saddle CAUTION:
• Make sure that it is removed from the front and rear hooks.
• Make sure to align the claw of the ITB Cover with the cut-off of protection sheet.

x4
• 2 claws

x2

F-4-128
Hooks
5) Remove the rear pin.
• 1 screw

ITB cover

Claw
Claws

F-4-130

F-4-129

MEMO:
Place the ITB cover upside down on the place where the ITB Unit will be stood.

4-93
4
4
4-94
7) Pull out the front pin. 9) Insert papers as shown in the figure to prevent the ITB getting damage by the plate when
removing the ITB.
MEMO:
To lock the pressure, pull out the pin while holding the ITB Unit with hand.

• 1 screw

F-4-133
10)Hold the ITB within 10mm from the edge and remove it upward.

F-4-131 10mm
8) Bend the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller Unit by 90 degree and reinstall it with the pin
removed in step 7).

10mm

F-4-134

F-4-132

4-94
4
4
4-95

CAUTION: Do not touch the surface of ITB Drive Roller, Secondary Transfer Inner Removing the Primary Transfer Roller (Bk)
Roller and Primary Transfer Roller as it may cause the image failure.
■■Before removing the Primary Transfer Roller (Bk)
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Remove the ITB Unit
• Remove the ITB Cleaning Unit

■■How to remove

CAUTION:
Do not touch the surface of Drive Roller, Secondary Transfer Inner Roller and Primary
Transfer Roller as it may cause the image failure.

CAUTION: When replacing ITB with a new one, affix the label to the specific position
near the Waste Toner Ejection Mouth of the ITB Cleaning Unit after the ITB Unit is
installed.
When affixing the new label, be sure to remove the old label and replace with the new
one on the same position.

11)Turn ON the power of the host machine.


12) When the machine is in standby condition, execute the “Auto gradation correction”.
13) Execute the ITB equilibrium position detection in service mode (COPIER > FUNCTION >
MISC-P > ITB-INT). This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.

4-95
4
4
4-96
1) Pull out the pin, make the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller Unit straight and install the 3) While holding the front bushing, pinch the claw and remove the Disengagement/
removed pin. Engagement Arm.

Stopper Bushing

F-4-137
F-4-135
4) Remove the Primary Transfer Roller (Bk).
2) Remove the ITB Unit from the ITB Cover and place it onto the paper in the position where
• 1 bushing
the roller is placed upside.
• 1 spring
• 2 claws

ITB unit
Primary transfer roller (Bk)

x2

Bushing

Claws Spring

ITB cover Paper


F-4-136
F-4-138

MEMO:
There is no particular direction for the Primary Transfer Roller installation.

4-96
4
4
4-97

CAUTION: Removing the Primary Transfer Roller (C,M,Y)


• Wind paper on the Primary Transfer Roller (Bk) and without touching the surface of the
roller.
■■Before removing the Primary Transfer Roller (C,M,Y)
• Do not touch the roller surface. • Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Remove the ITB Unit
• Remove the ITB Cleaning Unit

■■How to remove

MEMO:
Paper
This procedure describes the steps for Primary Transfer Roller (C). Go through the
same procedure for M and Y.
Primary transfer roller (BK)

CAUTION:
Do not touch the surface of Drive Roller, Secondary Transfer Inner Roller and Primary
CAUTION:
Transfer Roller as it may cause the image failure.
Hold the stopper with finger lightly after installation to check that the claw is surely
installed.

5) To execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection, make the main body in standby state.
6) Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection Service Mode (COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-
P>ITB-INIT) (Level 1). This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.

4-97
4
4
4-98
1) Pull out the pin, make the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller Unit straight and install the 4) While holding the front bushing, pinch the claw and remove the Disengagement/
removed pin. Engagement Arm.

Disengagement/
engagement arm

Claw

Boss

Bushing

F-4-139 F-4-142

2) Remove the ITB Unit from the ITB Cover and place it onto the paper. 5) While holding the bushing, remove the stopper from the boss.
• 2 claws
Boss
ITB unit Stopper

x2

Claws
Bushing

ITB cover Paper


F-4-143
F-4-140
6) Remove the Primary Transfer Roller (C).
3) Turn the ITB Sub Pressure Release Lever to make the Primary Transfer Roller (C,M,Y)
• 1 bushing
lifted.
• 1 spring
Primary transfer roller(C) Primary transfer roller(M) Primary transferr oller(Y)

ITB sub pressure release lever


F-4-141

4-98
4
4
4-99
Bushing
CAUTION:
Spring • After installing the Primary Transfer Roller (C,M,Y), turn the ITB Sub Pressure Release
Transfer roller (C)
Lever to make sure that the Primary Transfer Roller (C,M,Y) moves up and down.
• After checking, be sure to make the Primary Transfer Roller (C,M,Y) lowered position.

Primary transfer roller (C) Primary transfer roller (M) Primary transfer roller (Y)

F-4-144
MEMO:
There is no particular direction for the Primary Transfer Roller installation.

ITB sub pressure release lever


CAUTION:
• Wind paper on the Primary Transfer Roller (C) and without touching the surface of the
roller.
• Do not touch the roller surface. 7) To execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection, make the main body in standby state.
8) Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection Service Mode (COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-
P>ITB-INIT) (Level 1). This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.

Paper

Primary transfer roller (C)

4-99
4
4
4-100
Removing the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller 1) Pull out the pin, make the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller Unit straight and install the
removed pin.
■■Before removing the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Remove the ITB Unit
• Remove the ITB Cleaning Unit

■■How to remove

CAUTION:
Do not touch the surface of Drive Roller, Secondary Transfer Inner Roller and Primary
F-4-146
Transfer Roller as it may cause the image failure.
2) Remove the ITB Unit from the ITB Cover and place it onto the paper in the position where
the roller side faces up.
• 2 claws

ITB unit

x2

Claws

F-4-145
ITB cover Paper
F-4-147

4-100
4
4
4-101
3) Remove the Grounding Plate and the Secondary Transfer Bearing Holder.
CAUTION:
• 1 screw
Be careful of the installation direction when installing the Secondary Transfer Inner
Roller.

Secondary transfer
Grounding plate bearing holder

F-4-148
4) Remove the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller.

5) To execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection, make the main body in standby state.
6) Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection Service Mode (COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-
P>ITB-INIT) (Level 1). This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.

F-4-149

4-101
4
4
4-102
Reinstalling the ITB 4) Remove the pin, and move the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller Unit toward the [2] direction
to take up the slack of the belt.
■■Before reinstalling the ITB
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Remove the ITB Unit
• Remove the ITB Cleaning Unit

■■How to reinstall
1) Check that the ITB Sub Pressure Release Lever is in the below position.

F-4-152
5) Put the ITB under the Belt Retainer Sheet, bring the ITB Displacement Sensor Flag into
contact with the ITB edge, and then, align the marking line with the position of the ITB.

Belt Retainer Sheet ITB Displacement sensor flag Marking Line

ITB sub pressure release lever


F-4-150
2) Stand the ITB Unit on the ITB Cover.
• 2 claws

x2

ITB cover F-4-153

Claw

Claws

F-4-151
3) Place papers on the ITB Cover to prevent bending of the ITB because pressure is applied
to a point when installing the ITB.

4-102
4
4
4-103
7) Remove the ITB Unit from the ITB Cover and install it to the plate.
CAUTION:
• 2 claws
When installing the ITB, be sure that the Plastic Film on the ITB Unit is inside of the
ITB.
x2

F-4-155

8) Install the rear pin.


• 1 screw

6) Return the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller Unit to straight, and then install the pin
removed
• 1 screw

F-4-156

F-4-154

4-103
4
4
4-104
9) Push the ITB Pressure Release Lever and install the Bush Slider to the boss.
CAUTION:
• 1 stop ring
Make sure that the shaft is fixed to the fixing member.

F-4-157

CAUTION:
Make sure that there is no gap between the ITB Pressure Release Lever and the Plate. CAUTION:
Make sure that the hook is fixed to the plate.

space

11) Turn over the ITB Unit.


12) Install the ITB Cleaning Unit.
10)Install the harness.
• 1 edge saddle
• 3 wire saddles

4-104
4
4
4-105

CAUTION: CAUTION:
When replacing ITB with a new one, after installing the ITB Cleaning Unit to the ITB When replacing ITB with a new one, affix the label to the specific position near the
Unit, apply tospearl on the whole area indicated in the figure below. Waste Toner Ejection Mouth of the ITB Cleaning Unit after the ITB Unit is installed.
When affixing the new label, be sure to remove the old label and replace with the new
one on the same position.

When applying tospearl, be careful not to scatter it on inside of the ITB, the Drive Roller
and the Secondary Transfer Inner Roller.
If it is scattered on inside of the ITB, the Drive Roller or the Secondary Transfer Inner
Roller, wipe it with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol while rotating the motor by
hand. At this time, turn the motor counterclockwise and do not turn it clockwise. 13)Turn ON the power of the host machine.
14) When the machine is in standby condition, execute the “Auto gradation correction”.
15) Execute the ITB equilibrium position detection in service mode (COPIER > FUNCTION >
MISC-P > ITB-INT). This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.

4-105
4
4
4-106
Removing the Recycle Toner Bottle Pulling Out the Process Unit
■■Before removing the Recycle Toner Bottle ■■Before pulling out the Process Unit
• Open the Front Cover • Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
■■How to remove
■■How to remove
1) Release the Recycle Toner Bottle Lock Lever.
1) Make sure that the arrow of ITB Sub Pressure Release Lever is aligned with the triangle
mark of the plate.
(If it is not aligned, align the arrow of lever with the triangle mark of plate.)

Triangle mark Triangle mark

F-4-158
2) Remove the Recycle Toner Bottle. ITB sub pressure ITB sub pressure
release lever release lever

F-4-160

F-4-159

CAUTION:
Do not tilt the Recycle Toner Bottle.
(Because it may cause misdetection on the Full Detection Sensor.)

4-106
4
4
4-107
2) Turn the ITB Pressure Release Lever in the right direction and release the pressure. 4) Place the paper onto the Process Unit to protect the Drum Unit from the light.

CAUTION:
Paper
When releasing the pressure of ITB Pressure Release Lever, make sure that the
protrusion of grip is aligned with the triangle mark of plate.

F-4-163

ITB pressure release lever

F-4-161
3) Pull out the Process Unit until it stops.
• 2 screws

x2

F-4-162

4-107
4
4
4-108
Removing the Process Unit 3) Place the paper onto the Process Unit to protect the Drum Unit from the light.
Paper
■■Before removing the Process Unit
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Pull out the Process Unit

■■How to remove

CAUTION:
When installing/removing the Process Unit, do not remove the Recycle Toner Bottle.
F-4-166
4) Take the 2 rails of Process Unit back to the host machine.

1) Remove the 4 stepped screws fixed on the right and left rails.

x4

F-4-167

F-4-164 NOTE:
2) Hold the front and rear of Process Unit and remove it flatly. When installing the Process Unit, if the Dustproof Shutter is opened and blocks to install
the unit, turn ON and then OFF the power. Be sure to check that the Dustproof Shutter
is closed before installation.

F-4-165

4-108
4
4
4-109
Reinstalling the Process Unit 3) Install the right and left rails and the Process Unit with 4 stepped screws.

■■Before reinstalling the Process Unit


• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
x4
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Pull out the Process Unit
• Remove the Process Unit

■■How to reinstall
1) Pull out the 2 rails of Process Unit from the host machine.

F-4-170

CAUTION:
Make sure that there is no gap [A] between the host machine and the Process Unit and
fix it with the screw.

F-4-168
2) Align the 4 protrusions of Process Unit with the positioning pin of rail and install it.

Protrusions of process unit Protrusions of process unit [A] [A]

F-4-171

Positioning pins Positioning pins


F-4-169

4-109
4
4
4-110
4) Slowly take the Process Unit back to the host machine and fix it with 2 screws. 5) Turn the ITB Pressure Release Lever in the left direction to apply the pressure.

CAUTION:

x2 When applying the pressure of ITB Pressure Release Lever, make sure that the
protrusion of grip is aligned with the lower triangle mark of plate.

F-4-172

CAUTION:
After closing the Process Unit, hold the edge of each Drum Unit from above as
described below. If the Drum Unit is not secured, it may cause the color displacement.

F-4-174
6) Install the ITB Cover and tighten the 2 loosened screws.

F-4-173
F-4-175
7) Close the Front Cover.
8) Close the Right Upper Cover.
9) Close the Right Lower Cover.

4-110
4
4
4-111
Removing the Drum Unit CAUTION:

■■Before removing the Drum Unit When removing the Drum Unit, do not pull it out from one handle.

• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Pull out the Process Unit

■■How to remove

CAUTION:
Do not touch the drum surface.

1)Hold the grip with both hands, press the Drum Unit against the Developing Assembly and
pull it out vertically.

F-4-177

Grips

F-4-176

4-111
4
4
4-112
Reinstalling the Drum Unit CAUTION:

■■Before reinstalling the Drum Unit When installing it at an angle, the shutter may be damaged. Thus, make sure to install it
from directly above.
• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Pull out the Process Unit
• Remove the Drum Unit

■■How to reinstall

CAUTION:
Do not touch the drum surface.

1) Hold the grip and install it from the top vertically. F-4-179

2) Align the guide of Process Unit with the guide of Drum Unit and install the Drum Unit.

Guide of
drum unit
Guide of
process unit
Guide of
drum unit
Grips
Guide of process unit

F-4-180

F-4-178 CAUTION:
Since the rail may be broken, make sure that the shutter is surely slid on the rail.

Shutter Shutter

Rail Rail
F-4-181

4-112
4
4
4-113

MEMO: 2-2) While the paper is set, install the Drum Unit (Bk) to the host machine.
When installing the Drum Unit (Bk) to the host machine, perform the following
Drum Unit (BK)
procedures.

2-1) Place the half fold paper included in the packaging box on the Developing Assembly
(Bk).Be sure to set the edge of half fold paper over the Toner Collecting Sheet of the
Developing Assembly.

2-3) Hold the folded portion and pull this paper out to the direction F-4-183
of arrow

3) Hold the grip part (8 places) with finger lightly and make sure that the Drum Unit is securely
installed.

Toner Collecting Sheet

F-4-182

F-4-184

4-113
4
4
4-114
Removing the Developing Assembly 2) Remove the stepped screw.

■■Before removing the Developing Assembly


• Open the Front Cover, Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the ITB Cover
• Pull out the Process Unit
• Remove the Drum Unit
• Remove the Recycle Toner Bottle
■■How to remove

F-4-186
MEMO:
This procedure describes the removal of Bk Developing Assembly. Go through the 3) While pulling out the stopper, remove the Developing Assembly upward.
same procedure for removing the Y,M,C Developing Assembly.

Developing assembly
CAUTION: Stopper

When installing/removing it, do not touch the Developing Sleeve.

CAUTION:
When installing/removing the Developing Assembly, be sure to remove the Recycle
Toner Bottle.
F-4-187

1) Remove the harness from the 2 harness guides and remove the connector. CAUTION:
Make sure to insert the 2 pins of stopper into the 2 holes of Developing Assembly and
install it.
x2 Harness
Harness guides

Connector

F-4-185

F-4-188

4-114
4
4
4-115

MEMO : Installing a new Developing Assembly


Initialization of Developing Assembly (toner ratio and patch) is necessary and it differs
depending on the color. ■■Before installing a new Developing Assembly
If 4 colors are replaced simultaneously, execute INISET-4.
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-Y Initialization of Y Developing Assembly • Opening the Front Cover
(toner ratio and patch) • Removing the ITB Cover
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-M Initialization of M Developing Assembly • Pulling out the Process Unit
(toner ratio and patch)
• Removing the Drum Unit
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-C Initialization of C Developing Assembly
(toner ratio and patch) • Removing the Waste Toner Container
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-K Initialization of Bk Developing Assembly
(toner ratio and patch)
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-4 Initialization of 4-colors Developing ■■How to install
Assembly (toner ratio and patch)
1) Install the Developing Assembly to the Process Unit in the reverse procedure of “Removing
the Developing Assembly”.
2) While holding the Developing Assembly with one hand, pull out the developing seal straight
up with other hand.
Perform this procedure for each color.

F-4-189

4-115
4
4
4-116

CAUTION: CAUTION:
When removing the Seal on the Developing Assembly, be sure to lift it slowly and If the Seal on the Developing Assembly is torn, remove the torn seal by pulling the end
vertically. If lifting it in an oblique direction, the Seal on the Developing Assembly is of it in the direction of the arrow. At that time, be careful not to leave the torn sheet in
stressed, and may cause tear of the seal the Developing Assembly.

Rear side
Seal

Seal

Front side

F-4-190
F-4-191

3) By following “installing the Drum Unit”, install the each color Drum Unit.
4) Be sure to hold the upper side of each Developing Assembly when removing the seal.
Otherwise the cover will be off from its position.

F-4-192

4-116
4
4
4-117

MEMO : Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller and


Initialization of Developing Assembly (toner ratio and patch) is necessary and it differs
depending on the color.
Secondary Transfer Separation Guide Unit
If 4 colors are replaced simultaneously, execute INISET-4.
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-Y Initialization of Y Developing Assembly ■■Before removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller and
(toner ratio and patch)
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-M Initialization of M Developing Assembly Secondary Transfer Separation Guide Unit
(toner ratio and patch)
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-C Initialization of C Developing Assembly
(toner ratio and patch)
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-K Initialization of Bk Developing Assembly
(toner ratio and patch)
■■How to remove
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-4 Initialization of 4-colors Developing
Assembly (toner ratio and patch) CAUTION:
Do not touch the surface of Secondary Transfer Outer Roller.

F-4-193

1) Place the paper to put the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller Unit.
2) Remove the rear stopper.
• 1 claw

F-4-194

4-117
4
4
4-118
3) Pinch the claws on both sides of bearing holder and remove the Secondary Transfer Outer 5) Remove the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller.
Roller Unit. • 2 bearing holders
• 4 claws • 2 bearings

x4
Bearing holder
Bearing

Bearing

Bearing holder
Secondary transfer
outer roller

F-4-195 F-4-197
4) Remove the Secondary Transfer Separation Guide Unit.
• 1 bushing
• 2 springs

Spring

Spring

Bushing
Secondary transfer
separation guide unit

F-4-196

4-118
4
4
4-119
Reinstalling the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller and 2) Fit the protrusion with the groove of the guide and install the bushing.
3) Install the spring onto both side of protrusion.
Secondary Transfer Separation Guide Unit
Spring

■■Before reinstalling the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller and


Secondary Transfer Separation Guide Unit
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller and Secondary Transfer Separation Guide
Unit

■■How to remove
Protrusion

F-4-199
CAUTION:
Do not touch the surface of Secondary Transfer Outer Roller.

1) Fit the side with longer shaft to the hole of Secondary Transfer Separation Guide Unit and
install the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller.

Shorter shaft Longer shaft

Hole

F-4-198

CAUTION:
After installing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller, make sure that the bearing holder
can rotate.

4-119
4
4
4-120

CAUTION: Removing the Toner Bottle manually


Make sure that the spring on the Duplex Unit side is not skewed. ■■Before Removing the Toner Bottle manually
• Remove the Right Rear Cover
• 1 screw (RS tight; M4)
• 2 screws (TP; M3)
• 1 claw

x3

F-4-200

4) Fit the spring on the Duplex Unit to the protrusion on the bearing holder of Secondary
Transfer Outer Roller Unit and install it one after other.
Claw

F-4-202
• Remove the Left Rear Cover, Left Rear Sub Cover.
1) Remove the Left Rear Cover.
• 2 rubber caps
• 2 screws
• 5 claws

Rubber cap

x2
F-4-201
Claws
5) Reinstall the rear stopper.
x5
MEMO:
When replacing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller, execute the service mode.
COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEANING > TNR-COAT
Rubber cap

F-4-203

4-120
4
4
4-121
2) If the Reader Unit is installed, remove the reader signal cable. • Remove the Rear Cover
• 1 connector • 3 rubber caps
• 3 screws
• 1 claw

x2

Rubber caps

Claw

F-4-204
3) Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover.
• 1 screw
Rear cover
• 1 hook
F-4-206

Hook
• Open the Controller Box
1) When the Reader is installed, remove the reader power cable.
• 2 connectors
• 2 wire saddles
• 1 cable guide

Reader power cable


x2

Left rear sub cover


x2
Cable guide
F-4-205

Wire saddles

Connectors

F-4-207

4-121
4
4
4-122
2-1) Avoid the harness and open the Controller Box. ■■How to remove
• 2 screws

MEMO:
This procedure describes the procedure of Toner Bottle (Bk). Go through the same
x2 procedure for Toner Bottle (C,M,Y).

1) Open the Toner Replacement Cover.


2) Remove the handle.
• 1 screw

Screw

F-4-208
2-2) When the FAX Unit is installed, avoid the harness and open the Controller Box and
the FAX Unit.
• 3 screws

x3

F-4-210
3) Install the handle to the shaft.
4) Turn the handle like ratchet and open the small cover.

F-4-209

F-4-211

4-122
4
4
4-123
5) Pull out the toner container.
Removing the Main Drive Unit
■■Before Removing the Main Drive Unit
• Remove the Right Rear Cover
• Remove the Left Rear Cover
• Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover.
• Remove the Rear Cover
• Open the Controller Box
• Remove the Rear Lower Cover

1) Remove the Connector Cover.


F-4-212 • 1 screw

CAUTION:
At installation, make sure to insert the Toner Container all the way in and close the
small cover.

F-4-214
2) When the Cassette Pedestal is installed, remove the connector.
• 5 connectors
• 6 harness guides

Connectors
F-4-213
x6

x5

Harness guides

F-4-215

4-123
4
4
4-124
3) Remove the Rear Lower Cover. ■■How to remove
• 2 rubber caps
1) Remove the Left Upper Cover.
• 2 screws
• 5 rubber caps
• 2 claws
• 5 screws
• 2 hooks

Left upper cover

x2 x5

Claw
x2
Claw

Hook Rubber caps

F-4-217
2) When the FAX Unit is installed, open the Controller Box and the FAX Unit while avoiding
Hook
the harness.
• 3 screws

x3

Harness
F-4-216

F-4-218

4-124
4
4
4-125
3) Open the High-voltage PCB. 5) Remove the Harness Guide Cover.
• 2 screws • 2 screws

HVT PCB Harness guide cover

x2 x2

F-4-219 F-4-221
4) Remove the Drum Driver PCB. 6) Pull out the harness of Laser Scanner and make a space by hooking the claw of harness
• 3 screws guide.
• 1 edge saddle
• 1 claw

x3 Harness

Drum driver PCB


Edge saddle
F-4-220

Claw
F-4-222

4-125
4
4
4-126
7) Remove the Fan Duct 1. 9) Remove all the red connectors from the Drum Driver PCB.
• 2 screws • 10 connectors
• 1 connector • 10 wire saddles
• 1 claw
Wire saddles Wire saddles

Claw x10 Connectors

Wire saddles
x10
x2 Connectors
Wire saddle
Wire saddles Drum driver PCB

Connector Connectors Connectors

Fan duct F-4-225

F-4-223 10) Remove the Main Drive Unit.


8) Remove the harness of Hopper. • 2 connectors
• 8 connectors • 6 screws

Connectors Connectors

x8 x2

x6

Connectors Main drive unit

F-4-224 F-4-226

4-126
4
4
4-127
Removing the Toner Container Front Inner Cover 2) Remove the Small Plate.
• 1 screw (P tight)
■■Before remove the Toner Container Front Inner Cover
• Release the lock of Toner Container (By service mode)

MEMO:
To release the lock of Toner Container manually, refer to the step 1) to 4) in “Removing
the Toner Container manually”. At that time, do not pull out the toner container.

1) Open the Toner Replacement Cover.


2) Execute the service mode and release the lock of Toner Container.
3) Turn OFF the power before closing the Small Cover and the Toner Replacement Cover.
4) Close the 4 Small Covers and the Toner Replacement Cover. (Same in manual operation)
F-4-228

• Remove the ITB Unit. 3) Remove the Front Upper Cover.


• Remove the Process Unit. • 1 screw (P tight)
• 1 screw (RS)

■■How to remove
1) Remove the Front Right Cover.
• 1 rubber cap
• 1 screw (remove)
• 1 screw (loosen) x2

Loosen
Rubber cap

Front right cover


F-4-229
F-4-227

4-127
4
4
4-128
4) Remove the Front Upper Right Cover. 7) Remove the Toner Container Front Inner Cover.
• 1 connector
• 1 wire saddle
• 4 screws (RS)

x4
Connector

F-4-230
5) Remove the Delivery Tray. Wire saddle

F-4-233

F-4-231
6) Open the 4 Small Covers and remove the 4 Toner Containers.

F-4-232

4-128
4
4
4-129
Removing the Hopper (M) CAUTION:

■■Before remove the Hopper (M) If it is placed sideways, toner may scatter inside the Hopper and it may cause the
operation failure. Thus, stand and put the Hopper Unit on the paper.
• Release the lock of Toner Container (By service mode)
• Remove the ITB Unit.
• Remove the Process Unit.
• Remove the Toner Container Front Inner Cover

■■How to remove
1) Remove the Toner Tray.
• 1 screw (M4 binding)

Paper

F-4-236

CAUTION:
When installing the Hopper, align the cut-off [A] part of Bottle Fixing Ring with the Bottle
Fixing Arm [B] and install it to the host machine.

F-4-234
2) While avoiding the duct sheet, remove the Hopper Unit.
• 1 connector
• 1 wire saddle
• 5 screws (RS)

Connector
x2
x3 Hopper Unit
[A]

[B]

F-4-237
Wire saddle
Duct sheet

F-4-235

4-129
4
4
4-130

CAUTION: Removing the Hopper (Y)


When installing the Toner Tray, align the Rod Lever with the Toner Cover Open/Close ■■Before remove the Hopper (Y)
Rod Lever and install it.
• Release the lock of Toner Container (By service mode)
Toner cover Open/Close rod lever • Remove the ITB Unit.
Rod lever • Remove the Process Unit.
• Remove the Toner Container Front Inner Cover

■■How to remove
1) Remove the Toner Tray.
• 1 screw (M4 binding)

F-4-238

CAUTION:
When installing the removed Toner Container, be sure not to shake it.

CAUTION:
When the Main Drive Unit is removed simultaneously, make sure to install the Main
Drive Unit first and then, the Hopper Unit in order. Otherwise, toner supply failure may
F-4-239
occur. 2) Remove the Left Cover.
• 5 rubber caps
• 5 screws
CAUTION:
• 5 claws
When replacing the Developing Assembly, make sure to initialize before installing the
Toner Container
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-M Crows

If install the Toner Container before initialization, T/D ratio cannot set the right value. x5
Crow
x5
Crows

F-4-240

4-130
4
4
4-131
3) Remove the Left Middle Stay.
CAUTION:
• 2 screws
If it is placed sideways, toner may scatter inside the Hopper and it may cause the
operation failure. Thus, stand and put the Hopper Unit on the paper.

x2

F-4-241
4) While avoiding the duct sheet, remove the Hopper Unit.
• 1 connector
• 1 wire saddle Paper
• 5 screws (RS)
F-4-243

Hopper Unit Connector


Wire saddle
x3 x2 CAUTION:
When installing the Hopper, align the cut-off [A] part of Bottle Fixing Ring with the Bottle
Fixing Arm [B] and install it to the host machine.

Duct sheet
F-4-242

[A]

[B]

F-4-244

4-131
4
4
4-132

CAUTION: Removing the Hopper (C)


When installing the Toner Tray, align the Rod Lever with the Toner Cover Open/Close ■■Before remove the Hopper (C)
Rod Lever and install it.
• Release the lock of Toner Container (By service mode)
Toner cover Open/Close rod lever • Remove the ITB Unit.
Rod lever • Remove the Process Unit.
• Remove the Toner Container Front Inner Cover

■■How to remove
1) Remove the Reverse Tray.
2) Remove the Inside Rear Cover 1 & 2.
• 3 caps
• 3 screws (RS)
F-4-245

CAUTION:
x3
When installing the removed Toner Container, be sure not to shake it.

CAUTION:
When the Main Drive Unit is removed simultaneously, make sure to install the Main
Drive Unit first and then, the Hopper Unit in order. Otherwise, toner supply failure may
occur. Inner rear cover 1 Inner rear cover 2

F-4-246
3) Remove the Harness Guide.
CAUTION:
• 2 screws (RS)
When replacing the Developing Assembly, make sure to initialize before installing the
Toner Container
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-Y
x2
If install the Toner Container before initialization, T/D ratio cannot set the right value.

F-4-247

4-132
4
4
4-133
4) Remove the Hopper Upper Stay. 7) Remove the Toner Tray.
• 3 screws (RS) • 1 screw (M4 binding)

x3

F-4-248 F-4-251
5) Remove the Secondary Delivery Duct. 8) While avoiding the Duct Sheet, remove the Hopper Unit.
• 2 screws (P tight) • 1 connector
• 1 wire saddle
• 5 screws (RS)
x2 Hopper Unit

x3 x2 Connector
Wire saddle

Duct sheet

F-4-252
F-4-249
6) Remove the rail Retaining Plate.
• 4 screws (M4 binding)

x4

F-4-250

4-133
4
4
4-134

CAUTION: CAUTION:
If the Hopper Unit is placed sideways, toner may scatter inside the Hopper and it may When installing the Toner Tray, align the Rod Lever with the Toner Cover Open/Close
cause the operation failure. Thus, stand and put the Hopper Unit on the paper. Rod Lever and install it.

Toner cover Open/Close rod lever

Rod lever

F-4-255

Paper
CAUTION:
F-4-253
When installing the removed Toner Container, be sure not to shake it.

CAUTION:
When installing the Hopper, align the cut-off [A] part of Bottle Fixing Ring with the Bottle CAUTION:
Fixing Arm [B] and install it to the host machine. When the Main Drive Unit is removed simultaneously, make sure to install the Main
Drive Unit first and then, the Hopper Unit in order. Otherwise, toner supply failure may
occur.

CAUTION:
When replacing the Developing Assembly, make sure to initialize before installing the
Toner Container
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-C
[A]
If install the Toner Container before initialization, T/D ratio cannot set the right value.
[B]

F-4-254

4-134
4
4
4-135
Removing the Hopper (Bk) 3) Remove the Duct Sheet.
• 2 screws (binding)
■■Before remove the Hopper (Bk)
• Release the lock of Toner Container (By service mode)
• Remove the ITB Unit. x2
• Remove the Process Unit.
• Remove the Drum Heater (Bk)
• Remove the Toner Container Front Inner Cover
• Remove the Hopper (C)

■■How to remove
1) Remove the Harness from the Fixing Guide. F-4-258
4) Remove the Hopper Unit.
• 1 connector
Harness
• 1 wire saddle
• 6 screws (RS)
• 3 fixing guides

Connector
Wire saddle
Guide
x4 x2 x3

F-4-256
Fixed guide
2) Remove all the Toner Trays.
• 3 screws (M4 binding)
F-4-259

x3

F-4-257

4-135
4
4
4-136

CAUTION: CAUTION:
If the Hopper Unit is placed sideways, toner may scatter inside the Hopper and it may When installing the Toner Tray, align the Rod Lever with the Toner Cover Open/Close
cause the operation failure. Thus, stand and put the Hopper Unit on the paper. Rod Lever and install it.

Toner cover Open/Close rod lever

Rod lever

F-4-262
Paper

F-4-260
CAUTION:
When installing the removed Toner Container, be sure not to shake it.
CAUTION:
When installing the Hopper, align the cut-off [A] part of Bottle Fixing Ring with the Bottle CAUTION:
Fixing Arm [B] and install it to the host machine.
When the Main Drive Unit is removed simultaneously, make sure to install the Main
Drive Unit first and then, the Hopper Unit in order. Otherwise, toner supply failure may
occur.

CAUTION:
When replacing the Developing Assembly, make sure to initialize before installing the
Toner Container
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-K
[A]
If install the Toner Container before initialization, T/D ratio cannot set the right value.
[B]

F-4-261

4-136
4
4
4-137

Fixing System 2) Pinch and pull out the tab of Fixing Assembly.

Removing the Fixing Assembly


■■Before removing the Fixing Assembly Tabs

• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover

F-4-265
3) Hold the grip and remove the Fixing Assembly.

F-4-263

■■How to Remove

1) Open the Fixing Rail and loosen the 4 screws.

Loosen
the screws F-4-266
Loosen
the screws
Caution:
Be sure to insert the Fixing Assembly until it stops at the time of installation.
In case of the faulty installation of the Fixing Assembly, either E009 or noise may occur.
Fixing Rail
If so, remove the Fixing Assembly, and install it again.

Fixing Rail

F-4-264

4-137
4
4
4-138
Removing the Film Unit 3) Remove the Shutter Unit.
• 4 screws
■■Before removing the Film Unit
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the Fixing Unit x4
■■How to Remove

MEMO:
When installing/removing it, do not touch the Film Unit and Pressure Roller.

1) Change the direction of the Fixing Assembly. (Place it in the position where the Drawer
connector side faces up.) F-4-268
4) Turn the pressure gear with hand and make the Pressure Roller engaged condition.
2) Remove the harness.
• 3 connectors
Pressure roller
• 6 harness guides
engaged condition
Drawer connector
Connectors Harness

x3

x8
Harness guides
F-4-269

Harness guides

F-4-267

4-138
4
4
4-139
5) Open the left and right Pressure Levers. 7) Remove the harness from the harness guide and remove the Film Unit.
• 2 screws

x2

F-4-272
8) Remove the Separation Guide from the Film Unit.
F-4-270
• 2 leaf springs
6) Remove the left and right Fixing Plates and the Terminal Plate.
• 3 screws

x3

Fixing Plates

Terminal Plate
F-4-273

F-4-271

4-139
4
4
4-140
Cleaning the Fixing Separation Guide Cleaning the Shutter Cover
■■Before Cleaning the Fixing Separation Guide ■■Before Cleaning the Shutter Cover
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover • Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the Fixing Unit • Remove the Fixing Unit
• Remove the Film Unit • Remove the Film Unit

■■How to Clean ■■How to Clean


1) Clean the Fixing Separation Guide with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol. 1) Clean the Shutter Cover with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol.

F-4-274 F-4-275

4-140
4
4
4-141
Removing the Pressure Roller and Pressure Roller Caution:
Bearing At installation, install it after fitting the 3 hooks to the notches.

■■Before removing the Pressure Roller and Pressure Roller


Bearing
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the Fixing Unit
• Remove the Film Unit

■■How to Remove

F-4-277
MEMO:
When installing/removing it, do not touch the Pressure Roller. 2) When installing/removing it, to prevent the Pressure Roller from being damaged, insert the
paper (approx. 5mm) under the Fixing Delivery Lower Guide to make a space between the
1) Remove the Fixing Inlet Guide. Inner Delivery Guide and the Pressure roller.
• 1 claw
• 1 screw
• 3 hooks Space
Inner delivery
guide

Paper
About 5mm Pressure roller
thickness
F-4-278

Hooks

Claw Fixing inlet guide


Hook

F-4-276

4-141
4
4
4-142
3) Lift the right side and remove the Pressure Roller Unit.
Caution:
When keeping the Fixing Assembly for long periods, turn the pressure gear and make
the Pressure Roller disengaged condition.

Pressure roller
disengaged condition

Pressure roller unit

F-4-279
4) Remove the Pressure Roller and the 2 Pressure Roller Bearings from the Pressure Roller
F-4-281
Unit.
• 2 bearing holders
• 1 E-ring
• 1 gear

Pressure roller Bearing


Bearing bearing holder
holder
Gear Pressure roller
E-ring bearing
Roller unit

F-4-280

4-142
4
4
4-143

Pickup Feed System Cleaning the Feed Contact Point Guide


■■Before cleaning the Feed Contact Point Guide
Cleaning the Secondary Transfer Guide
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
■■Before cleaning the Secondary Transfer Guide
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover ■■How to Clean
1) Clean the Feed Contact Point Guide with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol.

Feed contact point guide

F-4-282 F-4-284

■■How to Clean
1) Clean the Transfer Guide with the lint-free paper moistened with alcohol.

Secondary transfer guide

F-4-283

4-143
4
4
4-144
Cleaning the Registration Roller Cleaning the Pre-registration Guide Assembly
■■Before cleaning the Registration Roller ■■Before cleaning the Pre-registration Guide Assembly
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover • Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover

■■How to Clean ■■How to Clean


1) Clean the Feed Contact Point Guide with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol. 1) Clean the inside of Pre-registration Guide Assembly with lint-free paper moistened with
alcohol.

Secondary Transfer Guide Pre-registration Guide Assembly

Registration roller

F-4-285
2) Clean the Outer Registration Roller with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol while F-4-287
rotating it. 2) Clean the outside of Pre-registration Guide Assembly with lint-free paper moistened with
alcohol.

Pre-registration Guide
Registration roller Assembly

F-4-286

F-4-288

4-144
4
4
4-145
Cleaning the Transparency Sensor Cleaning the Vertical Path Sensor and the Lightproof
■■Before cleaning the Transparency Sensor Sheet
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover ■■Before cleaning the Vertical Path Sensor and the Lightproof
Sheet
■■How to Clean
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
1) Clean the Transparency Sensor with lint-free paper moistened with water in one direction.

■■How to Clean
1) Clean the Vertical Path Sensor with dry lint-free paper.

Transparency sensor Vertical Path Sensor

F-4-289
2) Clean the Prism with lint-free paper.

F-4-291
2) Clean the Lightproof Sheet with dry lint-free paper.

Prism

F-4-290

Lightproof Sheet

F-4-292

4-145
4
4
4-146
Cleaning the Fixing Delivery Guide Assembly Cleaning the Post-fixing Roller
■■Before cleaning the Fixing Delivery Guide Assembly ■■Before cleaning the Post-fixing Roller
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover • Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover

■■How to Clean ■■How to Clean


1) Open the Fixing Delivery Guide. 1) Open the Fixing Delivery Guide.
2) Clean the inside of Fixing Delivery Guide Assembly with lint-free paper moistened with 2) Clean the Post-fixing Roller 1 with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol while rotating it.
alcohol.

Post-fixing roller

Fixing delivery guide

F-4-295

F-4-293 3) Clean the Post-fixing Roller 2 with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol while rotating it.
3) Clean the outside of Fixing Delivery Guide Assembly with lint-free paper moistened with
alcohol.

Post-fixing roller

F-4-296
Fixing delivery guide

F-4-294

4-146
4
4
4-147
Cleaning the Fixing Delivery Roller Cleaning the Duplex Feed Upper Roller, Wheel
■■Before cleaning the Fixing Delivery Roller ■■Before cleaning the Duplex Feed Upper Roller, Wheel
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover • Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover

■■How to Clean ■■How to Clean


1) Open the Fixing Delivery Guide. 1) Open the Right Lower Cover.
2) Clean the Fixing Delivery Roller 1 with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol while rotating 2) Clean the Duplex Feed Upper Roller, Wheel with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol
the gear. while rotating it.

Duplex feed upper rollers

Fixing delivery roller

F-4-297 F-4-299
3) Clean the Fixing Delivery Roller 2 with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol while rotating
it.

Fixing delivery roller

Duplex feed upper wheels

F-4-300

F-4-298

4-147
4
4
4-148
Cleaning the Duplex Feed Lower Roller, Wheel Cleaning the First, Second and Third Delivery Roller
■■Before cleaning the Duplex Feed Lower Roller, Wheel ■■Before cleaning the First, Second and Third Delivery Roller
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover • Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover

■■How to Clean ■■How to Clean


1) Open the Right Lower Cover. 1) Clean the First, Second and Third Delivery Rollers with lint-free paper moistened with
2) Clean the Duplex Feed Lower Roller, Wheel with lint-free paper moistened with alcohol alcohol.
while rotating it.
Second and Third
delivery roller
Duplex feed lower rollers

F-4-303

F-4-301
Second and Third
delivery wheels

Duplex feed lower wheels F-4-304

F-4-302

4-148
4
4
4-149
Removing the Second and Third Delivery Unit
■■Before removing the Second and Third Delivery Unit
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover

■■How to remove
First delivery roller
1) Remove the Front Right Cover.
• 1 rubber cap
• 1 screw (remove)
F-4-305 • 1 screw (loosen)

Second delivery roller

Loosen
Rubber cap

Front right cover

F-4-306 F-4-308

Third delivery roller

F-4-307

4-149
4
4
4-150
2) Remove the Reverse Trail Edge Guide and the Inner Delivery Cover. 4) Remove the Second and Third Delivery Unit.
• 1 screw • 4 screws
• 2 hooks
Second and third delivery unit

x4

x2

Reverse trail edge guide


Hooks Inner delivery cover
F-4-311

Caution:
After installing the Second and Third Delivery Unit, make sure that the Sensor Flag in 1
F-4-309 place works normally.
3) Remove the 2 connectors and 3 wire saddles.
Sensor flag
Wire saddles
x3

x2 Second delivery
sensor

Connectors

F-4-312

F-4-310

4-150
4
4
4-151
Removing the First Delivery Unit 4) Remove the First Delivery Unit.
• 2 screws
■■Before removing the First Delivery Unit • 1 stepped screw

• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover


• Remove the Second and Third Delivery Unit
x3 First delivery unit

■■How to remove
1) Remove the Right Upper Cover Latch.
• 2 screws

2) Remove the Right Lower Cover Latch.


• 2 screws
F-4-315
Right upper cover latch

Caution:
x4
At installation, align the First Delivery Sensor and the Sensor Flag and install it.

Sensor flag

First delivery sensor

Right lower cover latch


F-4-313
3) Open the Fixing Assembly and remove the Fixing Gear Cover.
Sensor flag
• 1 screw

Fixing gear cover First delivery sensor


F-4-316

Fixing assembly

F-4-314

4-151
4
4
4-152

Caution: Removing the Duplex Unit


After installing the First Delivery Unit, make sure that the 2 Sensor Flags work normally. ■■Before removing the Duplex Unit
Sensor flag • Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
First delivery sensor

■■How to remove
First delivery sensor 1) Remove the Front Cover of Right Unit.
• 1 screw
• 1 claw

F-4-317

Claw

F-4-318

4-152
4
4
4-153
2) Remove the connector and the grounding wire.
Caution:
• 2 connectors
• 1 screw When removing the Duplex Unit, note that the Right Door Rotation Hinge and the spring
• 1 wire saddle are easily disassembled.

Connectors

x2

Right door
rotation hinge

Spring

Wire saddle Grounding wire

F-4-319
3) Hold the sides of Duplex Unit and remove it.
F-4-321

F-4-320

4-153
4
4
4-154
Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller 3) Tilt the shaft, pull the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller and remove it.

■■Before removing the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller


Multi-purpose tray pickup roller
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the Duplex Unit Shaft

■■How to remove
1) Remove the Both Angle Guide.
• 2 screws

F-4-324
x2
Caution:
At installation, be sure to fit the Split Pin into the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller.

Multi-purpose tray pickup roller

Split pin

F-4-322
2) Remove the gear, 2 stop rings and the bushing.

F-4-325
Stop rings
Gear

Bushing

F-4-323

4-154
4
4
4-155
Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Separation Roller 2) Remove the Multi-purpose Tray Separation Roller.
• 1 claw
■■Before removing the Multi-purpose Tray Separation Roller
• Open the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover
• Remove the Duplex Unit
• Removing the Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Roller

■■How to remove
1) Remove the Front Feed Guide and Middle Feed Guide. Multi-purpose tray
separation roller Claw
• 2 screws
• 3 claws

MEMO: F-4-327
Lift the Front and Middle Feed Guides, push them into the rear, and pull them out
toward front. Caution: Points to note at installation
Align the groove of Multi-purpose Tray Separation Roller with the protrusion of limiter
and push it until it clicks.
x2
Multi-purpose tray
separation roller

Claws

Protrusion
Middle feed guide

Limiter
x3
Front feed guide

Claws

F-4-326

4-155
4
4
4-156

Caution: Points to note at installation Removing the Pickup Roller


Open the Multi-purpose Tray Sub Cover and make sure that the holes of Front and ■■Before removing the Pickup Roller
Middle Feed Guide are hooked onto the claw of Multi-purpose Tray Pickup Frame.
• Remove the Cassette
Front feed guide Middle feed guide
MEMO:
x3 This procedure describes the step of cassette 1. Go through the same procedure for
cassette 3 and 4 if the Cassette Pedestal is installed.

Push the release button and remove the cassette.

Claws

Caution: Points to note at installation


Open the Multi-purpose Tray Sub Cover and make sure that the bearing part of Multi-
purpose Tray Pickup Sensor Flag is surely installed.

Bearing part Bearing part


F-4-328

Sensor flag

4-156
4
4
4-157
■■How to remove Removing the Feed Roller

MEMO:
■■Before removing the Feed Roller
This procedure describes the removing step of cassette 1 Pickup Roller. Go through the • Remove the Cassette
same procedure for the Pickup Roller of cassette 2.

■■How to remove
Caution:
Do not touch the surface of Pickup Roller and the Separation Roller. MEMO:
This procedure describes the removing steps of cassette 1 Feed Roller. Go through the
same procedure for the Feed Roller of cassette 2.

1) Remove the cassette 1 and cassette 2.


2) Remove the Pickup Roller. Caution:
• 1 pin Do not touch the surface of Pickup Roller and the Separation Roller.
• 1 tab

1)Remove the cassette 1 and cassette 2.


2)Remove the Cassette Feed Roller.
• 1 tab

F-4-329

F-4-330

4-157
4
4
4-158
Removing the Separation Roller Removing the Pickup Assembly Idler Gear
■■Before removing the Separation Roller ■■Before removing the Pickup Assembly Idler Gear
• Remove the Cassette • Remove the Cassette
• Remove the Pickup Roller
■■How to remove • Remove the Feed Roller

MEMO: ■■How to remove


This procedure describes the removing procedure of cassette 1 Separation Roller. Go
through the same procedure for the Separation Roller of cassette 2.
MEMO:
This procedure describes the removing procedure of cassette 1 Pickup Assembly Idler
Gear. Go through the same procedure for the Pickup Assembly Idler Gear of cassette 2.
Caution:
Do not touch the surface of Pickup Roller and the Separation Roller.

Caution:
Do not touch the surface of Pickup Roller and the Separation Roller.
1)Remove the cassette 1 and cassette 2.
2) Remove the Separation Roller.
1) Remove the Pickup Assembly Idler Gear.
• 1 tab
• 1 tab

F-4-331
F-4-332

4-158
4
4
4-159
Removing the Right Lower Cover 2-1) When the Cassette Pedestal is installed, remove the Right Front Cover 3.
• 1 screw
■■Before removing the Right Lower Cover
• Remove the Cassette1,2

■■How to remove
1) When the side paper deck is installed, remove the side paper deck, remove the Deck
Connect Cover.

Right front cover 3

F-4-334
2-2) When the Cassette Pedestal is not installed, remove the Right Lower Sub Cover 1 and
the Right Front Cover 3.
• 1 screw

Right front cover 3

Right lower sub cover 1

Claw

F-4-333 F-4-335

4-159
4
4
4-160
3) Open the Cassette Right Upper Cover and the Cassette Right Lower Cover. 7) Remove the front stop ring and separate the arm.
4) Open the Right Upper Cover and the Right Lower Cover.

Arm Stop ring


Stop ring

Arm

F-4-339
8) Remove the wire from the host machine and remove the Right Lower Cover.

F-4-336
5) Remove the Right Rear Cover 3.
• 3 claws
• 1 hook
Wire
Claw

x4
Right rear cover 3

Right lower cover

Claws

Claw
F-4-340
F-4-337
6) Remove the 2 screws and the connector.

Connector

F-4-338

4-160
4
4
4-161
Removing the Cassette 1 Pickup Unit 3) Remove the Pickup Harness.
• 1 wire saddle
■■Before removing the Cassette 1 Pickup Unit • 1 edge saddle
• 2 connectors
• Remove the Cassette1,2
• Remove the Right Lower Cover
Connectors

■■How to remove x2
1)Lift the lever and remove the Right Front Inner Cover.
• 2 screws x2 Wire saddle

x2 Edge saddle

D
F-4-343
4) Hold the Pickup Guide and remove the Cassette 1 Pickup Unit.
Lever
• 4 screws (RS; M4)
• 1 screw (RS; M3)
Right front inner cover Pickup guide

F-4-341
2)Remove the Right Lower Sub Cover 2 and remove the Right Rear Inner Cover. x5
• 2 screws

Right rear inner cover

x2

x2 Cassette 1 pickup unit

F-4-344

Right lower sub cover 2


Claws
F-4-342

4-161
4
4
4-162
Removing the Cassette 2 Pickup Unit 3) Lift the Lower Guide and remove the arm.

■■Before removing the Cassette 2 Pickup Unit


• Remove the Cassette Lower guide
• Remove the Right Lower Cover
• Remove the Cassette Right Upper Cover
1-1)When the Cassette Pedestal is installed, open the Cassette Right Lower Cover Arm

F-4-347
4) Align it with D-cut and remove the Cassette Right Upper Cover.

Cassette right lower cover


D-Cut

F-4-345
1-2)When the Cassette Pedestal is not installed, remove the Right Lower Sub Cover 1.
• 1 claw

Right lower sub cover 1

Cassette right upper cover

F-4-348

Claw

F-4-346
2) Open the Cassette Right Upper Cover.

4-162
4
4
4-163
■■How to remove 3) Remove the Cassette 2 Pickup Unit.
• 4 screws
1) Remove the Right Lower Sub Cover 2 and remove the Right Rear Inner Cover.
• 2 screws

Right rear inner cover x4


x2

x2

Cassette 2 pickup unit


Right lower sub cover 2
F-4-351
Claws

F-4-349
2) Remove the Pickup Harness.
• 1 wire saddle
• 1 edge saddle
• 2 connectors

Connectors

x2

x2

Wire saddle Edge saddle

F-4-350

4-163
4
4
4-164
Removing the Cassette Size Detection Unit
■■Before remove the Cassette Size Detection Unit
• Remove the Cassette

■■How to remove

MEMO:
• This procedure describes the removing steps of Cassette 1 Size Detection Unit. Go
through the same procedure for Cassette 2 Size Detection Unit.
• When removing the Cassette 1 Size Detection Unit, make sure to remove the Cassette 1
Pickup Unit.
• When removing the Cassette 2 Size Detection Unit, make sure to remove the Cassette 2
Pickup Unit.

1) Remove the Cassette 1 Size Detection Unit.


• 1 connector
• 1 wire saddle
• 2 screws

x2

Connector Cassette size detection unit


Wire saddle

F-4-352

4-164
4
4
4-165

Option 3) Remove the cable from the wire saddle.

Removing the ADF Unit


■■How to remove

MEMO:
When removing the ADF Unit and the Reader Unit from the host machine, remove the
ADF Unit first and then, remove the Reader Unit because the accuracy of scanner
systems may be deteriorated.

1) Open the ADF.


Wire saddle

F-4-355

MEMO:
There is no wire saddle in case of Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1.

3) Remove the inner plate.


• 4 screws

F-4-353
2) Remove the Reader Cable Cover. x4
• 2 screws

x2

F-4-356

F-4-354

4-165
4
4
4-166
4) Remove the cable.
Caution:
• 1 edge saddle
• 2 connectors In case of Color Image Reader Unit-B1/B2, record the position of scale of ADF mounting
screw.

x2

F-4-359

5-1) In case of Color Image Reader Unit-B1/B2, remove the 2 screws.


F-4-357

MEMO:
After removing the cable, close the edge saddle. x2

MEMO:
Remove the flat cable in case of Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1.
• 1 reuse band
• 1 edge saddle
• 1 harness retainer
• 3 connectors

F-4-360

x3

x3

F-4-358

4-166
4
4
4-167
5-2) In case of Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1, remove the 4 screws.
Caution:
Be careful not to damage the Reader Communication Cable Guide when
x4 placing it.

F-4-361

Caution:
F-4-363
Be sure not to get scratches on the White Sheet on the removed ADF.

MEMO:
At installation, install it in the recorded scale position of ADF mounting screw.

F-4-362

4-167
4
4
4-168
■■Height Adjustment a. Checking the height of front height adjustment roll.
1) Push the paper (plain paper) to the protrusion of the stream reading glass and set it in the
1. Check the height. position where the sheet of the stream reading glass is fully covered.
1) Close the DADF.
2) Check that the 2 height adjustment rolls on the front/rear left come contact with the stream
reading glass.

MEMO:
Turning ON the LED helps the check operation.
(Lv.1) COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-R > SCANLAMP

Height adjustment roll


Stream reading glass
Paper
Protrusion Sheet Reading position Protrusion Sheet Reading position

F-4-365

CAUTION:
Do not set it in the position where the original read position is covered by the paper.

Height adjustment roll


2) Close the DADF.
3) Pull out the paper in the direction of the arrow and check that there is resistance.
F-4-364

3) If not, execute the height adjustment.


If you cannot check it visually, check it by the following method.

F-4-366
4) If there is no resistance, execute the height adjustment.

4-168
4
4
4-169
b. Checking the height of rear height adjustment roll. ■■Adjustment procedure
1) Push the paper (plain paper) to the protrusion of the stream reading glass and set it in the
1) Rotate the fixing screw on top of the left hinge to adjust it.
position where the sheet of the stream reading glass is fully covered.
To remove the space on the front: rotate it clockwise (black arrow direction)
Protrusion Sheet Reading position Paper Protrusion Sheet Reading position To remove the space on the rear or both sides: rotate it counterclockwise (white arrow
direction)

Blanking cover

Fixing screw

F-4-367

CAUTION:
F-4-369
Do not set it in the position where the original read position is covered by the paper.
2) Check the height again and make sure that the height is appropriate.

2) Close the DADF.


3) Pull out the paper in the direction of the arrow and check that there is resistance.

F-4-368
4) If there is no resistance, execute the height adjustment.

4-169
4
4
4-170
■■Right Angle Adjustment 3) Loosen the 2 knurled screws on front of right hinge unit.
4) Open the rubber cover on the back of right hinge unit and loosen the screw, and then make
an adjustment by the hexagon socket bolt.
MEMO:
There are 2 adjustment methods; for front side reading (reader side scanner unit) and If A is less than 90 deg, rotate it clockwise.
for back side reading (DADF side scanner unit). If A is more than 90 deg, rotate it counterclockwise.

a. Adjustment for front side reading Rubber cover


1) Set a test chart to DADF and make a 1-sided print.
2) Check the right angle accuracy of angle A on the printed paper. If it is not right angle, make
an adjustment.

Image on test chart


Printed image

Hexagon socket bolt Fixing nut

Feed direction
Knurled screw
F-4-370
F-4-371
5) After adjustment, tighten the fixing nut and 2 knurled screws.
6) Printout a test chart again and check that angle A is right angle.

4-170
4
4
4-171
b. Adjustment for back side reading Removing the Reader Unit
1) Set a test chart to DADF upside down and make a 2-sided print.
2) Check the right angle accuracy of angle A on the printed paper. If it is not right angle, make ■■How to remove
an adjustment.

Image on test chart MEMO:


Printed image
When removing the ADF Unit and the Reader Unit from the host machine, make sure
to remove the ADF Unit first and then, remove the Reader Unit since the accuracy of
scanner systems may be deteriorated.

1) Remove the Reader Left Cover.


• 2 claws
• 2 screws (binding; M4x8)
• 2 rubber caps

Claws
x2

x2
Feed direction
F-4-372
3) Remove the front cover.
4) Loosen the adjustment screw.
5) Adjust the position of the guide that supports the scanner unit. Rubber caps Reader left cover
If A is less than 90 deg, move the guide to right direction (black arrow direction). F-4-374
If A is more than 90 deg, move the guide to left direction (white arrow direction). 2) Install the fixing screw of scanner system kept at the installation.
• screw (binding; M4x8)
Adjusting screw
Guide

x2

F-4-373
F-4-375
6) After adjustment, tighten the screw.
7) Printout a test chart again and check that it is right angle.

4-171
4
4
4-172
3) Remove the Reader Right Cover. 6) Remove the screw of Reader Front Cover.
• 2 claws • 2 screws
• 2 screws (binding; M4x8) • 1 screw (flat-head; M4x6) (for Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 only)
• 2 rubber caps
flat-head : M4x6
Claws
x3
x2

x2

Rubber caps
Reader right cover F-4-378

F-4-376
7)Remove the Reader Front Cover.
4)Move the Control Panel in the direction of the arrow. • 3 bosses
5)Move the Control Panel Base Cover in the direction of the arrow.
• 1 screw

F-4-379
8) Remove the front side of Reader Unit with a stubby screwdriver.
• 2 screws (TP; M4x8)

Plate

F-4-377 x2 x2

(Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1) (Color Image Reader Unit-B1/B2)


F-4-380

4-172
4
4
4-173
9) Remove the reader power cable. 12) Remove the Fixing Hook C and the Reader Fixing Hook A.
• 2 connectors • 2 screws (binding; M4x8)
• 2 wire saddles
Protrusion Protrusion
• 1 cable guide

x2

x2
Protrusion
Cable guide Fixing hook C Reader fixing hook A
Wire saddles
F-4-383
13) Remove the connector of reader communication cable.
Reader power cable
14) Remove the reader communication cable from the cut-off of the host machine plate.

Connectors
F-4-381
10) Open the Right Upper Cover and the Right Lower Cover.

Right upper cover


Cut-off of the host machine plate

Reader communication cable

F-4-384

Right lower cover 15) Remove the 2 Reader Fixing Hooks B.


• 2 screws (flat-head; M4x6)

F-4-382
11) Close the Right Lower Cover.
x2 (Duplex Color Image (Color Image Reader
Reader Unit-B1) Unit-B1/B2)

Protrusions Protrusions

F-4-385

4-173
4
4
4-174
16) Remove the stepped screw.
Caution:
• Make sure to lift the Reader Unit with 2 people or more. And also, lift it flatly.
• Make sure to place the Reader Unit on the flat surface with preventing the impact
on it.
• When placing the Reader Unit, be careful not to get a finger and a cable get caught.

F-4-386
17) Remove the Reader Unit with 2 People or more.

(Front View) (Back View)


F-4-388

F-4-387

4-174
4
5 Adjustment

■Main

■Image
Controller
Formation System

■Pickup Feed System

5
5
5-2

Main Controller When using


the Card
1) Go to COPIER > FUNCTION> INSTALL > CARD and enter the numerical value
of the leading card which is used for Department ID.
Reader and Then, press “OK” button. (e.g.: If No.1 to No.1000 cards are used for
imageWARE Department ID, enter “1” of the leading card.)
HDD Accounting 2) After turning OFF and ON the main power switch, perform the following
Manager operations from Settings/Registration mode.
How to Replace Refer to “Removing the HDD”. • In Management Settings > User Management > Department ID Management >
the Parts Page Totals, be sure that “ID00000001” to “ID00001000” are created.
Before 1) Backup of the set/registered data • Set the following: Preferences > Network > TCP / IP Settings > IPv4 Settings>IP
Replacing Use the Remote UI. Address Settings > IP Address, Gateway Address, Subnet Mask
Management Settings > Data Management > Import/Export • In Management Settings > User Management> System Manager Information
Target data: Settings> System Manager ID and System PIN, register any number for them.
• Address List Then, turn OFF and ON the main power switch.
• Forwarding Settings If “System Manager ID” and “System PIN” are not registered, “card registration
• Settings/Registration to device” cannot be executed for the imageWARE Accounting Manager setting
• Web Access Favorites operation.
• Printer Settings 3) Download the card ID from imageWARE Accounting Manager to the Main Body
• Paper Information again.
2) Printing the set/registered data 4) After downloading is completed, go to Management Settings > User
Use the service mode. Management > Department ID Management > Page Totals. Be sure that only
(Lv.1) COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P > USER-PRT the downloaded card ID is displayed.
List of the set/registered data which cannot be backed up is printed." 5) Print using the user card registered from imageWARE Accounting Manager.
Aftter Replacing 1) HDD format Be sure that the card information used for the target devices of imageWARE
1-1) Start with the safe mode. (While pressing 2 and 8 keys simultaneously, Accounting Manager is collected.
turn ON the main power switch.) Points to Note when Using the System Software-installed HDD When using the
1-2) Use SST to format all partitions. HDD which was installed the system software of the other machine (different serial
2) Downloading system software number), be sure to format the HDD after the installation.
2-1) Use SST to download the system software (System, LANG, RUI and If the HDD is not formatted, the operation cannot be guaranteed.
others). Points to Note When using the HDD which was installed the system software of the other
3) Initializing the key, certificate and CA certificate when Using machine (different serial number), be sure to format the HDD after the installation.
(Lv.2) COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR > CA-KEY the System If the HDDis not formatted, the operation cannot be guaranteed.
4) Turning OFF and ON the main power switch Software-
5) Restoring the backup data installed HDD
Use the Remote UI. T-5-1
Management Settings > Data Management > Import/Export
6) Resetting/registering the data
While referring to the list of set/registered data which was printed before Main controller PCB 1
replacement, reset/register the data.
7) When the user generates and adds the encryption key, certificate and/or CA How to Replace Refer to “Removing the Main Controller PCB 1”.
certificate, request the user to generate them again. the Parts
8) Executing “Auto Adjust Gradation (Full Adjust)” Settings/Registration mode: Operation at Transferring the parts from old PCB to new PCB
Adjustment/Maintenance > Adjust Image Quality > Auto Adjust Gradation Replacement • DDR2-SDRAM (2 pc.)
• Flash PCB
• TPM PCB

Resetting/registering the data is not necessary after Main Controller PCB 1 is


replaced.
T-5-2

5-2
5
5
5-3
Main controller PCB 2 Aftter Replacing Restoration of DC Controller PCB SRAM
COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > DSRAMRES (LEVEL2)
“ACTIVE” is displayed at execution and then “OK!” is displayed about 2 minutes
How to Replace Refer to “Removing the Main Controller PCB 2”.
later. Restoration is complete.
the Parts
Prohibited • When replacing the DC Controller PCB, be sure to use a new one. Do not use
Before 1) Backup of the set/registered data
Operation the DC Controller PCB which was used with another machine.
Replacing Use the Remote UI.
T-5-4
Management Settings > Data Management > Import/Export
Target data:
• Address List
• Forwarding Settings
TPM PCB
• Settings/Registration
• Web Access Favorites How to Replace Refer to “Security Function (Encryption Key, Certificate and Protection of
• Printer Settings the Parts Password)”
• Paper Information * Be sure to perform the installation work by referring to the procedure above. T-5-5
2) Printing the set/registered data
Use the service mode.
(Lv.1) COPIER > FUNCTION > MISC-P > USER-PRT
List of the set/registered data which cannot be backed up is printed
Replacement Transferring the parts from old PCB to new PCB
• DDR2-SDRAM (2 pc.)
• Memory PCB
• Bypass PCB
Aftter Replacing 1) After installing the parts, turn ON the main power switch.
2) Restoring the backup data
Use the Remote UI.
Management Settings > Data Management > Import/Export
3) Resetting/registering the data
While referring to the list of set/registered data which was printed out before
replacement, reset/register the data.
4) When the user generates and adds the encryption key, certificate and/or CA
certificate, request the user to generate them again.
Prohibited Do not transfer the following parts to another model (which has a different serial
Operation number).
If you fail to do so, the Main Body does not activate normally and this might cause
to fail the restoration.
• Main Controller PCB 2 (with Memory PCB installed)
• Memory PCB
T-5-3

DC controller PCB
How to Replace Refer to “Removing the DC Controller PCB”.
the Parts
Before Backup of DC Controller PCB SRAM
Replacing COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > DSRAMBUP (LEVEL2)
“ACTIVE” is displayed and then “OK!” is displayed about 2 minutes later.
Turn OFF the main power when the above work is complete.

5-3
5
5
5-4

Image Formation System ITB


How to Replace Refer to “Removing the ITB”
Developing Assembly the Parts
Before Check that the version of the machine is the following version or later.
Adjustment Initialization of Developing Assembly (toner ratio and patch) is necessary and it Installation MN-CON: Ver.34.05 D-CON: Ver.18.01
procedure differs depending on the color. In case of prior version to the foregoing version, upgrade the machine and change
If 4 colors are replaced simultaneously, execute INISET-4. the value in the following service mode.
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-Y Initialization of Y Developing Select COPIER>OPTION>IMG-TR>ITB-TYPE, and change the setting from 0 to 1.
Assembly (toner ratio and patch) Adjustment Execute the user mode (Settings/Registration > Adjustment/Maintenance > Adjust
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-M Initialization of M Developing Procedure Image Quality > Auto Adjust Gradation).
Assembly (toner ratio and patch) Execute the ITB equilibrium position detection in service mode.
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-C Initialization of C Developing COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-P>ITB-INIT <Level1>
Assembly (toner ratio and patch) This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-K Initialization of Bk Developing T-5-9
Assembly (toner ratio and patch)
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-4 Initialization of 4-colors Developing
Assembly (toner ratio and patch) Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
T-5-6
How to Replace Refer to “Removing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller/Secondary Transfer
Patch sensor the Parts
Adjustment
Separation Guide Unit”.
When replacing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller, execute the following service
Procedure mode.
How to Replace Refer to “Removing the Patch Sensor (Front/Center/Rear)”.
COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEANING > TNR-COAT
the Parts
T-5-10
Adjustment Initialization of Patch sensor is necessary
procedure COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON > P-ALPHA Input Patch Sensor alpha value
T-5-7 Hopper Unit
ITB Unit How to Replace Refer to “Removing the Hopper (M/Y/C/Bk)”.
the Parts
How to Replace Refer to “Removing the ITB Unit”. Adjustment When installing the removed Toner Container, do not shake it.
the Parts Procedure When removing the Main Drive Unit simultaneously, install the Main Drive Unit and
Adjustment After replacement, execute the user mode (Settings/Registration > Adjustment/ Hopper Unit in that order.
procedure Maintenance > Adjust Image Quality > Auto Adjust Gradation). Toner supply failure may occur.
In case that the ITB Unit was removed, install the ITB Unit and execute the ITB In case that the Developing Assembly is replaced simultaneously, execute the
equilibrium position detection in service mode. following service mode to initialize the Developing Assembly before installing the
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-P>ITB-INIT <Level1> Toner Container.
This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes. COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > INISET-X (X: Color changed)
Remove the ITB Unit when replacing the following parts. If the Toner Container is installed first, TD ratio of the Developing Assembly cannot
• ITB Cleaning Unit be set to a correct value.
• ITB T-5-11
• Primary Transfer Roller
• Secondary Transfer Inner Roller

T-5-8

5-4
5
5
5-5

Pickup Feed System Method of Setting Special Paper


• Service mode
Method of Setting 8K and 16K (Chinese Paper) COPIER > OPTION > CST > CSTX-UY > Setting number
X: Cassette number, Y: Size category (X: 1 to 4, Y: 1 to 4)
1) Set the original detection size to AB configuration.r
(Lv.1) COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > MODEL-SZ = 0
Size category
2) Enable detection and display of Chinese paper (K size paper: 8K and 16K).
(Lv.2) COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > KSIZE-SW = 1 Size category Size
U1 FLSC, A-FLS, OFI, E-OFI, A-LTRR, A-LGL, G-LGL, A-OFI, M-OFI, FA4, FB4
3) Change the setting of Cassette 1 from EXEC to 16K.
U2 K-LGLR, G-LTRR
(Lv.2) COPIER > OPTION > CST > CST-K-SW = 1
U3 K-LGL, A-LTR, G-LTR
4) (Lv.2) COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW >MODELSZ2 = 0. U4 B-OFI
5) Turn OFF and then ON the main power. T-5-12

Setting No. Size


22 K-LGL
23 K-LGLR
24 FLSC
25 A-FLS
26 OFI
27 E-OFI
28 B-OFI
29 A-LTR
30 A-LTRR
31 G-LTR
32 G-LTRR
33 A-LGL
34 G-LGL
36 A-OFI
37 M-OFI
42 FA4
43 FB4
T-5-13

Example: When setting G-LTR to Cassette 2


COPIER> OPTION> CST> CST2-U3> 31

5-5
5
6 Troubleshooting

■Initial

■Test
Check
Print

■Troubleshooting items

■Version Upgrade

6
6
6-2

Initial Check

Initial check items list


Item No. Detail Check
Site Environment 1 The voltage of the power supply is as rated (±10%).
The site is not a high temperature / humidity environment (near a water faucet, water boiler, humidifi er), and it is not in a cold place. The
2
machine is not near a source of fi re or dust.
3 The site is not subject to ammonium gas.
4 The site is not exposed to direct rays of the sun. (Otherwise, provide curtains.)
5 The site is well ventilated, and the fl oor keeps the machine level.
6 The machine's power plug remains connected to the power outlet.
Checking the Paper 7 The paper is of a recommended type.
8 The paper is not moist. Try paper fresh out of package.
Checking the Placement of Paper 9 Check the cassette and the manual feed tray to see if the paper is not in excess of a specifi c level.
10 If a transparency is used, check to make sure that it is placed in the correct orientation in the manual feed tray.
Checking the Durables 11 Check the table of durables to see if any has reached the end of its life.
Checking the Periodically Check the scheduled servicing table and the periodically replaced parts table, and replace any part that has reached the time of replacement.
12
Replaced Parts
T-6-1

6-2
6
6
6-3

Test Print

Overview
This machine have the following test print TYPE and you can judge the image failure that is checked as “Yes” in the following image check items with each test print.
If the image failure occurred on normal output does not reappear on the test print, it may be caused by the PDL input or reader side.
Items
Uneven
PG
TYPE Pattern Transfer Black line Uneven Density Right Straight Color Originator
TYPE Gradation Fogging White line
Fault (Color line) Density at the Front / Angle Lines displacement,
Rea
0 Normal copy / print ----
1to3 ---(For R&D) ----
4 16 gradations Yes Yes Yes Yes Main controller PCB 2
5 Full half-tone Yes Yes Yes Yes Yes Main controller PCB 2
6 Grid Yes Yes Yes Main controller PCB 2
7to9 ---(For R&D) ----
10 MCYBk horizontal stripes Main controller PCB 2
Yes Yes Yes
(sub scanning direction)
11 ---(For R&D) ----
12 64-gradation Yes Yes Yes Main controller PCB 2
13 ---(For R&D) ----
14 Full color 16-gradation Yes Yes Main controller PCB 2
15to100 ---(For R&D) ----
T-6-2

Steps to select the test print TYPE


1) Set the number of print, paper size etc.
2) Select: COPIER > TEST > PG.
3) Select: COPIER > TEST > PG > TYPE.
4) Enter the desired TYPE number and press OK key.
5) Select the corresponding color (setting 1 means output) in COLOR-Y/M/C/K.
6) Set the density in DENS-Y/M/C/K (this is enabled for TYPE=5 only).
7) Press start key.

6-3
6
6
6-4
How to use the test print
■■16 gradations (TYPE=4)

This test print is for mainly checking the gradation, fogging, white line and uneven density at front & rear.
Check item Check method Assumed cause
Gradation Check that 16 density gradation is properly reproduced. Failure of Drum Unit (end of life)
Failure of Laser Scanner Unit
Fogging Check that fogging occurs on white image area only. Failure of Drum Unit (end of life)
Failure of Laser Scanner Unit
White line Check that white line does not appear on entire image. Failure of Developing Assembly
Uneven density at Check that uneven density does not appear at front & rear. Failure of Photosensitive Drum (approx. 94mm)
front & rear Failure of Developing Cylinder (approx. 63mm)
T-6-3

F-6-1

■■Full half tone (TYPE=5)


This test print is for mainly checking the black line, white line and uneven density.

MEMO:
1. Select: service mode > COPIER > TEST > PG and specify developing color “COLOR-Y/M/C/K” to output the print by
developing color.
2. To change the density of test print, select: service mode > TEST > PG > DENS-Y/M/C/K and set the density.

Check item Check method Assumed cause


Transfer failure Check that the transfer failure does not appear on entire image. Failure of ITB (scratch, dirt)
Failure of Primary Transfer Roller (scratch, dirt)
Failure of Secondary Transfer Roller (scratch, dirt)
Black line Check that black line does not appear on entire image. Scratch on Photosensitive Drum
(color line) Dirt on Primary Charging Roller
White line Check that white line does not appear on entire image. Failure of ITB Unit
Failure of Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
F-6-2
Dirt on laser light path
Uneven pitch Check that uneven pitch does not appear on entire image. Failure of Photosensitive Drum (approx. 94mm)
Failure of Developing Cylinder (approx. 94mm)
Uneven density Check that uneven density does not appear on entire image. Dirt on Dustproof Glass
Deterioration of ITB
T-6-4

6-4
6
6
6-5
■■Grid (TYPE=6)

This test print is for mainly checking the color displacement, right angle accuracy and straight line accuracy.
Check items Check method Assumed cause
Uneven density Check that uneven density does not appear on solid area of Failure of Laser Scanner Unit
each color Failure of developer in Developing Assembly
Failure of Primary Transfer Roller
Black line (color line) Check that black line (color line) does not appear on solid area Scratch on Photosensitive Drum
of each color Dirt on Primary Charging Roller
White line Check that white line does not appear on solid area of each Failure of ITB Unit
color Failure of Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
Dirt on Laser Light Path
T-6-5

F-6-3

■■MCYBk horizontal stripe (TYPE=10)


4.0+1.5/-1.0mm This test print is for mainly checking the dark area density of each color, each color balance and white line on development.
Check items Check method Assumed cause
Uneven density Check that uneven density does not appear on solid area of Failure of Laser Scanner Unit
each color Failure of developer in Developing Assembly
Failure of Primary Transfer Roller
Black line (color line) Check that black line (color line) does not appear on solid area Scratch on Photosensitive Drum
of each color Dirt on Primary Charging Roller
White line Check that white line does not appear on solid area of each Failure of ITB Unit
color Failure of Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
Dirt on Laser Light Path
T-6-6

2.5 +1.5mm/-1.5mm F-6-4

6-5
6
6
6-6
■■64-gradations (TYPE=12)
This test print is for mainly checking the gradations of YMCBk single color at one time.
Check item Check method Assumed cause
Gradation Check that 64 gradations density is properly reproduced. Failure of Drum Unit (end of life)
Failure of Laser Scanner Unit
Fogging Check that fogging appears on white image area only. Failure of Drum Unit (end of life)
Failure of Laser Scanner Unit
White line Check that there is no white line on entire image. Failure of Developing Assembly
T-6-7

F-6-5

■■Full color 16-gradations (TYPE=14)


This test print is for mainly checking the gray balance, gradations of YMCBk singe color and fogging.
Check item Check method Assumed cause
Gradation Check that 64 gradations density is properly reproduced in Failure of Drum Unit (end of life)
each color. Failure of Laser Scanner Unit
Light areas Fogging Check that fogging appears on white image area only. Failure of Drum Unit (end of life)
Failure of Laser Scanner Unit
Gray balance Check that density is even in each color on gray scale area. Failure of Drum Unit (end of life)
T-6-8

White White

F-6-6

6-6
6
6
6-7

Troubleshooting items Image Faults


■■Image fogging due to the electrostatic charge failure
Troubleshooting items list
Category Item Reference
Image Displacement/blur/ Foggy image due to charge failure 6-7
failure smear/fogging 35mm pitch ghost due to toner deterioration 6-8
35mm uneven density due to cycle variation of 6-9
Developing Cylinder
Dirt/line 95mm uneven density on paper lead edge 6-9
Blank image/line Color spot due to laser exposure failure 6-10
Secondary transfer blank image 6-11
Fixing wrinkle due to deterioration of rib on Fixing Inlet 6-12
Guide
Soiled image due to the oil attached to the Fixing 6-13
Separation Guide

Operation failure Noise around the Fixing Film Unit 6-14


Process Unit cannot be closed. 6-15
Productivity is reduced on paper stack delivery in thin 6-16 F-6-7
[Occurrence area]
paper mode (52g/m2 to 63g/m2). <Staple Finisher C1/
Saddle Stitch Finisher C1> Between the Primary Charging Roller and the drum
T-6-9

[Cause]
When the solid image of Y color is copied under the high temperature and high humidity
environment, uneven discharge may occur between the Primary Charging Roller and the
drum. As a result, there is a possibility that a mottled image may occur on other colors than Y.
[Occurrence condition]
In case that the drum unit is under the high temperature and high humidity environment at an
initial state

[Remedy]
Please perform the following procedures.

6-7
6
6
6-8
●● In Case that Paper Setting for the Poor Image is "Plain Paper" ■■35-mm pitch ghost due to toner deterioration
1) Target current setting of discharge current control
(COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI>DIS-TGM/TGC/TGK) <Level2>
The setting value of the applicable service mode is set to "+2." If not improved, the setting
value is increased by every [ +2 ].
2) Adjustment of electrostatic charge AC current
(COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI>OFSTAC-M/OFSTAC-C/ OFSTAC-K) <Level1>
The setting value of the applicable service mode is set to "+2." The setting value is set to +4,
If not improved.

●● In Case that Paper Setting for the Poor Image is "Heavy Paper"
1) Target current setting of discharge current control (COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI>DIS-TGM2/
TGC2/TGK2) <Level2>
The setting value of the applicable service mode is set to "+2." If not improved, the setting
value is set to +4.
[Occurrence area] F-6-8
2) Adjustment of electrostatic charge AC current (COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI>OFSTACM2/
Developing cylinder
OFSTACC2/OFSTACK2) <Level1>
The setting value of the applicable service mode is set to "+2." The setting value is set to +4,
[Cause]
If not improved.
In case that the image pattern, which has extreme shading differences, is copied under the
high temperature and high humidity environment, the deterioration toner of a previous image
[Notes about remedy]
may adhere on a developing cylinder. For this reason, the inversion residual image (negative
A drum life will be influenced if the 2nd service mode (adjustment of electrostatic charge AC
ghost) of the previous image may occur in the next image.
current) is changed.
For this reason, please do not set the setting value to +4 or more at the maximum.
[Occurrence condition]
In case that the image pattern with extreme shading differences is copied (the halftone image
was copied immediately after the solid image)

[Remedy]
1) Targeted value setting of ATR control (COPIER>ADJUST>DENS>P-TG-Y/M/C/K) <Level2>
The applicable service mode setting value for the color, which the poor image has occurred,
is set to "-1."
2) After cycling the power of the main unit, copy 8 A3 solid images.
As a result, if the image on the 8th sheet is checked and a defect is not improved, please
move on to the following step.
3) Lower the setting value of the applicable service mode by 1 step.
4) After cycling the power of the main unit, copy 8 A3 solid images.
5) Check the image on the 8th sheet.
6) If a poor image is not improved, repeat Step 3)-5).

6-8
6
6
6-9
■■The 35-mm uneven image density due to the periodic deflection ■■Uneven Image Density at 95 mm of Paper Leading Edge
of the developing cylinder

About 95mm
[Occurrence area] F-6-10
Fixing Unit

[Cause]
Usually, the paper, which passed the Fixing Unit, is fed to the Inner Feed Roller along with
About 35mm
the separation guide. However, when thin paper is used, since the elasticity of the paper is
[Occurrence area] F-6-9
low, there is a possibility that the paper may be pulled by the roller if the paper leading edge
Developing cylinder reaches the Inner Feed Roller.
As a result, since the paper, which met the separation guide, comes floating, the nip angle of
[Cause] the Fixing Unit changes.
In case that the durable advanced Developing Assembly is used under the high temperature For this reason, a density change may occur at around 95 mm from the image leading edge.
and high humidity environment, the slight periodic deflection on the developing cylinder may
occur. As a result, since the gap between the developing cylinder and the drum becomes [Occurrence condition]
uneven, the uneven image density in a cycle of 35 mm due to a developing failure may occur. In case that the solid image is copied on the thin paper under the high temperature and high
humidity environment
[Occurrence condition]
In case that the durable advanced Developing Assembly is used under the high temperature [Remedy]
and high humidity environment. Please perform the following steps.
This phenomenon tends to occur, when a solid image or a halftone image is copied.
●● In case that the Paper Setting for the Poor Image is "Thin Paper"
[Remedy] Setting of the ITOP temperature in thin paper (COPIER>OPTION>IMG-TR>FXS-TMP5)
Adjustment of the developing AC bias maximum value (COPIER>OPTION>IMG-FIX>ADJ- <Level2>
VPP) <Level2> Set the setting value of the applicable service mode to "-1." If not improved, set the setting
The applicable service mode setting value is set to "-1." If a defect is not improved, check the value to "-2."
images with lowering the setting value one step by one step.

6-9
6
6
6-10
●● In case that the Paper Setting for the Poor Image is "Plain Paper 1" [Remedy]
Setting of the ITOP temperature in the plain paper 1 (COPIER>OPTION>IMG-FIX>FX-S-TMP) When installing the Drum Unit (Bk) to the host machine, perform the following procedures.
<Level2>
Set the setting value of the applicable service mode to "-1." If not improved, set the setting 1)Pull out the Process Unit.
value to "-2." 2)Remove a dummy Drum or Drum Unit.
3)Place the half fold paper on the Developing Assembly (Bk).
[Notes about remedy]
If the applicable service mode is changed and a heavy paper is fed, fixing capability may Paper
deteriorate.

■■Missing color due to the laser exposure failure

F-6-12
4) While the paper is set, install the Drum Unit (Bk) to the host machine.

Drum Unit (BK)

[Occurrence area] F-6-11


Developing Assembly

[Cause]
If pushing the drum unit to the Developing Assembly in installation, there is a possibility to
catch the Mylar sheet of the Developing Assembly downward.
As a result, since an optical path is shut when the laser for the applicable color is irradiated,
the image may become light.

[Occurrence condition]
The installation failure of the drum unit

F-6-13

6-10
6
6
6-11
5) Hold the folded portion and pull this paper out to the direction of upper. ■■Blank area cased by poor secondary transfer

Paper

[Occurrence area] F-6-15


F-6-14 Secondary Transfer Outer Roller

[Cause]
Since the resistance of a paper changes when the recycled paper having bad surface nature
is used under the high temperature and high humidity environment, the current value of the
Secondary Transfer may be insufficient. As a result, the blank area caused by Secondary
Transfer failure may occur.

[Occurrence condition]
In case that the recycled paper having bad surface nature is used under the high temperature
and high humidity environment.
This phenomenon will be more obvious when a blue solid image is copied.

[Remedy]
Please perform the following steps.
1) Check environmental classification inside the machine.
Indication of inside environmental classification (COPIER>DISPLAY>MISC>ENV-TR)
<Level1>
2) Check the "paper type" when the poor image occurred. (Example: Plain paper 1)
3) Check the "printing surface" which the poor image occurred. (Example: In the case of a first
side)
4) Perform adjustment of secondary transcription ATVC target current
(COPIER>ADJUST>HVTR>XXXX).

6-11
6
6
6-12
Set the setting value of the applicable service mode to "+10" after checking the sub-item ■■Fixing wrinkle due to deterioration of rib on Fixing Inlet Guide
name corresponding to XXXX from the following table. If not improved, please increase the
setting value by +10 each.
(Example: When the paper type is the plain paper 1, environmental classification is 1 and it is
on a first side, COPIER>ADJUST>HVTR>2TR-N1)
Paper type Environmental Service mode sub-item name
Classification First side Second side
Plane Paper1 1 2TR-N1 2TR-N2
64 ~ 82g 2 2TR-N12 2TR-N22
3 2TR-N13 2TR-N23
Plane Paper2 1 2TR-HN1 2TR-HN2
83 ~ 105g 2 2TR-HN12 2TR-HN22
3 2TR-HN13 2TR-HN23
Thin Paper 1 2TR-T1 2TR-T2
52 ~ 64g 2 2TR-T12 2TR-T22
3 2TR-T13 2TR-T23 [Location] F-6-16

Recycled Paper 1 2TR-R1 2TR-R2 Fixing Inlet Guide


2 2TR-R12 2TR-R22
3 2TR-R13 2TR-R23 [Cause]
Heavy paper 1 1 2TR-H1 2TR-H2
When making 2-sided copies of solid image continuously in high temperature & high humidity
106 ~ 163g 2 2TR-H12 2TR-H22
3 2TR-H13 2TR-H23 environment, rib side on the Fixing Inlet Guide is deteriorated and resin part may be scraped.
Heavy paper 2 1 2TR-SH1 2TR-SH2 As a result, when the leading edge of paper enters the Fixing Inlet Guide, it is trapped by the
164 ~ 209g 2 2TR-SH12 2TR-SH22 scraped rib and the paper deflects leading to the wrinkle at the trailing edge of paper.
3 2TR-SH13 2TR-SH23
Heavy paper 3 1 2TR-UH1 2TR-UH2
[Condition]
210 ~ 256g 2 2TR-UH12 2TR-UH22
3 2TR-UH13 2TR-UH23 When making 2-sided copies of solid image continuously in high temperature & high humidity
Postcard 1 2TR-P1 2TR-P2 environment.
2 2TR-P12 2TR-P22
3 2TR-P13 2TR-P23 [Field Remedy]
Envelope 1 2TR-E1 2TR-E2
Replace the Fixing Inlet Guide.
2 2TR-E12 2TR-E22
3 2TR-E13 2TR-E23
Transparency 1 2TR-O1 -
2 2TR-O12 -
3 2TR-O13 -
T-6-10

[Notes about remedy]


If the service mode is changed, the life of the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller will be
influenced.
For this reason, please do not set the setting value to +80 or more at the maximum.

6-12
6
6
6-13
■■Soiled image due to the oil attached to the Fixing Separation
Guide

約120mm
[Location] F-6-18
Leading edge of Fixing Separation Guide

[Cause]
When the paper passes through the Fixing Assembly, oil of fused toner may attach to the
Fixing Inlet Guide leading edge of Fixing Separation Guide and it may accumulate.
F-6-17
At that time, when making 2-sided solid print with 2-colors, curled leading edge of paper on
2nd side may contact with the Delivery Flapper.
Thus, movement of this paper changes and it may touch the leading edge of Fixing
Separation Guide. As a result, oil attached to the leading edge of guide may appear on the
image.

[Condition]
With using the Fixing Assembly that is used over a prolonged period, when making 2-sided
solid print with 2-colors.

[Field Remedy]
Dry wipe the leading edge of Fixing Separation Guide with ling-free paper.

6-13
6
6
6-14
Operation Error
■■Noise around the Fixing Film Unit
[Location]
Fixing Film Unit
[Cause]
Separation Guide
Because the grease inside the Fixing Film deteriorates due to prolonged use, sliding
Cleaning Area performance between the Fixing Film and the heater surface may be decreased.
As a result, the Fixing Film contacts with the heater surface when it rotates and noise may be
generated.
[Field Remedy]
By pushing the Fixing Film area, grease inside the film circulates and sliding performance will
be improved.

Operation procedure is as below.


F-6-19
1) Remove the Fixing Unit.
2) Change the direction of the Fixing Assembly. (Place the Fixing Assembly where the Drawer
Connecter faces up.)

Drawer connector

F-6-20

6-14
6
6
6-15
3) While pushing the Fixing Film area with lint-free paper, move it right and left 2 times. ■■Cannot close the Process Unit
[Location]
Process Unit

[Cause]
If the main power switch is turned OFF just after the copy operation (approx. within 5
seconds) and the Process Unit is opened, the Laser Shutter May not be closed.
As a result, the rear side of Process Unit and the Laser Shutter interfere each other when the
Unit is closed and the Process Unit cannot be installed to the host machine.

F-6-21 [Occurrence Condition]


If the main power switch is turned OFF just after the copy operation (approx. within 5
seconds) or if the power plug is disconnected without turning OFF the main power switch.

[Field Remedy]
Process Unit can be installed to the host machine by strongly pushing it.
However, if the Unit is installed to the host machine with brute force, it may damage other
parts. Thus, be sure to follow the below operation procedure.

1) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. (Laser Shutter is closed automatically.)
2) While the Process Unit remains pulled out, make sure that the Laser Shutter is surely
closed. At this time, do not put your hands inside the machine.
3) Turn OFF the main power switch and install the Process Unit to the host machine.

6-15
6
6
6-16
■■Productivity decrease at stack delivery in thin paper (52g/m2 ~
63g/m2) mode < Staple Finisher C1/Saddle Stitch Finisher C1>

[Location]
Process Tray on the Staple Finisher C1/Saddle Stitch Finisher C1

[Cause]
When the thin paper (52g/m2 to 63g/m2) is selected and the paper stack is delivered from
the corresponding finisher, electrostatic is generated under the low humidity environment
because the paper is fractioned in the Process Tray causing paper attraction. As a result,
alignment failure may occur.
To avoid this, the electro static is prevented from being generated by decelerating the feed
speed in case of foregoing condition.

[Occurrence condition]
This paper (52g/m2 to 63g/m2) is selected and the paper stack is delivered from the
corresponding finisher.

[Field Remedy]
Change the paper selection to plain paper 1 (64g/m2 ~ 81g/m2) and deliver the paper stack.
Approx. 19% of productivity can be enhanced (in the following condition).
Condition: A4 paper and 10 sheets stack delivery (1-point staple)

[Note at operation]
Feed speed is enhanced when the plain paper 1 (64g/m2 ~ 81g/m2) is specified for paper
selection.
However, the possibility to generate the electrostatic is also increased when the feed speed is
enhanced and it may cause the alignment failure.
If such a case, change the paper selection to thin paper (52g/m2 ~ 63g/m2).

6-16
6
6
6-17

Version upgrade

Overview
■■Overview of Version Upgrade
The system software version is upgraded in 2 steps, downloading and writing the new version of the system software.
●● Downloading System Software
This machine supports the following 3 downloading methods.
1. Download via the service support tool (hereinafter “SST”)
Connect this machine to the PC by the cross cable to download the system software using SST installed in the PC.
2. Download using the USB memory storage device
Insert the USB memory storage device storage device to the slot of the machine and download the system software stored in the device.
3. Download via Contents Delivery System (hereinafter “CDS”)
Access to CDS via Internet to download the system software directly to the machine.

System CD SST Host Machine


System Software System Software
Download mode Write the
system software
Normal mode
/(Safe mode) Restart

Copy the
System Software Automatically restarted

USB menu

USB memory
storage device Activate the machine with the
System Software new system software version
Temporary Memory Space

Done

CDS
System Software Updater

F-6-22

6-17
6
6
6-18
■■Writing System Software
The system software downloaded in either of the above-mentioned methods is stored in the temporary memory space.
After the system software is successfully downloaded, restart the machine to write the software in the machine.
In case the main power switch is turned OFF during the writing process, the machine may not be started.
This machine supports the remote version upgrade via CDS. When upgrading the system software via CDS, the warning message is shown on the control panel to alert the user not to turn OFF the
power switch.

F-6-23
When the system software is successfully written, the machine is automatically restarted to activate the downloaded system software.
If any error occurs during the writing process, the error code, E753-0001, is shown.
The name of the system software component is shown to the left of the error log message, “version up…..error”. Check the name if the software is for the option not attached to the machine. If so,
turn OFF / ON the machine to recover the error (see Troubleshooting for details).

6-18
6
6
6-19

Log

version up...
error massage

Error
massage

F-6-24

6-19
6
6
6-20
■■Download Mode
When the version is upgraded via SST or with the USB memory storage device storage device, start the machine in Download mode. This machine has the following 2 Download modes similarly with
other iR-series models.

●● Normal mode(recommend):
• Start from Copier > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > Download.
• Conventionally, the main power switch of this machine was turned ON while pressing 1 and 7 keys. However, the procedure above automatically assigns a static IP address and enables the
download same as before.
• You can obtain the version information and avoid unnecessary download and errors.

MEMO :
When entering Download mode, be sure to go into Service mode after all items of main menu have been displayed.
This machine reads the version information of system software when it starts. You must start Download mode after the version information has been obtained.

●● Safe mode:
• Press 2 and 8 keys simultaneously on the numeric keypad when turning on the power.
• In Safe mode, only SYSTEM, MEAPCONT, LANGUAGE, RUI, and SDICT are obtained among the version information. Other version information including DCON and RCON cannot be obtained in
this mode. This may cause the following symptoms when downloading the system software.
• The existing system software components are also overwritten. Thus, time may be extended to download / write the software.
• The message is not shown even when the current operation triggers version downgrade.
• The system software may be downloaded even for the option not attached to the host machine. This triggers E753-0001.
To avoid these symptoms, download the system software in Normal mode except when you are unable enter Service mode.

6-20
6
6
6-21
■■System Software Components
The table below shows the system software components for this machine.
Software to be upgraded Display on SST How to upgrade versions Remarks
Registered name Name of system SST USB memory Others
of product software
Host Machine Main Controller iAC5051 SYSTEM ○ ○ -
MEAP Controller MEAPCON ○ ○ -
Language Module LANGUAGE ○ ○ -
OCR Libraly SDICT ○ ○ -
Remote UI Contents RUI ○ ○ -
RUI portal RPTL ○ ○ -
Mobile print MOBPR ○ ○ -
UI-BOX BOX ○ ○ -
UI-COPY COPY ○ ○ -
UI-Intro INTRO ○ ○ -
UI-SEND SEND ○ ○ -
Voice Synthesis Dictionary TTS ○ ○ -
Voice Recognition Dictionary ASR ○ ○ -
Paper Type Information File MEDIA ○ ○ -
Service Mode Contents SMCNT ○ ○ -
Printer Controller DCON ○ ○ -
WebDAV Contents WEBDAV ○ ○ -
Resources for Web Browser BROWSER ○ ○ -
Reader Controller(2-sided Single Pass) RCOND ○ ○ - Color Image Reader Unit-B1
Reader Controller(2-sided Double Pass) RCONS ○ ○ - Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1
Fax Board Boot Program Super G3 Fax Board AE1 G3CCB ○ ○ - Super G3FAX Board – AE1
Fax Board Main Program Super G3 Fax Board AE1 G3CCM ○ ○ - Super G3FAX Board – AE1
Box Checker BCT ○ ○ -
Key/Certificatefor Encrypted Communication iAXXXX KEY ○ ○ -
Staple Finisher – C1/Saddle Finisher Controller FIN_C1 FIN_CON ○ ○ - Staple Finisher – C1/Saddle Stitch Finisher – C1
Stitch Finisher – C1 Saddle Controller SDL_CON ○ ○ - Saddle Stitch Finisher – C1
External 2-hole Puncher B1 Punch Controller EXP_B1 EXP_CON - - ○ External 2-hole Puncher B1
Inner Finisher – A1 Finisher Controller IFN_A1 FIN_CON ○ ○ - Inner Finisher – A1
T-6-11

This machine holds the increased number of system software components compared to conventional iR machines to meet vastly extended functionality.
The Image Reader for this machine consists of 2-sided Single Pass and 2-sided Double Pass, requiring specific system software for each.
• The name of the system software for the 2-sided Single Pass Image Reader (Duplex Color Image Reader Unit – B1): RCOND
• The name of the system software for the 2-sided Double Pass Image Reader (Color Image Reader Unit – B1): RCONS
The finisher for this machine supports version upgrade via the host machine in any of the above-mentioned methods, i.e., via SST, USB memory storage device storage device or CDS. Note that the
External 2-hole Puncher B1 does not support version upgrade via the host machine. To upgrade versions, connect the option with the PC using the downloader PCB to download the system software
via SST.

6-21
6
6
6-22
■■Note on Download Process

Warning: Never turn OFF the power during the download / writing process.
Turning off the power during the download / writing process may cause a failure of machine start-up at power-on.
If this occurs, start the machine in Safe mode (by pressing 2 and 8 keys simultaneously on the numeric keypad).
When the machine is successfully started in Safe mode, execute formatting of BOOTDEV partition, retry downloading the system software.

Note: Normal mode is recommended when downloading the system software.


The system software can be downloaded either in Normal or Safe mode. However, some of the version information cannot be obtained when downloading the system software in Safe mode.
Thus, the SST version is unconditionally overridden in Safe mode. In addition, the system software version may be downgraded inadvertently because no message is shown on the control
panel during the download process in Safe mode. It will take extended time since existing versions are also overridden.

Warning: Error code E753-0001


The error code, E753-0001, is triggered when any error occurs during the writing process of the system software downloaded via SST or the USB memory storage device storage device. This
error code is also shown when the system software is downloaded for the option not attached to the host machine. If the error is triggered by the software for the unattached option, turn OFF /
ON the power for recovery. Listed below are the codes that may be actually shown during the download process. If any of these is shown for the unattached option, turn OFF / ON the power.
(Refer to Troubleshooting)

Name of system software Option


FIN_C1 Staple Finisher – C1/Saddle Stitch Finisher – C1
IFN_A1 Inner Finisher – A1
G3CCB Super G3FAX Board – AE1
G3CCM Super G3FAX Board – AE1

6-22
6
6
6-23
Version Upgrade via SST ●● Downloading System Software
System software is saved in the temporary storage area on HDD after downloaded with SST.
■■Overview
Restart the machine after download so that it will be written to the system area, and the flash
The system software can be downloaded either of the two modes below via SST. ROM.
• Assist mode (recommended) After the writing has been completed normally, this machine automatically restarts with the
• Single mode new system software.
Assist mode provides the following features. 1) Download the system software
• Attached option types are automatically recognized. -
[
- - Download Mode - - -
iR2270i-JPjaxxxx-MN.dsh ] - - - - - - - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iM-JPjaxxxx-1F77-MN.PRG ] - - - - Complete

• The new versions of the system software for attached option types are automatically
[ iR2270iM-ZZjaxxxx-49AD.PRG ] - - - - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iW-JPjaxxxx-5C16-MN.PRG ] - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iW-ZZjaxxxx-A825.PRG ] - - - - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iF-JPjaxxxx-DE96-ICC.PRG ] - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iW-ZZjaxxxx-A825.PRG ] - - - - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iG-JPjaxxxx-EC30-ICC.PRG ] - - - - Complete

searched.
• The set of system software with interactive behavior confirmed is automatically
downloaded.
HDD
• The accessories attached to the host machine are automatically recognized to download
System
the system software for each accessory. Software
System
Software
Temporary
memory space

This machine holds a number of system software components that mutually interacts
during operation. Behaviors of such system software should be confirmed when these are
downloaded as the set. Thus, Assist mode is basically recommended to download the system
software for this machine.

Automatically restarted
2) 主電源スイッチOFF/ON

MEMO : 3) The system software is written


Use Single mode only when any of the following conditions is met.
• When downloading some the system software components, i.e. DCON, RCON or options.
<<<<< download shell >>>>>

HDD
[ SYSTEM JPja-m ] - - - - Upgrading complete
[ SYSTEM ZZ ] - - - - - - - Upgrading complete
[ SYSTEM JPja-w ] - - - - Upgrading complete
[ SYSTEM ZZ ] - - - - - - - Upgrading complete

• When reloading the system software after HDD is formatted.


[ FONT F ] - - - - - - - - - - Upgrading complete
[ FONT G ] - - - - - - - - - - Upgrading complete
+++ Switch OFF the power then ON. +++

System
Software
Temporary
memory space

System
memory area

Automatically restarted
4) 主電源スイッチOFF/ON

FLASH
ROM 5) Start with the new version.

F-6-25

6-23
6
6
6-24
■■Copying System Software 5) Select the drive where the system CD is set and click “Search” button.

●● System CD to SST
Copy the system software stored in the system CD to SST.

MEMO:
The system software is compressed if the file size exceeds the CD memory capacity.
If the above is the case, decompress the file before copying it to SST.

Preparation
Requirements:
• PC with SST Ver.4.22 or later installed
• The system CD for this machine

Steps to copy the system software


1) Start the PC F-6-27

2) Set the system CD in the PC 6) The system software stored in the system CD is listed.
3) Start SST Uncheck the box(es) for unnecessary folder(s) and/or system software and click “Copy”
4) Click “Register Firmware” button. button.

F-6-26 F-6-28

6-24
6
6
6-25
7) The message is shown when the system software is successfully copied. Click “OK” button. ■■Connection
The following IP address is automatically set for this machine at start-up in Download mode.
• IP address:172.16.1.100
• Subnet mask:255.255.255.0
When the PC with SST installed is connected to this machine, change the PC network
address to the following.
• IP address:172.16.1.160
• Subnet mask:255.255.255.0
• Default gateway: arbitrary

Caution:
If the PC has the connection to the network, the settings changed to the above-
mentioned may cause network failures due to redundant IP addresses, etc. Ensure that
F-6-29 the PC is disconnected from the network when you change the PC network settings.
Alternatively use the cross cable to connect the PC to this machine.

Preparation
Requirements
• PC with SST Ver. 4.22 or later installed and the system software for this machine is stored
• Cross cable
10Base-T : Category 3 or 5
100Base-T : Category 5
1000Base-T : Enhanced Category 5 (CAT5e) or later

Caution:
Disconnect USB memory storage device storage devices if connected.
Communication to SST is disabled in this machine if any USB memory storage device
storage device is recognized. SST and the USB memory storage device storage device
cannot be used concurrently.

6-25
6
6
6-26
4) Check the IP address of the PC.
Go to Start menu to select Program > Accessory > Command Prompt.
Type IPCONFIG and press [Return] to see the network settings of the PC.
If any discrepancies from the description in the figure below are found, change the network
settings of the PC.

F-6-31

Caution:
IP address:172.16.1.160
Subnet mask:255.255.255.0 The network settings are not shown with IPCONFIG if the PC is disconnected from
IP address:172.16.1.100 the network. To check the settings, connect the PC to this machine at power-on by the
Subnet mask:255.255.255.0 cross cable.
Cross cable
10Base-T:Category 3, 5 or later
100Base-TX:Category 5 or later
1000Base-TX: Category 5 (CAT5e) or later
F-6-30

Steps
1) Use the cross cable to connect the machine to the PC with SST installed.
2) Turn on the main power switch of this machine.
3) Enter Service mode to start the machine in Download mode.
Select COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > DOWNLOAD and press [OK].

6-26
6
6
6-27
■■Downloading System Software (Assist mode) MEMO:
1) Start this machine and enter Download mode (COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > If the PC in Assist mode is connected to the machine in Safe mode,when click “Start”
botton, the following message is shown.
DOWNLOAD).
2) Connect the PC to this machine and start SST.
3) Click “Start Assist mode” button.
Skip this step when starting SST in Assist mode.

Click “Next” button to restart the machine. Enter Service mode upon the main menu
displayed and start Normal mode as Download mode.

F-6-32 4) Click “Start” button


If the upgraded set of the system software is stored in SST, the new set is automatically
selected.

MEMO:
If no upgrade is stored, the existing system software set is unchanged. At any rate, any
versions of the system software can be downloaded by manual selection.

F-6-33
When download is completed, the machine is automatically restarted to initiate the writing
process.The machine may repeat restarting several times depending on option configuration.
Upon the system software written, the machine is restarted again and the main menu is
displayed.

6-27
6
6
6-28

MEMO: Download Confirmation Message Modes


■■Downloading System Software (Single mode)
Download is confirmed in any of the three message modes. The following is the sample steps to download DCON (the other components of the system

• Skip the existing versions and confirm whether to download downgraded versions
software can be downloaded similarly).
Upgraded versions are downloaded without message. 1) Start the machine in an appropriate Download mode.
Skip download of the existing versions. 2) Connect the PC to this machine to start SST.
Confirm whether to download downgraded versions.
3) Select the model to be connected and “Single”, check the network settings. Click “Start”
• Confirm whether to download the existing versions / downgraded versions button.
Upgraded versions are downloaded without message.
Confirm whether to download and overwrite the existing versions.
Confirm whether to download downgraded versions.
• Overwrite all versions
Regardless of version upgrade or downgrade, all versions of the system software are
downloaded without message.
By default, “Skip the existing versions and confirm whether to download downgraded
versions” is selected.

5) Click"Next"button.

F-6-35

F-6-34
6) Disconnect the cross cable from the machine.
7) Enter Service mode to check the system software versions.
8) Click"OK"button.
The main menu is displayed.

6-28
6
6
6-29

MEMO: MEMO: Download Confirmation Message Modes


The following device information is shown at the right top of SST screen. Download is confirmed in any of the three message modes.
• IP address • Skip the existing versions and confirm whether to download downgraded versions
• Model name Upgraded versions are downloaded without message.
• Download mode Skip download of the existing versions.
Confirm whether to download downgraded versions.
• Confirm whether to download the existing versions / downgraded versions
Upgraded versions are downloaded without message.
Confirm whether to download and overwrite the existing versions.
Confirm whether to download downgraded versions.
• Overwrite all versions.
Regardless of version upgrade or downgrade, all versions of the system software are
downloaded without message.
By default, “Skip the existing versions and confirm whether to download downgraded

5) When download is completed, click “OK” button.

4) Select the DCON version to be downloaded and click “Start” button.


Multiple files can be selected in this step.

F-6-37
The main menu is displayed.

F-6-36

6-29
6
6
6-30
6) Click “Shutdown / Restart” button.
MEMO:
If it is before restarting the machine, the downloaded system software can be deleted
not written on HDD or Flash ROM.
1) Click “Clear” button.
“Clear” button

F-6-38
7) Click “Restart” button.

2) Click “Execute Clear” button.


The system software, which is stored in the temporary memory space of HDD, is
deleted.

F-6-39
The machine is restarted.
The downloaded system software is written on HDD or Flash ROM.
8) Click"OK"button.
9) Enter Service mode to check the versions.
3) Click“OK”button.
Return to the previous screen.

6-30
6
6
6-31
■■Formatting HDD When executing format BOOTDEV When executing format ALL
startup in normal mode
●● Overview
Execute format BOOTDEV Execute format ALL
This machine probides the following two types of HDD Formatting.
• ALL:to format the whole HDD
• When HDD set as the service parts (the new HDD) is mounted Automatically restart
• When clearing the system software and data completely from HDD and reloading the
system software.
Select download mode Select download mode
Once Format ALL is executed in your machine, all the user data and MEAP applications
([1]: Upgrade (AUTO)is recommended) ([1]: Upgrade (AUTO)is recommended)
held in HDD will be cleared. Ensure to gain an agreement from the user before formatting.

• BOOTDEV: to format the system software storage area on HDD.


• When clearing the system software storage area and reloading the system software Download the system software
Download the system software
HDD needs not to be formatted at version upgrade. for the main controller

HDD can be formatted only in Single mode. Automatically restart Automatically restart
After HDD is formatted, the machine cannot be started before the system software is
downloaded.
Writing process Writing process

After Format ALL is executed, the machine is automatically restarted to reflect formatting
Automatically restart Automatically restart
to HDD. At this time, the machine automatically starts in Download mode. For BOOTDEV
format, the machine is ready to download the system software without restarting.
After formatting, enter either Assist mode(recommended) or Single mode to download the Start in the new version Start in the new version
system software.
of the system software of the system software

F-6-40

6-31
6
6
6-32

When executing format ALL startup in normal mode MEMO:


When executing format BOOTDEV When executing format ALL With SSTv4.22, due to sharing the simple mode processing with the existing models,
the following screen is displayed.
Execute format ALL Execute format ALL As for the iR ADVANCE series models (or this machine), the procedure displayed on
the screen is not necessary; thus, click the “Next” button to go on to the next screen.
Automatically restart Automatically restart

Select Download mode Select Download mode


(preferably in assist mode) (preferably in assist mode)

Download the system software Download the system software


for the main controller

Automatically restart Automatically restart

Writing process Writing process F-6-42

Automatically restart Automatically restart

Start in Download mode


Start in Download mode
of Normal mode
of Normal mode

Download the system software for


Since there is no system software DCON/RCON/option
to be downloaded,
the shutdown sequence is executed
Automatically restart
restart the machine manually
Writing process
Start in the same version
of the system software Automatically restart

Start in the new version


of the system software

F-6-41

6-32
6
6
6-33
●● Steps of Formatting 5) Select "BOOTDEV" or "ALL" to click "Start".
1) Enter Download mode. (Enter Safe mode when you mount the new HDD or when the
machine is unable to start normally due to HDD failures, etc.)
2) Connect the PC to the machine to start SST.
3) Select the model to be connected and “single”. Check the network settings and click “Start”
button.

F-6-45
6) Click "Execute Format" button.

F-6-43

4) Click“Format HDD”button

F-6-46
HDD is formatted.

F-6-44

6-33
6
6
6-34
7) Download the system software in any Download mode (Assist mode recommended). See ●● Mounting New HDD
the steps to download the system software for details. After HDD set as the service parts is mounted, the new HDD should be formatted initially. In
this case, the message is shown to confirm if the new HDD is mounted.

The figure below shows the abbreviated steps.

Replacing HDDs

Start the machine in Safe mode


(by pressing 2 and 8 keys simultaneously on the numeric keypad)

Connect to SST
F-6-47

Caution:
After HDD is formatted, ensure to download the system software. If the system software Confirm that the new HDD is successfully mounted
is not downloaded, E602 error is triggered at power-on.

Format HDD (Format ALL)


Caution:
Restarting takes more time after HDD is formatted and the system software is
downloaded (to write the downloaded software).
Follow the steps as described in Format ALL section.
Down time may be approx. 5 minutes in maximum to proceed the writing process.
F-6-48
Never turn OFF the machine while Starting screen is shown.

6-34
6
6
6-35
When the new HDD is mounted, the machine cannot be started in the normal procedure. ■■Backup
Start the machine in Safe mode as Download mode. When gaining connection to SST, the
message is shown to confirm if the new HDD is mounted. ●● Overview
At the time of replacing controller PCBs, the backup function enables to save data held in the
PCB to migrate them to the new PCB.

• Backup via SST


Backup data Downloaded/Uploaded file names
Backup data RAM SramImg.bin(to be uploaded / downloaded)
MEAP applications MeapBack.bin(to be uploaded / downloaded)
For investigation in Dev Sublog.bin(Do not select this file)
T-6-12

• Backup RAM holds the data from Backup RAM of the Main Controller PCB 2.
(Because setting data of service mode for the parts counter and the Main Controller are
stored, be sure to back up the data when replacing the Main Controller PCB and the DC
Controller PCB.)
• MeapBack holds MEAP applications and their data stored in HDD

F-6-49
• Backup via Service mode
Click "Yes" and the message is shown, confirming whether to format HDD.
Backup data Service mode
Backup of Reader COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM RSRAMBUP (Backup)
Controller PCB COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM RSRAMRES (Restore)
Backup of DC Controller COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM DSRAMBUP (Backup)
PCB COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM DSRAMRES (Restore)
T-6-13

Data is stored in HDD.

MEMO:
Before replacing the Reader Controller PCBs, back up the data from Service mode.
The backup data can be restored from Service mode when the PCBs are replaced. This
enables to maintain the setting data including Service mode stored in the old Reader
Controller PCB.

Before replacing the DC controller PCBs, back up the data from Service mode. The
F-6-50 backup data can be restored from Service mode when the PCBs are replaced. This
Click “Initialize” button to initialize HDD (Format ALL). Follow the steps described in Format enables to maintain the setting data including Service mode stored in the old Controller
PCB.
ALL section to download the system software.
Before replacing the Main Controller PCB 2, upload SramImg.bin. By downloading
SramImg.bin after replacement, the new Main Controller PCB 2 inherits the data
including Service mode stored in the old PCB

6-35
6
6
6-36
●● Steps to Upload Data ●● Listed below are the sample steps to upload MeapBack.
1) Enter Download mode.
Caution: 2) Connect the PC to the machine to start SST.
• Do not select Sublog.bin. 3) Select the model to be connected and “Single”. Check the network settings and click “Start”.
• The backup data can be downloaded only on the machine from which the data were
uploaded.
• This machine does not use SramRCON and SramDcon

iR ADVNCE C5051 Series


Service PC
SST
iR ----
Upload/Download Main controller PCB1
System

MeapBack F-6-52
/ SramImg.bin 4) Click “Upload Data” button.

Main controller PCB2


SRAM

HDD
SramImg.bin
Meapback.bin

Main controller

F-6-51

F-6-53

6-36
6
6
6-37
5) Select “MeapBack.bin” to click “Start” button. ●● Steps to Download Data

Caution:
• The backup data can be downloaded to the machine from which the data were
uploaded

Listed below were the sample steps to download MeapBack.


1) Enter Download mode
2) Connect the PC to the machine and start SST.
3) Select the model to be connected and “Single”. Check the network setting and click “Start”
button.

F-6-54
6) Enter the file name to be saved and comments when necessary. Click “Save” button.

F-6-56

F-6-55
7) Click “OK” button.

6-37
6
6
6-38
4) Click “Download Data” button.
Version Upgrade using USB memory Storage Device
■■Relation between SST and USB memory storage device
Storage Device
When using the USB memory storage device storage device for version upgrade, the system
software should be copied to the USB memory storage device storage device. By inserting
the USB memory storage device storage device to the slot of the machine, the system
software can be upgraded.
The figure below shows the relation between SST and USB memory storage device storage
device.

PC iR ----

F-6-57
5) Select the data to be downloaded and click “Start” button.

SST

System software

Copying the System Software


システムソフトウェアのコピー

USB memory
storage device HDD
Downloading the
SST system software

F-6-58 Flash ROM


System software
6) When the data are successfully downloaded, click “OK” button.
7) Restart the machine F-6-59
When downloading the system software, enter any of Download modes below.
• Normal mode (recommended)
Select COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > Download in Service mode and press [OK].
• Safe mode (only when any system error occurs or the machine is unable to start normally;
turn ON the main power switch by pressing 2 and 8 keys simultaneously on the numeric
keypad)

6-38
6
6
6-39
●● Downloading System Software ■■Copying System Software
Copy the system software from SST to the USB memory storage device storage device.
●● System CD to SST
Right after download from the USB memory storage device storage device, the system
Copy the system software stored in the system CD to SST.
software is stored in the temporary memory space in HDD.
The system software is written in the system memory area, Boot area and Flash ROM upon
MEMO:
the machine restarted. The system software is compressed if the file size exceeds the CD memory capacity.
When the writing process is successfully completed, the machine is automatically restarted If the above is the case, decompress the file before copying it to SST.
with the new version of the system software.

Tasks in the customer site Preparation


1) Download the system software Requirements:
-
[
[
- - Download Mode - - -
iR2270i-JPjaxxxx-MN.dsh ] - - - - - - - - - - Complete
iR2270iM-JPjaxxxx-1F77-MN.PRG ] - - - - Complete
• PC with SST Ver. 4.22 or later installed
[ iR2270iM-ZZjaxxxx-49AD.PRG ] - - - - - - - Complete

• The system CD for this machine


[ iR2270iW-JPjaxxxx-5C16-MN.PRG ] - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iW-ZZjaxxxx-A825.PRG ] - - - - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iF-JPjaxxxx-DE96-ICC.PRG ] - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iW-ZZjaxxxx-A825.PRG ] - - - - - - - Complete
[ iR2270iG-JPjaxxxx-EC30-ICC.PRG ] - - - - Complete

Task in the office


Steps to copy the system software
USB memory HDD 1) Start the PC.
storage device 2) Set the system CD to the PC.
System System System
Software Software Software 3) Start SST.
Temporary
memory space 4) Click “Register Firmware” button.

Copying the system software

Automatically restarted
2) 主電源スイッチOFF/ON

3) The system software is written

<<<<< download shell >>>>>

HDD
[ SYSTEM JPja-m ] - - - - Upgrading complete
[ SYSTEM ZZ ] - - - - - - - Upgrading complete
[ SYSTEM JPja-w ] - - - - Upgrading complete
[ SYSTEM ZZ ] - - - - - - - Upgrading complete
[ FONT F ] - - - - - - - - - - Upgrading complete
[ FONT G ] - - - - - - - - - - Upgrading complete
+++ Switch OFF the power then ON. +++

System
Software
Temporary
memory space

System
memory area

Automatically restarted
4) 主電源スイッチOFF/ON F-6-61

FLASH
ROM 5) Start with the new version.

F-6-60

6-39
6
6
6-40
5) Select the drive where the system CD is set and click “Search” button. 7) The message is shown when the system software is copied. Click “OK” button.

F-6-62
F-6-64
6) The list of the system software components stored in the system CD is shown on the
screen.
Uncheck the box(es) of unnecessary folder(s) and/or system software component(s) and
click “Copy” button.

F-6-63

6-40
6
6
6-41
●● SST to USB memory Storage Device 4) Click the USB icon shown in "Select the target" Screen.
Copy the system software stored in SST to the USB memory storage device storage device.

Preparation
Requirements:
• PC with SST Ver. 4.22 or later installed
• USB memory storage device (*)

Requirements for USB memory storage device:


Interface: USB 1.1 or later (USB 2.0 is recommended)
Memory capacity: 1GB or more is recommended (the total file size of the system software
is approx. 500MB).
Format: FAT (FAT 16), FAT32 (NTFS and HFS are not supported). The memory is formatted
in a partition (multiple partitions are not supported)
Unavailable USB memory: memory that is protected by a password or the encryption F-6-65

technology. 5) Select the drive (removable disk) where the USB memory storage device storage device is
inserted.
Steps to copy the system software
1) Start the PC.
2) Insert the USB memory storage device storage device to the slot of the PC.
3) Start SST.

F-6-66

6-41
6
6
6-42
6) Select “Series” and “Version” (the System Version).
MEMO:
When the accessory configuration is known for the machine where the system software
is to be downloaded, uncheck the boxes of unnecessary accessories. E753-0001 is
triggered if the software for an unnecessary accessory is downloaded. (If this occurred,
turn OFF/ON the power to recover the error.)

8) Click “OK” when the system software is successfully copied in the USB memory storage
device storage device.

F-6-67

MEMO:
The signs shown in the field of “Firmware registration static” indicate the following:
Y: Stored in SST
N: Not stored in SST

7) Click “Start” button.


Start copying the system software to the USB memory storage device storage device.
F-6-69

F-6-68

6-42
6
6
6-43
■■Connection 3) Switch to the download mode to use.
• In the case of normal mode (Recommended)
Select the following in Service Mode: COPIER > FUNCTION > SYSTEM > DOWNLOAD;
Caution:
and then press [OK].
This machine does not communicate with SST once it recognizes a USB memory
• In the case of safe mode (This mode should not be used as general rule. To be used only
storage device; therefore, SST and a USB memory storage device cannot be used at
when normal startup fails, such as a system error, etc.)
the same time.
While pressing 2 + 8 keys at the same time, turn ON the Main Power Switch.
Once this machine recognizes the USB memory storage device, the following menu is
displayed on the Control Panel.
Preparation
Item to prepare: a USB memory storage device, which the system software for this machine
is stored.
Procedure [[[[[ download Menu (USB) ]]]]]]]]]]]
1) If a cross cable is connected to this machine, remove the cross cable. -------------------------------------
2) Connect the USB memory storage device to the USB port. [1]: Upgrade (Auto)
[2]: Upgrade (w Confirmation)
[3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all)
[4]: Format HDD
[5]: Backup
[7]: Clear downloaded files
[8]: download Menu 2
[9]: Other Menu

[Reset]: Shutdown
F-6-71

Caution:
Depending on the manufacturer or the model, this machine may not recognize the USB
memory storage device.
This machine retries the detection of a USB memory storage device for up to 60
seconds after power-ON. The above menu is not displayed if the recognition of a USB
USB memory memory storage device is failed within the time period.
In such a case, use another USB memory storage device.

USB port

F-6-70

6-43
6
6
6-44
■■Upgrading System Software ●● Points to Note When Operating/Using System Software
●● Menu/Function Overview MEMO:
The following download method is recommended to execute normal download of the
system software (any download work other than downloading after replacing/formatting
[[[[[ download Menu (USB) ]]]]]]]]]]] the HDD):
------------------------------------- Download mode --- Normal mode
[1]: Upgrade (Auto) Download menu --- [1]: Upgrade (Auto)
[2]: Upgrade (w Confirmation)
[3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all)
[4]: Format HDD Caution: Prohibition to turn OFF the power during downloading/writing

[5]: Backup Do not turn OFF the power during downloading or writing of the system software;
[7]: Clear downloaded files otherwise, this machine may not be started even if the power is turned ON.
[8]: download Menu 2 If the machine fails to be started even if the power is turned ON, start the machine in
[9]: Other Menu safe mode (pressing 2 + 8 keys).
When the machine can be started in safe mode, be sure to download the system
[Reset]: Shutdown software once again.
If the machine fails to be started, replace the HDD and then download the system
F-6-72
Downloading System Software software.

[1]: Upgrade(Auto)
To download/write the system software (automatic) Caution: Note when the power is turned OFF
[2]: Upgrade (w Confirmation)
Be sure to execute shutdown sequence to quit download mode.
To download the system software (confirmation)
Pressing the [Reset] key and then the [0] key on the menu screen executes the
[3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all)
shutdown sequence.
To download the system software (overwriting)
Once the message on the touch panel disappears, turn OFF the Main Power Switch.
[4]: Format HDD
To format the HDD/BOOTDEV partition
[5]: Backup
Do not use this menu because this function is for R&D review
[7]: Clear downloaded files
To clear the system software immediately after downloading (before writing)
[8]: Download Menu 2
To move to Download Menu 2
[9]: Other Menu
Others (e.g.: version information)
[Reset]: Shutdown
To execute shutdown sequence

Press the key on the Control Panel to select/execute the functions.

F-6-73

6-44
6
6
6-45
■■Downloading/Writing System Software (Automatic) 3) Press the key on the Control Panel.
[1] -> [0]: To execute downloading/Any key other than [0] key: To return to the menu screen.
●● [1]: Upgrade (Auto)
The version is compared between the host machine/option and the system software in the
[[[[[ download Menu (USB) ]]]]]]]]]]]
USB memory storage device to download only the system software with newer version in the
-------------------------------------
USB memory storage device to the temporary storage area of the HDD.
[1]: Upgrade (Auto)
In safe mode, only the following system software can retrieve the version information (the
[2]: Upgrade (w Confirmation)
version is compared).
[3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all)
SYSTEM, LANGUAGE, RUI, MERAPCONT, SDICT
[4]: Format HDD
For the Host Machine that cannot retrieve the version information, the system software is to
[5]: Backup
be downloaded.
[7]: Clear downloaded files
[8]: download Menu 2
For the system software of the option that is not connected, it is handled as follows:
[9]: Other Menu
<In the case of startup in normal mode (Recommended)>
• When Download Mode Version (to be displayed on the initial screen when starting the
[Reset]: Shutdown
download mode) is before 00.36
F-6-74
All the system software including the one of the non-connecting option is to be
During downloading, download status is displayed on the Control Panel.
downloaded as well (E753 is displayed).
• When Download Mode Version (to be displayed on the initial screen when starting the
download mode) is 00.36:
For the Finisher that is not connected, the system software is not to be downloaded.
G3CCB/G3CCM is to be downloaded even if Super G3FAX Board – AE1 is not
installed (E753 is displayed).
• When Download Mode Version (to be displayed on the initial screen when starting the
download mode) is 00.40 or later:
For the option that is not connected, the system software is not to be downloaded.

<In the case of startup in safe mode>


All the system software including the one of the non-connecting option is to be downloaded
as well (E753 is displayed).

F-6-75
After downloading is complete, this machine is automatically restarted to write the Once downloading is complete, this machine is automatically restarted to start writing to the
downloaded system software to the HDD system area/flash ROM. HDD system area/flash ROM.
The screen shows the countdown once writing process is properly complete.
Operation procedure
1) Enter download mode.
2) Connect the USB memory storage device to the USB port.

6-45
6
6
6-46
■■Downloading System Software (Confirmation)
●● [2]: Upgrade (w Confirmation)
The version is compared between the host machine/option and the system software in the
USB memory storage device to download the system software with newer version in the USB
memory storage device to the temporary storage area of the HDD.
When the system software version in the USB memory storage device is the same or older, a
confirmation message is displayed on the Control Panel so that the user can select whether
to overwrite or not.

In safe mode, only the following system software can retrieve the version information (the
version is compared).
SYSTEM, LANGUAGE, RUI, MERAPCONT, SDICT
For the Host Machine that cannot retrieve the version information, the system software is to
F-6-76
be downloaded.
Once the countdown shows 0, this machine is automatically restarted.
For the system software of the option that is not connected, it is handled as follows:
4) When the main menu is displayed, press the removal key at the lower right on the touch
<In the case of startup in normal mode (Recommended)>
panel and select removal of the memory media, and then remove the USB memory storage
• When Download Mode Version (to be displayed on the initial screen when starting the
device.
download mode) is before 00.36:

Caution: All the system software including the one of the non-connecting option is to be
After HDD formatting and downloading, this machine takes a long time (for writing the downloaded as well (E753 is displayed).
software). • When Download Mode Version (to be displayed on the initial screen when starting the
This machine, in some cases, stays in standby screen up to 10 min during writing. At download mode) is 00.36:
this time, do not turn off the main power switch. For the Finisher that is not connected, the system software is not to be downloaded.
G3CCB/G3CCM is to be downloaded even if Super G3FAX Board – AE1 is not
installed (E753 is displayed).
• When Download Mode Version (to be displayed on the initial screen when starting the
download mode) is 00.40 or later:
For the option that is not connected, the system software is not to be downloaded.

<In the case of startup in safe mode>


All the system software including the one of the non-connecting option is to be downloaded
as well (E753 is displayed).

Unlike menu [1], this machine is not automatically started despite completion of downloading.
By manually turning OFF/ON the power, the system software is written at the time of startup.
In this case, starting the machine in safe mode deletes the downloaded system software
saved in the temporary storage area; therefore, do not press the numeric keys (2 + 8), but
execute normal startup to execute writing.

6-46
6
6
6-47
Operation procedure
1) Enter download mode.
2) Connect the USB memory storage device to the USB port.
3) Press the key on the Control Panel.
[2] -> [0]: To execute downloading/Any key other than [0] key: To return to the menu screen.

[[[[[ download Menu (USB) ]]]]]]]]]]]


-------------------------------------
[1]: Upgrade (Auto)
[2]: Upgrade (w Confirmation)
[3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all)
[4]: Format HDD
[5]: Backup
[7]: Clear downloaded files F-6-79
[8]: download Menu 2 4) Press the “Reset” key.
[9]: Other Menu Shutdown sequence is executed.
5) Once the message on the touch panel disappears, turn OFF the Main Power Switch.
/[2] has been selected. Execute?/ 6) Remove the USB memory storage device.
- (OK):0 / (CANCEL):Any other keys - 7) Ensure the LED at the lower right on the Control Panel is turned OFF, and turn ON the
Main Power Switch.
F-6-77
Writing to the HDD system area/flash ROM is started after the startup. The screen shows
During downloading, download status is displayed on the Control Panel.
the countdown once the writing process is properly completed.
The screen shows the countdown once the writing process is properly completed. This
MEMO:
When the system software version in the USB memory storage device is the same or machine is restarted with the downloaded system software at the count of 0.
older than the system software in the HDD, a message is displayed in each case to
confirm whether to overwrite or not.
Press the key on the Control Panel.
[0]: To overwrite/Any key other than [0]: Not to overwrite

F-6-78

Once downloading is complete, a message is displayed to encourage pressing the “Reset”


key.

6-47
6
6
6-48
■■Downloading System Software (Overwriting) Caution:
●● [3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all) In overwriting download mode of the USB memory storage device, all the system
Regardless of the system software version in the host machine, all the system software in the software stored in the USB memory storage device is downloaded as well. Therefore,
USB memory storage device is downloaded. be sure to keep the following in mind: If the USB memory storage device includes the
Regardless of the system software version in the host machine, all the system software in the system software of non-connecting option, E753-0001 is displayed when the writing
process is completed.
USB memory storage device is downloaded.
Unlike menu [1], this machine is not automatically started despite completion of downloading. In the case of an error in downloading of the non-connecting option, the machine can
By manually turning OFF/ON the power, the system software is written at the time of startup. be recovered by turning OFF/ON the power.
In this case, starting the machine in safe mode deletes the downloaded system software To prevent such error, uncheck the applicable system software so that the system
saved in the temporary storage area; therefore, do not press the numeric keys (2 + 8), but software of the non-connecting option is not downloaded when downloading the system
execute normal startup to execute writing. software from SST to USB.

Once downloading is complete, a message is displayed to encourage pressing the “Reset”


Operation procedure
key.
1) Enter download mode.
2) Connect the USB memory storage device to the USB port.
3) Press the key on the Control Panel.
[3] -> [0]: To execute downloading/Any key other than [0] key: To return to the menu screen.

[[[[[ download Menu (USB) ]]]]]]]]]]]


-------------------------------------
[1]: Upgrade (Auto)
[2]: Upgrade (w Confirmation)
[3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all)
[4]: Format HDD
[5]: Backup
[7]: Clear downloaded files
[8]: download Menu 2 F-6-81

[9]: Other Menu 4) Press the “Reset” key.


Shutdown sequence is executed.
/[3] has been selected. Execute?/ 5) Once the message on the touch panel disappears, turn OFF the Main Power Switch.
- (OK):0 / (CANCEL):Any other keys - 6) Remove the USB memory storage device.
7) After checking that the LED is turned OFF at the lower right on the Control Panel, turn ON
F-6-80 the Main Power Switch.
During downloading, download status is displayed on the Control Panel. Writing to the HDD system area/flash ROM is started after the startup. The screen shows
the countdown once the writing process is properly complete.
When the countdown shows 0, this machine is restarted with the downloaded system
software.

6-48
6
6
6-49
■■Formatting HDD When executing format BOOTDEV When executing format ALL
startup in normal mode
●● HDD Format Overview
Execute format BOOTDEV Execute format ALL
The following 2 types of formatting methods are available with this machine:
• ALL: To initialize the entire HDD
• In the case of installing the HDD provided as a service part (a new HDD). Automatically restart
• In the case of cleaning the entire software and data in the HDD to reinstall the system
software.
Select download mode Select download mode
All the user data and MEAP application in the HDD is deleted when executing Format ALL
([1]: Upgrade (AUTO)is recommended) ([1]: Upgrade (AUTO)is recommended)
with the machine in use; therefore, be sure to obtain agreement from the user to execute
Format ALL.

Download the system software Download the system software


• BOOTDEV: to format the system software storage area on HDD. for the main controller
• In the case of normal upgrading by cleaning the storage area of the system software
• User data will not be deleted. Automatically restart Automatically restart
To reinstall the system software, HDD formatting is not required.

Writing process Writing process


After formatting, this machine cannot be started unless the system software is downloaded.
When Format ALL is executed, initialization process is reflected to the HDD so that this
Automatically restart Automatically restart
machine is automatically restarted to automatically enter download mode. In the case of
formatting BOOTDEV, the machine is not automatically restarted, but the system software
can be downloaded. Start in the new version Start in the new version
After formatting is executed, be sure to download the system software by “[1]: Upgrade
of the system software of the system software
(AUTO)” in main menu. F-6-82

6-49
6
6
6-50
●● [4]: Format HDD 4) Press the key on the Control Panel.
This mode executes formatting of BOOTDEV partition or the entire HDD. [1] -> [0]: To execute formatting BOOTDEV/Any key other than [0]: To return to the menu
screen.
Operation procedure [2] -> [0]: To execute formatting the entire HDD/Any key other than [0]: To return to the
1) Enter download mode. menu screen.
2) Connect the USB memory storage device to the USB port. [C]: To return to the menu screen.
3) Press the key on the Control Panel.
[4] -> [0]: To execute formating /Any key other than [0] key: To return to the menu screen.

[[[[[ download Menu (USB) ]]]]]]]]]]]


-------------------------------------
[1]: Upgrade (Auto)
[2]: Upgrade (w Confirmation)
[3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all)
[4]: Format HDD
[5]: Backup
[7]: Clear downloaded files
[8]: download Menu 2
[9]: Other Menu F-6-84
Once downloading is complete, a message is displayed to encourage pressing the “Reset”
/[4] has been selected. Execute?/ key.
- (OK):0 / (CANCEL):Any other keys -
5) Press any key to return to the menu screen.
F-6-83
6) Download the system software.
Refer to “Separate Download” for details.

6-50
6
6
6-51
■■Backup ■■Other Menu
●● [5]: Backup ●● [9]: Other Menu
This mode displays other menu.
Caution:
Do not use this function because this mode is for R&D review. Operation procedure
1) Enter download mode.
2) Connect the USB memory storage device to the USB port.
■■Clearing Download File 3) Press the key on the Control Panel.
[9] -> [0]: To display other menu/Any key other than [0] key: To return to the menu screen.
●● [7]: Clear downloaded files
This menu clears the system software stored in the temporary storage area of the HDD.
●● [1]: Version Information
This function is used to clear the downloaded file without writing it after downloading the
This mode displays the version of download mode.
system software in menu [2] or [3].
Operation procedure
1) After downloading by menu [2] or [3], press the “Reset” key to execute shutdown
sequence, and then turn OFF the main power once the screen display disappears.
2) Start the machine in safe mode (while pressing 2 + 8 keys at the same time, turn ON the
Main Power Switch).
If the system software is stored in the HDD temporary storage area when starting the
machine in safe mode, the system software is deleted. In such a case, the following message
is displayed on the touch panel.
“All downloaded file is deleted.”

3) Turn OFF the Main Power Switch.


4) Remove the USB memory storage device.

■■Download Menu 2 F-6-85


Press any key to return to the main menu.
●● [8]: Download Menu 2

Caution:
Do not use this menu because this function is for R&D review

6-51
6
6
6-52
Troubleshooting ●● Upgrading by SST
Be sure to use Assist mode as a general rule because the system software of the non-
■■Error Code: E753-0001 connecting option is not to be downloaded in Assist mode.
In Single mode, it is available to download the system software of the option that is not
●● Cause
installed.
In the case of an error during writing process of the system software or in the case of writing
In the case of downloading the Finisher’s system software, make the download mode of
the system software of the option that is not installed, an error is determined to display E753-
the Host Machine in normal mode and connect to SST, and then download just the system
0001.
software of the Finisher with the version information displayed at the right side of the SST
screen.
●● Remedy In the case that Super G3FAX Board – AE1 is not installed or in the case of download mode
The result of writing process is displayed at the upper side of E753-0001 error display.
in safe mode, G3CCB/G3CCM is not displayed on the list of downloadable system software.
Be sure to check the system software with the error (error or NG) displayed.
In the case of the following display, E753-0001 is displayed unless the supported option is
installed. Caution:
• [G3CCB], [G3CCM]: Super G3FAX Board – AE1
When downloading both FIN_C1-FIN_CON and FIN_C1-SDL_CON system software to
• [FIN_C1] Staple Finisher – C1, Saddle Stitch Finisher – C1 the Host Machine that connects Staple Finisher –C1, both result in errors and E753 is
• [IFN_A1] Inner Finisher – A1 displayed.
When the option with the software that causes the error fails to be installed, the machine is
In such a case, writing result on the touch panel displays double [FIN_C1”].
recovered by turning OFF/ON the power.
When downloading just FIN_C1-SDL_CON to the Host Machine that connects Staple
Press the Reset key to execute shutdown, and then turn OFF the Main Power Switch once
Finisher – C1, it results in an error and E753 is displayed.
the touch panel display disappears. Turn ON the Main Power Switch when the power lamp at
In such a case, writing result on the touch panel displays a single [FIN_C1].
the lower right on the Control Panel is turned OFF.
Be sure to download just FIN_C1-FIN_CON to Staple Finisher – C1.

For the software of the following options, take care of downloading because downloading to
the Host Machine without any connecting option can cause improper display of E753-0001.
MEMO:
• Super G3FAX Board – AE1
Image Reader has 2 types of system software: RCOND and RCONS.
iAC5051-G3CCB Downloading both RCOND and RCONS results in writing of only the system software
iAC5051-G3CCM that complies with the Image Reader installed in the Host Machine. When downloading
• Staple Finisher – C1 the system software that does not comply with the Image Reader installed in the Host
Machine, it results in skipping of writing process (it will not be an error).
FIN_C1-FIN_CON
• Saddle Stitch Finisher – C1
FIN_C1-FIN_CON
FIN_C1-SDL_CON
• Inner Finisher – A1
IFN_A1-FIN_CON

6-52
6
6
6-53
●● Upgrading by USB memory storage device • In the case of startup in normal mode to select [3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all) in the USB
Depending on the version of the download module, the condition for improper display differs. menu:
To check the version of download module: All the system software stored in the USB memory storage device is definitely to
• When starting the download mode, the version is displayed as Download Mode be downloaded (E753 is displayed).
Version on the initial screen. • In the case of startup in safe mode to select [1]: Upgrade (Auto), [2]: Upgrade (w
• When selecting [9]: Other Menu in the download menu (USB), the version is displayed Confirmation) or [3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all) in the USB menu:
as MiniBootable Version. All the system software stored in the USB memory storage device is definitely to
When the USB memory storage device stores the system software of the option that is not be downloaded (E753 is displayed).
installed, the behavior is as follows:
• The system software is before Download Mode Version 00.36:
Even if selecting any Upgrade of [1], [2] or [3] in the USB menu in both normal
mode and safe mode, all the system software of the non-connecting option is to be
downloaded. (E753 is displayed).

• The system software is Download Mode Version 00.36


• In the case of startup in normal mode to select [1]: Upgrade (Auto) or [2]: Upgrade (w
Confirmation) in the USB menu:
For the Finisher that is not installed, the system software is not to be downloaded
(E753 is not displayed).
G3CCB/G3CCM is to be downloaded even if Super G3FAX Board – AE1 is not
installed (E753 is displayed).
• In the case of startup in normal mode to select [3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all) in the USB
menu:
All the system software stored in the USB memory storage device is definitely to
be downloaded (E753 is displayed).
• In the case of startup in safe mode to select [1]: Upgrade (Auto), [2]: Upgrade (w
Confirmation) or [3]: Upgrade (Overwrite all) in the USB menu:
All the system software stored in the USB memory storage device is definitely to
be downloaded (E753 is displayed).

• The system software is Download Mode Version 00.40 or later:


• In the case of startup in normal mode to select [1]: Upgrade (Auto) or [2]: Upgrade (w
Confirmation) in the USB menu:
For the Finisher that is not installed, the system software is not to be downloaded
(E753 is not displayed).
G3CCB/G3CCM is not to be downloaded if Super G3FAX Board – AE1 is not
installed (E753 is not displayed).

6-53
6
6
6-54

Version Upgrade via CDS


■■Overview
Among the 4 methods in which service technicians provide firmware install services, the
following 3 methods are available using Updater functions.

a. UGW-linked Download and Update (Full-remote Update)


b. UGW-linked Download (Remote Distribution Update)
c. Manual Download and Update (On-site Update from Service Mode)

: Operator of each company : User operation

Firmware
Market Release

a
b
c
Distribution
Setting to UGW Firmware acquisition
(UGW-linked)*1

*2

Distribution setting & Distribution setting & Distribution setting &


Download Download Download
Automatic download Via Service mode Scheduled download Via User mode Via User mode Download via SST
(Local UI) (Local UI) (Remote UI)

Apply (Update) Apply (Update) Apply (Update)


Automatic update Via Service mode Scheduled update Via User mode Via User mode Update via SST
(Local UI) (Local UI) (Remote UI)

Without connection to
With connection to external network
external network

*1: Schedules for UGW-linked distribution are maintained on CDS. F-6-86

*2: Functioning supports periodical update with a device after firmware version V50.00.

NOTE:
• See User Manual of the device for how to connect the device to the external network.
• When needed, perform the communication test before actual download to check if the
communication with the distribution server is normal.

6-54
6
6
6-55
■■Preparation ●● Setting Sales Company’s HQ
When using devices input in the markets listed below, the default setting of Sales Company’s
●● Overview of Preparation
HQ should be changed before obtaining firmware distributed from CDS. Unless the setting is
The following should be prepared before using Updater.
changed properly, the desired firmware may not be able to be selected.
• For updating of firmware
Default Setting of Sales Setting of Sales Company's
Enabling Enabling Market
Setting Company's HQ HQ after Change
Enabling [Update [Manual Enabling Canada US CA
Installation Sales Network
UGW Firmware] Update] Button [Scheduled Latin America US/SG LA
Method Company’s Settings
Link Button of User of User Mode Update] Hong Kong SG HK
HQ
Mode (Remote UI) T-6-16

UGW-linked
Go to the following screen to change the setting of Sales Company's HQ.
Download and Yes Yes Yes - - -
Update Service Setting of Device Service Mode COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > CDS-CTL
UGW-linked Technician (Level 1)
Yes Yes Yes - - -
Download
Manual
Download and Yes Yes - - - -
Update NOTE:
Manual The list below shows the setting of Sales Company’s HQ for CDS-CTS by market.
Download and Check and adhere to the appropriate setting for your market.
Yes Yes - Yes - - <List of Sales Company’s HQ and the settings for CDS-CTL>
Update via
Local UI Japan = JP China = CN
Manual USA = US Hong Kong = HK
Download and Singapore = SG Australia = AU
Yes Yes - Yes - -
Update via Europe = NL Canada = CA
Remote UI
Korea = KR Latin America= LA
Special
Download and
Yes - - - Yes -
Update via
Remote UI
Scheduled
Yes Yes - - - Yes
Update
T-6-14

• For Install of Application


Enabling [Install Application/
Installation Method Network Settings
Options] Button of User Mode
LMS-linked Installation Yes -
LMA-linked installation via Local UI Yes Yes
LMS-linked installation via Remote UI Yes Yes
T-6-15

6-55
6
6
6-56
●● Network Settings 2. Confirming URL Setting of Distribution Server
1. Connecting to External Network This section describes how to confirm the URL setting of the distribution server.
The method of connecting to external network is similar to a normal network connection
method. Refer to user manual of the device for details. 1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.
1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
NOTE: 3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
• See User Manual for how to connect the device to the external network. 4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.
• Before using UGW link or User mode, see the sections below to prepare as required.
“Enabling UGW Link”
“Enabling [Update Firmware] Button of User Mode” 2. Press [Updater] button.
“Enabling [Install Application/Options] Button of User Mode”

NOTE:
“External Network” here means the network connecting the device to CDS via Internet.

F-6-87

6-56
6
6
6-57
3. Press [Software Management Settings] button. 5. Ensure to enter “https://device.c-cdsknn.net/cds_soap/updaterif” in the field beside the
[Delivery Server URL] button.
If the URL is not entered or a wrong URL is entered in the field, click [Delivery Server URL]
button to show the virtual keypad. Check the URL and enter the correct one.

F-6-88
4. Press [Settings] button.

F-6-90
6. Press [OK] to set the entered items. Now the URL of the distribution server is successfully
set.

F-6-89

6-57
6
6
6-58
3. Communication Test 3. Press [Software Management Settings] button.
This section describes how to check if the communication is normally done to the distribution
server and/or the file server.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

F-6-92

F-6-91

6-58
6
6
6-59
4. Press [Test Communication] button. 6. Upon the communication test completed, the communication test result screen is shown.
Press [OK] button to exit this operation.

F-6-95
F-6-93
5. Press [Yes] button.

F-6-94
Obtain the download file information for communication test from the distribution server
(to execute the communication test to the distribution server).
Using the download file information for communication test, the contents for test are
downloaded from the file server (for the communication test to the file server).

6-59
6
6
6-60
●● Enabling UGW Link
When installing the firmware in the method of “UGW-linked Download and Update” or “UGW-
linked Download”, the following should be set before actually using UGW link.
Setting of Device
COPIER >OPTION >FNC-SW >CDS-UGW
Service Mode
(0 -> 1)
Service Technician (Level 1)
Setting of UGW In [Customer Management] screen, set [Do not
WebPortal distribute firmware] to [Distribute firmware].
See "Analysis>Firmware Distribution
Setting of Authorities on
Sales Company's HQ Information" to grant the appropriate authorities
UGW WebPortal
to each account.

NOTE:
• See “imageWARE Remote Operator’s Manual / e-Maintenance Business Operation
Manual“ for how to operate UGW WebPortal.
• [Distribute Firmware] should be set on [Customer Management] screen for staff in charge
of setting for [Enter customer information] or [Command for firmware distribution] in order
to allow them to select the desired device on [Firmware Distribution Information] screen.

6-60
6
6
6-61
■■a. UGW-linked Download and Update (Full-remote Update) ■■b. UGW-linked Download (Remote Distribution Update)
See the figure below for the operational flow of “UGW-linked Download and Update”. See the figure below for the operational flow of “UGW-linked download”.

STEP 1 STEP 1 STEP 2


Scheduling Scheduling Update using
via UGW via UGW Updater

F-6-96 F-6-97
STEP1: Scheduling via UGW STEP 1: Scheduling via UGW
The firmware distribution schedule to the certain device should be set on UGW. The firmware distribution schedule to the certain device should be set on UGW.
See “UGW-linked Download and Update” in chapter 5 of Operation Manual of Content See “UGW-linked Download” in Operation Manual of CDS V1.0 (for Firmware Distribution) for
Delivery System V1.0 for Firmware Distribution for details. details.

The device checks the schedule concerned every 12 hours on UGW. This allows the device
to register the firmware distribution setting, enabling automatic firmware download and NOTE:
The firmware downloaded by scheduling via UGW can be checked/deleted from User
update.
mode, but cannot be updated. If a user download the other firmware, the firmware
downloaded with "UGW-linked Download" is overwritten.
CAUTION:
[Devices without Wait for EOJ (end of job) Function]
STEP 2: Update using Updater
• Firmware update will delete print jobs in the queue. Ensure to notify users of this
before you start updating. It is recommended to perform firmware update during non- The firmware downloaded on the device can be updated using Updater functions.
business hours.
1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.
[Devices with Wait for EOJ Function]
1). Press [Setting/Registration (User mode)] button on the control panel.
• Firmware update will not be triggered when any of the following jobs remains in the
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
queue.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User mode)] button on the control panel.
-Print 4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.
-Scan
-Fax (except I-FAX; this function is enabled for I-FAX only during Print/Scan operation)

See Chapter 1 “Limitations and Cautions“ of this manual for more detailed information.

NOTE:
To contacts registered for E-mail notification on UGW, the E-mail is sent from UGW
upon completing firmware update.

6-61
6
6
6-62
2. Press [Updater] button. 4. Press [Apply Firmware] button.

F-6-98 F-6-100
3. Press [Update Firmware] button.

F-6-99

6-62
6
6
6-63
5. Confirm the downloaded firmware and press [Yes] button.
CAUTION:
[Devices without Wait for EOJ (end of job) Function]
• Firmware update will delete print jobs in the queue. Ensure to notify users of this
before you start updating. It is recommended to perform firmware update during non-
business hours.
[Devices with Wait for EOJ Function]
• Firmware update will not be triggered when any of the following jobs remains in the
queue.

-Print
-Scan
-Fax (except I-FAX; this function is enabled for I-FAX only during Print/Scan operation)

See Chapter 1 “Limitations and Cautions“ of this manual for more detailed information.

F-6-101
6. The firmware is applied to the device. The device is automatically restarted when the
NOTE:
firmware is successfully applied. To contacts registered for E-mail notification on UGW, the E-mail is sent from UGW
upon completing firmware update.
7. When the device is restarted, confirm the version of the firmware.
1). Press [Check Counter Key] button on the control panel.
2). Press [Check Device Configuration] button.
3). Confirm if the updated firmware version corresponds to [Controller Version].

Now the firmware is successfully updated in the method of “Manual Download and Update”.

6-63
6
6
6-64
■■c. Manual Download and Update (On-site Update from Service 3. Press [Update Firmware] button.

Mode)
The figure below shows the operational flow of “Manual Download and Update”.

STEP 1 STEP 2
Download using Update using
Updater Updater

F-6-102
STEP 1: Download using Updater
The firmware can be downloaded from CDS to the device using Updater.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User mode)] button on the control panel. F-6-104

2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel. 4. Confirm the firmware to be updated in either of the following 2 ways.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User mode)] on the control panel. • To update to the official edition, press [Confirm Applicable Firmware] button and go to Step 6.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown. • To update to the individual response edition, press [Special Firmware] and go to Step 5.

2. Press [Updater] button.

F-6-105

F-6-103

6-64
6
6
6-65
5. [Special Firmware] screen is shown as below. Enter the fields and press [OK] button. 6. [New Firmware] screen is shown as below. Check the contents and press [Next] button.

F-6-106
• [Retrieval ID]: F-6-107
• [Version]:
Enter numeric up to 8 characters.
The current firmware version is shown.
• [Password]:
• [Applicable Firmware]:
Enter numeric up to 8 characters.
Select the firmware applicable to the device from the dropdown list.
• [Additional Languages]:
More than 1 language can be selected, and it is possible to add another language when
upgrading the firmware.
Up to 8 languages can be added, including Japanese and English. The languages already
registered in the device are always selected, and SST is used to delete an unnecessary
language from the device.
• [Release Note]:
If any release note is published, the contents are shown here.

NOTE:
To update to the individual response edition, the firmware corresponding to the ID and
password that you input is displayed.in [Applicable Firmware]..

6-65
6
6
6-66
7. [Delivery Settings] screen is shown as below. Enter the fields and press [OK] button. [E-mail]:
E-mails concerning update statuses are sent from the device to the contact registered here.
Enter the E-mail address of the service technician in charge.
Enter 1-byte alphanumeric or symbols up to 64 characters.
• [Comments]:
Enter the comment in 1-byte alphanumeric or symbols up to 128 characters.
Enter the comment to be automatically included in E-mail. Model Name in the comment will
be helpful to identify the device relevant to the E-mail.

NOTE:
[Timing to Apply]
• For firmware versions with no remote update permission, [Auto] cannot be selected in
[Timing to Apply]

[Updated Module Only]


• For firmware versions with difference-only delivery disabled, only [OFF] can be
F-6-108 selected in [Updated Module Only].
• [Delivery Time]:
Press either [Now] or [Set Time] button. [E-mail]
• [Now]: • To send E-mails to multiple destinations, each E-mail address should be delimited with
The firmware is downloaded immediately after distribution schedule is set. comma (,) or semi-colon (;).
• [Set Time]: • For E-mail addresses entered in this field, a notification E-mail is sent at the following
Be sure to specify the date (within 30 days) and time. The firmware is downloaded on timing.
the specified date and time. -Distribution Set
-Distribution Started
Enter the date and time using the numeric keypad in the format of “yyyy/mm/dd -Distribution Finished
hh:mm:ss” -Update Started
-Update Finished
• [Timing to Apply]: -Error Occurred
Press either [Auto] or [Manual] button.
• [Auto]:
The firmware is applied automatically upon firmware downloaded.
• [Manual]:
The firmware is automatically downloaded. Go to [Apply Firmware] to set up for
updating the downloaded firmware.
• [Updated Module Only]:
Press either [On] or [Off] button.
• [On]:
Only difference between the current and new firmware is downloaded.
• [Off]:
The firmware to be applied is wholly downloaded.

6-66
6
6
6-67
8. Confirm Export Criteria screen is shown as below. Check the contents and press [Accept] • When Distribution Time and Timing to Apply of Distribution Setting are set to [Now] and
button. [Manual], respectively:
Confirm the firmware and press [OK] button. Now STEP 1 is successfully completed.

F-6-109 F-6-111

9. One of the screens below is shown according to the setting. • When Distribution Time is set to [Set Time] in Distribution Setting:
• When Distribution Time and Timing to Apply of Distribution Setting are set to [Now] and Confirm the distribution schedule and press [OK] button. Now STEP 1 is successfully
[Auto], respectively: completed.
Firmware is downloaded and updated automatically to the device. The device is
automatically restarted upon update completed. Now STEP 1 is successfully completed.

F-6-112

F-6-110

6-67
6
6
6-68
STEP 2: Update using Updater 3. Press [Update Firmware] button.
The firmware downloaded to the device can be updated using Updater functions.
When Timing to Apply is set to [Auto] in Distribution Setting in STEP 1, the firmware is
updated automatically. Only when Timing to Apply is set to [Manual], follow the steps below to
update the firmware.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

F-6-114
4. Press [Apply Firmware] button.

F-6-113

F-6-115

6-68
6
6
6-69
5. Confirm the downloaded firmware and press [Yes] button. 7. When the device is restarted, confirm the version of the firmware.
1). Press [Check Counter Key] button on the control panel.
2). Press [Check Device Configuration] button.
3). Confirm if the updated firmware version corresponds to [Controller Version].

Now the firmware is successfully updated in the method of “Manual Download and Update”.

CAUTION:
[Devices without Wait for EOJ (end of job) Function]
• Firmware update will delete print jobs in the queue. Ensure to notify users of this
before you start updating. It is recommended to perform firmware update during non-
business hours.
[Devices with Wait for EOJ Function]
• Firmware update will not be triggered when any of the following jobs remains in the
F-6-116
queue.
6. The firmware is applied to the device. The device is automatically restarted when the
firmware is successfully applied. -Print
-Scan
-Fax (except I-FAX; this function is enabled for I-FAX only during Print/Scan operation)

See Chapter 1 “Limitations and Cautions“ of this manual for more detailed information.

6-69
6
6
6-70
■■Deleting Firmware Distribution Schedule 4. Press [Delete Scheduled Delivery] button.

This section describes how to delete firmware distribution schedule set by Updater.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] button at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

3. Press [Update Firmware] button.

F-6-118
5. Confirm the contents of the distribution schedule and press [Yes] button.

F-6-117

F-6-119
6. Confirm the result of deletion shown on the screen and press [OK] button. Now the
firmware distribution schedule is successfully deleted.

6-70
6
6
6-71
■■Updating Downloaded Firmware (Applying Firmware) 4. Press [Apply Firmware] button.

This section describes how to update the downloaded firmware.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

3. Press [Update Firmware] button.

F-6-121
5. Confirm the downloaded firmware and press [Yes] button.

F-6-120

F-6-122
6. The firmware is applied to the device. The device is automatically restarted when the
firmware is successfully applied.

7. When the device is restarted, confirm the version of the firmware.


1). Press [Check Counter Key] button on the control panel.
2). Press [Check Device Configuration] button.

6-71
6
6
6-72
3). Confirm if the updated firmware version corresponds to [Controller Version]. ■■Deleting Downloaded Firmware
This section describes how to delete the downloaded firmware using Updater.
Now the firmware is successfully updated in the method.

1. Start [Service Mode] at Level 1.


1). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
2). Press [2] and [8] button at a time on the control panel.
3). Press [Setting/Registration (User Mode)] button on the control panel.
4). [Service Mode] screen is shown.

2. Press [Updater] button.

3. Press [Update Firmware] button.

F-6-123

6-72
6
6
6-73
4. Press [Delete Firmware] button.

F-6-124
5. Confirm the downloaded firmware to be deleted and press [Yes] button.

F-6-125
6. Confirm the result of deletion and press [OK] button. Now the downloaded firmware is
successfully deleted.

6-73
6
6
6-74
■■Troubleshooting on Firmware Installation Symptom: Firmware download is aborted during operation using Updater functions.
Cause: The network cable is disconnected or the power went off due to blackout and the like.
No.1
Action: Retry download. Firmware under download is cancelled upon aborted.
Symptom: I can’t find the firmware to be updated using Updater.
Cause: Preparation has not been properly done.
No.3
Action: Confirm the setting of Sales Company’s HQ bellow.
Symptom: Firmware update is aborted during operation using Updater functions and the
Setting of Device [SERVICE MODE] (Level1)
device cannot be started.
COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > CDS-CTL
Cause: The power went off due to blackout and the like.
Action: Service technicians should follow the steps below via SST.
1. Press [2] and [8] buttons at a time to start the device.
1) Turn on the power and hold down [2] and [8] buttons at a time on the control panel.
2) [Download Mode] is shown on Local UI.
If the operation above does not trigger the download mode, BOOT (Flash Memory,
service parts) should be replaced (takes up to 1 minute for rewriting).
If the operation above successfully triggers the download mode, go to the next steps
below.

F-6-126
2. Via SST, format the HDD of BOOT Dev only.
Cause: The version currently in use is not available for update.
Action: Download the release note from CDS separately to upgrade to the version available 3. Via SST, install the firmware in the device.
for update.
No.4
Cause: You try to download firmware from User mode.You can download only the latest Symptom: Firmware has not been downloaded according to the distribution schedule.
version of firmware from User mode. Cause: Other firmware distribution schedule is set.Since only 1 distribution schedule is held,
Action: Download from Service mode. the registered schedule may be overridden by the new firmware distribution schedule.
Action: Once the schedule is overridden, the firmware cannot be downloaded. Distribution
<User Mode> <Service Mode> should be rescheduled for the firmware.

Cause: At the scheduled distribution date and time, the firmware registered was not found on
CDS.
Action: Distribution should be rescheduled for the firmware.

Cause: After distribution is scheduled, device is updated to other version of firmware via SST.
(Status of the firmware in the device is changed.)
Action: Distribution should be rescheduled for the firmware.

F-6-127 Cause: The power of the device was off at scheduled date and time.
F-6-128 Action: Distribution should be rescheduled for the firmware.
No.2

6-74
6
6
6-75
No.5 ■■Information required for Reports
Symptom: The firmware presumed to be downloaded to the device cannot be found.
Cause: Since only 1 firmware can be held on the device, the firmware previously downloaded ●● Information required for Service Technicians to Obtain on Site
was overridden by the newly downloaded one. • Update Logs
Action: Retry the firmware download. • System Logs (Log Level: 4)

●● Information to Report
• Symptom occurred
• Location of the device
• Date and Time that symptom occurred
• Steps taken for reproduction
• Firmware / Application you tried to install
• Occurrence frequency
• Model dependency (if the same symptom occurred in other models)
• Dependency on firmware/MEAP application/system option
• Conditions of symptom occurrence
• Model
• Firmware version installed on the device
• List of MEAP applications installed on the device
• Network setting information of the device
• Service mode setting information
Setting of device service mode COPIER > FUNCTION > INSTALL > CDS-CTL
(Level 1) COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > CDS-UGW
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > CDS-FIRM
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > CDS-MEAP
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > LOCLFIRM

* As many as the items listed above should be obtained on site. More information provided
will be helpful for investigation.

6-75
6
6
6-76
■■Debug Logs NOTE:
• See “Setting Log Level” in chapter 3 for details of changing Log Level
●● Obtaining Log Files
Updater log files can be obtained by copy & paste from remote UI.
This procedure is shown below. 4. If the value of CDS-MEAP or CDS-FIRM was changed in the service mode, return to the
original value and then restart the device to enable this setting.
1. Check that the “CDS-MEAP” or “CDS-FIRM” is enabled in the service mode. If they are not
enabled, change the value to “1” and then restart the device. Obtaining the log files is completed.
Service mode (Level1) > Mode List
• COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > CDS-MEAP: 1
• COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > CDS-FIRM: 1

2. Log in the remote UI (URL: http://<device’s IP address or host name>) using the system
administrator right.

3. From “Display Logs/Communication Test” screen, obtain System Logs (log level 4) and
Update Logs by copy & paste.
Top page (Remote UI) > [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [License/
Others] > [Register/Update Software] > “Display Logs/Communication Test”

F-6-129

6-76
6
6
6-77
■■Error Messages
Error messages displayed in LUI on a device are shown below. As to error codes, see the next list.
No. Messages Timing of display Cause Remedy
1 An error occurred with the delivery In communicating with the System error occurred in server. Obtain the log etc. (Refer to "Version Upgrade via CDS" under “Version Upgrade”of
server. delivery server. Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the sales
Contact your sales representative. company.
Error Code: [xxx]
2 Delivery server is stopped. In communicating with the Delivery server stopped. Check the delivery server stop information. After the delivery server starts, perform the
Wait a while and then try to perform the delivery server. operation from this application.
operation again. When the delivery server stop information is not available, contact the sales company's
Check the following URL for details. Support Department.
<Stopped Delivery Server URL>
3 Failed to connect to delivery server. In communicating with the Communication error due to incorrect settings of Set correct CDS URL in the Updater settings.
Check the delivery server and network. delivery server. CDS URL.
Excluding delivery server stop, communication error Check if the network environment is correct to solve the cause of the error occurrence.
to the delivery server occurred. If the network environment of the device is correct, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version
Upgrade via CDS” under “Version Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this
manual.) and contact Support Div. of the sales company.
4 Download was stopped because an At the time of file Communication error to the delivery server Check if the network environment is correct to solve the cause of the error occurrence.
error occurred with the file server. download occurred. If the network environment of the device is correct, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version
Check the network. Upgrade via CDS” under “Version Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this
manual.) and contact Support Div. of the sales company.
5 Downloaded files are invalid. Check At the time of file The received file is broken. After checking the network environment of the device, re-execute the job.
the network. download If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
6 Failed to retrieve information of special Acquisition of applicable No information exists about firmware for special Enter the correct firmware ID or Password applicable to the firmware information.
firmware. firmware information firmware retrieval ID or Password is invalid. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Check the retrieval ID and password. Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
7 Scheduled delivery information of Acquisition of applicable Delivery information with specified delivery ID does Register the delivery schedule again. If this occurs at the time of canceling file download,
firmware does not exist. firmware information not exist. deleting downloaded firmware or deleting scheduled delivery, no remedy is required.
Check it because it may already have
been deleted.
8 Failed to apply firmware. Firmware application error Error due to the application (NLM) Obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version Upgrade”of
Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the sales
company.

6-77
6
6
6-78
No. Messages Timing of display Cause Remedy
9 Delivery Server : Connect Failed Communication test, etc. In the communication test, failed to connect to the Check the network environment of the device, and re-execute the job.
File Server : Retrieve Failed (communication test result delivery server. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Error Code: [xxxx] dialogue) In SOAP communication, failed to success after 1 Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
min retry. sales company.
ID and Password required for proxy to connect to Set proxy and restart the communication test.
the internet are not configured in device. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
The access to the network is limited. Set the user environment to make the access to the following domain available.
https://device.cdsknn.net/
http://cdsknn.net.edgesuite.net/
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Delivery server stopped. Contact Field Support Group in the sale company.
After confirmation that the delivery server has been restored, restart the communication
test.
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company again.
10 Delivery Server : Connect OK Delivery Server : Connect Due to no return of data for the communication test, Check the network environment of the device and re-execute the job.
File Server : Retrieve Failed OK time-out (in HTTP communication, no response If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Error Code: [xxxx] File Server : Retrieve for 1min) occurred. After that, retried but failed to Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
Failed connect to server. sales company.
Error Code: [XXXX] The network cable was disconnected during data Reconnect the network cable and then restart the communication test.
download in the communication test. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
The file server stopped during data download in the Contact the sales company's Support Department.
communication test. After confirmation that the delivery server has been restored, restart the communication
test.
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company again.
Hash value in the communication test file is Check the network environment and re-execute the job.
incorrect. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.

6-78
6
6
6-79
No. Messages Timing of display Cause Remedy
11 An error occurred. communication test, etc. The max value (space/file) was exceeded and new Check if the log file exceeded the max value.
Error Code: [xxx] (main screen) log was not accepted. <Update log>
Normally an old log file is deleted before the max Max space: 128KB/file
value (space/file) is exceeded, but error may occur Max file number: 4
due to other element (e.g. I/O error).
<System log>
Max space: 512KB/file
Max file number: 4

If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Notice of version Failed to acquire version information of device Re-execute the job.
information (main screen) due to no CDS registration of firmware version of If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
device. Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
At the time of notifying version information, failed to Check if the network environment is correct to solve the cause of the error occurrence.
connect to the delivery server. If the network environment of the device is correct, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version
No return of notifying version information Upgrade via CDS” under “Version Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this
manual.) and contact Support Div. of the sales company.
Network cable was disconnected during notice of Re-connect the network cable and re-execute the job.
version information. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Failed to send notice of version information since Re-execute the job.
the main power was turned OFF and then ON If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
during the sending. Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Server stopped at the time of sending notice of Check the network environment of the device and re-execute the job.
version information. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
An internal error occurred at the time of sending Obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version Upgrade”of
notice of version information. Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the sales
company.

6-79
6
6
6-80
No. Messages Timing of display Cause Remedy
11 An error occurred. UGW linkage (main UGW linkage was turned ON when eRDS was OFF.For a device using eRDS, turn ON the eRDS. For a device not using eRDS, turn OFF the
Error Code: [xxx] screen) UGW linkage.
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
An internal error occurred at the time of acquiring Re-execute the job.
delivery information. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
On-site (error dialogue) An internal error occurred at the time of acquiring Re-execute the job.
applicable firmware information. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
An internal error occurred at the time of sending Re-execute the job.
approval information. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
An internal error occurred at the time of delivery Re-execute the job.
order If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Immediate download An internal error occurred at the time of requesting Re-execute the job.
(error dialogue) firmware delivery information. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
During the download, all space in the storage disk After adding vacant space of the storage disk, re-execute the job.
was occupied. (DiskFull) If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
At the end of receipt, an internal error occurred. Re-execute the job.
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Manual update (error At the update start, an internal error occurred. Re-execute the job.
dialogue) If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company
Automatic update (error At the update start, an internal error occurred. Re-execute the job.
dialogue) If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Deletion of downloaded At the time of notifying cancellation, an internal Re-execute the job.
firmware error occurred. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.

6-80
6
6
6-81
No. Messages Timing of display Cause Remedy
12 An error occurred. Check the Update UGW linkage (main eRDS sent an order but Updater failed to connect Conduct a communication test to analyze the cause of the error. After solving the cause,
Firmware screen. screen) to server. resend the order from the eRDS.
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Delivery server stopped. Contact the sales company's Support Department.
After confirming restoration of the delivery server, re-execute the job.
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Scheduled date and time acquired from the delivery Do the delivery setting from UGW again.
server was before current time (15 or more min had If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
passed.) Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Scheduled data and time acquired from the delivery Do the delivery setting from UGW again.
server did not exist. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Immediate download At the time of immediate download, turned OFF and Re-execute the job.
(main screen) then ON the power of device main body. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Manual update (main Updated version was different from the ordered Re-execute the job.
screen) version. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Automatic update (main Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
screen) sales company.
After the update, failed to connect to the delivery Check the network environment and re-execute the job.
server. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
After the update, delivery server stopped. Contact the sales company's Support Department. After confirming restoration of the
delivery server, re-execute the job.
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
After the update, the network cable was Re-connect the network cable and re-execute the job.
disconnected. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
After the update, server returned an error. Obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version Upgrade”of
Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the sales
company.
After the update, an internal error occurred. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.

6-81
6
6
6-82
No. Messages Timing of display Cause Remedy
13 Delivery Error UGW linkage (Update eRDS sent an order but Updater failed to connect Conduct a communication test to analyze the cause of the error. After solving the cause,
Error Code: [xxx] Firmware screen) to the server. resend the order from the eRDS.
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
The delivery server stopped. Contact the sales company's Support Department. After confirming restoration of the
delivery server, re-execute the job.
If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
The scheduled data and time acquired from delivery Do the delivery setting from UGW again.
server does not exist. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
14 Delivery Error UGW linkage (Update The scheduled date and time acquired from delivery Do the delivery setting from UGW again.
Delivery Time Firmware screen) server was before current time (15 or more min had If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Delivery Firmware Label passed). Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
Delivery Firmware version sales company.
Error Code: [ xxx ] Immediate download At the time of immediate download, turned OFF and Re-execute the job.
(Update Firmware screen) then ON the power of device main body. If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
15 Applicable firmware is not registered. On-site (error dialogue) At the user site, no latest firmware exists. This means the current firmware is the latest, so this error has no impact.
But when the latest firmware to be retrieved must exist e.g. released new firmware
information has been notified, contact Field Support Group in the sales company.
No applicable firmware exists on CDS, so the Contact the sales company's Support Department.
service person can't select any applicable firmware.
16 Restart failed. Manual update (error An error occurred at the time of the device restart. After turning OFF and then ON the main power of the device, re-execute the job.
Turn the main power OFF and ON. dialogue) If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
Automatic update (error An error occurred at the time of the device restart. After turning OFF and then ON the main power of the device, re-execute the job.
dialogue) If it recurs, obtain the log etc. (Refer to “Version Upgrade via CDS” under “Version
Upgrade”of Chapter 6 “Troubleshooting” of this manual.) and contact Support Div. of the
sales company.
17 Specify [E-Mail Address] with up to 64 At the time of periodical The specified E-mail address exceeded 64 Specify E-mail address within 64 characters.
characters. update setting characters.
18 The following characters cannot be At the time of periodical The E-mail address was including the characters Do not specify E-mail address with characters which cannot be used.
used for the [E-Mail Address]: update setting which could not be used.
,:;“()[]<>\
19 Specify [Comments] with up to 128 At the time of periodical Comments exceeded 128 characters. Specify comments within 128 characters.
characters. update setting
20 The [Delivery Server URL] is incorrect. In setting with the deliver The specified deliver server URL is wrong. Enter the right URL(https://device.c-cdsknn.net/cds_soap/updaterif)
server URL.
T-6-17

6-82
6
6
6-83
■■Error Codes
Error Codes displayed on LUI in a device and how to read them.

●● How to read an error code

8 4014206 Code Value Contents

The first digit 8 Error


Error field
The second digit 0 Not defined.
Operator 1 CDS server
2 Updater
3 UGW
4 Service person
5 IT administrator (User)
The 3rd - 4th digits xx Method
Method category
The 5th digit 0 Category code
Category code 1
2
3
4
5
6
7
The 6 - 8th digits 000- See Error code list
Description code

●● Error Code
The error code list is shown below. Remedy are error codes of "-", and for all the error codes out of the list, contact Field Suppot Group in the sales company.
Error Code (hex number) Description Remedy Cause of error
The first The second The 3rd - 4th The 5th digit The 6 - 8th digits CDS UP CDS file Network
digit Error digit digits Method Category Description delivery DATER server
field Operator category code code server
8 Error
0 Not defined.
1 CDS server
x x Relating method code
0 Not categorized
0 0 1 No value is set in a mandatory data entry item - - - -
0 0 2 In a string type of a data entry item, digit number and/or - - - -
character type is/are set against the regulations

6-83
6
6
6-84
Error Code (hex number) Description Remedy Cause of error
The first The second The 3rd - 4th The 5th digit The 6 - 8th digits CDS UP CDS file Network
digit Error digit digits Method Category Description delivery DATER server
field Operator category code code server
0 0 3 In an data entry item, the value is set against the regulations - - - -
(E.g. the set value is other than "Operator: 4. Service person,
5. User")
0 0 4 No applicable delivery information exists - - - -
1 Operation
0 0 1 Inconsistency between the current firmware component - - -
in the data entry item and delivery information (E.g. the
conditions for automatic update are not met. The settings of
a mandatory additional set are invalid)
0 0 2 In a notice of delivery-allowed information, an install-set was - - - -
release to the market, but the market release was stopped
during the delivery
0 0 3 No mail template file exists - - - -
0 0 4 The device serial number in the data entry item differs from - - - -
that in delivery information
0 0 5 User is selected as Operator in the data entry items and the - - - -
retrieval type is other than the latest
0 0 6 The retrieval type in the data entry item is special and - - - -
registration ID and individual Password are not set (*
Operator did not enter registration ID and individual
Password)
0 0 7 The retrieval type in the data entry item is special and - - - -
Operator is not Service person
0 0 8 As to the device serial number in the data entry items, there - - - -
is no applicable device code product
0 0 9 The retrieval type in the data entry items is special and - - - -
there are no basic-set applicable to the registration ID and
Password (* When wrong registration ID or Password was
entered by an operator)
0 0 A The delivery status is Applying - - - -
0 0 B No approval information exists about EULA or the export - - - -
criteria when the delivery is determined
0 0 C The delivery status is Distributing/Distributed/Applying/ - - - -
Finished/Failed
0 0 D The delivery status is Distributing/Distributed/Applying/ - - - -
Finished/Failed
0 0 E The delivery status is New/Waiting to Distribute/Distributed/ - - - -
Applying/Finished/Failed
0 0 F The delivery code is other than Distributing. - - - -
(Firmware delivery)
0 0 0 The delivery status is New/Waiting to Distribute/Distributing/ - - - -
Applying/Finished/Failed
0 0 1 The delivery status is Distributing/Distributed/Applying/ - - - -
Finished/Failed
0 0 2 Device is "Not applicable to CDS" - - - -
(Firmware delivery)
2 I/O
0 0 1 The specified license access number does not exist in LMS - - - -

6-84
6
6
6-85
Error Code (hex number) Description Remedy Cause of error
The first The second The 3rd - 4th The 5th digit The 6 - 8th digits CDS UP CDS file Network
digit Error digit digits Method Category Description delivery DATER server
field Operator category code code server
0 0 2 The specified license access number has been deauthorized - - - -
0 0 3 The package product of the entered license access number - - - -
doesn't include MEAP application/System Option
0 0 4 The sales company for the MEAP application isn't identical - - - -
with the sale company for the package product
0 0 5 The number of licenses to be issued will exceed the limit - - - -
number allowed to register
0 0 6 As for System Option for the same function, the license keys - - - -
were issued more than the defined number of times for the
same device serial number
0 0 7 No device product exists applicable to the optional product - - - -
0 0 8 No product exists applicable to the device serial number - - - -
0 0 9 The product of the entered license access number cannot - - - -
be used with this device because the settings of the sales
company are incorrect
0 0 A No product linked to the license access number is registered - - - -
in CDS for delivery
0 0 B Although the product linked to the license access number is - - - -
registered in CDS for delivery, the delivery is stopped now
0 0 C No existence of optional product applicable to the device - - - -
serial number.
0 0 D The license access number has been registered for another - - - -
device
0 0 E For the device product applicable to the device serial - - - -
number, no available software (MEAP application, System
Option) exists
0 1 0 LMS system error - - - -
2~5
x x Relating method code
0 Not cartelized
0 0 0 Not defined Normally not indicated
1 0 0 Unknown error Normally not indicated
1 Operation
0 0 1 Processing exclusively Start the operation again after - - -
terminating other Updater operations
being executed simultaneously
1 0 1 Failed to process preparation for use - - - -
1 0 2 Failed to process use end - - - -
1 0 3 Time out during restart of readiness preparation - - - -
1 0 4 Session time-out excluding after application inquiry (after Start the operation again from the - -
issuing delivery ID) beginning
1 0 5 CDS URL is not set Set CDS URL - - -
1 0 6 There is another job Start the operation again after - - -
terminating the job of the device
2 I/O
1 x x An internal error about file operation - - - -
2 x x An internal error about xML file operation - - - -
3 0 1 Failed to output the license file - - - -
3 Device

6-85
6
6
6-86
Error Code (hex number) Description Remedy Cause of error
The first The second The 3rd - 4th The 5th digit The 6 - 8th digits CDS UP CDS file Network
digit Error digit digits Method Category Description delivery DATER server
field Operator category code code server
1 x x An internal error in CPCA - - - -
2 x x An internal error in IMI - - - -
3 x x An internal error in SMS - - - -
4 x x An internal error in NLM - - - -
4 SOAP communication
1 0 1 The processing thread stopped - - - -
1 0 2 Processing SOAP communication now - - - -
1 0 3 The function type is not matched - - - -
1 0 4 An invalid SOAP response error - - - -
2 0 1 An internal error about application information - - - -
2 0 2 config.xml is NOT FOUND - - - -
2 0 3 type.xml is NOT FOUND - - - -
2 0 4 An error in binding type.xml - - - -
2 0 5 An error in creating a service tab - - - -
2 0 6 A runtime error in performing the web method - - -
2 0 7 An unknown host error in performing the web method • Check the network environment of the -
device and start the operation again
• Check if the URL settings of the
CDS server are correct, and start the
operation again after resetting
3 0 1 The delivery server is stopped - - - -
3 0 2 An error occurrence in the delivery server - - -
5 HTTP communication
1 0 1 Specified Hash Algorithm is unknown - - - -
2 0 1 Invalid HTTP request - -
2 0 2 Failed to connect to the server Check the network environment of the -
device and start the operation again
2 0 3 Failed to find the server Check the network environment of the -
device and start the operation again
2 0 4 An input/output error occurred during the connecting process - -
to the server
2 0 5 Failed to read a HTTP response - -
2 0 6 Error in a HTTP response - -
3 0 1 Failed to retrieve the data stream - - -
3 0 2 Failed to create the file object for receipt - - -
3 0 3 Failed to create the data stream of the file for receipt - - -
3 0 4 Failed to receive the data Check the network environment of the -
device and start the operation again
3 0 5 An error about reserving the file data for receipt - - - -
3 0 6 Failed to close the data stream - - - -
3 0 7 Failed to close the file data for receipt - - - -
3 0 8 Invalid hash code of the download file Check the network environment of the
device and start the operation again
3 0 9 The prosy authorization method is not applicable Check the proxy authentication method - -
used, and start the operation again
after changing the settings to use the
corresponding proxy anthentication
6 Socket communication
1 0 1 Failed to connect the eRDS - - -
1 0 2 No response from eRDS - - -

6-86
6
6
6-87
Error Code (hex number) Description Remedy Cause of error
The first The second The 3rd - 4th The 5th digit The 6 - 8th digits CDS UP CDS file Network
digit Error digit digits Method Category Description delivery DATER server
field Operator category code code server
1 0 3 No notice of start from the eRDS - - -
1 0 4 Error of socket reading - - -
1 0 5 Socket communication time-out - - -
7 Other internal codes
0 0 2 One of installation, start or authorization failed - - - -
(When installation or authorization failed, it is regarded as an
error) *
0 3 x An internal error in processing the installation - - - -
1 x x An error by using invalid API - - - -
2 x x An internal error in SMS - - - -
3 0 1 No existence of delivery ID - - - -
3 0 2 Invalid delivery ID - - - -
3 0 3 The updated firmware information is not identical with the - - - -
firmware information after activation of the Updater
3 0 4 The process of firmware download is incomplete - - - -
3 0 5 The update process is incomplete - - - -
3 0 6 The installment process is incomplete - - - -
4 0 1 Failed to retrieve delivery information - - - -
5 0 1 Failed to execute the delivery process - - - -
5 0 2 The scheduled delivery was not executed within the defined Scheduled deliveries not executed - - -
period of time within the defined period of time are
abandoned, so register a scheduled
delivery again.
When setting the date and time of the
scheduled delivery, be sure to designate
a time when the device is ON
T-6-18

* Not displayed on a device UI

6-87
6
6
6-88
Controller Self Diagnosis ■■Overview
Two types of error diagnosis tools are installed in this machine, and stored in the locations
■■Introduction
shown below.
Operation of the (2 types of) error diagnosis tools added to the main body and remedy for
errors are described. These tools can reduce time to determine cause of errors occurred in
field and improve the accuracy of specifying error locations.
This manual can be applied when the main body is placed in the following conditions.
• The main body does not boot. (In such a case that the Control Panel is not displayed or the
progress bar does not work, etc.)
• An error is suspected to have occurred in the Main Controller PCB 1/2 and other related
PCBs (child PCBs such as SDRAM or TPM mounted in the Main Controller PCB 1/2).

PCBs and units diagnosed by each tool are as follow:

●● Boot System Error Diagnosis Tool


• Main Controller PCB 1 side <Main Controller PCB 1, SDRAM, PCI Expansion PCB (option)>
• Control Panel
• All-night Power Supply, Non-all-night Power Supply
●● Controller System Error Diagnosis Tool
• Main Controller PCB 1 side <Main Controller PCB 1, SDRAM, TPM PCB, FLASH Memory F-6-130
PCB, PCI Expansion PCB (option)> Boot System Error Diagnosis Tool covers the components shown in the red frame (solid line)
• Main Controller PCB 2 side <Main Controller PCB 2, SDRAM (M0*, M1), SDRAM (P), in the figure. Controller System Error Diagnosis Tool covers the components shown in the
Memory PCB, Open I/F PCB (option)> blue frame (dotted line).
• Rizer PCB / HDD
●● Boot System Error Diagnosis Tool
* SDRAM (M0) is an option.
This tool automatically checks the Control Panel, Main Controller PCB 1, All-night Power
Supply, and Non-all-night Power Supply, and notifies the result by the number of light-out and
blinking interval of the lamp on the Control Panel.
This tool is installed in the ROM of Main Controller PCB 1.
Therefore, regardless the version of MN-CNT, this tool can be used even when an error
occurs in child PCBs or when the Controller System Error Diagnosis Tool cannot be booted.

6-88
6
6
6-89
●● Controller System Error Diagnosis Tool Main Controller PCB 1
This tool automatically checks the Main Controller PCB 1/2, child PCBs mounted on the Main
J2032
Controller PCB 1/2, and HDD, and display the result on the Control Panel. BAT1
This tool is installed in HDD. J2031
Therefore, this tool cannot be used when an error occurred in HDD or HDD cannot be
accessed.
DDR2-SDRAM
512 MB + 512 MB
■■Layout Drawing
Layout Drawing of PCBs Subject to Diagnosis

F-6-132

F-6-131

6-89
6
6
6-90
Main Controller PCB 2 ■■Basic Flowchart
Basic Check Items
Check all of the items shown below.

Turn O N the m ain power s witc h.

DDR2-SDRAM (M0)
512 MB
J13

J11 Does the Pow er Supply LED


No
DDR2-SDRAM (M1) Ex ec ute bas ic c hec k.
on the Control Panel light up?
1 GB

Yes

J12 BAT1
No
Is the Control Panel dis play ed? Ex ec ute Boot Sy s tem Error
Diagnos is Tool.
DDR2-SDRAM (P)
512 MB
F-6-133 Yes

No Ex ec ute Controller Sy s tem Error


Does the main body boot c orrec tly ?
Diagnos is Tool.

Yes

Take an ac tion appropriate f or


the error.

F-6-134

6-90
6
6
6-91
●● Basic Check Items ■■Operation
1. Check if the Leakage Breaker is turned OFF.
Operations of the two diagnosis tools are explained below.
2. Check if the Power Supply Plug is disconnected.
Use each tool according to the following purposes.
3. Check if the Connection Cable between the Main Controller PCB 1 and Control Panel is
• When the main body does not boot (the Control Panel is not displayed): Execute Boot
disconnected.
System Error Diagnosis.
4. Check if the Connection Main Controller PCB 1 and Main Controller PCB 2 definitely?
• When an error is suspected to have occurred in the Main Controller PCB 1/2 or child PCBs
5. Check if the Connection An All-night Power Supply. Change Non-all-night Power Supply if
mounted on the Main Controller PCB 1/2: Execute Controller System Error Diagnosis.
not recovered.

■■Boot System Error Diagnosis


■■Prerequisite
●● Boot Method
Make sure that the version of MN-Cont of the main body is Ver.30.30 or later.
1) Turn ON the Main Power Supply Switch while pressing the Control Panel Power Supply
When the version is old (older than Ver.30.30), although Controller System Error Diagnosis
Switch.
Tool (BCT) (see Memo) is downloaded, it cannot be installed and is discarded.
Therefore, if the version of MN-Cont of the main body is old (older than Ver.30.30), update the
version to Ver.30.30 or later using SST (Service Support Tool) or USB memory, and enter the
SST download mode again to install BCT.

Caution:
When upgrading of system software, HDD format, or BootDev format is performed, BCT
is simultaneously installed with other system software if the MN-Cont version is new
(Ver.30.30 or later).
In other words, when the MN-Cont version is new (Ver.30.30 or later), it is not necessary
to install BCT again.

However, installation of BCT via CDS is not supported by the current version. (It will be
supported in the future.)

NOTE: F-6-135

BCT stands for Box Checker Test.


When BCT is installed on the main body, version of the installed module can be
checked using service mode (COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION>BCT).

6-91
6
6
6-92
2) Right after the Main Power Supply Lamp lights up once, it lights out instantly, and diagnosis <When an error is detected by diagnosis>
starts. The Main Power Supply Lamp repeats high-speed blinking after completion of a check in
(When the Main Power Supply Lamp lights out, you can release your finger from the Control which an error is detected. (See *1.)
Panel Switch.) For example, when an error is detected in Check 2, the Main Power Supply Lamp lights out
twice and repeats high-speed blinking (ON/OFF in 0.3 seconds interval).
When an error is detected, be sure to count the number of times the Main Power Supply
Lamp lights out.
For detailed results, see “Error Diagnosis”.

F-6-136

●● Diagnosis Time
Diagnosis is completed in approx. 1 minuites. F-6-138
*1: When an error is detected, there is a possibility that the Main Power Supply Lamp may
<When the diagnosis result is normal> not perform high-speed blinking but perform other operation (continuous light-up, light-out). In
After the Main Power Supply Lamp repeatedly lights out 5 times, it lights up and the diagnosis this case, remove and then install the 2 SDRAMs on the Main Controller PCB 1.
is completed. If the error is not resolved, execute the remedy of the Check No. which is not completed
After completion of the diagnosis, this machine executes normal boot sequence. normally. (For details, see “Error Diagnosis”.)
*2: Although diagnosis time for Check 3, and Check 4 is longer than that of other Checks, it is
correct operation.
*3: When the 2 SDRAMs are not mounted on the Main Controller PCB 1, this diagnosis is not
completed. In this case, install the appropriate 2 SDRAMs.

F-6-137

6-92
6
6
6-93
●● Error Diagnosis ■■Controller System Error Diagnosis
<Boot System Error Diagnosis Table>
●● Boot Method
The error locations are identified according to the following table.
1) Turn ON the Main Power Supply Switch while pressing the numeric keys ‘2’ and ‘4’
simultaneously.

F-6-140

Board

Board

F-6-141

F-6-139
This tool does not perform a boot check for the Flash Memory PCB.

6-93
6
6
6-94
2) Keep pressing the numeric keys (for approx. 20 seconds) until the following screen ●● Diagnosis Time
appears on the Control Panel. Diagnosis is completed in approx. 3 minutes.
The result is displayed on the Control Panel.

<When the diagnosis result is normal>

F-6-142

NOTE: F-6-144

When this tool is not installed correctly, the following regular screen is displayed. <When an error is detected by diagnosis>
In this case, perform the following remedy. Detailed information is displayed under the judgment result. In detailed information, the name
Turn OFF the Main Power Supply Switch again, and execute step 1 and 2 shown
of the test where an error was detected is indicated.
above.
If this tool still does not boot, it means that BCT is deleted. So, install BCT.
If BCT is not installed correctly, “--.--” is displayed in Service
Mode (COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION>BCT) in the main body.

F-6-145

F-6-143

6-94
6
6
6-95
<How to view the error result> Test Name Description Assumed Error Remedy Error Code
The following screen is an enlarged view of the detailed information indicated above. Location
Explanation of the detailed error information is described. SN-4 SM Check an SM Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller -
BUS IA Clock bus error in PCB 1 PCB 1.
Gen Clock Generator
on the Main
Controller PCB
1
SN-5 SM Check an SM Main Controller 1. Check the connection of the -
BUS SOC bus error in the PCB 1 Main Controller PCB 1, and the
F-6-146 DIMM1 Main Controller PCI Expansion Main Controller PCB 2.
[no] means that optional PCBs are not mounted. PCB 1 and PCB 2. Check the installation of SDRAM
SDRAM (M1) Main Controller (M1) on the Main Controller PCB 2.
When [no] is displayed although an optional PCB is mounted, it means that an error has been on the Main PCB 2 3. Replace SDRAM (M1) on the
occurring. Controller PCB SDRAM (M1) on Main Controller PCB 2.
[NG] means that an error occurred to PCBs mounted as standard. 2 Main Controller 4. Replace the Main Controller
PCB 2 PCB 2.
5. Replace the Main Controller
NOTE: PCB 1.
Once the tool is activated, this machine reboots after approx. 2 minutes. SN-6 SM Check an SM Main Controller 1. Check the connection of the -
After completion of the diagnosis, be sure to turn OFF and then ON the main power. BUS SOC bus error in the PCB 1 Main Controller PCB 1, and the
By turning the power OFF, the operation of this tool completes. DIMM2 Main Controller PCI Expansion Main Controller PCB 2.
PCB 1 and PCB 2. Check the installation of SDRAM
SDRAM (M0) Main Controller (M0) on the Main Controller PCB 2.
on the Main PCB 2 3. Replace SDRAM (M0) on the
<Controller System Error Diagnosis Table> Controller PCB SDRAM (M0) on Main Controller PCB 2.
The error locations are identified according to the following table. 2 Main Controller 4. Replace the Main Controller
PCB 2 PCB 2.
Test Name Description Assumed Error Remedy Error Code 5. Replace the Main Controller
Location PCB 1.
SN-1 IA- Check an error Main Controller 1. Check the installation of SDRAM -
SDRAM between the PCB 1 on the Main Controller PCB. Supplementary Information:
Main Controller SDRAM on Main 2. Replace SDRAM on the Main If SDRAM (M0) on the Main
PCB 1 and Controller PCB 1 Controller PCB 1. Controller PCB 2 is not installed,
SDRAM on the 3. Replace the Main Controller [no] is displayed for the diagnosis
Main Controller PCB 1. result.
PCB 1 SN-7 PCI Check a PCI Main Controller 1. Check the connection of the -
SN-2 SM Check an Main Controller 1. Check the installation of SDRAM - Config bus error in thePCB 1 Main Controller PCB 1, and the
BUS IA SM bus error PCB 1 on the Main Controller PCB. Maestro Main Controller PCI Expansion Main Controller PCB 2.
DIMM1 in SDRAM SDRAM (outside) 2. Replace SDRAM (outside) of PCB 1 and the PCB 2. Replace the Main Controller
(outside) on the on Main Controller the Main Controller PCB 1. Main Controller Main Controller PCB 1.
Main Controller PCB 1 3. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2 PCB 2 3. Replace the Main Controller
PCB 1 PCB 1. SDRAM (M0/M1) PCB 2.
SN-3 SM Check an SM Main Controller 1. Check the installation of SDRAM - on Main Controller
BUS IA bus error in PCB 1 on the Main Controller PCB 1. PCB 2
DIMM2 SDRAM (inside) SDRAM (inside) 2. Replace SDRAM (inside) of the SN-8 PCI Check a LAN Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller -
on the Main on Main Controller Main Controller PCB 1. Config LANC chip error on the PCB 1 PCB 1.
Controller PCB PCB 1 3. Replace the Main Controller Main Controller
1 PCB 1. PCB 1

6-95
6
6
6-96
Test Name Description Assumed Error Remedy Error Code Test Name Description Assumed Error Remedy Error Code
Location Location
SN-9 PCI Check a PCI Main Controller 1. Check the installation between - SN-15 Check failure Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller -
Config PCI- bus error PCB 1 the Main Controller PCB 1 and PCI FLASH ROM of CPU ROM PCB 2 PCB 2.
Bridge between the PCI Expansion Expansion PCB. (IC60) on the
Main Controller PCB 2. Replace PCI Expansion PCB. Main Controller
PCB 1 and the 3. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2
PCI Expansion PCB 1. SN-16 Check an error Main Controller 1. Check the installation of SDRAM E747
PCB P-SDRAM between the PCB 2 (P) on the Main Controller PCB 2. E748
Supplementary Information: If Main Controller SDRAM (P) 2. Replace SDRAM (P) on the
the PCI Expansion PCB is not PCB 2 and Open I/F PCB Main Controller PCB 2.
installed, [no] is displayed for the SDRAM (P) 3. Replace the Main Controller
diagnosis result. on the Main PCB 2.
SN-10 CPLD Check failure Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller - Controller PCB
of CPLD chip PCB 1 PCB 1. 2
on the Main SN-17 Check failure of Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller E747
Controller PCB R-SDRAM Rchip SDRAM PCB 2 PCB 2. E748
1 on the Main Open I/F PCB
SN-11 LANC Check failure Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller - Controller PCB
SPI of LANC SPI PCB 1 PCB 1. 2
on the Main SN-18 Check failure of Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller E747
Controller PCB S-SDRAM Schip SDRAM PCB 2 PCB 2. E748
1 on the Main E732
SN-12 RTC Check failure Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller - Controller PCB
CHECK of RTC on the PCB 1 PCB 1. 2
Main Controller SN-19 Check failure of Main Controller 1. Check the installation of the E747
PCB 1 O-SDRAM Ochip SDRAM PCB 2 Open I/F PCB. E748
SN-13 TPM Check failure of Main Controller 1. Check the installation of the E746 on the Open I/F Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Open I/F PCB.
the TPM PCB PCB 1 TPM PCB. PCB 3. Replace the Main Controller
on the Main TPM PCB 2. Replace the TPM PCB. PCB 2.
Controller PCB 3. Replace the Main Controller
1 PCB 1. Supplementary Information: If
* TPM PCB is the Open I/F PCB is not installed,
not installed [no] is displayed for the diagnosis
in products result.
for China. So, SN-20 GU Check a Main Controller 1. Check the installation of the E747
the diagnosis BUS GUBUS error PCB 2 Open I/F PCB or the Bypass I/F E748
results NG. on the Main Open I/F PCB PCB on the Main Controller PCB 2.
SN-14 Check an Main Controller 1. Check the installation of SDRAM - Controller PCB Bypass PCB 2. Replace the Open I/F PCB or
M-SDRAM error between PCB 2 (M0, M1) on the Main Controller 2 the Bypass I/F PCB on the Main
SDRAMs on the SDRAM (M0/M1) PCB 2. Controller PCB 2.
Main Controller on Main Controller 2. Replace SDRAM (M0, M1) on 3. Replace the Main Controller
PCB 2 PCB 2 the Main Controller PCB 2. PCB 2.
3. Replace the Main Controller
PCB 2.

6-96
6
6
6-97
Test Name Description Assumed Error Remedy Error Code
Location
SN-21 FRAM Check failure Main Controller 1. Check the installation of E355
between the PCB 2 the Memory PCB on the Main
Main Controller Memory PCB Controller PCB 2.
PCB 2 and the 2. Replace the Memory PCB on
Memory PCB the Main Controller PCB 2.
3. Replace the Main Controller
PCB 2.
SN-22 SRAM Check failure Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller E246
of SDRAM PCB 2 PCB 2. E350
and battery E355
exhaustion
on the Main
Controller PCB
2
SN-23 JUST Check ROM Main Controller 1. Replace the Main Controller -
ROM READ READ on the PCB 2 PCB 2.
Main Controller
PCB 2
SN-24 HDD Check an HDD Main Controller 1. Check the cable connection of -
I/F error PCB 2 the HDD.
PCI Expansion 2. Check the connection between
PCB the Main Controller PCB 2 and the
HDD Cable Main Controller PCB 1.
HDD 3. Replace the HDD.
T-6-19

■■Restrictions
●● <Boot System Error Diagnosis>
• If an error cannot be resolved by executing remedy according to the error diagnosis table
described above, consider boot failure of the main power supply and take appropriate
actions.

●● <Controller System Error Diagnosis>


• Regarding the diagnosis for the test names (SN-1, 2, 7, 15, 21, 24), if an error occurs in the
diagnosis under the test names, this diagnosis tool will not boot.
• When no PCBs are installed on the Main Controller PCB 1/2, the following judgment results
are displayed.
Standard PCB: [NG]
Optional PCB: [OK]
However, [no] is displayed in detailed error information for optional PCBs.

6-97
6
7 Error Code

■Overview

■Error Code

■Jam Code

■Alarm Code

7
7
7-2

Overview ■■Location code


When jam occurs, pickup location is indicated with the following pickup position code.
Outline
Pickup position Pickup position code
■■Outline At Finisher jam/At error avoidance jam/At ADF jam without pickup
00
operation (at SEND, Inbox, etc.)
This chapter describes various codes which are displayed when a failure occurs on the
Cassette 1 01
product. These are classified into 3 codes as follows. Cassette 2 02
Cassette 3 (Cassette Feeding Unit-AD1) 03
Code type Explanation Reference
Cassette 4 (Cassette Feeding Unit-AD1) 04
Error code This code is displayed when an error occurs on the machine. Multi-purpose Tray 05
Jam code This code is displayed when a jam occurs inside the machine. Paper Deck Unit-B1 06
Alarm code This code is displayed when a function of the machine is malfunctioned. Duplex (At duplex printing, jam occurs after paper passes through the
F0
T-7-1
Duplex Paper Sensor (PS38).)
T-7-3
• Error code notation
An error code is shown in 7-digit [E000XXX] on the display on the operation panel. However,
[000] in 2 to 4 digit is not used. Thus, an error code is described as [EXXX] using 5 to 7 digit
in the service manual. (e.g.: E012 = E000012)

■■Location code
Error code, jam code, and alarm code include the location information.
Location information is displayed as 2-digit numbers as follows.

Device JAM ERR ALARM


imageRUNNER ADVANCE C5051/C5045/C5035/C5030 00 Main Controller = 00 Others of
Printer engine = 05 listed below
Color Image Reader Unit - B1(Reader+DADF) 01 04 02
Duplex Color Image Reader Unit - B1(Reader+DADF)
Paper Deck Unit-B1 00 05 04
Cassette Feeding Unit-AD1 00 05 -
Staple Finisher-C1 / Booklet Finisher-C1 02 05 61,62
Inner Finisher-A1 02 05 -
External 2 Hole Puncher-B1 02 05 65
T-7-2

7-2
7
7
7-3
■■Points to Note When Clearing MN-CON
• Execution of clearing MN-COM deletes all data in Address Book, Forwarding Settings,
Settings/Registration (Preferences), Adjustment/Maintenance, Function Settings, Set
Destination, Management Settings, TPM Settings, etc. Before execution of this operation,
ask user to back up the data and get approval for this operation.

• When clearing MN-CON while any login application other than Default Authentication is,
error such as not displayed login screen occurred. In this case, access SMS once and
switch login application to Default Authentication to recover to the normal status.

■■Points to Note When Clearing HDD


As a remedy for error codes (E602-XXXX, E611-0000), HDD partition is selected and the
target partition may be cleared.
When clearing partition, be sure to check which data will be deleted by referring Detail of
HDD partition LVI and explain to the user before starting work.

■■Measures for E747


There are many detail codes in E747. Since these detail codes are for R&D use, remedy to
be performed in the field is the same, except for E747-1201 and E747-FF01. Because of that,
errors other than the 2 errors mentioned above are described as E747-XXXX, and common
remedy is described.

7-3
7
7
7-4

Error Code Ecode Detail Location Item Description


Code
E001 0003 05 Title High temperature error detected by hardware
Error Code Details Description Hardware detects abnormal high temperature of the
Thermistor (Main Thermistor 1: 264 deg C, Main Thermistor
2: 265 deg C, Sub Thermistor 1, 2: 280 deg C) for 400 msec
Ecode Detail Location Item Description
consecutively.
Code
Remedy 1. If the detected temperature of the Thermistor is less than
E001 0000 05 Title Abnormal high temperature in Main Thermistor 1, 2 the abnormal high temperature specified for Thermistor,
Description Main Thermistor 1, 2 (TH1) detects 260 deg C or more for 0.2 go through the following to clear the error: COPIER >
sec. FUNCTION > CLEAR > ERR; and then turn OFF and then
Remedy 1. Go through the following: DISPLAY > ANALOG > ON the power.
FIX-C, or DISPLAY > ANALOG > FIX-E; if it’s less than If it’s at abnormally high temperature, do not turn on the
260 deg C, go through the following to clear the error: power before replacing the Film Unit.
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; and then turn OFF/ON 2. Replace the Film Unit
the power. 3. Replace the Fixing Assembly
It it’s 260 deg C or more, do not turn on the power before 4. Go through the following to check drive of FM5 and
replacing the Film Unit. FM6: COPIER > FUNCTION > PART-CHK > FAN; if the not
2. Replace the Film Unit. working properly, replace the fan.
3. Replace the Fixing Assembly. 5. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)
4. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
NOTE: After performing the above remedy work, go through
NOTE: After performing the above remedy work, go through the following to clear the error: COPIER > FUNCTION >
the following to clear the error: COPIER > FUNCTION > CLEAR > ERR
CLEAR > ERR E003 0000 05 Title Error detected when the Heater is ON
E001 0001 05 Title Abnormal high temperature in Sub Thermistor 1, 2 Description After the Heater was turned ON, Main Thermistor 2, Sub
Description Sub Thermistor 1, 2 (TH1) detects 275 deg C or more for 0.2 Thermistor 1 or Sub Thermistor 2 detects 20 deg C or more
sec. and 50 deg C or less for 3 sec.
Remedy 1. Go through the following: DISPLAY > ANALOG > FIX-E2 Remedy 1. Go through the following to clear the error: COPIER >
or DISPLAY > ANALOG > FIX-E3; if it’s less than 275 deg FUNCTION > CLEAR > ERR; and then turn OFF and then
C, go through the following to clear the error: COPIER > ON the power.
FUNCTION > CLEAR > ERR; and then turn OFF and then 2. Check connection of the Connectors (Thermistor
ON the power. Connector and AC Connector).
If it’s 275 deg C or more, do not turn on the power before 3. Replace the Film Unit
replacing the Film Unit. 4. Replace the Fixing Assembly
2. Replace the Film Unit 5. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)
3. Replace the Fixing Assembly
4. Go through the following to check drive of FM5 and FM6: NOTE: After performing the above remedy work, go through
COPIER > FUNCTION > PART-CHK > FAN; if not working the following to clear the error: COPIER > FUNCTION >
properly, replace the fan. CLEAR > ERR
5. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)

NOTE: After performing the above remedy work, go through


the following to clear the error: COPIER > FUNCTION >
CLEAR > ERR

7-4
7
7
7-5
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E003 0001 05 Title Abnormal detection during paper feeding E004 0000 05 Title Thermistor disconnection detection error
Description During print control, Sub Thermistor detects 70 deg C or less Description Signal name, FUSER_CNCTX, detects disconnection for
from the target temperature for 5 sec. 500 msec or longer.
Remedy 1. Go through the following to clear the error: COPIER > Remedy 1. Check if the Fixing Assembly is installed.
FUNCTION > CLEAR > ERR; and then turn OFF and then 2. Check connection of the connectors in Fixing Assembly.
ON the power. 3. Check connection of DC Controller PCB (UN1) Connector.
2. Replace the Film Unit 4. Replace the Film Unit.
3. Replace the Fixing Assembly 5. Replace the Fixing Assembly.
4. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1) 6. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
E004 0001 05 Title Error in detection of welding with fixing relay
NOTE: After performing the above remedy work, go through Description Welding of fixing relay on the AC Driver PCB
the following to clear the error: COPIER > FUNCTION > Remedy 1. Replace the AC Driver PCB (replacement is necessary
CLEAR > ERR due to welding of the relay).
E003 0002 05 Title Abnormal low temperature when the Heater is ON
(disconnection detected) Other fixing-related error occurs (highly possible of E001)
Description After the Heater was turned ON, any of the Thermistors 2. Perform the remedy for the error occurred.
detects 20 deg C or less for 3 sec. E009 0000 05 Title Error in engagement
Remedy 1. Go through the following to clear the error: COPIER > Description Failed to detect ON with the Fixing Pressure Sensor
FUNCTION > CLEAR > ERR; and then turn OFF and then although 3 sec has passed.
ON the power. Remedy If it occurs at the time of the Fixing Assembly replacement, it
2. Check connection of the Connectors (Thermistor is highly possible that the installation of the Fixing Assembly
Connector and AC Connector). is insufficient. Therefore, remove and then reinstall the Fixing
3. Replace the Film Unit Assembly first.
4. Replace the Fixing Assembly
5. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1) 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
2. Remove the Fixing Assembly and then install the Fixing
NOTE: After performing the above remedy work, go through Assembly (to reinstall)
the following to clear the error: COPIER > FUNCTION > 3. Go through the following to move M22: COPIER >
CLEAR > ERR FUNCTION > PART-CHK > MTR
E003 0004 05 Title Timeout at start-up
Description After the start-up control was started, the start-up control is If the Motor works properly
not completed although 60 sec has passed. 4-1. Replace the Fixing Assembly
Remedy 1. Check connection of the Connectors (Thermistor 5-1. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)
Connector and AC Connector).
2. Replace the Film Unit If the Motor does not work properly
3. Replace the Fixing Assembly Mechanical failure.
4. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1) 4-2. Check if the Gear is damaged.
5-2. Replace the Motor.
NOTE: After performing the above remedy work, go through
the following to clear the error: COPIER > FUNCTION >
CLEAR > ERR

7-5
7
7
7-6
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E009 0001 05 Title Error in disengagement E012 0201 05 Title Faulty signal with M Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2
Description Failed to detect OFF with the Fixing Pressure Sensor Description Faulty signal with M Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2
although 3 sec has passed. Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2
Remedy If it occurs at the time of the Fixing Assembly replacement, it (UN33, UN34)
is highly possible that the installation of the Fixing Assembly 2. Check that the Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel is properly
is insufficient. Therefore, remove and then reinstall the Fixing installed.
Assembly first. 3. Check connection of the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
4. Manually turn the Rotor of the Drum Motor
1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. counterclockwise and check that the Drum Rotation Sensor
2. Remove the Fixing Assembly and then install the Fixing Wheel rotates. -> If the wheel does not rotate, replace the
Assembly (to reinstall) Drum Drive Unit.
3. Go through the following to move M21: COPIER > 5. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor to clean the Sensor
FUNCTION > PART-CHK > MTR and the Wheel.
6. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor.
If the Motor works properly 7. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
4-1. Replace the Fixing Assembly E012 0301 05 Title Faulty signal with C Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2
5-1. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1) Description Faulty signal with C Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2
Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2
If the Motor does not work properly (UN35, UN36)
Mechanical failure. 2. Check that the Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel is properly
4-2. Check if the Gear is damaged. installed.
5-2. Replace the Motor. 3. Check connection of the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
E012 0101 05 Title Faulty signal with Y Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2 4. Manually turn the Rotor of the Drum Motor
Description Faulty signal with Y Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2 counterclockwise and check that the Drum Rotation Sensor
Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2 Wheel rotates. -> If the wheel does not rotate, replace the
(UN31, UN32) Drum Drive Unit.
2. Check that the Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel is properly 5. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor to clean the Sensor
installed. and the Wheel.
3. Check connection of the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). 6. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor.
4. Manually turn the Rotor of the Drum Motor 7. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
counterclockwise and check that the Drum Rotation Sensor E012 0401 05 Title Faulty signal with Bk Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2
Wheel rotates. -> If the wheel does not rotate, replace the Description Faulty signal with Bk Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2
Drum Drive Unit. Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 1 and 2
5. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor to clean the Sensor (UN37, UN38)
and the Wheel. 2. Check that the Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel is properly
6. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor. installed.
7. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) 3. Check connection of the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
4. Manually turn the Rotor of the Drum Motor
counterclockwise and check that the Drum Rotation Sensor
Wheel rotates. -> If the wheel does not rotate, replace the
Drum Drive Unit.
5. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor to clean the Sensor
and the Wheel.
6. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor.
7. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)

7-6
7
7
7-7
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E012 0102 05 Title Faulty signal with Y Drum Rotation Sensor 1 E012 0203 05 Title Faulty signal with M Drum Rotation Sensor 2
Description No detection with the signal for 80msec or more Description No detection with the signal for 80msec or more
Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 1. Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 2 (UN34).
2. Take out Drum Rotation Sensor 1 (UN31) to clean the 2. Take out Drum Rotation Sensor 2 to clean the Sensor.
Sensor. 3. Replace Drum Rotation Sensor 2.
3. Replace Drum Rotation Sensor 1. 4. Check if the harness of the Drum Rotation Sensor is faulty
4. Check if the harness of the Drum Rotation Sensor is faulty (replace the harness if it’s disconnected).
(replace the harness if it’s disconnected). 5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) E012 0303 05 Title Faulty signal with C Drum Rotation Sensor 2
E012 0202 05 Title Faulty signal with M Drum Rotation Sensor 1 Description No detection with the signal for 80msec or more
Description No detection with the signal for 80msec or more Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 2 (UN36).
Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 1. 2. Take out Drum Rotation Sensor 2 to clean the Sensor.
2. Take out Drum Rotation Sensor 1 (UN33) to clean the 3. Replace Drum Rotation Sensor 2.
Sensor. 4. Check if the harness of the Drum Rotation Sensor is faulty
3. Replace Drum Rotation Sensor 1. (replace the harness if it’s disconnected).
4. Check if the harness of the Drum Rotation Sensor is faulty 5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
(replace the harness if it’s disconnected). E012 0403 05 Title Faulty signal with Bk Drum Rotation Sensor 2
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) Description No detection with the signal for 80msec or more
E012 0302 05 Title Faulty signal with C Drum Rotation Sensor 1 Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 2 (UN38).
Description No detection with the signal for 80msec or more 2. Take out Drum Rotation Sensor 2 to clean the Sensor.
Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 1. 3. Replace Drum Rotation Sensor 2.
2. Take out Drum Rotation Sensor 1 (UN35) to clean the 4. Check if the harness of the Drum Rotation Sensor is faulty
Sensor. (replace the harness if it’s disconnected).
3. Replace Drum Rotation Sensor 1. 5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
4. Check if the harness of the Drum Rotation Sensor is faulty E012 0104 05 Title Failure in Y Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel
(replace the harness if it’s disconnected). Description Failure is detected with the Y Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) Remedy 1. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor to clean the Sensor
E012 0402 05 Title Faulty signal with Bk Drum Rotation Sensor 1 (UN31, UN32) and the Wheel.
Description No detection with the signal for 80msec or more 2. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel.
Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 1. 3. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor.
2. Take out Drum Rotation Sensor 1 (UN37) to clean the 4. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
Sensor. E012 0204 05 Title Failure in M Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel
3. Replace Drum Rotation Sensor 1. Description Failure is detected with the M Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel
4. Check if the harness of the Drum Rotation Sensor is faulty Remedy 1. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor to clean the Sensor
(replace the harness if it’s disconnected). (UN33, UN34) and the Wheel.
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) 2. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel.
E012 0103 05 Title Faulty signal with Y Drum Rotation Sensor 2 3. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor.
Description No detection with the signal for 80msec or more 4. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
Remedy 1. Check connection of Drum Rotation Sensor 2 (UN32). E012 0304 05 Title Failure in C Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel
2. Take out Drum Rotation Sensor 2 to clean the Sensor. Description Failure is detected with the C Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel
3. Replace Drum Rotation Sensor 2. Remedy 1. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor to clean the Sensor
4. Check if the harness of the Drum Rotation Sensor is faulty (UN35, UN36) and the Wheel.
(replace the harness if it’s disconnected). 2. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel.
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) 3. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor.
4. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)

7-7
7
7
7-8
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E012 0404 05 Title Failure in Bk Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel E012 0106 05 Title Failure in rotation of Y Drum Motor
Description Failure is detected with the Bk Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel Description The Y Drum Motor is not rotating at the specified speed/is
Remedy 1. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor to clean the Sensor stopped.
(UN37, UN38) and the Wheel. Remedy 1. Check connection of the connector with the Drum Motor
2. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor Wheel. (M1)
3. Replace the Drum Rotation Sensor. 2. Check connection of the connector with Drum Driver PCB
4. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) (UN4).
E012 0105 05 Title Failure in Y Drum Motor Control 3. Check the ITB (to see if the ITB is displaced/damaged.
Description Unstable rotation of the Y Drum Motor Refer to E075 if the ITB is displaced).
Remedy 1. Check if the Drum is installed. 4. Replace the ITB Cleaning Blade.
2. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor (UN31, UN32) to 5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
clean the Sensor and the Wheel. E012 0206 05 Title Failure in rotation of M Drum Motor
3. Remove the Process Unit and then install (reinstall) the Description The M Drum Motor is not rotating at the specified speed/is
Process Unit. stopped.
4. Replace the Drum Unit. Remedy 1. Check connection of the connector with the Drum Motor
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) (M2)
E012 0205 05 Title Failure in M Drum Motor Control 2. Check connection of the connector with Drum Driver PCB
Description Unstable rotation of the M Drum Motor (UN4).
Remedy 1. Check if the Drum is installed. 3. Check the ITB (to see if the ITB is displaced/damaged.
2. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor (UN33, UN34) to Refer to E075 if the ITB is displaced).
clean the Sensor and the Wheel. 4. Replace the ITB Cleaning Blade.
3. Remove the Process Unit and then install (reinstall) the 5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
Process Unit. E012 0306 05 Title Failure in rotation of C Drum Motor
4. Replace the Drum Unit. Description The C Drum Motor is not rotating at the specified speed/is
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) stopped.
E012 0305 05 Title Failure in C Drum Motor Control Remedy 1. Check connection of the connector with the Drum Motor
Description Unstable rotation of the C Drum Motor (M3)
Remedy 1. Check if the Drum is installed. 2. Check connection of the connector with Drum Driver PCB
2. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor (UN35, UN36) to (UN4).
clean the Sensor and the Wheel. 3. Check the ITB (to see if the ITB is displaced/damaged.
3. Remove the Process Unit and then install (reinstall) the Refer to E075 if the ITB is displaced).
Process Unit. 4. Replace the ITB Cleaning Blade.
4. Replace the Drum Unit. 5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) E012 0406 05 Title Failure in rotation of Bk Drum Motor
E012 0405 05 Title Failure in Bk Drum Motor Control Description The Bk Drum Motor is not rotating at the specified speed/is
Description Unstable rotation of the Bk Drum Motor stopped.
Remedy 1. Check if the Drum is installed. Remedy 1. Check connection of the connector with the Drum Motor
2. Take out the Drum Rotation Sensor (UN37, UN38) to (M4)
clean the Sensor and the Wheel. 2. Check connection of the connector with Drum Driver PCB
3. Remove the Process Unit and then install (reinstall) the (UN4).
Process Unit. 3. Check the ITB (to see if the ITB is displaced/damaged.
4. Replace the Drum Unit. Refer to E075 if the ITB is displaced).
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) 4. Replace the ITB Cleaning Blade.
5. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4)

7-8
7
7
7-9
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E012 1000 05 Title Failure in rotation when ITB Motor is driven. E013 0001 05 Title Error in Recycle Toner Stirring Motor
Description The ITB Motor is not rotating at the specified speed/is Description The motor failed to rotate at the specified speed.
stopped. Remedy 1. Check disconnection of the Recycle Toner Stirring Motor
Remedy 1. Check connection of the connector with the ITB Motor (M14)
(M13). 2. Check toner level in the Recycle Toner container (replace
2. Check connection of the connector with the ITB Unit. the Recycle Toner container if the toner level is too much).
3. Check connection of the connector with the Drum Driver 3. Replace the Recycle Toner Stirring Motor.
PCB (UN4). 4. Replace the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2).
4. Check the ITB (to see if the ITB is displaced or damaged. 5. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
Refer to E075 if the ITB is displaced). E014 0001 05 Title Error in Fixing Motor
5. Replace the ITB Cleaning Blade. Description The motor failed to rotate at the specified speed.
6. Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) Remedy 1. Check the Fixing Assembly.
E012 1001 05 Title Failure is detected before ITB motor is driven. 2. Remove and then install the Fixing Assembly.
Description LOCK signal is detected Low before the ITB Motor is driven. 3. Replace the Fixing Assembly.
Remedy 1. Check the cable connected to the ITB Motor. 4. Replace the Fixing Motor.
2. Check the cable connected to the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). 5. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
E012 2000 05 Title Failure in rotation of Drum Motors (in all colors) and ITB E020 0011 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly
Motor Description Patch level is higher than the target upper limit although the
Description Faulty rotation with all of the Motors at the same time (based patch level was minimized at the time of patch initialization.
on the assumption that all of the motors fail to rotate) Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
Remedy 1. Check the connector on the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). cleaning first If P-LED-DA is 3F or more.
2. Check the connector on the Relay Board (UN5).
3. Check the Interlock Switch. 1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the
4. Check the Drum Driver Harness. Drum.
E012 3000 05 Title Failure in Drum Rotation Sensors (in all colors) 2. Clean the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) Window.
Description The Drum Rotation Sensors are faulty (in all colors) at the 3. Replace the Patch Sensor.
same time. 4. Replace the Drum.
Remedy 1. Check the connector on the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). E020 0012 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly
2. FU3 is disconnected on the Drum Driver PCB (UN4) -> Description Patch level is higher than the target upper limit although the
Check the harness & replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). patch level was minimized at the time of patch initialization.
E012 3001 05 Title Failure in control of Drum Motors in all colors Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
Description Controls of the Drum Motors (in all colors) are faulty at the cleaning first If P-LED-DA is 3F or more.
same time.
Remedy Check the Process Unit (to see if it’s properly installed). 1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the
Check the Drum Unit (to see if it’s properly installed). Drum.
E012 3002 05 Title Failure in rotation of Drum Motor (in all colors) 2. Clean the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) Window.
(M1,M2,M3,M4) 3. Replace the Patch Sensor.
4. Replace the Drum.
Description All of the Drum Motors are not rotating at the specified
speed/are stopped.
Remedy Check the connector on the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

7-9
7
7
7-10
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E020 0013 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly E020 0022 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly
Description Patch level is higher than the target upper limit although the Description Patch level is lower than the target lower limit although the
patch level was minimized at the time of patch initialization. patch level was maximized at the time of patch initialization.
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
cleaning first If P-LED-DA is 3F or more. cleaning first if P-LED-DA is 3F or more.
If the Patch Sensor (UN47, UN48,UN49) value shows 1-digit,
1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the check that the Developing Assembly is installed, and then
Drum. perform remedy from “3”.
2. Clean the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) Window.
3. Replace the Patch Sensor. 1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the
4. Replace the Drum. Drum.
E020 0014 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly 2. Clean the Patch Sensor Window.
Description Patch level is higher than the target upper limit although the 3. Replace the Patch Sensor.
patch level was minimized at the time of patch initialization. 4. Replace the Drum.
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform E020 0023 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly
cleaning first If P-LED-DA is 3F or more. Description Patch level is lower than the target lower limit although the
patch level was maximized at the time of patch initialization.
1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
Drum. cleaning first if P-LED-DA is 3F or more.
2. Clean the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) Window. If the Patch Sensor (UN47, UN48,UN49) value shows 1-digit,
3. Replace the Patch Sensor. check that the Developing Assembly is installed, and then
4. Replace the Drum. perform remedy from “3”.
E020 0021 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly
Description Patch level is lower than the target lower limit although the 1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the
patch level was maximized at the time of patch initialization. Drum.
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform 2. Clean the Patch Sensor Window.
cleaning first if P-LED-DA is 3F or more. 3. Replace the Patch Sensor.
If the Patch Sensor (UN47, UN48,UN49) value shows 1-digit, 4. Replace the Drum.
check that the Developing Assembly is installed, and then E020 0024 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly
perform remedy from “3”. Description Patch level is lower than the target lower limit although the
patch level was maximized at the time of patch initialization.
1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
Drum. cleaning first if P-LED-DA is 3F or more.
2. Clean the Patch Sensor Window. If the Patch Sensor (UN47, UN48,UN49) value shows 1-digit,
3. Replace the Patch Sensor. check that the Developing Assembly is installed, and then
4. Replace the Drum. perform remedy from “3”.

1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the


Drum.
2. Clean the Patch Sensor Window.
3. Replace the Patch Sensor.
4. Replace the Drum.

7-10
7
7
7-11
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E020 0081 05 Title Error in ITB background light intensity E020 0103 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly
Description At ITB background correction, average value of the detected Description The value is higher than the upper limit for the patch.
light intensity is 120 or less. Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
When it occurs twice in a row, error is displayed. cleaning first If P-LED-DA is 3F or more.
Remedy This error tends to occur when the Patch Sensor window
is not opened sufficiency due to damage on the Patch 1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the
Detection Shutter. Drum.
Especially, when LV.2 > DISPLAY > DENS > P-LED-DA is 2. Clean the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) Window.
3F, check if the Patch Detection Shutter is damaged or the 3. Check if the patch sensor is disconnected.
Patch Sensor window is soiled. 4. Replace the Patch Sensor.
5. Replace the Drum.
1. Check the installation of the Patch Detection Shutter. E020 0104 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly
2. Clean the Patch Sensor window. Description The value is higher than the upper limit for the patch.
3. Check the disconnection of the Patch Sensor (UN47, Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
UN48, UN49). cleaning first If P-LED-DA is 3F or more.
4. Check the installation of the ITB Unit.
5. Replace the Patch Sensor. 1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the
E020 0101 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly Drum.
Description The value is higher than the upper limit for the patch. 2. Clean the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) Window.
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform 3. Check if the patch sensor is disconnected.
cleaning first If P-LED-DA is 3F or more. 4. Replace the Patch Sensor.
5. Replace the Drum.
1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the E020 0201 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly
Drum. Description The value is lower than the lower limit for the patch.
2. Clean the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) Window. Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
3. Check if the patch sensor is disconnected. cleaning first if P-LED-DA is 3F or more.
4. Replace the Patch Sensor. If the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) value shows 1-digit,
5. Replace the Drum. perform remedy from “3”.
E020 0102 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly If the supply area of the Developing Assembly is badly
Description The value is higher than the upper limit for the patch. soiled, toner can be leaked.
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
cleaning first If P-LED-DA is 3F or more. 1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the
Drum.
1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the 2. Clean the Patch Sensor Window.
Drum. 3. Check if the patch sensor is disconnected.
2. Clean the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) Window. 4. Replace the Patch Sensor.
3. Check if the patch sensor is disconnected. 5. Replace the Drum.
4. Replace the Patch Sensor. 6. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit.
5. Replace the Drum. 7. Check toner level in the Toner Container.
8. Check short-circuit of the harness of the Toner Supply
Sensor (PS1).

7-11
7
7
7-12
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E020 0202 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly E020 0204 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly
Description The value is lower than the lower limit for the patch. Description The value is lower than the lower limit for the patch.
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform
cleaning first if P-LED-DA is 3F or more. cleaning first if P-LED-DA is 3F or more.
If the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) value shows 1-digit, If the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) value shows 1-digit,
perform remedy from “3”. perform remedy from “3”.
If the supply area of the Developing Assembly is badly If the supply area of the Developing Assembly is badly
soiled, toner can be leaked. soiled, toner can be leaked.

1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the 1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the
Drum. Drum.
2. Clean the Patch Sensor Window. 2. Clean the Patch Sensor Window.
3. Check if the patch sensor is disconnected. 3. Check if the patch sensor is disconnected.
4. Replace the Patch Sensor. 4. Replace the Patch Sensor.
5. Replace the Drum. 5. Replace the Drum.
6. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit. 6. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit.
7. Check toner level in the Toner Container. 7. Check toner level in the Toner Container.
8. Check short-circuit of the harness of the Toner Supply 8. Check short-circuit of the harness of the Toner Supply
Sensor (PS2). Sensor (PS4).
E020 0203 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly E020 0130 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly
Description The value is lower than the lower limit for the patch. Description The average of ATR reference value is more than the
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > P-LED-DA; perform specified value at the time of ATR initialization.
cleaning first if P-LED-DA is 3F or more. Remedy 1. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS5) Harness.
If the Patch Sensor (UN47,UN48,UN49) value shows 1-digit, 2. Replace the Developing Assembly.
perform remedy from “3”. E020 0131 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly
If the supply area of the Developing Assembly is badly Description The average of ATR reference value is less than the
soiled, toner can be leaked. specified value at the time of ATR initialization.
Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS5) Connector is properly
1. Check installation of the Developing Assembly and the connected.
Drum. 2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness.
2. Clean the Patch Sensor Window. 3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
3. Check if the patch sensor is disconnected. E020 0140 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly
4. Replace the Patch Sensor.
Description Unable to adjust the control voltage at the time of ATR
5. Replace the Drum.
initialization: less than the specified value (3.2V).
6. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit.
Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS5) Connector is properly
7. Check toner level in the Toner Container.
connected.
8. Check short-circuit of the harness of the Toner Supply
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness.
Sensor (PS3).
3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
E020 0141 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly
Description Unable to adjust the control voltage at the time of ATR
initialization: exceeds the specified value (6.8V).
Remedy 1. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS5) Harness.
2. Replace the Developing Assembly.

7-12
7
7
7-13
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E020 0190 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly E020 0231 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly
Description Error in signal lower limit with ATR sampling detected value Description The average of ATR reference value is less than the
Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor Connector is disconnected. specified value at the time of ATR initialization.
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS5) Harness. Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS6) Connector is properly
3. Replace the Developing Assembly. connected.
E020 0191 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly 2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness.
Description Error in signal upper limit with ATR sampling detected value 3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
Remedy 1. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit. E020 0240 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly
2. Check toner level in the Toner Container. Description Unable to adjust the control voltage at the time of ATR
3. Replace the Developing Assembly. initialization: less than the specified value (3.2V).
4. Check short-circuit of the harness with the Toner Buffer Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS6) Connector is properly
Supply Sensor (PS1). connected.
E020 01B0 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly 2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness.
Description Error in upper limit with T/D ratio at the time of print 3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
sequence E020 0241 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly
(Large amount of toner in the Developing Assembly) Description Unable to adjust the control voltage at the time of ATR
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > DENS > DENS-Y; if initialization: exceeds the specified value (6.8V).
DENS-Y is slightly higher than 5.0%, output 10 sheets of Remedy 1. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS6) Harness.
solid image with the color causing the error (to reduce T/ 2. Replace the Developing Assembly.
D ratio). See the Service Mode again to see if the problem E020 0290 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly
is improved. Remedy is complete if it’s improved. If not, Description Error in signal lower limit with ATR sampling detected value
perform the following remedy work. Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor Connector is disconnected.
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS6) Harness.
1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS5) Connector is disconnected. 3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness. E020 0291 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly
3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
Description Error in signal upper limit with ATR sampling detected value
E020 01B1 05 Title Error in Y Developing Assembly
Remedy 1. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit.
Description Error in lower limit with T/D ratio at the time of print sequence 2. Check toner level in the Toner Container.
(Small amount of toner in the Developing Assembly) 3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
Remedy 1. Output 10 sheets of white (blank) sheets (to increase T/D 4. Check short-circuit of the harness with the Toner Buffer
ratio). Supply Sensor (PS2).
2. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit. E020 02B0 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly
3. Check toner level in the Toner Container.
Description Error in upper limit with T/D ratio at the time of print
4. Replace the Developing Assembly.
sequence
5. Check short-circuit of the harness of the Toner supply
(Large amount of toner in the Developing Assembly)
sensor (PS1).
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > DENS > DENS-M; if
E020 0230 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly
DENS-M is slightly higher than 5.0%, output 10 sheets of
Description The average of ATR reference value is more than the solid image with the color causing the error (to reduce T/
specified value at the time of ATR initialization. D ratio). See the Service Mode again to see if the problem
Remedy 1. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS6) Harness. is improved. Remedy is complete if it’s improved. If not,
2. Replace the Developing Assembly. perform the following remedy work.

1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS6) Connector is disconnected.


2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness.
3. Replace the Developing Assembly.

7-13
7
7
7-14
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E020 02B1 05 Title Error in M Developing Assembly E020 03B0 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly
Description Error in lower limit with T/D ratio at the time of print sequence Description Error in upper limit with T/D ratio at the time of print
(Small amount of toner in the Developing Assembly) sequence
Remedy 1. Output 10 sheets of white (blank) sheets (to increase T/D (Large amount of toner in the Developing Assembly)
ratio). Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > DENS > DENS-C; if
2. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit. DENS-C is slightly higher than 5.0%, output 10 sheets of
3. Check toner level in the Toner Container. solid image with the color causing the error (to reduce T/
4. Replace the Developing Assembly. D ratio). See the Service Mode again to see if the problem
5. Check short-circuit of the harness of the Toner supply is improved. Remedy is complete if it’s improved. If not,
sensor (PS2). perform the following remedy work.
E020 0330 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly
Description The average of ATR reference value is more than the 1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS7) Connector is disconnected.
specified value at the time of ATR initialization. 2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness.
Remedy 1. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS7) Harness. 3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
2. Replace the Developing Assembly. E020 03B1 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly
E020 0331 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly Description Error in lower limit with T/D ratio at the time of print sequence
Description The average of ATR reference value is less than the (Small amount of toner in the Developing Assembly)
specified value at the time of ATR initialization. Remedy 1. Output 10 sheets of white (blank) sheets (to increase T/D
Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS7) Connector is properly ratio).
connected. 2. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit.
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness. 3. Check toner level in the Toner Container.
3. Replace the Developing Assembly. 4. Replace the Developing Assembly.
E020 0340 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly 5. Check short-circuit of the harness of the Toner supply
sensor (PS3).
Description Unable to adjust the control voltage at the time of ATR
initialization: less than the specified value (3.2V). E020 0430 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly
Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS7) Connector is properly Description The average of ATR reference value is more than the
connected. specified value at the time of ATR initialization.
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness. Remedy 1. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS8) Harness.
3. Replace the Developing Assembly. 2. Replace the Developing Assembly.
E020 0341 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly E020 0431 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly
Description Unable to adjust the control voltage at the time of ATR Description The average of ATR reference value is less than the
initialization: exceeds the specified value (6.8V). specified value at the time of ATR initialization.
Remedy 1. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS7) Harness. Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS8) Connector is properly
2. Replace the Developing Assembly. connected.
E020 0390 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly 2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness.
3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
Description Error in signal lower limit with ATR sampling detected value
E020 0440 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly
Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor Connector is disconnected.
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS7) Harness. Description Unable to adjust the control voltage at the time of ATR
3. Replace the Developing Assembly. initialization: less than the specified value (3.2V).
E020 0391 05 Title Error in C Developing Assembly Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS8) Connector is properly
connected.
Description Error in signal upper limit with ATR sampling detected value
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness.
Remedy 1. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit.
3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
2. Check toner level in the Toner Container.
3. Replace the Developing Assembly.
4. Check short-circuit of the harness with the Toner Buffer
Supply Sensor (PS3).

7-14
7
7
7-15
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E020 0441 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly E021 0100 05 Title Error in Y Developing Motor
Description Unable to adjust the control voltage at the time of ATR Description The motor failed to rotate at the specified speed.
initialization: exceeds the specified value (6.8V). Remedy 1. Check the load applied to the Developing Assembly (turn
Remedy 1. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS8) Harness. the gear with your hand to check if the load is appropriate. If
2. Replace the Developing Assembly. the load is too much, replace the Developing Assembly).
E020 0490 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly 2. Select the following in Service Mode: COPIER >
Description Error in signal lower limit with ATR sampling detected value FUNCTION > PART-CHK > MTR; and turn M5 to check
Remedy 1. Check if the ATR Sensor Connector is disconnected. the drive of the Developing Motor. If it’s not rotating
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor (TS8) Harness. properly, check the harness (to see if the harness is caught,
3. Replace the Developing Assembly. disconnected or physically removed).
E020 0491 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly 3.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
Description Error in signal upper limit with ATR sampling detected value
E021 0200 05 Title Error in M Developing Motor
Remedy 1. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit.
2. Check toner level in the Toner Container. Description The motor failed to rotate at the specified speed.
3. Replace the Developing Assembly. Remedy 1. Check the load applied to the Developing Assembly (turn
4. Check short-circuit of the harness with the Toner Buffer the gear with your hand to check if the load is appropriate. If
Supply Sensor (PS4). the load is too much, replace the Developing Assembly).
E020 04B0 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly 2. Select the following in Service Mode: COPIER >
FUNCTION > PART-CHK > MTR; and turn M6 to check
Description Error in upper limit with T/D ratio at the time of print
the drive of the Developing Motor. If it’s not rotating
sequence
properly, check the harness (to see if the harness is caught,
(Large amount of toner in the Developing Assembly)
disconnected or physically removed).
Remedy Go through the following: DISPLAY > DENS > DENS-K; if
3.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) replace
DENS-K is slightly higher than 5.0%, output 10 sheets of
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
solid image with the color causing the error (to reduce T/
E021 0300 05 Title Error in C Developing Motor
D ratio). See the Service Mode again to see if the problem
is improved. Remedy is complete if it’s improved. If not, Description The motor failed to rotate at the specified speed.
perform the following remedy work. Remedy 1. Check the load applied to the Developing Assembly (turn
the gear with your hand to check if the load is appropriate. If
1. Check if the ATR Sensor (TS8) Connector is disconnected. the load is too much, replace the Developing Assembly).
2. Check short-circuit of the ATR Sensor Harness. 2. Select the following in Service Mode: COPIER >
3. Replace the Developing Assembly. FUNCTION > PART-CHK > MTR; and turn M7 to check
E020 04B1 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Assembly the drive of the Developing Motor. If it’s not rotating
properly, check the harness (to see if the harness is caught,
Description Error in lower limit with T/D ratio at the time of print sequence
disconnected or physically removed).
(Small amount of toner in the Developing Assembly)
3.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) replace
Remedy 1. Output 10 sheets of white (blank) sheets (to increase T/D
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
ratio).
2. Check toner leak from the Toner Buffer Unit.
3. Check toner level in the Toner Container.
4. Replace the Developing Assembly.
5. Check short-circuit of the harness of the Toner supply
sensor (PS4).

7-15
7
7
7-16
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E021 0400 05 Title Error in Bk Developing Motor E025 0110 05 Title Timeout error in detection of Y Toner Bottle Seal/Release
Description The motor failed to rotate at the specified speed. Sensor
Remedy 1. Check the load applied to the Developing Assembly (turn Description Failure in detection about the changes of ON => OFF => ON
the gear with your hand to check if the load is appropriate. If with the sensor when the cap of the Y Toner Container was
the load is too much, replace the Developing Assembly). sealed/released.
2. Select the following in Service Mode: COPIER > Remedy 1. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Main Drive
FUNCTION > PART-CHK > MTR; and turn M8 to check Unit to check the operation.
the drive of the Developing Motor. If it’s not rotating 2. If the Main Drive Unit side failed to rotate, check the drive
properly, check the harness (to see if the harness is caught, (to see damage of the gear, etc.)
disconnected or physically removed). If it’s results in NG, replace the Main Drive Unit.
3.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) replace 3. If the Main Drive Unit side failed to rotate while the Drive
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). rotates, turn the Set-on Hopper Unit to check the rotating
E025 0100 05 Title Error in lock of the Y Toner Container Motor operation. If it’s results in NG, replace the Set-on Hopper
Description The Y Toner Container Motor is detected to be locked / lock Unit.
detection. 4. If both the Main Drive Unit and the Set-on Hooper Unit
Remedy 1. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Main Drive rotates together once the Main Drive Unit is manually rotated
Unit to check the operation (by comparing with other color, while sealing/releasing of the container works properly,
etc.) check the sensor harness (to see if the harness is caught,
If the manual rotating operation results in NG, perform the disconnected or physically removed).
following because it’s due to mechanical overload. 5. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 4.
If there is no problem, go to step 5. 6.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) Replace
2. Remove the Delivery Tray to check the position of the the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
projection attached at the back of the gear in the Hopper E025 0120 05 Title Y Mismatched phase
Assembly. Compare with the gear that works properly. If the Description Set-on Unit detects opening of the Y Toner Container as well
position of the projection is displaced, check the following. as the Small Door.
Check the lever to open/close the Toner Small Cover (to see Remedy 1. Check if the Small Door can be closed.
if the operation is smooth, no damage with the lever, the 2. Close the Small Door and turn OFF and then ON the
lever works OK (no wrong move to up/down). If the lever is power to check recovery.
faulty, replace the lever. 3. Check the installation of the Open/Close Sensor of the
3. Remove the Main Drive Unit to check the unit (to see Small Door (to see if it’s installed at the correct position).
damage, etc.) 4. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the harness is
If it’s results in NG, replace the Main Drive Unit. caught, disconnected or physically removed).
4. Manually turn the gear on the cam in the hopper unit to 5.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) Replace
check the rotation. the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
If it’s results in NG, replace the Set-on Hopper Unit.
5.(If the above measures do not solve the problem) Replace
the Toner Container Motor (M9).
Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

7-16
7
7
7-17
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 0200 05 Title Error in lock of the M Toner Container Motor E025 0210 05 Title Timeout error in detection of M Toner Bottle Seal/Release
Description The M Toner Container Motor is detected to be locked / lock Sensor
detection. Description Failure in detection about the changes of ON => OFF => ON
Remedy 1. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Main Drive with the sensor when the cap of the M Toner Container was
Unit to check the operation (by comparing with other color, sealed/released.
etc.) Remedy 1. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Main Drive
If the manual rotating operation results in NG, perform the Unit to check the operation.
following because it’s due to mechanical overload. 2. If the Main Drive Unit side failed to rotate, check the drive
If there is no problem, go to step 5. (to see damage of the gear, etc.)
2. Remove the Delivery Tray to check the position of the If it’s results in NG, replace the Main Drive Unit.
projection attached at the back of the gear in the Hopper 3. If the Main Drive Unit side failed to rotate while the Drive
Assembly. Compare with the gear that works properly. If the rotates, turn the Set-on Hopper Unit to check the rotating
position of the projection is displaced, check the following. operation. If it’s results in NG, replace the Set-on Hopper
Check the lever to open/close the Toner Small Cover (to see Unit.
if the operation is smooth, no damage with the lever, the 4. If both the Main Drive Unit and the Set-on Hooper Unit
lever works OK (no wrong move to up/down). If the lever is rotates together once the Main Drive Unit is manually rotated
faulty, replace the lever. while sealing/releasing of the container works properly,
3. Remove the Main Drive Unit to check the unit (to see check the sensor harness (to see if the harness is caught,
damage, etc.) disconnected or physically removed).
If it’s results in NG, replace the Main Drive Unit. 5. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 4.
4. Manually turn the gear on the cam in the hopper unit to 6.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) Replace
check the rotation. the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
If it’s results in NG, replace the Set-on Hopper Unit. E025 0220 05 Title M Mismatched phase
5.(If the above measures do not solve the problem) Replace Description Set-on Unit detects opening of the M Toner Container as well
the Toner Container Motor (M10). as the Small Door.
Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). Remedy 1. Check if the Small Door can be closed.
2. Close the Small Door and turn OFF and then ON the
power to check recovery.
3. Check the installation of the Open/Close Sensor of the
Small Door (to see if it’s installed at the correct position).
4. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed).
5.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

7-17
7
7
7-18
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 0300 05 Title Error in lock of the C Toner Container Motor E025 0310 05 Title Timeout error in detection of C Toner Bottle Seal/Release
Description The C Toner Container Motor is detected to be locked / lock Sensor
detection. Description Failure in detection about the changes of ON => OFF => ON
Remedy 1. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Main Drive with the sensor when the cap of the C Toner Container was
Unit to check the operation (by comparing with other color, sealed/released.
etc.) Remedy 1. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Main Drive
If the manual rotating operation results in NG, perform the Unit to check the operation.
following because it’s due to mechanical overload. 2. If the Main Drive Unit side failed to rotate, check the drive
If there is no problem, go to step 5. (to see damage of the gear, etc.)
2. Remove the Delivery Tray to check the position of the If it’s results in NG, replace the Main Drive Unit.
projection attached at the back of the gear in the Hopper 3. If the Main Drive Unit side failed to rotate while the Drive
Assembly. Compare with the gear that works properly. If the rotates, turn the Set-on Hopper Unit to check the rotating
position of the projection is displaced, check the following. operation. If it’s results in NG, replace the Set-on Hopper
Check the lever to open/close the Toner Small Cover (to see Unit.
if the operation is smooth, no damage with the lever, the 4. If both the Main Drive Unit and the Set-on Hooper Unit
lever works OK (no wrong move to up/down). If the lever is rotates together once the Main Drive Unit is manually rotated
faulty, replace the lever. while sealing/releasing of the container works properly,
3. Remove the Main Drive Unit to check the unit (to see check the sensor harness (to see if the harness is caught,
damage, etc.) disconnected or physically removed).
If it’s results in NG, replace the Main Drive Unit. 5. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 4.
4. Manually turn the gear on the cam in the hopper unit to 6.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) Replace
check the rotation. the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
If it’s results in NG, replace the Set-on Hopper Unit. E025 0320 05 Title C Mismatched phase
5.(If the above measures do not solve the problem) Replace Description Set-on Unit detects opening of the C Toner Container as well
the Toner Container Motor (M11). as the Small Door.
Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). Remedy 1. Check if the Small Door can be closed.
2. Close the Small Door and turn OFF and then ON the
power to check recovery.
3. Check the installation of the Open/Close Sensor of the
Small Door (to see if it’s installed at the correct position).
4. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed).
5.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

7-18
7
7
7-19
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 0400 05 Title Error in lock of the Bk Toner Container Motor E025 0410 05 Title Timeout error in detection of Bk Toner Bottle Seal/Release
Description The Bk Toner Container Motor is detected to be locked / lock Sensor
detection. Description Failure in detection about the changes of ON => OFF => ON
Remedy 1. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Main Drive with the sensor when the cap of the Bk Toner Container was
Unit to check the operation (by comparing with other color, sealed/released.
etc.) Remedy 1. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Main Drive
If the manual rotating operation results in NG, perform the Unit to check the operation.
following because it’s due to mechanical overload. 2. If the Main Drive Unit side failed to rotate, check the drive
If there is no problem, go to step 5. (to see damage of the gear, etc.)
2. Remove the Delivery Tray to check the position of the If it’s results in NG, replace the Main Drive Unit.
projection attached at the back of the gear in the Hopper 3. If the Main Drive Unit side failed to rotate while the Drive
Assembly. Compare with the gear that works properly. If the rotates, turn the Set-on Hopper Unit to check the rotating
position of the projection is displaced, check the following. operation. If it’s results in NG, replace the Set-on Hopper
Check the lever to open/close the Toner Small Cover (to see Unit.
if the operation is smooth, no damage with the lever, the 4. If both the Main Drive Unit and the Set-on Hooper Unit
lever works OK (no wrong move to up/down). If the lever is rotates together once the Main Drive Unit is manually rotated
faulty, replace the lever. while sealing/releasing of the container works properly,
3. Remove the Main Drive Unit to check the unit (to see check the sensor harness (to see if the harness is caught,
damage, etc.) disconnected or physically removed).
If it’s results in NG, replace the Main Drive Unit. 5. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 4.
4. Manually turn the gear on the cam in the hopper unit to 6.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) Replace
check the rotation. the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
If it’s results in NG, replace the Set-on Hopper Unit. E025 0420 05 Title Bk Mismatched phase
5.(If the above measures do not solve the problem) Replace Description Set-on Unit detects opening of the Bk Toner Container as
the Toner Container Motor (M12). well as the Small Door.
Replace the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). Remedy 1. Check if the Small Door can be closed.
2. Close the Small Door and turn OFF and then ON the
power to check recovery.
3. Check the installation of the Open/Close Sensor of the
Small Door (to see if it’s installed at the correct position).
4. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed).
5.(If the above measures do not solve the problem,) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

7-19
7
7
7-20
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 01A0 05 Title Error in Y Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (PS5) E025 01B0 05 Title Error in Y Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (PS5)
Description Unable to detect the change in sensor status (ON -> OFF) Description Unable to detect the change in sensor status (OFF -> ON)
when the Set-on Unit opens the Toner Container so that when the Set-on Unit closes the Toner Container so that
open and close status cannot be judged correctly. open and close status cannot be judged correctly.
Remedy [1] Identify the cause of the error whether it is due to Remedy "[1] Identify the cause of the error whether it is due to
mechanical problem to open and close the Toner Container mechanical problem to open and close the Toner Container
or electrical problem at the sensor side. or electrical problem at the sensor side.
1. Check if the Toner Container Cam HP Sensor is soiled 1. Check the installation of the Toner Container Cam HP
and the installation of the sensor. Sensor.
2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive 2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive
to check that the output value of the sensor is switched in to check that the output value of the sensor is switched in
service mode. service mode.
It is difficult to check the screen while rotating the Set-on It is difficult to check the screen while rotating the Set-on
Drive. Thus, rotate it a little and check the screen. If the Drive. Thus, rotate it a little and check the screen. If the
value is not changed, rotate it a little again and check the value is not changed, rotate it a little again and check the
operation. operation.
Service mode I/O Service mode I/O
Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (Y) PS5: COPIER/IO/ Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (Y) PS5: COPIER/IO/
O-SENSOR/P024 bit4 O-SENSOR/P024 bit4
3. If the Set-on Drive Unit side fails to rotate, check the drive. 2. If the Set-on Drive Unit side fails to rotate, check the drive.
(Damage of gear, etc.) (Damage of gear, etc.)
  If it is due to damage of the drive system, replace the Set- If it is due to damage of the drive system, replace the Set-
on Drive Unit. on Drive Unit.
4. If the Set-on Unit side fails to rotate while the Drive 4. If the Set-on Unit side fails to rotate while the Drive
Unit rotates, remove the Hopper Unit to check the rotating Unit rotates, remove the Hopper Unit to check the rotating
operation. operation.
  If it does not rotate, replace the Hopper Unit. If it does not rotate, replace the Hopper Unit.

[2] If sensor signal is not changed by opening/closing the [2] If sensor signal is not changed by opening/closing the
Toner Container manually, it is highly possible that electrical Toner Container manually, it is highly possible that electrical
problem of the sensor is the cause of the error. problem of the sensor is the cause of the error.
5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is 5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed). caught, disconnected or physically removed).
6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5, 6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5,
and check the change in sensor signal with the procedure and check the change in sensor signal with the procedure
described in step 2.  described in step 2.
7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace 7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the
following operation check regardless the cause of the error. following operation check regardless the cause of the error.
Go through the following to clear the error: Go through the following to clear the error:
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and
then ON the power. then ON the power.
In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from
toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check
that the replacement operation can be performed normally. that the replacement operation can be performed normally."

7-20
7
7
7-21
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 01C0 05 Title Error in Cover Sensor (PS13) in Y Toner Container NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the
Description When removing the Toner Container, opening of Small following operation check regardless the cause of the error.
Covers cannot be detected. Go through the following to clear the error:
Remedy [1] Check open/close detection area around the Inner Door. COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and
1. Check that the Inner Door can be opened/closed normally. then ON the power.
(Damage of the Inner Door, or slide of shaft area) In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from
2. Check if the sensor is soiled and the installation of it. toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check
that the replacement operation can be performed normally.
[2] In the case that the Inner Door opens/closes normally
and there is no problem with the installation of the sensor,
identify the cause of the error whether it is due to mechanical
problem of the link area to open the Inner Door or electrical
problem at the sensor side.
3. Check that the output value of the sensor is switched
correctly in service mode when opening and closing the
Inner Door manually.
Service mode I/O
Toner Container Inner Cover Sensor (Y) PS13: COPIER/IO/
O-SENSOR/P024 bit8

[3] In the case that the sensor signal changes correctly, it is


highly possible that mechanical problem of the link area to
open the Inner Door is the cause of the error.
2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive
to check that the Inner Door is opened (be sure to open the
Outer Door beforehand). If the Inner Door is not opened by
manually rotating the Set-on Drive, mechanical damage is
suspected so replace the part which does not operate.
(Order from upstream of the drive: Set-on Drive Unit -> Set-
on Hopper Unit -> Bottle Base Unit -> Bottle Front Inner
Door Unit)

[4] In the case that the sensor signal does not change
correctly, it is highly possible that electrical problem of the
sensor which detects opening/closing of the Inner Door is
the cause of the error.
5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed, *including the
Relay Connector).
6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5.
7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

7-21
7
7
7-22
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 02A0 05 Title Error in M Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (PS6) E025 02B0 05 Title Error in M Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (PS6)
Description Unable to detect the change in sensor status (ON -> OFF) Description Unable to detect the change in sensor status (OFF -> ON)
when the Set-on Unit opens the Toner Container so that when the Set-on Unit closes the Toner Container so that
open and close status cannot be judged correctly. open and close status cannot be judged correctly.
Remedy [1] Identify the cause of the error whether it is due to Remedy [1] Identify the cause of the error whether it is due to
mechanical problem to open and close the Toner Container mechanical problem to open and close the Toner Container
or electrical problem at the sensor side. or electrical problem at the sensor side.
1. Check if the Toner Container Cam HP Sensor is soiled 1. Check the installation of the Toner Container Cam HP
and the installation of the sensor. Sensor.
2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive 2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive
to check that the output value of the sensor is switched in to check that the output value of the sensor is switched in
service mode. service mode.
It is difficult to check the screen while rotating the Set-on It is difficult to check the screen while rotating the Set-on
Drive. Thus, rotate it a little and check the screen. If the Drive. Thus, rotate it a little and check the screen. If the
value is not changed, rotate it a little again and check the value is not changed, rotate it a little again and check the
operation. operation.
Service mode I/O Service mode I/O
Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (M) PS6: COPIER/IO/ Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (M) PS6: COPIER/IO/
O-SENSOR/P024 bit5 O-SENSOR/P024 bit5
3. If the Set-on Drive Unit side fails to rotate, check the drive. 3. If the Set-on Drive Unit side fails to rotate, check the drive.
(Damage of gear, etc.) (Damage of gear, etc.)
If it is due to damage of the drive system, replace the Set- If it is due to damage of the drive system, replace the Set-
on Drive Unit. on Drive Unit.
4. If the Set-on Unit side fails to rotate while the Drive 4. If the Set-on Unit side fails to rotate while the Drive
Unit rotates, remove the Hopper Unit to check the rotating Unit rotates, remove the Hopper Unit to check the rotating
operation. operation.
If it does not rotate, replace the Hopper Unit. If it does not rotate, replace the Hopper Unit.

[2] If sensor signal is not changed by opening/closing the [2] If sensor signal is not changed by opening/closing the
Toner Container manually, it is highly possible that electrical Toner Container manually, it is highly possible that electrical
problem of the sensor is the cause of the error. problem of the sensor is the cause of the error.
5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is 5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed). caught, disconnected or physically removed).
6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5, 6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5,
and check the change in sensor signal with the procedure and check the change in sensor signal with the procedure
described in step 2. described in step 2.
7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace 7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the
following operation check regardless the cause of the error. following operation check regardless the cause of the error.
Go through the following to clear the error: Go through the following to clear the error:
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and
then ON the power. then ON the power.
In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from
toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check
that the replacement operation can be performed normally. that the replacement operation can be performed normally.

7-22
7
7
7-23
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 02C0 05 Title Error in Cover Sensor (PS14) in M Toner Container NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the
Description When removing the Toner Container, opening of Small following operation check regardless the cause of the error.
Covers cannot be detected. Go through the following to clear the error:
Remedy [1] Check open/close detection area around the Inner Door. COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and
1. Check that the Inner Door can be opened/closed normally. then ON the power.
(Damage of the Inner Door, or slide of shaft area) In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from
2. Check if the sensor is soiled and the installation of it. toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check
that the replacement operation can be performed normally.
[2] In the case that the Inner Door opens/closes normally
and there is no problem with the installation of the sensor,
identify the cause of the error whether it is due to mechanical
problem of the link area to open the Inner Door or electrical
problem at the sensor side.
3. Check that the output value of the sensor is switched
correctly in service mode when opening and closing the
Inner Door manually.
Service mode I/O
Toner Container Inner Cover Sensor (M) PS14: COPIER/IO/
O-SENSOR/P024 bit9

[3] In the case that the sensor signal changes correctly, it is


highly possible that mechanical problem of the link area to
open the Inner Door is the cause of the error.
2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive
to check that the Inner Door is opened (be sure to open the
Outer Door beforehand). If the Inner Door is not opened by
manually rotating the Set-on Drive, mechanical damage is
suspected so replace the part which does not operate.
(Order from upstream of the drive: Set-on Drive Unit -> Set-
on Hopper Unit -> Bottle Base Unit -> Bottle Front Inner
Door Unit)

[4] In the case that the sensor signal does not change
correctly, it is highly possible that electrical problem of the
sensor which detects opening/closing of the Inner Door is
the cause of the error.
5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed, *including the
Relay Connector).
6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5.
7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

7-23
7
7
7-24
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 03A0 05 Title Error in C Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (PS7) E025 03B0 05 Title Error in C Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (PS7)
Description Unable to detect the change in sensor status (ON -> OFF) Description Unable to detect the change in sensor status (OFF -> ON)
when the Set-on Unit opens the Toner Container so that when the Set-on Unit closes the Toner Container so that
open and close status cannot be judged correctly. open and close status cannot be judged correctly.
Remedy [1] Identify the cause of the error whether it is due to Remedy [1] Identify the cause of the error whether it is due to
mechanical problem to open and close the Toner Container mechanical problem to open and close the Toner Container
or electrical problem at the sensor side. or electrical problem at the sensor side.
1. Check if the Toner Container Cam HP Sensor is soiled 1. Check the installation of the Toner Container Cam HP
and the installation of the sensor. Sensor.
2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive 2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive
to check that the output value of the sensor is switched in to check that the output value of the sensor is switched in
service mode. service mode.
It is difficult to check the screen while rotating the Set-on It is difficult to check the screen while rotating the Set-on
Drive. Thus, rotate it a little and check the screen. If the Drive. Thus, rotate it a little and check the screen. If the
value is not changed, rotate it a little again and check the value is not changed, rotate it a little again and check the
operation. operation.
Service mode I/O Service mode I/O
Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (C) PS7: COPIER/IO/ Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (C) PS7: COPIER/IO/
O-SENSOR/P024 bit6 O-SENSOR/P024 bit6
3. If the Set-on Drive Unit side fails to rotate, check the drive. 3. If the Set-on Drive Unit side fails to rotate, check the drive.
(Damage of gear, etc.) (Damage of gear, etc.)
If it is due to damage of the drive system, replace the Set- If it is due to damage of the drive system, replace the Set-
on Drive Unit. on Drive Unit.
4. If the Set-on Unit side fails to rotate while the Drive 4. If the Set-on Unit side fails to rotate while the Drive
Unit rotates, remove the Hopper Unit to check the rotating Unit rotates, remove the Hopper Unit to check the rotating
operation. operation.
If it does not rotate, replace the Hopper Unit. If it does not rotate, replace the Hopper Unit.

[2] If sensor signal is not changed by opening/closing the [2] If sensor signal is not changed by opening/closing the
Toner Container manually, it is highly possible that electrical Toner Container manually, it is highly possible that electrical
problem of the sensor is the cause of the error. problem of the sensor is the cause of the error.
5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is 5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed). caught, disconnected or physically removed).
6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5, 6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5,
and check the change in sensor signal with the procedure and check the change in sensor signal with the procedure
described in step 2. described in step 2.
7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace 7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the
following operation check regardless the cause of the error. following operation check regardless the cause of the error.
Go through the following to clear the error: Go through the following to clear the error:
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and
then ON the power. then ON the power.
In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from
toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check
that the replacement operation can be performed normally. that the replacement operation can be performed normally.

7-24
7
7
7-25
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 03C0 05 Title Error in Cover Sensor (PS15) in C Toner Container NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the
Description When removing the Toner Container, opening of Small following operation check regardless the cause of the error.
Covers cannot be detected. Go through the following to clear the error:
Remedy [1] Check open/close detection area around the Inner Door. COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and
1. Check that the Inner Door can be opened/closed normally. then ON the power.
(Damage of the Inner Door, or slide of shaft area) In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from
2. Check if the sensor is soiled and the installation of it. toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check
that the replacement operation can be performed normally.
[2] In the case that the Inner Door opens/closes normally
and there is no problem with the installation of the sensor,
identify the cause of the error whether it is due to mechanical
problem of the link area to open the Inner Door or electrical
problem at the sensor side.
3. Check that the output value of the sensor is switched
correctly in service mode when opening and closing the
Inner Door manually.
Service mode I/O
Toner Container Inner Cover Sensor (C) PS15: COPIER/IO/
O-SENSOR/P024 bit10

[3] In the case that the sensor signal changes correctly, it is


highly possible that mechanical problem of the link area to
open the Inner Door is the cause of the error.
2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive
to check that the Inner Door is opened (be sure to open the
Outer Door beforehand). If the Inner Door is not opened by
manually rotating the Set-on Drive, mechanical damage is
suspected so replace the part which does not operate.
(Order from upstream of the drive: Set-on Drive Unit -> Set-
on Hopper Unit -> Bottle Base Unit -> Bottle Front Inner
Door Unit)

[4] In the case that the sensor signal does not change
correctly, it is highly possible that electrical problem of the
sensor which detects opening/closing of the Inner Door is
the cause of the error.
5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed, *including the
Relay Connector).
6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5.
7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

7-25
7
7
7-26
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 04A0 05 Title Error in Bk Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (PS8) E025 04B0 05 Title Error in Bk Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (PS8)
Description Unable to detect the change in sensor status (ON -> OFF) Description Unable to detect the change in sensor status (OFF -> ON)
when the Set-on Unit opens the Toner Container so that when the Set-on Unit closes the Toner Container so that
open and close status cannot be judged correctly. open and close status cannot be judged correctly.
Remedy [1] Identify the cause of the error whether it is due to Remedy [1] Identify the cause of the error whether it is due to
mechanical problem to open and close the Toner Container mechanical problem to open and close the Toner Container
or electrical problem at the sensor side. or electrical problem at the sensor side.
1. Check if the Toner Container Cam HP Sensor is soiled 1. Check the installation of the Toner Container Cam HP
and the installation of the sensor. Sensor.
2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive 2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive
to check that the output value of the sensor is switched in to check that the output value of the sensor is switched in
service mode. service mode.
It is difficult to check the screen while rotating the Set-on It is difficult to check the screen while rotating the Set-on
Drive. Thus, rotate it a little and check the screen. If the Drive. Thus, rotate it a little and check the screen. If the
value is not changed, rotate it a little again and check the value is not changed, rotate it a little again and check the
operation. operation.
Service mode I/O Service mode I/O
Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (Bk) PS8: COPIER/IO/ Toner Container Cam HP Sensor (Bk) PS8: COPIER/IO/
O-SENSOR/P024 bit7 O-SENSOR/P024 bit7
3. If the Set-on Drive Unit side fails to rotate, check the drive. 3. If the Set-on Drive Unit side fails to rotate, check the drive.
(Damage of gear, etc.) (Damage of gear, etc.)
If it is due to damage of the drive system, replace the Set-on If it is due to damage of the drive system, replace the Set-
Drive Unit. on Drive Unit.
4. If the Set-on Unit side fails to rotate while the Drive 4. If the Set-on Unit side fails to rotate while the Drive
Unit rotates, remove the Hopper Unit to check the rotating Unit rotates, remove the Hopper Unit to check the rotating
operation. operation.
If it does not rotate, replace the Hopper Unit. If it does not rotate, replace the Hopper Unit.

[2] If sensor signal is not changed by opening/closing the [2] If sensor signal is not changed by opening/closing the
Toner Container manually, it is highly possible that electrical Toner Container manually, it is highly possible that electrical
problem of the sensor is the cause of the error. problem of the sensor is the cause of the error.
5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is 5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed). caught, disconnected or physically removed).
6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5, 6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5,
and check the change in sensor signal with the procedure and check the change in sensor signal with the procedure
described in step 2. described in step 2.
7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace 7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4). the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the
following operation check regardless the cause of the error. following operation check regardless the cause of the error.
Go through the following to clear the error: Go through the following to clear the error:
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and
then ON the power. then ON the power.
In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from
toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check
that the replacement operation can be performed normally. that the replacement operation can be performed normally.

7-26
7
7
7-27
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E025 04C0 05 Title Error in Cover Sensor (PS16) in Bk Toner Container NOTE: After performing the remedy work, perform the
Description When removing the Toner Container, opening of Small following operation check regardless the cause of the error.
Covers cannot be detected. Go through the following to clear the error:
Remedy [1] Check open/close detection area around the Inner Door. COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR>ERR; then, turn OFF and
1. Check that the Inner Door can be opened/closed normally. then ON the power.
(Damage of the Inner Door, or slide of shaft area) In user mode, perform the toner replacement operation (from
2. Check if the sensor is soiled and the installation of it. toner removal to reset/recovery) at least once, and check
that the replacement operation can be performed normally.
[2] In the case that the Inner Door opens/closes normally E027 0100 05 Title Error in supply with Y Developing Assembly
and there is no problem with the installation of the sensor, Description Failure in detection about the changes of ON => OFF =>
identify the cause of the error whether it is due to mechanical ON with the sensor which detects a full rotation of the supply
problem of the link area to open the Inner Door or electrical screw within the specified period of time.
problem at the sensor side. Remedy 1. Check the damage of the Developing Coupling.
3. Check that the output value of the sensor is switched If it’s damaged, replace the Developing Assembly.
correctly in service mode when opening and closing the 2. Check the damage of the coupling (with the Developing
Inner Door manually. Assembly) at the Host Machine side.
Service mode I/O If it’s damaged, remove the Main Drive Unit to replace the
Toner Container Inner Cover Sensor (Bk) PS16: COPIER/IO/ coupling.
O-SENSOR/P024 bit11 3. Turn the motor as a single unit while the Drum/Developing
Assembly is removed to check rotation of the Main Drive
[3] In the case that the sensor signal changes correctly, it is Unit.
highly possible that mechanical problem of the link area to If it does not rotate, replace the Motor.
open the Inner Door is the cause of the error. If the above measures do not solve the problem, replace the
2. Use the attached tool to manually rotate the Set-on Drive Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
to check that the Inner Door is opened (be sure to open the If there still remains the problem, replace the Main Drive
Outer Door beforehand). If the Inner Door is not opened by Unit.
manually rotating the Set-on Drive, mechanical damage is 4. Remove the Hopper Unit and manually turn the Supply
suspected so replace the part which does not operate. Input Gear to check rotation.
(Order from upstream of the drive: Set-on Drive Unit -> Set- If it’s results in NG, replace the Hopper Unit.
on Hopper Unit -> Bottle Base Unit -> Bottle Front Inner
Door Unit)

[4] In the case that the sensor signal does not change
correctly, it is highly possible that electrical problem of the
sensor which detects opening/closing of the Inner Door is
the cause of the error.
5. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the Harness is
caught, disconnected or physically removed, *including the
Relay Connector).
6. Replace the sensor which has been checked in step 5.
7. (If the measures above do not solve the problem) Replace
the Drum Driver PCB (UN4).

7-27
7
7
7-28
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E027 0200 05 Title Error in supply with M Developing Assembly E027 0400 05 Title Error in supply with Bk Developing Assembly
Description Failure in detection about the changes of ON => OFF => Description Failure in detection about the changes of ON => OFF =>
ON with the sensor which detects a full rotation of the supply ON with the sensor which detects a full rotation of the supply
screw within the specified period of time. screw within the specified period of time.
Remedy 1. Check the damage of the Developing Coupling. Remedy 1. Check the damage of the Developing Coupling.
If it’s damaged, replace the Developing Assembly. If it’s damaged, replace the Developing Assembly.
2. Check the damage of the coupling (with the Developing 2. Check the damage of the coupling (with the Developing
Assembly) at the Host Machine side. Assembly) at the Host Machine side.
If it’s damaged, remove the Main Drive Unit to replace the If it’s damaged, remove the Main Drive Unit to replace the
coupling. coupling.
3. Turn the motor as a single unit while the Drum/Developing 3. Turn the motor as a single unit while the Drum/Developing
Assembly is removed to check rotation of the Main Drive Assembly is removed to check rotation of the Main Drive
Unit. Unit.
If it does not rotate, replace the Motor. If it does not rotate, replace the Motor.
If the above measures do not solve the problem, replace the If the above measures do not solve the problem, replace the
Drum Driver PCB (UN4). Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
If there still remains the problem, replace the Main Drive If there still remains the problem, replace the Main Drive
Unit. Unit.
4. Remove the Hopper Unit and manually turn the Supply 4. Remove the Hopper Unit and manually turn the Supply
Input Gear to check rotation. Input Gear to check rotation.
If it’s results in NG, replace the Hopper Unit. If it’s results in NG, replace the Hopper Unit.
E027 0300 05 Title Error in supply with C Developing Assembly E032 0001 05 Title ASSIST Counter failed to work
Description Failure in detection about the changes of ON => OFF => Description Detection of short-circuit with the Count Pulse Signal
ON with the sensor which detects a full rotation of the supply Remedy Check the cable (to see if it’s disconnected)
screw within the specified period of time. E045 0000 05 Title Error in Transparency Sensor
Remedy 1. Check the damage of the Developing Coupling. Description When the power is ON or the door is closed, the light failed
If it’s damaged, replace the Developing Assembly. to be back although there is no paper.
2. Check the damage of the coupling (with the Developing Remedy 1. Check installation or soil of the Transparency Sensor
Assembly) at the Host Machine side. (UN51) and the prism.
If it’s damaged, remove the Main Drive Unit to replace the 2. Check the Sensor Harness (to see if the harness is
coupling. caught, disconnected or physically removed).
3. Turn the motor as a single unit while the Drum/Developing 3. Replace the Transparency Sensor.
Assembly is removed to check rotation of the Main Drive 4. Replace the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2).
Unit. E061 0001 05 Title Abnormal current run to the Y Drum (small current level or
If it does not rotate, replace the Motor. no drum is found)
If the above measures do not solve the problem, replace the
Description Abnormal current run to the Y Drum (small current level or
Drum Driver PCB (UN4).
no drum is found)
If there still remains the problem, replace the Main Drive
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit.
Unit.
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum
4. Remove the Hopper Unit and manually turn the Supply
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate
Input Gear to check rotation.
at the contact point).
If it’s results in NG, replace the Hopper Unit.
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum
at Process Unit side.
4. Replace the Drum Unit.
5. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN23,UN24).

7-28
7
7
7-29
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E061 00E0 05 Title Abnormal current run to the Y Drum (small current level or E061 0101 05 Title Abnormal current run to the M Drum (small current level or
no drum is found) no drum is found)
Description The change in current level for Y Drum film thickness Description Abnormal current run to the M Drum (small current level or
detection is too much compared to the previous time. no drum is found)
Remedy 1. Check with the Host Machine which generates an error Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit.
to check if a wrong cartridge (which is different from the 2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum
initialized cartridge) is installed. Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum at the contact point).
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate 3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum
at the contact point) at Process Unit side.
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum 4. Replace the Drum Unit.
at Process Unit side. 5. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN25,UN26).
4. Replace the Drum Unit. E061 01E0 05 Title Abnormal current run to the M Drum (small current level or
5. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN23,UN24). no drum is found)
E061 00F0 05 Title Abnormal current run to the Y Drum (small current level or Description The change in current level for M Drum film thickness
no drum is found) detection is too much compared to the previous time.
Description Abnormal initial current level at the time of initialization of the Remedy 1. Check with the Host Machine which generates an error
Y Drum film thickness (large current level) to check if a wrong cartridge (which is different from the
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit. initialized cartridge) is installed.
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum 2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate
at the contact point). at the contact point)
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum 3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum
at the Process Unit side. at Process Unit side.
4. Forced initialization in Service Mode: COPIER > 4. Replace the Drum Unit.
FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETY: execution of the color 5. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN25,UN26).
causing the error. E061 01F0 05 Title Abnormal current run to the M Drum (small current level or
5. Replace the Drum Unit. no drum is found)
6. Check the primary transfer voltage value (if it’s not Description Abnormal initial current level at the time of initialization of the
appropriate, turn OFF and then ON the main power to M Drum film thickness (large current level)
forcibly execute the ATVC control). Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit.
E061 00F1 05 Title Abnormal current run to the Y Drum (small current level or 2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum
no drum is found) Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate
Description Abnormal initial current level at the time of initialization of the at the contact point).
Y Drum film thickness (small current level) 3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit. at the Process Unit side.
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum 4. Forced initialization in Service Mode: COPIER >
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETM: execution of the color
at the contact point). causing the error.
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum 5. Replace the Drum Unit.
at Process Unit side. 6. Check the primary transfer voltage value (if it’s not
4. Forced initialization in Service Mode: COPIER > appropriate, turn OFF and then ON the main power to
FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETY: execution of the color forcibly execute the ATVC control).
causing the error)
5. Replace the Drum Unit.
6. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN23,UN24).

7-29
7
7
7-30
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E061 01F1 05 Title Abnormal current run to the M Drum (small current level or E061 02F0 05 Title Abnormal current run to the C Drum (small current level or
no drum is found) no drum is found)
Description Abnormal initial current level at the time of initialization of the Description Abnormal initial current level at the time of initialization of the
M Drum film thickness (small current level) C Drum film thickness (large current level)
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit. Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit.
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum 2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate
at the contact point). at the contact point).
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum 3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum
at Process Unit side. at the Process Unit side.
4. Forced initialization in Service Mode: COPIER > 4. Forced initialization in Service Mode: COPIER >
FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETM: execution of the color FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETC: execution of the color
causing the error) causing the error.
5. Replace the Drum Unit. 5. Replace the Drum Unit.
6. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN25,UN26). 6. Check the primary transfer voltage value (if it’s not
E061 0201 05 Title Abnormal current run to the C Drum (small current level or appropriate, turn OFF and then ON the main power to
no drum is found) forcibly execute the ATVC control).
Description Abnormal current run to the C Drum (small current level or E061 02F1 05 Title Abnormal current run to the C Drum (small current level or
no drum is found) no drum is found)
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit. Description Abnormal initial current level at the time of initialization of the
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum C Drum film thickness (small current level)
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit.
at the contact point). 2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate
at Process Unit side. at the contact point).
4. Replace the Drum Unit. 3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum
5. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN27,UN28). at Process Unit side.
E061 02E0 05 Title Abnormal current run to the C Drum (small current level or 4. Forced initialization in Service Mode: COPIER >
no drum is found) FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETC: execution of the color
Description The change in current level for C Drum film thickness causing the error)
detection is too much compared to the previous time. 5. Replace the Drum Unit.
Remedy 1. Check with the Host Machine which generates an error 6. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN27,UN28).
to check if a wrong cartridge (which is different from the E061 0301 05 Title Abnormal current run to the Bk Drum (small current level or
initialized cartridge) is installed. no drum is found)
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum Description Abnormal current run to the Bk Drum (small current level or
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate no drum is found)
at the contact point) Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit.
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum 2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum
at Process Unit side. Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate
4. Replace the Drum Unit. at the contact point).
5. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN27,UN28). 3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum
at Process Unit side.
4. Replace the Drum Unit.
5. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN29,UN30).

7-30
7
7
7-31
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E061 03E0 05 Title Abnormal current run to the Bk Drum (small current level or E074 0001 05 Title Error in disengagement operation
no drum is found) Description Primary Transfer Detachment Sensor 1 failed to be detected
Description The change in current level for Bk Drum film thickness for 2 sec at the time of disengagement operation
detection is too much compared to the previous time. Remedy 1. Check connection of the connector with the ITB Unit.
Remedy 1. Check with the Host Machine which generates an error 2. Replace the ITB Unit.
to check if a wrong cartridge (which is different from the E074 0002 05 Title Error in engagement operation
initialized cartridge) is installed. Description Primary Transfer Detachment Sensor 2 failed to be detected
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum for 2 sec at the time of engagement operation
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate Remedy 1. Check connection of the connector with the ITB Unit.
at the contact point) 2. Replace the ITB Unit.
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum E074 0003 05 Title Error in Sensor
at Process Unit side.
Description Both Primary Transfer Detachment Sensor 1 and 2
4. Replace the Drum Unit.
(PS22,PS23) are detected at the time of engagement/
5. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN29,UN30).
disengagement operation
E061 03F0 05 Title Abnormal current run to the Bk Drum (small current level or
Remedy 1. Check connection of the connector with the ITB Unit.
no drum is found)
2. Replace the ITB Unit.
Description Abnormal initial current level at the time of initialization of the
E075 0002 05 Title Timeout error in searching ITB steering HP
Bk Drum film thickness (large current level)
Description Unable to detect change (Low -> High or High -> Low) of ITB
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit.
Steering Sensor Signal although 10 sec has passed.
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum
Remedy 1. Check disconnection of the ITB Connector.
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate
2. Check disconnection with the ITB (including the inside of
at the contact point).
the ITB Unit).
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum
3. Replace the ITB Unit.
at the Process Unit side.
4. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
4. Forced initialization in Service Mode: COPIER >
E075 0003 05 Title Error in full displacement of ITB (rear)
FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETK: execution of the color
causing the error. Description ITB Displacement Sensor detects full displacement position
5. Replace the Drum Unit. at the rear.
6. Check the primary transfer voltage value (if it’s not Remedy 1. Clear displacement of the ITB (procedures are written
appropriate, turn OFF and then ON the main power to below).
forcibly execute the ATVC control). 2. Replace the ITB Unit.
E061 03F1 05 Title Abnormal current run to the Bk Drum (small current level or
no drum is found) a). Place paper and take out the ITB unit.
b). lift the front left side up (where the cleaner and the motor
Description Abnormal initial current level at the time of initialization of the
are located) and hold the ITB Unit as if to twist it.
Bk Drum film thickness (small current level)
c). Turn the Motor counterclockwise as it to make 2 to 3
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Drum Unit.
round of the ITB.
2. Check if there is failure in grounding contact at the Drum
d).As the ITB is getting closer to the center, fit the marking
Unit side (such as loosened screw which secures the plate
line with the edge of the ITB.
at the contact point).
3. Check if there is failure in grounding contact with the Drum
MEMO
at Process Unit side.
This symptom likely to occur if the machine is NOT installed
4. Forced initialization in Service Mode: COPIER >
on the level (the left-rear is higher). Check if the machine is
FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETK: execution of the color
installed on the level.
causing the error)
If this problem still occurs, replace the ITB Unit.
5. Replace the Drum Unit.
6. Replace the Pre-exposure LED PCB (UN29,UN30).

7-31
7
7
7-32
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E075 0004 05 Title Error in combination of ITB Displacement Sensors E100 0300 05 Title BD error of CBk-side Scanner
Description Failed to determine position due to combination of the ITB Description Failure in detection of BD signal even though the specified
Displacement Sensors (PS25 - PS28) (faulty sensor) period of time has passed when Laser Scanner Unit 2 (CBk
Remedy 1. Check disconnection of the ITB Connector. laser) is started or making prints.
2. Check disconnection with the ITB (including the inside of Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
the ITB Unit). 2. Check the connector of Laser Scanner Unit 2.
3. Replace the ITB Unit. 3. Replace Laser Scanner Unit 2.
4. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1). E100 B000 05 Title BD cycle error
E075 0005 05 Title Error/failure in searching ITB steering HP Description When the BD cycle count value is not within the specified
Description Failed to detect correct HP position although the change (Low range.
-> High or High -> Low) of the ITB Steering Sensor Signal Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
can be detected (execute retry twice) 2. Check connection of harness on the Laser Scanner Unit.
Remedy 1. Check disconnection of the ITB Connector. 3. Replace the Laser Scanner Unit.
2. Check disconnection with the ITB (including the inside of 4. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
the ITB Unit). 5. Replace the harness.
3. Replace the ITB Unit. E102 0101 05 Title Faulty EEPROM of YM-side Scanner
4. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1). Description In the case of an error in reading EEPROM in the Laser
E075 0103 05 Title Error in full displacement of ITB (front) Driver (YM) or in the case of a wrong Laser Scanner Unit
Description ITB Displacement Sensor detects full displacement position which does not match with the Host Machine.
at the front. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Remedy 1. Clear displacement of the ITB (procedures are written 2. Check the connector of the Laser Scanner Unit 1
below) 3. Replace the Laser Scanner Unit 1.
2. Replace the ITB Unit. E102 0301 05 Title Faulty EEPROM of CBk-side Scanner
Description In the case of an error in reading EEPROM of the Laser
a). Place paper and take out the ITB Unit. Driver (CBk), in the case of failure in reading the correct
b). Lift the rear left side up (where the cleaner is located; information (laser, etc.) from EEPROM, or in the case of a
opposite to the motor) and hold the ITB Unit as if to twist it. wrong Laser Scanner which does not match with the Host
c). Turn the Motor counterclockwise as if to make 2 to 3 Machine.
round of the ITB. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
d). As the ITB is getting closer to the center, fit the marking 2. Check the connector of Laser Scanner Unit 2.
line with the edge of the ITB. 3. Replace Laser Scanner Unit 2.
E110 0100 05 Title Error in Polygon Motor of YM-side Scanner (BD lock failed)
MEMO
Description In the case of failure in detecting FG signal although the
This symptom likely to occur if the machine is NOT installed
specified period of time has passed after the Scanner Motor
on the level (the left-front is higher). Check if the machine is
of Laser Scanner Unit 1 (YM laser) was started.
installed on the level.
Remedy 1. Check the connector of Laser Scanner Unit 1.
If this problem still occurs, replace the ITB Unit.
2. Replace Laser Scanner Unit 1.
E100 0100 05 Title BD error of YM-side Scanner
E110 0300 05 Title Error in Polygon Motor of CBk-side Scanner (BD lock failed)
Description Failure in detection of BD signal even though the specified
Description In the case of failure in detecting FG signal although the
period of time has passed when Laser Scanner Unit 1 (YM
specified period of time has passed after the Scanner Motor
laser) is started or making prints.
of Laser Scanner Unit 2 (CBk laser) was started.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Remedy 1. Check the connector of Laser Scanner Unit 2.
2. Check the connector of Laser Scanner Unit 1
2. Replace Laser Scanner Unit 2.
3. Replace Laser Scanner Unit 1.

7-32
7
7
7-33
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E110 0101 05 Title Error in Polygon Motor of YM-side Scanner (unreached E193 0X01 05 Title Error in IMG2 (In X, 0 to 2 is applied. Each one shows IC on
speed) the DC Controller.)
Description In the case of failure in detecting FG signal while the Description Failure of LSI timing adjustment circuit on the DC Controller
Scanner Motor of Laser Scanner Unit 1 (YM laser) is stably PCB.
rotating. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. 2. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN2).
2. Check the connector of Laser Scanner Unit 1 E197 0X00 05 Title Error in communication of HOB DMA mode (In X, 0 to 2 is
3. Replace Laser Scanner Unit 1. applied. Each one shows IC on the DC Controller.)
E110 0301 05 Title Error in Polygon Motor of CBk-side Scanner (unreached Description Communication failure between CPU and LSI on the DC
speed) Controller.
Description In the case of failure in detecting FG signal while the Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Scanner Motor of Laser Scanner Unit 2 (CBk laser). 2. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. E197 0X01 05 Title Error in communication of HOB single-shot mode (In X, 0 to
2. Check the connector of Laser Scanner Unit 2. 2 is applied. Each one shows IC on the DC Controller.)
3. Replace Laser Scanner Unit 2. Description Communication failure between CPU and LSI on the DC
E112 0000 05 Title Error in Dustproof Shutter Controller PCB (UN1).
Description Failed to be at HP when it’s open (when the Job is started). Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Dustproof Shutter Drive. 2. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
2. Check if the connector of the Laser Shutter Sensor (PS29) E197 0X02 05 Title Error in communication of HOB single-shot mode (In X, 0 to
or the Laser Shutter Motor (M27) is removed (disconnected). 2 is applied. Each one shows IC on the DC Controller.)
3. Check the status of Sensor Flag. Description Communication failure between CPU and LSI on the DC
4. Replace the HP Sensor, Replace the Laser Shutter Motor Controller PCB (UN1).
(M27). Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
E112 0001 05 Title Error in Dustproof Shutter 2. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
Description Failure to be back to the HP although the specified period of E197 0X03 05 Title Timeout error in HOB single-shot mode (In X, 0 to 2 is
time has passed when closing. applied. Each one shows IC on the DC Controller.)
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Dustproof Shutter Drive. Description Communication failure between CPU and LSI on the DC
2. Check if the connector of the Laser Shutter Sensor (PS29) Controller PCB (UN1).
or the Laser Shutter Motor (M27) is removed (disconnected). Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
3. Check the status of Sensor Flag. 2. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
4. Replace the HP Sensor, Replace the Laser Shutter Motor E197 0X80 05 Title Timeout error in EHOB transmission-waiting (In X, 0 to 2 is
(M27). applied. Each one shows IC on the DC Controller.)
E112 0002 05 Title Error in Dustproof Shutter Description Communication failure between the DC Controller PCB (UN1)
Description Failed to move from the HP when opening (the Job is and Laser Scanner Unit.
started) Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Remedy 1. Check installation of the Dustproof Shutter Drive. 2. Check connection of harness on the target color side (YM/
2. Check if the connector of the Laser Shutter Sensor (PS29) CK).
or the Laser Shutter Motor (M27) is removed (disconnected). 3. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
3. Check the status of Sensor Flag. 4. Replace the Laser Scanner Unit.
4. Replace the HP Sensor, Replace the Laser Shutter Motor 5. Replace the harness on the target color side (YM/CK).
(M27).

7-33
7
7
7-34
Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code
E197 0X81 05 Title Timeout error in EHOB reception-waiting (In X, 0 to 2 is
applied. Each one shows IC on the DC Controller.)
Description Communication failure between the DC Controller PCB (UN1)
and Laser Scanner Unit.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
2. Check connection of harness on the target color side (YM/
CK).
3. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
4. Replace the Laser Scanner Unit.
5. Replace the harness on the target color side (YM/CK).
E197 0XA0 05 Title Timeout error in HOB transmission-waiting (In X, 0 to 2 is
applied. Each one shows IC on the DC Controller.)
Description Communication failure between CPU and LSI on the DC
Controller PCB (UN1).
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
2. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
E197 0XB0 05 Title Timeout error in HOB reception-waiting (In X, 0 to 2 is
applied. Each one shows IC on the DC Controller.)
Description Communication failure between CPU and LSI on the DC
Controller PCB (UN1).
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
2. Replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1).
T-7-4

7-34
7
7
7-35
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E202 0001 04 Title Scanner HP error E227 0001 04 Title Power supply (24V) error
Description Scanner Unit error when moving to the left side for HP Description 24V port error when the power is turned ON
check operation Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. 2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and
2.Check the drive of Scanner Motor. (Open the DF Unit to check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
check the operation of Motor.) 3. Check the 24V port of the Reader Controller PCB and DF
3. Check the flag position of Scanner Home Position Sensor Driver PCB.
and Scanner Unit. 4. Check the power supply and Relay PCB on the Printer
4.Replace the Reader Controller PCB. side.
E202 0002 04 Title Scanner HP error 5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB and DF Driver PCB.
Description Scanner Unit error when moving to the right side for HP E227 0002 04 Title Power supply (24V) error
check operation Description 24V port error when a job is started
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
2. Check the drive of Scanner Motor. (Open the DF Unit to 2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and
check the operation of Motor.) check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
3. Check the flag position of Scanner Home Position Sensor 3. Check the 24V port of the Reader Controller PCB and DF
and Scanner Unit. Driver PCB.
4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. 4. Check the power supply and Relay PCB on the Printer
E202 0101 04 Title Glass HP error side.
* This error occurs on Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB and DF Driver PCB.
only. E227 0003 04 Title Power supply (24V) error
Description Glass error when moving to the left side for HP check Description 24V port error when a job is ended
operation Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
2.Check the drive of Glass Shifting Motor. (Set the service 3. Check the 24V port of the Reader Controller PCB and DF
mode: FEEDER > FUNCTION > MTR-CHK > 7. Then, set Driver PCB.
FEEDER > FUNCTION > MTR-ON.) 4. Check the power supply and Relay PCB on the Printer
3. Check the flag position of Scanner Home Position Sensor side.
and Scanner Unit. 5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB and DF Driver PCB.
4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. E227 0004 04 Title Power supply (24V) error
E202 0102 04 Title Glass HP error Description 24V port error when loading
* This error occurs on Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
only. 2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and
Description Glass error when moving to the right side for HP check check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
operation 3. Check the 24V port of the Reader Controller PCB and DF
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. Driver PCB.
2. Check the drive of Glass Shifting Motor. (Set the service 4. Check the power supply and Relay PCB on the Printer
mode: FEEDER > FUNCTION > MTR-CHK > 7. Then, set side.
FEEDER > FUNCTION > MTR-ON.) 5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB and DF Driver PCB.
3. Check the flag position of Scanner Home Position Sensor
and Scanner Unit.
4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.

7-35
7
7
7-36
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E227 0101 04 Title Power supply (24V) error E240 0002 05 Title 3 minutes has passed since the status remained to be
Description 24V port error when the power of DF Unit is turned ON waiting for image output request
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. Description No response after 3 minutes has passed since the image
2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and output request from the Main Controller to the DC Controller
check that the Cable is not open-circuit. during printing.
3. Check the 24V port of the Reader Controller PCB and DF Remedy Check connection of the connector.
Driver PCB. Check connection of the Sub PCB in the Controller Box.
4. Check the power supply and Relay PCB on the Printer Check connection and replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)/
side. Main Controller PCB 1.
5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB and DF Driver PCB. E240 0003 05 Title Keep on rotating after the jam (engine bug)
E227 0102 04 Title Power supply (24V) error Description Engine keeps rotating when jam occurs.
Description 24V port error when a job is started in the DF Unit Remedy Check connection of the connector.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. Check connection of the Sub PCB in the Controller Box.
2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and Check connection and replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)/
check that the Cable is not open-circuit. Main Controller PCB 1.
3. Check the 24V port of the Reader Controller PCB and DF E240 0004 05 Title Error in controller communication
Driver PCB. Description No response after 1.5 minutes has passed since the print
4. Check the power supply and Relay PCB on the Printer request from the Main Controller to the DC Controller.
side. Remedy Check connection of the connector.
5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB and DF Driver PCB. Check connection of the Sub PCB in the Controller Box.
E227 0103 04 Title Power supply (24V) error Check connection and replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)/
Description 24V port error when a job is ended in the DF Unit Main Controller PCB 1.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. E240 0005 05 Title Timeout error in Dhalf request
2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and Description No response after 1.5 minutes has passed since the auto
check that the Cable is not open-circuit. adjustment request from the Main Controller to the DC
3. Check the 24V port of the Reader Controller PCB and DF Controller.
Driver PCB. Remedy Check connection of the connector.
4. Check the power supply and Relay PCB on the Printer Check connection of the Sub PCB in the Controller Box.
side. Check connection and replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)/
5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB and DF Driver PCB. Main Controller PCB 1.
E240 0000 05 Title Error in communication data E246 0001 05 Title System error
Description When communication data error between the controller and Description System error
DC Controller PCB is detected. Remedy Contact the service company office
Remedy Check connection of the connector. E246 0002 05 Title System error
Check connection of the Sub PCB in the Controller Box.
Description System error
Check connection and replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)/
Remedy Contact the service company office
Main Controller PCB.
E246 0003 05 Title System error
E240 0001 05 Title 3 minutes has passed since the status remained to be
Description System error
waiting for pickup request
Remedy Contact the service company office
Description No response after 3 minutes has passed since the pickup
request from the Main Controller to the DC Controller during E246 0005 05 Title System error
printing. Description System error
Remedy Check connection of the connector. Remedy Contact the service company office
Check connection of the Sub PCB in the Controller Box. E247 0001 05 Title System error
Check connection and replace the DC Controller PCB (UN1)/ Description System error
Main Controller PCB 1. Remedy Contact the service company office

7-36
7
7
7-37
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E248 0001 04 Title EEPROM error E270 0101 04 Title Scanner Unit (Paper Back) VSYNC signal error
Description Failure of power-on at EEPROM for the reader controller * This error occurs on Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1
PCB (PCB1) only.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. Description Due to the VSYNC error in the Scanner Unit PCB (Paper
2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and Back) which communicates with Reader Controller PCB,
check that the Cable is not open-circuit. VSYNC signal is not sent appropriately, so the image error
3. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. occurs or the operation stops abnormally.
E248 0002 04 Title EEPROM error Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Description Failure of writing at EEPROM for the reader controller PCB 2. Check the connection between Reader Controller PCB
(PCB1) and Scanner Unit PCB (Paper Back), and check that the
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. Cable is not open-circuit.
2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and 3. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and
check that the Cable is not open-circuit. check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
3. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. 4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.
E248 0003 04 Title EEPROM error 5. Replace the Scanner Unit (Paper Back).
Description Failure of reading after writing at EEPROM for the reader E280 0001 04 Title Communication error between Reader Controller PCB and
controller PCB (PCB1) Scanner Unit (Paper Front)
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. Description Within specified time, communication between Reader
2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and Controller PCB and Scanner Unit (Paper Front) cannot be
check that the Cable is not open-circuit. made.
3. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
E270 0001 04 Title Scanner Unit (Paper Front) VSYNC signal error 2. Check the connection between Reader Controller PCB
and Scanner Unit PCB (Paper Front), and check that the
Description Due to the VSYNC error in the Scanner Unit PCB (Paper
Cable is not open-circuit.
Front) which communicates with Reader Controller PCB,
3. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and
VSYNC signal is not sent appropriately, so the image error
check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
occurs or the operation stops abnormally.
4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
5. Replace the Scanner Unit (Paper Front).
2. Check the connection between Reader Controller PCB
E280 0101 04 Title Communication error between Reader Controller PCB and
and Scanner Unit PCB (Paper Front), and check that the
Scanner Unit (Paper Back)
Cable is not open-circuit.
* This error occurs on Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1
3. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and
only.
check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. Description Within specified time, communication between Reader
5. Replace the Scanner Unit (Paper Front). Controller PCB and Scanner Unit (Paper Back) cannot be
made.
E270 0002 04 Title DDI HSYNC error
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Description Due to the DDI hardware HSYNC signal error, VSYNC
2. Check the connection between Reader Controller PCB
signal is not sent appropriately, so the image error occurs or
and Scanner Unit PCB (Paper Back), and check that the
the operation stops abnormally.
Cable is not open-circuit.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
3. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and
2. Check the connection between Reader and Printer, and
check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.
3. Replace the DDI-S Cable between Reader and Printer.
5. Replace the Scanner Unit (Paper Back).
4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.

7-37
7
7
7-38
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E302 0001 04 Title Error in paper face shading E350 3000 05 Title System error
Description Error in shading RAM access Description System error
The shading value is out of the specified range. Remedy Contact the service company office
Remedy 1. Check that the LED of the Scanner Unit (Paper Front) is E351 0000 00 Title Main Controller PCB 2 communication error
lit. Description Main Controller PCB 2 communication error.
2. Check the connection between Scanner Unit (Paper Remedy 1. Disconnect and then connect the connector of the Main
Front) and LED, and check that the Cable is not open- Controller PCB 2.
circuit. 2. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2.
3. Check the connection between Reader Controller PCB E354 0001 05 Title System error
and Scanner Unit PCB (Paper Front), and check that the
Description System error
Cable is not open-circuit.
Remedy Contact the service company office
4. Check the condition of Shading White Plate of the Stream
E354 0002 05 Title System error
Read Glass (Paper Front) (scratches, dust, soil, etc.).
5. Check if Scanner Unit (Paper Front) detects HP correctly. Description System error
(If it does not detect correctly, the Scanner Unit reaches to Remedy Contact the service company office
the end when DF is opened.) E355 0001 05 Title System error
6. Replace the Scanner Unit (Paper Front). Description System error
7. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. Remedy Contact the service company office
E302 0101 04 Title Error in paper back shading E355 0002 05 Title System error
Description Error in shading RAM access Description System error
The shading value is out of the specified range. Remedy Contact the service company office
Remedy 1. Check that the LED of the Scanner Unit (Paper Back) is E355 0003 05 Title System error
lit. Description System error
2. Check the connection between Scanner Unit (Paper Remedy Contact the service company office
Back) and LED, and check that the Cable is not open-circuit. E355 0004 05 Title System error
3. Check the connection between Reader Controller PCB
Description System error
and Scanner Unit PCB (Paper Back), and check that the
Remedy Contact the service company office
Cable is not open-circuit.
E400 0001 04 Title Communication error between Reader Controller PCB and
4. Check the condition of Shading White Plate of the
DF Unit
Scanner Glass (Paper Back) (scratches, dust, soil, etc.).
5. Check if Scanner Unit (Paper Back) detects HP correctly. Description Communication checksum error between Reader Controller
6. Replace the Scanner Unit (Paper Back). PCB and DF Unit
7. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
E350 0000 05 Title System error 2. Check the connection between Reader Controller PCB
and DF Driver PCB (Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable),
Description System error
and check that the Cables are not open-circuit.
Remedy Contact the service company office
3. Replace the Cable between Reader Controller PCB and
E350 0001 05 Title System error
DF Driver PCB.
Description System error 4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.
Remedy Contact the service company office 5. Replace the DF Driver PCB.
E350 0002 05 Title System error
Description System error
Remedy Contact the service company office
E350 0003 05 Title System error
Description System error
Remedy Contact the service company office

7-38
7
7
7-39
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E400 0002 04 Title Communication error between Reader Controller PCB and E407 0002 04 Title Tray Lifter Motor error
DF Unit Description Paper Face Detection Sensor when Lifter is being lifted
Description Communication error between Reader Controller PCB and does not become ON within specified time.
DF Unit Remedy 1. Check that after Lifter is lifted fully, it is located in the
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. correct position. (Check the engagement with the Gear.)
2. Check the connection between Reader Controller PCB 2. Check the Tray Lifter Motor, and also check whether
and DF Driver PCB (Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable), shifting operation is performed normally.
and check that the Cables are not open-circuit. 3. Check the connection between Paper Face Detection
3. Replace the Cable between Reader Controller PCB and Sensor and DF Driver PCB, and check that the Cable is not
DF Driver PCB. open-circuit.
4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. 4. Replace the DF Driver PCB.
5. Replace the DF Driver PCB. 5. Replace the Tray Lifter Motor.
E401 0001 04 Title Pickup error E413 0001 04 Title DF Disengagement Motor error
Description Pickup Unit is not returned to the home position. Description Lead Roller 1 disengagement error
Remedy 1. Check that Pickup Unit Lifter HP Sensor flag moves Remedy 1. Open the ADF Front Cover, and then check the operation
smoothly. of active Disengagement Motor.
2. Check the connection between DF Driver PCB and 2. Check the physical position of Disengaging HP Sensor
Pickup Unit Lifter HP Sensor, and check that the Cable is and its flag.
not open-circuit. 3. Check that the Cable of Disengaging HP Sensor is not
3.Check the operation of Pickup Motor. (Set the service open-circuit.
mode: FEEDER > FUNCTION > MTR-CHK > 9. Then, set 4. Replace the DF Driver PCB.
FEEDER > FUNCTION > MTR-ON.) E413 0002 04 Title DF Disengagement Motor error
4. Replace the DF Driver PCB. Description Lead Roller 1 disengagement error
E401 0002 04 Title Pickup error Remedy 1. Open the ADF Front Cover, and then check the operation
Description Pickup Unit does not move from the home position. of active Disengagement Motor.
Remedy 1. Check that Pickup Unit Lifter HP Sensor flag moves 2. Check the physical position of Disengaging HP Sensor
smoothly. and its flag.
2. Check the connection between DF Driver PCB and 3. Check that the Cable of Disengaging HP Sensor is not
Pickup Unit Lifter HP Sensor, and check that the Cable is open-circuit.
not open-circuit. 4. Replace the DF Driver PCB.
3. Check the operation of Pickup Motor. (Set the service E413 0011 04 Title DF Disengagement Motor error
mode: FEEDER > FUNCTION > MTR-CHK > 9. Then, set Description Lead Roller 2 disengagement error
FEEDER > FUNCTION > MTR-ON.) Remedy 1. Open the ADF Front Cover, and then check the operation
4. Replace the DF Driver PCB. of active Disengagement Motor.
E407 0001 04 Title Tray Lifter Motor error 2. Check the physical position of Disengaging HP Sensor
Description Tray HP Sensor does not detect ON or OFF within specified and its flag.
time. 3. Check that the Cable of Disengaging HP Sensor is not
Remedy 1. Check that after Lifter is lifted fully, it is located in the open-circuit.
correct position. (Check the engagement with the Gear.) 4. Replace the DF Driver PCB.
2.Check the connection between Tray HP Sensor and DF
Driver PCB, and check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
3.Check the operation of Tray Lifter Motor.
4. Replace the DF Driver PCB.
5. Replace the Tray Lifter Motor.

7-39
7
7
7-40
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E413 0012 04 Title DF Disengagement Motor error E503 0003 05 Title Communication error
Description Lead Roller 2 disengagement error Description Communication between the Punch Controller and the
Remedy 1. Open the ADF Front Cover, and then check the operation Finisher Controller is suspended.
of active Disengagement Motor. Remedy 1. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and host
2. Check the physical position of Disengaging HP Sensor machine DC Controller PCB (UN1) is faulty.
and its flag. 2. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
3. Check that the Cable of Disengaging HP Sensor is not 3. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
open-circuit. 4. The host machine DC Controller PCB (UN1) is faulty.
4. Replace the DF Driver PCB. E503 0004 05 Title Communication error
E423 0001 04 Title DF Unit SDRAM error Description The communication with the inserter or the folder is
* This error occurs on Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 interrupted.
only. Remedy 1. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and host
Description SDRAM access error machine controller PCB is faulty.
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. 2. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
2. Check the connection between Reader and Controller, 3. The host machine controller PCB is faulty.
and check that the Cable is not open-circuit. E505 0001 05 Title EEPROM error
3. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. Description The checksum for the EEPROM data has an error.
E423 0002 04 Title DF Unit SDRAM error Remedy 1. Failure of Finisher Controller PCB.
* This error occurs on Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 E505 0002 05 Title EEPROM error
only. Description The checksum for the EEPROM data has an error.
Description SDRAM Verify error Remedy 1. An error is detected in the check sum value in EEPROM
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. data on the Punch Controller.
2. Check the connection between Reader and Controller, E514 8001 05 Title Rear end assist home position error
and check that the Cable is not open-circuit.
Description The stapler does not leave the rear end assist home
3. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.
position when the rear end assist motor has been driven for
E490 0001 04 Title Different DF model 3 seconds.
Description Installed DF is not the supported DF. Remedy 1. The rear end assist home position sensor (PI109) is
Remedy 1. Using the service mode, check if the installed DF model faulty.
is the same model which was set in the service mode. 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and rear
2. Check the connection between Reader Controller PCB end assist motor is faulty.
and DF Driver PCB, and check that the Cable is not open- 3. The end assist mechanism is faulty.
circuit. 4. The rear end assist motor (M109) is faulty.
3. Replace the DF Driver PCB. 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
4. Replace the Reader Controller PCB. E514 8002 05 Title Rear end assist home position error
E500 0000 05 Title Communication error Description The stapler does not return to the rear end assist home
Description Communication between the controller of the connected position when the rear end assist motor has been driven for
device and the Finisher Controller is suspended. 3 seconds.
Remedy 1. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. Remedy 1. The rear end assist home position sensor (PI109) is
2. The host machine DC Controller PCB (UN1) is faulty. faulty.
E503 0002 05 Title Communication error 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and rear
Description Communication between the Saddle Controller and the end assist motor is faulty.
Finisher Controller is suspended. 3. The end assist mechanism is faulty.
Remedy 1. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and 4. The rear end assist motor (M109) is faulty.
saddle controller PCB is faulty. 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
2. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
3. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.

7-40
7
7
7-41
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E519 8001 05 Title Gear change home position error E530 8001 05 Title Front aligning plate home position error
Description The gear change home position sensor does not turn OFF Description The aligning plate does not leave the aligningplate front
when the gear change motor has been driven for 387 home position sensor when thealignment plate front motor
pulses. has been driven for 4 seconds.
Remedy 1. The gear change home position sensor (PI117) is faulty. Remedy 1. The front aligning plate home position sensor (PI106) is
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and gear faulty.
change motor is faulty. 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and front
3. The gear change mechanism is faulty. aligning plate motor is faulty.
4. The gear change motor (M110) is faulty. 3. The front aligning plate is faulty.
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 4. The front aligning plate motor (M103) is faulty.
E519 0002 05 Title Gear change home position error 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
Description The gear change home position sensor does not turn ON E530 8002 05 Title Front aligning plate home position error
when the gear change motor has been driven for 387 Description The aligning plate does not return to aligning plate front
pulses. home position sensor when the alignment plate front motor
Remedy 1. The gear change home position sensor (PI117) is faulty. has been driven for 4 seconds.
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and gear Remedy 1. The front aligning plate home position sensor (PI106) is
change motor is faulty. faulty.
3. The gear change mechanism is faulty. 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and front
4. The gear change motor (M110) is faulty. aligning plate motor is faulty.
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 3. The front aligning plate is faulty.
E520 0001 05 Title Shift Motor fails to move from HP 4. The front aligning plate motor (M103) is faulty.
Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
of time and cannot move from HP, it is detected as an error E531 0001 05 Title Stapler Motor fails to move from HP
if the same symptom occurs again after the first retry. Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M4) Connector is physically removed. of time and cannot move from HP, it is detected as an error
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. if the same symptom occurs again after the first retry.
3. Check if the Shift Roller HP Sensor (S2) Connector is Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M10) Connector is physically
physically removed. removed.
4. Check if the Shift Roller HP Sensor (S2) failure occurs. 2. Check if the Motor failure occurs.
E520 0002 05 Title Shift Motor fails to return to HP 3. Check if the Stapler HP Sensor (S18) Connector is
Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period physically removed.
of time and cannot return to HP, it is detected as an error if 4. Check if the Stapler HP Sensor (S18) failure occurs.
the same symptom occurs again after the first retry. E531 0002 05 Title Stapler Motor fails to return to HP
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M4) Connector is physically removed. Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. of time and cannot return to HP, it is detected as an error if
3. Check if the Shift Roller HP Sensor (S2) Connector is the same symptom occurs again after the first retry.
physically removed. Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M10) Connector is physically
4. Check if the Shift Roller HP Sensor (S2) failure occurs. removed.
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs.
3. Check if the Stapler HP Sensor (S18) Connector is
physically removed.
4. Check if the Stapler HP Sensor (S18) failure occurs.

7-41
7
7
7-42
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E531 8001 05 Title Staple home position error E532 8002 05 Title Stapler shift home position error
Description Stapler fails to move from the staple home position although Description The stapler does not return to the stapler shift home position
the Staple Motor is driven for a specified period of time. when the stapler shift motor has been driven for 20 seconds.
Remedy 1. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and Remedy 1. The stapler drive home position sensor (PI110) is faulty.
stapler is faulty. 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and
2. The stapler is faulty. stapler shift motor is faulty.
3. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 3. The stapler shift base is faulty.
E531 8002 05 Title Staple home position error 4. The stapler shift motor (M105) is faulty.
Description Stapler fails to move from the staple home position although 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
the Staple Motor is driven for a specified period of time. E535 8001 05 Title Swing home position error
Remedy 1. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and Description The stapler does not leave the swing home position when
stapler is faulty. the swing motor has been driven for 3 seconds.
2. The stapler is faulty. Remedy 1. The swing home position sensor (PI105) is faulty.
3. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and swing
E532 0001 05 Title STP Move Motor fails to move from HP motor is faulty.
Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period 3. The swing mechanism is faulty.
of time and cannot move from HP, it is detected as an error 4. The swing motor (M106) is faulty.
if the same symptom occurs again after the first retry. 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M1) Connector is physically removed. E535 8002 05 Title Swing home position error
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. Description The stapler does not return to the swing home position
3. Check if the Stapler Move HP Sensor (S10) Connector is when the swing motor has bee driven for 3 seconds.
physically removed. Remedy 1. The swing home position sensor (PI105) is faulty.
4. Check if the Stapler Move HP Sensor (S10) failure 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and swing
occurs. motor is faulty.
E532 0002 05 Title STP Move Motor fails to return to HP 3. The swing mechanism is faulty.
Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period 4. The swing motor (M106) is faulty.
of time and cannot return to HP, it is detected as an error if 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
the same symptom occurs again after the first retry. E537 8001 05 Title Rear aligning plate home position error
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M1) Connector is physically removed. Description The aligning plate does not leave the aligning plate rear
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. home position sensor when the alignment plate rear motor
3. Check if the Stapler Move HP Sensor (S10) Connector is has been driven for 4 seconds.
physically removed. Remedy 1. The aligning plate rear home position sensor (PI107) is
4. Check if the Stapler Move HP Sensor (S10) failure faulty.
occurs. 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and
E532 8001 05 Title Stapler shift home position error aligning plate rear motor is faulty.
Description The stapler does not leave the stapler shifthome position 3. The rear aligning plate is faulty.
when the stapler shift motor hasbeen driven for 5 seconds. 4. The rear aligning plate motor (M104) is faulty.
Remedy 1. The stapler drive home position sensor (PI110) is faulty. 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and
stapler shift motor is faulty.
3. The stapler shift base is faulty.
4. The stapler shift motor (M105) is faulty.
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.

7-42
7
7
7-43
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E537 8002 05 Title Rear aligning plate home position error E540 8002 05 Title Tray 1 shift area error
Description The aligning plate does not return to aligning plate rear Description The dangerous area is reached before the tray 1 paper
home position sensor when the alignment plate rear motor surface sensor detects paper surface during the paper
has been driven for 4 seconds. surface detection operation.
Remedy 1. The aligning plate rear home position sensor (PI107) is A discontinuous area is detected during tray operation.
faulty. Remedy 1. The tray 1 shift area sensor PCB is faulty.
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 1
aligning plate rear motor is faulty. shift motor is faulty.
3. The rear aligning plate is faulty. 3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty.
4. The rear aligning plate motor (M104) is faulty. 4. The tray 1 shift motor (M107) is faulty.
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
E540 0001 05 Title Tray Lift Motor timeout error E540 8003 05 Title Swing guide switch/Staple safety switch error
Description Unable to complete the operation even after the specified Description The swing guide switch or staple safety switch is activated
period of time during initial rotation. When the Motor while the tray is operating.
remains in the same area for the specified period of time Remedy 1. The tray 1 shift area sensor PCB is faulty.
and the same symptom occurs again after the first retry, it is 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 1
detected as an error. shift motor is faulty.
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M11) Connector is physically 3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty.
removed. 4. The tray 1 shift motor (M107) is faulty.
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
3. Check if the Stack Tray Clock Sensor (S14) Connector is E540 8004 05 Title The tray 1 shift motor clock error
physically removed. Description The FG input cannot be detected when the tray 1 shift motor
4. Check if the Stack Tray Clock Sensor (S14) failure has been driven for 0.2 second.
occurs. Remedy 1. The tray 1 shift area sensor PCB is faulty.
E540 0002 05 Title Tray Lift Motor clock error 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 1
Description At initial rotation, when the Tray Lift Motor rotates and clock shift motor is faulty.
input is not detected within the specified period of time, it is 3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty.
detected as an error if the same symptom occurs again after 4. The tray 1 shift motor (M107) is faulty.
the first retry. 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M11) Connector is physically E540 8005 05 Title The tray 1 shift motor speed error
removed. Description The lock detection signal turns OFF 150 ms after the lock
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. detection signal turned ON.
3. Check if the Stack Tray Clock Sensor (S14) Connector is Remedy 1. The tray 1 shift area sensor PCB is faulty.
physically removed. 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 1
4. Check if the Stack Tray Clock Sensor (S14) failure shift motor is faulty.
occurs. 3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty.
E540 8001 05 Title Tray 1 time out error 4. The tray 1 shift motor (M107) is faulty.
Description If the tray does not return to home position when the tray 1 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
shift motor is driven for 25 seconds.
If the tray does not move to other area when tray 1 shift
motor is driven for 5 seconds.
Remedy 1. The tray 1 shift area sensor PCB is faulty.
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 1
shift motor is faulty.
3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty.
4. The tray 1 shift motor (M107) is faulty.
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.

7-43
7
7
7-44
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E540 8006 05 Title The tray 1 shift motor acceleration error E542 8001 05 Title Tray 1 time out error
Description The lock detection signal does not turn ON when the tray 1 Description If the tray does not return to home position when the tray 1
shift motor has been driven for 1 second. shift motor is driven for 25 seconds.
Remedy 1. The tray 1 shift area sensor PCB is faulty. If the tray does not move to other area when tray 2 shift
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 1 motor is driven for 5 seconds.
shift motor is faulty. Remedy 1. The Tray 2 shift area sensor PCB is faulty.
3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty. 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 2
4. The tray 1 shift motor (M107) is faulty. shift motor is faulty.
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty.
E540 8007 05 Title The tray 1 shift motor error 4. The Tray 2 shift motor (M105) is faulty.
Description The lock detection signal does not turn OFF when the tray 1 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
shift motor is at a stop. E542 8002 05 Title Tray 2 shift area error
Remedy 1. The tray 1 shift area sensor PCB is faulty. Description The upper limit area is reached before the tray 2 paper
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 1 surface sensor 1 detects the paper surface during paper
shift motor is faulty. surface detection operation.
3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty. A discontinuous area is detected during tray operation.
4. The tray 1 shift motor (M107) is faulty. During evacuation operation, arrival at the area beyond the
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. tray 2 paper surface sensor 2 is detected before this sensor
E542 0001 05 Title Additional Tray Lift Motor timeout error detects paper surface.
Description Unable to complete the operation even after the specified Remedy 1. The tray 2 shift area sensor PCB is faulty.
period of time during initial rotation. When the Motor 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 2
remains in the same area for the specified period of time shift motor is faulty.
and the same symptom occurs again after the first retry, it is 3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty.
detected as an error. 4. The tray 2 shift motor (M105) is faulty.
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M12) Connector is physically 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
removed. E542 8004 05 Title The tray 2 shift motor clock error
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. Description The FG input cannot be detected when the tray 2 shift motor
3. Check if the Additional Tray Clock Sensor (S23) has been driven for 0.2 second.
Connector is physically removed. Remedy 1. The Tray 2 shift area sensor PCB is faulty.
4. Check if the Additional Tray Clock Sensor (S23) failure 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 2
occurs. shift motor is faulty.
E542 0002 05 Title Additional Tray Lift Motor clock error 3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty.
Description At initial rotation, when the Tray Lift Motor rotates and clock 4. The Tray 2 shift motor (M105) is faulty.
signal is not detected within the specified period of time, it is 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
detected as an error if the same symptom occurs again after E542 8005 05 Title The tray 2 shift motor speed error
the first retry. Description The lock detection signal turns OFF 150 ms after the lock
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M12) Connector is physically detection signal turned ON.
removed. Remedy 1. The tray 2 shift area sensor PCB is faulty.
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. 2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 2
3. Check if the Additional Tray Clock Sensor (S23) shift motor is faulty.
Connector is physically removed. 3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty.
4. Check if the Additional Tray Clock Sensor (S23) failure 4. The tray 2 shift motor (M105) is faulty.
occurs. 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.

7-44
7
7
7-45
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E542 8006 05 Title The tray 2 shift motor acceleration error E56F 0001 05 Title Entrance Roller Release/Stopper HP Motor fails to move
Description The lock detection signal does not turn ON when the tray 2 from HP
shift motor has been driven for 1 second. Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period
Remedy 1. The tray 2 shift area sensor PCB is faulty. of time and cannot move from HP, it is detected as an error
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 2 if the same symptom occurs again after the first retry.
shift motor is faulty. Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M6) Connector is physically removed.
3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty. 2. Check if the Motor failure occurs.
4. The tray 2 shift motor (M105) is faulty. 3. Check if the Entrance Roller Release/Stopper HP Sensor
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. (S5) Connector is physically removed.
E542 8007 05 Title The tray 2 shift motor error 4. Check if the Entrance Roller Release/Stopper HP Sensor
Description The lock detection signal does not turn OFF when the tray 2 (S5) failure occurs.
shift motor is at a stop. E56F 0002 05 Title Entrance Roller Release/Stopper HP Motor fails to return to
Remedy 1. The tray 2 shift area sensor PCB is faulty. HP
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and tray 2 Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period
shift motor is faulty. of time and cannot return to HP, it is detected as an error if
3. The tray up/down mechanism is faulty. the same symptom occurs again after the first retry.
4. The tray 2 shift motor (M105) is faulty. Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M6) Connector is physically removed.
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 2. Check if the Motor failure occurs.
E567 0001 05 Title Shift Roller Release Motor fails to move from HP 3. Check if the Entrance Roller Release/Stopper HP Sensor
Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period (S5) Connector is physically removed.
of time and cannot move from HP, it is detected as an error 4. Check if the Entrance Roller Release/Stopper HP Sensor
if the same symptom occurs again after the first retry. (S5) failure occurs.
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M5) Connector is physically removed. E571 0001 05 Title Gripper Open/Close Motor fails to move from HP
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period
3. Check if the Shift Roller Release Sensor (S3) Connector of time and cannot move from HP, it is detected as an error
is physically removed. if the same symptom occurs again after the first retry.
4. Check if the Shift Roller Release Sensor (S3) failure Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M7) Connector is physically removed.
occurs. 2. Check if the Motor failure occurs.
E567 0002 05 Title Shift Roller Release Motor fails to return to HP 3. Check if the Gripper Arm HP Sensor (S13) Connector is
Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period physically removed.
of time and cannot return to HP, it is detected as an error if 4. Check if the Gripper Unit HP Sensor (S7) failure occurs.
the same symptom occurs again after the first retry. E571 0002 05 Title Gripper Open/Close Motor fails to return to HP
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M5) Connector is physically removed. Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. of time and cannot return to HP, it is detected as an error if
3. Check if the Shift Roller Release Sensor (S3) Connector the same symptom occurs again after the first retry.
is physically removed. Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M7) Connector is physically removed.
4. Check if the Shift Roller Release Sensor (S3) failure 2. Check if the Motor failure occurs.
occurs. 3. Check if the Gripper Arm HP Sensor (S13) Connector is
physically removed.
4. Check if the Gripper Unit HP Sensor (S7) failure occurs.

7-45
7
7
7-46
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E575 0001 05 Title Gripper Unit Move Motor fails to move from HP E590 8001 05 Title Punch home position error
Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period Description The puncher does not detect the punch home position
of time and cannot move from HP, it is detected as an error sensor when the puncher motor has been driven for 20
if the same symptom occurs again after the first retry. msec.
Remedy 1. Check if the Motor (M2) Connector is physically removed. Remedy 1. The punch home position sensor (PI63) and punch motor
2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. clock sensor (PI62) is faulty.
3. Check if the Gripper Unit HP Sensor (S7) Connector is 2. The wiring between the punch controller PCB and sensor
physically removed. is faulty.
4. Check if the Gripper Unit HP Sensor (S7) failure occurs. 3. The punch mechanism is faulty.
E575 0002 05 Title Gripper Unit Move Motor fails to return to HP 4. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
Description At initial rotation, when the Motor rotates for specified period 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
of time and cannot return to HP, it is detected as an error if E590 8002 05 Title Punch home position error
the same symptom occurs again after the first retry. Description After the motor has been stopped at time of punch motor
Assumed 1. Check if the Motor (M2) Connector is physically removed. initialization, the puncher does not detect punch home
cause 2. Check if the Motor failure occurs. position sensor.
3. Check if the Gripper Unit HP Sensor (S7) Connector is Remedy 1. The punch home position sensor (PI63) and punch motor
physically removed. clock sensor (PI62) is faulty.
4. Check if the Gripper Unit HP Sensor (S7) failure occurs. 2. The wiring between the punch controller PCB and sensor
E584 8001 05 Title Shutter home position error is faulty.
Description The stapler does not leave the shutter home position when 3. The punch mechanism is faulty.
the stack ejection motor has been driven for 30 seconds. 4. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
Remedy 1. The shutter home position sensor (PI113) is faulty. 5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and stack E591 8001 05 Title Scrap full detection error
ejection motor, and between the finisher controller PCB and Description The voltage of the light received is 3.0 V or less even when
shutter clutch is faulty. the light emitting duty of the scrap full detector sensor has
3. The shutter mechanism is faulty. been increased to 66% or more.
4. The stack ejection motor (M102), shutter clutch (CL101), Remedy 1. The wiring between the scrap full detector PCB and
ang stack ejection lower roller clutch (CL102) is faulty. punch controller PCB is faulty.
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 2. The scrap full detector PCB is faulty.
E584 0002 05 Title Shutter home position error 3. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
Description The stapler does not return to the shutter home position 4. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
when the stack ejection motor has been driven for 3 E591 8002 05 Title Scrap full detection error
seconds. Description The voltage of the light received is 2.0 V or more even when
Remedy 1. The shutter home position sensor (PI113) is faulty. the light emitting duty of the scrap full detector sensor has
2. The wiring between the finisher controller PCB and stack been decreased to 0%.
ejection motor, and between the finisher controller PCB and Remedy 1. The scrap full detector PCB is faulty.
shutter clutch is faulty. 2. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
3. The shutter mechanism is faulty. 3. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
4. The stack ejection motor (M102), shutter clutch (CL101),
ang stack ejection lower roller clutch (CL102) is faulty.
5. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.

7-46
7
7
7-47
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E592 8001 05 Title Trailing edge sensor error E592 8006 05 Title Horizontal registration sensor 2 error
Description The voltage of the light received is 3.0 V or less even Description The voltage of the light received is 2.0 V or more even when
when the light emitting duty of the trailing edge sensor the light emitting duty of the horizontal registration sensor 2
(LED5,PTR5) has been increased to 66% or more. (LED2,PTR2) has been decreased to 0%.
Remedy 1. The wiring between the LED PCB/photosensor PCB and Remedy 1. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty.
punch controller PCB is faulty. 2. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
2. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty. 3. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
3. The punch controller PCB is faulty. E592 8007 05 Title Horizontal registration sensor 3 error
4. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. Description The voltage of the light received is 2.5 V or less even when
E592 8002 05 Title Trailing edge sensor error the light emitting duty of the horizontal registration sensor 3
Description The voltage of the light received is 2.0 V or more even when (LED3,PTR3) has been increased to 66% or more.
the light emitting duty of the trailing edge sensor has been Remedy 1. The wiring between the LED PCB/photosensor PCB and
decreased to 0%. punch controller PCB is faulty.
Remedy 1. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty. 2. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty.
2. The punch controller PCB is faulty. 3. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
3. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 4. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
E592 8003 05 Title Horizontal registration sensor 1 error E592 8008 05 Title Horizontal registration sensor 3 error
Description The voltage of the light received is 2.5 V or less even when Description The voltage of the light received is 2.0 V or more even when
the light emitting duty of the horizontal registration sensor 1 the light emitting duty of the horizontal registration sensor 3
(LED1,PTR1) has been increased to 66% or more. (LED3,PTR3) has been decreased to 0%.
Remedy 1. The wiring between the LED PCB/photosensor PCB and Remedy 1. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty.
punch controller PCB is faulty. 2. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
2. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty. 3. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
3. The punch controller PCB is faulty. E592 8009 05 Title Horizontal registration sensor 4 error
4. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. Description The voltage of the light received is 2.5 V or less even when
E592 8004 05 Title Horizontal registration sensor 1 error the light emitting duty of the horizontal registration sensor 4
Description The voltage of the light received is 2.0 V or more even when (LED4,PTR4) has been increased to 66% or more.
the light emitting duty of the horizontal registration sensor 1 Remedy 1. The wiring between the LED PCB/photosensor PCB and
(LED1,PTR1) has been decreased to 0%. punch controller PCB is faulty.
Remedy 1. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty. 2. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty.
2. The punch controller PCB is faulty. 3. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
3. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 4. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
E592 8005 05 Title Horizontal registration sensor 2 error E592 800A 05 Title Horizontal registration sensor 4 error
Description The voltage of the light received is 2.5 V or less even when Description The voltage of the light received is 2.0 V or more even when
the light emitting duty of the horizontal registration sensor 2 the light emitting duty of the horizontal registration sensor 4
(LED2,PTR2) has been increased to 66% or more. (LED4,PTR4) has been decreased to 0%.
Remedy 1. The wiring between the LED PCB/photosensor PCB and Remedy 1. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty.
punch controller PCB is faulty. 2. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
2. The LED PCB and photosensor PCB is faulty. 3. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.
3. The punch controller PCB is faulty.
4. The finisher controller PCB is faulty.

7-47
7
7
7-48
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E593 8001 05 Title Horizontal registration home position error E5F1 8001 05 Title Paper folding motor lock error
Description At time of horizontal registration motor initialization, the Description The feed speed of the paper fold roller reaches 5 mm/sec or
punch slide unit does not leave the horizontal home position less.
sensor even when it has been driven for 9 mm. Remedy 1. The paper folding motor clock sensor (PI4) and paper
Remedy 1. The horizontal registration home position (PI61) is faulty. folding home position sensor (PI21. is faulty.
2. The wiring between the punch controller PCB and sensor 2. The paper folding roller drive mechanism is faulty.
is faulty. 3. The paper folding motor (M2) is faulty.
3. The horizontal registration mechanism is faulty. 4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
4. The horizontal registration motor (M62) is faulty. E5F1 8002 05 Title Paper positioning plate home position error
5. The punch controller PCB is faulty. Description The status of Paper Fold Home Position Sensor does
6. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. not change although the Paper Fold Motor is driven for a
E593 8002 05 Title Horizontal registration home position error specified period of time.
Description At time of horizontal registration motor initialization, the Remedy 1. The paper folding motor clock sensor (PI4) and paper
punch slide unit does not return to the horizontal registration folding home position sensor (PI21) is faulty.
home position sensor even when the unit has been driven 2. The paper folding roller drive mechanism is faulty.
for 37 mm. 3. The paper folding motor (M2) is faulty.
Remedy 1. The horizontal registration home position (PI61) is faulty. 4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
2. The wiring between the punch controller PCB and sensor E5F2 8001 05 Title Guide home position error
is faulty. Description The guide home position sensor does not turn ON when the
3. The horizontal registration mechanism is faulty. guide motor has been driven for 700 pulses.
4. The horizontal registration motor (M62) is faulty. Remedy 1. The guide home position sensor (PI13) is faulty.
5. The punch controller PCB is faulty. 2. The guide plate drive mechanism is faulty.
6. The finisher controller PCB is faulty. 3. The guide Motor (M3) is faulty.
E5F0 8001 05 Title Paper positioning plate home position error 4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
Description The paper positioning plate home positio sensor does not E5F2 8002 05 Title Guide home position error
turn ON when the paper positioning plate motor has been Description The guide home position sensor does not turn OFF when
driven for 1500 pulses. the guide motor has been driven for 50 pulses.
Remedy 1. The paper positioning plate home position sensor (PI7) is Remedy 1. The guide home position sensor (PI13) is faulty.
faulty. 2. The guide plate drive mechanism is faulty.
2. The positioning plate drive mechanism is faulty. 3. The guide Motor (M3) is faulty.
3. The paper positioning plate motor (M4) is faulty. 4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty. E5F3 8001 05 Title Aligning plate home position error
E5F0 8002 05 Title Paper positioning plate home position error Description The aligning plate home position sensor does not turn ON
Description The paper positioning plate home position sensor does not when the aligning plate motor has been driven for 500
turn OFF when the paper positioning plate motor has been pulses.
driven for 300 pulses. Remedy 1. The aligning plate home position sensor (PI5) is faulty.
Remedy 1. The paper positioning plate home position sensor (PI7) is 2. The aligning plate drive mechanism is faulty.
faulty. 3. The aligning motor (M5) is faulty.
2. The positioning plate drive mechanism is faulty. 4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
3. The paper positioning plate motor (M4) is faulty. E5F3 8002 05 Title Aligning plate home position error
4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
Description The aligning plate home position sensor does not turn OFF
when the aligning plate motor has been driven for 50 pulses.
Remedy 1. The aligning plate home position sensor (PI5) is faulty.
2. The aligning plate drive mechanism is faulty.
3. The aligning motor (M5) is faulty.
4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.

7-48
7
7
7-49
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E5F4 8001 05 Title Stitcher (rear) home position error E5F6 8003 05 Title Paper pushing plate motor clock error
Description The stitching home position sensor does not turn ON when Description The number of pulses detected by the paper pushing plate
the stitch motor (rear) has been driven backward for 0.5 sec. motor clock sensor is 6 pulses or less.
Remedy 1. The stitcher home position sensor (rear) (SW5) is faulty. Remedy 1. The paper pushing plate home position sensor (PI14),
2. The stitcher (rear) is faulty. paper pushing plate top position sensor (PI15), and paper
3. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty. pushing plate motor clock sensor (PI1) is faulty.
E5F4 8002 05 Title Stitcher (rear) home position error 2. The paper pushing plate drive mechanism is faulty.
Description The stitching home position sensor does not turn OFF when 3. The paper pushing plate motor (M8) is faulty.
the stitch motor (rear) has been driven forward for 0.5 sec. 4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
Remedy 1. The stitcher home position sensor (rear) (SW5) is faulty. E5F6 8004 05 Title Pushing position error
2. The stitcher (rear) is faulty. Description The paper pushing plate leading edge position sensor does
3. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty. not turn ON when the paper pushing plate motor has been
E5F5 8001 05 Title Stitcher (front) home position error driven for 0.1 sec.
Description The stitching home position sensor does not turn ON when Remedy 1. The paper pushing plate home position sensor (PI14),
the stitch motor (front) has been driven forward for 0.5 sec. paper pushing plate top position sensor (PI15), and paper
Remedy 1. The stitcher home position sensor (front) (SW7) is faulty. pushing plate motor clock sensor (PI1) is faulty.
2. The stitcher (front) is faulty. 2. The paper pushing plate drive mechanism is faulty.
3. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty. 3. The paper pushing plate motor (M8) is faulty.
E5F5 8002 05 Title Stitcher (front) home position error 4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
Description The stitching home position sensor does not turn OFF when E5F6 8005 05 Title Pushing position error
the stitch motor (front) has been driven backward for 0.5 Description The paper pushing plate leading edge position sensor does
sec. not turn OFF when the paper pushing plate motor has been
Remedy 1. The stitcher home position sensor (front) (SW7) is faulty. driven for 0.5 sec.
2. The stitcher (front) is faulty. Remedy 1. The paper pushing plate home position sensor (PI14),
3. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty. paper pushing plate top position sensor (PI15), and paper
E5F6 8001 05 Title Paper pushing plate home position error pushing plate motor clock sensor (PI1) is faulty.
2. The paper pushing plate drive mechanism is faulty.
Description The paper pushing plate home position sensor does not turn
3. The paper pushing plate motor (M8) is faulty.
ON when the paper pushing plate motor has been driven for
4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
0.5 sec.
T-7-5
Remedy 1. The paper pushing plate home position sensor (PI14),
paper pushing plate top position sensor (PI15), and paper
pushing plate motor clock sensor (PI1) is faulty.
2. The paper pushing plate drive mechanism is faulty.
3. The paper pushing plate motor (M8) is faulty.
4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.
E5F6 8002 05 Title Paper pushing plate home position error
Description The paper pushing plate home position sensor does not turn
OFF when the paper pushing plate motor has been driven
for 150 ms.
Remedy 1. The paper pushing plate home position sensor (PI14),
paper pushing plate top position sensor (PI15), and paper
pushing plate motor clock sensor (PI1) is faulty.
2. The paper pushing plate drive mechanism is faulty.
3. The paper pushing plate motor (M8) is faulty.
4. The saddle stitcher controller PCB is faulty.

7-49
7
7
7-50
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0001 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0006 00 Title Error in HDD
Description HDD failed to be recognized. Startup partition (BOOTDEV) Description There is no system for the sub CPU
failed to be found at startup. Remedy Reinstall the system software. For details, see “Chapter 6:
Remedy 1. Turn OFF the main switch and check connection of HDD Upgrading”.
cable, and then turn ON the main switch. For your reference, the method using USB memory is
2. Be sure that HDD spins stably (no problem in drive sound) described below.
and 5V/12V power is supplied when the main power is turned 1. Prepare the USB memory which system software was
ON. registered.
3. If the above measures do not solve the problem, replace 2. Execute the following service mode:
the HDD and reinstall the system. If there still remains the COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM>DOWNLOAD to enter the
problem, replace the Main Controller PCB 1. download mode. (When it is not operated normally, start the
E602 0002 00 Title Error in HDD safe mode.)
Description There is no system for the main CPU 3. Insert the USB memory to the equipment.
Remedy 1. Start in Safe Mode, then perform overall format using SST 4. Execute [3]: Upgrade (Overwrite All) in the main menu. (Be
or USB momory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF sure to download SYSTEM, LANGUAGE and RUI.)
and then ON the Main Switch.(Prepare the USB memory 5. System software is downloaded and the machine restarts
which system software was registered. Insert the USB automatically. At this time, if the machine restarts with the
memory to the equipment. Execute [3]: Upgrade (Overwrite safe mode, E753 might occurs. Check the log. In case of the
All) in the main menu.) system software of the options which are not connected, turn
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be OFF and then ON the power supply to restore. (For details,
caused by failure with HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and see the description for E753.)
reinstall the system.
E602 0003 00 Title Error in HDD If the measures above do not solve the problem, replace the
HDD and download the system software with the foregoing
Description WriteAbort was detected with BootDevice
method.
Remedy 1. Execute detection and recovery of WriteAbortSector
E602 0007 00 Title Error in HDD
<In the case of display of B/W E-code>
1-1. Perform the following steps because Service Mode is Description There is no ICCProfile
not available. Remedy 1. Start up in Safe Mode and reinstall the system using SST;
1-2. Turn OFF the power. Then, while pressing 1+9 keys, and then turn OFF and then ON the main power switch.
turn ON the power. WriteAbortSector recovery routine is 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
automatically started which makes the screen black. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
1-3. After a while, progress is displayed because the process and reinstall the system.
takes time (40 to 50 min.). The process is complete when E602 0009 00 Title Error in HDD
the screen turns white. Description There is no Font file in /BOOTDEV/BOOT
<In the case of official display of wrench-mark> Remedy 1. Start up in Safe Mode and reinstall the system using SST;
1-1. Set as follows: CHK-TYPE=0; and execute HD-CHECK and then turn OFF and then ON the main power switch.
(40 to 50 min.), and then turn OFF and then ON the main 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
switch. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start up and reinstall the system.
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB E602 0012 00 Title Error in HDD
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Description There is no file in which the Web browser refers to
then ON the main switch. Remedy 1. Start up in Safe Mode and reinstall the Web browser using
3. If no improvement is found despite the above measures, SST, and then turn OFF and then ON the main power switch.
it can be caused by failure with HDD; therefore, replace the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
HDD and reinstall the system. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system.

7-50
7
7
7-51
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0100 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0104 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
then ON the Main Power Switch. then ON the Main Power Switch.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system. the system.
E602 0101 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0105 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description Error in file system
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB Main Switch.
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
then ON the Main Power Switch. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by and reinstall the system.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall E602 0110 00 Title Error in HDD
the system. Description System error or Packet data error
E602 0102 00 Title Error in HDD Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Description Failure in contact with HDD 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start Main Power Switch.
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
then ON the Main Power Switch. and reinstall the system.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by E602 0112 00 Title Error in HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall Description System error or Packet data error
the system. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
E602 0103 00 Title Error in HDD 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Description WriteAbort (at startup) reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to Main Power Switch.
execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter and reinstall the system.
the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD-
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch.

7-51
7
7
7-52
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0113 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0124 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
damaged. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Main Power Switch.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the and reinstall the system.
applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD- E602 0125 00 Title Error in HDD
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Description WriteAbort
Switch. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the damaged.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. power.
E602 0114 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
Description System error or Packet data error applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD-
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Switch.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
Main Power Switch. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.
E602 0122 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0200 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 0123 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 0201 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description Failure in contact with HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
and reinstall the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-52
7
7
7-53
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0202 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0212 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Main Power Switch.
then ON the Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall and reinstall the system.
the system. E602 0213 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 0203 00 Title Error in HDD Description WriteAbort
Description WriteAbort (at startup) Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to damaged.
execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to
dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power. perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD- power.
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
E602 0204 00 Title Error in HDD applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD-
Description Failure in contact with HDD CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
then ON the Main Power Switch. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by the system.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall E602 0214 00 Title Error in HDD
the system. Description System error or Packet data error
E602 0205 00 Title Error in HDD Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Description Error in file system 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system. E602 0222 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 0210 00 Title Error in HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Description System error or Packet data error Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system.

7-53
7
7
7-54
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0223 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0301 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 0224 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 0302 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description Failure in contact with HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
and reinstall the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
E602 0225 00 Title Error in HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Description WriteAbort the system.
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be E602 0303 00 Title Error in HDD
damaged. Description WriteAbort (at startup)
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power.
power. 2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD-
applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD- CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch.
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power E602 0304 00 Title Error in HDD
Switch. Description Failure in contact with HDD
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
the system. then ON the Main Power Switch.
E602 0300 00 Title Error in HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
Description Failure in contact with HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. the system.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start E602 0305 00 Title Error in HDD
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB Description Error in file system
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to
then ON the Main Power Switch. execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by Main Switch.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
the system. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system.

7-54
7
7
7-55
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0310 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0322 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 0312 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0323 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 0313 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0324 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
damaged. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Main Power Switch.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the and reinstall the system.
applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD- E602 0325 00 Title Error in HDD
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Description WriteAbort
Switch. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the damaged.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. power.
E602 0314 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
Description System error or Packet data error applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD-
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Switch.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
Main Power Switch. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.

7-55
7
7
7-56
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0400 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0404 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
then ON the Main Power Switch. then ON the Main Power Switch.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system. the system.
E602 0401 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0405 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description Error in file system
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB Main Switch.
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
then ON the Main Power Switch. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by and reinstall the system.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall E602 0410 00 Title Error in HDD
the system. Description System error or Packet data error
E602 0402 00 Title Error in HDD Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Description Failure in contact with HDD 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start Main Power Switch.
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
then ON the Main Power Switch. and reinstall the system.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by E602 0412 00 Title Error in HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall Description System error or Packet data error
the system. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
E602 0403 00 Title Error in HDD 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Description WriteAbort (at startup) reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to Main Power Switch.
execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter and reinstall the system.
the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD-
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch.

7-56
7
7
7-57
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0413 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0424 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
damaged. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Main Power Switch.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the and reinstall the system.
applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD- E602 0425 00 Title Error in HDD
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Description WriteAbort
Switch. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the damaged.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. power.
E602 0414 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
Description System error or Packet data error applicable CHK-TYPE=1 in the partition to execute HDD-
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Switch.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
Main Power Switch. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.
E602 0422 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0500 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 0423 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 0501 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description Failure in contact with HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
and reinstall the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-57
7
7
7-58
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0502 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0512 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Main Power Switch.
then ON the Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall and reinstall the system.
the system. E602 0513 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 0503 00 Title Error in HDD Description WriteAbort
Description WriteAbort (at startup) Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to damaged.
execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to
dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power. perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD- power.
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
E602 0504 00 Title Error in HDD applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD-
Description Failure in contact with HDD CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
then ON the Main Power Switch. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by the system.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall E602 0514 00 Title Error in HDD
the system. Description System error or Packet data error
E602 0505 00 Title Error in HDD Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Description Error in file system 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system. E602 0522 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 0510 00 Title Error in HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Description System error or Packet data error Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system.

7-58
7
7
7-59
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0523 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0601 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 0524 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 0602 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description Failure in contact with HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
and reinstall the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
E602 0525 00 Title Error in HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Description WriteAbort the system.
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be E602 0603 00 Title Error in HDD
damaged. Description WriteAbort (at startup)
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power.
power. 2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD-
applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD- CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch.
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power E602 0604 00 Title Error in HDD
Switch. Description Failure in contact with HDD
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
the system. then ON the Main Power Switch.
E602 0600 00 Title Error in HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
Description Failure in contact with HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. the system.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start E602 0605 00 Title Error in HDD
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB Description Error in file system
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to
then ON the Main Power Switch. execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by Main Switch.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
the system. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system.

7-59
7
7
7-60
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0610 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0622 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 0612 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0623 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 0613 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0624 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
damaged. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Main Power Switch.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the and reinstall the system.
applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD- E602 0625 00 Title Error in HDD
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Description WriteAbort
Switch. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the damaged.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. power.
E602 0614 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
Description System error or Packet data error applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD-
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Switch.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
Main Power Switch. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.

7-60
7
7
7-61
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0700 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0704 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
then ON the Main Power Switch. then ON the Main Power Switch.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system. the system.
E602 0701 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0705 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description Error in file system
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB Main Switch.
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
then ON the Main Power Switch. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by and reinstall the system.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall E602 0710 00 Title Error in HDD
the system. Description System error or Packet data error
E602 0702 00 Title Error in HDD Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Description Failure in contact with HDD 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start Main Power Switch.
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
then ON the Main Power Switch. and reinstall the system.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by E602 0712 00 Title Error in HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall Description System error or Packet data error
the system. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
E602 0703 00 Title Error in HDD 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Description WriteAbort (at startup) reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to Main Power Switch.
execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter and reinstall the system.
the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD-
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch.

7-61
7
7
7-62
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0713 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0724 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
damaged. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Main Power Switch.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the and reinstall the system.
applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD- E602 0725 00 Title Error in HDD
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Description WriteAbort
Switch. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the damaged.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. power.
E602 0714 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
Description System error or Packet data error applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD-
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Switch.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
Main Power Switch. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.
E602 0722 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0800 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 0723 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 0801 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description Failure in contact with HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
and reinstall the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-62
7
7
7-63
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0802 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0812 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Main Power Switch.
then ON the Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall and reinstall the system.
the system. E602 0813 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 0803 00 Title Error in HDD Description WriteAbort
Description WriteAbort (at startup) Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to damaged.
execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to
dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power. perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD- power.
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
E602 0804 00 Title Error in HDD applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD-
Description Failure in contact with HDD CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
then ON the Main Power Switch. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by the system.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall E602 0814 00 Title Error in HDD
the system. Description System error or Packet data error
E602 0805 00 Title Error in HDD Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Description Error in file system 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system. E602 0822 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 0810 00 Title Error in HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Description System error or Packet data error Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system.

7-63
7
7
7-64
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0823 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0901 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 0824 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 0902 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description Failure in contact with HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
and reinstall the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
E602 0825 00 Title Error in HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Description WriteAbort the system.
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be E602 0903 00 Title Error in HDD
damaged. Description WriteAbort (at startup)
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power.
power. 2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the the applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to execute HDD-
applicable CHK-TYPE=2 in the partition to execute HDD- CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch.
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power E602 0904 00 Title Error in HDD
Switch. Description Failure in contact with HDD
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
the system. then ON the Main Power Switch.
E602 0900 00 Title Error in HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
Description Failure in contact with HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. the system.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start E602 0905 00 Title Error in HDD
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB Description Error in file system
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to
then ON the Main Power Switch. execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by Main Switch.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
the system. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system.

7-64
7
7
7-65
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 0910 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0922 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 0912 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0923 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 0913 00 Title Error in HDD E602 0924 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
damaged. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Main Power Switch.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the and reinstall the system.
applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to execute HDD- E602 0925 00 Title Error in HDD
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Description WriteAbort
Switch. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the damaged.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. power.
E602 0914 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
Description System error or Packet data error applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to execute HDD-
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Switch.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
Main Power Switch. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.

7-65
7
7
7-66
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1000 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1004 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
then ON the Main Power Switch. then ON the Main Power Switch.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system. the system.
E602 1001 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1005 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description Error in file system
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy Recovery in Boot Partition is available only through SST in
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start Safe Mode.
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and USB memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF
then ON the Main Power Switch. and then ON the Main Power Switch.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 1002 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1010 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Main Power Switch.
then ON the Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall and reinstall the system.
the system. E602 1012 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 1003 00 Title Error in HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Description WriteAbort (at startup) Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Remedy Recovery in Boot partition is available only through SST in 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Safe Mode. reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
1. Set as follows: CHK-TYPE=4 = 0; and execute HDD- Main Power Switch.
CHECK (duration: several dozen minutes), and then turn 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
OFF and then ON the power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, get in and reinstall the system.
Download Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
then ON the Main Power Switch.

7-66
7
7
7-67
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1013 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1024 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
damaged. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=4 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Main Power Switch.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the and reinstall the system.
applicable CHK-TYPE=4 in the partition to execute HDD- E602 1025 00 Title Error in HDD
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Description WriteAbort
Switch. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the damaged.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=4 in the partition to
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. power.
E602 1014 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
Description System error or Packet data error applicable CHK-TYPE=4 in the partition to execute HDD-
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Switch.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
Main Power Switch. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.
E602 1022 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1100 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 1023 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 1101 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description Failure in contact with HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
and reinstall the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-67
7
7
7-68
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1102 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1112 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Main Power Switch.
then ON the Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall and reinstall the system.
the system. E602 1113 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 1103 00 Title Error in HDD Description WriteAbort
Description WriteAbort (at startup) Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=5 in the partition to damaged.
execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=5 in the partition to
dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power. perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the applicable CHK-TYPE=5 in the partition to execute HDD- power.
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
E602 1104 00 Title Error in HDD applicable CHK-TYPE=5 in the partition to execute HDD-
Description Failure in contact with HDD CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
then ON the Main Power Switch. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by the system.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall E602 1114 00 Title Error in HDD
the system. Description System error or Packet data error
E602 1105 00 Title Error in HDD Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Description Error in file system 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=5 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system. E602 1122 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 1110 00 Title Error in HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Description System error or Packet data error Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system.

7-68
7
7
7-69
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1123 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1201 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 1124 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 1202 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description Failure in contact with HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
and reinstall the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
E602 1125 00 Title Error in HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Description WriteAbort the system.
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be E602 1203 00 Title Error in HDD
damaged. Description WriteAbort (at startup)
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=5 in the partition to Remedy 1. If possible, ask the customer to retrieve the data in the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Address Book from the remote UI.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=6 in the partition to
power. execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the dozen minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the power.
applicable CHK-TYPE=5 in the partition to execute HDD- 3. If the above measure failed to recover the system, get in
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Download Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the then ON the main power switch.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) E602 1204 00 Title Error in HDD
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by Description Failure in contact with HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
the system. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
E602 1200 00 Title Error in HDD in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Description Failure in contact with HDD memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. then ON the Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and the system.
then ON the Main Power Switch.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-69
7
7
7-70
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1205 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1214 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Error in file system Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=6 in the partition to Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Main Switch. reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
and reinstall the system. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
E602 1210 00 Title Error in HDD and reinstall the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 1222 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description System error or Packet data error
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Main Power Switch. reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
and reinstall the system. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
E602 1212 00 Title Error in HDD and reinstall the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 1223 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description System error or Packet data error
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Main Power Switch. reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
and reinstall the system. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
E602 1213 00 Title Error in HDD and reinstall the system.
Description WriteAbort E602 1224 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Description System error or Packet data error
damaged. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=6 in the partition to 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
power. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
applicable CHK-TYPE=6 in the partition to execute HDD- and reinstall the system.
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
Switch.
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-70
7
7
7-71
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1225 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1303 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description WriteAbort (at startup)
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy Recovery in Boot partition is available only through SST in
damaged. Safe Mode.
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=6 in the partition to 1. Set as follows: CHK-TYPE=7 = 0; and execute HDD-
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several CHECK (duration: several dozen minutes), and then turn
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the OFF and then ON the power.
power. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, get in
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the Download Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
applicable CHK-TYPE=6 in the partition to execute HDD- memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power then ON the Main Power Switch.
Switch. E602 1304 00 Title Error in HDD
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the Description Failure in contact with HDD
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
the system. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
E602 1300 00 Title Error in HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
Description Failure in contact with HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start the system.
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB E602 1305 00 Title Error in HDD
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Description Error in file system
then ON the Main Power Switch. Remedy Recovery in Boot Partition is available only through SST in
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by Safe Mode.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or
the system. USB memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF
E602 1301 00 Title Error in HDD and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Description Failure in contact with HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start and reinstall the system.
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB E602 1310 00 Title Error in HDD
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Description System error or Packet data error
then ON the Main Power Switch. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. Main Power Switch.
E602 1302 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
Description Failure in contact with HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. and reinstall the system.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
then ON the Main Power Switch.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-71
7
7
7-72
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1312 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1323 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 1313 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1324 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
damaged. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=7 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Main Power Switch.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the and reinstall the system.
applicable CHK-TYPE=7 in the partition to execute HDD- E602 1325 00 Title Error in HDD
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Description WriteAbort
Switch. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the damaged.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=7 in the partition to
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. power.
E602 1314 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
Description System error or Packet data error applicable CHK-TYPE=7 in the partition to execute HDD-
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Switch.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
Main Power Switch. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.
E602 1322 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1400 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-72
7
7
7-73
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1401 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1410 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Main Power Switch.
then ON the Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall and reinstall the system.
the system. E602 1412 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 1402 00 Title Error in HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Description Failure in contact with HDD Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB Main Power Switch.
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
then ON the Main Power Switch. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by and reinstall the system.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall E602 1413 00 Title Error in HDD
the system. Description WriteAbort
E602 1403 00 Title Error in HDD Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
Description WriteAbort (at startup) damaged.
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=8 in the partition to 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=8 in the partition to
execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power. dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter power.
the applicable CHK-TYPE=8 in the partition to execute HDD- 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch. applicable CHK-TYPE=8 in the partition to execute HDD-
E602 1404 00 Title Error in HDD CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
Description Failure in contact with HDD Switch.
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
then ON the Main Power Switch. the system.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by E602 1414 00 Title Error in HDD
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall Description System error or Packet data error
the system. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
E602 1405 00 Title Error in HDD 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
Description Error in file system reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=8 in the partition to Main Power Switch.
execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
Main Switch. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be and reinstall the system.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system.

7-73
7
7
7-74
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1422 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1500 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 1423 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description System error or Packet data error E602 1501 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description Failure in contact with HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD then ON the Main Power Switch.
and reinstall the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
E602 1424 00 Title Error in HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Description System error or Packet data error the system.
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. E602 1502 00 Title Error in HDD
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Description Failure in contact with HDD
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
and reinstall the system. then ON the Main Power Switch.
E602 1425 00 Title Error in HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
Description WriteAbort failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be the system.
damaged. E602 1503 00 Title Error in HDD
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=8 in the partition to Description WriteAbort (at startup)
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=9 in the partition to
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
power. dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the 2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter
applicable CHK-TYPE=8 in the partition to execute HDD- the applicable CHK-TYPE=9 in the partition to execute HDD-
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main switch.
Switch.
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-74
7
7
7-75
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1504 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1513 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in contact with HDD Description WriteAbort
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start damaged.
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=9 in the partition to
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
then ON the Main Power Switch. dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by power.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
the system. applicable CHK-TYPE=9 in the partition to execute HDD-
E602 1505 00 Title Error in HDD CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
Description Error in file system Switch.
Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=9 in the partition to (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
Main Switch. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD the system.
and reinstall the system. E602 1514 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 1510 00 Title Error in HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Description System error or Packet data error Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system. E602 1522 00 Title Error in HDD
E602 1512 00 Title Error in HDD Description System error or Packet data error
Description System error or Packet data error Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Switch.
Main Power Switch. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall the system.
and reinstall the system. E602 1523 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system.

7-75
7
7
7-76
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1524 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1602 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description Failure in contact with HDD
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
Main Power Switch. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be then ON the Main Power Switch.
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
and reinstall the system. failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
E602 1525 00 Title Error in HDD the system.
Description WriteAbort E602 1603 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Description WriteAbort (at startup)
damaged. Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=10 in the partition to
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=9 in the partition to execute HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several dozen minutes); and then turn OFF and then ON the power.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures failed to recover the system, enter
power. the applicable CHK-TYPE=10 in the partition to execute
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the main
applicable CHK-TYPE=9 in the partition to execute HDD- switch.
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power E602 1604 00 Title Error in HDD
Switch. Description Failure in contact with HDD
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
the system. then ON the Main Power Switch.
E602 1600 00 Title Error in HDD 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
Description Failure in contact with HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. the system.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start E602 1605 00 Title Error in HDD
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB Description Error in file system
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and Remedy 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=10 in the partition to
then ON the Main Power Switch. execute HDD-CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by Main Switch.
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
the system. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
E602 1601 00 Title Error in HDD and reinstall the system.
Description Failure in contact with HDD E602 1610 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Description System error or Packet data error
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
then ON the Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
the system. and reinstall the system.

7-76
7
7
7-77
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 1612 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1623 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 1613 00 Title Error in HDD E602 1624 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
damaged. 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=10 in the partition to reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several Main Power Switch.
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the and reinstall the system.
applicable CHK-TYPE=10 in the partition to execute HDD- E602 1625 00 Title Error in HDD
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power Description WriteAbort
Switch. Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the damaged.
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND) 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=10 in the partition to
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
the system. power.
E602 1614 00 Title Error in HDD 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
Description System error or Packet data error applicable CHK-TYPE=10 in the partition to execute HDD-
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Switch.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
Main Power Switch. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.
E602 1622 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system.

7-77
7
7
7-78
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 2000 00 Title Error in HDD Encryption Board E602 4001 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Authentication error between the host machine and the Description No Linux system start script.
Encryption Board. Remedy 1. Check the cable and the power connector.
Remedy 1. After checking connection of the Encryption Board, 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
disconnect and connect the connector and, turn OFF and in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
then ON the power. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
2. Execute the key clear procedure. then ON the Main Power Switch.
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
* Key clear: system recovery procedure failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
1. Execute the key clear procedure with SST. the system.
--> As a result, the disk becomes unformatted disk. Thus, it is E602 FF00 00 Title Error in HDD
necessary to execute step 2. Description Failure in contact with HDD
--> E602-0001 will be indicated if activating the machine with Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
the unformatted disk. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
2. Execute HDD format and system reinstallation with SST. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
E602 2001 00 Title Error in HDD Encryption Board memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
Description Mismatch in the Encryption Board operation. then ON the Main Power Switch.
Remedy 1. Execute the key clear procedure. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
E602 2002 00 Title Error in HDD Encryption Board failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Description Failure of the Encryption Board. the system.
Remedy 1. After checking connection of the Encryption Board, E602 FF01 00 Title Error in HDD
disconnect and connect the connector and, turn OFF and Description Failure in contact with HDD
then ON the power. Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
2. Execute the key clear procedure. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
3. After replacing the Encryption Board, execute HDD format in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
and system reinstallation with SST. memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
4. Replace the LAN-BARSAC Board --> replace the Main then ON the Main Power Switch.
Controller PCB 1. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
E602 4000 00 Title Error in HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
Description Unable to mount the Linux system. the system.
Remedy 1. Check the cable and the power connector. E602 FF02 00 Title Error in HDD
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start Description Failure in contact with HDD
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector.
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start
then ON the Main Power Switch. in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall then ON the Main Power Switch.
the system. 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-78
7
7
7-79
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 FF03 00 Title Error in HDD E602 FF12 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort (at startup) Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy 1. Set as follows: CHK-TYPE=3 = 0; and execute HDD- Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
CHECK (duration: several dozen minutes), and then turn 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
OFF and then ON the power. reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, execute Main Power Switch.
HDD-CLEAR with CHK-TYPE=3 = 1, 2, 3, 5, and then turn 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
OFF and then ON the power. caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
E602 FF04 00 Title Error in HDD and reinstall the system.
Description Failure in contact with HDD E602 FF13 00 Title Error in HDD
Remedy 1. Check the cable and power connector. Description WriteAbort
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, start Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
in Safe Mode to perform overall format using SST or USB damaged.
memory and reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and 1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to
then ON the Main Power Switch. perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall power.
the system. 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
E602 FF05 00 Title Error in HDD applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to execute HDD-
Description Error in file system CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
Remedy This is the error which usually does not occur. Switch.
1. Execute HDD-CLEAR with CHK-TYPE=3 = 1, 2, 3, 5, and (Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
then turn OFF and then ON the power. following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
and reinstall the system. the system.
E602 FF10 00 Title Error in HDD E602 FF14 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and 1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.
E602 FF11 00 Title Error in HDD E602 FF21 00 Title Error in HDD
Description Failure in HDD connection Description Failure in HDD connection
Remedy This is the error which usually does not occur in Read/Write Remedy This is the error which usually does not occur in Read/Write
level. level.
1. Check the cable and power connector. 1. Check the cable and power connector.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be 2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system. and reinstall the system.

7-79
7
7
7-80
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E602 FF22 00 Title Error in HDD E604 0512 00 Title Faulty/insufficient image memory (Main Controller PCB1)
Description System error or Packet data error Description No necessary memory at Main Controller PCB 1
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Remedy Make the Memory capacity at Main Controller PCB 1 as
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and indicated by 0512.
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch. E604 1024 00 Title Faulty/insufficient image memory (Main Controller PCB1)
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be Description No necessary memory at Main Controller PCB 1
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD Remedy Make the Memory capacity at Main Controller PCB 1 as
and reinstall the system. indicated by 1024.
E602 FF23 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error E604 1536 00 Title Faulty/insufficient image memory (Main Controller PCB1)
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug. Description No necessary memory at Main Controller PCB 1
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and Remedy Make the Memory capacity at Main Controller PCB 1 as
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the indicated by 1536.
Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system.
E602 FF24 00 Title Error in HDD
Description System error or Packet data error
Remedy It’s due to data corruption or software bug.
1. Start in Safe Mode to perform overall format with SST and
reinstall the system, and then turn OFF and then ON the
Main Power Switch.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, it can be
caused by failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD
and reinstall the system.
E602 FF25 00 Title Error in HDD
Description WriteAbort
Remedy The document data (such as BOX on the HDD) can be
damaged.
1. Enter the applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to
perform HDD-CHECK (duration: several minutes to several
dozens of minutes), and then turn OFF and then ON the
power.
2. If the above measures do not solve the problem, enter the
applicable CHK-TYPE=3 in the partition to execute HDD-
CLEAR, and then turn OFF and then ON the Main Power
Switch.
(Use SST to perform reformat/reinstallation in the case of the
following: BOOTDEV, BOOTDEV2 and APL_SEND)
3. If there still remains the problem, it can be caused by
failure with the HDD; therefore, replace the HDD and reinstall
the system.

7-80
7
7
7-81
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E611 0000 00 Title Error code to prevent repeated retransmission at power down c. When the System of the main body is ver. 22.01 or earlier,
during fax transmission or when it cannot be upgraded immediately.
Description When the power is down during fax transmission, this c-1. Execute service mode > COPIER > FUNCTION >
machine resends the fax at the next power-on. However, the CLEAR > MN-CON.
operation (retransmission => rebooting => retransmission) c-2. Execute service mode > COPIER > FUNCTION >
might be repeated due to the damage on SRAM at the power SYSTEM > CHK-TYPE > 1 > OK > HD-CLEAR.
down. To prevent this symptom, this error code is displayed Before executing this service mode, inform users that all
when this operation is repeated in a short term. images in the Inbox will be deleted and get approval from
Remedy Classify into the following 3 categories and perform the them.
operation respectively. c-3. Execute service mode > COPIER > FUNCTION >
SYSTEM > CHK-TYPE > 2 > OK > HD-CLEAR
a.When the System of the main body is ver. 30.30 or later. c-4. Turn OFF and then ON the main power switch.
b.When the System of the main body is between ver. 20.02
and 30.29, and can be upgraded. [Points to Note When Clearing MN-CON]
c.When the System of the main body is ver. 22.01 or earlier, Execution of clearing MN-COM deletes all data in
or when it cannot be upgraded immediately. Address Book, Forwarding Settings, Settings/Registration
(Preferences), Adjustment/Maintenance, Function Settings,
a. When the System of the main body is ver. 30.30 or later. Set Destination, Management Settings, TPM Settings, etc.
a-1. Execute service mode > COPIER> FUNCTION > Before execution of this operation, ask user to back up the
CLEAR > FXTX-CLR. (This service mode can be used only data and get approval for this operation.
when the System is ver. 30.30 or later) When clearing MN-CON while any login application other
a-2. Turn OFF and then ON the main power switch. than Default Authentication is, error such as not displayed
a-3. If possible, upgrade to ver. 31.02 or later which modified login screen occurred. In this case, access SMS once and
this error. switch login application to Default Authentication to recover
to the normal status.
*The following procedure shows the execution of clearing E613 0512 00 Title Faulty/insufficient image memory (Main Controller PCB2)
MN-CON, so refer to [Points to Note When CLeaning MN- Description No necessary memory at Main Controller PCB 2
CON]. Remedy Make the Memory capacity at Main Controller PCB 2 as
b. When the System of the main body is between ver. 20.02 indicated by 0512.
and 30.29, and can be upgraded. E613 1024 00 Title Faulty/insufficient image memory (Main Controller PCB2)
b-1. Upgrade the System to ver. 30.30 or later (if possible, Description No necessary memory at Main Controller PCB 2
31.02 or later). Remedy Make the Memory capacity at Main Controller PCB 2 as
b-2. Execute service mode > COPIER> FUNCTION > indicated by 1024.
CLEAR > FXTX-CLR.
E613 1536 00 Title Faulty/insufficient image memory (Main Controller PCB2)
b-3. Execute service mode > COPIER> FUNCTION >
Description No necessary memory at Main Controller PCB 2
CLEAR > MN-CON. (Be careful that this step does not exist
Remedy Make the Memory capacity at Main Controller PCB 2 as
in procedure a.)
indicated by 1536.
b-4. Turn OFF and then ON the main power switch.
(Unlike step c, this procedure does not require the execution
of clearing HDD.)

7-81
7
7
7-82
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E674 0001 00 Title Failure in communication of FAX board E674 0010 00 Title Failure in communication of FAX board
Description Error is detected for specified number of times in Description Failure in opening of the timer device to be used with
communication with FAX board. OnBoard Fax
Remedy Note: “Main Controller PCB” in the sentence refers to “Main Remedy Note: “Main Controller PCB” in the sentence refers to “Main
Controller PCB 2” for 1-line Fax Board or “Main Controller 1” Controller PCB 2” for 1-line Fax Board or “Main Controller 1”
for 2-/3-/4-line Fax Board. for 2-/3-/4-line Fax Board.

1. Check connection between the FAX board and the Main Replace the Main controller PCB.
controller PCB. E674 0011 00 Title Failure in communication of FAX board
2. Replace the Fax board. Description Failure in starting of the timer device which is used with
3. Replace the Main controller PCB. OnBoardFax
E674 0004 00 Title Failure in communication of FAX board Remedy Note: “Main Controller PCB” in the sentence refers to “Main
Description Failure in access of the modem IC which is used with Controller PCB 2” for 1-line Fax Board or “Main Controller 1”
OnBoardFax for 2-/3-/4-line Fax Board.
Remedy Note: “Main Controller PCB” in the sentence refers to “Main
Controller PCB 2” for 1-line Fax Board or “Main Controller 1” Replace the Main controller PCB.
for 2-/3-/4-line Fax Board. E674 0030 00 Title Failure in communication of FAX board
Description Error in checksum of USB-FAX MAINROM
1. Check connection between the FAX board and the Main Remedy Get in the download mode from the Service Mode when the
controller PCB. power is turned ON and execute downloading of USBFAX
2. Replace the Fax board. MAINROM.
3. Replace the Main controller PCB. E677 0003 00 Title Failure in Print Server
E674 0008 00 Title Failure in communication of FAX board Description Error is detected at the Mother Board check when print
Description Failure in access of the port IC that is be used with server is started.
OnBoardFax Remedy 1. Check connection of the cable and turn OFF and then ON
Remedy Note: “Main Controller PCB” in the sentence refers to “Main the power.
Controller PCB 2” for 1-line Fax Board or “Main Controller 1” 2. Reinstall the Print Server(For details, refer to “Service
for 2-/3-/4-line Fax Board. Manual image PASS-A1_B1.”)
E677 0010 00 Title Failure in Print Server
1. Check connection between the FAX board and the Main
Description Failure was detected in operation of the CPU fan on the print
controller PCB.
server.
2. Replace the Fax board.
Remedy 1. Replace the board of the print server.
3. Replace the Main controller PCB.
2. Reinstall the Print Server
E674 000C 00 Title Failure in communication of FAX board
E677 0080 00 Title Failure in Print Server
Description Failure is detected in access of the modem IC and port IC
Description Error is detected at the Mother Board check when print
that are used with OnBoardFax
server is started.
Remedy Note: “Main Controller PCB” in the sentence refers to “Main
Remedy 1. Check the cable connection and turn OFF and then ON
Controller PCB 2” for 1-line Fax Board or “Main Controller 1”
the power.
for 2-/3-/4-line Fax Board.
2. Reenter the job.
3. Reinstall the print server.
1. Check connection between the FAX board and the Main
T-7-6
controller PCB.
2. Replace the Fax board.
3. Replace the Main controller PCB.

7-82
7
7
7-83
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E710 0001 05 Title Error in initialization of IPC (Ctrl) E719 0001 00 Title Error in Coin Vendor.
Description Failed to be at ready status within 3 sec after IPC chip has Description Error in starting of the CoinVendor
been started. - The Coin Vendor, which should have been connected
Remedy Check the connection between DC Controller PCB and before the power was turned OFF, is not connected when
Finisher, and check that the Cable is not open-circuit. the power is turned ON.
E711 0001 05 Title Error in register of IPC (Ctrl) Remedy Check the connection between charging management
Description Set 4 errors within 1.5 sec in register IPC chip. equipment and machine, and check that the Cable is not
Remedy Check the cable. open-circuit.
E711 0002 05 Title Error in IPC communication
Clear the error while the charging management equipment
Description Initial communication error with the Finisher
is connected to operate and when switching to the operation
Remedy Check the connector connected to the Finisher.
without charging management equipment.
E713 0001 05 Title Error in IPC communication
(To prevent the misuse by removing the charging
Description When receiving retransmission request for 3 times in a row. management equipment, this error code is displayed.)
Remedy Check the connector connected to the Finisher. E719 0002 00 Title Error in Coin Vendor.
E713 0002 05 Title Error in IPC communication Description Error in IPC when CoinVendor is running.
Description When detecting CRC error at transmission. - In the case of disconnection of IPC or an error in which
Remedy Check the connector connected to the Finisher. IPC communication failed to be recovered.
E713 0004 05 Title Error in IPC communication - When disconnection of the pickup delivery signal is
Description When not receiving data for more than specified time detected.
Remedy Check the connector connected to the Finisher. - When illegal connection is detected (short-circuit with Tx
E713 0008 05 Title Error in IPC communication and Rx of IPC)
Description When checksum of the received data is not correct. Remedy Check the connection between charging management
Remedy Check the connector connected to the Finisher. equipment and machine, and check that the Cable is not
E713 0010 05 Title Error in UFDI communication open-circuit.
Description Neither ACK nor NAK is returned for specified times in a
Clear the error while the charging management equipment
row.
is connected to operate and when switching to the operation
Remedy Check the connector connected to the Finisher.
without charging management equipment.
E713 0011 05 Title Error in UFDI communication
(To prevent the misuse by removing the charging
Description NAK is returned for specified times in a row. management equipment, this error code is displayed.)
Remedy Check the connector connected to the Finisher. E719 0003 00 Title Error in Coin Vendor.
E713 0020 05 Title UFDI communication error Description - In the case of communication error with the coin vendor
Description BCC of the reception data is invalid for specified number of while obtaining the unit price at start-up.
times in a row. Remedy Check the connection between charging management
Remedy Check the connection of the Connector with Finisher. equipment and machine, and check that the Cable is not
E713 0021 05 Title Error in UFDI communication open-circuit.
Description Timeout before the completion of reception for specified
times in a row. Clear the error while the charging management equipment
Remedy Check the connector connected to the Finisher. is connected to operate and when switching to the operation
E713 0022 05 Title Error in UFDI communication without charging management equipment.
Description Undefined error for specified times in a row at reception. (To prevent the misuse by removing the charging
Remedy Check the connector connected to the Finisher. management equipment, this error code is displayed.)

7-83
7
7
7-84
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E719 0011 00 Title Error in Coin Vendor. E730 1001 00 Title Error in PDL software
Description Error in starting of NewCardReader Description Initialization error.
- NewCardReader, which should have been connected Remedy 1. Execute the PDL reset process.
before the power was turned OFF, is not connected when 2. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
the power is turned ON. E730 100A 00 Title Error in PDL software
Remedy Check the connection between charging management Description Fatal system error occurs.
equipment and machine, and check that the Cable is not Remedy 1. Execute the PDL reset process.
open-circuit. 2. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
E730 A006 00 Title Error in PDL communication
Clear the error while the charging management equipment
Description PDL fails to respond. No response from PDL due to
is connected to operate and when switching to the operation
Controller firmware, not installed, etc.
without charging management equipment.
Remedy 1. Execute the PDL reset process.
(To prevent the misuse by removing the charging
2. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
management equipment, this error code is displayed.)
3. Check the connection of Main Controller PCB 2.
E719 0012 00 Title Error in Coin Vendor.
4. Reinstall the controller firmware.
Description Error in IPC when NewCardReader is running. 5. Replace the Main Controller PCB 1.
- In the case of disconnection of IPC or an error in which
E730 A007 00 Title Mismatch in PDL version
IPC communication failed to be recovered.
Description Mismatch of version between the control software of the
Remedy Check the connection between charging management
host machine and PDL control software.
equipment and machine, and check that the Cable is not
Remedy Execute overall system format and installation.
open-circuit.
E730 B013 00 Title Error in PDL embedded font
Clear the error while the charging management equipment Description Font data is corrupted.
is connected to operate and when switching to the operation Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
without charging management equipment. 2. Reinstall the system.
(To prevent the misuse by removing the charging 3. Execute overall system format and installation.
management equipment, this error code is displayed.) E730 C000 00 Title Error in initialization
E719 0031 00 Title Error in serial communication at the start of the New Card Description An error, such as memory acquisition failure, occurs at
Reader initialization.
Description Failure in communication with the serial New Card Reader Remedy Execute overall system format and installation.
at start-up. Replace the Main Controller PCB1.
Remedy - Check if the cable of the serial New Card Reader is E730 C001 00 Title Error in HDD access
disconnected. Description An error occurs at HDD access.
- Take out the serial New Card Reader. Remedy Execute overall system format and installation.
- COPIER > Function > CLEAR > CARD Replace the HDD.
- COPIER > Function > CLEAR > ERR Replace the Main Controller PCB 2.
E719 0032 00 Title Error in serial communication at the start of the New Card Replace the Main Controller PCB 1.
Reader E731 3000 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB 2
Description Communication failed in the middle of the operation Description Unable to recognize the SURF Board.
although communication with the serial New Card Reader Remedy 1. Check the connection of the Main Controller PCB 2.
was successful at start-up. 2. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2.
Remedy - Check if the cable of the serial New Card Reader is 3. Replace the Main Controller PCB 1.
disconnected.

7-84
7
7
7-85
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E731 3001 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB 2 E743 0000 00 Title DDI communication error
Description Failure of SURF initialization. Description SCI error occurrence, reception data NG, reception timeout,
Remedy 1. Check the connection of the Main Controller PCB 2. SEQ timeout error
2. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
3. Replace the Main Controller PCB 1. 2. Check the connection of the Cable between Reader and
E731 3002 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB 2 Controller.
Description Failure of SURF initialization. 3. Check the voltage (+24V and +12V) on the Reader
Remedy 1. Check the connection of the Main Controller PCB 2. Controller PCB.
2. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2. 4. Replace the DDI-S Cable.
3. Replace the Main Controller PCB 1. 5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.
E731 3015 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB 2 6. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2.
Description Video data is not transmitted to CL1-G even though there is E743 0003 00 Title DDI communication error
no problem in the software. Description SCI error occurrence, reception data NG, reception timeout,
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power. SEQ timeout error
2. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
3. Replace the Main Controller PCB 1. 2. Check the connection of the Cable between Reader and
E732 0001 00 Title Error in scanner communication Controller.
3. Check the voltage (+24V and +12V) on the Reader
Description Error in DDI-S communication
Controller PCB.
Remedy 1. Check the connector connecting to the Scanner.
4. Replace the DDI-S Cable.
2. Check the power of the Scanner ->whether to perform
5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.
initialization at start-up?
6. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2.
3. Replace the Rcon, the Scanner Board or the Main
E743 0004 00 Title DDI communication error
controller PCB 2.
Description SCI error occurrence, reception data NG, reception timeout,
E732 9999 00 Title Error in scanner communication
SEQ timeout error
Description When a Scanner is detected for the first time from the
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Printer Model (not an error).
2. Check the connection of the Cable between Reader and
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Controller.
E733 0000 00 Title Error in printer communication
3. Check the voltage (+24V and +12V) on the Reader
Description Communication with the printer failed at start-up. Controller PCB.
Remedy 1.Check the connector connecting to the Printer. 4. Replace the DDI-S Cable.
2. Check the power of the Printer -> whether to perform 5. Replace the Reader Controller PCB.
initialization at start-up? 6. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2.
3. Replace the Dcon or the Main controller PCB 2. E744 0001 00 Title Failure in language file
E733 0001 00 Title Error in printer communication Description Mismatched version between the HDD and the Bootable
Description Error in DDI-P communication Remedy Reinstall the correct language file using SST or USB
Remedy 1.Check the connector connecting to the Printer. memory reinstall the entire software.
2. Check the power of the Printer -> whether to perform E744 0002 00 Title Failure in language file
initialization at start-up?
Description Oversized language file in HDD
3. Replace the Dcon or the Main Controller PCB 2.
Remedy Format the HDD and reinstall the software because there
E740 0002 00 Title Failure in Ethernet Board
can be more than necessary language files.
Description Incorrect MAC address
E744 0003 00 Title Failure in language file
Remedy 1 Replace the LAN card.
Description Unable to find the language which should be switched and
E740 0003 00 Title Failure in Ethernet Board described in Config.txt in the HDD.
Description Incorrect MAC address Remedy Reinstall the software.
Remedy 1Replace the LAN card.

7-85
7
7
7-86
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E744 0004 00 Title Failure in language file E746 0023 00 Title Error in engine ID of SoftID
Description Unable to switch to the language in the HDD. Description No response from Image Analysis Board (PCB used for
Remedy Reinstall the software. PCAM)
E744 2000 00 Title Error in engine ID of SoftID Remedy 1. Check to see if the Option Board is properly inserted.
Description The engine ID described in SoftID is incorrect 2. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Remedy 1. Replace the SoftID PCB 3. If the above measure does not solve the problem, replace
E744 4000 00 Title Model information mismatch the Option Board.
4. Remove the Image Analysis Board and go to the
Description Mismatch of model information between the Main Controller
following service mode: COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR>ST-
PCB 1 and the DC Controller is detected.
JBLK (Lv2). Change the value of ST-JBLK from 1 to 0, and
Remedy This error occurs only when replacing the DC Controller. By
turn OFF and then ON the main power.
returning the original PCB, this error can be recovered. (If
E746 0024 00 Title Error in engine ID of SoftID
other error code is displayed, see the corresponding error
code.) Description Failure in behavior of Image Analysis Board (PCB used for
If it is not recovered, replace the DC Controller to a new PCAM)
one. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
2. If the above measure does not solve the problem, replace
DC Controller PCB does not have model information at the Option Board.
the time of shipment. Model information is written when 3. Remove the Image Analysis Board and go to the
installing the PCB to the host machine. Therefore, the DC following service mode: COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR>ST-
Controller PCB which was installed to imageRUNNER JBLK (Lv2). Change the value of ST-JBLK from 1 to 0, and
ADVANCE C5045 can be installed only to imageRUNNER turn OFF and then ON the main power.
ADVANCE C5045. E746 0031 00 Title Error in engine ID of SoftID
E746 0011 00 Title Error in engine ID of SoftID Description Error in hardware
Description Because both the voice composition board and the Remedy Replace the TPM chip.
composition recognition board are inserted. E746 0032 00 Title Error in engine ID of SoftID
Remedy Insert only 1 board of the appropriate voice board. Description Mismatched data in TPM
E746 0021 00 Title Error in engine ID of SoftID Remedy Format the system.
Description Self-check NG of Image Analysis Board (PCB used for Format the HDD using SST or USB memory, and
PCAM) download the system software. For details, see “Chapter
Remedy 1. Replace the Image Analysis Board (PCB used for PCAM) 6: Upgrading”. For your reference, the method using USB
2. Remove the Image Analysis Board and go to the memory is described below.
following service mode: COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR>ST- 1. Prepare the USB memory which system software was
JBLK (Lv2). Change the value of ST-JBLK from 1 to 0, and registered.
turn OFF and then ON the main power. 2. Execute the following service mode:
E746 0022 00 Title Error in engine ID of SoftID COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM>DOWNLOAD to enter the
download mode.
Description Different version of Image Analysis Board (PCB used for
3. Insert the USB memory to the equipment.
PCAM)
4. Execute [4]: Format HDD in the main menu.
Remedy 1. Update the firmware of the Option Board.
5. After formatting is completed, the machine reboots
2. Remove the Image Analysis Board and go to the
automatically and starts with the download mode.
following service mode: COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR>ST-
6. Execute [1]: Upgrade (Auto) in the main menu.
JBLK (Lv2). Change the value of ST-JBLK from 1 to 0, and
7. System software is downloaded and the machine restarts
turn OFF and then ON the main power.
automatically.

7-86
7
7
7-87
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E746 0033 00 Title Error in engine ID of SoftID E747 FF00 00 Title A wrong Sub Board was detected
Description Error that can be recovered Description A wrong Sub Board was detected
Remedy When the TPM key was backed up, it can be restored. Remedy Check contact of ScanI/F cable --> Replace
1. Connect the USB memory which stores the TPM key. Check contact of the Sub Board O and the cable -->
2. Go to Management Settings > Data Management > TPM Replace
Settings, and then click “Restore TPM Key”. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2
3. Enter the password set at backup operation. E747 FF01 00 Title Connection failure with DDR-SDRAM (P)/inappropriate
4. When the restoration completion screen is displayed, memory size
click “OK”. Remove the USB memory, and turn OFF and Description Connection failure with DDR-SDRAM (P)/inappropriate
then ON the main power. memory size
Remedy Replace the DDR-SDRAM (P)
When the TPM key was not backed up: E747 0000 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Formatting the system is required.
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
E746 0034 00 Title TPM auto recovery error
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Description The error occurs when clearing HDD while TPM setting is Main Controller PCB2.
ON. 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
Remedy It is recovered by turning OFF and then ON the power. 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
E747 1201 00 Title PDL rendering error 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
Description Image processing IC error. 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power (Send the data to Inc. E747 001E 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
because the error code will be displayed again if printing the Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
data with which the error was displayed.) Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
2. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2. Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
E747 3F00 00 Title Undetected error of the Image Process Chip P Main Controller PCB2.
Description Undetected error of the Image Process Chip P 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
Remedy Replace the Main Controller PCB 2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
E747 7F00 00 Title Undetected error of the Image Process Chip R 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
Description Undetected error of the Image Process Chip R 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
Remedy Replace the Main Controller PCB 2 E747 011B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
E747 9F00 00 Title Detection shows that Sub Board O failed to be installed Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Detection shows that Sub Board O failed to be installed Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Remedy Check contact of the Sub Board O and the cable, or replace Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
-> Replace the Main Controller PCB 2 Main Controller PCB2.
E747 BF00 00 Title Detection shows that Sub Board O failed to be installed 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
Description Detection shows that Sub Board O failed to be installed
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
Remedy Check contact of the Sub Board O and the cable, or replace
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
-> Replace the Main Controller PCB 2
E747 DF00 00 Title Undetected error of Image Process Chip S
Description Undetected error of Image Process Chip S
Remedy Check contact of ScanI/F cable --> Replace
-> Replace the Main Controller PCB 2

7-87
7
7
7-88
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 011A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 031B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0119 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 031A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 021B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0319 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 021A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 041B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0219 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 041A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-88
7
7
7-89
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 0419 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 061A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 051D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0619 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 051C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0618 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 051B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 071B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 061B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 071A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-89
7
7
7-90
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 0719 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0818 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0718 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 091B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 081B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 091A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 081A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0919 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0819 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0918 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-90
7
7
7-91
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 0A1B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0B1A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0A1A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0B19 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0A19 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0B18 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0A18 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0C1B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0B1B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0C1A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-91
7
7
7-92
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 0C19 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0E0E 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0C18 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0E0D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0D17 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0E0B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0E17 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0E09 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0E0F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0E08 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-92
7
7
7-93
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 0E07 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0F18 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0E06 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0F17 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0E05 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 0F0F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0F1B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 101B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 0F19 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 101A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-93
7
7
7-94
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 1019 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 110E 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 1018 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 110D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 1017 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 1217 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 100F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 1208 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 1117 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 1207 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-94
7
7
7-95
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 1206 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 1200 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 1205 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 2000 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 1204 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 221F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 1203 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 221C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 1202 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 221B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-95
7
7
7-96
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 2218 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 221B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 2217 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 221A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 221E 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 2219 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 221D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 2218 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 221C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 2217 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-96
7
7
7-97
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 2216 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3619 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 2215 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3618 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 2214 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3717 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 2213 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3716 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 2212 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3715 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-97
7
7
7-98
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 381F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3A06 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 381B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3A02 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 3906 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3A01 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 3902 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3C00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 3901 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3D00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-98
7
7
7-99
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 3F01 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3F06 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 3F02 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 3F07 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 3F03 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 4000 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 3F04 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 421F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 3F05 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 421E 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-99
7
7
7-100
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 421D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 4218 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 421C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 4217 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 421B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 4216 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 421A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 4215 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 4219 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 4214 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-100
7
7
7-101
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 4213 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 5716 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 4212 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 5715 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5619 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 581F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5618 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 581B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5717 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 5906 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-101
7
7
7-102
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 5902 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 5C00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5901 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 5D00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5A06 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 5F00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5A02 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 5F01 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5A01 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 5F02 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-102
7
7
7-103
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 5F03 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6000 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5F04 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 621F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5F05 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 621E 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5F06 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 621D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 5F07 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 621C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-103
7
7
7-104
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 621B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6216 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 621A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6215 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 6219 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6214 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 6218 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6213 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 6217 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6212 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-104
7
7
7-105
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 651F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6B1D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 651D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6B1A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 651C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6B19 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 6A1F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6B17 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 6B1F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 6C1F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-105
7
7
7-106
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 6C1E 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 741E 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 6F1F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 751F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 711F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 751C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 721F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 751B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 741F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 7C00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-106
7
7
7-107
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 7D00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 9118 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 8000 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 9117 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 851F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 9116 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 851D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 9115 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 851C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 9114 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-107
7
7
7-108
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 951B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 A51D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 951A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 A51C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 9C00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 B118 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 A000 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 B117 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 A51F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 B116 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-108
7
7
7-109
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 B115 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 C000 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 B114 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 C51F 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 B51B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 C51D 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 B51A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 C51C 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 BC00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 C51B 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-109
7
7
7-110
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 C51A 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 D619 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 C519 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 D618 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 C706 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 D717 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 C702 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 D716 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
E747 C701 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E747 D715 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Error in Main Controller PCB2
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at
Main Controller PCB2. Main Controller PCB2.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) 5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)

7-110
7
7
7-111
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E747 DC00 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 E748 2023 00 Title Error in access of Main Controller PCB 2
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 Description Unable to initialize the memory DDR2-SDRAM on the Main
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the Controller PCB 2.
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at Remedy 1. Clean the terminal of the DDR2-SDRAM , and disconnect
Main Controller PCB2. and then connect it.
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB 2. Replace the DDR2-SDRAM.
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 E748 2024 00 Title Error in access of Main Controller PCB 2
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2 Description CPU on the Main Controller PCB 2 fails to complete the
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board) initialization.
E747 DF01 00 Title Error in Main Controller PCB2 Remedy 1. Clean the terminal of the DDR2-SDRAM , and disconnect
Description Error in Main Controller PCB2 and then connect it.
Remedy 1. Check contact of ScanI/F cable. Check contact of the 2. Replace the DDR2-SDRAM.
Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB.Check contact of SDRAM at E748 9000 00 Title System error
Main Controller PCB2. Description System error
2. Replace the Bypass PCB or Open I/F PCB Remedy Contact to the sales companies.
3. Replace the SDRAM at Main Controller PCB2 E753 0001 00 Title Download Error
4. Replace the Main Controller PCB2
Description System Software Update Error
5. Replace the HDD (replace the new encryption board)
Error occurs when updating system software of uninstalled
E748 2010 00 Title Error in Flash PCB options
Description Unable to find the IPL (startup program). Remedy 1. Check the log to find where the download error has been
Remedy Replace the Flash PCB. occurred.
E748 2011 00 Title Error in Flash PCB FIN_C1 Staple Finisher-C1/Booklet Finisher-C1
Description Unable to find the kernel. IFN_A1 Inner Finisher-A1
Remedy Replace the Flash PCB. G3CCB Super G3 FAX Board-AE1
E748 2012 00 Title Error in Flash PCB G3CCM Super G3 FAX Board-AE1
Description Unable to mount the Linux system at starting service mode, When any of the above system software is displayed, check
or there is no system start script. if the target option has been installed.
Remedy Replace the Flash PCB. When the target option has not been installed:
E748 2021 00 Title Error in access of Main Controller PCB 2 Turn OFF and then ON the main power supply to restore
(since there is no system software to be updated.).
Description Necessary H/W on the Main Controller PCB 2 is not found.
When the target option has been installed:
Remedy 1. Clean the terminal of the Main Controller PCB 2, and
Check if the accessory is correctly installed and if the target
disconnect and then connect it.
system software to be downloaded is for the installed
2. Clean the terminal of the Main Controller PCB 1, and
option. Then download the appropriate system software
disconnect and then connect it.
again.
3. Replace the Main Controller PCB 2.
E804 0000 00 Title Error in Power Supply Fan
E748 2022 00 Title Error in access of Main Controller PCB 2
Description Lock of the Power Supply Fan was detected
Description Necessary H/W on the Main Controller PCB 2 is not found.
Remedy 1. Check power distribution to the Fan.
Remedy 1. Remove and then insert the Main Controller PCB 1 and
2. Replace the Fan.
the Main Controller PCB 2 .
2. Replace the Main Controller PCB 1 and the Main
Controller PCB 2.

7-111
7
7
7-112
Ecode Detail Location Item Description Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code Code
E805 0000 05 Title Error in Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 1 E806 0002 05 Title Error in Secondary Transfer Exhaust Fan
Description 1. After the power of the Host Machine has been turned Description 1. After the power of the Host Machine has been turned ON,
ON, rotation of the Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 1 (FM1) was rotation of the fan was detected before turning ON the fan.
detected before turning ON the fan. 2. There is no rotation signal while the fan is rotating.
2. There is no rotation signal while the Fixing Heat Exhaust Remedy 1. Check the fan harness (to see if the harness is caught,
Fan 1 (FM1) is rotating. disconnected or physically removed).
Remedy 1. Check the Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 1 (FM1) harness 2. Replace the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2).
(to see if the harness is caught, disconnected or physically 3. Replace the Secondary Transfer Exhaust Fan (FM8).
removed). E807 0000 05 Title Error in Process cartridge fan (front)
2. Check the fuse of the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2). Description 1. After the power of the Host Machine has been turned ON,
3. Replace the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2). rotation of the fan was detected before turning ON the fan.
4. Replace the Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 1 (FM1). 2. There is no rotation signal while the fan is rotating.
E805 0001 05 Title Error in Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 2 Remedy 1. Check the fan harness (to see if the harness is caught,
Description 1. After the power of the Host Machine has been turned disconnected or physically removed).
ON, rotation of the Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 2 (FM2) was 2. Replace the Relay Board.
detected before turning ON the fan. 3. Replace the fan.
2. There is no rotation signal while the Fixing Heat Exhaust E807 0001 05 Title Error in Process cartridge fan (rear)
Fan 2 (FM2) is rotating. Description 1. After the power of the Host Machine has been turned ON,
Remedy 1. Check the Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 2 (FM2) harness rotation of the fan was detected before turning ON the fan.
(to see if the harness is caught, disconnected or physically 2. There is no rotation signal while the fan is rotating.
removed). Remedy 1. Check the fan harness (to see if the harness is caught,
2. Replace the Feed Driver PCB. disconnected or physically removed).
3. Replace the Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 2 (FM2). 2. Replace the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2).
E806 0000 05 Title Error in Delivery fan 1 3. Replace the fan.
Description 1. Failure in the Connect signal when the fan was turned E808 0000 05 Title Error in Zero Cross
OFF. Description Zero Cross failed to be detected for 50ms or more while the
2. Failure detected while the fan is rotating. fixing relay was ON.
Remedy 1. Check the fan harness (to see if the harness is caught, Remedy 1. Replace the AC Driver (UN6).
disconnected or physically removed). 2. Check the cycle of the input voltage (failure in power-
2. Replace the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2). peripheral area of the customer. Ask the customer to
3. Replace the Delivery Fan (FM7). perform the power supply work).
E806 0001 05 Title Error in Delivery fan 2 E811 0000 05 Title Fuse cutoff error in Process Cartridge
Description 1. After the power of the Host Machine has been turned ON, Description Fuse cannot be cut off (disconnect) although it is tried to be
rotation of the fan was detected before turning ON the fan. cut off.
2. There is no rotation signal while the fan is rotating. Remedy 1. Turn OFF and then ON the power.
Remedy 1. Check the fan harness (to see if the harness is caught, 2. Check the resistance value of the Fuse on Drum.
disconnected or physically removed). 3. Replace the Drum.
2. Replace the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2). E811 0001 05 Title Error in 24V of the drum new/old detection.
3. Replace the Delivery Fan 2 (FM9).
Description Error in 24V of the drum new/old detection.
Remedy 1. Check the FUSE_5 on the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2).
2. Replace the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2).

7-112
7
7
7-113
Ecode Detail Location Item Description
Code
E840 0000 05 Title Error in shutter for Fixing Edge Cooling Fan (if the HP failed
to be detected when the error occurred).
Description Failed to detect that the fan shutter has moved to the
specified position when moving the fan shutter from
anywhere other than the HP.
Remedy 1. Check the harness of the Shutter Motor (M27), the
Shutter HP Sensor (PS31) and the Shutter Position Sensor
(PS32) (to see if the harness is caught, disconnected or
physically removed).
2. Replace the Pickup Feed Driver PCB (UN2).
3. Replace the Shutter Motor, the Shutter HP Sensor or the
Shutter Position Sensor.
E880 0001 00 Title Error in Controller Fan
Description Fan lock of the Controller CPU cooling fan was detected
Remedy Check if the connector is connected.
If the connection was found OK, replace the Controller Fan
3 (FM13).
E880 0003 00 Title Error in Controller Fan
Description Riser PCB Fan was detected to be locked.
Remedy Check if the connector is connected.
If the connection was found OK, replace the Controller Fan
1 (FM11).
E880 0004 00 Title Error in Controller Fan
Description Riser PCB Fan was detected to be locked.
Remedy Check if the connector is connected.
If the connection was found OK, replace the Controller Fan
2 (FM12).
E880 0005 00 Title Error in Controller Fan
Description Fan lock of the HDD Cooling Fan was detected
Remedy Check if the connector is connected.
It the connection is OK, replace the HDD Cooling Fan
(FM14).
T-7-7

7-113
7
7
7-114

Jam Code PS8


PS9

image RUNNER ADVANCE C5051/C5045/C5035/


C5030

[PS39]

[PS42] [PS43]
[PS40]

[PS41]
[PS37]
F-7-3

ACC Jam
Type Sensor Name Sensor ID
[PS34] [PS35] [PS36] ID Code
00 0B00 Door open Front door sensor,Right lower door PS18,PS19,PS20
[PS38] sensor,Right door sensor

[PS33] [PS47] 00 0105 Delay jam Registration sensor PS33


00 0205 Stationary jam Registration sensor PS33
[UN53] 00 0A05 POWER ON Registration sensor PS33
[PS55] 00 FF05 Sequence jam *2 Registration sensor PS33
00 0106 Delay jam Fixing inlet sensor PS34
00 0206 Stationary jam Fixing inlet sensor PS34
[PS56] 00 0A06 POWER ON Fixing inlet sensor PS34
00 FF06 Sequence jam *2 Fixing inlet sensor PS34
00 0107 Delay jam Inner delivery sensor PS37
00 0207 Stationary jam Inner delivery sensor PS37
F-7-1
00 0A07 POWER ON Inner delivery sensor PS37
[PS1D] 00 FF07 Sequence jam *2 Inner delivery sensor PS37
00 010D Delay jam Duplex paper sensor PS38
[PS6D] 00 020D Stationary jam Duplex paper sensor PS38
00 0A0D POWER ON Duplex paper sensor PS38
00 FF0D Sequence jam *2 Duplex paper sensor PS38
00 010A Delay jam Reverse sensor PS39
00 020A Stationary jam Reverse sensor PS39
00 0A0A POWER ON Reverse sensor PS39
00 FF0A Sequence jam *2 Reverse sensor PS39
00 010C Delay jam Duplex inlet sensor PS40
00 020C Stationary jam Duplex inlet sensor PS40
00 0A0C POWER ON Duplex inlet sensor PS40
F-7-2
00 FF0C Sequence jam *2 Duplex inlet sensor PS40
00 0108 Delay jam First delivery sensor PS41
00 0208 Stationary jam First delivery sensor PS41

7-114
7
7
7-115
ACC Jam ACC Jam
Type Sensor Name Sensor ID Type Sensor Name Sensor ID
ID Code ID Code
00 0A08 POWER ON First delivery sensor PS41 00 0D91 Different media Different media length -
00 FF08 Sequence jam *2 First delivery sensor PS41 length
00 0109 Delay jam Second delivery sensor PS42 00 0D92 Incorrect paper Transparency sensor UN51
00 0209 Stationary jam Second delivery sensor PS42 00 0D93 Incorrect paper Transparency sensor UN51
00 0A09 POWER ON Second delivery sensor PS42 00 0113 Delay jam Vertical path sensor UN53
00 FF09 Sequence jam *2 Second delivery sensor PS42 00 0213 Stationary jam Vertical path sensor UN53
00 010B Delay jam Third delivery sensor PS43 00 FF13 Sequence jam *2 Vertical path sensor UN53
00 020B Stationary jam Third delivery sensor PS43 00 FF90 Sequence jam *3 Communication sequence error with -
00 0A0B POWER ON Third delivery sensor PS43 Finisher
00 FF0B Sequence jam *2 Third delivery sensor PS43 T-7-8

00 0A01 POWER ON Cassette 1 pre-registration sensor PS55 *1 The state is recovered by opening and closing the Door, or turning OFF and then ON the
00 FF01 Sequence jam *2 Cassette 1 pre-registration sensor PS55
power supply.
00 0102 Delay jam Cassette 2 pre-registration sensor PS56
00 0202 Stationary jam Cassette 2 pre-registration sensor PS56 If the same jam is detected regardless of the operation above, the error code is displayed.
00 0A02 POWER ON Cassette 2 pre-registration sensor PS56
00 FF02 Sequence jam *2 Cassette 2 pre-registration sensor PS56 *2: The state is recovered by opening and closing the Door, or turning OFF and then ON the
00 010F Delay jam Deck pickup sensor PS6D power supply.
00 0111 Delay jam Buffer pass entrance sensor PS1
If it is not recovered by the above operation, it is considered an error near the target sensor.
00 0112 Delay jam Buffer pass exit sensor PS2
00 020F Stationary jam Deck pickup sensor PS6D Disconnect and then connect the connectors around the target sensor, check if the cable is
00 0211 Stationary jam Buffer pass entrance sensor PS1 open circuit, and replace the sensor.
00 0212 Stationary jam Buffer pass exit sensor PS2
00 0A0F POWER ON Deck pickup sensor PS6D *3: The state is recovered by opening and closing the Door, or turning OFF and then ON the
00 0A11 POWER ON Buffer pass entrancee sensor PS1
power supply.
00 0A12 POWER ON Buffer pass exit sensor PS2
00 FF0F Sequence jam *2 Deck pickup sensor PS6D If it is not recovered by the above operation, operation failure of the Finisher (including error
00 FF11 Sequence jam *2 Buffer pass entrance sensor PS1 in the harness) is suspected as a cause.
00 FF12 Sequence jam *2 Buffer pass exit sensor PS2
00 0103 Delay jam Cassette 3 pre-registration sensor PS8
00 0203 Stationary jam Cassette 3 pre-registration sensor PS8
00 0A03 POWER ON Cassette 3 pre-registration sensor PS8
00 FF03 Sequence jam *2 Cassette 3 pre-registration sensor PS8
00 0104 Delay jam Cassette 4 pre-registration sensor PS9
00 0204 Stationary jam Cassette 4 pre-registration sensor PS9
00 0A04 POWER ON Cassette 4 pre-registration sensor PS9
00 FF04 Sequence jam *2 Cassette 4 pre-registration sensor PS9
00 0CF1 Error *1 Recovered by opening and closing the -
Door
00 0CA1 Error *1 Recovered by opening and closing the -
Door
00 0CA2 Error *1 Recovered by opening and closing the -
Door
00 0CA3 Error *1 Recovered by opening and closing the -
Door

7-115
7
7
7-116
Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 / Color Image ACC Jam Code Type Sensor Name Sensor ID
ID
Reader Unit-B2 01 0048 Stationary Read sensor 1 PCB4
01 0009 delay Read sensor 2 SR5
01 0049 delay Read sensor 2 SR5
[SR4] [PCB2] [SR10]
[PCB5] 01 0010 Stationary Read sensor 2 SR5
[SR12] 01 0050 Stationary Read sensor 2 SR5
01 0011 delay Delivery sensor PCB5
01 0051 delay Delivery sensor PCB5
01 0012 Stationary Delivery sensor PCB5
[PCB3] 01 0052 Stationary Delivery sensor PCB5
[PCB4] 01 0090 Door open - -
01 0091 Door open - -
[SR5] 01 0092 Door open Cover open/closed sensor SR10
01 0093 Door open Cover open/closed sensor SR10
[SR15] [SR16] 01 0094 Power ON - -
[SR12~15] 01 0071 Sequence Error - -
[SR6] [SR9] [SR7] [SR8]
01 0073 Error Disengaging home position sensor 1 SR15
[SR1] [SR4] [SR5] 01 0074 Error Disengaging home position sensor 2 SR16
01 0075 Error Pickup unit lifter home position sensor SR12
T-7-9

Color Image Reader Unit-B2


ACC Jam Code Type Sensor Name Sensor ID
ID
[SR11] [SR2] [SR3] [VR1] [SR10] 01 0001 delay Timing sensor SR4
01 0002 Stationary Timing sensor SR4
F-7-4
01 0042 Stationary Timing sensor SR4
Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 01 0095 Pickup Error Timing sensor SR4
ACC Jam Code Type Sensor Name Sensor ID 01 0003 delay Registration sensor SR1
ID 01 0043 delay Registration sensor SR1
01 0001 delay Post-separation sensor 3 PCB2 01 0004 Stationary Registration sensor SR1
01 0002 Stationary Post-separation sensor 3 PCB2 01 0044 Stationary Registration sensor SR1
01 0042 Stationary Post-separation sensor 3 PCB2 01 0009 delay Read sensor SR2
01 0095 Pickup Error Post-separation sensor 3 PCB2 01 0049 delay Read sensor SR2
01 0003 delay Delivery sensor SR4 01 0010 Stationary Read sensor SR2
01 0043 delay Delivery sensor SR4 01 0050 Stationary Read sensor SR2
01 0004 Stationary Delivery sensor SR4 01 0013 delay Delivery reversal sensor SR3
01 0044 Stationary Delivery sensor SR4 01 0053 delay Delivery reversal sensor SR3
01 0005 delay Registration sensor PCB3 01 0014 Stationary Delivery reversal sensor SR3
01 0045 delay Registration sensor PCB3 01 0054 Stationary Delivery reversal sensor SR3
01 0006 Stationary Registration sensor PCB3 01 0090 Door open - -
01 0046 Stationary Registration sensor PCB3 01 0091 Door open - -
01 0007 delay Read sensor 1 PCB4 01 0092 Door open Cover open/closed sensor SR6
01 0047 delay Read sensor 1 PCB4 01 0093 Door open Cover open/closed sensor SR6
01 0008 Stationary Read sensor 1 PCB4 01 0094 Power ON - -

7-116
7
7
7-117
ACC Jam Code Type Sensor Name Sensor ID Staple Finisher-C1 / Booklet Finisher-C1
ID
01 0071 Sequence Error - -
01 0073 Error Release motor HP sensor SR11 PI108 PI123 PI105 PI107
T-7-10 PI109 PI101
* The state is recovered by opening and closing the Door, or turning OFF and then ON the PI111
power supply.
PI117
If the same jam is detected regardless of the operation above, the error code is displayed. PI106

PI114

PI104

PI102
PI103
PI116

PI113
PI110

PI115
PI112 PI120

F-7-5

7-117
7
7
7-118

ACC Jam
Type Sensor Name Sensor ID
ID Code
02 110F Retry error * - -
02 1F8F Retry error * - -
02 1002 Delay jam Punch pass sensor PCB12
PI22 02 1400 Door open - -
PI16 PI9 02 1F88 Door open - -
PI18 02 1102 Stationary jam Punch pass sensor PCB12
PI19 02 1F92 Delay jam Delivery sensor PI11
PI11 02 1F87 POWER ON Paper pushing plate motor clock PI1, PI17, PI18,
sensor,Vertical pat paper sensor,No.1 PI19, PI20, PI22
PI20 paper sensor,No.2 paper sensor,No.3
paper sensor,Saddle inlet sensor
PI21 02 1001 Delay jam Inlet sensor PI103
02 1101 Stationary jam Inlet sensor PI103
PI6 02 1200 Resijual jam Inlet sensor PI103
PI14 02 1004 Delay jam Feed path sensor PI104
02 1104 Stationary jam Feed path sensor PI104
PI5 PI15 02 1300 Early jam Feed path sensor PI104
02 1FA2 stationary jam Delivery sensor, Vertical path sensor PI11,PI17
02 1F91 Delay jam No.1 paper sensor PI18
02 1FA1 Stationary jam No.1 paper sensor,No.2 paper PI18,PI19,PI20
PI12 sensor,No.3 paper sensor
02 1F93 Delay jam Saddle inlet sensor PI22
02 1FA3 Stationary jam Saddle inlet sensor PI22
PI17
02 1604 Punch jam Side registration HP sensor PI63
PI13 02 1605 POWER ON Punch pass sensor PCB12
PI4 02 1F86 Staple jam Saddle staple SDL STP
PI8
02 1500 Staple jam stapler STP
PI1 PI7
T-7-11
F-7-6
* The state is recovered by opening and closing the Door, or turning OFF and then ON the
power supply.
If the same jam is detected regardless of the operation above, the error code is displayed.

7-118
7
7
7-119
Inner Finisher-A1 ACC Jam
Type Sensor Name Sensor ID
ID Code
02 1C75 Error Gripper unit HP sensor S7
S22 S2 S1
02 1C71 Sensor error * Gripu arm sensor S13
02 1C20 Sensor error * Shift roller HP sensor S2
02 1C67 Sensor error * Shift roller release sensor S3
02 1C32 Sensor error * stapler move HP sensor S10
02 1C6F Sensor error * Entrance roller release /stopper HP sensor S5
02 1C40 Sensor error * stack tray clock sensor S14
02 1C42 Sensor error * Additional tray clock sensor S23
02 1001 Delay jam Entrance sensor S1
02 1101 Stationary jam Entrance sensor S1
02 1701 Early jam Entrance sensor S1
02 1102 Stationary jam Processing tray sensor S6
02 1300 POWER ON Entrance sensor,Processing tray sensor S1,S6
02 1F00 Early jam Entrance sensor S1
02 1500 Staple jam Stapler HP sensor,Stapler edging sensor S18,S19
02 1400 Door open Front cover switch SW1
T-7-12

* The state is recovered by opening and closing the Door, or turning OFF and then ON the
power supply.
S15 S16 S6 If the same jam is detected regardless of the operation above, the error code is displayed.
F-7-7

S18
S19
S20

S10 S13
S9
S7
S12
S11

F-7-8

7-119
7
7
7-120

Alarm Code Location Alarm


Description Details
of Trouble Code
33 - 0011 Fixing exhaust fan alarm SET: In case the fan abnormality occurred during a
Alarm Code job.
RESET: In case the fan operates normally during a
job
Location Alarm
Description Details 33 - 0022 Read Motor Cooling Fan The fan rotation signal cannot be detected after 3
of Trouble Code (FM1) alarm seconds have passed since the Read Motor Cooling
00 - 0246 Error code display Soft counter PCB cannot write normally. Fan (FM1) is turned ON. Check the connector
(4-digit) connection -> Replace the Read Motor Cooling Fan
00 - 0247 Error code display Soft counter PCB cannot restore data. (FM1).
(4-digit) 33 - 0023 Scanner Unit (DADF) The fan rotation signal cannot be detected after
02 - 0020 Front face DADF dust SET: In case that 'DADF dust correction with the Cooling Fan (FM3) 3 seconds have passed since the Scanner Unit
correction occurs front face roller during DADF paper interval" is alarm (DADF) Cooling Fan (FM3) is turned ON. Check the
enabled. connector connection -> Replace the Scanner Unit
02 - 0021 Reverse face DADF dust SET: In case that 'DADF dust correction with the (DADF) Cooling Fan (FM3).
correction occurs reverse face roller during DADF paper interval" is 33 - 0025 Scanner Unit (Reader) The fan rotation signal cannot be detected after
enabled. Cooling Fan (FM1) 3 seconds have passed since the Scanner Unit
02 - 0022 Insufficient LED light In case the light intensity is insufficient when LED alarm (Reader) Cooling Fan (FM1) is turned ON. Check
intensity error in front lighting the connector connection -> Replace the Scanner
scanner Unit (Reader) Cooling Fan (FM1).
02 - 0023 Insufficient LED light In case the light intensity is insufficient when LED 34 - 0002 Auto registration Abnormal data occurred on more or equal to 8 out of
intensity error in back lighting adjustment 10 sets of auto registration pattern.
scanner Dirt on the belt and scratches were wrongly detected
04 - 0008 Optional deck lifter error - as a pattern and discrepancy in reading data
09 - 0001 Drum life (Y) - occurred as the result.
09 - 0002 Drum life (M) - 34 - 0003 Auto registration Timeout occurred due to unsuccess in reading 10
09 - 0003 Drum life (C) - adjustment sets of auto registration pattern.
09 - 0004 Drum life (K) - Registration detection sensor failure, Registration
10 - 0001 No toner (Bk) (RDS - detection sensor cleaning member covered the
creates) registration detection sensor, or no image drew on
10 - 0002 No toner (Cy) (RDS - the belt.
creates) 37 - 0001 For R&D For R&D
10 - 0003 No toner (M) (RDS - 37 - 0002 For R&D For R&D
creates) 37 - 0003 For R&D For R&D
10 - 0004 No toner (Ye) (RDS - 37 - 0004 For R&D For R&D
creates) 37 - 0005 For R&D For R&D
11 - 0001 Waste toner alarm Detected waste toner bottle full. 37 - 0006 For R&D For R&D
31 - 0006 HDD failure when HDD failure when equipped with the mirroring 37 - 0007 For R&D For R&D
equipped with the function 37 - 1000 For R&D For R&D
mirroring function 37 - 2000 For R&D For R&D
33 - 0010 Scanner Unit Exhaust The fan rotation signal cannot be detected after 38 - 0001 For R&D For R&D
Fan (FM3) alarm 3 seconds have passed since the Scanner Unit 38 - 0002 For R&D For R&D
Exhaust Fan (FM2) of the Reader is turned ON. 50 - 0007 Insufficient light intensity Clean the Post-separation Sensor 3 (PCB2) if light
Check the connector connection -> Replace the in Post-separation intensity is insufficient when adjusting output of the
Scanner Unit Exhaust Fan (FM2). Sensor 3 (PCB2) sensor.

7-120
7
7
7-121
Location Alarm Location Alarm
Description Details Description Details
of Trouble Code of Trouble Code
50 - 0008 Insufficient light intensity Clean the Read Sensor 1 (PCB4) if light intensity is 73 - 0008 LIPS File management error in LIPS
in Read Sensor 1 insufficient when adjusting output of the sensor. 73 - 0009 LIPS Reception data management error
(PCB4) 73 - 0010 LIPS Page control error
50 - 0009 Insufficient light intensity Clean the Delivery Sensor (PCB5) if light intensity is 73 - 0011 LIPS Macro management error
in Delivery Sensor insufficient when adjusting output of the sensor. 73 - 0012 LIPS Color management error
(PCB5) 73 - 0013 LIPS Layout control error
50 - 0010 Successive occurrence Condition unable to separate 1st sheet of original 73 - 0014 LIPS Font management error
of separation alarm from the ADF occurs 3 times in a row. Check rotation
73 - 0015 LIPS Letter drawing error
of the Pickup Motor -> Check the life of the Pickup
73 - 0016 LIPS Graphic drawing error
Roller -> Check if paper lint is at the pickup slot.
73 - 0017 LIPS Image drawing error
50 - 0013 Insufficient light intensity Clean the Registration Sensor (PCB3) if light
73 - 0018 LIPS Display error to LCD
in Registration Sensor intensity is insufficient when adjusting output of the
(PCB3) sensor. 73 - 0019 LIPS Text mode command error layer error
61 - 0001 No staple Operation : User message is displayed on controller 73 - 0020 LIPS Vector mode command error layer error
(process tray assembly) of main unit. 73 - 0021 LIPS Utility execution control error
Printing operation is suspended when operating 73 - 0022 LIPS Database management error in LIPS
staple job during a print job. 73 - 0023 LIPS Menu control error in LIPS
Recovery method : Replenish with staples. 73 - 0024 LIPS Boot error in LIPS
62 - 0001 No staple Operation : Print operation is suspended after user 73 - 0025 LIPS When the graphic library is in use for image
(saddle assembly) message is displayed on controller of main unit. processing, if the memory allocation is failed.
Printing operation is suspended when operating 73 - 0026 LIPS Data format error of image mode
side-staple job during a print job. 75 - 0001 Error occurred in Yukon -
Recovery method : Replenish with staples. 75 - 0002 Error occurred due to -
65 - 0001 Punch dust full Operation : User message is displayed on controller invalid SVG analysis
of main unit. from Yukon
When punching during a print job, operation varies 75 - 9101 Video transfer error -
depending on the detection level of the punch dust (CLG-O1 Overrun error)
sensor. 75 - 9102 Video transfer error -
Punch dust detection level 1: Continue operation. (CLG-O1 VsyncB error)
Punch dust detection level 2: Suspend printing (in
75 - 9103 Video transfer error -
case punching operated 1000 times after the level 1
(CLG-O1 VsyncB,
detection)
Overrun error)
Recovery method : Remove punch dust.
75 - 9104 Video transfer error -
70 - 0001 Memory overflow -
(CLG-O1 VsyncA error)
70 - 0002 Font memory overflow -
75 - 9105 Video transfer error -
70 - 0003 Micromemory overflow - (CLG-O1 VsyncA,
70 - 0004 Image memory overflow - Overrun error)
70 - 0005 Pattern memory - 75 - 9106 Video transfer error -
overflow (CLG-O1 VsyncA,
70 - 0006 A hard disk error - VsyncB error)
70 - 0007 Detect operation - 75 - 9107 Video transfer error -
abnormality for the HDD (CLG-O1 VsyncA,
access request VsyncB, Overrun error)
73 - 0004 LIPS Overflow of work memory for translator 75 - 9108 Video transfer error -
73 - 0006 LIPS Error in configuration acquisition/management (CLG-O1 HsyncB error)
73 - 0007 LIPS Memory management error in LIPS

7-121
7
7
7-122
Location Alarm Location Alarm
Description Details Description Details
of Trouble Code of Trouble Code
75 - 9109 Video transfer error - 75 - 9118 Video transfer error -
(CLG-O1 HsyncB, (CLG-O1 HsyncA,
Overrun error) HsyncB error)
75 - 910A Video transfer error - 75 - 9119 Video transfer error -
(CLG-O1 HsyncB, (CLG-O1 HsyncA,
VsyncB error) HsyncB, Overrun error)
75 - 910B Video transfer error - 75 - 911A Video transfer error -
(CLG-O1 HsyncB, (CLG-O1 HsyncA,
VsyncB, Overrun error) HsyncB, VsyncB error)
75 - 910C Video transfer error - 75 - 911B Video transfer error -
(CLG-O1 HsyncB, (CLG-O1 HsyncA,
VsyncA error) HsyncB, VsyncB,
75 - 910D Video transfer error - Overrun error)
(CLG-O1 HsyncB, 75 - 911C Video transfer error -
VsyncA, Overun error) (CLG-O1 HsyncA,
75 - 910E Video transfer error - HsyncB, VsyncA error)
(CLG-O1 HsyncB, 75 - 911D Video transfer error -
VsyncA, VsyncB error) (CLG-O1 HsyncA,
75 - 910F Video transfer error - HsyncB, VsyncA,
(CLG-O1 HsyncB, Overun error)
VsyncA, VsyncB 75 - 911E Video transfer error -
,Overun error) (CLG-O1 HsyncA,
75 - 9110 Video transfer error - HsyncB, VsyncA,
(CLG-O1 HsyncA error) VsyncB error)
75 - 9111 Video transfer error - 75 - 911F Video transfer error -
(CLG-O1 HsyncA, (CLG-O1 HsyncA,Hsync
Overrun error) B,VsyncA,VsyncB,Overr
75 - 9112 Video transfer error - un error)
(CLG-O1 HsyncA, 75 - 9120 Video transfer error -
VsyncB error) (CLG-O1 timeout error)
75 - 9113 Video transfer error - 75 - B101 Video transfer error -
(CLG-O1 HsyncA, (CLG-O2 Overrun error)
VsyncB, Overrun error) 75 - B102 Video transfer error -
75 - 9114 Video transfer error - (CLG-O2 VsyncB error)
(CLG-O1 HsyncA, 75 - B103 Video transfer -
VsyncA error) error (CLG-O2
75 - 9115 Video transfer error - VsyncB,Overrun error)
(CLG-O1 HsyncA, 75 - B104 Video transfer error -
VsyncA, Overun error) (CLG-O2 VsyncA error)
75 - 9116 Video transfer error - 75 - B105 Video transfer error -
(CLG-O1 HsyncA, (CLG-O2 VsyncA,
VsyncA, VsyncB error) Overrun error)
75 - 9117 Video transfer error - 75 - B106 Video transfer error -
(CLG-O1 HsyncA, (CLG-O2 VsyncA,
VsyncA, VsyncB, VsyncB error)
Overun error)

7-122
7
7
7-123
Location Alarm Location Alarm
Description Details Description Details
of Trouble Code of Trouble Code
75 - B107 Video transfer error - 75 - B116 Video transfer error -
(CLG-O2 VsyncA, (CLG-O2 HsyncA,
VsyncB, Overrun error) VsyncA, VsyncB error)
75 - B108 Video transfer error - 75 - B117 Video transfer error -
(CLG-O2 HsyncB error) (CLG-O2 HsyncA,
75 - B109 Video transfer error - VsyncA, VsyncB,
(CLG-O2 HsyncB, Overun error)
Overrun error) 75 - B118 Video transfer error -
75 - B10A Video transfer error - (CLG-O2 HsyncA,
(CLG-O2 HsyncB, HsyncB error)
VsyncB error) 75 - B119 Video transfer error -
75 - B10B Video transfer error - (CLG-O2 HsyncA,
(CLG-O2 HsyncB, HsyncB, Overrun error)
VsyncB, Overrun error) 75 - B11A Video transfer error -
75 - B10C Video transfer error - (CLG-O2 HsyncA,
(CLG-O2 HsyncB, HsyncB, VsyncB error)
VsyncA error) 75 - B11B Video transfer error -
75 - B10D Video transfer error - (CLG-O2 HsyncA,
(CLG-O2 HsyncB, HsyncB, VsyncB,
VsyncA, Overun error) Overrun error)
75 - B10E Video transfer error - 75 - B11C Video transfer error -
(CLG-O2 HsyncB, (CLG-O2 HsyncA,
VsyncA, VsyncB error) HsyncB, VsyncA error)
75 - B10F Video transfer error - 75 - B11D Video transfer error -
(CLG-O2 HsyncB, (CLG-O2 HsyncA,
VsyncA, VsyncB HsyncB, VsyncA,
,Overun error) Overun error)
75 - B110 Video transfer error - 75 - B11E Video transfer error -
(CLG-O2 HsyncA error) (CLG-O2 HsyncA,
75 - B111 Video transfer error - HsyncB, VsyncA,
(CLG-O2 HsyncA, VsyncB error)
Overrun error) 75 - B11F Video transfer error -
75 - B112 Video transfer error - (CLG-O2 HsyncA,Hsync
(CLG-O2 HsyncA, B,VsyncA,VsyncB,Overr
VsyncB error) un error)
75 - B113 Video transfer error - 75 - B120 Video transfer error -
(CLG-O2 HsyncA, (CLG-O2 timeout error)
VsyncB, Overrun error) 76 - 0001 Font No memory for internal font
75 - B114 Video transfer error - 76 - 0002 Font Fails to assure the work area to analyze the font that
(CLG-O2 HsyncA, is downloaded at "Resource Download".
VsyncA error) 76 - 0003 Font Fails to access the file that stores the font.
75 - B115 Video transfer error - 76 - 0004 Font Fails to allocate the FM work memory.
(CLG-O2 HsyncA, 76 - 0005 Font Fails to analyze the internal font.
VsyncA, Overun error) 76 - 0006 Font Alignment of font data is wrong.
76 - 0007 Font Failed to allocate work memory with scaler. There
are 3 types depending on where to occur.

7-123
7
7
7-124
Location Alarm Location Alarm
Description Details Description Details
of Trouble Code of Trouble Code
76 - 0008 Font Failed to allocate work memory with scaler. There 83 - 0018 CanonPDF PDF analysis error
are 3 types depending on where to occur. Un-supported transparent object exists.
77 - 0001 PDL Fails to allocate the memory 84 - 0001 XPS memory full error -
77 - 0002 PDL Failure of rendering 84 - 0002 XPS spool full error -
77 - 0003 PDL DGL entry invalid 84 - 0003 XPS print range error -
77 - 0005 PDL Other errors 84 - 0004 XPS document data -
77 - 0006 PDL DLG memory insufficient error
78 - 0003 GL GL entry invalid 84 - 0005 XPS page data error -
78 - 0005 GL System memory full 84 - 0006 XPS image data error -
79 - 0001 In-house developed PCL PCL initialization error 84 - 0007 XPS font data error -
79 - 0002 In-house developed PCL PCL processing error 84 - 0008 XPS non-support image -
79 - 0003 In-house developed PCL Overflow of work memory for translator error
79 - 0004 In-house developed PCL Download overflow 84 - 0009 XPS rendering error -
80 - 0001 BDL Admin error T-7-13

80 - 0003 BDL DataArea error


80 - 0010 BDL Graphics error
80 - 0011 BDL Char error
80 - 0015 BDL Print data cannot process this version.
80 - 0016 BDL Overflow of work memory for translator
80 - 0018 BDL Syntax error
80 - 0019 BDL In case of invalid data format in BDL custom mode.
81 - 0001 Imaging Fails to allocate the memory
81 - 0002 Imaging Failure of rendering
81 - 0003 Imaging Overflow of work memory for translator
81 - 0004 Imaging Imaging initialization error
81 - 0005 Imaging Imaging processing error
82 - 0001 RIP H/W Dart hangup by the DisplayList injustice
83 - 0001 CanonPDF PDF data error
83 - 0002 CanonPDF PDF compression analysis error
83 - 0003 CanonPDF PDF page compression error
83 - 0004 CanonPDF PDF data processing error
83 - 0005 CanonPDF PDF memory full
83 - 0006 CanonPDF PDF temporary file error
83 - 0007 CanonPDF PDF color analysis error
83 - 0008 CanonPDF PDF data reading error
83 - 0009 CanonPDF PDF output selection error
83 - 0010 CanonPDF PDF process file error
83 - 0011 CanonPDF PDF access error
83 - 0012 CanonPDF PDF analysis access error
83 - 0013 CanonPDF PDF font error
83 - 0014 CanonPDF PDF rendering error
83 - 0015 CanonPDF PDF data decode error
83 - 0016 CanonPDF PDF print range error
83 - 0017 CanonPDF PDF error

7-124
7
8 Service Mode

■Overview

■COPIER

■FEEDER

■SORTER

■BOARD

8
8
8-2

Overview Service mode item explanations


Instructions on how to use service mode items can be found within the service mode itself. Explanatory texts for the initial window, main items, sub items and minor items can be
The information explains what items have been added or changed from previous models. displayed.
Select the desired initial window, main item, sub item or minor item, then pres [i] (Information
button) to display an explanatory text (hereafter, service mode contents) on the selected item.
Service Mode Menu
E.g., COPIER > DISPLAY > Version window
TOP Screen

1) Press [i]

4) A detailed explanation on the


item will be displayed (usage
scenarios, instructions,
settings range, etc.).
F-8-1 2) Minor item titles
"MODELIST" A brand new additional mode in the host machine. are displayed.
A function that can be used as a reference on
how to use each item in Service Mode is installed.
The new function, which will be described later, is
available in MODELIST Mode.
"MODELIST CLASSIC" This mode is same as the old machine. The new
function, which will be described later, is not
available in the MODELIST CLASSIC Mode.
If " MODELIST " or " MODELIST CLASSIC " is pressed, the screen will switch to initial screen for
each mode.

3) Select the desired


minor item and
press [i]

F-8-2
• The service mode contents can be displayed in J/E/F/I/G/S languages.
• Service mode contents, like system software, can be upgraded by SST.

8-2
8
8
8-3
I/O information enhancement Display of Error Code/Alarm Code description
On the COPIER > I/O, the mode to confirm input output signal of electrical parts used (sensor, The detail description of each code can be viewed on the error code and alarm code
motor, fan, etc), makes it easier to look for the intended electrical part. occurrence record screen.
And the screen will also display the input output signal.
Device classification ERROR CODE : COPIER > DISPLAY >ERR

1) Press the button.


Electrical parts
classification Which button to press, will depend on which
electrical parts intended and its device
classification. For instance, if the host
machine uses paper pass detection sensor,
then press the button on the "COPIER" and
"P-Sensor" position.

2) Then the selected electrical


parts classification's mark,
name, port number and 0/1
content will appear.
F-8-4
ALARM CODE : COPIER > DISPLAY >ERR

3) If the "i" button is pressed,


the screen displaying the
electrical parts array will appear.

[PS39]

[PS42] [PS43]
[PS40]

[PS41]
[PS37]

[PS34] [PS35] [PS36]


[PS38]
[PS33] [PS47]

[UN53]
[PS55]

[PS56]

F-8-3

F-8-5

8-3
8
8
8-4
COPIER > OPTION > BODY, Item Segmentation Security features
On the current machine, there are extremely many items in the COPIER > OPTION > BODY (in To prevent unauthorized access to Service Mode, Password set is enabled.
related to host machine specification), that it is difficult to reach the intended item.
In order to reach the intended item in shorter time, all items inside the BODY is classified to ■■Related service modes
15 categories.
• COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > PSWD-SW (Level1)
Set password type for transition to service mode.
Classification Name Description <Setting range>
Function switching FNC-SW Language, cassette, paper size type, NAVI/ 0: No password (default)
DA connection, count-up spec., document size
detection, dirt detection level
1: Service engineer
2: System administrator and Service engineer.
Display switching/ display timing DSPLY-SW UI (User Interface) display related
Image related (fixing) IMG-FIX Fixing related
• COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > SM-PSWD (Level2)
Image related (transfer) IMG-TR Primary transfer, secondary transfer, ITB
Password for service engineer for transition to service mode.
Image related (developing) IMG-DEV Developer related
<Setting range>
Image related (laser/ latent image) IMG-LSR Laser, latent image related
Image related (reader/ ADF) IMG-RDR Reader, ADF image related To reinforce the security, change the password from a default.
Image related (controller, other IMG-MCON MN-CON image related, and image related items
general items) other than those referred to above. ******** (eight digit numeral) [default: 11111111]
Image quality/ copy speed IMG-SPD Power down sequence
After the above setting, to enter Service Mode, enter password screen will appear.
Cleaning CLEANING Cleaning of charging unit, drum, transfer roller,
ITB, etc.
Environment settings ENV-SET Temperature, humidity, environmental heater,
condensation, log acquisition
Paper feed (pickup, delivery) FEED-SW Stack performance, motor speed adjustment,
delivery functions, etc.
Noise reduction SOUND Noise related
Network NETWORK Network settings, IFAX, SEND, E-RDS, etc.
Customization CUSTOM Customization
T-8-1

8-4
8
8
8-5
1) Additional Functions > System Settings > System Manager Settings > enter System
Switching Screen (Level 1 < - > 2)
Manager ID > enter System Password Settings > press OK button.
Switching screens between level 1 and 2 has been made easier.
When level 1 screen is displayed, press <LEVEL 1> in the right upper side of the screen, and
it will switch to level 2.

System
Manager
ID

System
Password

F-8-6
2) After entering the password for service technician (Service mode: COPIER > Option >
FNC-SW > SM-PSWD), press OK button.

SM-PSWD

F-8-7

MEMO :
If Service Engineer’s password is forgotten, password function is cancelable by using
Service Support Tool (SST).

F-8-8

8-5
8
8
8-6
Language switch Back-up of service mode
The language of the explanatory text displayed in the Service Mode can be switched by In factory setting, adjustments are made for each machine, and adjustment values are written
performing the below languange switch operation in User Mode in the service label.
The explanatory text can be displayed by installing the Service Mode Content (SCMNT) in When you replaced the DC controller PCB, or executed the RAM clear function, adjustment
HDD. values for ADJUST or OPTION return to default. Therefore, when you made adjustments and
Service Mode Content (SCMNT) can be installed and upgraded on SST. changed values of the Service Mode in the field, be sure to write down the changed values in
Additional Functions > Common Settings > Language Switch the service label. When there is no relevant field in the service label, write down the values in
a blank field.

Service Label

F-8-10

F-8-9

MEMO :
If the Service Mode Content (SMCNT) of the concerned language is not installed,
English explanatory text will be displayed.
If English-language Service Mode Content (SMCNT) is not installed either, explanatory
text can't be displayed.

8-6
8
8
8-7

COPIER MN-CONT
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
Display of MNCON firmware version
Lv.1 Details To display the firmware version of Main Controller PCB.
DISPLAY Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
■■VERSION RUI Display of remote UI version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of remote UI.
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION Use case When upgrading the firmware
DC-CON Display of DCON firmware version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.1 Details To display the firmware version of DC Controller PCB. PUNCH Display of Puncher Unit version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.1 Details To display the version of Puncher Unit.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
R-CON Display of RCON firmware version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.1 Details To display the firmware version of Reader Controller PCB. LANG-EN Display of English language file version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.1 Details To display the version of English language file.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
PANEL Dis of Control Panel CPU PCB ROM version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.1 Details To display the ROM version of Control Panel CPU PCB. LANG-FR Display of French language file version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.1 Details To display the version of French language file.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
ECO Display of ECO-ID PCB ROM version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.1 Details To display the ROM version of ECO-ID PCB LANG-DE Display of German language file version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.1 Details To display the version of German language file.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
FEEDER [Not used] Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SORTER Display of FIN-CONT firmware version LANG-IT Display of Italian language file version
Lv.1 Details To display the firmware version of Finisher Controller PCB. Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
NIB Display of network software version LANG-JP Display of Japanese language file ver
Lv.1 Details To display the version of the network software. Lv.1 Details To display the version of Japanese language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
PS/PCL Display of UFR function version LANG-CS Display of Czech language file version
Lv.1 Details To display the UFR function version Lv.2 Details To display the version of Czech language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SDL-STCH Dis of Saddle Sttch Ctrollr PCB ROM ver LANG-DA Display of Danish language file version
Lv.1 Details To display the ROM version of the Saddle Stitcher Controller PCB. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Danish language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
OP-CON Display of Option Controller PCB ROM ver LANG-EL Display of Greek language file version
Lv.1 Details To display the ROM ver of Option Controller PCB. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Greek language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-7
8
8
8-8
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
LANG-ES Display of Spanish language file version LANG-SV Display of Swedish language file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Spanish language file. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Swedish language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
LANG-ET Display of Estonian language file ver LANG-TW Dis of Chinese language file ver: trad
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Estonian language file. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Chinese language file (traditional).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
LANG-FI Display of Finnish language file version LANG-ZH Dis of Chinese language file ver: smpl
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Finnish language file. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Chinese language file (simplified).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
LANG-HU Display of Hungarian language file ver ECO-ID Display of ECO-ID code
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Hungarian language file. Lv.2 Details To display the ECO-ID code.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range ASCII character string (12 digits)
LANG-KO Display of Korean language file version GDI-UFR Display of UFR function version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Korean language file. Lv.1 Details To display the version of UFR function.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
LANG-NL Display of Dutch language file version LANG-BU Display of Bulgarian language file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Dutch language file. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Bulgarian language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
LANG-NO Display of Norwegian language file ver LANG-CR Display of Croatian language file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Norwegian language file. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Croatian language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
LANG-PL Display of Polish language file version LANG-RM Display of Romanian language file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Polish language file. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Romanian language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
LANG-PT Display of Portuguese language file ver LANG-SK Display of Slovak language file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Portuguese language file. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovak language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
LANG-RU Display of Russian language file version LANG-TK Display of Turkish language file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Russian language file. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Turkish language file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
LANG-SL Display of Slovenian language file ver MEAP Display of MEAP contents version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovenian language file. Lv.1 Details To display the version of MEAP contents in HDD.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-8
8
8
8-9
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
OCR-CN Display of Chinese OCR: simplified TTS-ES Dis of Spanish voice dictionary version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Chinese OCR (simplified). Lv.1 Details To display the version of Spanish voice dictionary.
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. “--.--” is displayed when no file is found.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
OCR-JP Display of Japanese OCR version TTS-DE Dis of German voice dictionary version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Japanese OCR. Lv.1 Details To display the version of German voice dictionary.
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. “--.--” is displayed when no file is found.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
OCR-KR Display of Korean OCR version WEB-BRWS Display of Web browser version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Korean OCR. Lv.1 Details To display the version of Web browser.
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. “--.--” is displayed when no file is found.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
OCR-TW Display of Chinese OCR ver: traditional HELP Display of easy NAVI version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Chinese OCR (traditional). Lv.1 Details To display the version of “EASY NAVI” file.
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Caution Version should be displayed for EASY NAVI function because it is an
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 external file.
BOOTROM Display of BOOTROM version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.1 Details To display the version of BOOTROM. Supplement/memo EASY NAVI function is equipped as standard instead of the
Use case When upgrading the firmware conventional HELP function.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 LANG-CA Display of Catalan language file version
TTS-JA Dis of Japanese voice dictionary version Lv.2 Details To display the version of Catalan language file.
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Japanese voice dictionary. “--.--” is displayed when no file is found.
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 WEBDAV Display of WebDAV version
TTS-EN Dis of English voice dictionary version Lv.1 Details To display the version of “WebDAV” file.
Lv.1 Details To display the version of English voice dictionary. “--.--” is displayed when no file is found.
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 TIMESTMP Display of timestamp version
TTS-IT Dis of Italian voice dictionary version Lv.1 Details To display the version of “Time Stamp” file.
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian voice dictionary. “--.--” is displayed when no file is found.
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 ASR-JA Dis of Japanese ASR dictionary version
TTS-FR Dis of French voice dictionary version Lv.1 Details To display the version of Japanese automatic speech recognition
Lv.1 Details To display the version of French voice dictionary. dictionary.
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. “--.--” is displayed when no file is found.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo ASR: Automatic Speech Recognition (voice recognition)

8-9
8
8
8-10
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
ASR-EN Dis of English ASR dictionary version MEDIA-EL Dis of Greek media information version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of English automatic speech recognition Lv.2 Details To display the version of Greek media information.
dictionary. Use case When upgrading the firmware
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Use case When upgrading the firmware MEDIA-ES Dis of Spanish media information version
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Lv.2 Details To display the version of Spanish media information.
Supplement/memo ASR: Automatic Speech Recognition (voice recognition) Use case When upgrading the firmware
MEDIA-JA Dis of Japanese media information ver Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Japanese media information. MEDIA-ET Dis of Estonian media information ver
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Estonian media information.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
MEDIA-EN Dis of English media information version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.2 Details To display the version of English media information. MEDIA-FI Dis of Finnish media information version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Finnish media information.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
MEDIA-DE Dis of German media information version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.2 Details To display the version of German media information. MEDIA-HU Dis of Hungarian media information ver
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Hungarian media information.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
MEDIA-IT Dis of Italian media information version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Italian media information. MEDIA-KO Dis of Korean media information version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Korean media information.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
MEDIA-FR Dis of French media information version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.2 Details To display the version of French media information. MEDIA-NL Dis of Dutch media information version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Dutch media information.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
MEDIA-ZH Dis of Chinese media info ver: smpl Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Chinese media information (simplified). MEDIA-NO Dis of Norwegian media information ver
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Norwegian media information.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
MEDIA-SK Dis of Slovak media information version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovak media information. MEDIA-PL Dis of Polish media information version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Polish media information.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
MEDIA-TK Dis of Turkish media information version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Turkish media information. MEDIA-PT Dis of Portuguese media information ver
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Portuguese media information.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
MEDIA-CS Dis of Czech media information version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Czech media information. MEDIA-RU Dis of Russian media information version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Russian media information.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-10
8
8
8-11
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
MEDIA-SL Dis of Slovenian media information ver SYSTEM Dis of Linux kernel/tool/driver/file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovenian media information. Lv.1 Details To display the version of Linux kernel/tool/driver/file.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
MEDIA-SV Dis of Swedish media information version ROOT Display of ROOT version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Swedish media information. Lv.1 Details To display the ROOT version.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
MEDIA-TW Dis of Chinese media info version:trad S-LNG-JP Dis of service mode Japanese file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Chinese media information (traditional). Lv.1 Details To display the version of Japanese language file in service mode.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
MEDIA-BU Dis of Bulgarian media information ver S-LNG-EN Dis of service mode English file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Bulgarian media information. Lv.1 Details To display the version of English language file in service mode.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
MEDIA-CR Dis of Croatian media information ver S-LNG-FR Dis of service mode French file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Croatian media information. Lv.1 Details To display the version of French language file in service mode.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
MEDIA-RM Dis of Romanian media information ver S-LNG-IT Dis of service mode Italian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Romanian media information. Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian language file in service mode.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
MEDIA-CA Dis of Catalan media information version S-LNG-GR Dis of service mode German file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Catalan media information. Lv.1 Details To display the version of German language file in service mode.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ECO2 [Not used] S-LNG-SP Dis of service mode Spanish file version
FAX1 Display of 1-line FAX PCB ROM version Lv.1 Details To display the version of Spanish language file in service mode.
Lv.1 Details To display the ROM version of 1-line FAX PCB. Use case When upgrading the firmware
“NULL” is displayed if the PCB is not connected. Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Use case When upgrading the firmware UI-RES Display of UI resource file version
Display/adj/set range ASCII character string (12 digits) Lv.1 Details To display the UIRES version.
FAX2/3/4 Dis of 2/3/4-line FAX PCB ROM version UIRES consists of the resource file which is necessary to display the
Lv.1 Details To display the ROM version of 2/3/4-line FAX PCB. native screen (top screen and software keyboard screen) of UI.
“NULL” is displayed if the PCB is not connected. Use case When checking the version at the time of downloading UIRES to
Use case When upgrading the firmware MFP
Display/adj/set range ASCII character string (12 digits) Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
IOCS Display of BIOS version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.1 Details To display the BIOS version. COPY-AP Display of COPY (JAVA UI) version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.1 Details To display the version of COPY application (JAVA UI).
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-11
8
8
8-12
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
SEND-AP Display of SEND (JAVA UI) version COPY-ZH Dis COPY appli Chinese file ver: smpl
Lv.1 Details To display the version of SEND application (JAVA UI). Lv.2 Details To display the simplified Chinese language file version of COPY
Use case When upgrading the firmware application (JAVA UI).
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
BOX-AP Display of BOX (JAVA UI) version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.1 Details To display the version of BOX application (JAVA UI). COPY-TW Dis of COPY appli Chinese file ver:trad
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the traditional Chinese language file version of COPY
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 application (JAVA UI).
MOBPR-AP Display of mobile print(JAVA UI) version Use case When upgrading the firmware
Lv.1 Details To display the version of the mobile print application (JAVA UI). Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Use case When upgrading the firmware COPY-KO Dis of COPY appli Korean file version
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Lv.2 Details To display the Korean language file version of COPY application
RPTL-AP Display of RUI portal version (JAVA UI).
Lv.1 Details To display the RUI portal version. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 COPY-CS Dis of COPY appli Czech file version
INTRO-AP Dis of useful func introduce appli ver Lv.2 Details To display the Czech language file version of COPY application (JAVA
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Introduction to Useful Features application. UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
TSP-JLK Dis of Image Data Analyzer PCB version COPY-DA Dis of COPY appli Danish file version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Image Data Analyzer PCB. Lv.2 Details To display the Danish language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-FR Dis of COPY appli French file version
COPY-EL Dis of COPY appli Greek file version
Lv.1 Details To display the French language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI). Lv.2 Details To display the Greek language file version of COPY application (JAVA
UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-IT Dis of COPY appli Italian file version
COPY-ET Dis of COPY appli Estonian file version
Lv.1 Details To display the Italian language file version of COPY application (JAVA
UI). Lv.2 Details To display the Estonian language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-DE Dis of COPY appli German file version
COPY-FI Dis of COPY appli Finnish file version
Lv.1 Details To display the German language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI). Lv.2 Details To display the Finnish language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-ES Dis of COPY appli Spanish file version
COPY-HU Dis of COPY appli Hungarian file version
Lv.1 Details To display the Spanish language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI). Lv.2 Details To display the Hungarian language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-12
8
8
8-13
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
COPY-NL Dis of COPY appli Dutch file version COPY-CR Dis of COPY appli Croatian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Dutch language file version of COPY application (JAVA Lv.2 Details To display the Croatian language file version of COPY application
UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-NO Dis of COPY appli Norwegian file version COPY-RM Dis of COPY appli Romanian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Norwegian language file version of COPY application Lv.2 Details To display the Romanian language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-PL Dis of COPY appli Polish file version COPY-SK Dis of COPY appli Slovak file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Polish language file version of COPY application (JAVA Lv.2 Details To display the Slovak language file version of COPY application (JAVA
UI). UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-PT Dis of COPY appli Portuguese file ver COPY-TK Dis of COPY appli Turkish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Portuguese language file version of COPY application Lv.2 Details To display the Turkish language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-RU Dis of COPY appli Russian file version COPY-CA Dis of COPY appli Catalan file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Russian language file version of COPY application Lv.2 Details To display the Catalan language file version of COPY application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-SL Dis of COPY appli Slovenian file version SEND-FR Dis of SEND appli French file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Slovenian language file version of COPY application Lv.1 Details To display the French language file version of SEND application (JAVA
(JAVA UI). UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-SV Dis of COPY appli Swedish file version SEND-IT Dis of SEND appli Italian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Swedish language file version of COPY application Lv.1 Details To display the Italian language file version of SEND application (JAVA
(JAVA UI). UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-ID Dis of COPY appli Indonesian file ver SEND-DE Dis of SEND appli German file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Indonesian language file version of COPY application Lv.1 Details To display the German language file version of SEND application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
COPY-BU Dis of COPY appli Bulgarian file version SEND-ES Dis of SEND appli Spanish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Bulgarian language file version of COPY application Lv.1 Details To display the Spanish language file version of SEND application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-13
8
8
8-14
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
SEND-ZH Dis SEND appli Chinese file ver: smpl SEND-NL Dis of SEND appli Dutch file version
Lv.2 Details To display the simplified Chinese language file version of SEND Lv.2 Details To display the Dutch language file version of SEND application (JAVA
application (JAVA UI). UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-TW Dis of SEND appli Chinese file ver:trad SEND-NO Dis of SEND appli Norwegian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the traditional Chinese language file version of SEND Lv.2 Details To display the Norwegian language file version of SEND application
application (JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-KO Dis of SEND appli Korean file version SEND-PL Dis of SEND appli Polish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Korean language file version of SEND application Lv.2 Details To display the Polish language file version of SEND application (JAVA
(JAVA UI). UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-CS Dis of SEND appli Czech file version SEND-PT Dis of SEND appli Portuguese file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the Czech language file version of SEND application (JAVA Lv.2 Details To display the Portuguese language file version of SEND application
UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-DA Dis of SEND appli Danish file version SEND-RU Dis of SEND appli Russian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Danish language file version of SEND application (JAVA Lv.2 Details To display the Russian language file version of SEND application
UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-EL Dis of SEND appli Greek file version SEND-SL Dis of SEND appli Slovenian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Greek language file version of the SEND application Lv.2 Details To display the Slovenian language file version of SEND application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-ET Dis of SEND appli Estonian file version SEND-SV Dis of SEND appli Swedish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Estonian language file version of SEND application Lv.2 Details To display the Swedish language file version of SEND application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-FI Dis of SEND appli Finnish file version SEND-ID Dis of SEND appli Indonesian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the Finnish language file version of SEND application Lv.2 Details To display the Indonesian language file version of SEND application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-HU Dis of SEND appli Hungarian file version SEND-BU Dis of SEND appli Bulgarian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the Hungarian language file version of SEND application Lv.2 Details To display the Bulgarian language file version of SEND application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-14
8
8
8-15
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
SEND-CR Dis of SEND appli Croatian file version INTRO-ZH Useful func intro Chinese file ver: smpl
Lv.2 Details To display the Croatian language file version of SEND application Lv.2 Details To display the version of simplified Chinese language file of
(JAVA UI). Introduction to Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-RM Dis of SEND appli Romanian file version INTRO-TW Useful func intro Chinese file ver: trad
Lv.2 Details To display the Romanian language file version of SEND application Lv.2 Details To display the version of traditional Chinese language file of
(JAVA UI). Introduction to Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-SK Dis of SEND appli Slovak file version INTRO-KO Dis of useful func intro Korean file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the Slovak language file version of SEND application (JAVA Lv.2 Details To display the version of Korean language file of Introduction to
UI). Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-TK Dis of SEND appli Turkish file version INTRO-CS Dis of useful func intro Czech file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the Turkish language file version of SEND application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Czech language file of Introduction to Useful
(JAVA UI). Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
SEND-CA Dis of SEND appli Catalan file version INTRO-DA Dis of useful func intro Danish file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the Catalan language file version of SEND application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Danish language file of Introduction to
(JAVA UI). Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-FR Dis of useful func intro French file ver INTRO-EL Dis of useful func intro Greek file ver
Lv.1 Details To display the version of French language file of Introduction to Lv.2 Details To display the version of Greek language file of Introduction to Useful
Useful Features application. Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-IT Dis useful func intro Italian file ver INTRO-ET Dis useful func intro Estonian file ver
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian language file of Introduction to Useful Lv.2 Details To display the version of Estonian language file of Introduction to
Features application. Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-DE Dis of useful func intro German file ver INTRO-FI Dis useful func intro Finnish file ver
Lv.1 Details To display the version of German language file of Introduction to Lv.2 Details To display the version of Finnish language file of Introduction to
Useful Features application. Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-ES Dis useful func intro Spanish file ver INTRO-HU Dis useful func intro Hungarian file ver
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Spanish language file of Introduction to Lv.2 Details To display the version of Hungarian language file of Introduction to
Useful Features application. Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-15
8
8
8-16
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
INTRO-NL Dis of useful func intro Dutch file ver INTRO-CR Dis useful func intro Croatian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Dutch language file of Introduction to Useful Lv.2 Details To display the version of Croatian language file of Introduction to
Features application. Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-NO Dis useful func intro Norwegian file ver INTRO-RM Dis useful func intro Romanian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Norwegian language file of Introduction to Lv.2 Details To display the version of Romanian language file of Introduction to
Useful Features application. Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-PL Dis of useful func intro Polish file ver INTRO-SK Dis of useful func intro Slovak file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Polish language file of Introduction to Useful Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovak language file of Introduction to
Features application. Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-PT Dis useful func intro Portuguese filever INTRO-TK Dis useful func intro Turkish file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Portuguese language file of Introduction to Lv.2 Details To display the version of Turkish language file of Introduction to
Useful Features application. Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-RU Dis useful func intro Russian file ver INTRO-CA Dis useful func intro Catalan file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Russian language file of Introduction to Lv.2 Details To display the version of Catalan language file of Introduction to
Useful Features application. Useful Features application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-SL Dis useful func intro Slovenian file ver CSTMN-FR Dis of custom menu French file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovenian language file of Introduction to Lv.1 Details To display the version of French language file for custom menu
Useful Features application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-SV Dis useful func intro Swedish file ver CSTMN-IT Dis of custom menu Italian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Swedish language file of Introduction to Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian language file for custom menu
Useful Features application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-ID Dis of useful func intro Indon file ver CSTMN-DE Dis of custom menu German file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Indonesian language file of Introduction to Lv.1 Details To display the version of German language file for custom menu
Useful Features application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
INTRO-BU Dis useful func intro Bulgarian file ver CSTMN-ES Dis of custom menu Spanish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Bulgarian language file of Introduction to Lv.1 Details To display the version of Spanish language file for custom menu
Useful Features application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-16
8
8
8-17
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
CSTMN-ZH Dis custom menu Chinese file ver: smpl CSTMN-NL Dis of custom menu Dutch file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of simplified Chinese language file for custom Lv.2 Details To display the version of Dutch language file for custom menu
menu application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-TW Dis of custom menu Chinese file ver:trad CSTMN-NO Dis of custom menu Norwegian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of traditional Chinese language file for custom Lv.2 Details To display the version of Norwegian language file for custom menu
menu application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-KO Dis of custom menu Korean file version CSTMN-PL Dis of custom menu Polish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Korean language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Polish language file for custom menu
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-CS Dis of custom menu Czech file version CSTMN-PT Dis of custom menu Portuguese file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Czech language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Portuguese language file for custom menu
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-DA Dis of custom menu Danish file version CSTMN-RU Dis of custom menu Russian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Danish language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Russian language file for custom menu
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-EL Dis of custom menu Greek file version CSTMN-SL Dis of custom menu Slovenian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Greek language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovenian language file for custom menu
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-ET Dis of custom menu Estonian file version CSTMN-SV Dis of custom menu Swedish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Estonian language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Swedish language file for custom menu
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-FI Dis of custom menu Finnish file version CSTMN-ID Dis of custom menu Indonesian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Finnish language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Indonesian language file for custom menu
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-HU Dis of custom menu Hungarian file ver CSTMN-BU Dis of custom menu Bulgarian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Hungarian language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Bulgarian language file for custom menu
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-17
8
8
8-18
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
CSTMN-CR Dis of custom menu Croatian file version ACSBT-ZH Dis Accessibility Chinese file ver: smpl
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Croatian language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of simplified Chinese language file for
application. Accessibility application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-RM Dis of custom menu Romanian file version ACSBT-TW Dis accessibility Chinese file ver:trad
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Romanian language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of traditional Chinese language file for
application. Accessibility application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-SK Dis of custom menu Slovak file version ACSBT-KO Dis of accessibility Korean file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovak language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Korean language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-TK Dis of custom menu Turkish file version ACSBT-CS Dis of accessibility Czech file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Turkish language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Czech language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
CSTMN-CA Dis of custom menu Catalan file version ACSBT-DA Dis of accessibility Danish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Catalan language file for custom menu Lv.2 Details To display the version of Danish language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ACSBT-FR Dis of accessibility French file version ACSBT-EL Dis of accessibility Greek file version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of French language file for Accessibility Lv.2 Details To display the version of Greek language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ACSBT-IT Dis of accessibility Italian file ver ACSBT-ET Dis of accessibility Estonian file ver
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian language file for Accessibility Lv.2 Details To display the version of Estonian language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ACSBT-DE Dis of accessibility German file version ACSBT-FI Dis of accessibility Finnish file ver
Lv.1 Details To display the version of German language file for Accessibility Lv.2 Details To display the version of Finnish language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ACSBT-ES Dis of accessibility Spanish file ver ACSBT-HU Dis of accessibility Hungarian file ver
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Spanish language file for Accessibility Lv.2 Details To display the version of Hungarian language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-18
8
8
8-19
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
ACSBT-NL Dis of accessibility Dutch file version ACSBT-CR Dis of accessibility Croatian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Dutch language file for Accessibility Lv.2 Details To display the version of Croatian language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ACSBT-NO Dis of accessibility Norwegian file ver ACSBT-RM Dis of accessibility Romanian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Norwegian language file for Accessibility Lv.2 Details To display the version of Romanian language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ACSBT-PL Dis of accessibility Polish file version ACSBT-SK Dis of accessibility Slovak file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Polish language file for Accessibility Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovak language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ACSBT-PT Dis of accessibility Portuguese file ver ACSBT-TK Dis of accessibility Turkish file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Portuguese language file for Accessibility Lv.2 Details To display the version of Turkish language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ACSBT-RU Dis of accessibility Russian file ver ACSBT-CA Dis of accessibility Catalan file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Russian language file for Accessibility Lv.2 Details To display the version of Catalan language file for Accessibility
application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ACSBT-SL Dis of accessibility Slovenian file ver ERS-FR Display of ERS French file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovenian language file for Accessibility Lv.1 Details To display the version of French language file for ERS application.
application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
ACSBT-SV Dis of accessibility Swedish file ver ERS-IT Display of ERS Italian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Swedish language file for Accessibility Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian language file for ERS application.
application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
ACSBT-ID Dis of accessibility Indonesian file ver ERS-DE Display of ERS German file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Indonesian language file for Accessibility Lv.1 Details To display the version of German language file for ERS application.
application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
ACSBT-BU Dis of accessibility Bulgarian file ver ERS-ES Display of ERS Spanish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Bulgarian language file for Accessibility Lv.1 Details To display the version of Spanish language file for ERS application.
application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System

8-19
8
8
8-20
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
ERS-ZH Display of ERS Chinese file ver:smpl ERS-HU Display of ERS Hungarian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of simplified Chinese language file for ERS Lv.2 Details To display the version of Hungarian language file for ERS application.
application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System ERS-NL Display of ERS Dutch file version
ERS-TW Display of ERS Chinese file ver:trad Lv.2 Details To display the version of Dutch language file for ERS application.
Lv.2 Details To display the version of traditional Chinese language file for ERS Use case When upgrading the firmware
application. Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Use case When upgrading the firmware Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 ERS-NO Display of ERS Norwegian file version
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System Lv.2 Details To display the version of Norwegian language file for ERS
ERS-KO Display of ERS Korean file version application.
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Korean language file for ERS application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System ERS-PL Display of ERS Polish file version
ERS-CS Display of ERS Czech file version Lv.2 Details To display the version of Polish language file for ERS application.
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Czech language file for ERS application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System ERS-PT Display of ERS Portuguese file ver
ERS-DA Display of ERS Danish file version Lv.2 Details To display the version of Portuguese language file for ERS
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Danish language file for ERS application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
ERS-EL Display of ERS Greek file version ERS-RU Display of ERS Russian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Greek language file for ERS application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Russian language file for ERS application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
ERS-ET Display of ERS Estonian file version ERS-SL Display of ERS Slovenian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Estonian language file for ERS application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovenian language file for ERS application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System
ERS-FI Display of ERS Finnish file version ERS-SV Display of ERS Swedish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Finnish language file for ERS application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Swedish language file for ERS application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System

8-20
8
8
8-21
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
ERS-ID Display of ERS Indonesian file ver UAC-IT Display of UAC Italian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Indonesian language file for ERS Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian language file for UAC application.
application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System UAC-DE Display of UAC German file version
ERS-BU Display of ERS Bulgarian file version Lv.1 Details To display the version of German language file for UAC application.
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Bulgarian language file for ERS application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System UAC-ES Display of UAC Spanish file version
ERS-CR Display of ERS Croatian file version Lv.1 Details To display the version of Spanish language file for UAC application.
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Croatian language file for ERS application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System UAC-ZH Display of UAC Chinese file ver:smpl
ERS-RM Display of ERS Romanian file version Lv.2 Details To display the version of simplified Chinese language file for UAC
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Romanian language file for ERS application. application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
ERS-SK Display of ERS Slovak file version UAC-TW Display of UAC Chinese file ver:trad
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovak language file for ERS application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of traditional Chinese language file for UAC
Use case When upgrading the firmware application.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ERS-TK Display of ERS Turkish file version Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Turkish language file for ERS application. UAC-KO Display of UAC Korean file version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Korean language file for UAC application.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ERS-CA Display of ERS Catalan file version Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Catalan language file for ERS application. UAC-CS Display of UAC Czech file version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Czech language file for UAC application.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Supplement/memo ERS: Error Recovery System Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
UAC-FR Display of UAC French file version Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
Lv.1 Details To display the version of French language file for UAC application. UAC-DA Display of UAC Danish file version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Danish language file for UAC application.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control

8-21
8
8
8-22
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
UAC-EL Display of UAC Greek file version UAC-RU Display of UAC Russian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Greek language file for UAC application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Russian language file for UAC application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
UAC-ET Display of UAC Estonian file version UAC-SL Display of UAC Slovenian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Estonian language file for UAC application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovenian language file for UAC application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
UAC-FI Display of UAC Finnish file version UAC-SV Display of UAC Swedish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Finnish language file for UAC application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Swedish language file for UAC application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
UAC-HU Display of UAC Hungarian file version UAC-ID Display of UAC Indonesian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Hungarian language file for UAC application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Indonesian language file for UAC
Use case When upgrading the firmware application.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
UAC-NL Display of UAC Dutch file version Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Dutch language file for UAC application. UAC-BU Display of UAC Bulgarian file version
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of Bulgarian language file for UAC application.
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
UAC-NO Display of UAC Norwegian file version Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Norwegian language file for UAC UAC-CR Display of UAC Croatian file version
application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Croatian language file for UAC application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
UAC-PL Display of UAC Polish file version UAC-RM Display of UAC Romanian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Polish language file for UAC application. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Romanian language file for UAC application.
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
UAC-PT Display of UAC Portuguese file ver UAC-SK Display of UAC Slovak file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Portuguese language file for UAC Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovak language file for UAC application.
application. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control

8-22
8
8
8-23
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
UAC-TK Display of UAC Turkish file version BOX-FR Display of BOX appli French file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Turkish language file for UAC application. Lv.1 Details To display the version of French language file for BOX application
Use case When upgrading the firmware (JAVA UI).
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
UAC-CA Display of UAC Catalan file version BOX-IT Dis of BOX appli Italian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Catalan language file for UAC application. Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian language file for BOX application
Use case When upgrading the firmware (JAVA UI).
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Use case When upgrading the firmware
Supplement/memo UAC: User Access Control Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
BCT Display of self diagnosis tool version BOX-DE Display of BOX appli German file version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of self diagnosis tool. Lv.1 Details To display the version of German language file for BOX application
Use case When upgrading the firmware (JAVA UI).
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only) Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
ASR-ES Dis of Spanish ASR dictionary version BOX-ES Dis of BOX appli Spanish file version
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Spanish automatic speech recognition Lv.1 Details To display the version of Spanish language file for BOX application
dictionary. (JAVA UI).
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. Use case When upgrading the firmware
Use case When upgrading the firmware Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 BOX-ZH Dis of BOX appli Chinese file ver:smpl
Supplement/memo ASR: Automatic Speech Recognition (voice recognition) Lv.2 Details To display the version of simplified Chinese language file for BOX
ASR-FR Dis of French ASR dictionary version application (JAVA UI).
Lv.1 Details To display the version of French automatic speech recognition Use case When upgrading the firmware
dictionary. Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. BOX-TW Dis of BOX appli Chinese file ver:trad
Use case When upgrading the firmware Lv.2 Details To display the version of traditional Chinese language file for BOX
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 application (JAVA UI).
Supplement/memo ASR: Automatic Speech Recognition (voice recognition) Use case When upgrading the firmware
ASR-IT Dis of Italian ASR dictionary version Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Lv.1 Details To display the version of Italian automatic speech recognition BOX-KO Display of BOX appli Korean file version
dictionary. Lv.2 Details To display the version of Korean language file for BOX application
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Supplement/memo ASR: Automatic Speech Recognition (voice recognition) BOX-CS Display of BOX appli Czech file version
ASR-DE Dis of German ASR dictionary version Lv.2 Details To display the version of Czech language file for BOX application
Lv.1 Details To display the version of German automatic speech recognition (JAVA UI).
dictionary. Use case When upgrading the firmware
“--.--” is displayed when no file is found. Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
Use case When upgrading the firmware BOX-DA Display of BOX appli Danish file version
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Lv.2 Details To display the version of Danish language file for BOX application
Supplement/memo ASR: Automatic Speech Recognition (voice recognition) (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99

8-23
8
8
8-24
COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION COPIER>DISPLAY>VERSION
BOX-EL Display of BOX appli Greek file version BOX-SL Dis of BOX appli Slovenian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Greek language file for BOX application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovenian language file for BOX application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
BOX-ET Dis of BOX appli Estonian file version BOX-SV Dis of BOX appli Swedish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Estonian language file for BOX application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Swedish language file for BOX application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
BOX-FI Dis of BOX appli Finnish file version BOX-ID Display of BOX appli Indonesian file ver
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Finnish language file for BOX application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Indonesian language file for BOX
(JAVA UI). application (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
BOX-HU Dis of BOX appli Hungarian file version BOX-BU Dis of BOX appli Bulgarian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Hungarian language file for BOX application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Bulgarian language file for BOX application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
BOX-NL Display of BOX appli Dutch file version BOX-CR Dis of BOX appli Croatian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Dutch language file for BOX application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Croatian language file for BOX application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
BOX-NO Dis of BOX appli Norwegian file version BOX-RM Dis of BOX appli Romanian file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Norwegian language file for BOX application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Romanian language file for BOX application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
BOX-PL Display of BOX appli Polish file version BOX-SK Display of BOX appli Slovak file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Polish language file for BOX application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Slovak language file for BOX application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
BOX-PT Display of BOX appli Portuguese file ver BOX-TK Dis of BOX appli Turkish file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Portuguese language file for BOX Lv.2 Details To display the version of Turkish language file for BOX application
application (JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
BOX-RU Dis of BOX appli Russian file version BOX-CA Dis of BOX appli Catalan file version
Lv.2 Details To display the version of Russian language file for BOX application Lv.2 Details To display the version of Catalan language file for BOX application
(JAVA UI). (JAVA UI).
Use case When upgrading the firmware Use case When upgrading the firmware
Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99 Display/adj/set range 00.01 to 99.99
T-8-2

8-24
8
8
8-25
■■USER ■■ACC-STS
COPIER>DISPLAY>USER COPIER>DISPLAY>ACC-STS
SPDTYPE Dis of Ctrollr Board engine speed type FEEDER Display of DADF connection state
Lv.1 Details To display the engine speed type (ppm) of Controller Board. Lv.1 Details To display the connecting state of DADF.
Use case When checking the engine speed type of Controller Board Use case When checking the connection between the machine and DADF
Display/adj/set range 55 to 75 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
BRWS-STS Display of service browser ON/OFF 0: Not connected, 1: Connected
Lv.1 Details To display whether the service browser can be used. SORTER Connect state of Finisher-related option
If the value is 1, [Service Browser] button is displayed on the service Lv.1 Details To display the connecting state of Finisher-related options.
mode initial screen. Use case When checking the connection of Finisher-related options
The value of BRWS-STS switches whenever COPIER> FUNCTION> Display/adj/set range Left column (connecting state of Finisher-related options): 1 to 5
INSTALL> BRWS-ACT is executed, but ON/OFF of service browser 1: Without Saddle
is enabled after reboot. If the service browser does not start even 2: With Saddle, without Folding Unit
though the value of BRWS-STS is 1, turn OFF/ON the main power 3: With Saddle and Inserter, without Folding Unit
switch. 4: With Saddle and Folding Unit, without Inserter
Use case When checking the operation mode of the service browser 5: With Saddle, Inserter and Folding Unit
Caution The value of BRWS-STS is linked with COPIER> FUNCTION> Right column (connecting state of Finisher-belonged Inserter): 0 to 4
INSTALL> BRWS-ACT, but the service browser cannot start even 0: no hole, 1: 2-hole, 2: 2/3-hole, 3: 4-hole, 4: 4-hole (SW)
though 1 is displayed unless the main power switch is turned OFF/ DECK Dis of Paper Deck connection state
ON. Lv.1 Details To display the connecting state of the Paper Deck.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 2 Use case When checking the connection between the machine and the Paper
1: ON (Available), 2: OFF (Not available) Decks
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> BRWS-ACT Display/adj/set range 0 to 5
T-8-3 0: Not connected, 1: Connected, 2 to 4: Not used, 5: Multi-purpose
Tray only
CARD Dis of connection state of Card Reader
Lv.1 Details To display the connecting state of Card Reader.
Use case When checking the connection between the machine and the Card
Reader
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: No card is inserted while the Card Reader is connected. (Copy is
not available.)
1: Card Reader is not connected, or card is inserted while the Card
Reader is connected. (Copy is available.)
RAM Display of MNCON PCB memory capacity
Lv.1 Details To display the memory capacity of the Main Controller PCB.
Use case When checking the memory capacity of the machine
Unit MB
Default value 1024
COINROBO Dis of Coin Manager connection state
Lv.1 Details To display the connecting state of the Coin Manager.
Use case When checking the connection between the machine and the Coin
Manager
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Not connected, 1: Connected

8-25
8
8
8-26
COPIER>DISPLAY>ACC-STS COPIER>DISPLAY>ACC-STS
NIB Display of Network PCB connection state HDD Display of HDD model name
Lv.1 Details To display the connecting state of the Network PCB. Lv.1 Details To display the model name of HDD.
Use case When checking the connection between the machine and the Use case When checking the model name of HDD used on the machine
Network PCB PCI1 Display of PCI1-connected PCB name
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 Lv.1 Details To display the name of the PCB that is connected to PCI1.
0: Not connected, 1: Ethernet PCB connected, 2: Token Ring PCB Use case When checking the name of the PCB that is connected to PCI1
connected, 3: Ethernet PCB + Token Ring PCB connected Display/adj/set range -: No PCB connected
NETWARE Dis of NetWare firmware install state Voice Board: Voice PCB
Lv.1 Details To display the installation state of the NetWare firmware. 3DES Board: Encryption PCB
Use case When checking whether NetWare firmware is installed to the 1Gbit-Board: Giga Ethernet PCB
machine PCI2 Display of PCI2-connected PCB name
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Lv.1 Details To display the name of the PCB that is connected to PCI2.
0: Not installed, 1: Installed Use case When checking name of the PCB that is connected to PCI2
SEND Display of SEND support PCB existence Display/adj/set range -: No PCB connected
Lv.1 Details To display whether there is PCB to support SEND function. iSLOT: iSLOT Wireless LAN PCB
SEND function can be used only when the PCB is mounted. Voice Board: Voice PCB
Use case When checking the connection between the machine and the PCB Voice Board R: Voice Recognition PCB (Display is hidden on this
that supports SEND function machine.)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 3DES Board: Encryption PCB
0: Not mounted, 1: Mounted 1Gbit-Board: Giga Ethernet PCB
PDL-FNC1 Display of enabling PDL function (1) PCI3 Display of PCI3-connected PCB name
Lv.1 Details To display enabling/disabling state of PDL function in bit row. Lv.1 Details To display the name of the PCB that is connected to PCI3.
When the corresponding bit for each function is 0, the function is Use case When checking name of the PCB that is connected to PCI3
disabled. When the corresponding bit is 1, the function is enabled. Display/adj/set range -: No PCB connected
Use case When displaying the available PDL on the machine iSLOT: iSLOT Wireless LAN PCB
Display/adj/set range 0000 0000 0000 0000 to 1111 1111 1111 1111 Voice Board: Voice PCB
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Voice Board R: Voice Recognition PCB (Display is hidden on this
bit31: BDL machine.)
bit30: PS 3DES Board: Encryption PCB
bit29: PCL 1Gbit-Board: Giga Ethernet PCB
bit28: PDF USBH-SPD Display of USB device connection speed
bit27: LIPS (LIPS/LX emulation) Lv.2 Details To display the connection speed of 8 USB devices to be connected
bit26: N201 (LIPS/LX emulation) to USB-Host chips.
bit25: I5577 (LIPS/LX emulation) High-speed connection may not be possible on some machines
bit24: ESC/P (LIPS/LX emulation) resulting in low-speed connection.
bit23: HPGL (LIPS/LX emulation) Sample message: USBH-SPD OFF OFF OFF FLL OFF HGH OFF
bit22: HPCL2 (LIPS/LX emulation) LOW
PDL-FNC2 Display of enabling PDL function (2) Use case When checking the connection speed of USB devices
Lv.1 Details To display enabling/disabling state of PDL function in bit row. Display/adj/set range OFF: Not connected, LOW: Low-speed connection, FLL: Full
When the corresponding bit for each function is 0, the function is connection, HGH: High-speed connection
disabled. When the corresponding bit is 1, the function is enabled. IA-RAM Display of MNCON PCB memory(IA) capacity
Use case When displaying the available PDL on the machine Lv.1 Details To display the memory (IA) capacity of the Main Controller PCB.
Display/adj/set range 0000 0000 0000 0000 to 1111 1111 1111 1111 Use case When checking the memory capacity of the Main Controller PCB
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Unit MB
b15 to b0: Reserved (to be used when PDL is newly added) Default value 1024
T-8-4

8-26
8
8
8-27
■■ANALOG COPIER>DISPLAY>ANALOG
TEMP2 Display of inside temperature
COPIER>DISPLAY>ANALOG Lv.1 Details To display the temperature inside the machine detected by the
TEMP Display of outside temperature Environment Sensor 1.
Lv.1 Details To display the temperature outside the machine. Use case When checking the temperature inside the machine
This is measured by the Environment Sensor 2 that detects the Display/adj/set range 0 to 100
outside air.
Unit Deg C
Appropriate target value 20 to 27
Use case When checking the temperature outside the machine
HUM2 Display of inside humidity
Display/adj/set range 0 to 50
Lv.1 Details To display the humidity inside the machine detected by the
Unit Deg C
Environment Sensor 1.
Appropriate target value 20 to 27
Use case When checking the humidity inside the machine
HUM Display of outside humidity
Display/adj/set range 0 to 100
Lv.1 Details To display the humidity outside the machine.
Unit %
This is measured by the Environment Sensor 2 that detects the
Appropriate target value 30 to 70
outside air.
FIX-E3 Dis of Fixing Heater rear edge temp
Use case When checking the humidity outside the machine
Lv.1 Details To display the rear edge temperature of the Fixing Heater detected
Display/adj/set range 0 to 100
by the Sub Thermistor 2.
Unit %
Use case When checking the edge temperature of the Fixing Heater
Appropriate target value 30 to 70
Display/adj/set range 0 to 300
ABS-HUM Display of outside moisture amount
Unit Deg C
Lv.1 Details To display the absolute moisture amount outside the machine.
T-8-5
This is measured by the Environment Sensor 2 that detects the
outside air.
Use case When checking the moisture amount outside the machine
Display/adj/set range 0 to 100
Unit g (g/m3)
Appropriate target value 0 to 22
FIX-C Display of Fixing Film temperature
Lv.1 Details To display the center temperature of the Fixing Film detected by the
Main Thermistor 2.
Use case When checking the temperature of Fixing Film
Display/adj/set range 0 to 300
Unit Deg C
FIX-E Dis of Fixing Heater center temperature
Lv.1 Details To display the center temperature of the Fixing Heater detected by
the Main Thermistor 1.
Use case When checking the temperature at the center of Fixing Heater
Display/adj/set range 0 to 300
Unit Deg C
FIX-E2 Dis of Fixing Heater front edge temp
Lv.1 Details To display the front edge temperature of the Fixing Heater detected
by the Sub Thermistor 1.
Use case When checking the edge temperature of the Fixing Heater
Display/adj/set range 0 to 300
Unit Deg C

8-27
8
8
8-28
■■CST-STS ■■HV-STS
COPIER>DISPLAY>CST-STS COPIER>DISPLAY>HV-STS
WIDTH-MF Dis of Multi-purpose Tray ppr width size 1ATVC-Y Dis pry trns paper interval current (Y)
Lv.2 Details To display the paper width size set on the Multi-purpose Tray. Lv.2 Details To display the decuple value of the paper interval current lastly flown
Use case When checking the paper width side set on the Multi-purpose Tray on the Primary Transfer Roller (Y) by the primary transfer paper
Unit mm interval ATVC control.
T-8-6 Use case When estimating the life of Primary Transfer Roller based on the
displayed value
Display/adj/set range 0 to 900
Unit µA
Appropriate target value 10 to 500
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> 1TR-CLR
1ATVC-M Dis pry trns paper interval current (M)
Lv.2 Details To display the decuple value of the paper interval current lastly flown
on the Primary Transfer Roller (M) by the primary transfer paper
interval ATVC control.
Use case When estimating the life of Primary Transfer Roller based on the
displayed value
Display/adj/set range 0 to 900
Unit µA
Appropriate target value 10 to 500
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> 1TR-CLR
1ATVC-C Dis pry trns paper interval current (C)
Lv.2 Details To display the decuple value of the paper interval current lastly flown
on the Primary Transfer Roller (C) by the primary transfer paper
interval ATVC control.
Use case When estimating the life of Primary Transfer Roller based on the
displayed value
Display/adj/set range 0 to 900
Unit µA
Appropriate target value 10 to 500
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> 1TR-CLR
1ATVC-K4 Dis pry trns ppr intvl crrnt (Bk):clr
Lv.2 Details To display the decuple value of the paper interval current lastly flown
on the Primary Transfer Roller (Bk) by the primary transfer paper
interval ATVC control at full-color jobs.
Use case When estimating the life of Primary Transfer Roller based on the
displayed value
Display/adj/set range 0 to 900
Unit µA
Appropriate target value 10 to 500
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> 1TR-CLR

8-28
8
8
8-29
COPIER>DISPLAY>HV-STS ■■CCD
2ATVC Dis of Sec Transfer ATVC target current
Lv.2 Details To display the decuple value of the current, which is derived by the
COPIER>DISPLAY>CCD
secondary transfer ATVC control, flown on the Secondary Transfer TARGET-B Shading target value (B)
Outer Roller. Lv.2 Details To display the shading target value of Blue.
As the use of Secondary Transfer Outer Roller is extended, the value Continuous display of 0 (minimum) or FFFF (maximum) is considered
is decreased. a failure of the Reader Controller PCB.
Use case When classifying the cause of an image failure Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535 - At scanned image failure
Unit µA Display/adj/set range 0 to FFFF
Appropriate target value 10 to 900 Appropriate target value 512 to 2047
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> 2TR-CLR TARGET-G Shading target value (G)
THCK-Y Display of Y Drum abrasion amount Lv.2 Details To display the target value of Green.
Lv.1 Details To display the abrasion amount of Y Photosensitive Drum that is Continuous display of 0 (minimum) or FFFF (maximum) is considered
derived by the result of the drum thickness detection. a failure of the Reader Controller PCB.
The result of the drum thickness detection is reflected to each control Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
of charging, development and transfer. - At scanned image failure
Use case - When checking the adequacy of setting value for transfer and Display/adj/set range 0 to FFFF
development. Appropriate target value 512 to 2047
- When checking the changes of Drum thickness against the life of TARGET-R Shading target value (R)
Drum Cartridge. Lv.2 Details To display the shading target value of Red.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 20 Continuous display of 0 (minimum) or FFFF (maximum) is considered
Unit µm a failure of the Reader Controller PCB.
Appropriate target value 0 to 15 Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
THCK-M Display of M Drum abrasion amount - At scanned image failure
Lv.1 Details To display the abrasion amount of M Photosensitive Drum that is Display/adj/set range 0 to FFFF
derived by the result of the drum thickness detection. Appropriate target value 512 to 2047
The result of the drum thickness detection is reflected to each control GAIN-OB Gain level of Img Sensor odd bit(B): frt
of charging, development and transfer. Lv.2 Details To display the Blue gain level adjustment value in odd-numbered bit
Use case - When checking the adequacy of setting value for transfer and on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper front).
development. Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the
- When checking the changes of Drum thickness against the life of Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB.
Drum Cartridge. Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
Display/adj/set range 0 to 20 - At scanned image failure
Unit µm Display/adj/set range 0 to FFFF
Appropriate target value 0 to 15 Appropriate target value 16 to 246
THCK-C Display of C Drum abrasion amount GAIN-OG Gain level of Img Sensor odd bit(G): frt
Lv.1 Details To display the abrasion amount of C Photosensitive Drum that is Lv.2 Details To display the Green gain level adjustment value in odd-numbered
derived by the result of the drum thickness detection. bit on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper front).
The result of the drum thickness detection is reflected to each control Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the
of charging, development and transfer. Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB.
Use case - When checking the adequacy of setting value for transfer and Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
development. - At scanned image failure
- When checking the changes of Drum thickness against the life of Display/adj/set range 0 to FFFF
Drum Cartridge. Appropriate target value 16 to 246
Display/adj/set range 0 to 20
Unit µm
Appropriate target value 0 to 15
T-8-7

8-29
8
8
8-30
COPIER>DISPLAY>CCD COPIER>DISPLAY>CCD
GAIN-OR Gain level of Img Sensor odd bit(R): frt LAMP-CL Scan Lamp intensity adj VL(color): frt
Lv.2 Details To display the Red gain level adjustment value in odd-numbered bit Lv.2 Details To display the LED light intensity adjustment value of Scanner Unit
on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper front). (paper front) in color scanning mode.
Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the Use case When image failure occurs at front side scanning in color mode
Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB. Display/adj/set range 33 to 163
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB Appropriate target value 33 to 163
- At scanned image failure Supplement/memo LED cannot be replaced individually. Replace the Scanner Unit.
Display/adj/set range 0 to FFFF LAMP2-BW Scan Lamp intensity adj VL(B&W): back
Appropriate target value 16 to 246 Lv.2 Details To display the LED light intensity adjustment value of Scanner Unit
GAIN-EB Gain level of Img Sensor even bit(B):frt (paper back) in B&W scanning mode.
Lv.2 Details To display the Blue gain level adjustment value in even-numbered bit Use case When image failure occurs at back side scanning in B&W mode.
on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper front). Display/adj/set range 33 to 163
Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the Appropriate target value 33 to 163
Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB.
Supplement/memo LED cannot be replaced individually. Replace the Scanner Unit.
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
LAMP2-CL Scan Lamp intensity adj VL(color): back
- At scanned image failure
Lv.2 Details To display the LED light intensity adjustment value of Scanner Unit
Display/adj/set range 0 to FFFF
(paper back) in color scanning mode.
Appropriate target value 16 to 246
Use case When image failure occurs at back side scanning in color mode
GAIN-EG Gain level of Img Sensor even bit(G):frt
Display/adj/set range 33 to 163
Lv.2 Details To display the Green gain level adjustment value in even-numbered
Appropriate target value 33 to 163
bit on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper front).
Supplement/memo LED cannot be replaced individually. Replace the Scanner Unit.
Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the
OFST-BW Img Sensor offset value (B&W) [Front]
Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB.
Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor offset value at B&W scanning.
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
- At scanned image failure Use case When image failure occurs at front side scanning in B&W mode
Display/adj/set range 0 to FFFF Display/adj/set range 1 to 95
Appropriate target value 16 to 246 Appropriate target value 1 to 95
GAIN-ER Gain level of Img Sensor even bit(R):frt OFST-CL Img Sensor offset value (color) [Front]
Lv.2 Details To display the Red gain level adjustment value in even-numbered bit Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor offset value at color scanning.
on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper front). Use case When image failure occurs at front side scanning in color mode
Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the Display/adj/set range 1 to 95
Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB. Appropriate target value 1 to 95
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB OFST2-BW Img Sensor offset value (B&W) [Back]
- At scanned image failure Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor offset value at B&W scanning.
Display/adj/set range 0 to FFFF Use case When image failure occurs at back side scanning in B&W mode
Appropriate target value 16 to 246 Display/adj/set range 1 to 95
LAMP-BW Scan Lamp intensity adj VL(B&W): front Appropriate target value 1 to 95
Lv.2 Details To display the LED light intensity adjustment value of Scanner Unit GAIN-BW1 Img Sensor gain level adj VL1(B&W): frt
(paper front) in B&W scanning mode. Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor B&W gain level adjustment value 1 of
Use case When image failure occurs at front side scanning in B&W mode Scanner Unit (paper front).
Display/adj/set range 20 to 163 Use case When image failure occurs at front side scanning in B&W mode
Appropriate target value 20 to 163 Display/adj/set range 1 to 47
Supplement/memo LED cannot be replaced individually. Replace the Scanner Unit. Appropriate target value 1 to 47

8-30
8
8
8-31
COPIER>DISPLAY>CCD COPIER>DISPLAY>CCD
GAIN-BW2 Img Sensor gain level adj VL2(B&W): frt GAIN2-OR Gain level of Img Sensor odd bit(R): bck
Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor B&W gain level adjustment value 2 of Lv.2 Details To display the Red gain level adjustment value in odd-numbered bit
Scanner Unit (paper front). on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper back).
Use case When image failure occurs at front side scanning in B&W mode Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47 Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB.
Appropriate target value 1 to 47 Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
GAIN-BW3 Img Sensor gain level adj VL3(B&W): frt - At scanned image failure
Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor B&W gain level adjustment value 3 of Display/adj/set range 1 to 47
Scanner Unit (paper front). Appropriate target value 1 to 47
Use case When image failure occurs at front side scanning in B&W mode. GAIN2-OG Gain level of Img Sensor odd bit(G): bck
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47 Lv.2 Details To display the Green gain level adjustment value in odd-numbered
Appropriate target value 1 to 47 bit on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper back).
GAIN-BW4 Img Sensor gain level adj VL4(B&W): frt Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the
Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB.
Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor B&W gain level adjustment value 4 of
Scanner Unit (paper front). Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
- At scanned image failure
Use case When image failure occurs at front side scanning in B&W mode.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47
Appropriate target value 1 to 47
Appropriate target value 1 to 47
GAIN2-OB Gain level of Img Sensor odd bit(B): bck
GAIN2BW1 Img Sensor gain level adj VL1(B&W): Back
Lv.2 Details To display the Blue gain level adjustment value in odd-numbered bit
Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor B&W gain level adjustment value 1 of
on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper back).
Scanner Unit (paper back).
Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the
Use case When image failure occurs at back side scanning in B&W mode.
Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
Appropriate target value 1 to 47
- At scanned image failure
GAIN2BW2 Img Sensor gain level adj VL2(B&W): Back
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47
Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor B&W gain level adjustment value 2 of
Appropriate target value 1 to 47
Scanner Unit (paper back).
GAIN2-ER Gain level of Img Sensor even bit(R):bck
Use case When image failure occurs at back side scanning in B&W mode.
Lv.2 Details To display the Red gain level adjustment value in even-numbered bit
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47
on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper back).
Appropriate target value 1 to 47 Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the
GAIN2BW3 Img Sensor gain level adj VL3(B&W): Back Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB.
Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor B&W gain level adjustment value 3 of Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
Scanner Unit (paper back). - At scanned image failure
Use case When image failure occurs at back side scanning in B&W mode. Display/adj/set range 1 to 47
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47 Appropriate target value 1 to 47
Appropriate target value 1 to 47 GAIN2-EG Gain level of Img Sensor even bit(G):bck
GAIN2BW4 Img Sensor gain level adj VL4(B&W): Back Lv.2 Details To display the Green gain level adjustment value in even-numbered
Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor B&W gain level adjustment value 4 of bit on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper back).
Scanner Unit (paper back). Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the
Use case When image failure occurs at back side scanning in B&W mode. Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47 Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB
Appropriate target value 1 to 47 - At scanned image failure
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47
Appropriate target value 1 to 47

8-31
8
8
8-32
COPIER>DISPLAY>CCD ■■DPOT
GAIN2-EB Gain level of Img Sensor even bit(B):bck
Lv.2 Details To display the Blue gain level adjustment value in even-numbered bit
COPIER>DISPLAY>DPOT
on CMOS Sensor of Scanner Unit (paper back). 2TR-PPR Dis of sec trns ATVC ppr allotted voltg
Continuous display of upper limit is considered a failure of the Lv.2 Details To display the paper allotted voltage set by the latest secondary
Scanner Unit/Reader Controller PCB. transfer Full ATVC control.
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB The appropriate range may be exceeded due to wrong media setting.
- At scanned image failure Use case When transfer failure occurs on certain media
Display/adj/set range 1 to 47 Display/adj/set range 0 to 5000
Appropriate target value 1 to 47 Unit V
OFST2-CL Img Sensor offset value (color) [Back] Appropriate target value Depending on media
Lv.2 Details To display the CMOS Sensor offset value at color scanning. 2TR-BASE Dis of sec transfer ATVC base voltage
Use case When image failure occurs at back side scanning in color mode. Lv.2 Details To display the base voltage set by the latest secondary transfer Full
Display/adj/set range 1 to 95 ATVC control.
Appropriate target value 1 to 95 The appropriate range may be exceeded due to wrong media setting.
Use case When transfer failure occurs on certain media
T-8-8
Display/adj/set range 0 to 6000
Unit V
Appropriate target value 500 to 5000
1TR-DC-Y Dis of primary transfer voltage (Y)
Lv.2 Details To display the voltage lastly applied to the Primary Transfer Roller (Y).
Use case When transfer failure occurs due to the primary transfer
Display/adj/set range 0 to 5000
Unit V
Appropriate target value 300 to 3000
1TR-DC-M Dis of primary transfer voltage (M)
Lv.2 Details To display the voltage lastly applied to the Primary Transfer Roller (M).
Use case When transfer failure occurs due to the primary transfer
Display/adj/set range 0 to 5000
Unit V
Appropriate target value 300 to 3000
1TR-DC-C Dis of primary transfer voltage (C)
Lv.2 Details To display the voltage lastly applied to the Primary Transfer Roller (C).
Use case When transfer failure occurs due to the primary transfer
Display/adj/set range 0 to 5000
Unit V
Appropriate target value 300 to 3000
1TR-DC-K Dis of primary transfer voltage (Bk)
Lv.2 Details To display the voltage lastly applied to the Primary Transfer Roller
(Bk).
Use case When transfer failure occurs due to the primary transfer
Display/adj/set range 0 to 5000
Unit V
Appropriate target value 300 to 4000

8-32
8
8
8-33
COPIER>DISPLAY>DPOT COPIER>DISPLAY>DPOT
CHG-AC-Y Display of primary charging AC bias (Y) LPWR-C Display of laser power (C)
Lv.2 Details To display the primary charging AC bias lastly applied to the Primary Lv.2 Details To display C laser power determined by D-max control.
Charging Roller (Y). FF display with low image density is considered that the
Use case When the charging failure image occurs Photosensitive Drum may be nearly the end of life.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3000 Use case When the image density is low
Unit Vpp Display/adj/set range 00 - FF (hexadecimal)
Appropriate target value 1300 to 2000 Appropriate target value 60 to FF
CHG-AC-M Display of primary charging AC bias (M) LPWR-K Display of laser power (Bk)
Lv.2 Details To display the primary charging AC bias lastly applied to the Primary Lv.2 Details To display Bk laser power determined by potential control.
Charging Roller (M). FF display with low image density is considered that the
Use case When the charging failure image occurs Photosensitive Drum may be nearly the end of life.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3000 Use case When the image density is low
Unit Vpp Display/adj/set range 00 - FF (hexadecimal)
Appropriate target value 1300 to 2000 Appropriate target value 60 to FF
CHG-AC-C Display of primary charging AC bias (C) PVCONT-Y Dis of target patch contrast potntl (Y)
Lv.2 Details To display the primary charging AC bias lastly applied to the Primary Lv.2 Details To display the target Y-patch contrast potential.
Charging Roller (C). Check the target patch contrast potential to check whether the toner
Use case When the charging failure image occurs supply control is properly executed at image density failure.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3000 Investigate the other possible factors if the value is within the defined
range.
Unit Vpp
Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure
Appropriate target value 1300 to 2000
- When analyzing the cause of a problem
CHG-AC-K Display of primary charging AC bias (Bk)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Lv.2 Details To display the primary charging AC bias lastly applied to the Primary
Unit V
Charging Roller (Bk).
Appropriate target value 20 to 120
Use case When the charging failure image occurs
PVCONT-M Dis of target patch contrast potntl (M)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3000
Lv.2 Details To display the target M patch contrast potential.
Unit Vpp
Check the target patch contrast potential to check whether the toner
Appropriate target value 1300 to 2000
supply control is properly executed at image density failure.
LPWR-Y Display of laser power (Y)
Investigate the other possible factors if the value is within the defined
Lv.2 Details To display Y laser power determined by D-max control. range.
FF display with low image density is considered that the
Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure
Photosensitive Drum may be nearly the end of life.
- When analyzing the cause of a problem
Use case When the image density is low
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Display/adj/set range 00 to FF (hexadecimal)
Unit V
Appropriate target value 60 to FF
Appropriate target value 20 to 120
LPWR-M Display of laser power (M)
Lv.2 Details To display M laser power determined by D-max control.
FF display with low image density is considered that the
Photosensitive Drum may be nearly the end of life.
Use case When the image density is low
Display/adj/set range 00 - FF (hexadecimal)
Appropriate target value 60 to FF

8-33
8
8
8-34
COPIER>DISPLAY>DPOT COPIER>DISPLAY>DPOT
PVCONT-C Dis of target patch contrast potntl (C) LPGAIN-Y Dis of Y-color laser power gain value
Lv.2 Details To display the target C patch contrast potential. Lv.2 Details To display the gain value of Y laser power by D-max control.
Check the target patch contrast potential to check whether the toner Use case When checking D-max control results
supply control is properly executed at image density failure. Display/adj/set range -100 to 100
Investigate the other possible factors if the value is within the defined Unit %
range. Appropriate target value 0
Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DPOT> LPGAIN-M, LPGAIN-C
- When analyzing the cause of a problem
LPGAIN-M Dis of M-color laser power gain value
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Lv.2 Details To display gain value of M laser power by D-max control.
Unit V
Use case When checking D-max control results
Appropriate target value 20 to 120
Display/adj/set range -100 to 100
PVCONT-K Dis of target patch contrast potntl (Bk)
Unit %
Lv.2 Details To display the target Bk patch contrast potential.
Appropriate target value 0
Check the target patch contrast potential to check whether the toner
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DPOT> LPGAIN-Y, LPGAIN-C
supply control is properly executed at image density failure.
LPGAIN-C Dis of C-color laser power gain value
Investigate the other possible factors if the value is within the defined
range. Lv.2 Details To display gain value of C laser power by D-max control.
Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure Use case When checking D-max control results
- When analyzing the cause of a problem Display/adj/set range -100 to 100
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Unit %
Unit V Appropriate target value 0
Appropriate target value 20 to 120 Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DPOT> LPGAIN-Y, LPGAIN-M
VRATE-Y Display of D-max Y-color Vd gain value T-8-9

Lv.1 Details To display the gain value for the Y Vd set by D-max PASCAL/D-max
control against the environment table value.
Use case When the image density is not appropriate
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Unit %
VRATE-M Display of D-max M-color Vd gain value
Lv.1 Details To display the gain for the M Vd set by D-max PASCAL/D-max
control against the environment table value.
Use case When the image density is not appropriate
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Unit %
VRATE-C Display of D-max C-color Vd gain value
Lv.1 Details To display the gain for the C Vd set by D-max PASCAL/D-max
control against the environment table value.
Use case When image density is not appropriate
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Unit %
VRATE-K Dis of D-max PASCAL Bk-color Vd gain VL
Lv.1 Details To display the gain for the Bk Vd set by D-max PASCAL control
against the environment table value.
Use case When image density is not appropriate
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Unit %

8-34
8
8
8-35
■■DENS COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS
DENS-K Dis of Bk developer density change ratio
COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS Lv.1 Details To display difference between Bk-color developer density and the
DENS-Y Dis of Y developer density change ratio target value in % (percentage).
Lv.1 Details To display the difference between Y-color developer density and the Intolerable difference will trigger E020. This may be caused by
target value in % (percentage). deterioration of the developer, failure/disconnection of the ATR
Intolerable difference will trigger E020. This may be caused by Sensor or error in toner supply system.
deterioration of the developer, failure/disconnection of the ATR The value is updated upon print operation after power-on.
Sensor or error in toner supply system. Use case - When the density greatly fluctuates
The value is updated upon print operation after power-on. - When the density is unstable even after gradation correction
Use case - When the density greatly Display/adj/set range -7 to 7
- When the density is unstable even after gradation correction Unit %
Display/adj/set range -7 to 7 Appropriate target value -4.5 to 4.5
Unit % Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> SGNL-K
Appropriate target value -4.5 to 4.5 DENS-S-Y Dis of ATR control patch density (Y)
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> SGNL-Y Lv.2 Details To display Y patch image density created by ATR control.
DENS-M Dis of M developer density change ratio Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
Lv.1 Details To display difference between M-color developer density and the Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
target value in % (percentage).
Appropriate target value 300 to 700
Intolerable difference will trigger E020. This may be caused by
DENS-S-M Dis of ATR control patch density (M)
deterioration of the developer, failure/disconnection of the ATR
Sensor or error in toner supply system. Lv.2 Details To display M patch image density created by ATR control.
The value is updated upon print operation after power-on. Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
Use case - When the density greatly fluctuates Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
- When the density is unstable even after gradation correction Appropriate target value 300 to 700
Display/adj/set range -7 to 7 DENS-S-C Dis of ATR control patch density (C)
Unit % Lv.2 Details To display C patch image density created by ATR control.
Appropriate target value -4.5 to 4.5 Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> SGNL-M Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
DENS-C Dis of C developer density change ratio Appropriate target value 300 to 700
Lv.1 Details To display difference between C-color developer density and the DENS-S-K Dis of ATR control patch density (Bk)
target value in % (percentage). Lv.2 Details To display Bk patch image density created by ATR control.
Intolerable difference will trigger E020. This may be caused by Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
deterioration of the developer, failure/disconnection of the ATR Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Sensor or error in toner supply system. Appropriate target value 300 to 700
The value is updated upon print operation after power-on. D-Y-TRGT Dis of ATR ctrl Y patch target density
Use case - When the density greatly fluctuates Lv.2 Details To display the target density for Y patch image created by ATR
- When the density is unstable even after gradation correction control.
Display/adj/set range -7 to 7 Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
Unit % Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value -4.5 to 4.5 Appropriate target value 300 to 700
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> SGNL-C D-M-TRGT Dis of ATR ctrl M patch target density
Lv.2 Details To display the target density for M patch image created by ATR
control.
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 300 to 700

8-35
8
8
8-36
COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS
D-C-TRGT Dis of ATR ctrl C patch target density SGNL-C Display of C-color developer density
Lv.2 Details To display the target density for C patch image created by ATR Lv.1 Details To display the measured value of C-color developer density.
control. The density is measured with the ATR Sensor (C) for each job.
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem The value is updated upon print operation after power-on.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
Appropriate target value 300 to 700 Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
REF-Y Dis of Y developer density target value Appropriate target value 20 to 230
Lv.1 Details To display the developer density target value for the ATR Sensor (Y). Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> DENS-C
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem SGNL-K Display of Bk-color developer density
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Lv.1 Details To display the measured value of Bk-color developer density.
Appropriate target value 20 to 230 The density is measured with the ATR Sensor (Bk) for each job.
REF-M Dis of M developer density target value The value is updated upon print operation after power-on.
Lv.1 Details To display the developer density target value for the ATR Sensor (M). Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Appropriate target value 20 to 230
Appropriate target value 20 to 230 Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> DENS-K
REF-C Dis of C developer density target value P-SENS-P Dis ATR ctrl base light intnsty (P-wave)
Lv.1 Details To display the developer density target value for the ATR Sensor (C). Lv.2 Details To display the light intensity (P-wave) reflected from the base (ITB)
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem at ATR control.
Intolerable values may be caused by Patch Sensor disconnection,
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
LED failure, stain on Sensor surface, Shutter failure, Registration
Appropriate target value 20 to 230
Patch Shutter Open/Close Solenoid failure, insufficient ITB cleaning,
REF-K Dis of Bk developer density target value
etc.
Lv.1 Details To display the developer density target value for the ATR Sensor (Bk).
Use case When checking the failure of Patch Sensor/ITB at low density,
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem fogging deterioration or E020 display
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 20 to 230 Appropriate target value 400 to 1000
SGNL-Y Display of Y-color developer density Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> P-SENS-S
Lv.1 Details To display the measured value of Y-color developer density. COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> PT-LPADJ
The density is measured with the ATR Sensor (Y) for each job. DEV-DC-Y Dis of developing DC voltage (Y)
The value is updated upon print operation after power-on.
Lv.2 Details To display the latest Y developing DC voltage Vdc.
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
Use case - When image failure occurs due to carrier adherence
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 - When fogging appears
Appropriate target value 20 to 230 - When fogging is deteriorated
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> DENS-Y Display/adj/set range 280 to 480
SGNL-M Display of M-color developer density Unit V
Lv.1 Details To display the measured value of M-color developer density. DEV-DC-M Dis of developing DC voltage (M)
The density is measured with the ATR Sensor (M) for each job. Lv.2 Details To display the latest M developing DC voltage Vdc.
The value is updated upon print operation after power-on.
Use case - When image failure occurs due to carrier adherence
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem - When fogging appears
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 - When fogging is deteriorated
Appropriate target value 20 to 230 Display/adj/set range 280 to 480
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> DENS-M Unit V

8-36
8
8
8-37
COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS
DEV-DC-C Dis of developing DC voltage (C) D-CRNT-P Dis of ATR ctrl dark current (P-wave)
Lv.2 Details To display the latest C developing DC voltage Vdc. Lv.2 Details To display the dark current value (P-wave) measured at ATR control.
Use case - When image failure occurs due to carrier adherence Use case When checking the Patch Sensor
- When fogging appears Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
- When fogging is deteriorated Appropriate target value 100 or under
Display/adj/set range 280 to 480 Supplement/memo Dark current: current flowing when the Patch Sensor LED is OFF.
Unit V D-CRNT-S Dis of ATR ctrl dark current (S-wave)
DEV-DC-K Dis of developing DC voltage (Bk) Lv.2 Details To display the dark current value (S-wave) measured at ATR control.
Lv.2 Details To display the latest Bk developing DC voltage Vdc. Use case When checking the Patch Sensor
Use case - When image failure occurs due to carrier adherence Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
- When fogging appears Appropriate target value 0 to 409
- When fogging is deteriorated Supplement/memo Dark current: current flowing when the Patch Sensor LED is OFF.
Display/adj/set range 280 to 480 P-SENS-S Dis ATR ctrl base light intnsty (S-wave)
Unit V Lv.2 Details To display the light intensity (S-wave) reflected from the base (ITB)
CHG-DC-Y Dis of primary charging DC voltage (Y) at ATR control.
Lv.2 Details To display the latest primary charging DC voltage of Y color. Intolerable values may be caused by insufficient ITB cleaning, etc.
Use case When low density or fogging occurs Use case When checking ITB failure at low density or fogging deterioration
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1500 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Unit V Appropriate target value 10 to 400
Appropriate target value 400 to 900 Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> P-SENS-P
CHG-DC-M Dis of primary charging DC voltage (M) COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> PT-LPADJ
Lv.2 Details To display the latest primary charging DC voltage of M color. DENS-Y-H Dis of ATR ctrl Y-clr T/D ratio history
Use case When low density or fogging occurs Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 Y-toner density log data (T/D ratio) detected
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1500 by the ATR Sensor (Y) at ATR control.
Unit V Sharp change in values may indicate ATR Sensor disconnection/
Appropriate target value 400 to 900 failure, whereas gradual change in values may indicate failure in
CHG-DC-C Dis of primary charging DC voltage (C) toner supply system.
Lv.2 Details To display the latest primary charging DC voltage of C color. Use case When checking toner density in the Developing Assembly at low
Use case When low density or fogging occurs density or fogging deterioration
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1500 Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Unit V Appropriate target value 20 to 230
Appropriate target value 400 to 900 DENS-M-H Dis of ATR ctrl M-clr T/D ratio history
CHG-DC-K Dis of Pry charge DC voltg (Bk)& gain VL Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 M-toner density log data (T/D ratio) detected
by the ATR Sensor (M) at ATR control.
Lv.2 Details To display the latest output value of primary charging DC voltage (Bk).
Sharp change in values may indicate ATR Sensor disconnection/
Use case When low density or fogging occurs
failure, whereas gradual change in values may indicate failure in
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1500
toner supply system.
Unit V
Use case When checking toner density in the Developing Assembly at low
Appropriate target value 400 to 900 density or fogging deterioration
D-K-TRGT Dis of ATR ctrl Bk patch target density Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Lv.2 Details To display the Bk patch image target density created by ATR control. Appropriate target value 20 to 230
Use case When analyzing the cause of a problem
Display/adj/set range 340 to 640
Appropriate target value 340 to 640

8-37
8
8
8-38
COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS
DENS-C-H Dis of ATR ctrl C-clr T/D ratio history DS-S-K-H Dis Bk clr patch image density history
Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 C-toner density log data (T/D ratio) detected Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 Bk-patch image density log data.
by the ATR Sensor (C) at ATR control. This provides cause judgment basis for E020 occurrence, etc.
Sharp change in values may indicate ATR Sensor disconnection/ Sharp change in values may indicate failure in Patch Sensor, Shutter
failure, whereas gradual change in values may indicate failure in or laser, whereas gradual change may indicate failure in toner supply
toner supply system. system.
Use case When checking toner density in the Developing Assembly at low This is particularly caused by Patch Sensor.
density or fogging deterioration Use case When analyzing the cause of E020
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 20 to 230 Appropriate target value 200 to 900
DS-S-Y-H Dis of Y-clr patch image density history P-LED-DA Dis of Patch Sensor LED light intensity
Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 Y-patch image density log data. Lv.2 Details To display the Patch Sensor LED intensity.
This provides cause judgment basis for E020 occurrence, etc. The stain on Sensor window or soiled ITB (ITB cleaning failure) is
Sharp change in values may indicate the failure in Patch Sensor, suspected if the background light intensity (P-wave) is too low even
Shutter or laser, whereas gradual change may indicate failure in with sufficient LED intensity and PT-LPADJ execution will not correct
toner supply system. the problem.
This is particularly caused by Patch Sensor. Use case When checking the Patch Sensor
Use case When analyzing the cause of E020 Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> P-SENS-P
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 SPL-LG-Y Display of Y toner supply history
Appropriate target value 200 to 900 Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 Y-toner supply log data.
DS-S-M-H Dis of M-clr patch image density history Each data represents the number of toner blocks supplied per paper.
Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 M-patch image density log data. Use case When checking toner supply status at E020 occurrence, low density
This provides cause judgment basis for E020 occurrence, etc. or fogging deterioration
Sharp change in values may indicate failure in Patch Sensor, Shutter Display/adj/set range 0 to 4
or laser, whereas gradual change may indicate failure in toner supply Appropriate target value 0 to 4
system. SPL-LG-M Display of M toner supply history
This is particularly caused by Patch Sensor. Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 M-toner supply log data.
Use case When analyzing the cause of E020 Each data represents the number of toner blocks supplied per paper.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Use case When checking toner supply status at E020 occurrence, low density
Appropriate target value 200 to 900 or fogging deterioration
DS-S-C-H Dis of C-clr patch image density history Display/adj/set range 0 to 4
Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 C-patch image density log data. Appropriate target value 0 to 4
This provides cause judgment basis for E020 occurrence, etc. SPL-LG-C Display of C toner supply history
Sharp change in values may indicate failure in Patch Sensor, Shutter Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 C-toner supply log data.
or laser, whereas gradual change may indicate failure in toner supply Each data represents the number of toner blocks supplied per paper.
system.
Use case When checking toner supply status at E020 occurrence, low density
This is particularly caused by Patch Sensor.
or fogging deterioration
Use case When analyzing the cause of E020
Display/adj/set range 0 to 4
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 4
Appropriate target value 200 to 900

8-38
8
8
8-39
COPIER>DISPLAY>DENS ■■MISC
DENS-K-H Dis of ATR ctrl Bk-clr T/D ratio history
Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 Bk-toner density log data (T/D ratio) detected
COPIER>DISPLAY>MISC
by the ATR Sensor (Bk) at ATR control. ENV-TR Dis of secondary transfer environment
Sharp change of values may indicate ATR Sensor disconnection/ Lv.1 Details To display the environment (moisture amount) of secondary transfer.
failure, whereas gradual change may indicate failure in toner supply Use case When checking the current installation environment of the machine
system. Display/adj/set range 1 to 3
Use case When checking toner density in the Developing Assembly at low Appropriate target value 1 to 3
density or fogging deterioration LPOWER-Y Display of laser light intensity (Y)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Lv.2 Details To display the Y laser intensity in real-time.
Appropriate target value 80 to 200 Use case When analyzing the cause of the image density failure
SPL-LG-K Display of Bk toner supply history Display/adj/set range 00 to FF
Lv.2 Details To display the latest 8 Bk-toner supply log data. Unit Hex. (hexadecimal)
Each data represents the number of toner blocks supplied per paper. Appropriate target value 50 to FF
Use case When checking the toner supply status at low density or fogging LPOWER-M Display of laser light intensity (M)
deterioration Lv.2 Details To display the M laser intensity in real-time.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 10 Use case When analyzing the cause of the image density failure
Appropriate target value 0 to 5 Display/adj/set range 00 to FF
T-8-10 Unit Hex. (hexadecimal)
Appropriate target value 50 to FF
LPOWER-C Display of laser light intensity (C)
Lv.2 Details To display the C laser intensity in real-time.
Use case When analyzing the cause of the image density failure
Display/adj/set range 00 to FF
Unit Hex. (hexadecimal)
Appropriate target value 50 to FF
LPOWER-K Display of laser light intensity (Bk)
Lv.2 Details To display the Bk laser intensity in real-time.
Use case When analyzing the cause of the image density failure
Display/adj/set range 00 to FF
Unit Hex. (hexadecimal)
Appropriate target value 50 to FF
ITB-POS Dis of ITB steering reference position
Lv.1 Details To display the steering reference position of ITB.
Use case At initial installation (after execution of COPIER> FUNCTION>
MISC-P> ITB-INIT)
Adj/set/operate method N/A (display only)
Display/adj/set range -580 to 580
Unit 1 pulse
Appropriate target value -300 to 450
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> ITB-INIT
T-8-11

8-39
8
8
8-40
■■HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
TGT-B-M Dis of ARCDAT screen B M-color target VL
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C Lv.2 Details To display the M-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control.
TGT-A-Y Dis of ARCDAT screen A Y-color target VL When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
Lv.2 Details To display the Y-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control. tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected.
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the Use case When hue variation occurs
target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Use case When hue variation occurs Appropriate target value 0 to 700
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Default value 255
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 TGT-B-C Dis of ARCDAT screen B C-color target VL
TGT-A-M Dis of ARCDAT screen A M-color target VL Lv.2 Details To display the C-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control.
Lv.2 Details To display the M-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control. When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected.
target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected. Use case When hue variation occurs
Use case When hue variation occurs Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Default value 255
Default value 255 TGT-B-K Dis of ARCDAT screen B Bk-clr target VL
TGT-A-C Dis of ARCDAT screen A C-color target VL Lv.2 Details To display the Bk-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control.
Lv.2 Details To display the C-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control. When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected.
target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected. Use case When hue variation occurs
Use case When hue variation occurs Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Default value 255
Default value 255 TGT-C-Y Dis of ARCDAT screen C Y-color target VL
TGT-A-K Dis of ARCDAT screen A Bk-clr target VL Lv.2 Details To display the Y-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control.
Lv.2 Details To display the Bk-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control. When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected.
target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected. Use case When hue variation occurs
Use case When hue variation occurs Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Default value 255
Default value 255 TGT-C-M Dis of ARCDAT screen C M-color target VL
TGT-B-Y Dis of ARCDAT screen B Y-color target VL Lv.2 Details To display the M-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control.
Lv.2 Details To display the Y-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control. When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected.
target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected. Use case When hue variation occurs
Use case When hue variation occurs Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Default value 255
Default value 255

8-40
8
8
8-41
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
TGT-C-C Dis of ARCDAT screen C C-color target VL SUM-A-K Dis ARCDAT screen A Bk-color ctrl differ
Lv.2 Details To display the C-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control. Lv.2 Details To display Bk-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the control.
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected. tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target
Use case When hue variation occurs value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 corrected.
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 255 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
TGT-C-K Dis of ARCDAT screen C Bk-clr target VL Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display the Bk-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control. SUM-B-Y Dis ARCDAT screen B Y-color ctrl differ
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the Lv.2 Details To display Y-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control.
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset the When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
target value). Check the Patch Sensor if not corrected. tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target
Use case When hue variation occurs value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 corrected.
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 255 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
SUM-A-Y Dis ARCDAT screen A Y-color ctrl differ Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display Y-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control. SUM-B-M Dis ARCDAT screen B M-color ctrl differ
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the Lv.2 Details To display M-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control.
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target
corrected. value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Use case When hue variation occurs corrected.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
SUM-A-M Dis ARCDAT screen A M-color ctrl differ Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display M-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control. SUM-B-C Dis ARCDAT screen B C-color ctrl differ
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the Lv.2 Details To display C-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control.
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target
corrected. value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Use case When hue variation occurs corrected.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
SUM-A-C Dis ARCDAT screen A C-color ctrl differ Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display C-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control. SUM-B-K Dis ARCDAT screen B Bk-color ctrl differ
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the Lv.2 Details To display Bk-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target control.
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
corrected. tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target
Use case When hue variation occurs value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 corrected.
Default value 0 Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0

8-41
8
8
8-42
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
SUM-C-Y Dis ARCDAT screen C Y-color ctrl differ SGNL-A-M Dis ARCDAT screen A M-patch current VL
Lv.2 Details To display Y-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control. Lv.2 Details To display the current M-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control.
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not Use case When hue variation occurs
corrected. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Use case When hue variation occurs Default value 0
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 SGNL-A-C Dis ARCDAT screen A C-patch current VL
Default value 0 Lv.2 Details To display the current C-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control.
SUM-C-M Dis ARCDAT screen C M-color ctrl differ When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
Lv.2 Details To display M-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control. range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the Use case When hue variation occurs
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not Default value 0
corrected. SGNL-A-K Dis ARCDAT screen A Bk-patch current VL
Use case When hue variation occurs Lv.2 Details To display the current Bk-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
Default value 0 range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
SUM-C-C Dis ARCDAT screen C C-color ctrl differ Use case When hue variation occurs
Lv.2 Details To display C-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the Default value 0
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target SGNL-B-Y Dis ARCDAT screen B Y-patch current VL
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Lv.2 Details To display the current Y-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control.
corrected.
When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
Use case When hue variation occurs range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
SUM-C-K Dis ARCDAT screen C Bk-color ctrl differ Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display Bk-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT SGNL-B-M Dis ARCDAT screen B M-patch current VL
control.
Lv.2 Details To display the current M-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control.
When hue variation occurs and the displayed value is not in the
When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
tolerable range, execute the auto gradation adjustment (reset target
range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Use case When hue variation occurs
corrected.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 0
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
SGNL-B-C Dis ARCDAT screen B C-patch current VL
Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display the current C-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control.
SGNL-A-Y Dis ARCDAT screen A Y-patch current VL
When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
Lv.2 Details To display the current Y-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control.
range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
Use case When hue variation occurs
range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0

8-42
8
8
8-43
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
SGNL-B-K Dis ARCDAT screen B Bk-patch current VL DLTA-A-M Dis of ARCDAT screen A M-density differ
Lv.2 Details To display the current Bk-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control. Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the M-patch target value and the
When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable current value of screen A in ARCDAT control.
range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer. When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Use case When hue variation occurs tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Default value 0 corrected.
SGNL-C-Y Dis ARCDAT screen C Y-patch current VL Use case When hue variation occurs
Lv.2 Details To display the current Y-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control. Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable Default value 0
range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer. DLTA-A-C Dis of ARCDAT screen A C-density differ
Use case When hue variation occurs Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the C-patch target value and the
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 current value of screen A in ARCDAT control.
Default value 0 When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
SGNL-C-M Dis ARCDAT screen C M-patch current VL tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Lv.2 Details To display the current M-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control.
corrected.
When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer. Use case When hue variation occurs
Use case When hue variation occurs Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Default value 0
Default value 0 DLTA-A-K Dis of ARCDAT screen A Bk-density differ
SGNL-C-K Dis ARCDAT screen C Bk-patch current VL Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Bk-patch target value and the
current value of screen A in ARCDAT control.
Lv.2 Details To display the current Bk-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Use case When hue variation occurs
corrected.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 0
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
SGNL-C-C Dis ARCDAT screen C C-patch current VL
Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display the current C-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control.
DLTA-B-Y Dis of ARCDAT screen B Y-density differ
When hue variation occurs or the value shown is not in the tolerable
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Y-patch target value and the
range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
current value of screen B in ARCDAT control.
Use case When hue variation occurs
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
Default value 0 value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
DLTA-A-Y Dis of ARCDAT screen A Y-density differ corrected.
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Y-patch target value and the Use case When hue variation occurs
current value of screen A in ARCDAT control. Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Default value 0
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0

8-43
8
8
8-44
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
DLTA-B-M Dis of ARCDAT screen B M-density differ DLTA-C-M Dis of ARCDAT screen C M-density differ
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the M-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the M-patch target value and the
current value of screen B in ARCDAT control. current value of screen C in ARCDAT control.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
DLTA-B-C Dis of ARCDAT screen B C-density differ DLTA-C-C Dis of ARCDAT screen C C-density differ
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the C-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the C-patch target value and the
current value of screen B in ARCDAT control. current value of screen C in ARCDAT control.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
DLTA-B-K Dis of ARCDAT screen B Bk-density differ DLTA-C-K Dis of ARCDAT screen C Bk-density differ
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Bk-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Bk-patch target value and the
current value of screen B in ARCDAT control. current value of screen C in ARCDAT control.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
DLTA-C-Y Dis of ARCDAT screen C Y-density differ TGT-A-Y2 ARCDAT scrn A Y-clr target VL (1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Y-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the Y-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control at
current value of screen C in ARCDAT control. 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not Appropriate target value 0 to 700
corrected. TGT-A-M2 ARCDAT scrn A M-clr target VL (1/2 SPD)
Use case When hue variation occurs Lv.2 Details To display the M-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control at
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 1/2 speed.
Default value 0 Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 700

8-44
8
8
8-45
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
TGT-A-C2 ARCDAT scrn A C-clr target VL (1/2 SPD) TGT-B-M3 ARCDAT scrn B M-color target VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the C-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control at Lv.2 Details To display the M-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control at
1/2 speed. 1/3 speed.
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
TGT-A-K2 ARCDAT scrn A Bk-clr target VL (1/2 SPD) TGT-B-C3 ARCDAT scrn B C-color target VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the Bk-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display the C-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control at
at 1/2 speed. 1/3 speed.
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
TGT-A-Y3 ARCDAT scrn A Y-color target VL(1/3 SPD) TGT-B-K3 ARCDAT scrn B Bk-clr target VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the Y-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control at Lv.2 Details To display the Bk-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control
1/3 speed. at 1/3 speed.
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
TGT-A-M3 ARCDAT scrn A M-color target VL(1/3 SPD) TGT-B-Y2 ARCDAT scrn B Y-color target VL(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the M-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control at Lv.2 Details To display the Y-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control at
1/3 speed. 1/2 speed.
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
TGT-A-C3 ARCDAT scrn A C-color target VL(1/3 SPD) TGT-B-M2 ARCDAT scrn B M-color target VL(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the C-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control at Lv.2 Details To display the M-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control at
1/3 speed. 1/2 speed.
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
TGT-A-K3 ARCDAT scrn A Bk-clr target VL(1/3 SPD) TGT-B-C2 ARCDAT scrn B C-color target VL(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the Bk-patch target value of screen A in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display the C-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control at
at 1/3 speed. 1/2 speed.
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
TGT-B-Y3 ARCDAT scrn B Y-color target VL(1/3 SPD) TGT-B-K2 ARCDAT scrn B Bk-clr target VL(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the Y-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control at Lv.2 Details To display the Bk-patch target value of screen B in ARCDAT control
1/3 speed. at 1/2 speed.
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Appropriate target value 0 to 700

8-45
8
8
8-46
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
TGT-C-Y2 ARCDAT scrn C Y-color target VL(1/2 SPD) TGT-C-K3 ARCDAT scrn C Bk-clr target VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the Y-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control at Lv.2 Details To display the Bk-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control
1/2 speed. at 1/3 speed.
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Appropriate target value 0 to 700
TGT-C-M2 ARCDAT scrn C M-color target VL(1/2 SPD) SUM-A-Y2 ARCDAT scrn A Y-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the M-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display Y-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control
at 1/2 speed. at 1/2 speed.
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
TGT-C-C2 ARCDAT scrn C C-color target VL(1/2 SPD) corrected.
Lv.2 Details To display the C-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control at Use case When hue variation occurs
1/2 speed. Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 SUM-A-M2 ARCDAT scrn A M-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD)
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 Lv.2 Details To display M-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control
TGT-C-K2 ARCDAT scrn C Bk-clr target VL(1/2 SPD) at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Lv.2 Details To display the Bk-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
at 1/2 speed.
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
corrected.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Use case When hue variation occurs
Appropriate target value 0 to 700
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
TGT-C-Y3 ARCDAT scrn C Y-color target VL(1/3 SPD)
Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display the Y-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control at
SUM-A-C2 ARCDAT scrn A C-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD)
1/3 speed.
Lv.2 Details To display C-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation
at 1/2 speed.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
TGT-C-M3 ARCDAT scrn C M-color target VL(1/3 SPD) value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Lv.2 Details To display the M-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control corrected.
at 1/3 speed. Use case When hue variation occurs
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Default value 0
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 SUM-A-K2 ARCDAT scrnA Bk-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD)
TGT-C-C3 ARCDAT scrn C C-color target VL(1/3 SPD) Lv.2 Details To display Bk-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control
Lv.2 Details To display the C-patch target value of screen C in ARCDAT control at at 1/2 speed.
1/3 speed. When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Use case When checking ARCDAT control operation tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Appropriate target value 0 to 700 corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0

8-46
8
8
8-47
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
SUM-B-Y2 ARCDAT scrn B Y-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD) SUM-C-Y2 ARCDAT scrn C Y-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display Y-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display Y-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/2 speed. at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SUM-B-M2 ARCDAT scrn B M-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD) SUM-C-M2 ARCDAT scrn C M-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display M-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display M-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/2 speed. at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SUM-B-C2 ARCDAT scrn B C-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD) SUM-C-C2 ARCDAT scrn C C-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display C-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display C-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/2 speed. at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SUM-B-K2 ARCDAT scrnB Bk-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD) SUM-C-K2 ARCDAT scrnC Bk-clr ctrl differ(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display Bk-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display Bk-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/2 speed. at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-47
8
8
8-48
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
DLT-A-Y2 ARCDAT scrn A Y-density differ (1/2 SPD) DLT-B-Y2 ARCDAT scrn B Y-density differ (1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between Y-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between Y-patch target value and the
current value of screen A in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed. current value of screen B in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
DLT-A-M2 ARCDAT scrn A M-density differ (1/2 SPD) DLT-B-M2 ARCDAT scrn B M-density differ (1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between M-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between M-patch target value and the
current value of screen A in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed. current value of screen B in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
DLT-A-C2 ARCDAT scrn A C-density differ (1/2 SPD) DLT-B-C2 ARCDAT scrn B C-density differ (1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between C-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between C-patch target value and the
current value of screen A in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed. current value of screen B in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
DLT-A-K2 ARCDAT scrn A Bk-density differ(1/2 SPD) DLT-B-K2 ARCDAT scrn B Bk-density differ(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between Bk-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between Bk-patch target value and the
current value of screen A in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed. current value of screen B in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
corrected. corrected.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-48
8
8
8-49
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
DLT-C-Y2 ARCDAT scrn C Y-density differ (1/2 SPD) SGL-A-Y2 ARCDAT scrnA Y-patch current VL(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between Y-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the current Y-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control
current value of screen C in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed. at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not Use case When hue variation occurs
corrected. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Use case When hue variation occurs Default value 0
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 SGL-A-M2 ARCDAT scrnA M-patch current VL(1/2 SPD)
Default value 0 Lv.2 Details To display the current M-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control
DLT-C-M2 ARCDAT scrn C M-density differ (1/2 SPD) at 1/2 speed.
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between M-patch target value and the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
current value of screen C in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed. tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the Use case When hue variation occurs
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not Default value 0
corrected. SGL-A-C2 ARCDAT scrnA C-patch current VL(1/2 SPD)
Use case When hue variation occurs Lv.2 Details To display the current C-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 at 1/2 speed.
Default value 0 When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
DLT-C-C2 ARCDAT scrn C C-density differ (1/2 SPD) tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between C-patch target value and the Use case When hue variation occurs
current value of screen C in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the Default value 0
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target SGL-A-K2 ARCDAT scrnA Bk ptch current VL(1/2 SPD)
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
Lv.2 Details To display the current Bk-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control
corrected.
at 1/2 speed.
Use case When hue variation occurs When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Default value 0 Use case When hue variation occurs
DLT-C-K2 ARCDAT scrn C Bk-density differ(1/2 SPD) Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between Bk-patch target value and the Default value 0
current value of screen C in ARCDAT control at 1/2 speed. SGL-B-Y2 ARCDAT scrnB Y-patch current VL(1/2 SPD)
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Lv.2 Details To display the current Y-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset the target
at 1/2 speed.
value). Check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer if not
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
corrected.
tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0
Default value 0

8-49
8
8
8-50
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
SGL-B-M2 ARCDAT scrnB M-patch current VL(1/2 SPD) SGL-C-C2 ARCDAT scrnC C-patch current VL(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the current M-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display the current C-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/2 speed. at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer. tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SGL-B-C2 ARCDAT scrnB C-patch current VL(1/2 SPD) SGL-C-K2 ARCDAT scrnC Bkpatch current VL(1/2 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the current C-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display the current Bk-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/2 speed. at 1/2 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer. tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SGL-B-K2 ARCDAT scrnB Bkpatch current VL(1/2 SPD) SUM-A-Y3 ARCDAT scrnA Y-clr ctrl differ (1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the current Bk-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display Y-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control
at 1/2 speed. at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer. tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
Use case When hue variation occurs value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
SGL-C-Y2 ARCDAT scrnC Y-patch current VL(1/2 SPD) Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display the current Y-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control SUM-A-M3 ARCDAT scrnA M-clr ctrl differ (1/3 SPD)
at 1/2 speed. Lv.2 Details To display M-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the at 1/3 speed.
tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer. When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Use case When hue variation occurs tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Default value 0 Use case When hue variation occurs
SGL-C-M2 ARCDAT scrnC M-patch current VL(1/2 SPD) Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Lv.2 Details To display the current M-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control Default value 0
at 1/2 speed. SUM-A-C3 ARCDAT scrnA C-clr ctrl differ (1/3 SPD)
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the Lv.2 Details To display C-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control
tolerable range, check the Patch Sensor or replace the developer. at 1/3 speed.
Use case When hue variation occurs When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
Default value 0 value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0

8-50
8
8
8-51
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
SUM-A-K3 ARCDAT scrnA Bk-clr ctrl differ(1/3 SPD) SUM-C-Y3 ARCDAT scrnC Y-clr ctrl differ (1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display Bk-patch control difference of screen A in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display Y-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/3 speed. at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer. value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SUM-B-Y3 ARCDAT scrnB Y-clr ctrl differ (1/3 SPD) SUM-C-M3 ARCDAT scrnC M-clr ctrl differ (1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display Y-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display M-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/3 speed. at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer. value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SUM-B-M3 ARCDAT scrnB M-clr ctrl differ (1/3 SPD) SUM-C-C3 ARCDAT scrnC C-clr ctrl differ (1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display M-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display C-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/3 speed. at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer. value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SUM-B-C3 ARCDAT scrnB C-clr ctrl differ (1/3 SPD) SUM-C-K3 ARCDAT scrnC Bk-clr ctrl differ(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display C-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display Bk-patch control difference of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/3 speed. at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer. value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
SUM-B-K3 ARCDAT scrnB Bk-clr ctrl differ(1/3 SPD) DLT-A-Y3 ARCDAT scrn A Y-density differ (1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display Bk-patch control difference of screen B in ARCDAT control Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Y-patch target value and the
at 1/3 speed. current value of screen A in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer. value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the
Use case When hue variation occurs developer.
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Use case When hue variation occurs
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0

8-51
8
8
8-52
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
DLT-A-M3 ARCDAT scrn A M-density differ (1/3 SPD) DLT-B-M3 ARCDAT scrn B M-density differ (1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the M-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the M-patch target value and the
current value of screen A in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed. current value of screen B in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the
developer. developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
DLT-A-C3 ARCDAT scrn A C-density differ (1/3 SPD) DLT-B-C3 ARCDAT scrn B C-density differ (1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the C-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the C-patch target value and the
current value of screen A in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed. current value of screen B in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the
developer. developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
DLT-A-K3 ARCDAT scrn A Bk-density differ(1/3 SPD) DLT-B-K3 ARCDAT scrn B Bk-density differ(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Bk-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Bk-patch target value and the
current value of screen A in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed. current value of screen B in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the
developer. developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0
DLT-B-Y3 ARCDAT scrn B Y-density differ (1/3 SPD) DLT-C-Y3 ARCDAT scrn C Y-density differ (1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Y-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Y-patch target value and the
current value of screen B in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed. current value of screen C in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the
developer. developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-52
8
8
8-53
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
DLT-C-M3 ARCDAT scrn C M-density differ (1/3 SPD) SGL-A-C3 ARCDAT scrnA C-patch current VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the M-patch target value and the Lv.2 Details To display the current C-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control
current value of screen C in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed. at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the Use case When hue variation occurs
developer. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Use case When hue variation occurs Default value 0
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 SGL-A-K3 ARCDAT scrnA Bkpatch current VL(1/3 SPD)
Default value 0 Lv.2 Details To display the current Bk-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control
DLT-C-C3 ARCDAT scrn C C-density differ (1/3 SPD) at 1/3 speed.
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the C-patch target value and the When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
current value of screen C in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed. tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the Use case When hue variation occurs
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the Default value 0
developer. SGL-B-Y3 ARCDAT scrnB Y-patch current VL(1/3 SPD)
Use case When hue variation occurs Lv.2 Details To display the current Y-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 at 1/3 speed.
Default value 0 When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
DLT-C-K3 ARCDAT scrn C Bk-density differ(1/3 SPD) tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Lv.2 Details To display the difference between the Bk-patch target value and the Use case When hue variation occurs
current value of screen C in ARCDAT control at 1/3 speed. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the Default value 0
tolerable range, execute auto gradation adjustment (reset target SGL-B-M3 ARCDAT scrnB M-patch current VL(1/3 SPD)
value). If not corrected, check Patch Sensor and replace the
Lv.2 Details To display the current M-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control
developer.
at 1/3 speed.
Use case When hue variation occurs When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Display/adj/set range -1023 to 1023 tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Default value 0 Use case When hue variation occurs
SGL-A-Y3 ARCDAT scrnA Y-patch current VL(1/3 SPD) Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Lv.2 Details To display the current Y-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control Default value 0
at 1/3 speed. SGL-B-C3 ARCDAT scrnB C-patch current VL(1/3 SPD)
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Lv.2 Details To display the current C-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control
tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
at 1/3 speed.
Use case When hue variation occurs When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Default value 0 Use case When hue variation occurs
SGL-A-M3 ARCDAT scrnA M-patch current VL(1/3 SPD) Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Lv.2 Details To display the current M-patch value of screen A in ARCDAT control Default value 0
at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0

8-53
8
8
8-54
COPIER>DISPLAY>HT-C
SGL-B-K3 ARCDAT scrnB Bkpatch current VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the current Bk-patch value of screen B in ARCDAT control
at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0
SGL-C-Y3 ARCDAT scrnC Y-patch current VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the current Y-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0
SGL-C-M3 ARCDAT scrnC M-patch current VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the current M-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0
SGL-C-C3 ARCDAT scrnC C-patch current VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the current C-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0
SGL-C-K3 ARCDAT scrnC Bkpatch current VL(1/3 SPD)
Lv.2 Details To display the current Bk-patch value of screen C in ARCDAT control
at 1/3 speed.
When hue variation occurs and the value shown is not in the
tolerable range, check Patch Sensor or replace the developer.
Use case When hue variation occurs
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Default value 0
T-8-12

8-54
8
8
8-55
IO Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P006 15 Third delivery flapper solenoid SL7 1:ON
■■Main Device (DCON > P004 to 029) 14 - - -
13 - - -
Address bit Name Mark Remarks 12 - - -
P004 15 - - - 11 - - -
14 Delivery fan 1 connect FM7 0:connect 10 - - -
13 Multi-purpose paper sensor PS47 1:paper 9 - - -
12 Duplex paper sensor PS38 1:paper 8 - - -
11 Third delivery sensor PS43 1:paper 7 - - -
10 Duplex inlet sensor PS40 1:paper 6 - - -
9 - - - 5 - - -
8 - - - 4 - - -
7 - - - 3 - - -
6 - - - 2 - - -
5 - - - 1 - FM10 1:halfspeed
4 - - - 0 - - -
3 - - - P007 Fixing heat exhaust fan 1,2 _half FM1,FM2 1:halfspeed
2 - - - 15
speed
1 - - - 14 Fixing cooling fan (front),(rear) FM5,FM6 1:ON
0 - - - Secondary transfer exhaust fan _ FM8 1:fullspeed
13
P005 15 - - - full speed
14 - - - Secondary transfer exhaust fan _ FM8 1:halfspeed
12
13 Second delivery sensor PS42 1:paper half speed
12 Reverse sensor PS39 1:paper Process cartridge fan (front) _full FM10 1:fullspeed
11
11 First delivery sensor PS41 1:paper speed
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - Fixing delivery motor_I1 M22 [I1:I0]=(00)0.88A,(01)0.62A(
7
6 - M28 0:CW1:CCW 10)0.51A,(11)0.09A
Laser shutter motor_I1 M28 [I1:I0]=(00)0.40A,(01)0.30A( 6 - M22
5 5 - - -
10)0.22A,(11)0.09A
4 - M28 - M27 0:CW=OPEN,
4
3 - - - 1:CCW=CLOSE
2 - SL5 1:ON Shutter motor_I1 M27 [I1:I0]=(00)0.40A,(01)0.30A(
3
1 - SL6 1:ON 10)0.22A,(11)0.09A
0 - SL4 1:ON 2 - M27
1 - - -
0 - FM1,FM2 1:fullspeed

8-55
8
8
8-56
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P008 15 - - - P010 15 Delivery fan 2 _full speed FM9 1:fullspeed
14 - - - 14 Delivery fan 2 _half speed FM9 1:halfspeed
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - UN21 1:bottle 8 - M26 1:ON
7 - - - 7 - - -
6 - - - 6 - - -
5 - - - 5 - - -
4 - UN59 0:new 4 - - -
3 - UN58 0:new 3 - CL1 1:ON
2 - UN57 0:new 2 - - -
1 - UN56 0:new Cassette 1 pickup motor_I1 M16 [I1:I0]=(00)1.01A,(01)0.79A(
1
0 - - - 10)0.51A,(11)0.09A
P009 15 DC interlock switch 1,2 SW3,SW4 1:DOOROPEN 0 - M16
14 Second delivery tray full sensor PS45 0:full P011 15 - - -
13 First delivery tray full sensor PS44 0:full 14 - - -
12 - - - Cassette 2 pickup motor_I1 M17 [I1:I0]=(00)1.01A,(01)0.79A(
13
11 Laser shutter sensor PS29 1:HP 10)0.51A,(11)0.09A
10 Front door sensor PS18 0:DOOROPEN 12 Cassette 2 pickup motor_I0 M17
9 - PS33 1:detect 11 - - -
8 - UN53 1:detect 10 - - -
7 - UN51 1:detect Registration motor_I1 M19 [I1:I0]=(00)1.10A,(01)0.84A(
9
6 - PS21 0:DOOROPEN 10)0.62A,(11)0.09A
5 - PS20 0:DOOROPEN 8 - M19
4 - PS37 1:paper 7 - - -
- PS32 1:A4,K8,B4/B5,A4-R 6 - - -
3 Multi-purpose motor_I1 M18 [I1:I0]=(00)1.10A,(01)0.84A(
0:LTR/LGL,EXE,LTR-R 5
2 - PS31 1:HP 10)0.62A,(11)0.09A
1 - PS30 1:engage 4 - M18
0 - PS19 0:DOOROPEN 3 - - -
2 - - -
Multi-purpose feed motor_I1 M20 [I1:I0]=(00)1.10A,(01)0.84A(
1
10)0.62A,(11)0.09A
0 - M20

8-56
8
8
8-57
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P012 15 - - - P014 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 Fixing arch sensor 2 PS36 1:paper Process cartridge fan (rear)_half FM4 0:halfspeed
13
12 Fixing arch sensor 1 PS35 1:paper speed
11 Fixing inlet sensor PS34 1:paper 12 - - -
10 - - - 11 Fixing motor_CW M21 0:CW1:CCW
9 - - - 10 - - -
8 - - - 9 Fixing motor_ON M21
7 - - - 8 - - -
6 - - - 7 - - -
5 - - - 6 - - 0:OFF
4 - - - 5 - - 1:OFF
3 - - - 4 - FM4 0:fullspeed
2 - - - First & Second delivery motor_I1 M23 [I1:I0]=(00)1.16A,(01)0.89A(
3
1 - - - 10)0.66A,(11)0.09A
0 - - - 2 - M23
P013 15 - - - 1 - - -
14 - - - 0 - - -
13 - - - P015 Third delivery motor_I1 M25 [I1:I0]=(00)0.93A,(01)0.74A(
15
12 - - - 10)0.44A,(11)0.09A
11 - - - 14 Third delivery motor_I0 M25
10 - - - 13 - - -
9 - - - 12 - - -
8 - - - Reverse roller motor_I1 M24 [I1:I0]=(00)0.72A,(01)0.51A(
11
7 - - - 10)0.39A,(11)0.09A
6 - - - 10 Reverse roller motor_I0 M24
5 - - - 9 - - -
4 - - - 8 - - -
3 - - - 7 Reverse roller motor M24 0:CW1:CCW
2 - - - 6 - - -
1 - - - 5 - - -
0 - - - 4 - - -
3 - - -
2 - - -
1 - - -
0 - - -

8-57
8
8
8-58
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P016 15 Cassette 3 size switch B_7 SW2 0:detect P018 15 - - -
14 Cassette 3 size switch B_6 SW2 0:detect 14 - - -
13 Cassette 3 size switch B_5 SW2 0:detect 13 - - -
12 Cassette 3 size switch B_4 SW2 0:detect 12 - - -
11 Cassette 3 size switch A_3 SW1 0:detect 11 - - -
10 Cassette 3 size switch A_2 SW1 0:detect 10 - - -
9 Cassette 3 size switch A_1 SW1 0:detect 9 - - -
8 Cassette 3 size switch A_0 SW1 0:detect 8 - - -
7 Cassette 4 size switch B_7 SW4 0:detect Cassette 3 pickup motor_I1 M1 (I1:I0)=(00)1.01A,(01)0.79A
7
6 Cassette 4 size switch B_6 SW4 0:detect (10)0.51A,(11)0.09A
5 Cassette 4 size switch B_5 SW4 0:detect 6 Cassette 3 pickup motor_I0 M1
4 Cassette 4 size switch B_4 SW4 0:detect Cassette 4 pickup motor_I1 M2 (I1:I0)=(00)1.01A,(01)0.79A
5
3 Cassette 4 size switch A_3 SW3 0:detect (10)0.51A,(11)0.09A
2 Cassette 4 size switch A_2 SW3 0:detect 4 Cassette 4 pickup motor_I0 M2
1 Cassette 4 size switch A_1 SW3 0:detect 3 - - -
0 Cassette 4 size switch A_0 SW3 0:detect 2 - - -
P017 15 Cassette 3 paper sensor PS2 0:paper 1 Cassette 4 pickup solenoid SL2 1:ON
14 Cassette 3 paper level sensor A PS4 0:paper 0 Cassette 4 pickup solenoid SL1 1:ON
13 Cassette 3 paper level sensor B PS5 0:paper P019 15 - - -
12 Cassette 3 pre-registration sensor PS8 1:paper 14 - - -
11 Cassette 4 paper sensor PS3 0:paper 13 - - -
10 Cassette 4 paper level sensor A PS6 0:paper 12 - - -
9 Cassette 4 paper level sensor B PS7 0:paper 11 - - -
8 Cassette 4 pre-registration sensor PS9 1:paper 10 - - -
7 Pedestal right cover sensor PS1 0:DOOROPEN 9 - - -
6 - - - 8 Cassette 3 pickup motor_CW M1 Hi:CCW/Low:CW
5 - - - 7 Cassette 4 pickup motor_CW M2 Hi:CCW/Low:CW
4 - - - 6 - - -
3 - - - 5 - - -
2 - - - 4 - - -
1 - - - 3 - - -
0 - - - 2 - - -
1 - - -
0 - - -

8-58
8
8
8-59
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P020 15 Cassette 1 size switch A_7 SW6 0:detect P022 15 ITB steering sensor PS24 1:ON
14 Cassette 1 size switch A_6 SW6 0:detect 14 ITB displacement sensor 1 PS25 1:ON
13 Cassette 1 size switch A_5 SW6 0:detect 13 ITB displacement sensor 2 PS26 1:ON
12 Cassette 1 size switch A_4 SW6 0:detect 12 ITB displacement sensor 3 PS27 1:ON
11 Cassette 1 size switch B_3 SW7 0:detect 11 ITB displacement sensor 4 PS28 1:ON
10 Cassette 1 size switch B_2 SW7 0:detect Primary transfer detachment PS22 0:engage
10
9 Cassette 1 size switch B_2- SW7 0:detect sensor 1
8 Cassette 1 size switch B_2 SW7 0:detect Primary transfer detachment PS23 1:engage
9
7 Cassette 2 size switch A_7 SW8 0:detect sensor 2
6 Cassette 2 size switch A_6 SW8 0:detect 8 - - -
5 Cassette 2 size switch A_5 SW8 0:detect 7 - - -
4 Cassette 2 size switch A_4 SW8 0:detect 6 - - -
3 Cassette 2 size switch B_3 SW9 0:detect 5 - - -
2 Cassette 2 size switch B_2 SW9 0:detect 4 - - -
1 Cassette 2 size switch B_1 SW9 0:detect 3 - - -
0 Cassette 2 size switch B_0 SW9 0:detect 2 - - -
P021 15 Cassette 1 paper sensor PS49 0:paper 1 Cassette 2 pickup solenoid SL3 1:ON
14 Cassette 1 paper level sensor A PS51 0:paper 0 Cassette 1 pickup solenoid SL2 1:ON
13 Cassette 1 paper level sensor B PS52 0:paper P023 15 - - -
12 Cassette 1 pre-registration sensor PS55 1:paper 14 - - -
11 Cassette 2 paper sensor PS50 0:paper 13 - - -
10 Cassette 2 paper level sensor A PS53 0:paper 12 - - -
9 Cassette 2 paper level sensor B PS54 0:paper 11 - - -
8 Cassette 2 pre-registration sensor PS56 1:paper 10 - - -
7 - - - 9 - - -
6 - - - 8 - - -
5 - - - 7 - - -
4 - - - 6 - - -
3 - - - 5 - - -
2 - - - 4 - - -
1 - - - 3 - - -
0 - - - 2 - - -
1 - - -
0 - - -

8-59
8
8
8-60
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P024 15 - - - P026 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 Toner container outer cover sensor PS17 1:close 12 - - -
Toner container inner cover sensor PS16 1:close 11 - - -
11
(Bk) 10 - - -
Toner container inner cover sensor PS15 1:close 9 - - -
10
(C) 8 - - -
Toner container inner cover sensor PS14 1:close Primary transfer separation motor_ M15 [I1:I0]=(00)1.06A,(01)0.87A(
9 7
(M) I1 10)0.69A,(11)0.09A
Toner container inner cover sensor PS13 1:close Primary transfer separation motor_ M15
8 6
(Y) I0
Toner container cam HP sensor PS8 1:HP 5 - - -
7
(Bk) Primary transfer separation motor_ M15 0:CW1:CCW
6 Toner container cam HP sensor (C) PS7 1:HP 4
CW
5 Toner container cam HP sensor (M) PS6 1:HP ITB displacement control motor_I1 M14 [I1:I0]=(00)0.74A,(01)0.66A(
3
4 Toner container cam HP sensor (Y) PS5 1:HP 10)0.24A,(11)0.09A
3 Piezo sensor (Bk) TS4 1:toner 2 ITB displacement control motor_I0 M14
2 Piezo sensor (C) TS3 1:toner 1 - - -
1 Piezo sensor (M) TS2 1:toner ITB displacement control motor_ M14 0:CW1:CCW
0
0 Piezo sensor (M) TS1 1:toner CW
P025 15 - - - P027 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 - - -
6 - - - 6 - - -
5 - - - 5 - - -
4 - - - 4 - - -
3 - - - 3 - - -
2 - - - 2 - - -
1 - - - 1 - - -
0 - - - 0 - - -

8-60
8
8
8-61
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P028 15 Deck open solenoid SL2D 1:ON P030 15 - - -
14 Deck lifter motor_lower limit signal M2D 1:ON 14 - - -
13 Deck lifter motor M2D 1:ON 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 Deck pickup clutch CL2D 1:ON 9 - - -
8 Deck pickup roller release solenoid SL1D 1:ON 8 - - -
7 Deck open indication LE100D 1:ON 7 - - -
6 Deck main motor M1D 1:ON 6 - - -
5 - - - 5 - - -
4 - - - 4 - - -
3 - - - 3 - - -
2 - - - 2 Baffer path delivery sensor PS2 1:paper
1 - - - 1 Baffer path open/close sensor PS3 1:paper
0 - - - 0 Baffer path entrance sensor PS1- 1:paper
P029 15 - - - T-8-13
14 - - -
13 - - -
Deck lifter lower limit sensing SW2D 1:lowerlimit
12
switch
11 Deck lifter upper limit sensor PS3D 1:upperlimit
10 Deck lifter position sensor PS4D 1:ON
9 Deck feed sensor PS1D 1:paper
8 - - -
7 Deck open sensor PS9D 1:CLOSE
6 Deck open sensing switch SW1D 0:CLOSE
5 Deck paper level sensor PS7D 1:paper
4 Deck paper-out sensor PS2D 0:nopaper
3 Deck pickup sensor PS6D 1:paper
2 Deck set sensor PS5D 1:conect
1 - - -
0

8-61
8
8
8-62
■■Color Image Reader Unit (RCON > P001 to 005) Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P003 15 - - -
Address bit Name Mark Remarks
14 - - -
P001 15 - - -
13 - - -
14 - - -
12 - - -
13 - - -
11 - - -
12 - - -
10 - - -
11 - - -
9 - - -
10 - - -
8 - - -
9 - - -
7 - - -
8 - - -
6 - - -
7 - - -
5 - - -
6 - - -
4 Scanner unit cooling fan lock FM2 1:error
5 - - -
3 Scanner unit exhaust fan lock FM1 1:error
4 - - -
2 DADF open/closed sensor 2 SR3 0:OPEN1:CLOSE
3 - - -
1 DADF open/closed sensor 1 SR1 0:OPEN1:CLOSE
2 - - -
0 Original size sensor 2 CF2 0:paper
1 - - -
P004 15 - - -
0 - - -
14 - - -
P002 15 - - -
13 - - -
14 - - -
12 - - -
13 - - -
11 - - -
12 - - -
10 - - -
11 - - -
9 - - -
10 - - -
8 - - -
9 - - -
Scanner motor_I0 M1 (I0:I1)=(0,0)100%(0,1)75
8 - - - 7
%(1,0)50%(1,1)25%
7 Original size sensor 1 CF1 0:paper
6 - - -
6 - - -
5 - - -
5 - - -
4 - - -
4 - - -
3 - - -
3 - - -
2 - - -
2 - - -
1 - - -
1 - - -
0 - - -
0 - - -

8-62
8
8
8-63
Address bit Name Mark Remarks ■■Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1 (FEEDER > P001 to 007)
P005 15 - - -
Address bit Name Mark Remarks
14 - - -
P001 15 - - -
13 - - -
14 - - -
12 - - -
13 - - -
11 - - -
12 - - -
10 - - - 11 - - -
9 - - - 10 - - -
8 - - - 9 - - -
7 - - - 8 - - -
6 - - - 7 Paper surface sensor SR6 1:upperlimit
5 - - - 6 Tray HP sensor SR13 1:HP(lowerlimit)
4 Scanner motor_derection M1 0:scan1:backscan 5 Tray open/closed sensor SR9 0:OPEN
3 Fan drive FM2 1:ON AB/ Inch identification sensor SR7 0:LGL(LTRR),A5R1:A4R(A5
4
2 Scanner motor M1 1:enable ),STMTR,B6
1 - - - LTR-R/ LGL identification sensor SR8 0:A4Randsmaller,
3
0 Scanner motor_I1 M1 1:LargerthanA4R
T-8-14
2 Read motor cooling fan lock FM2 0:error
1 - - -
0 - - -
P002 15 - - -
14 - - -
13 - - -
12 - - -
11 - - -
10 - - -
9 - - -
8 - - -
7 Scanner unit cooling fan lock FM3 0:error
6 Pickup roller unit lifter HP sensor SR12 1:HP
5 Post-separation sensor 1 SR2 0:paper
4 Post-separation sensor 2 SR3 0:paper
3 - - -
2 - - -
1 Original sensor SR1 1:paper
0 Cover open/closed sensor SR10 0:OPEN

8-63
8
8
8-64
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P003 15 - - - P005 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 Original size sensor 1 SR17 1:paper 7 Disengagement motor 2 M7 1:enable
6 Original size sensor 2 SR18 1:paper 6 Disengagement motor 1 M6 1:enable
5 Original size sensor 3 SR19 1:paper 5 Tray lifter motor M8 1:enable
4 Original size sensor 4 SR20 1:paper 4 - - -
Disengaging home position sensor SR15 1:HP 3 stamp solenoid - 1:ON
3
1 2 Tray lifter motor_direction M8 0:down1:up
2 Leading edge position sensor SR22 1:paper 1 - - -
1 - - - 0 Feed motor_direction M2 0:nouse1:CW
Disengaging home position sensor SR16 1:HP P006 15 - - -
0
2 14 - - -
P004 15 - - - 13 - - -
14 - - - 12 - - -
13 - - - 11 - - -
12 - - - 10 - - -
11 - - - 9 - - -
10 - - - 8 - - -
9 - - - 7 Read motor M4 1:enable
8 - - - 6 Registration motor M3 1:enable
Post-separation sensor 3 (feeder PCB2 0:paper 5 Feed motor M2 1:enable
7
side) 4 Pickup motor_direction M1 0:nouse1:CW
6 Delay sensor SR4 0:paper Pickup roller unit lifter motor_ M10 0:nouse1:CW
Glass shifting home position SR11 0:HP 3
5 direction
sensor 2 Read motor cooling fan FM2 1:ON
4 - - - 1 Glass shift motor_direction M9 0:HP1:
3 Registration sensor PCB3 0:paper 0 Glass shift motor M9 1:enable
2 Read sensor 1 PCB4 0:paper
1 Read sensor 2 SR5 1:paper
0 Delivery sensor PCB5 0:paper

8-64
8
8
8-65
Address bit Name Mark Remarks ■■Color Image Reader Unit-B2 (FEEDER > P001 to 006)
P007 15 - - -
14 - - -
Address bit Name Mark Remarks
13 - - - P001 15 - - -
12 - - - 14 - - -
11 - - - 13 - - -
10 - - - 12 - - -
9 - - - 11 - - -
8 - - - 10 - - -
7 - - - 9 - - -
6 - - - 8 - - -
5 - - - A4R/LTRR identification sensor SR10 0:A4R and smaller,1:Larger
7
than A4R
4 Delivery motor_direction M5 0:CW1:CCW
6 Last document detection sensor SR9 1:paper
3 Delivery motor M5 1:enable
5 Timing sensor SR4 1:paper
2 - - -
4 - - -
1 Scanner unit cooling fan FM3 1:ON
3 - - -
0 Pickup roller unit lifter motor M10 1:enable
2 - - -
T-8-15
1 - - -
0 - - -
P002 15 - - -
14 - - -
13 - - -
12 - - -
11 - - -
10 - - -
9 - - -
8 - - -
7 Document width sensor2 SR13 1:paper
6 Document width sensor3 SR14 1:paper
5 Document width sensor4 SR15 1:paper
4 Delivery reversal sensor SR3 1:paper
3 Release motor HP sensor SR11 1:HP
2 - - -
1 Document length sensor 1 SR7 1:paper
0 Document length sensor 2 SR8 1:paper

8-65
8
8
8-66
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P003 15 - - - P005 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 Fan FM1 1:ON
6 - - - 6 Pickup clutch CL2 1:ON
5 - - - 5 Registration clutch CL1 1:ON
4 - - - release motor_I0 M2 (I0:I1)Ampere
4
3 Document set sensor SR5 0:papeer large(0,0)->(0,1)->(1,0)->
2 Cover open/closed sensor SR6 1:OPEN release motor_I1 M2 (I0:I1)Ampere
3
1 - - - large(0,0)->(0,1)->(1,0)->
0 Document width sensor1 SR12 1:paper 2 release motor M2 1:enable
P004 15 - - - 1 Stamp solenoid SL2 1:ON
14 - - - 0 - - -
13 - - - P006 15 - - -
12 - - - 14 - - -
11 - - - 13 - - -
10 - - - 12 - - -
9 - - - 11 - - -
8 - - - 10 - - -
7 - - - 9 - - -
6 - - - 8 - - -
5 - - - 7 - - -
4 - - - 6 - - -
3 - - - ADF motor_I0 M1 (I0:I1)Ampere
5
2 - - - large(0,0)->(0,1)->(1,0)->
1 - - - ADF motor_I1 M1 (I0:I1)Ampere
4
0 - - - large(0,0)->(0,1)->(1,0)->
3 ADF motor M1 1:enable
2 ADF motor_direction M1 0:separate 1:pickup
1 - - -
0 - - -
T-8-16

8-66
8
8
8-67
■■Inner Finisher-A1(SORTER>P001 to P014) Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P003 15 - - -
Address bit Name Mark Remarks 14 - - -
P001 15 - - - 13 - - -
14 - - - 12 - - -
13 - - - 11 - - -
12 - - - 10 - - -
11 - - - 9 - - -
10 - - - 8 - - -
9 - - - 7 Feed motor_CW M3 0:CW1:CCW
8 - - - 6 Feed motor_clock M3 1:output
7 Entrance sensor S1 0:ON1:OFF 5 - - -
6 Gripper unit HP sensor S7 0:ON1:OFF 4 STPmove motor_clock M1 1:output
5 - - - 3 STPmove motor_PWM M1 0:OFF1:ON
4 - - - 2 Feed motor_PWM M3 0:OFF1:ON
3 - - - 1 - - -
2 - - - 0 Gripper unit move motor_PWM M2 0:OFF1:ON
1 - - - P004 15 - - -
0 - - - 14 - - -
P002 15 - - - 13 - - -
14 - - - 12 - - -
13 - - - 11 - - -
12 - - - 10 - - -
11 - - - 9 - - -
10 - - - 8 - - -
9 - - - 7 - - -
8 - - - 6 - - -
7 Gripper unit move motor_CW M2 0:CW1:CCW 5 - - -
6 - - - 4 - - -
5 Paper lever drive solenoid SOL1 0:OFF1:ON 3 Additional tray clock sensor S23 0:ON1:OFF
4 - - - 2 stack tray clock sensor S14 0:ON1:OFF
3 Shift motor M4 0:OFF1:ON 1 stapler move HP sensor S10 0:ON1:OFF
2 shift roller release motor M5 0:OFF1:ON 0 stapler HP sensor S18 0:ON1:OFF
1 stopper motor M6 0:OFF1:ON
0 Gripper open/close motor M7 0:OFF1:ON

8-67
8
8
8-68
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P005 15 - - - P007 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 - - -
6 - - - 6 - - -
Entrance roller release /stopper HP S5 0:ON1:OFF 5 - - -
5
sensor 4 - - -
4 - - - 3 - - -
3 Shift roller release sensor S3 0:ON1:OFF 2 - - -
2 Shift roller HP sensor S2 0:ON1:OFF 1 - - -
1 - - - 0 Additional tray paper sensor S22 0:ON1:OFF
0 - - - P008 15 - - -
P006 15 - - - 14 - - -
14 - - - 13 - - -
13 - - - 12 - - -
12 - - - 11 - - -
11 - - - 10 - - -
10 - - - 9 - - -
9 - - - 8 - - -
8 - - - 7 - - -
Additional tray upper/lower limit S21 0:OFF1:ON 6 - - -
7
sensor 5 - - -
6 - - - 4 - - -
5 - - - 3 - - -
4 - - - 2 - - -
3 - - - 1 - - -
2 - - - 0 - - -
1 - - -
0 - - -

8-68
8
8
8-69
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P009 15 - - - P011 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 Processing tray sensor S6 0:nopaper1:paper
6 - - - 6 Stapler safety switch SW2 0:OFF1:ON
5 - - - 5 Fan2 M9 0:OFF1:ON
4 - - - 4 - - -
3 - - - 3 Fan1 M8 0:OFF1:ON
2 - - - 2 - - -
1 - - - 1 - - -
0 - - - 0 - - -
P010 15 - - - P012 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 - - -
6 - - - 6 - - -
5 - - - 5 paper surface sensor2 S12 0:OFF1:ON
4 - - - 4 paper surface sensor1 S11 0:OFF1:ON
3 stack tray paper sensor S15 0:nopaper1:paper 3 stapler edging sensor S19 0:OFF1:ON
2 - - - 2 stapler sensor S20 0:ON1:OFF
1 stack tray middle sensor S16 1:mid/lowlevel 1 Gripper stapler connection sensor S9 0:OFF1:ON
0 - - - 0 Front cover switch SW1 0:OFF1:ON

8-69
8
8
8-70
Address bit Name Mark Remarks ■■Staple Finisher-C1/Booklet Finisher-C1(SORTER>P001, P007
P013 15 - - -
14 - - - to P031)
13 - - -
Address bit Name Mark Remarks
12 - - -
P001 15 - - -
11 - - -
14 - - -
10 - - -
13 - - -
9 - - -
12 - - -
8 - - -
11 - - -
7 - - -
10 - - -
6 - - -
9 - - -
5 - - -
8 - - -
4 - - -
7 Tray 2 paper surface sensor 2 PI120 0:paper1:nopaper
3 - - -
6 - - -
2 - - -
5 - - -
1 - - -
4 - - -
0 - - -
3 Front cover sensor PI102 0:CLOSE1:OPEN
P014 15 - - -
2 - - -
14 - - -
1 - - -
13 - - -
0 - - -
12 - - -
P007 15 - - -
11 - - -
14 - - -
10 - - -
13 - - -
9 - - -
12 - - -
8 - - -
11 - - -
7 stapler motor M10 0::ENABLE1:DISABLE
10 - - -
6 - - -
9 - - -
5 - - -
8 - - -
4 Tray lift motor M11 0::ENABLE1:DISABLE
7 - - -
3 - - -
6 - - -
2 - - -
5 - - -
1 - - -
4 - - -
0 - - -
3 Tray 1 shift motor_lock M107 0:OFF1:lock
T-8-17
2 - - -
1 - - -
0 Front cover sensor PI102 0:CLOSE1:OPEN

8-70
8
8
8-71
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P008 15 - - - P010 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 - - -
6 - - - 6 - - -
5 - - - 5 - - -
4 Inlet sensor PI103 0:paper1:nopaper 4 - - -
3 Swing guide home position sensor PI105 1:HP 3 - - -
2 - - - 2 - - -
1 - - - 1 - - -
0 - - - 0 - - -
P009 15 - - - P011 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 Tray 1 paper surface sensor PI111 0:paper1:nopaper 7 - - -
6 - - - 6 - - -
5 - - - 5 - - -
4 - - - 4 - - -
3 - - - 3 - - -
2 - - - 2 - - -
1 Tray 2 shift motor_lock M108 0:OFF1:lock 1 - - -
0 Tray 1 paper sensor PI112 0:paper1:nopaper 0 - - -

8-71
8
8
8-72
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P012 15 - - - P014 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 Swing height sensor PI123 0:CLOSE1:OPEN 7 Tray 1 shift motor_enable M107 0:standby1:enable
6 Gear change home position sensor PI117 0:HP 6 Tray 1 shift motor_CW M107 0:CW1:CCW
5 Upper cover sensor PI101 0:CLOSE1:OPEN 5 Tray 1 shift motor M107 0:OFF1:ON
Rear end assist guide home PI109 0:HP 4 Rear end assist motor_enable M109 0:standby1:enable
4
position sensor Rear end assist motor_enable_I1 M109 [P014>3:P014>2][0:0]:Low,
3 Processing Tray sensor PI108 0:paper1:nopaper 3 [0:1]:MID,[1:0]:High,[1:1]:M
Rear aligning plate home position PI107 0:HP ax
2
sensor 2 Rear end assist motor_enable_I0 M109
Front aligning plate home position PI106 0:HP 1 Rear end assist motor_enable_CW M109 0:CW1:CCW
1
sensor 0 - - -
0 - - - P015 15 - - -
P013 15 - - - 14 - - -
14 - - - 13 - - -
13 - - - 12 - - -
12 - - - 11 - - -
11 - - - 10 - - -
10 - - - 9 - - -
9 - - - 8 - - -
8 - - - 7 - - -
7 Tray 2 shift motor M108 0:OFF1:ON 6 - - -
6 Tray 2 shift motor_CW M108 0:CW1:CCW 5 Stapler shift motor_enable M105 0:standby1:enable
5 Inlet roller separation solenoid SL101 0:OFF1:ON 4 - - -
4 - - - 3 - - -
3 - - - 2 Stack ejection motor_CW M102 0:CW1:CCW
2 - - - 1 Swing motor_ampere M106 0:High1:Low
Entrance feed motor_I1 M101 [P013>1:P013>0][0:0]:Low, 0 Swing motor_CW M106 0:CW1:CCW
1 [0:1]:MID,[1:0]:High,[1:1]:M
ax
0 Entrance feed motor_I0 M101

8-72
8
8
8-73
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P016 15 - - - P018 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 Stapler shift motor_CW M105 0:CCW1:CW
6 Rear aligning plate motor M104 0:CW1:CCW 6 Buffer roller separation solenoid SL102 0:OFF1:ON
5 - - - 5 Shutter clutch CL101 0:OFF1:ON
4 Rear aligning plate motor M104 0:High1:Low 4 Stack ejection lower roller clutch CL102 0:OFF1:ON
3 - - - 3 Buffer rear end holding solenoid SL104 0:OFF1:ON
2 Front aligning plate motor_ ampere M103 0:High1:Low 1st delivery roller separation SL103 0:OFF1:ON
2
1 Front aligning plate motor_CW M103 0:CW1:CCW solenoid
0 - - - Stapler shift motor_I1 M105 [P018>1:P018>0][0:0]:Low,
P017 15 - - - 1 [0:1]:MID,[1:0]:High,[1:1]:M
14 - - - ax
13 - - - 0 Stapler shift motor_I0 M105
12 - - - P019 15 - - -
11 - - - 14 - - -
10 - - - 13 - - -
9 - - - 12 - - -
8 - - - 11 - - -
Stapler alignment interference PI115 0:paper1:nopaper 10 - - -
7 9 - - -
sensor
6 Shutter home position sensor PI114 0:paper1:nopaper 8 - - -
5 Tray 2 paper sensor PI113 0:HP 7 - - -
4 Stapler shift home position sensor PI110 0:HP 6 Feed path sensor PI104 0:paper1:nopaper
3 Tray 2 paper surface sensor 1 PI116 0:Interference 5 - - -
2 - - - 4 - - -
1 - - - 3 Stitcher HP sensor (rear) SW5 1:HP
0 - - - 2 Stitcher HP sensor (front) SW7 1:HP
1 - - -
0 - - -

8-73
8
8
8-74
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P020 15 - - - P022 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
Alignment plate home position PI5 1:HP 7 - - -
7
sensor 6 - - -
6 - - - 5 - - -
5 - - - 4 - - -
4 - - - 3 - - -
3 - - - 2 - - -
2 Vertical pat paper sensor PI17 0:nopaper1:paper 1 - - -
1 - - - 0 Feed motor_CW M1 0:CCW1:CW
0 - - - P023 15 - - -
P021 15 - - - 14 - - -
14 - - - 13 - - -
13 - - - 12 - - -
12 - - - 11 - - -
11 - - - 10 - - -
10 - - - 9 - - -
9 - - - 8 - - -
8 - - - 7 - - -
7 - - - 6 - - -
6 - - - 5 - - -
5 - - - 4 - - -
4 - - - 3 - - -
3 - - - 2 - - -
2 - - - 1 - - -
Paper pushing plate top position PI15 0:edge 0 - - -
1
sensor
Paper pushing plate home position PI14 1:HP
0
sensor

8-74
8
8
8-75
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P024 15 - - - P026 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 - - -
6 - - - 6 - - -
5 No.2 paper deflecting solenoid SL2 0:OFF1:ON 5 - - -
4 No.1 paper deflecting solenoid SL1 0:OFF1:ON 4 - - -
3 Saddle inlet solenoid SL5 0:OFF1:ON 3 Stitcher motor (rear)_CW M6 0:ON1:OFF
2 Paper folding home position sensor PI21 0:OFF1:ON 2 - - -
1 - - - 1 Staple sensor (rear) SW4 0:OFF1:ON
0 - - - 0 - - -
P025 15 - - - P027 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 - - -
6 - - - 6 Feed plate contact solenoid SL4 0:OFF1:ON
5 - - - 5 Paper folding motor_RV M2 0:OFF1:ON
4 - - - 4 - - -
3 - - - 3 - - -
2 Feed motor M1 0:ON1:OFF Paper positioning PI8 0:paper1:nopaper
2
1 - - - plate paper sensor
0 - - - Paper positioning plate home PI7 0:HP
1
position sensor
0 Tray paper sensor PI6 0:paper1:nopaper

8-75
8
8
8-76
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P028 15 - - - P030 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 Paper pushing plate motor_EN M8 0:ON1:OFF 7 - - -
6 Paper pushing plate motor_FWM M8 0:OFF1:ON 6 - - -
5 Paper pushing plate motor_RV M8 0:OFF1:ON 5 - - -
4 Paper folding motor_FWD M2 0:OFF1:ON 4 - - -
3 - - - 3 - - -
2 - - - 2 - - -
1 - - - 1 - - -
0 - - - 0 - - -
P029 15 - - - P031 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 Stitcher motor (rear)_CCW M6 0:ON1:OFF 7 Saddle inlet sensor PI22 0:nopaper1:paper
6 - - - 6 Guide home position sensor PI13 1:HP
5 - - - 5 Crescent roller phase sensor PI12 1:HP
4 Stitcher motor (front)_CW M7 0:ON1:OFF 4 Delivery sensor PI11 0:paper1:nopaper
3 Stitcher motor (front)_CCW M7 0:ON1:OFF 3 Inlet cover sensor PI9 0:CLOSE1:OPEN
2 Staple sensor (front) SW6 1:enable 2 - - -
1 - - - 1 - - -
0 - - - 0 - - -
T-8-18

8-76
8
8
8-77
■■External 2 Hole Puncher-B1(SORTER>P013, P032 to P036, Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P033 15 - - -
P039) 14 - - -
13 - - -
Address bit Name Mark Remarks
12 - - -
P013 15 - - -
11 - - -
14 - - -
10 - - -
13 - - -
9 - - -
12 - - -
8 - - -
11 - - -
7 - - -
10 - - -
6 - - -
9 - - -
5 - - -
8 - - -
4 - - -
7 - - -
3 - - -
6 - - -
2 - - -
5 - - -
1 - - -
4 Punch feed motor_enable M63 0:standby1:enable
0 - - -
Punch feed motor_I1 M63 [P013>3:P013>2][0:0]=Low
P034 15 - - -
3 ,[0:1]=MID,[1:0]=High,[1:1]=
14 - - -
Max
13 - - -
2 Punch feed motor_I0 M63
12 - - -
1 - - -
11 - - -
0 - - -
10 - - -
P032 15 - - -
9 - - -
14 - - -
8 - - -
13 - - -
7 Punch motor_CW M61 0:ON
12 - - -
6 Punch motor_CCW M61 0:ON
11 - - -
5 LED PCB (Rear edge direction) PCB3 0:nopaper1:paper
10 - - -
4 Horizontal registration HP sensor PI61 1:HP
9 - - -
3 - - -
8 - - -
2 - - -
7 Punch HP sensor PI63 0:HP
1 - - -
6 - - -
0 - - -
5 - - -
4 - - -
3 - - -
2 - - -
1 - - -
0 - - -

8-77
8
8
8-78
Address bit Name Mark Remarks Address bit Name Mark Remarks
P035 15 - - - P039 15 - - -
14 - - - 14 - - -
13 - - - 13 - - -
12 - - - 12 - - -
11 - - - 11 - - -
10 - - - 10 - - -
9 - - - 9 - - -
8 - - - 8 - - -
7 - - - 7 Side registration sensor1 PCB2 0:paper
6 - - - 6 Scrap full detector PCB PCB4 0:paper
5 Side registration motor_ampere M62 0:active1:keep 5 Upper door switch MSW61 0:OPEN1:CLOSE
4 - - - 4 Front door switch MSW62 0:OPEN1:CLOSE
3 - - - 3 Side registration sensor2 PCB2 0:paper
2 - - - 2 Side registration sensor3 PCB3 0:paper
1 - - - 1 Side registration sensor4 PCB3 0:paper
0 - - - 0 - - -
P036 15 - - - T-8-19
14 - - -
13 - - -
12 - - -
11 - - -
10 - - -
9 - - -
8 - - -
7 - - -
6 - - -
5 - - -
4 - - -
3 - - -
2 Side registration motor_B M62 1:ON
1 Side registration motor_A M62 1:ON
0 - - -

8-78
8
8
8-79
ADJUST COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ-XY
ADJ-Y-DF Adj img pstn in DADF mode:horz scan[Frt]
■■ADJ-XY Lv.1 Details To adjust the image reading start position in horizontal scanning
direction at DADF reading.
COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ-XY When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
ADJ-X Adj of img pstn in book mode: vert scan the value of service label.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image reading start position (image lead edge position) As the value is incremented by 1, the image position moves to the
in vertical scanning direction. rear side by 0.1mm.
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
the value of service label. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
When the non-image width is larger than the standard value, set the 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
smaller value. Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
When out of original area is copied, set the larger value. service label.
As the value is incremented by 1, the image position moves to the Display/adj/set range 2 to 202
trailing edge side by 0.1mm. Unit 0.1 mm
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Default value 102
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. STRD-POS Adj read pstn in DADF mode: front side
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.1 Details To adjust the reading position at DADF reading (front side).
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
Display/adj/set range 1 to 100 the value of service label.
Unit 0.1 mm Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Default value 29 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
ADJ-Y Adj of img pstn in book mode: horz scan 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image reading start position in horizontal scanning Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
direction. service label.
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter Display/adj/set range -100 to 100
the value of service label. Unit 0.1 mm
When the non-image width is larger than the standard value, set the Default value 0
smaller value.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STRD-POS
When out of original area is copied, set the larger value.
ADJ-X-MG Adj img ratio in book mod:vert scan[frt]
As the value is incremented by 1, the image position moves to the
rear side by 0.1mm. Lv.1 Details To make a fine adjustment of image magnification in vertical
scanning direction at copyboard reading.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
the value of service label.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
As the value is incremented by 1, the image magnification changes
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the by 0.01%.
service label. +: Enlarge
Display/adj/set range 36 to 236 -: Reduce
Unit 0.1 mm Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Default value 116 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
service label.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 0.01%
Default value 0

8-79
8
8
8-80
COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ-XY ■■CCD
ADJY-DF2 Adj img pstn in DADF mod:horiz scan[bck]
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image position of back side in horizontal scanning
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
direction at simultaneous duplex reading. W-PLT-X White level data(X) entry of white plate
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
the value of service label. the value of service label. When replacing the Copyboard Glass,
As the value is incremented by 1, the image position moves to the enter the value of barcode label which is affixed on the glass.
rear side by 0.1mm. Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data - When replacing the Copyboard Glass
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
service label. Display/adj/set range 1 to 9999
Display/adj/set range 56 to 220 Default value 8271
Unit 0.1 mm Related service mode COPIER.> ADJUST> CCD> W-PLT-Y, W-PLT-Z, BW-TGT
Default value 124 W-PLT-Y White level data(Y) entry of white plate
T-8-20 Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
the value of service label. When replacing the Copyboard Glass,
enter the value of barcode label which is affixed on the glass.
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
- When replacing the Copyboard Glass
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
service label.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 9999
Default value 8735
Related service mode COPIER.> ADJUST> CCD> W-PLT-X, W-PLT-Z, BW-TGT
W-PLT-Z White level data(Z) entry of white plate
Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
the value of service label. When replacing the Copyboard Glass,
enter the value of barcode label which is affixed on the glass.
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
- When replacing the Copyboard Glass
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
service label.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 9999
Default value 9418
Related service mode COPIER.> ADJUST> CCD> W-PLT-X, W-PLT-Y, BW-TGT

8-80
8
8
8-81
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
SH-TRGT Shading tgt VL(B&W)[book mode]:D-Reader DFTAR-R Shading target value (R) [Front side]
Lv.1 Details To set the B&W shading target value in copyboard reading mode. Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB, enter the value of
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data service label.
- When replacing the Scanner Unit When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper front),
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2 and
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. write the value which is automatically set in the service label.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
service label. - When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper front)
Display/adj/set range 1 to 2047 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 1126 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
100-RG Img Sensr RG color displace crrct VL:Frt Display/adj/set range 1 to 2047
Lv.1 Details To correct the color displacement (R and G lines) in vertical scanning Default value 1159
direction due to the Scanner Unit (paper front). Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter DFTAR-G Shading target value (G) [Front side]
the value of service label. Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB, enter the value of
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data service label.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper front),
press OK key. execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2 and
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. write the value which is automatically set in the service label.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
service label. - When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper front)
Display/adj/set range -256 to 256 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Unit 0.001 line 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 1 to 2047
100-GB Img Sensr GB color displace crrct VL:Frt Default value 1189
Lv.1 Details To correct the color displacement (G and B lines) in vertical scanning Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2
direction due to the Scanner Unit (paper front). DFTAR-B Shading target value (B) [Front side]
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB, enter the value of
the value of service label. service label.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper front),
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2 and
press OK key. write the value which is automatically set in the service label.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the - When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper front)
service label. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -256 to 256 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Unit 0.001 line Display/adj/set range 1 to 2047
Default value 0 Default value 1209
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2

8-81
8
8
8-82
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
MTF2-M1 MTF value 1 setting: horz scan [Front] MTF2-M6 MTF value 6 setting: horz scan [Front]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-M2 MTF value 2 setting: horz scan [Front] MTF2-M7 MTF value 7 setting: horz scan [Front]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-M3 MTF value 3 setting: horz scan [Front] MTF2-M8 MTF value 8 setting: horz scan [Front]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-M4 MTF value 4 setting: horz scan [Front] MTF2-M9 MTF value 9 setting: horz scan [Front]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-M5 MTF value 5 setting: horz scan [Front] MTF2-S1 MTF value 1 setting: vert scan [Front]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC

8-82
8
8
8-83
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
MTF2-S2 MTF value 2 setting: vert scan [Front] MTF2-S7 MTF value 7 setting: vert scan [Front]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-S3 MTF value 3 setting: vert scan [Front] MTF2-S8 MTF value 8 setting: vert scan [Front]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-S4 MTF value 4 setting: vert scan [Front] MTF2-S9 MTF value 9 setting: vert scan [Front]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-S5 MTF value 5 setting: vert scan [Front] 100DF2GB Img Sensr GB clr crrct VL[bck]: D-Reader
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.2 Details To correct the color displacement (G and B lines) in vertical scanning
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. direction due to the Scanner Unit (paper back).
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. the value of service label.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 50 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Display/adj/set range -256 to 256
MTF2-S6 MTF value 6 setting: vert scan [Front] Unit 0.001 line
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Default value 0
Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC

8-83
8
8
8-84
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
100DF2RG Img Sensr RG clr crrct VL[bck]: D-Reader DFCH2B10 Complex chart No.10 data(B) [Front side]
Lv.2 Details To correct the color displacement (R and G lines) in vertical scanning Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Blue data (for paper
direction due to the Scanner Unit (paper back). front) of No.10 image in DADF complex chart.
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
the value of service label. Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 2550
Display/adj/set range -256 to 256 Default value 0
Unit 0.001 line DFCH2G2 Complex chart No.2 data (G) [Front side]
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Green data (for paper
DFCH2R2 Complex chart No.2 data (R) [Front side] front) of No.2 image in DADF complex chart.
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Red data (for paper Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
front) of No.2 image in DADF complex chart. Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 1 to 2550
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 2000
Display/adj/set range 1 to 2550 DFCH2G10 Complex chart No.10 data(G) [Front side]
Default value 2000 Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Green data (for paper
DFCH2R10 Complex chart No.10 data(R) [Front side] front) of No.10 image in DADF complex chart.
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Red data (for paper Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
front) of No.10 image in DADF complex chart. Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 2550
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2550 CCD-CHNG Scanner Unit(ppr frt) rplce flag setting
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To set the calculation mode of MTF filter coefficient that is used at
DFCH2B2 Complex chart No.2 data (B) [Front side] the replacement of Scanner Unit (paper front).
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Blue data (for paper When replacing the Scanner Unit (paper front), enter 1. When
front) of No.2 image in DADF complex chart. replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. value of service label.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case - When replacing the Scanner Unit (paper front)
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 2550 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 2000 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Data at factory shipment is used.
1: Data at factory shipment is not used. (Scanner Unit (paper front) is
already replaced.)
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTFMCL, MTFSCL, MTFMBW,
MTFSBW

8-84
8
8
8-85
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
MTF-M1 MTF value 1 setting: horz scan [Back] MTF-M6 MTF value 6 setting: horz scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF-M2 MTF value 2 setting: horz scan [Back] MTF-M7 MTF value 7 setting: horz scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF-M3 MTF value 3 setting: horz scan [Back] MTF-M8 MTF value 8 setting: horz scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF-M4 MTF value 4 setting: horz scan [Back] MTF-M9 MTF value 9 setting: horz scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF-M5 MTF value 5 setting: horz scan [Back] MTF-S1 MTF value 1 setting: vert scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC

8-85
8
8
8-86
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
MTF-S2 MTF value 2 setting: vert scan [Back] MTF-S7 MTF value 7 setting: vert scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF-S3 MTF value 3 setting: vert scan [Back] MTF-S8 MTF value 8 setting: vert scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF-S4 MTF value 4 setting: vert scan [Back] MTF-S9 MTF value 9 setting: vert scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF-S5 MTF value 5 setting: vert scan [Back] DFCH-R2 Complex chart No.2 data (R) [Back side]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Red data (for paper
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. back) of No.2 image in DADF complex chart.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 50 Display/adj/set range 1 to 2550
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Default value 2000
MTF-S6 MTF value 6 setting: vert scan [Back] Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFCH-R10, DFCH-B2, DFCH-B10,
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. DFCH-G2, DFCH-G10
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-LNR
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 80
Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC

8-86
8
8
8-87
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
DFCH-R10 Complex chart No.10 data (R) [Back side] DFCH-G2 Complex chart No.2 data (G) [Back side]
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Red data (for paper Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Green data (for paper
back) of No.10 image in DADF complex chart. back) of No.2 image in DADF complex chart.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2550 Display/adj/set range 1 to 2550
Default value 0 Default value 2000
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFCH-R2, DFCH-B2, DFCH-B10, Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFCH-R10, DFCH-B2, DFCH-B10,
DFCH-G2, DFCH-G10 DFCH-G2, DFCH-G10
COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-LNR COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-LNR
DFCH-B2 Complex chart No.2 data (B) [Back side] DFCH-G10 Complex chart No.10 data (G) [Back side]
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Blue data (for paper Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Green data (for paper
back) of No.2 image in DADF complex chart. back) of No.10 image in DADF complex chart.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 2550 Display/adj/set range 0 to 2550
Default value 2000 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFCH-R10, DFCH-B2, DFCH-B10, Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFCH-R2, DFCH-B2, DFCH-B10,
DFCH-G2, DFCH-G10 DFCH-G2, DFCH-G10
COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-LNR COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-LNR
DFCH-B10 Complex chart No.10 data (B) [Back side] MTF2-M10 MTF value 10 setting: horz scan [Front]
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the Blue data (for paper Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
back) of No.10 image in DADF complex chart. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 20 to 85
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2550 Default value 50
Default value 0 Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFCH-R2, DFCH-B2, DFCH-B10, MTF2-M11 MTF value 11 setting: horz scan [Front]
DFCH-G2, DFCH-G10 Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-LNR Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 85
Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC

8-87
8
8
8-88
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
MTF2-M12 MTF value 12 setting: horz scan [Front] MTF-M11 MTF value 11 setting: horz scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 85 Display/adj/set range 20 to 85
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-S10 MTF value 10 setting: vert scan [Front] MTF-M12 MTF value 12 setting: horz scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 85 Display/adj/set range 20 to 85
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-S11 MTF value 11 setting: vert scan [Front] MTF-S10 MTF value 10 setting: vert scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 85 Display/adj/set range 20 to 85
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF2-S12 MTF value 12 setting: vert scan [Front] MTF-S11 MTF value 11 setting: vert scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 85 Display/adj/set range 20 to 85
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC
MTF-M10 MTF value 10 setting: horz scan [Back] MTF-S12 MTF value 12 setting: vert scan [Back]
Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation. Lv.1 Details Setting value for MTF filter coefficient calculation.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Enter the value of service label on the Reader.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 20 to 85 Display/adj/set range 20 to 85
Default value 50 Default value 50
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> MTF-CLC

8-88
8
8
8-89
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD COPIER>ADJUST>CCD
DFCH2K2 Complex chart No.2 data (B&W) [Front] DFTAR-BW Shading target value (B&W) [Front side]
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the B&W data (for paper Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB, enter the value of
front) of No.2 image in DADF complex chart. service label.
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper front),
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL3, DF-WLVL4 and
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. write the value which is automatically set in the service label.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Display/adj/set range 1 to 2550 - When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper front)
Default value 2000 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
DFCH2K10 Complex chart No.10 data (B&W) [Front] 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the B&W data (for paper Display/adj/set range 700 to 1400
front) of No.10 image in DADF complex chart. Default value 1209
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL3, DF-WLVL4
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data DFTBK-G Shading target value (G) [Back side]
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB, enter the value of
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. service label.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2550 When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper back),
Default value 0 execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2 and
DFCH-K2 Complex chart No.2 data (B&W) [Back] write the value which is automatically set in the service label.
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the B&W data (for paper Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
back) of No.2 image in DADF complex chart. - When replacing the Scanner Unit (paper back)
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 700 to 1400
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 1136
Display/adj/set range 1 to 2550 Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2
Default value 2000 DFTBK-B Shading target value (B) [Back side]
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFCH-R2, DFCH-R10, DFCH-B2, Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB, enter the value of
DFCH-B10, DFCH-G2, DFCH-G10, DFCH-K10 service label.
COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-LNR When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper back),
DFCH-K10 Complex chart No.10 data (B&W) [Back] execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2 and
write the value which is automatically set in the service label.
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity, set the B&W data (for paper
back) of No.10 image in DADF complex chart. Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Enter the value of service label on the Reader. - When replacing the Scanner Unit (paper back)
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 700 to 1400
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2550 Default value 1126
Default value 0 Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFCH-R2, DFCH-R10, DFCH-B2,
DFCH-B10, DFCH-G2, DFCH-G10, DFCH-K2
COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-LNR

8-89
8
8
8-90
COPIER>ADJUST>CCD ■■IMG-REG
DFTBK-R Shading target value (R) [Back side]
Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB, enter the value of
COPIER>ADJUST>IMG-REG
service label. REG-H-Y Adj Y color write start pstn: horz scan
When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper back), Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of yellow color image in the
execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2 and horizontal scanning direction in increments of 1 pixel.
write the value which is automatically set in the service label. Use case When yellow color displacement in the horizontal scanning direction
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data occurs
- When replacing the Scanner Unit (paper back) Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range 700 to 1400 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Default value 1156 Unit 1 pixel
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1, DF-WLVL2 Default value 0
CCD-CHG2 Scanner Unit(paper back) rplce flag set REG-H-C Adj C color write start pstn: horz scan
Lv.1 Details To set the calculation mode of MTF filter coefficient that is used at Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of cyan color image in the horizontal
the replacement of Scanner Unit (paper back). scanning direction in increments of 1 pixel.
When replacing the Scanner Unit (paper back), enter 1. When Use case When cyan color displacement in the horizontal scanning direction
replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the occurs
value of service label. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Use case - When replacing the Scanner Unit (paper back) press OK key.
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Unit 1 pixel
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 0
0: Data at factory shipment is used. REG-H-K Adj Bk color write start pstn: horz scan
1: Data at factory shipment is not used. (Scanner Unit (paper back) Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of black color image in the horizontal
is already replaced.) scanning direction in increments of 1 pixel.
Default value 0 Use case When black color displacement in the horizontal scanning direction
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF2MCL, MTF2SCL, MTF2MBW, occurs
MTF2SBW Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
DFTBK-BW Shading target value (B&W) [Back side] press OK key.
Lv.1 Details When replacing the Reader Controller PCB, enter the value of Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
service label. Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper back), Unit 1 pixel
execute COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL3, DF-WLVL4 and
Default value 0
write the value which is automatically set in the service label.
REG-HS-Y Adj Y color write start pstn: horz scan
Use case - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of yellow color image in the
- When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit (paper back)
horizontal scanning direction in smaller increments than 1 pixel.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When yellow color displacement in the horizontal scanning direction
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
occurs (smaller than 1 pixel)
Display/adj/set range 700 to 1400
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Default value 1126
press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL3, DF-WLVL4
Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
T-8-21
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1/32 pixel
Default value 0

8-90
8
8
8-91
COPIER>ADJUST>IMG-REG COPIER>ADJUST>IMG-REG
REG-HS-C Adj C color write start pstn: horz scan REG-V-K Adj Bk color write start pstn: vert scan
Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of cyan color image in the horizontal Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of black color image in the vertical
scanning direction in smaller increments than 1 pixel. scanning direction in increments of 1 pixel.
Use case When cyan color displacement in the horizontal scanning direction Use case When black color displacement in the vertical scanning direction
occurs (smaller than 1 pixel) occurs
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1/32 pixel Unit 1 line
Default value 0 Default value 0
REG-HS-K Adj Bk color write start pstn: horz scan REG-H-M Adj M color write start pstn: horz scan
Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of black color image in the horizontal Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of magenta color image in the
scanning direction in smaller increments than 1 pixel. horizontal scanning direction in increments of 1 pixel.
Use case When black color displacement in the horizontal scanning direction Use case When magenta color displacement in the horizontal scanning
occurs (smaller than 1 pixel) direction occurs
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1/32 pixel Unit 1 pixel
Default value 0 Default value 0
REG-V-Y Adj Y color write start pstn: vert scan REG-V-M Adj M color write start pstn: vert scan
Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of yellow color image in the vertical Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of magenta color image in the
scanning direction in increments of 1 pixel. vertical scanning direction in increments of 1 pixel.
Use case When yellow color displacement in the vertical scanning direction Use case When magenta color displacement in the vertical scanning direction
occurs occurs
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 line Unit 1 line
Default value 0 Default value 0
REG-V-C Adj C color write start pstn: vert scan REG-HS-M Fine adj M write start pstn: horz scan
Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of cyan color image in the vertical Lv.1 Details To adjust the write start position of magenta color image in the
scanning direction in increments of 1 pixel. horizontal scanning direction in smaller increments than 1 pixel.
Use case When cyan color displacement in the vertical scanning direction Use case When magenta color displacement in the horizontal scanning
occurs direction occurs (smaller than 1 pixel)
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 line Unit 1/32 pixel
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-91
8
8
8-92
COPIER>ADJUST>IMG-REG
MAG-H Adj of stdrd magnifictn ratio: horz scan
Lv.1 Details To adjust the standard magnification ratio in horizontal scanning
direction by increasing/decreasing the number of pixels.
The adjustment result is reflected to all colors.
All correction values registered in the media list are proportionally
changed.
Use case When adjusting the standard magnification due to parts replacement
or environmental change, etc.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Unit 0.1 %
Default value 0
MAG-V Adj of stdrd magnifictn ratio: vert scan
Lv.1 Details To adjust the standard magnification ratio in vertical scanning
direction by changing the speed of Photosensitive Drum, ITB and
Registration Roller.
Use case When adjusting the standard magnification due to parts replacement
or environmental change, etc.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
Caution - Do not use this at the normal service.
- Be sure to perform auto color displacement correction after
adjustment.
Display/adj/set range -12 to 12
Unit 0.087 %
Default value 0
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Correct Color
Mismatch
T-8-22

8-92
8
8
8-93
■■DENS COPIER>ADJUST>DENS
REF-M M toner density target value entry
COPIER>ADJUST>DENS Lv.1 Details To enter the ATR Sensor (M) target value of ATR control after RAM
SGNL-Y Y toner dens value entry at initialize clear.
Lv.1 Details To enter the Y toner density value of Patch Sensor (Center) at Use case When checking the value before RAM clear and re-enter it after RAM
initialization. clear
Use case When checking the value before RAM clear and re-enter it after RAM Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
clear 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Default value 94 (at RAM clear). This is changed by initialization.
Appropriate target value 340 to 640 REF-C C toner density target value entry
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To enter the ATR Sensor (C) target value of ATR control after RAM
SGNL-M M toner dens value entry at initialize clear.
Lv.1 Details To enter the M toner density value of Patch Sensor (Center) at Use case When checking the value before RAM clear and re-enter it after RAM
initialization. clear
Use case When checking the value before RAM clear and re-enter it after RAM Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
clear 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 Default value 94 (at RAM clear). This is changed by initialization.
Appropriate target value 340 to 640 SIGG-Y Adj Y toner dens gain VL at ATR control
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details [Not used] To adjust the gain value of Y toner density target value at
SGNL-C C toner dens value entry at initialize ATR control
Lv.1 Details To enter the C toner density value of Patch Sensor (Center) at Y patch level value when ATR-INIT is executed at Drum Unit
initialization. initialization is displayed.
Use case When checking the value before RAM clear and re-enter it after RAM When replacing the DC Controller PCB, enter the ATR-INIT value
clear unique to each Drum Unit.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case - When identifying the cause in the case that an image density failure
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. occurs
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023 - When replacing the DC Controller PCB
Appropriate target value 340 to 640 Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Default value 0 Default value 0
REF-Y Y toner density target value entry SIGG-M Adj M toner dens gain VL at ATR control
Lv.1 Details To enter the ATR Sensor (Y) target value of ATR control after RAM Lv.1 Details [Not used] To adjust the gain value of M toner density target value at
clear. ATR control
Use case When checking the value before RAM clear and re-enter it after RAM M patch level value when ATR-INIT is executed at Drum Unit
clear initialization is displayed.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When replacing the DC Controller PCB, enter the ATR-INIT value
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. unique to each Drum Unit.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Use case - When identifying the cause in the case that an image density failure
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 occurs
Default value 94 (at RAM clear). This is changed by initialization. - When replacing the DC Controller PCB
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Default value 0

8-93
8
8
8-94
COPIER>ADJUST>DENS COPIER>ADJUST>DENS
SIGG-C Adj C toner dens gain VL at ATR control T-SPLY-M Adjustment of M toner supply amount
Lv.1 Details [Not used] To adjust the gain value of C toner density target value at Lv.2 Details [Not used] To adjust the offset value of M toner supply amount.
ATR control When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
C patch level value when ATR-INIT is executed at Drum Unit value of service label.
initialization is displayed. Use case When E020 occurs frequently
When replacing the DC Controller PCB, enter the ATR-INIT value Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
unique to each Drum Unit. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Use case - When identifying the cause in the case that an image density failure Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
occurs Unit 0.1
- When replacing the DC Controller PCB Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 T-SPLY-C Adjustment of C toner supply amount
Default value 0 Lv.2 Details [Not used] To adjust the offset value of C toner supply amount.
SIGG-K Adj Bk toner dens gain VL at ATR control When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
Lv.1 Details [Not used] To adjust the gain value of Bk toner density target value at value of service label.
ATR control Use case When E020 occurs frequently
Bk patch level value when ATR-INIT is executed at Drum Unit Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
initialization is displayed. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
When replacing the DC Controller PCB, enter the ATR-INIT value
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
unique to each Drum Unit.
Unit 0.1
Use case - When identifying the cause in the case that an image density failure
Default value 0
occurs
T-SPLY-K Adjustment of Bk toner supply amount
- When replacing the DC Controller PCB
Lv.2 Details [Not used] To adjust the offset value of Bk toner supply amount.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
Default value 0
value of service label.
SGNL-K Bk toner dens value entry at initialize
Use case When E020 occurs frequently
Lv.1 Details To enter the Bk toner density value of Patch Sensor (Center) at
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
initialization.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Use case When checking the value before RAM clear and re-enter it after RAM
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
clear
Unit 0.1
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
DMAX-Y Adj D-max ctrl Y color dens target VL
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1023
Lv.2 Details An image failure might occur because the density target value of the
Appropriate target value 340 to 640
D-max control becomes out of the setting table due to environment
Default value 0
change.
T-SPLY-Y Adjustment of Y toner supply amount
Adjust the offset of the yellow density target value of D-max control.
Lv.2 Details [Not used] To adjust the offset value of Y toner supply amount. The offset is reset when D-max control (Full Adjust) is executed.
When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
Use case When any image failure occurs due to environment change
value of service label.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When E020 occurs frequently
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution - Do not use this at the normal service.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
- This is limited for the use of printer model.
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
Display/adj/set range -128 to 128
Unit 0.1
Default value 0
Default value 0

8-94
8
8
8-95
COPIER>ADJUST>DENS COPIER>ADJUST>DENS
DMAX-M Adj D-max ctrl M color dens target VL P-TG-M Adj of ATR control M-color target value
Lv.2 Details An image failure might occur because the density target value of the Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the ATR patch target value for M.
D-max control becomes out of the setting table due to environment When the target value determined upon initialization is changed, the
change. T/D ratio is also changed.
Adjust the offset of the magenta density target value of D-max Fogging and density increase are alleviated when the value is
control. smaller, and carrier adherence is alleviated when it is larger.
The offset is reset when D-max control (Full Adjust) is executed. Use case When density failures, fogging, and carrier adherence, etc. occur
Use case When any image failure occurs due to environment change Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution - Do not use this at the normal service. 3) Make 50 prints of approx. 10% image ratio (ex. COPIER> TEST>
- This is limited for the use of printer model. PG> TYPE: 16) 4 times.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 128 4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation> Full Adjust.
Default value 0 Caution Execute the Auto Adjust Gradation first to increase the density. If you
DMAX-C Adj D-max ctrl C color dens target VL adjust the offset of the target value, fogging might get worse.
Lv.2 Details An image failure might occur because the density target value of the Display/adj/set range -4 to 4
D-max control becomes out of the setting table due to environment Default value 0
change. Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Adjust the offset of the cyan density target value of D-max control. Gradation> Full Adjust
The offset is reset when D-max control (Full Adjust) is executed. P-TG-C Adj of ATR control C-color target value
Use case When any image failure occurs due to environment change Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the ATR patch target value for C.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When the target value determined upon initialization is changed, the
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. T/D ratio is also changed.
Caution - Do not use this at the normal service. Fogging and density increase are alleviated when the value is
- This is limited for the use of printer model. smaller, and carrier adherence is alleviated when it is larger.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 128 Use case When density failures, fogging, and carrier adherence, etc. occur
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
P-TG-Y Adj of ATR control Y-color target value press OK key.
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the ATR patch target value for Y. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
When the target value determined upon initialization is changed, the 3) Make 50 prints of approx. 10% image ratio (ex. COPIER> TEST>
T/D ratio is also changed. PG> TYPE: 16) 4 times.
Fogging and density increase are alleviated when the value is 4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation> Full Adjust.
smaller, and carrier adherence is alleviated when it is larger. Caution Execute the Auto Adjust Gradation first to increase the density. If you
Use case When density failures, fogging, and carrier adherence, etc. occur adjust the offset of the target value, fogging might get worse.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Display/adj/set range -4 to 4
press OK key. Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
3) Make 50 prints of approx. 10% image ratio (ex. COPIER> TEST> Gradation> Full Adjust
PG> TYPE: 16) 4 times.
4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation> Full Adjust.
Caution Execute the Auto Adjust Gradation first to increase the density. If you
adjust the offset of the target value, fogging might get worse.
Display/adj/set range -4 to 4
Default value 0
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Gradation> Full Adjust

8-95
8
8
8-96
COPIER>ADJUST>DENS COPIER>ADJUST>DENS
P-TG-K Adj of ATR control Bk-color target value REF-K Bk toner density target value entry
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the ATR patch target value for Bk. Lv.2 Details To enter the ATR Sensor (Bk) target value of ATR control after RAM
When the target value determined upon initialization is changed, the clear.
T/D ratio is also changed. Use case When checking the value before RAM clear and re-enter it after RAM
Fogging and density increase are alleviated when the value is clear
smaller, and carrier adherence is alleviated when it is larger. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When density failures, fogging, and carrier adherence, etc. occur 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 94 (at RAM clear). This is changed by initialization.
3) Make 50 prints of approx. 10% image ratio (ex. COPIER> TEST> DMLMT-HY Y toner charging DC voltage upper limit
PG> TYPE: 16) 4 times.
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the charging DC voltage upper limit for Y in
4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation> Full Adjust.
D-max control.
Caution Execute the Auto Adjust Gradation first to increase the density. If you
Use case When a failure occurs due to limiter of D-max control
adjust the offset of the target value, fogging might get worse.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -4 to 4
2) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Quick Adjust.
Default value 0
Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Display/adj/set range -300 to 300
Gradation> Full Adjust
Unit 1V
DMAX-K Adj D-max ctrl Bk color dens target VL
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Lv.2 Details An image failure might occur because the density target value of the
Gradation > Quick Adjust
D-max control becomes out of the setting table due to environment
DMLMT-HM M toner charging DC voltage upper limit
change.
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the charging DC voltage upper limit for M in
Adjust the offset of the black density target value of D-max control.
D-max control.
The offset is reset when D-max control (Full Adjust) is executed.
Use case When a failure occurs due to limiter of D-max control
Use case When any image failure occurs due to environment change
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Quick Adjust.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range -300 to 300
Display/adj/set range -128 to 128
Unit 1V
Default value 0
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
P-ALPHA Adjustment of Patch Sensor a value
Gradation > Quick Adjust
Lv.1 Details To adjust the adjustment coefficient alpha for the patch sensor .
DMLMT-HC C toner charging DC voltage upper limit
The value multiplied by 1000 is displayed in the screen.
When replacing the Patch Sensor Unit, enter the value of the service Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the charging DC voltage upper limit for C in
label. D-max control.
Use case When a density reading error of the Patch Sensor occurs Use case When a failure occurs due to limiter of D-max control
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Quick Adjust.
Display/adj/set range 512 to 2047 Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Appropriate target value 1200 Display/adj/set range -300 to 300
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> PT-LPADJ Unit 1V
Supplement/memo alpha: Ratio of P-wave to S-wave Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Gradation > Quick Adjust

8-96
8
8
8-97
COPIER>ADJUST>DENS COPIER>ADJUST>DENS
DMLMT-HK Bk toner charging DC voltage upper limit DMLMT-LK Bk toner charging DC voltage lower limit
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the charging DC voltage upper limit for Bk in Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the charging DC voltage lower limit for Bk in
D-max control. D-max control.
Use case When a failure occurs due to limiter of D-max control Use case When a failure occurs due to limiter of D-max control
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Quick Adjust. 2) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Quick Adjust.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range -300 to 300 Display/adj/set range -300 to 300
Unit 1V Unit 1V
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Gradation > Quick Adjust Gradation > Quick Adjust
DMLMT-LY Y toner charging DC voltage lower limit CONT-Y ATR Sensor (Y) control voltage entry
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the charging DC voltage lower limit for Y in Lv.1 Details To enter the density detection control voltage of ATR Sensor (Y).
D-max control. When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
Use case When a failure occurs due to limiter of D-max control value of service label.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When the backup data is cleared by RAM clear, etc.
2) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Quick Adjust. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
Display/adj/set range -300 to 300 service label.
Unit 1V Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust Unit 0.1 V
Gradation > Quick Adjust Appropriate target value 32 to 68
DMLMT-LM M toner charging DC voltage lower limit Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> CONT-Y
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the charging DC voltage lower limit for M in CONT-M ATR Sensor (M) control voltage entry
D-max control. Lv.1 Details To enter the density detection control voltage of ATR Sensor (M).
Use case When a failure occurs due to limiter of D-max control When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. value of service label.
2) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Quick Adjust. Use case When the backup data is cleared by RAM clear, etc.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -300 to 300 Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
Unit 1V service label.
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Gradation > Quick Adjust Unit 0.1 V
DMLMT-LC C toner charging DC voltage lower limit Appropriate target value 32 to 68
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the charging DC voltage lower limit for C in Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> CONT-M
D-max control.
Use case When a failure occurs due to limiter of D-max control
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Quick Adjust.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range -300 to 300
Unit 1V
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Gradation > Quick Adjust

8-97
8
8
8-98
COPIER>ADJUST>DENS ■■BLANK
CONT-C ATR Sensor (C) control voltage entry
Lv.1 Details To enter the density detection control voltage of ATR Sensor (C).
COPIER>ADJUST>BLANK
When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the BLANK-T Adjustment of leading edge margin
value of service label. Lv.1 Details To adjust the margin on the leading edge of paper.
Use case When the backup data is cleared by RAM clear, etc. As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is increased toward the
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. center of the paper by 1 pixel (0.0423mm).
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the Use case - When reducing the margin upon user’s request
service label. - When enlarging the margin for transfer separation/fixing separation
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Unit 0.1 V Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Appropriate target value 32 to 68 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1181
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> CONT-C Unit 1 pixel
CONT-K ATR Sensor (Bk) control voltage entry Default value 94
Lv.1 Details To enter the density detection control voltage of ATR Sensor (Bk). BLANK-L Adjustment of left edge margin
When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the Lv.1 Details To adjust the margin on the left edge of paper.
value of service label. As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is increased toward the
Use case When the backup data is cleared by RAM clear, etc. center of the paper by 1 pixel (0.0423mm).
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case - When reducing the margin upon user’s request
- When enlarging the margin for transfer separation/fixing separation
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
service label. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1181
Unit 0.1 V Unit 1 pixel
Appropriate target value 32 to 68 Default value 59
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> DENS> CONT-K BLANK-R Adjustment of right edge margin
Lv.1 Details To adjust the margin on the right edge of paper.
T-8-23
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is increased toward the
center of the paper by 1 pixel (0.0423mm).
Use case - When reducing the margin upon user’s request
- When enlarging the margin for transfer separation/fixing separation
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1181
Unit 1 pixel
Default value 59
BLANK-B Adjustment of trailing edge margin
Lv.1 Details To adjust the margin on the trailing edge of paper.
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin is increased toward the
center of the paper by 1 pixel (0.0423mm).
Use case - When reducing the margin upon user’s request
- When enlarging the margin for transfer separation/fixing separation
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1181
Unit 1 pixel
Default value 59
T-8-24

8-98
8
8
8-99
■■V-CONT COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT
VCONT-M Adj of M color contrast potential
COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT Lv.2 Details To adjust the contrast potential for M.
VCONT-Y Adj of Y color contrast potential As the value is incremented by 1, the contrast potential changes by
Lv.2 Details To adjust the contrast potential for Y. 10V.
As the value is incremented by 1, the contrast potential changes by +: Image becomes darker.
10V. -: Image becomes lighter.
+: Image becomes darker. When the value is too large, paper winds around the Fixing Roller or
-: Image becomes lighter. a transfer failure occurs.
When the value is too large, paper winds around the Fixing Roller or In principle, the adjustment of the density should be performed in
a transfer failure occurs. Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Density Adjustment
In principle, the adjustment of the density should be performed in Mode.
Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Density Adjustment Use case When adjusting the density of D-max control in the case that an
Mode. image density failure occurs
Use case When adjusting the density of D-max control in the case that an Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
image density failure occurs press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
press OK key. 3) Execute COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DPC.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust.
3) Execute COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DPC. Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust. Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Unit 10 V
Display/adj/set range -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -10 to 10
Unit 10 V Default value 0
Appropriate target value -10 to 10 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> VCONT-Y, VCONT-C, VCONT-K
Default value 0 COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DPC
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> VCONT-M, VCONT-C, VCONT-K Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DPC Gradation > Full Adjust
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Density Adjustment
Gradation > Full Adjust Mode
Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Density Adjustment
Mode

8-99
8
8
8-100
COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT
VCONT-C Adj of C color contrast potential VCONT-K Adj of Bk color contrast potential
Lv.2 Details To adjust the contrast potential for C. Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the contrast potential Vcont for Bk.
As the value is incremented by 1, the contrast potential changes by As the value is incremented by 1, the contrast potential changes by
10V. 10V.
+: Image becomes darker. +: Image becomes darker.
-: Image becomes lighter. -: Image becomes lighter.
When the value is too large, paper winds around the Fixing Roller or When the value is too large, paper winds around the Fixing Belt or a
a transfer failure occurs. transfer failure occurs.
In principle, the adjustment of the density should be performed in In principle, the adjustment of the density should be performed in
Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Density Adjustment Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Density Adjustment
Mode. Mode.
Use case When adjusting the density of D-max control in the case that an Use case When adjusting the density of D-max control in the case that an
image density failure occurs image density failure occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
3) Execute COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DPC. 3) Execute COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DPC
4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust. 4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -20 to 20 Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
Unit 10 V Unit 10 V
Appropriate target value -10 to 10 Appropriate target value -10 to 10
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> VCONT-Y, VCONT-M, VCONT-K Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> VCONT-Y, VCONT-M, VCONT-C
COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DPC COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DPC
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Gradation > Full Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust
Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Density Adjustment Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Density Adjustment
Mode Mode

8-100
8
8
8-101
COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT
VBACK-Y Adj Y color fogging removal potential VBACK-M Adj M color fogging removal potential
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the fogging removal potential Vback for Y. Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the fogging removal potential Vback for M.
A value obtained by adding the adjustment value in Adjustment/ A value obtained by adding the adjustment value in Adjustment/
Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Correct Color Cast to the Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Correct Color Cast to the
fogging removal potential is set as the fogging adjustment value. fogging removal potential is set as the fogging adjustment value.
As the value is incremented by 1, the fogging removal potential As the value is incremented by 1, the fogging removal potential
changes by 5V. changes by 5V.
+: Fogging, blanking of image edge, and carrier adherence are +: Fogging, blanking of image edge, and carrier adherence are
alleviated. alleviated.
-: Coarse image, blanking of image edge, and carrier adherence -: Coarse image, blanking of image edge, and carrier adherence
are alleviated. are alleviated.
Use case At the occurrence of Y fogging Use case At the occurrence of M fogging
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
3) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust. 3) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10 Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Unit 5V Unit 5V
Appropriate target value -5 to 5 Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> VBACK-M, VBACK-C, VBACK-K Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> VBACK-Y, VBACK-C, VBACK-K
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Gradation > Full Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust
Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Correct Color Cast Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Correct Color Cast

8-101
8
8
8-102
COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT
VBACK-C Adj C color fogging removal potential VBACK-K Adj Bk color fogging removal potential
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the fogging removal potential Vback for C. Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the fogging removal potential Vback for Bk.
A value obtained by adding the adjustment value in Adjustment/ A value obtained by adding the adjustment value in Adjustment/
Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Correct Color Cast to the Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Correct Color Cast to the
fogging removal potential is set as the fogging adjustment value. fogging removal potential is set as the fogging adjustment value.
As the value is incremented by 1, the fogging removal potential As the value is incremented by 1, the fogging removal potential
changes by 5V. changes by 5V.
+: Fogging, blanking of image edge, and carrier adherence are +: Fogging, blanking of image edge, and carrier adherence are
alleviated. alleviated.
-: Coarse image, blanking of image edge, and carrier adherence -: Coarse image, blanking of image edge, and carrier adherence
are alleviated. are alleviated.
Use case At the occurrence of C fogging Use case At the occurrence of Bk fogging
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
3) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust. 3) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10 Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Unit 5V Unit 5V
Appropriate target value -5 to 5 Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> VBACK-Y, VBACK-M, VBACK-K Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> VBACK-Y, VBACK-M, VBACK-C
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust COPIER> DISPLAY> DPOT> VBACK-K
Gradation > Full Adjust Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Correct Color Cast Gradation > Full Adjust
Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Correct Color Cast
PT-VCT-Y Adj of Y color target contrast potential
Lv.2 Details To adjust the Y patch target contrast potential for D-max PASCAL
control.
As the value is incremented by 1, the target contrast potential
changes by 1 V.
+: Potential is increased.
-: Potential is decreased.
Use case When density failures, fogging, and carrier adherence, etc. occur
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
3) Print 50 sheets of image with approx. 10% image ratio (e.g.
COPIER> TEST> PG> TYPE: 16) 4 times.
4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 1V
Default value According to the environment condition.
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> PT-VCT-M, PT-VCT-C, PT-VCT-K

8-102
8
8
8-103
COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT COPIER>ADJUST>V-CONT
PT-VCT-M Adj of M color target contrast potential PT-VCT-K Adj of Bk clr target contrast potential
Lv.2 Details To adjust the M patch target contrast potential for D-max PASCAL Lv.2 Details To adjust the Bk patch target contrast potential for D-max PASCAL
control. control.
As the value is incremented by 1, the target contrast potential As the value is incremented by 1, the target contrast potential
changes by 1 V. changes by 1 V.
+: Potential is increased. +: Potential is increased.
-: Potential is decreased. -: Potential is decreased.
Use case When density failures, fogging, and carrier adherence, etc. occur Use case When density failures, fogging, and carrier adherence, etc. occur
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
3) Print 50 sheets of image with approx. 10% image ratio (e.g. 3) Print 50 sheets of image with approx. 10% image ratio (e.g.
COPIER> TEST> PG> TYPE: 16) 4 times. COPIER> TEST> PG> TYPE: 16) 4 times.
4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust. 4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 1V Unit 1V
Default value According to the environment condition. Default value According to the environment condition.
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> PT-VCT-Y, PT-VCT-C, PT-VCT-K Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> PT-VCT-Y, PT-VCT-M, PT-VCT-C
PT-VCT-C Adj of C color target contrast potential T-8-25
Lv.2 Details To adjust the C patch target contrast potential for D-max PASCAL
control.
As the value is incremented by 1, the target contrast potential
changes by 1 V.
+: Potential is increased.
-: Potential is decreased.
Use case When density failures, fogging, and carrier adherence, etc. occur
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
3) Print 50 sheets of image with approx. 10% image ratio (e.g.
COPIER> TEST> PG> TYPE: 16) 4 times.
4) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 1V
Default value According to the environment condition.
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> V-CONT> PT-VCT-Y, PT-VCT-M, PT-VCT-K

8-103
8
8
8-104
■■PASCAL COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL
OFST-P-K Bk density adj at test print reading
COPIER>ADJUST>PASCAL Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of Bk color test print reading signal at Auto Adjust
OFST-P-Y Y density adj at test print reading Gradation (Full Adjust).
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of Y color test print reading signal at Auto Adjust When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
Gradation (Full Adjust). the value of service label.
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter As the greater value is set, the image after adjustment gets darker.
the value of service label. Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
As the greater value is set, the image after adjustment gets darker. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
press OK key. Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. service label.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Display/adj/set range -128 to 128
Display/adj/set range -128 to 128 Default value According to the adjustment value of the Reader at factory shipment
Default value According to the adjustment value of the Reader at factory shipment T-8-26
OFST-P-M M density adj at test print reading
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of M color test print reading signal at Auto Adjust
Gradation (Full Adjust).
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
the value of service label.
As the greater value is set, the image after adjustment gets darker.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
service label.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 128
Default value According to the adjustment value of the Reader at factory shipment
OFST-P-C C density adj at test print reading
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of C color test print reading signal at Auto Adjust
Gradation (Full Adjust).
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
the value of service label.
As the greater value is set, the image after adjustment gets darker.
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the
service label.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 128
Default value According to the adjustment value of the Reader at factory shipment

8-104
8
8
8-105
■■COLOR COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR
ADJ-K Bk color balance adjustment
COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR Lv.1 Details To adjust the default value of the color balance for Bk when the
ADJ-Y Y color balance adjustment density of Bk varies between machines.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the default value of the color balance for Y when the As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
density of Y varies between machines. If the value is too large, a transfer failure and/or a fixing failure
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. occurs.
If the value is too large, a transfer failure and/or a fixing failure Use case When alleviating the variation of the density between machines upon
occurs. user’s request
Use case When alleviating the variation of the density between machines upon Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
user’s request press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 0
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. OFST-Y Adj of Y bright area dens&color balance
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 Lv.1 Details To adjust the bright area density and color balance of Y.
Default value 0 As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
ADJ-M M color balance adjustment Lower the value when the background cannot be read correctly
Lv.1 Details To adjust the default value of the color balance for M when the because the density of a document is dark and increase the value
density of M varies between machines. when the density of a document is light.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. Lower the value when removal of the background is not performed
If the value is too large, a transfer failure and/or a fixing failure correctly and a fogging-like image appears.
occurs. This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image
Use case When alleviating the variation of the density between machines upon Quality> Color Balance in user mode.
user’s request Use case - When the background of a document cannot be read correctly
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and - When removal of the background cannot be performed correctly
press OK key. and a fogging-like image appears
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
ADJ-C C color balance adjustment Display/adj/set range -32 to 32
Lv.1 Details To adjust the default value of the color balance for C when the Default value 0
density of C varies between machines. Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
If the value is too large, a transfer failure and/or a fixing failure
occurs.
Use case When alleviating the variation of the density between machines upon
user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Default value 0

8-105
8
8
8-106
COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR
OFST-M Adj of M bright area dens&color balance OFST-K Adj Bk bright area dens&color balance
Lv.1 Details Lv.1 Details To adjust the bright area density and color balance of Bk.
To adjust the bright area density and color balance of M. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. Lower the value when the background cannot be read correctly
Lower the value when the background cannot be read correctly because the density of a document is dark and increase the value
because the density of a document is dark and increase the value when the density of a document is light.
when the density of a document is light. Lower the value when removal of the background is not performed
Lower the value when removal of the background is not performed correctly and a fogging-like image appears.
correctly and a fogging-like image appears. This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image
This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance in user mode.
Quality> Color Balance in user mode. Use case - When the background of a document cannot be read correctly
Use case - When the background of a document cannot be read correctly - When removal of the background cannot be performed correctly
- When removal of the background cannot be performed correctly and a fogging-like image appears
and a fogging-like image appears Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and press OK key.
press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range -32 to 32
Display/adj/set range -32 to 32 Default value 0
Default value 0 Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance LD-OFS-Y Color balance adj of Y low dens area
OFST-C Adj of C bright area dens&color balance Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the low density area of Y.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the bright area density and color balance of C. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image
Lower the value when the background cannot be read correctly Quality> Color Balance.
because the density of a document is dark and increase the value Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
when the density of a document is light. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Lower the value when removal of the background is not performed press OK key.
correctly and a fogging-like image appears. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Quality> Color Balance in user mode. Default value 0
Use case - When the background of a document cannot be read correctly Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance
- When removal of the background cannot be performed correctly
LD-OFS-M Color balance adj of M low dens area
and a fogging-like image appears
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the low density area of M.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
press OK key.
This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Quality> Color Balance.
Display/adj/set range -32 to 32
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Default value 0
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance

8-106
8
8
8-107
COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR
LD-OFS-C Color balance adj of C low dens area MD-OFS-M Color balance adj of M mid dens area
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the low density area of C. Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the intermediate density area of M.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image
Quality> Color Balance. Quality> Color Balance.
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance
LD-OFS-K Color balance adj of Bk low dens area MD-OFS-C Color balance adj of C mid dens area
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the low density area of Bk. Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the intermediate density area of C.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image
Quality> Color Balance. Quality> Color Balance.
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance
MD-OFS-Y Color balance adj of Y mid dens area MD-OFS-K Color balance adj of Bk mid dens area
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the intermediate density area of Y. Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the intermediate density area of Bk.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image This setting is linked with Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image
Quality> Color Balance. Quality> Color Balance.
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance

8-107
8
8
8-108
COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR
HD-OFS-Y Color balance adj of Y high dens area HD-OFS-K Color balance adj of Bk high dens area
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the high density area of Y. Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the high density area of Bk.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
This setting is linked with Adjustment/ Maintenance> Adjust Image This setting is linked with Adjustment/ Maintenance> Adjust Image
Quality> Color Balance. Quality> Color Balance.
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance
HD-OFS-M Color balance adj of M high dens area PL-OFS-Y Clr blnce adj of Y low dens area:PDL
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the high density area of M. Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the low density area of Y at PDL print.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
This setting is linked with Adjustment/ Maintenance> Adjust Image Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Quality> Color Balance. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 PL-OFS-M Clr blnce adj of M low dens area:PDL
Default value 0 Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the low density area of M at PDL print.
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
HD-OFS-C Color balance adj of C high dens area Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the high density area of C. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. press OK key.
This setting is linked with Adjustment/ Maintenance> Adjust Image 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Quality> Color Balance. Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and PL-OFS-C Clr blnce adj of C low dens area:PDL
press OK key. Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the low density area of C at PDL print.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Color Balance press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Default value 0

8-108
8
8
8-109
COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR
PL-OFS-K Clr blnce adj of Bk low dens area:PDL PM-OFS-K Clr blnce adj of Bk mid dens area:PDL
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the low density area of Bk at PDL print. Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the intermediate density area of Bk at
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. PDL print.
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
PM-OFS-Y Clr blnce adj of Y mid dens area:PDL Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the intermediate density area of Y at PH-OFS-Y Clr blnce adj of Y high dens area:PDL
PDL print. Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the high density area of Y at PDL print.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Default value 0 Default value 0
PM-OFS-M Clr blnce adj of M mid dens area:PDL PH-OFS-M Clr blnce adj of M high dens area:PDL
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the intermediate density area of M at Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the high density area of M at PDL print.
PDL print. As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and press OK key.
press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 Default value 0
Default value 0 PH-OFS-C Clr blnce adj of C high dens area:PDL
PM-OFS-C Clr blnce adj of C mid dens area:PDL Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the high density area of C at PDL print.
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the intermediate density area of C at As the greater value is set, the image gets darker.
PDL print. Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
Default value 0

8-109
8
8
8-110
COPIER>ADJUST>COLOR ■■HV-PRI
PH-OFS-K Clr blnce adj of Bk high dens area:PDL
Lv.2 Details To adjust the color balance of the high density area of Bk at PDL
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI
print. DIS-TGY Dischg crrnt ctrl Y tgt crrnt adj:1/1SPD
As the greater value is set, the image gets darker. Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the Y target current at discharge current
Use case Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. control in plain paper (1/1 speed).
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Use case When a image failure (sand-like image) occurs
press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -8 to 8 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
T-8-27
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Unit 5 µA
Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0
DIS-TGM Dischg crrnt ctrl M tgt crrnt adj:1/1SPD
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the M target current at discharge current
control in plain paper (1/1 speed).
Use case When a image failure (sand-like image) occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Unit 5 µA
Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0
DIS-TGC Dischg crrnt ctrl C tgt crrnt adj:1/1SPD
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the C target current at discharge current
control in plain paper (1/1 speed).
Use case When a image failure (sand-like image) occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Unit 5 µA
Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0

8-110
8
8
8-111
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI
DIS-TGK Dischg crrnt ctrl Bktgt crrnt adj:1/1SPD DIS-TGC2 Dischg crrnt ctrl C tgt adj: 1/2, 1/3SPD
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the Bk target current at discharge current Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the C target current at discharge current
control in plain paper (1/1 speed). control in plain paper (1/2, 1/3 speed).
Use case When a image failure (sand-like image) occurs Use case When a image failure (sand-like image) occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10 Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Unit 5 µA Unit 5 µA
Appropriate target value -5 to 5 Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0 Default value 0
DIS-TGY2 Dischg crrnt ctrl Y tgt adj: 1/2, 1/3SPD DIS-TGK2 Dischg crrnt ctrl Bk tgt adj:1/2, 1/3SPD
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the Y target current at discharge current Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the Bk target current at discharge current
control in plain paper (1/2, 1/3 speed). control in plain paper (1/2, 1/3 speed).
Use case When a image failure (sand-like image) occurs Use case When a image failure (sand-like image) occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10 Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Unit 5 µA Unit 5 µA
Appropriate target value -5 to 5 Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0 Default value 0
DIS-TGM2 Dischg crrnt ctrl M tgt adj: 1/2, 1/3SPD OFSTAC-Y Adj of Y clr charge AC current: 1/1SPD
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the M target current at discharge current Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of the charge AC current for Y.
control in plain paper (1/2, 1/3 speed). As the value is incremented by 1, the current value is increased by
Use case When a image failure (sand-like image) occurs 20 µA.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value
press OK key. when the density is high or a spotted image occurs.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. - At the occurrence of a spotted image
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Unit 5 µA Caution - Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Appropriate target value -5 to 5 - If the value is too large, the life of the Photosensitive Drum
Default value 0 becomes shorter.
Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
Unit 20 Vpp
Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0
Required time 1 minute
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-PRI> OFSTAC-M, OFSTAC-C, OFSTAC-K

8-111
8
8
8-112
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI
OFSTAC-M Adj of M clr charge AC current: 1/1SPD OFSTAC-K Adj of Bk clr charge AC current: 1/1SPD
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of the charge AC current for M. Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of the charge AC current for Bk.
As the value is incremented by 1, the current value is increased by As the value is incremented by 1, the current value is increased by
20 µA. 20 µA.
Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value
when the density is high or a spotted image occurs. when the density is high or a spotted image occurs.
Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure
- At the occurrence of a spotted image - At the occurrence of a spotted image
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution - Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Caution - Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
- If the value is too large, the life of the Photosensitive Drum - If the value is too large, the life of the Photosensitive Drum
becomes shorter. becomes shorter.
Display/adj/set range -20 to 20 Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
Unit 20 Vpp Unit 20 Vpp
Appropriate target value -5 to 5 Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0 Default value 0
Required time 1 minute Required time 1 minute
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-PRI> OFSTAC-Y, OFSTAC-C, OFSTAC-K Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-PRI> OFSTAC-Y, OFSTAC-M, OFSTAC-C
OFSTAC-C Adj of C clr charge AC current: 1/1SPD OFSTACY2 Adj of Y clr charge AC current: 1/2SPD
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of the charge AC current for C. Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of the charge AC current for Y at 1/2 speed.
As the value is incremented by 1, the current value is increased by As the value is incremented by 1, the offset is increased by 50 µA.
20 µA. Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value
Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value when the density is high or a spotted image occurs.
when the density is high or a spotted image occurs. Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure
Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure - At the occurrence of a spotted image
- At the occurrence of a spotted image Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Caution - Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
- If the value is too large, the life of the Photosensitive Drum Unit 20 Vpp
becomes shorter. Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Display/adj/set range -20 to 20 Default value 0
Unit 20 Vpp Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-PRI> OFSTACM2, OFSTACC2, OFSTACK2
Appropriate target value -5 to 5 OFSTACM2 Adj of M clr charge AC current: 1/2SPD
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of the charge AC current for M at 1/2 speed.
Required time 1 minute As the value is incremented by 1, the offset is increased by 50 µA.
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-PRI> OFSTAC-Y, OFSTAC-M, OFSTAC-K Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value
when the density is high or a spotted image occurs.
Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure
- At the occurrence of a spotted image
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
Unit 20 Vpp
Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-PRI> OFSTACY2, OFSTACC2, OFSTACK2

8-112
8
8
8-113
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-PRI
OFSTACC2 Adj of C clr charge AC current: 1/2SPD
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of the charge AC current for C at 1/2 speed.
As the value is incremented by 1, the offset is increased by 50 µA.
Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value
when the density is high or a spotted image occurs.
Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure
- At the occurrence of a spotted image
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
Unit 20 Vpp
Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-PRI> OFSTACY2, OFSTACM2, OFSTACK2
OFSTACK2 Adj of Bk clr charge AC current: 1/2SPD
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset of the charge AC current for Bk at 1/2 speed.
As the value is incremented by 1, the offset is increased by 50 µA.
Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value
when the density is high or a spotted image occurs.
Use case - At the occurrence of an image density failure
- At the occurrence of a spotted image
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly.
Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
Unit 20 Vpp
Appropriate target value -5 to 5
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-PRI> OFSTACY2, OFSTACM2, OFSTACC2
T-8-28

8-113
8
8
8-114
■■HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
1TR-TGK1 Prmry trns ATVC Bk target current (clr)
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current for Bk upon primary transfer
1TR-TGY Adj of prmry trns ATVC Y target current ATVC control in full color mode.
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current for Y upon primary transfer As the value is incremented by 1, the offset is increased by 2 µA.
ATVC control. Increase the value if spotty mark or mottled image occurs.
As the value is incremented by 1, the offset is increased by 2 µA. Decrease the value if white spots occur.
Increase the value if spotty mark or mottled image occurs. Use case When an image failure due to the primary transfer occurs
Decrease the value if white spots occur. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Use case When an image failure due to the primary transfer occurs press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Unit 1 µA
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Appropriate target value -10 to 10
Unit 1 µA Default value 0
Appropriate target value -10 to 10 2TR-N1 Sec trns ATVC tgt crrnt:low hmdy pln 1st
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of plain
1TR-TGM Adj of prmry trns ATVC M target current paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity, 600 dpi).
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current for M upon primary transfer Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
ATVC control. conditions
As the value is incremented by 1, the offset is increased by 2 µA. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Increase the value if spotty mark or mottled image occurs. press OK key.
Decrease the value if white spots occur.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Use case When an image failure due to the primary transfer occurs
Unit 0.2 µA
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Appropriate target value -20 to 20
press OK key.
Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2TR-N2 Sec trns ATVC tgt crrnt:low hmdy pln 2nd
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of plain
Unit 1 µA
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity, 600 dpi).
Appropriate target value -10 to 10
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Default value 0
conditions
1TR-TGC Adj of prmry trns ATVC C target current
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current for C upon primary transfer press OK key.
ATVC control.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
As the value is incremented by 1, the offset is increased by 2 µA.
Unit 0.2 µA
Increase the value if spotty mark or mottled image occurs.
Decrease the value if white spots occur. Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Use case When an image failure due to the primary transfer occurs Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -10 to 10
Default value 0

8-114
8
8
8-115
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-P1 Sec trns ATVC tgt crrnt:low hmdy crd 1st 2TR-UH1 Sec trns ATVC crrnt:low hmdy ext hvy 1st
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of postcard/ Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of extra
envelope at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity). heavy paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity)
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 0.2 µA Unit 0.2 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0
2TR-P2 Sec trns ATVC tgt crrnt:low hmdy crd 2nd 2TR-UH2 Sec trns ATVC crrnt:low hmdy ext hvy 2nd
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of extra
postcard/envelope at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low heavy paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity)
humidity). Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the conditions
conditions Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and press OK key.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Unit 0.2 µA
Unit 0.2 µA Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Default value 0
Default value 0 2TR-N12 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy pln 1st
2TR-H1 Sec trns ATVC tgt crrnt:low hmdy hvy 1st Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of plain/
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of heavy plain2/thin paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity). humidity, 600dpi).
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 0.2 µA Unit 0.2 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0
2TR-H2 Sec trns ATVC tgt crrnt:low hmdy hvy 2nd 2TR-N22 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy pln 2nd
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of heavy Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of plain/
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity) plain2/thin paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the humidity, 600dpi).
conditions Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and conditions
press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 press OK key.
Unit 0.2 µA Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Unit 0.2 µA
Default value 0 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0

8-115
8
8
8-116
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-H12 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy hvy 1st 2TR-P12 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy crd 1st
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of heavy Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity). postcard/envelope at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the humidity).
conditions Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and conditions
press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 press OK key.
Unit 0.2 µA Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Unit 0.2 µA
Default value 0 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
2TR-H22 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy hvy 2nd Default value 0
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of heavy 2TR-P22 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy crd 2nd
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity). Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the postcard/envelope at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal
conditions humidity).
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
press OK key. conditions
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Unit 0.2 µA press OK key.
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Default value 0 Unit 0.2 µA
2TR-UH12 Sec trns ATVCcrrnt:norm hmdy ext hvy 1st Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of extra Default value 0
heavy paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity). 2TR-N13 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy pln 1st
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of plain/
conditions plain2/thin paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and humidity, 600dpi).
press OK key. Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 conditions
Unit 0.2 µA Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 press OK key.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
2TR-UH22 Sec trns ATVCcrrnt:norm hmdy ext hvy 2nd Unit 0.2 µA
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of extra Appropriate target value -20 to 20
heavy paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity). Default value 0
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 0.2 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0

8-116
8
8
8-117
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-N23 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy pln 2nd 2TR-UH23 Sec trns ATVCcrrnt:high hmdy ext hvy 2nd
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of plain/ Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of extra
plain2/thin paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high heavy paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity).
humidity, 600dpi). Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the conditions
conditions Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and press OK key.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Unit 0.2 µA
Unit 0.2 µA Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Default value 0
Default value 0 2TR-P13 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy crd 1st
2TR-H13 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy hvy 1st Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of postcard/
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of heavy envelope at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity).
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the conditions
conditions Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and press OK key.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Unit 0.2 µA
Unit 0.2 µA Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Default value 0
Default value 0 2TR-P23 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy crd 2nd
2TR-H23 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy hvy 2nd Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of heavy postcard/envelope at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). humidity).
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 0.2 µA Unit 0.2 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0
2TR-UH13 Sec trns ATVCcrrnt:high hmdy ext hvy 1st 2TR-O1 Sec trns ATVC tgt crrnt: low hmdy transp
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of extra Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the transparency at
heavy paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity).
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 0.2 µA Unit 0.2 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-117
8
8
8-118
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-O12 Sec trns ATVC tgt crrnt:norm hmdy transp 1TR-TGKT Pry trns ATVC Bk tgt crrnt adj: Bk only
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the transparency at Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of primary transfer ATVC control target current in
secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity). B&W mode.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the As the value is incremented by 1, the offset changes by 1 µA.
conditions If the value is too large, fogging etc. due to transfer memory occurs
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and and if it is too small, transfer failure etc. occurs.
press OK key. Use case When the image failure due to primary transfer occurs in B&W mode
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Unit 0.2 µA press OK key.
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 2) Execute the primary transfer ATVC (open/close the Front Cover
Default value 0 etc.)
2TR-O13 Sec trns ATVC tgt crrnt:high hmdy transp Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the transparency at Unit 1 µA
secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). Appropriate target value -10 to 20
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Default value 0
conditions Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 1TR-TGY, 1TR-TGM, 1TR-TGC, 1TR-
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and TGK
press OK key. 2TR-T1 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: low hmdy thin 1st
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of thin
Unit 0.2 µA paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity).
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
Default value 0
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
2TR-HN2 Sec trns ATVC crrnt:low hmdy hvy pln 2nd
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of
conditions
relatively heavy plain paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
low humidity).
press OK key.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Caution Increase/decrease the value by 1 while checking the symptom each
conditions
time.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
press OK key.
Unit 1 µA
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Unit 1 µA
Default value 0
Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N1
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N2

8-118
8
8
8-119
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-T2 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: low hmdy thin 2nd 2TR-T22 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy thin 2nd
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of thin Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of thin
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity). paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity).
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Caution Increase/decrease the value by 1 while checking the symptom each Caution Increase/decrease the value by 1 while checking the symptom each
time. time.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 µA Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N2 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N22
2TR-T12 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy thin 1st 2TR-T13 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy thin 1st
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of thin Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of thin
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity). paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity).
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Caution Increase/decrease the value by 1 while checking the symptom each Caution Increase/decrease the value by 1 while checking the symptom each
time. time.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 µA Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N12 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N13

8-119
8
8
8-120
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-T23 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy thin 2nd 2TR-R2 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: low hmdy rcycl 2nd
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of thin Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of recycled
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity).
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Caution Increase/decrease the value by 1 while checking the symptom each Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
time. Unit 1 µA
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Unit 1 µA Default value 0
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N2
Default value 0 2TR-R12 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy rcycl 1st
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N23 Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of recycled
2TR-R1 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: low hmdy rcycl 1st paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity).
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of recycled If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity). high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. conditions
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
conditions press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
press OK key. Unit 1 µA
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Unit 1 µA Default value 0
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N12
Default value 0 2TR-R22 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy rcycl 2nd
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N1 Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of recycled
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity).
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N22

8-120
8
8
8-121
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-R13 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy rcycl 1st 2TR-HN12 Sec trns ATVCcrrnt:norm hmdy hvy pln 1st
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of recycled Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of relatively
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). heavy plain paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or humidity).
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
conditions Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and conditions
press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 press OK key.
Unit 1 µA Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Unit 1 µA
Default value 0 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N13 Default value 0
2TR-R23 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy rcycl 2nd Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N12
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of recycled 2TR-HN22 Sec trns ATVCcrrnt:norm hmdy hvy pln 2nd
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or relatively heavy plain paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner normal humidity).
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
conditions scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
press OK key. conditions
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Unit 1 µA press OK key.
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Default value 0 Unit 1 µA
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N23 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
2TR-HN1 Sec trns ATVC crrnt:low hmdy hvy pln 1st Default value 0
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of relatively Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N22
heavy plain paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low
humidity).
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N1

8-121
8
8
8-122
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-HN13 Sec trns ATVCcrrnt:high hmdy hvy pln 1st 2TR-SH1 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: low hmdy hvy2 1st
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of relatively Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of heavy2
heavy plain paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity).
humidity). If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the conditions
conditions Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and press OK key.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Unit 1 µA
Unit 1 µA Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Default value 0
Default value 0 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-H1
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N13 2TR-SH2 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: low hmdy hvy2 2nd
2TR-HN23 Sec trns ATVCcrrnt:high hmdy hvy pln 2nd Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of heavy2
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity).
relatively heavy plain paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high humidity). high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. conditions
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
conditions press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
press OK key. Unit 1 µA
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Unit 1 µA Default value 0
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-H2
Default value 0 2TR-SH12 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy hvy2 1st
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N23 Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of heavy2
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity).
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-H12

8-122
8
8
8-123
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-SH22 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy hvy2 2nd 2TR-E2 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: low hmdy envlp 2nd
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of heavy2 Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity). envelope at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity).
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 µA Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-H22 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-P2
2TR-SH13 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy hvy2 1st 2TR-E12 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy envlp 1st
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of heavy2 Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of envelope
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity).
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 µA Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-H13 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-P12
2TR-E1 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: low hmdy envlp 1st 2TR-E22 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: norm hmdy envlp 2nd
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of envelope Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of
at secondary transfer ATVC control (in low humidity). envelope at secondary transfer ATVC control (in normal humidity).
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the
conditions conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 µA Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-P1 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-P22

8-123
8
8
8-124
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
2TR-E13 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy envlp 1st 2TR-OFF Batch adj of sec trns ATVC target crrnt
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 1st side of envelope Lv.1 Details To collectively adjust the offset values of target current in secondary
at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). transfer ATVC control regardless of conditions.
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias if the same symptom
conditions occurs regardless of conditions
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 Display/adj/set range -128 to 127
Unit 1 µA Unit 1 µA
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Appropriate target value -20 to 20
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-P13 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-N1, etc.
2TR-E23 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy envlp 2nd 1TR-TGY2 Adj Y Pry Trns ATVC tgt crrnt:1/2 speed
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for Y upon primary
envelope at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). transfer ATVC control at 1/2 speed.
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or Increase the value when spots, mottled image, or image failure due
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner to insufficient transfer current occurs.
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. Decrease the value when image fogging due to transfer memory or
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the drum memory due to strong transfer current occurs.
conditions Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and setting occurs
press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 press OK key.
Unit 1 µA 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-P23 1TR-TGM2 Adj M Pry Trns ATVC tgt crrnt:1/2 speed
2TR-SH23 Sec trns ATVC crrnt: high hmdy hvy2 2nd Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for M upon primary
Lv.1 Details To adjust the offset value of target current for the 2nd side of heavy2 transfer ATVC control at 1/2 speed.
paper at secondary transfer ATVC control (in high humidity). Increase the value when spots, mottled image, or image failure due
If the value is too large, density loss due to excessive transfer or to insufficient transfer current occurs.
high-voltage mottled image etc. occurs and if it is too small, toner Decrease the value when image fogging due to transfer memory or
scattering on solid image or mottled image etc. occurs. drum memory due to strong transfer current occurs.
Use case When adjusting the secondary transfer bias according to the Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current
conditions setting occurs
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -128 to 127 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Unit 1 µA Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Appropriate target value -20 to 20 Default value 0
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> HV-TR> 2TR-H23

8-124
8
8
8-125
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR
1TR-TGC2 Adj C Pry Trns ATVC tgt crrnt:1/2 speed 1TR-TGM3 Adj M Pry Trns ATVC tgt crrnt:1/3 speed
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for C upon primary Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for M upon primary
transfer ATVC control at 1/2 speed. transfer ATVC control at 1/3 speed.
Increase the value when spots, mottled image, or image failure due Increase the value when spots, mottled image, or image failure due
to insufficient transfer current occurs. to insufficient transfer current occurs.
Decrease the value when image fogging due to transfer memory or Decrease the value when image fogging due to transfer memory or
drum memory due to strong transfer current occurs. drum memory due to strong transfer current occurs.
Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current
setting occurs setting occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Default value 0 Default value 0
1TR-TK12 Adj Bk Pry Trns ATVC tgt crrnt:1/2 speed 1TR-TGC3 Adj C Pry Trns ATVC tgt crrnt:1/3 speed
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for pure black upon Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for C upon primary
primary transfer ATVC control at 1/2 speed. transfer ATVC control at 1/3 speed.
Increase the value when spots, mottled image, or image failure due Increase the value when spots, mottled image, or image failure due
to insufficient transfer current occurs. to insufficient transfer current occurs.
Decrease the value when image fogging due to transfer memory or Decrease the value when image fogging due to transfer memory or
drum memory due to strong transfer current occurs. drum memory due to strong transfer current occurs.
Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current
setting occurs setting occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Default value 0 Default value 0
1TR-TGY3 Adj Y Pry Trns ATVC tgt crrnt:1/3 speed 1TR-TK13 Adj Bk Pry Trns ATVC tgt crrnt:1/3 speed
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for Y upon primary Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for pure black upon
transfer ATVC control at 1/3 speed. primary transfer ATVC control at 1/3 speed.
Increase the value when spots, mottled image, or image failure due Increase the value when spots, mottled image, or image failure due
to insufficient transfer current occurs. to insufficient transfer current occurs.
Decrease the value when image fogging due to transfer memory or Decrease the value when image fogging due to transfer memory or
drum memory due to strong transfer current occurs. drum memory due to strong transfer current occurs.
Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current
setting occurs setting occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-125
8
8
8-126
COPIER>ADJUST>HV-TR ■■FEED-ADJ
1TR-TK42 Adj clr Bk Pry Trn ATVC tgt crrnt:1/2SPD
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for Bk (color) upon
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ
primary transfer ATVC control at 1/2 speed. REGIST Adj of rgst start timing: Plain paper
As the value is incremented by 1, the offset is increased by 2 µA. Lv.1 Details To adjust the timing to turn ON the Registration Motor in the case of
Increase the value if spots (white spots), leopard pattern image plain paper.
occurs. As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the leading edge of
Decrease the value if white dots occur. paper is increased by 0.1 mm.
Decrease the value if mottled image due to paper surface nature +: Top margin becomes smaller. (An image moves upward.)
occurs when paper type is heavy paper 1/2. -: Top margin becomes larger. (An image moves downward.)
Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
setting occurs value of service label.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Use case When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10 Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 2 micro A Unit 0.1 mm
Default value 0 Default value 0
1TR-TK43 Adj clr Bk Pry Trn ATVC tgt crrnt:1/3SPD ADJ-C1 Cassette1 write start pstn in horz scan
Lv.2 Details To adjust the offset of the target current value for Bk (color) upon Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning
primary transfer ATVC control at 1/3 speed. direction when feeding paper from the Cassette 1 (paper width is
Increase the value when spots, mottled image, or image failure due within 320 mm.)
to insufficient transfer current occurs. As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of
Decrease the value when image fogging due to transfer memory or paper is increased by 0.1 mm.
drum memory due to strong transfer current occurs. +: Left margin becomes larger (An image moves to the right.)
Use case When an image failure due to inappropriate primary transfer current -: Left margin becomes smaller (An image moves to the left.)
setting occurs When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and the value of service label.
press OK key. Use case When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 press OK key.
Default value 0 Caution If the paper width exceeds 320 mm, execute mechanical adjustment.
T-8-29
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 0.1 mm
Default value 0

8-126
8
8
8-127
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ
ADJ-C2 Cassette2 write start pstn in horz scan ADJ-C4 Cassette 4 write start pstn in horz scan
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning
direction when feeding paper from the Cassette 2 (paper width is direction when feeding paper from the Cassette 4 (paper width is
within 320 mm.) within 320 mm.)
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of
paper is increased by 0.1 mm. paper is increased by 0.1 mm.
+: Left margin becomes larger (An image moves to the right.) +: Left margin becomes larger. (An image moves to the right.)
-: Left margin becomes smaller (An image moves to the left.) -: Left margin becomes smaller. (An image moves to the left.)
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
the value of service label. value of service label.
Use case When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Caution If the paper width exceeds 320 mm, execute mechanical adjustment. Caution If the paper width exceeds 320 mm, execute mechanical adjustment.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 0.1 mm Unit 0.1 mm
Default value 0 Default value 0
ADJ-C3 Cassette 3 write start pstn in horz scan ADJ-MF Write start pstn in horz scan: MP tray
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning
direction when feeding paper from the Cassette 3 (paper width is direction when feeding paper from the Multi-purpose Tray (paper
within 320 mm.) width is within 320 mm.)
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of
paper is increased by 0.1 mm. paper is increased by 0.1 mm.
+: Left margin becomes larger. (An image moves to the right.) +: Left margin becomes larger. (An image moves to the right.)
-: Left margin becomes smaller. (An image moves to the left.) -: Left margin becomes smaller. (An image moves to the left.)
When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
value of service label. value of service label.
Use case When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key. press OK key.
Caution If the paper width exceeds 320 mm, execute mechanical adjustment. Caution If the paper width exceeds 320 mm, execute mechanical adjustment.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 0.1 mm Unit 0.1 mm
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-127
8
8
8-128
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ
ADJ-DK Write start pstn in horz scan:Ppr Deck ADJ-C3RE Write start pstn in horz scan:Cst3 2nd
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning
direction when feeding paper from the Paper Deck (paper width is direction for 2nd side when feeding paper from the Cassette 3.
within 320 mm.) As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of paper is increased by 0.1 mm.
paper is increased by 0.1 mm. +: Left margin becomes larger (An image moves to the right.)
+: Left margin becomes larger. (An image moves to the right.) -: Left margin becomes smaller (An image moves to the left.)
-: Left margin becomes smaller. (An image moves to the left.) When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the the value of service label.
value of service label. Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Use case When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and press OK key.
press OK key. Display/adj/set range -55 to 55
Caution If the paper width exceeds 320 mm, execute mechanical adjustment. Unit 0.1 mm
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Default value 0
Unit 0.1 mm ADJ-C4RE Write start pstn in horz scan:Cst4 2nd
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning
ADJ-C1RE Write start pstn in horz scan:Cst1 2nd direction for 2nd side when feeding paper from the Cassette 4.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of
direction for 2nd side when feeding paper from the Cassette 1. paper is increased by 0.1 mm.
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of +: Left margin becomes larger (An image moves to the right.)
paper is increased by 0.1 mm. -: Left margin becomes smaller (An image moves to the left.)
+: Left margin becomes larger (An image moves to the right.) When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter
-: Left margin becomes smaller (An image moves to the left.) the value of service label.
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
the value of service label. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Display/adj/set range -55 to 55
press OK key. Unit 0.1 mm
Display/adj/set range -55 to 55 Default value 0
Unit 0.1 mm ADJ-DKRE Write start pstn in horz scan: Deck 2nd
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning
ADJ-C2RE Write start pstn in horz scan:Cst2 2nd direction for 2nd side when feeding paper from the Paper Deck.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of
direction for 2nd side when feeding paper from the Cassette 2. paper is increased by 0.1 mm.
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of +: Left margin becomes larger. (An image moves to the right.)
paper is increased by 0.1 mm. -: Left margin becomes smaller. (An image moves to the left.)
+: Left margin becomes larger (An image moves to the right.) When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the
-: Left margin becomes smaller (An image moves to the left.) value of service label.
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
the value of service label. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Display/adj/set range -55 to 55
press OK key. Unit 0.1 mm
Display/adj/set range -55 to 55 Default value 0
Unit 0.1 mm
Default value 0

8-128
8
8
8-129
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ
ADJ-MFRE Write start pstn in horz scan:MPTray 2nd REG-DUP1 Rgst start timing adj: Plain, 2nd side
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image write start position in the horizontal scanning Lv.1 Details To adjust the top margin by changing the timing to turn ON the
direction for 2nd side when feeding paper from the Multi-purpose Registration Motor when feeding the second side of plain paper.
Tray. As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of paper is increased by 0.1 mm.
paper is increased by 0.1 mm. +: Top margin becomes smaller. (An image moves upward.)
+: Left margin becomes larger. (An image moves to the right.) -: Top margin becomes larger. (An image moves downward.)
-: Left margin becomes smaller. (An image moves to the left.) Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter press OK key.
the value of service label. Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Unit 0.1 mm
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Default value 0
press OK key. REG-DUP2 Rgst start timing adj: Heavy, 2nd side
Display/adj/set range -55 to 55 Lv.1 Details To adjust the top margin by changing the timing to turn ON the
Unit 0.1 mm Registration Motor when feeding the second side of heavy paper.
Default value 0 As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of
REG-THCK Rgst start timing adj: Heavy, 1/2 speed paper is increased by 0.1 mm.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the top margin by changing the timing to turn ON the +: Top margin becomes smaller. (An image moves upward.)
Registration Motor when feeding heavy paper. -: Top margin becomes larger. (An image moves downward.)
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
paper is increased by 0.1 mm. press OK key.
+: Top margin becomes smaller. (An image moves upward.) Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
-: Top margin becomes larger. (An image moves downward.) Unit 0.1 mm
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Default value 0
press OK key. LP-FEED1 Cassette pre-rgst arch amount: Plain
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Lv.1 Details To adjust the arch amount before registration when feeding plain
Unit 0.1 mm paper from the cassette.
Default value 0 As the value is incremented by 1, the pre-registration arch amount
REG-OHT Rgst start timing adj: Transparency changes by 0.5 mm.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the top margin by changing the timing to turn ON the +: Increase
Registration Motor when feeding transparency. -: Decrease
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin on the left edge of Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
paper is increased by 0.1 mm. press OK key.
+: Top margin becomes smaller. (An image moves upward.) Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
-: Top margin becomes larger. (An image moves downward.) Unit 0.5 mm
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Default value 0
press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 0.1 mm
Default value 0

8-129
8
8
8-130
COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ COPIER>ADJUST>FEED-ADJ
LP-MULT1 MP Tray pre-rgst arch amount: Plain TBLT-SPD Fine adjustment of ETB speed
Lv.1 Details To adjust the arch amount before registration when feeding plain Lv.1 Details To make a fine adjustment of the ETB speed.
paper from the Multi-purpose Tray. +: The speed is increased.
As the value is incremented by 1, the pre-registration arch amount -: The speed is decreased.
changes by 0.5 mm. When the speed is changed, image magnification in the vertical
+: Increase scanning direction is changed.
-: Decrease Use case When image magnification is changed due to replacement of ETB,
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and etc.
press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 press OK key.
Unit 0.5 mm Display/adj/set range -30 to 30
Default value 0 Unit 0.1 mm/sec
LP-DUP1 Duplex pre-rgst arch amount: Plain Default value 0
Lv.1 Details To adjust the arch amount before registration when feeding plain T-8-30
paper in duplex mode.
As the value is incremented by 1, the pre-registration arch amount
changes by 0.5 mm.
+: Increase
-: Decrease
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 0.5 mm
Default value 0
REG-SPD Speed adjustment of Registration Motor
Lv.1 Details To adjust 1/1 speed of the Registration Motor.
As the value is incremented by 1, the speed is increased by 0.2%.
+: Speed up
-: Slow down
When the value is decreased, the blurry image at around 40 to
45mm from the image trailing edge is alleviated.
Use case When blurry image occurs at around 40 to 45mm from the image
trailing edge
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -5 to 5
Unit 0.20%
Default value 0

8-130
8
8
8-131
■■CST-ADJ ■■MISC
COPIER>ADJUST>CST-ADJ COPIER>ADJUST>MISC
MF-A4R Adj of MP Tray A4R paper width SEG-ADJ Set criteria for text/photo: front side
Lv.1 Details To adjust the width of A4R paper in the Multi-purpose Tray. Lv.1 Details To set the judgment level of text/photo original in Text/Photo/Map
When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the mode.
value of service label. As the value is increased, the original tends to be detected as a
When registering a new value, execute COPIER> FUNCTION> photo document, and as the value is decreased, the original tends to
CST> A4R. be detected as a text document.
Use case - When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When adjusting the classification level of text and photo in Text/
- When registering a new value. Photo/Map mode
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
service label. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Display/adj/set range -4 to 4
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CST> A4R K-ADJ Set criteria for black text: front side
MF-A6R Adj of MP Tray A6R paper width Lv.1 Details To set the judgment level of black characters at text processing.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the width of A6R paper in the Multi-purpose Tray. As the value is increased, the text tends to be detected as black.
When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the Use case When preferring the text to be judged as black
value of service label. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
When registering a new value, execute COPIER> FUNCTION> press OK key.
CST> A6R. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Use case - When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
- When registering a new value. Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. ACS-ADJ Set criteria for B&W/color in ACS:front
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.1 Details To set the judgment level of B&W/color original in ACS mode.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the As the value is increased, the original tends to be detected as a
service label. B&W document, and as the value is decreased, the original tends to
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 be detected as a color document.
Default value 0 Use case When adjusting the color detection level in ACS mode
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CST> A6R Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
MF-A4 Adj of MP Tray A4 paper width press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the width of A4 paper in the Multi-purpose Tray. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data, enter the Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
value of service label. Default value 0
When registering a new value, execute COPIER> FUNCTION> ACS-EN Set judgment area in ACS mode:front side
CST> A4. Lv.2 Details To set the judgment area in ACS mode.
Use case - When replacing the DC Controller PCB/clearing RAM data As the greater value is set, the judgment area is widened.
- When registering a new value. Use case When adjusting the judgment area in ACS mode
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. press OK key.
Caution After the setting value is changed, write the changed value in the 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
service label. Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Default value 1
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CST> A4
T-8-31

8-131
8
8
8-132
COPIER>ADJUST>MISC COPIER>ADJUST>MISC
ACS-CNT Set jdgmt pixel count area in ACS:front SEG-ADJ3 Set text/photo jdgmt stdrd: back side
Lv.2 Details To set the area which counts the pixel to judge the color presence in Lv.1 Details To set the judgment level of text/photo original in Text/Photo/Map
ACS mode. mode (back side at duplex reading with 1 path).
As the greater value is set, the judgment area is widened. As the value is increased, the original tends to be detected as a
Use case When adjusting the area which counts the pixel to judge the color photo document, and as the value is decreased, the original tends to
presence in ACS mode be detected as a text document.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Use case When adjusting the classification level of text and photo in Text/
press OK key. Photo/Map mode (back side at duplex reading with 1 path)
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
ACS-EN2 Set ACS mode jdgmt area in DADF mode Display/adj/set range -4 to 4
Lv.2 Details To set the judgment area in ACS mode at DADF reading. Default value 0
As the greater value is set, the judgment area is widened. K-ADJ3 Set Bk text jdgmt stdrd: back side
Use case When adjusting the judgment area in ACS mode at DADF reading Lv.1 Details To set the judgment level of black characters at text processing (back
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and side at duplex reading with 1 path).
press OK key. As the value is increased, the text tends to be detected as black.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When preferring the text to be judged as black (back side at duplex
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 reading with 1 path)
Default value 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
ACS-CNT2 Set ACS jdgmt pixel count area in DADF press OK key.
Lv.2 Details To set the area which counts the pixel to judge the color presence in 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
ACS mode at DADF reading. Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
As the greater value is set, the judgment area is widen. Default value 0
Use case When adjusting the area which counts the pixel to judge the color ACS-ADJ3 Set ACS B&W/color jdgmt stdrd:back side
presence in ACS mode at DADF reading Lv.1 Details To set the judgment level of B&W/color original in ACS mode (back
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and side at duplex reading with 1 path).
press OK key. As the value is increased, the original tends to be detected as a
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. B&W document, and as the value is decreased, the original tends to
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 be detected as a color document.
Default value 0 Use case When adjusting the color detection level in ACS mode (back side at
REOS-PG Set Reos processing coeffct at 1200dpi duplex reading with 1 path)
Lv.2 Details To set an optimal Reos processing coefficient for 1200dpi print. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Print PG of the type 55 in COPIER> TEST> PG> TYPE, check the press OK key.
images in the 4 areas of this PG, and specify the number of the area 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
in which the character proportion and line width become optimum by Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
the Reos processing module in the case of PDL1200 dpi setting. Default value 0
After the setting is done, output the vertical and horizontal patterns
with 3 dots and 10 spaces, which are the same as the PG above,
in 1200 dpi, and confirm that the result is the same as the specified
area.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 4
Default value 2
Related service mode COPIER> TEST> PG> TYPE

8-132
8
8
8-133
COPIER>ADJUST>MISC COPIER>ADJUST>MISC
ACS-EN3 Set of ACS mode jdgmt area: back side SH-ADJ2 Sharpness setting change function
Lv.2 Details To set the judgment area in ACS mode (back side at duplex reading Lv.1 Details To adjust the sharpness of images on the second side of a
with 1 path). document, which is set in the user mode, in the 1-path duplex stream
As the greater value is set, the judgment area is widened. reading mode.
As the greater value is set, the image gets sharper.
Use case When adjusting the judgment area in ACS mode (back side at duplex If the value is too large, moire is likely to occur in an output image of
reading with 1 path) COPY and SEND.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and To match the image quality with that of the second side in the 1-path
press OK key. duplex stream reading mode, decrease the value when moire on the
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. first side is stronger than the second side, and increase the value
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 when it is weaker.
Default value 1 Use case When moire frequently occurs on images of COPY and SEND output
ACS-CNT3 ACS mode jdgmt pixel count area: back Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
Lv.2 Details To set the area which counts the pixel to judge the color presence in press OK key.
ACS mode (back side at duplex reading with 1 path). 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
As the greater value is set, the judgment area is widen. Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
Use case When adjusting the area which counts the pixel to judge the color Default value 0
presence in ACS mode (back side at duplex reading with 1 path) Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> MISC> SH-ADJ
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Related user mode Settings/Registration> Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image
press OK key. Quality> Sharpness
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. T-8-32
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
Default value 0
SH-ADJ Adjustment of sharpness
Lv.1 Details To adjust the sharpness of the following images which are set in the
user mode:
- Image to be read in the copyboard reading mode
- Image on the first side of a document to be read in the reverse-
path duplex stream reading mode
- Image on the first side of a document to be read in the 1-path
duplex stream reading mode
As the greater value is set, the image gets sharper.
If the value is too large, moire is likely to occur in an output image of
COPY and SEND.
To match the image quality with that of the second side in the 1-path
duplex stream reading mode, decrease the value when moire on the
first side is stronger than the second side and increase the value
when it is weaker.
Use case When moire frequently occurs on images of COPY and SEND output
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> MISC> SH-ADJ2
Related user mode Settings/Registration> Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image
Quality> Sharpness

8-133
8
8
8-134
■■EXP-LED COPIER>ADJUST>EXP-LED
PR-EXP-K Setting of Bk Pre-exposure LED current
COPIER>ADJUST>EXP-LED Lv.2 Details To set the current of Bk Pre-exposure LED.
PR-EXP-Y Setting of Y Pre-exposure LED current Increase the value when taking a measure for drum ghost.
Lv.2 Details To set the current of Y Pre-exposure LED. Decrease the value when potential is not applied well.
Increase the value when taking a measure for drum ghost. Use case - When drum ghost is significant (drum pitch is not correct)
Decrease the value when potential is not applied well. - When potential is not applied well
Use case - When drum ghost is significant (drum pitch is not correct) Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
- When potential is not applied well 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Unit 1/16%
Display/adj/set range 0 to 15 Default value 0
Unit 1/16%
T-8-33
Appropriate target value 10 to 15
Default value 0
PR-EXP-M Setting of M Pre-exposure LED current
Lv.2 Details To set the current of M Pre-exposure LED.
Increase the value when taking a measure for drum ghost.
Decrease the value when potential is not applied well.
Use case - When drum ghost is significant (drum pitch is not correct)
- When potential is not applied well
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 15
Unit 1/16%
Appropriate target value 10 to 15
Default value 0
PR-EXP-C Setting of C Pre-exposure LED current
Lv.2 Details To set the current of C Pre-exposure LED.
Increase the value when taking a measure for drum ghost.
Decrease the value when potential is not applied well.
Use case - When drum ghost is significant (drum pitch is not correct)
- When potential is not applied well
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Do not use this at the normal service.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 15
Unit 1/16%
Appropriate target value 10 to 15
Default value 0

8-134
8
8
8-135
FUNCTION COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL
STIR-4 Stirring of all color developer
■■INSTALL Lv.1 Details To stir developer in the Developing Assemblies of 4 colors (Y/M/C/
Bk).
COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL Use case - At installation of the machine
STIR-Y Stirring of Y color developer - At occurrence of an image failure
Lv.1 Details To stir developer in the Y Developing Assembly. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Use case - At installation of the machine Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
- At occurrence of an image failure Required time Approx. 60 seconds (C5051/5045), Approx. 90 seconds
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. (C5035/5030)
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STIR-Y, STIR-M, STIR-C, STIR-K
Required time Approx. 60 seconds (C5051/5045), Approx. 90 seconds INIT-Y Y toner dens signal initial VL reading
(C5035/5030) Lv.2 Details [Not used] To read the initial value of Y toner density value (SGNL-Y,
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STIR-M, STIR-C, STIR-K, STIR-4 REF-Y).
STIR-M Stirring of M color developer After feeding over 100 sheets using a new Toner Container, this
Lv.1 Details To stir developer in the M Developing Assembly. mode can reset this Toner Container as a new one.
Use case - At installation of the machine Use case When a new Toner Container which 100 or more sheets are fed for
- At occurrence of an image failure image failure test, etc. is used as a new one again
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Required time Approx. 60 seconds (C5051/5045), Approx. 90 seconds Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> DENS> SGNL-Y, REF-Y
(C5035/5030) INIT-M M toner dens signal initial VL reading
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STIR-Y, STIR-C, STIR-K, STIR-4 Lv.2 Details [Not used] To read the initial value of M toner density value (SGNL-M,
STIR-C Stirring of C color developer REF-M).
Lv.1 Details To stir developer in the C Developing Assembly. After feeding over 100 sheets using a new Toner Container, this
Use case - At installation of the machine mode can reset this Toner Container as a new one.
- At occurrence of an image failure Use case When a new Toner Container which 100 or more sheets are fed for
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. image failure test, etc. is used as a new one again
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Required time Approx. 60 seconds (C5051/5045), Approx. 90 seconds Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
(C5035/5030) Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> DENS> SGNL-M, REF-M
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STIR-Y, STIR-M, STIR-K, STIR-4 INIT-C C toner dens signal initial VL reading
STIR-K Stirring of Bk color developer Lv.2 Details [Not used] To read the initial value of C toner density value (SGNL-C,
Lv.1 Details To stir developer in the Bk Developing Assembly. REF-C).
Use case - At installation of the machine After feeding over 100 sheets using a new Toner Container, this
- At occurrence of an image failure mode can reset this Toner Container as a new one.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Use case When a new Toner Container which 100 or more sheets are fed for
image failure test, etc. is used as a new one again
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Required time Approx. 60 seconds (C5051/5045), Approx. 90 seconds
(C5035/5030) Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> STIR-Y, STIR-M, STIR-C, STIR-4 Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> DENS> SGNL-C, REF-C

8-135
8
8
8-136
COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL
INIT-K Bk toner dens signal initial VL reading INISET-Y Exe of Y Dev Ass’y initial install mode
Lv.2 Details [Not used] To read the initial value of Bk toner density value (SGNL-K, Lv.1 Details To automatically execute operation necessary for initial installation of
REF-K). the Y Developing Assembly.
After feeding over 100 sheets using a new Toner Container, this 1. Idle rotation of the Developing Assembly
mode can reset this Toner Container as a new one. 2. Initialization of the Toner Density Sensor
Use case When a new Toner Container which 100 or more sheets are fed for 3. Secondary transfer ATVC control
image failure test, etc. is used as a new one again 4. Patch light intensity correction
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. 5. Background correction
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! 6. Discharge current control
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> DENS> SGNL-K, REF-K 7. Primary transfer ATVC control
8. Initialization of the Patch Sensor
STRD-POS Scan position auto adj in DADF mode
9. Auto registration
Lv.1 Details To adjust the DADF scanning position automatically.
10. D-max control
Use case At DADF installation/uninstallation
11. D-half control
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set a paper for stream reading position adjustment, and then 12. ARCDAT-Lite (creates the target)
close the DADF. 13. Cleaning of the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller (twice)
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. 14. Counter reset of the Developing Assembly
The operation automatically stops after the adjustment.
Use case When replacing the Y Developing Assembly
3) Write the value displayed by COPIER>ADJUST>ADJ-XY>STRD-
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
POS in the service label.
Caution - When installing the machine or replacing the Developing Assembly
Caution Write the adjusted value in the service label.
of other color, do not use this item. .
Display/adj/set range At normal termination: OK, At abnormal termination: NG
- Execute this item after setting “AINR-OFF” to “1: ON”.
Required time Approx. 10 seconds
Display/adj/set range During operation: xxx second (remaining time), At normal termination:
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> ADJ-XY> STRD-POS OK, At abnormal termination: NG
CARD Card number setting Required time 155 seconds
Lv.1 Details To set the card number to be used for Card Reader. Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> INISET-M, INISET-C, INISET-K,
A series of numbers from the entered number to the number of cards INISET-4, AINR-OFF
specified by CARD-RNG can be used.
Use case - At installation of the Card Reader
- After replacement of the HDD
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the number, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution The card management information (department ID and password) is
initialized.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2001
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> FNC-SW> CARD-RNG (Level 2)
KEY ON/OFF of management key function
Lv.1 Details To set whether to enable or disable the management key function.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0

8-136
8
8
8-137
COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL
INISET-M Exe of M Dev Ass’y initial install mode INISET-C Exe of C Dev Ass’y initial install mode
Lv.1 Details To automatically execute operation necessary for initial installation of Lv.1 Details To automatically execute operation necessary for initial installation of
the M Developing Assembly. the C Developing Assembly.
1. Idle rotation of the Developing Assembly 1. Idle rotation of the Developing Assembly
2. Initialization of the Toner Density Sensor 2. Initialization of the Toner Density Sensor
3. Secondary transfer ATVC control 3. Secondary transfer ATVC control
4. Patch light intensity correction 4. Patch light intensity correction
5. Background correction 5. Background correction
6. Discharge current control 6. Discharge current control
7. Primary transfer ATVC control 7. Primary transfer ATVC control
8. Initialization of the Patch Sensor 8. Initialization of the Patch Sensor
9. Auto registration 9. Auto registration
10. D-max control 10. D-max control
11. D-half control 11. D-half control
12. ARCDAT-Lite (creates the target) 12. ARCDAT-Lite (creates the target)
13. Cleaning of the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller (twice) 13. Cleaning of the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller (twice)
14. Counter reset of the Developing Assembly 14. Counter reset of the Developing Assembly
Use case When replacing the M Developing Assembly Use case When replacing the C Developing Assembly
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution - When installing the machine or replacing the Developing Assembly Caution - When installing the machine or replacing the Developing Assembly
of other color, do not use this item. . of other color, do not use this item. .
- Execute this item after setting “AINR-OFF” to “1: ON”. - Execute this item after setting “AINR-OFF” to “1: ON”.
Display/adj/set range During operation: xxx second (remaining time), At normal termination: Display/adj/set range During operation: xxx second (remaining time), At normal termination:
OK, At abnormal termination: NG OK, At abnormal termination: NG
Required time 155 seconds Required time 155 seconds
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> INISET-Y, INISET-C, INISET-K, Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> INISET-Y, INISET-M, INISET-K,
INISET-4, AINR-OFF INISET-4, AINR-OFF
AINR-OFF ON/OFF of warm-up rotation deactivation
Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF to disable execution of warm-up rotation.
Warm-up rotation can be omitted when turning OFF/ON the power to
check the image, etc. after the adjustment of warm-up rotation, etc.
This mode is executed when warm-up rotation is not needed.
Use case - At installation
- When replacing the Developing Assembly
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Be sure to enable the operation (cancel disabling) before the
machine is used by the user. The operation is automatically enabled
by executing INISET-Y/M/C/K/4.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF (Warm-up rotation enabled), 1: ON (Warm-up rotation
disabled)
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> INISET-Y, INISET-M, INISET-C,
INISET-K, INISET-4

8-137
8
8
8-138
COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL
E-RDS Set use/no use of Embedded-RDS function COM-LOG Dis connect error w/ Sales Co’s server
Lv.1 Details To set whether to use the Embedded-RDS function. Lv.1 Details To display error information when the connection with the sales
Use case When using Embedded-RDS company’s server failed.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When using Embedded-RDS
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method Display only
Caution Be sure to use E-RDS, RGW-PORT, COM-TEST, COM-LOG and Caution Be sure to use E-RDS, RGW-PORT, COM-TEST, COM-LOG and
RGW-ADR as a set. RGW-ADR as a set.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range Year, date, time, error code, error detail information (maximum 128
0: Function not used, 1: Function used (All the counter information is characters)
sent.) Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> E-RDS, RGW-PORT, COM-TEST,
Default value 0 RGW-ADR
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> RGW-PORT, COM-TEST, COM- Supplement/memo Embedded-RDS: Function to send device information such as the
LOG, RGW-ADR device counter, failure, and consumables etc. to the sales company’s
Supplement/memo Embedded-RDS: Function to send device information such as the server via SOAP protocol
device counter, failure, and consumables etc. to the sales company’s RGW-ADR URL setting of Sales Company’s server
server via SOAP protocol Lv.1 Details To set the URL of the sales company’s server to be used for
RGW-PORT Set port number of Sales Co’s server Embedded-RDS.
Lv.1 Details To set the port number of the sales company’s server to be used for Use case When using Embedded-RDS
Embedded-RDS. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the URL.
Use case When using Embedded-RDS 2) Enter the URL, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Caution - Do not use Shift-JIS character strings.
Caution Be sure to use E-RDS, RGW-PORT, COM-TEST, COM-LOG and - Be sure to use E-RDS, RGW-PORT, COM-TEST, COM-LOG and
RGW-ADR as a set. RGW-ADR as a set.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 65535 Display/adj/set range URL
Default value 443 Default value https://a01.ugwdevice.net/ugw/agentif010
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> E-RDS, COM-TEST, COM-LOG, Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> E-RDS, RGW-PORT, COM-TEST,
RGW-ADR COM-LOG
Supplement/memo Embedded-RDS: Function to send device information such as the Supplement/memo Embedded-RDS: Function to send device information such as the
device counter, failure, and consumables etc. to the sales company’s device counter, failure, and consumables etc. to the sales company’s
server via SOAP protocol server via SOAP protocol
COM-TEST Dis connect result w/ Sales Co’s server CNT-DATE Set counter send start date to SC server
Lv.1 Details To display the result of the connection test with the sales company’s Lv.1 Details To set the year, month, date, hour and minute to send counter
server. information to the sales company’s server.
Use case When using Embedded-RDS This is displayed only when the Embedded-RDS third-party extended
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. function is available.
Caution Be sure to use E-RDS, RGW-PORT, COM-TEST, COM-LOG and Use case When the Embedded-RDS third-party expanded function is available
RGW-ADR as a set. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When connection is completed: OK, 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
When connection is failed: NG Display/adj/set range YYYYMMDDHHMM (12 digits)
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> E-RDS, RGW-PORT, COM-LOG, YYYY: Year, MM: Month, DD: Date, HH: Hour, MM: Minute
RGW-ADR Default value 000000000000
Supplement/memo Embedded-RDS: Function to send device information such as the Supplement/memo Embedded-RDS: Function to send device information such as the
device counter, failure, and consumables etc. to the sales company’s device counter, failure, and consumables etc. to the sales company’s
server via SOAP protocol server via SOAP protocol

8-138
8
8
8-139
COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL
CNT-INTV Set counter send interval to SC server INISET-K Exe of Bk Dev Ass’y initial install mode
Lv.1 Details To set the interval of sending counter information to the sales Lv.1 Details To automatically execute operation necessary for initial installation of
company’s server in a unit of one hour. the Bk Developing Assembly.
This is displayed only when the Embedded-RDS third-party extended 1. Idle rotation of the Developing Assembly
function is available. 2. Initialization of the Toner Density Sensor
Use case - When restarting the potential control after executing COPIER> 3. Secondary transfer ATVC control
OPTION> IMG-FIX> PO-CNT. 4. Patch light intensity correction
- When D-max control conditions are changed 5. Background correction
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 6. Discharge current control
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 7. Primary transfer ATVC control
Display/adj/set range 1 to 168 (= 1 week) 8. Initialization of the Patch Sensor
Unit 1 hour 9. Auto registration
10. D-max control
Default value 24
11. D-half control
Supplement/memo Embedded-RDS: Function to send device information such as the
12. ARCDAT-Lite (creates the target)
device counter, failure, and consumables etc. to the sales company’s
13. Cleaning of the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller (twice)
server via SOAP protocol
14. Counter reset of the Developing Assembly
INISET-4 All color Dev Ass’y initial install mode
Use case When replacing the Bk Developing Assembly
Lv.1 Details To automatically execute operation necessary for initial installation of
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
the Developing Assemblies of 4 colors (Y, M, C, Bk).
Caution - When installing the machine or replacing the Developing Assembly
1. Idle rotation of the Developing Assembly
of other color, do not use this item. .
2. Initialization of the Toner Density Sensor
- Execute this item after setting “AINR-OFF” to “1: ON”.
3. Secondary transfer ATVC control
4. Patch light intensity correction Display/adj/set range During operation: xxx second (remaining time), At normal termination:
5. Background correction OK, At abnormal termination: NG
6. Discharge current control Required time 155 seconds
7. Primary transfer ATVC control Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> INISET-Y, INISET-M, INISET-C,
8. Initialization of the Patch Sensor INISET-4, AINR-OFF
9. Auto registration BRWS-ACT ON/OFF of service browser
10. D-max control Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF of service browser.
11. D-half control ON/OFF of service browser switches whenever the main power
12. ARCDAT-Lite (creates the target) switch is turned OFF/ON after execution.
13. Cleaning of the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller (twice) If connection with the UGW server is successful, “OK!” is displayed.
14. Counter reset of the Developing Assembly If “NG!” is displayed, execute a communication test using COM-
Use case - At installation TEST.
- When replacing the Developing Assemblies of all colors The setting is enabled after reboot. Whether the service browser is
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. ON or OFF can be checked in COPIER> DISPLAY> USER> BRWS-
Caution - Use this item only when replacing Developing Assemblies of 4 STS (1: ON, 2: OFF).
colors simultaneously. Use case - When using the service browser
- Execute this item after setting “AINR-OFF” to “1: ON”. - At operation check
Display/adj/set range During operation: xxx second (remaining time), At normal termination: Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
OK, At abnormal termination: NG 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Required time 155 seconds Caution After execution, turn OFF/ON the main power switch. After reboot,
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> INISET-Y, INISET-M, INISET-C, be sure to check the usage status in COPIER> DISPLAY> USER>
INISET-K, AINR-OFF BRWS-STS.
Display/adj/set range At normal termination: OK!, At abnormal termination: NG!
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> COM-TEST
COPIER> DISPLAY> USER> BRWS-STS

8-139
8
8
8-140
COPIER>FUNCTION>INSTALL ■■CCD
CDS-CTL Setting of country/area when CDS is used
Lv.1 Details To set the country/area to enable the CDS.
COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD
Use case When enabling the CDS DF-WLVL1 White level adj in book mode: color
Display/adj/set range CA (Canada), LA (Latin America), HK (Hong Kong) and the country/ Lv.1 Details To adjust the white level for copyboard scanning automatically by
area specified in COPIER> OPTION> FNC-SW> CONFIG. setting the paper which is usually used by the user on the Copyboard
Glass.
Default value It differs according to the location.
Use case - When replacing the Copyboard Glass
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> FNC-SW> CONFIG
- When replacing the Scanner Unit
Supplement/memo CDS: Contents Delivery System
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
T-8-34
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the Copyboard Glass.
2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution Be sure to execute DF-WLVL2 in a row.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When the operation finished normally:
OK!
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL2
COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTBK-R, DFTBK-G, DFTBK-B
DF-WLVL2 White level adj in DADF mode: color
Lv.1 Details To adjust the white level for DADF scanning automatically by setting
the paper which is usually used by the user on the DADF.
Use case - When replacing the Copyboard Glass
- When replacing the Scanner Unit
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the DADF.
2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution Be sure to execute this item after DF-WLVL1.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CCD> DF-WLVL1
COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R, DFTAR-G, DFTAR-B,
DFTAR2-R, DFTAR2-G, DFTAR2-B, DFTAR-BW, DFTAR2BW,
DFTBK-R, DFTBK-G, DFTBK-B

8-140
8
8
8-141
COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD COPIER>FUNCTION>CCD
DF-LNR Deriving of DADF front/back linearity DF-WLVL4 White level adj in DADF mode (B&W)
Lv.1 Details To derive the front/back side linearity characteristics in the use of Lv.1 Details To adjust the white level for DADF scanning automatically by setting
DADF based on the scanning data of the DADF complex chart (No. 2, the paper which is usually used by the user on the DADF.
No. 10). Use case - When replacing the Copyboard Glass
- When replacing the Scanner Unit
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data - When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the value of the reader’s service label. (under COPIER> Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the DADF.
ADJUST> CCD) 2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
DFCH-R2, DFCH-G2, DFCH-B2, DFCH-K2, Caution Be sure to execute this item after DF-WLVL3.
DFCH-R10, DFCH-G10, DFCH-B10, DFCH-K10, Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
DFCH2R2, DFCH2G2, DFCH2B2, DFCH2K2, Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTAR-R, DFTAR-G, DFTAR-B,
DFCH2R10, DFCH2G10, DFCH2B10, DFCH2K10 DFTAR2-R, DFTAR2-G, DFTAR2-B, DFTBK-BW
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. BW-TGT Set of B&W shading target value
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! Lv.1 Details After the white level data (X/Y/Z) for the Standard White Plate is set,
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFCH-R2, DFCH-G2, DFCH-B2, read the Standard White Plate and set the black and white shading
DFCH-K2, DFCH-R10, DFCH-G10, DFCH-B10, DFCH-K10, target value.
DFCH2R2, DFCH2G2, DFCH2B2, DFCH2K2, DFCH2R10, Use case When replacing the Copyboard Glass/Scanner Unit
DFCH2G10, DFCH2B10, DFCH2K10
Caution Be sure to execute this item after execution of COPIER> ADJUST>
MTF-CLC Deriving of MTF filter coefficient CCD>W-PLT-X, W-PLT-Y, W-PLT-Z.
Lv.1 Details To derive the MTF filter coefficient to be set for ASIC based on the Display/adj/set range 1 to 2047
MTF value of the DADF complex chart.
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> W-PLT-X, W-PLT-Y, W-PLT-Z
Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
T-8-35
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF-M1 to M12, MTF-S1 to S12,
MTF2-M1 to M12, MTF2-S1 to S12
Supplement/memo The scanning data of the DADF complex chart is indicated in the
label of the Scanner Unit (DADF/Reader).
DF-WLVL3 White level adj in book mode (B&W)
Lv.1 Details To adjust the white level for copyboard scanning automatically by
setting the paper which is usually used by the user on the Copyboard
Glass.
Use case - When replacing the Copyboard Glass
- When replacing the Scanner Unit
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on the Copyboard Glass.
2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution Be sure to execute DF-WLVL4 in a row.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> DFTBK-BW

8-141
8
8
8-142
■■LASER COPIER>FUNCTION>LASER
LD-ADJ-K Restore Bk Skew Crrct Motor initial pstn
COPIER>FUNCTION>LASER Lv.2 Details When Bk-color skew volume in vertical scanning direction is larger
LD-ADJ-Y Restore Y Skew Crrct Motor initial pstn than estimation, the Image Skew Correction Motor (Bk) is locked,
Lv.2 Details When Y-color skew volume in vertical scanning direction is larger and color displacement cannot be corrected even when color
than estimation, the Image Skew Correction Motor (Y) is locked, displacement correction control is executed. This item places the
and color displacement cannot be corrected even when color Image Skew Correction Motor (Bk) to the center position in such
displacement correction control is executed. This item places the cases.
Image Skew Correction Motor (Y) to the center position in such Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit to identify the failure position
cases. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit to identify the failure position Caution After opening and closing the door during operation, execute the
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. service mode again even if “OK!” is displayed.
Caution After opening and closing the door during operation, execute the Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
service mode again even if “OK!” is displayed. Required time 10 seconds
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
T-8-36
Required time 10 seconds
LD-ADJ-M Restore M Skew Crrct Motor initial pstn
Lv.2 Details When M-color skew volume in vertical scanning direction is larger
than estimation, the Image Skew Correction Motor (M) is locked,
and color displacement cannot be corrected even when color
displacement correction control is executed. This item places the
Image Skew Correction Motor (M) to the center position in such
cases.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit to identify the failure position
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution After opening and closing the door during operation, execute the
service mode again even if “OK!” is displayed.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Required time 10 seconds
LD-ADJ-C Restore C Skew Crrct Motor initial pstn
Lv.2 Details When C-color skew volume in vertical scanning direction is larger
than estimation, the Image Skew Correction Motor (C) is locked,
and color displacement cannot be corrected even when color
displacement correction control is executed. This item places the
Image Skew Correction Motor (C) to the center position in such
cases.
Use case When replacing the Laser Scanner Unit to identify the failure position
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution After opening and closing the door during operation, execute the
service mode again even if “OK!” is displayed.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Required time 10 seconds

8-142
8
8
8-143
■■DPC COPIER>FUNCTION>DPC
DRMRSETM Forcible exe of M Drum replacement mode
COPIER>FUNCTION>DPC Lv.1 Details When replacement of Drum Unit is completed within 30 minutes,
DRMRSETY Forcible exe of Y Drum replacement mode warm-up rotation may not be executed at power-off/on because of
Lv.1 Details When replacement of Drum Unit is completed within 30 minutes, high fixing temperature. In such cases, drum potential becomes
warm-up rotation may not be executed at power-off/on because of unstable, causing an image failure to occur. To prevent this symptom,
high fixing temperature. In such cases, drum potential becomes this item forcibly executes the same operation as warm-up rotation.
unstable, causing an image failure to occur. To prevent this symptom, At this time, laser power values, etc., that were corrected according
this item forcibly executes the same operation as warm-up rotation. to M drum counter, total charging time, target Vd values for potential
At this time, laser power values, etc., that were corrected according control and drum durability are reset.
to Y drum counter, total charging time, target Vd values for potential Use case - When detection of the Drum Unit replacement has failed
control and drum durability are reset. - When the Drum Unit used in other machine for a while is used as a
Use case - When detection of the Drum Unit replacement has failed dummy unit
- When the Drum Unit used in other machine for a while is used as a Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
dummy unit 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When the drum replacement mode is enabled, it becomes disabled
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. automatically after execution.
When the drum replacement mode is enabled, it becomes disabled Caution Use a Drum Unit that is not close to the end of life as a dummy unit.
automatically after execution. When using a Drum Unit that is close to the end of life, it affects the
Caution Use a Drum Unit that is not close to the end of life as a dummy unit. life of developer, etc.
When using a Drum Unit that is close to the end of life, it affects the Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
life of developer, etc. 0: Disabled (Not executed), 1: Enabled (Executed)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 0
0: Disabled (Not executed), 1: Enabled (Executed) Required time Approx. 2 minutes
Default value 0 Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DRM-RSET, DRMRSETY,
Required time Approx. 2 minutes DRMRSETC, DRMRSETK
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DRM-RSET, DRMRSETM,
DRMRSETC, DRMRSETK

8-143
8
8
8-144
COPIER>FUNCTION>DPC COPIER>FUNCTION>DPC
DRMRSETC Forcible exe of C Drum replacement mode DRMRSETK Forcible exe of Bk Drum replacement mode
Lv.1 Details When replacement of Drum Unit is completed within 30 minutes, Lv.1 Details When replacement of Drum Unit is completed within 30 minutes,
warm-up rotation may not be executed at power-off/on because of warm-up rotation may not be executed at power-off/on because of
high fixing temperature. In such cases, drum potential becomes high fixing temperature. In such cases, drum potential becomes
unstable, causing an image failure to occur. To prevent this symptom, unstable, causing an image failure to occur. To prevent this symptom,
this item forcibly executes the same operation as warm-up rotation. this item forcibly executes the same operation as warm-up rotation.
At this time, laser power values, etc., that were corrected according At this time, laser power values, etc., that were corrected according
to C drum counter, total charging time, target Vd values for potential to Bk drum counter, total charging time, target Vd values for potential
control and drum durability are reset. control and drum durability are reset.
Use case - When detection of the Drum Unit replacement has failed Use case - When detection of the Drum Unit replacement has failed
- When the Drum Unit used in other machine for a while is used as a - When the Drum Unit used in other machine for a while is used as a
dummy unit dummy unit
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
When the drum replacement mode is enabled, it becomes disabled When the drum replacement mode is enabled, it becomes disabled
automatically after execution. automatically after execution.
Caution Use a Drum Unit that is not close to the end of life as a dummy unit. Caution Use a Drum Unit that is not close to the end of life as a dummy unit.
When using a Drum Unit that is close to the end of life, it affects the When using a Drum Unit that is close to the end of life, it affects the
life of developer, etc. life of developer, etc.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Disabled (Not executed), 1: Enabled (Executed) 0: Disabled (Not executed), 1: Enabled (Executed)
Default value 0 Default value 0
Required time Approx. 2 minutes Required time Approx. 2 minutes
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DRM-RSET, DRMRSETY, Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> DPC> DRM-RSET, DRMRSETY,
DRMRSETM, DRMRSETK DRMRSETM, DRMRSETC
T-8-37

8-144
8
8
8-145
■■CST ■■CLEANING
COPIER>FUNCTION>CST COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEANING
MF-A4R Reg Multi-purpose Tray A4R stdrd width DEVL-CLN Cleaning of Developing Assembly
Lv.1 Details To register the standard value of A4R paper width (210mm) on the Lv.1 Details To clean the Developing Assembly by forcibly consuming the
Multi-purpose Tray. deteriorated toner.
Make a fine adjustment by COPIER> ADJUST> CST-ADJ> MF-A4R. It is executed by the user’s system administrator.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set A4R paper on the Multi-purpose Tray, and set the guide so Use case When light density, etc. occurs after operating the machine in a low
that it fits the paper width. duty and high humidity environment for a long period of time
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
The value is registered after automatic adjustment. Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When the operation finished normally:
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 OK!
Default value 0 2TR-CLN Clean of Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CST-ADJ> MF-A4R Lv.1 Details To clean paper dust adhered on the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller.
MF-A6R Reg Multi-purpose Tray A6R stdrd width Both the Primary Transfer Roller and the Secondary Transfer Outer
Lv.1 Details To register the standard value of A6R paper width (105 mm) on the Roller are engaged to the ITB.
Multi-purpose Tray. The Process Unit does operation that is the same at image
Make a fine adjustment by COPIER> ADJUST> CST-ADJ> MF-A6R. formation. It forms 4 toner bands which the 4 colors are laid on top of
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set A6R paper on the Multi-purpose Tray, and set the guide so another on the ITB.
that it fits the paper width. The base voltage (Vb) calculated with the Secondary Transfer ATVC
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. control is applied to the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller until the
The value is registered after automatic adjustment. toner bands pass through, so that toner is adhered on the Secondary
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Transfer Outer Roller.
Default value 0 After the toner bands passed, Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
cleaning control is executed (positive/reverse bias is applied every 2
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CST-ADJ> MF-A6R
rotations of the roller). Toner is adhered on the ITB.
MF-A4 Reg Multi-purpose Tray A4 standard width
When the toner adhered on the ITB passed through the ITB Cleaning
Lv.1 Details To register the standard value of A4 paper width (297 mm) on the
Unit, the operation is stopped.
Multi-purpose Tray.
Make a fine adjustment by COPIER> ADJUST> CST-ADJ> MF-A4.
Use case - When the back side of the sheet is soiled by the Secondary
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set A4 paper on the Multi-purpose Tray, and set the guide so that
Transfer Outer Roller
it fits the paper width.
- When contacting with the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller at the
2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
time of jam processing, etc.
The value is registered after automatic adjustment.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When the operation finished normally:
Default value 0
OK!
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CST-ADJ> MF-A4
Default value 0
T-8-38
TNR-COAT Exe toner coating mode to Sec Trns Roll
Lv.1 Details When using a new Secondary Transfer Outer Roller, material on
the surface of the roller scrapes against the ITB and adheres on it,
causing an white spot image.
With the toner coating mode, the ITB is cleaned by coating the
Secondary Transfer Outer Roller with toner, and removing the
material adhered on the ITB with the toner.
Use case When replacing the Secondary Transfer Outer Roller
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When the operation finished normally:
OK!
T-8-39

8-145
8
8
8-146
■■FIXING
COPIER>FUNCTION>FIXING
NIP-CHK Check of fixing nip width
Lv.1 Details To check whether the fixing nip width is appropriate by printing.
If it is not appropriate, a fixing failure may occur.
Use case - When replacing the fixing-related parts (Fixing Film, Pressure
Roller)
- When a fixing failure occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set A4/LTR plain paper (75 to 90g/m2) on the main unit deck.
2) Select the cassette, and then press OK key.
Printing is started, and a sheet is automatically stopped at the fixing
nip (10 seconds) and then is automatically delivered.
3) Measure the nip width.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When the operation finished normally:
OK!
Appropriate target value Center: 15.5 +/- 1mm, Edge: 17.5 +/- 1mm
T-8-40

8-146
8
8
8-147
■■PANEL ■■PART-CHK
COPIER>FUNCTION>PANEL COPIER>FUNCTION>PART-CHK
LCD-CHK Check of LCD Panel dot missing CL Specification of operation Clutch
Lv.1 Details To check whether there is a missing dot on the LCD Panel of the Lv.1 Details To specify the clutch to operate.
Control Panel. Use case When replacing the Clutch/checking the operation
Use case When replacing the LCD Panel Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 1 to 5
2) Check that the LCD Panel lights up in the order of white, black, 1: Multi-purpose Pickup Clutch (CL1)
red, green and blue. 2: Toner Supply Clutch (Y) (CL2)
3) Press STOP key to terminate checking. 3: Toner Supply Clutch (M) (CL3)
LED-CHK Check of Control Panel LED 4: Toner Supply Clutch (C) (CL4)
Lv.1 Details To check whether the LED on the Control Panel lights up. 5: Toner Supply Clutch (Bk) (CL5)
Use case When replacing the LCD Panel Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key. Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> PART-CHK> CL-ON
2) Check that the LED lights up in the order. CL-ON Operation check of Clutch
3) Terminate checking with LED-OFF. Lv.1 Details To start operation of the clutch specified with CL.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> PANEL> LED-OFF During operation, ON/OFF is repeated with an interval of 3 seconds.
LED-OFF End check of Control Panel LED Use case When replacing the Clutch/checking the operation
Lv.1 Details To terminate checking of the LED on the Control Panel. Adj/set/operate method 1) Drive the ITB and Drum (COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> MAIN-
Use case During execution of LED-CHK DRV).
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. 2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> PANEL> LED-CHK 3) Check the gear of the Transfer Cleaning Assembly.
KEY-CHK Check of key entry Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Lv.1 Details To check the key input on the Control Panel. Default value 0
Use case When replacing the LCD Panel Required time Approx. 1 minute
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item and press the key on the Control Panel. Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> MAIN-DRV
2) Check that the input value is displayed. COPIER> FUNCTION> PART-CHK> CL
3) Release the selection to terminate checking. Supplement/memo Remove the Inner Cover so that the Clutch can be checked visually.
TOUCHCHK Adj of coordinate pstn of Touch Panel FAN Specification of operation Fan
Lv.1 Details To adjust the coordinate position on the Touch Panel of the Control Lv.1 Details To specify the Fan to operate.
Panel. Use case When replacing the Fan/checking the operation
Use case When replacing the LCD Panel Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 1 to 10
2) Press the 9 “+” in sequence. 1: Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 1 (FM1)
T-8-41 2: Fixing Heat Exhaust Fan 2 (FM2)
3: Not used
4: Process Cartridge Fan (Rear) (FM4)
5: Fixing Cooling Fan (Front) (FM5)
6: Fixing Cooling Fan (Rear) (FM6)
7: Delivery Fan 1 (FM7)
8: Secondary Transfer Exhaust Fan (FM8)
9: Delivery Fan 2 (FM9)
10: Process Cartridge Fan (Front) (FM10)
Default value 1
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> PART-CHK> FAN-ON

8-147
8
8
8-148
COPIER>FUNCTION>PART-CHK COPIER>FUNCTION>PART-CHK
FAN-ON Operation check of Fan MTR Specification of operation Motor
Lv.1 Details To start operation check of the Fan specified by FAN. Lv.1 Details To specify the Motor to operate.
Use case When replacing the Fan/checking the operation Use case When replacing the Motor/checking the operation
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! Caution Do not operate M1 to M8 and M13 (* asterisk) unless they are
Required time 1 minute necessary.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> PART-CHK> FAN Display/adj/set range 1 to 28
1: Image skew correction motor (Y) (M31) *1
2: Image skew correction motor (M) (M32)
3: Image skew correction motor (C) (M33)
4: Image skew correction motor (Bk) (M34)
5: Developing motor (Y) (M5)
6: Developing motor (M) (M6)
7: Developing motor (C) (M7)
8: Developing motor (Bk) (M8)
9: Toner container motor (Y) (M9)
10: Toner container motor (M) (M10)
11: Toner container motor (C) (M11)
12: Toner container motor (Bk) (M12)
13: Drum motors for all colors (M1 to M4), ITB motor (M13) *4
14: ITB displacement control motor (M14) *2
15: Primary transfer separation motor (M15) *3
16: Cassette 1 pickup motor (M16)
17: Cassette 2 pickup motor (M17)
18: Multi-purpose motor (M18)
19: Registration motor (M19)
20: Multi-purpose feed motor (M20)
21: Fixing motor (M21) *2
22: Fixing delivery motor (M22)
23: First & Second delivery motor (M23)
24: Reverse roller motor (M24)
25: Third delivery motor (M25)
26: Waste toner stirring motor (M26)
27: Shutter motor (M27) *3
28: Laser shutter motor (M28) *3

*1: Do not use this because it is the reference for operation of other
motors.
*2: Do not use this; otherwise, it may cause damage.
*3: Installation/uninstallation only. (If it is operated, it may cause
damage.)
*4: The 5 motors operate simultaneously.
Default value 1
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> PART-CHK> MTR-ON

8-148
8
8
8-149
COPIER>FUNCTION>PART-CHK ■■CLEAR
MTR-ON Operation check of Motor
Lv.1 Details To start operation check of the Motor specified by MTR.
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR
The operation automatically stops after operation of 5 seconds. ERR Clear of error code
Use case When replacing the Motor/checking the operation Lv.1 Details To clear error codes (E000, E001, E002, E003, E717, E719).
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Use case At error occurrence
Caution While the Toner Container Drive Motor is active, be sure to remove Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
the Toner Container. Otherwise, toner leakage may occur in the 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
machine. DC-CON RAM clear of DC Controller PCB
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! Lv.1 Details To clear the RAM data of the DC Controller PCB.
Required time 1 minute Use case When clearing the RAM data of the DC Controller PCB
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> PART-CHK> MTR Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
SL Specification of operation Solenoid 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To specify the Solenoid to operate. Caution - Before execution of this item, be sure to output the service mode
Use case When replacing the Solenoid/checking the operation setting values by P-PRINT. After execution, enter necessary setting
values.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
- The RAM data is cleared after the main power switch is turned
Display/adj/set range 1 to 7
OFF/ON.
1: Registration Shutter Solenoid (SL1)
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> P-PRINT
2: Cassette 1 Pickup Solenoid (SL2)
3: Cassette 2 Pickup Solenoid (SL3) R-CON RAM clear of Reader Controller PCB
4: Multi-purpose Tray Lifting Solenoid (SL4) Lv.1 Details To clear the RAM data of the Reader Controller PCB.
5: First Delivery Flapper Solenoid (SL5) Use case When clearing the RAM data of the Reader Controller PCB
6: Second Delivery Flapper Solenoid (SL6) Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
7: Third Delivery Flapper Solenoid (SL7) 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 1 Caution - Before execution of this item, be sure to output the service mode
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> PART-CHK> SL-ON setting values by P-PRINT. After execution, enter necessary setting
SL-ON Operation check of Solenoid values.
Lv.1 Details To start operation check for the Solenoid specified by SL. - The RAM data is cleared after the main power switch is turned
The operation stops after “ON for 0.5 sec” => “OFF for 10 sec” => “ON OFF/ON.
for 0.5 sec” => “OFF for 10 sec” => “ON for 0.5 sec”. Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> P-PRINT
Use case When replacing the Solenoid/checking the operation JAM-HIST Clear of jam history
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Lv.1 Details To clear the jam history.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! Use case When clearing the jam history
Required time 1 minute Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> PART-CHK> SL ERR-HIST Clear of error code history
T-8-42
Lv.1 Details To clear the error code history.
Use case When clearing the error code history
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
PWD-CLR Clear of system administrator password
Lv.1 Details To clear the password of the system administrator set in the user
mode.
Use case When clearing the password of the system administrator
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.

8-149
8
8
8-150
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR
ADRS-BK Clear of address book MN-CON RAM clear of MNCON PCB SRAM Board
Lv.1 Details To clear the address book data. Lv.1 Details To clear the RAM data of the Main Controller PCB SRAM Board.
Use case When clearing the address book data All data on the SRAM Board is initialized.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key. Use case When clearing the RAM data of the Main Controller PCB SRAM
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Board
Caution The address book data is cleared after the main power switch is Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
turned OFF/ON. The machine is automatically rebooted.
CNT-MCON Clear of Main Controller service counter 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To clear the service counter counted by the Main Controller PCB. Caution - Inform the user that all images in Inbox will be deleted and get
Use case When clearing the service counter counted by the Main Controller approval for it.
PCB - Since the file management information is initialized, images on the
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. HDD cannot be read.
- Before execution of this item, be sure to output the service mode
Related service mode COPIER> COUNTER
setting values by P-PRINT. After execution, enter necessary setting
Supplement/memo See COUNTER for the target counter.
values.
CNT-DCON Clear of DC Controller service counter
- The RAM data is cleared after the main power switch is turned
Lv.1 Details To clear the service counter counted by the DC Controller PCB. OFF/ON.
Use case When clearing the service counter counted by the DC Controller Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> P-PRINT
PCB
CARD Clear of card ID-related data
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To clear the data related to the card ID (department).
OPTION Clear of service mode setting VL(OPTION)
Use case When clearing the data related to the card ID
Lv.1 Details To return the value specified in service mode (OPTION) to the default
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
value (value at the time of RAM clear).
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution The value is cleared after the main power switch is turned OFF/ON.
Caution - Before execution of this item, be sure to output the service mode
setting values by P-PRINT. After execution, enter necessary setting
values.
- This item is executed for the data on the Main Controller PCB, DC
Controller PCB and Reader Controller PCB.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> P-PRINT
MMI Clear of user mode setting value
Lv.1 Details To clear the user mode setting values (excluding values for Control
Panel, common settings, and FAX).
- Common Settings
- Timer Settings
- Adjustment/Cleaning
- Report Settings
- System Settings
- Copy Settings
- Communications Settings
- Printer Settings
Use case When clearing various setting values of user mode
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution The setting value is cleared after the main power switch is turned
OFF/ON.

8-150
8
8
8-151
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR
CA-KEY Deletion of CA certificate and key pair KEY-CLR Encrypt key clear of HDD Encrypt Board
Lv.2 Details To simultaneously delete the CA certificate and key pair which are Lv.2 Details To clear the encryption key of the HDD Encryption Board (Security
additionally registered by the user. Kit) for replacement.
Use case When a service person replaces/discards the device Processing is executed at the time of replacement of the encryption
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key. board, and a new encryption key is generated.
2) Check that OK is displayed. Use case When replacing the encryption key for the HDD Encryption Board
3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution - Unless this item is executed at the time of replacement/discard 2) Check that OK is displayed.
of the device, the CA certificate and key pair which are additionally 3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
registered by the user remain in the HDD, which is a problem in Caution Since all data in the HDD becomes unavailable when executing this
terms of security. item, be sure to initialize the HDD after turning OFF/ON the main
- Do not execute this item carelessly because the CA certificate power switch.
and key pair which are additionally registered are deleted when Display/adj/set range At normal termination: OK, At abnormal termination: NG
it is executed. If they are deleted mistakenly, they need to be REG-CLR Clear of image position correction value
again registered by the user. If no CA certificate and key pair are Lv.2 Details To clear the value when the correction value that is adjusted by
additionally registered, the machine condition becomes the same as image position correction control becomes a faulty value due to
the one at the time of factory shipment. some reasons.
- When NG is displayed in 2), there is a possibility that deletion was When color displacement cannot be corrected by image position
not executed. In this case, surely execute the deletion by initializing correction control, clear the correction value and turn OFF/ON the
the HDD, etc. machine or execute “Quick Adjust” in user mode so that image
Display/adj/set range At normal termination: OK, At abnormal termination: NG position correction is executed again.
Supplement/memo - The CA certificate is used in the MEAP application with E-RDS and When a correction failure occurs in an oblique direction, use
SSL client connection, and the key pair is used in the SSL function of “COPIER> FUNCTION> LASER> LD-ADJ-Y, LD-ADJ-M, LD-ADJ-C”
IPP, RUI and MEAP. at the same time.
- When the main power switch is turned OFF/ON, the CA certificate Use case - When color displacement cannot be corrected by image position
and key pair which were registered at the time of factory shipment correction control
are decompressed from the archive (/BOOTDEV/KCMNG), and - When a failure occurs in correction in an oblique direction
become available in the E-RDS/SSL function. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
ERDS-DAT Initialization of E-RDS SRAM data Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> LASER> LD-ADJ-Y, LD-ADJ-M, LD-ADJ-C
Lv.1 Details To initialize the SCM value of the Embedded-RDS stored in the Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
SRAM. Gradation > Quick Adjust
SCM values are ON/OFF of E-RDS, server’s port number, server’s USBM-CLR Initialize USB MEAP priority rgst info
SOAP URL, and communication schedule with the server (how often
Lv.1 Details To initialize the registered ID data retained in the OS field by calling
the data is acquired), etc.
the API provided by the OS.
The value set by COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> E-RDS, RGW-
Use case When a failure occurs in USB MEAP priority registration
PORT, RGW-ADR, COM-LOG is cleared.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Use case When upgrading the Bootable in the E-RDS environment
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution The method of using the SRAM in E-RDS differs depending on the
Bootable version. Therefore, unless the SRAM data is cleared at the
time of version upgrade, data inconsistency occurs.
Display/adj/set range At normal termination: OK, At abnormal termination: NG
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> INSTALL> E-RDS, RGW-PORT, RGW-ADR,
COM-LOG

8-151
8
8
8-152
COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR COPIER>FUNCTION>CLEAR
1TR-CLR Primary transfer ATVC log clear LANG-CLR Uninstallation of language files
Lv.2 Details To clear the log information of test voltage value and detection Lv.2 Details To uninstall the language files other than English file.
current value at primary transfer paper interval ATVC control. When rebooting the machine after execution, language files other
Image error occurs if there is a problem in log information which than English file are deleted, and language displayed on the screen
is referred at primary transfer paper interval ATVC control. When becomes English.
the value of current (COPIER> DISPLAY> HV-STS> 1ATVC-Y/M/ Use case When uninstalling language files
C/K4) flown to Primary Transfer Roller has an error, clear the log Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
information, so that the test voltage of the initial setting is applied at 2) Reboot the machine.
the primary transfer paper interval ATVC control. T-8-43
Use case When clearing the log of primary transfer paper interval ATVC control
at the time of image error due to primary transfer
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: During operation, 1: Termination
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> HV-STS> 1ATVC-Y/M/C/K4
COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> 2TR-CLR
2TR-CLR Secondary transfer ATVC log clear
Lv.2 Details To clear the log information of test voltage value and detection
current value at secondary transfer ATVC control.
Image error occurs if there is a problem in log information which
is referred at secondary transfer ATVC control. When the value of
current (COPIER> DISPLAY> HV-STS> 2ATVC) flown to Secondary
Transfer Outer Roller has an error, clear the log information, so
that the test voltage of the initial setting is applied at the secondary
transfer ATVC control.
Use case When clearing the log of secondary transfer ATVC control at the time
of image error due to secondary transfer
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: During operation, 1: Termination
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> HV-STS> 2ATVC
COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> 1TR-CLR
JV-CACHE Cache clear of JAVA application
Lv.1 Details To clear the cache information used by JAVA application.
Use case When initializing the JAVA application
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
FXTX-CLR Clearing fax job information
Lv.1 Details To clear fax job information stored on SRAM.
Use this mode to restore from E611-0001.
Use case When E611-0001 occurs
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.

8-152
8
8
8-153
■■MISC-R COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R
1PCLBSET DADF 2 faces color differ crrct ref side
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R Lv.1 Details To set which side of the front or back side should be the reference
SCANLAMP Light-up check of LED side when correcting a color difference at the time of duplex stream
Lv.1 Details To light up the LED for 3 seconds. reading.
Use case When replacing the LED The correction result is reflected after executing the following
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. operation: specify the reference side, execute a series of color
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! difference correction processing, and then turn OFF/ON the power.
Required time 3 seconds Use case Before starting correction of color difference in DADF duplex printing
1PSCLB-A DADF 2 faces color differ crrct (front) Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To acquire scanning data on the front side in order to correct the Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
color difference between the front and back side at the time of duplex 0: N/A, 1: Front side, 2: Back side
stream reading. Default value 0
A significant color difference may occur between the front and back 1PCLBUDR DADF 2 faces clr differ crrct lowr limit
side of the image scanned on DADF caused by variations in the light Lv.1 Details Colors which do not need to be corrected are sometimes corrected
source of the lamp and changes in durability. Such a color difference as a result of correction of color difference in duplex stream reading.
is corrected by executing 1PSCLB-B following 1PSCLB-A. To keep colors which do not need to be corrected, the correction
Use case When a significant color difference occurs between the front and amount is adjusted so that the effect of correction is weakened.
back side caused by variations in the light source of the lamp and The result is reflected when correction of color difference is executed
changes in durability again after the setting is made.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set paper on DADF. When “1: ON” is specified, unnecessary correction is not executed,
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. but an expected effect may not be obtained for other colors.
Caution Be sure not to turn OFF/ON the power after OK is displayed by Use case If the color difference occurs on the colors which didn’t have any
1PSCLB-A. difference before correction, adjust the correction amount before
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! executing the color difference correction again.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-R> 1PSCLB-B, 1PCLBRST Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
1PSCLB-B DADF 2 faces color differ crrct (back) Caution Expected correction result may not be obtained.
Lv.1 Details To acquire scanning data on the back side in order to correct the Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
color difference between the front and back side at the time of duplex 0: OFF, 1: ON
stream reading. Default value 0
A significant color difference may occur between the front and back 1PCLBOVR DADF 2 faces clr differ crrct upr limit
side of the image scanned on DADF caused by variations in the light Lv.1 Details Excessive correction is sometimes made when correcting color
source of the lamp and changes in durability. Such a color difference difference in duplex stream reading.
is corrected by executing 1PSCLB-B following 1PSCLB-A. To control excessive correction, adjust the correction amount to
Use case When a significant color difference occurs between the front and weaken the effect of correction.
back side caused by variations in the light source of the lamp and The result is reflected when correction of color difference is executed
changes in durability again after the setting is made.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set the document used by 1PSCLB-A on DADF, so that the front When “1: Weak control” or “2: Strong control” is specified, excessive
side is faced down and the cyan image is placed at the left rear side. correction is not made, but an expected effect may not be obtained
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. for other colors.
Caution Be sure not to turn OFF/ON the power after OK is displayed by Use case If the color difference occurs on the colors which didn’t have any
1PSCLB-A. difference before correction, adjust the correction amount before
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! executing the color difference correction again.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-R> 1PSCLB-A, 1PCLBRST Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution Expected correction result may not be obtained.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
0: No control, 1: Weak control, 2: Strong control

8-153
8
8
8-154
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R
CLM-PLTN Sampling of color copyboard read MTF VL CLM-DF1 Sampling of clr front stream read MTF VL
Lv.1 Details The MTF value for the Reader Unit is sometimes displaced from the Lv.1 Details The MTF value for the Reader Unit is sometimes displaced from the
factory setting value depending on the condition at transportation/ factory setting value depending on the condition at transportation/
storage. If the machine is installed without correcting the value, it storage. If the machine is installed without correcting the value, it
may cause an image failure such as moire. Therefore, it is necessary may cause an image failure such as moire. Therefore, it is necessary
to readjust the MTF value by reading the MTF adjustment chart at to readjust the MTF value by reading the MTF adjustment chart at
installation. installation.
When color copyboard reading is performed, the controller performs When color front side stream reading is performed, the controller
sampling of the MTF value. This value is set in COPIER> ADJUST> performs sampling of the MTF value. This value is set in COPIER>
CCD> MTF2-Mx, MTF2-Sx. ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-Mx, MTF2-Sx.
Use case At installation Use case At installation
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set the MTF chart on the copyboard glass. Adj/set/operate method 1) Set the MTF chart on the ADF.
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. 2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! 3) Perform color front side stream reading with the MTF chart set on
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-M1 to 12, MTF2-S1 to 12 the ADF. (CLM-DF1)
BWM-PLTN Sampling of B&W copyboard read MTF value Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Lv.1 Details The MTF value for the Reader Unit is sometimes displaced from the Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-M1 to 12, MTF2-S1 to 12
factory setting value depending on the condition at transportation/ BWM-DF1 Sampling of B&W front stream read MTF VL
storage. If the machine is installed without correcting the value, it Lv.1 Details The MTF value for the Reader Unit is sometimes displaced from the
may cause an image failure such as moire. Therefore, it is necessary factory setting value depending on the condition at transportation/
to readjust the MTF value by reading the MTF adjustment chart at storage. If the machine is installed without correcting the value, it
installation. may cause an image failure such as moire. Therefore, it is necessary
When B&W copyboard reading is performed, the controller performs to readjust the MTF value by reading the MTF adjustment chart at
sampling of the MTF value. This value is set in COPIER> ADJUST> installation.
CCD> MTF2-Mx, MTF2-Sx. When B&W front side stream reading is performed, the controller
Use case At installation performs sampling of the MTF value. This value is set in COPIER>
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set the MTF chart on the copyboard glass. ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-Mx, MTF2-Sx.
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. Use case At installation
Adj/set/operate method 1) Set the MTF chart on the ADF.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! 2) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-M1to 12, MTF2-S1 to 12 3) Perform B&W front side stream reading with the MTF chart set on
the ADF. (BWM-DF1)
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-M1 to 12, MTF2-S1 to 12

8-154
8
8
8-155
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R
CLM-DF2 Sampling color back stream read MTF VL CLPLT-EN Color copyboard read MTF VL initial set
Lv.1 Details The MTF value for the Reader Unit is sometimes displaced from the Lv.1 Details To return the MTF value for color copyboard reading to the factory
factory setting value depending on the condition at transportation/ setting value.
storage. If the machine is installed without correcting the value, it Since overwriting is performed with the backup data retained in the
may cause an image failure such as moire. Therefore, it is necessary Reader Controller PCB, the MTF value obtained by sampling of the
to readjust the MTF value by reading the MTF adjustment chart at MTF chart becomes disabled.
installation. When CLM-PLTN is executed, the value is automatically set to 1.
When color back side stream reading is performed, the controller When the value is set to 0, the value adjusted with CLM-PLTN
performs sampling of the MTF value. The MTF value is set in MTF- becomes disabled and returned to the factory setting value.
Mx, MTF-Sx. Use case When returning the MTF value to the initial setting value upon user’s
Use case At installation request in case that a sufficient quality level cannot be obtained on
Adj/set/operate method 1) Perform color back side stream reading with the MTF chart set on the front side of a color image even performing a fine adjustment
the ADF. (CLM-DF2) with CLM-TGT after adjusting the MTF value with CLM-PLTN.
2) Set the MTF chart on the ADF. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
3) Select the item, and then press OK key. Caution The MTF value obtained by reading the MTF chart becomes
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! disabled.
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF-M1 to 12, MTF-S1 to 12 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
BWM-DF2 Sampling B&W back stream read MTF value 0: Factory setting value, 1: Adjustment value at installation
Lv.1 Details The MTF value for the Reader Unit is sometimes displaced from the Required time Approx. 1 minute
factory setting value depending on the condition at transportation/ Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-R> CLM-PLTN, CLM-TGT
storage. If the machine is installed without correcting the value, it COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-M1 to 12, MTF2-S1 to 12
may cause an image failure such as moire. Therefore, it is necessary BWPLT-EN B&W copyboard read MTF value initial set
to readjust the MTF value by reading the MTF adjustment chart at Lv.1 Details To return the MTF value for B&W copyboard reading to the factory
installation. setting value.
When B&W back side stream reading is performed, the controller Since overwriting is performed with the backup data retained in the
performs sampling of the MTF value. The MTF value is set in MTF- Reader Controller PCB, the MTF value obtained by sampling of the
Mx, MTF-Sx. MTF chart becomes disabled.
Use case At installation When BWM-PLTN is executed, the value is automatically set to 1.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Perform B&W back side stream reading with the MTF chart set on When the value is set to 0, the value adjusted with BWM-PLTN
the ADF. (BWM-DF2) becomes disabled and returned to the factory setting value.
3) Set the MTF chart on the ADF. Use case When returning the MTF value to the initial setting value upon user’s
4) Select the item, and then press OK key. request in case that a sufficient quality level cannot be obtained on
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! the front side of a B&W image even performing a fine adjustment
Related service mode COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF-M1 to 12, MTF-S1 to 12 with BWM-TGT after adjusting the MTF value with BWM-PLTN.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution The MTF value obtained by reading the MTF chart becomes
disabled.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Factory setting value, 1: Adjustment value at installation
Required time Approx. 1 minute
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-R> BWM-PLTN, BWM-TGT
COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-M1 to 12, MTF2-S1 to 12

8-155
8
8
8-156
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R
CLDF1-EN Clr front stream read MTF VL initial set CLDF2-EN Clr back stream read MTF VL initial set
Lv.1 Details To return the MTF value for color front side stream reading to the Lv.1 Details To return the MTF value for color back side stream reading to the
factory setting value. factory setting value.
Since overwriting is performed with the backup data retained in the Since overwriting is performed with the backup data retained in the
Reader Controller PCB, the MTF value obtained by sampling of the Reader Controller PCB, the MTF value obtained by sampling of the
MTF chart becomes disabled. MTF chart becomes disabled.
When CLM-DF1 is executed, the value is automatically set to 1. When CLM-DF2 is executed, the value is automatically set to 1.
When the value is set to 0, the value adjusted with CLM-DF1 When the value is set to 0, the value adjusted with CLM-DF2
becomes disabled and returned to the factory setting value. becomes disabled and returned to the factory setting value.
Use case When returning the MTF value to the initial setting value upon user’s Use case When returning the MTF value to the initial setting value upon user’s
request in case that a sufficient quality level cannot be obtained on request in case that a sufficient quality level cannot be obtained on
the front side of a color image even performing a fine adjustment the back side of a color image even performing a fine adjustment
with CLM-TGT after adjusting the MTF value with CLM-DF1. with CLM-TGT after adjusting the MTF value with CLM-DF2.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution The MTF value obtained by reading the MTF chart becomes Caution The MTF value obtained by reading the MTF chart becomes
disabled. disabled.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Factory setting value, 1: Adjustment value at installation 0: Factory setting value, 1: Adjustment value at installation
Required time Approx. 1 minute Required time Approx. 1 minute
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-R> CLM-DF1, CLM-TGT Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-R> CLM-DF2, CLM-TGT
COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-M1 to 12, MTF2-S1 to 12 COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF-M1 to 12, MTF-S1 to 12
BWDF1-EN B&W front stream read MTF VL initial set BWDF2-EN B&W back stream read MTF VL initial set
Lv.1 Details To return the MTF value for B&W front side stream reading to the Lv.1 Details To return the MTF value for B&W back side stream reading to the
factory setting value. factory setting value.
Since overwriting is performed with the backup data retained in the Since overwriting is performed with the backup data retained in the
Reader Controller PCB, the MTF value obtained by sampling of the Reader Controller PCB, the MTF value obtained by sampling of the
MTF chart becomes disabled. MTF chart becomes disabled.
When BWM-DF1 is executed, the value is automatically set to 1. When BWM-DF2 is executed, the value is automatically set to 1.
When the value is set to 0, the value adjusted with BWM-DF1 When the value is set to 0, the value adjusted with BWM-DF2
becomes disabled and returned to the factory setting value. becomes disabled and returned to the factory setting value.
Use case When returning the MTF value to the initial setting value upon user’s Use case When returning the MTF value to the initial setting value upon user’s
request in case that a sufficient quality level cannot be obtained on request in case that a sufficient quality level cannot be obtained on
the front side of a B&W image even performing a fine adjustment the back side of a B&W image even performing a fine adjustment
with BWM-TGT after adjusting the MTF value with BWM-DF1. with BWM-TGT after adjusting the MTF value with BWM-DF2.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution The MTF value obtained by reading the MTF chart becomes Caution The MTF value obtained by reading the MTF chart becomes
disabled. disabled.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Factory setting value, 1: Adjustment value at installation 0: Factory setting value, 1: Adjustment value at installation
Required time Approx. 1 minute Required time Approx. 1 minute
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-R> BWM-DF1, BWM-TGT Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-R> BWM-DF2, BWM-TGT
COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF2-M1 to 12, MTF2-S1 to 12 COPIER> ADJUST> CCD> MTF-M1 to 12, MTF-S1 to 12

8-156
8
8
8-157
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-R
CLM-TGT Fine adjustment of color MTF value RD-SHPOS Shift to fixed pstn of Reader Scan Unit
Lv.1 Details To perform the filter processing inside of the Reader Controller so Lv.2 Details Scanner Unit on the Reader side is shifted to the fixed position
that the MTF value measured by CLM-PLTN/CLM-DF1/CLM-DF2 before moving the machine.
becomes 55% or lower of the value. If the machine is moved after Reader is installed, the Scanner Unit
When 1 is specified, the MTF correction filter is calculated again, moves and it might cause damage. The damage is prevented by
and the MTF value becomes 50% or lower of the value (the image tightening the screws after the Scanner Unit is shifted to the specific
becomes foggy). The backed up MTF filter correction coefficient is position before the machine is moved.
updated. Use case When the machine is moved after Reader is installed
Use case When decreasing the MTF value (to make the image foggy) upon Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
user’s request (moire, incorrect judgment) Caution When the machine is moved after Reader is installed, be sure to shift
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. the Scanner Unit to the specific position to be fixed and then tighten
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 the screws. If the Scanner Unit is not fixed, it might cause damage
0: 55 % when the machine is moved.
1: 50 % (The image becomes foggy.) Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Required time a few seconds
Required time Approx. 2 minutes T-8-44
Supplement/memo The MTF value is set to 65% at the time of shipment.
BWM-TGT Fine adjustment of B&W MTF value
Lv.1 Details To perform the filter processing inside of the Reader Controller so
that the MTF value measured by BWM-PLTN/BWM-DF1/BWM-DF2
becomes 55% or lower of the value.
When 1 is specified, the MTF correction filter is calculated again,
and the MTF value becomes 50% or lower of the value (the image
becomes foggy). The backed up MTF filter correction coefficient is
updated.
Use case When decreasing the MTF value (to make the image foggy) upon
user’s request (moire, incorrect judgment)
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: 55 %
1: 50 % (The image becomes foggy.)
Default value 0
Required time Approx. 2 minutes
Supplement/memo The MTF value is set to 65% at the time of shipment.
SCANLMP2 Light-up check of LED Lamp Unit: back
Lv.1 Details To light up the LED Lamp Unit for back side, which is placed in the
ADF, and check whether there is a missing block or no lighting in
LED.
Use case When replacing the LED Lamp Unit for back side
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Required time Approx. 5 seconds

8-157
8
8
8-158
■■MISC-P COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-P
ENV-PRT Inside temp/hmdy & fix roller temp log
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-P Lv.1 Details To print the data of temperature and humidity in the machine/
P-PRINT Output of service mode setting value temperature of the surface of the Fixing Roller as logs.
Lv.1 Details To print the service mode setting value. Use case When grasping information of temperature in the machine/fixing
Use case Before executing the CLEAR service mode, etc. temperature for trouble analysis
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Required time Approx. 80 seconds Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Supplement/memo It takes approximately 15 seconds before printing starts. Required time Approx. 15 seconds
KEY-HIST Output of Ctrl Panel key entry history PJH-P-1 Detail info of print job history:100 job
Lv.1 Details To print the key input history on the Control Panel. Lv.1 Details To print the print job history for the latest 100 jobs with detailed
Use case When printing the key input history on the Control Panel information.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. In the case of less than 100 jobs, the history of all print jobs is
Required time Approx. 15 seconds printed.
HIST-PRT Output of jam and error history Use case When printing the print job history with detailed information
Lv.1 Details To print the jam history and error history. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Use case When printing the jam/error history Supplement/memo Output the print job history with detailed information which is
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. not displayed/printed in the job history screen under “System
Required time Approx. 15 seconds Monitor>Print>Log>Printer” and in the report of the print job history.
TRS-DATA Moving memory reception data to Inbox PJH-P-2 Detail info of print job history:all job
Lv.2 Details To move the data received in memory to Inbox. Lv.1 Details To print the history of all print jobs stored in the machine with detailed
Use case When moving the data received in memory to Inbox information (for maximum 5000 jobs).
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. The difference between PJH-P-1 and this item is only the number of
jobs printed.
USER-PRT Output of user mode list
Use case When printing the print job history with detailed information
Lv.1 Details To print the user mode list.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Use case When printing the user mode list
Supplement/memo Output the print job history with detailed information which is
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
not displayed/printed in the job history screen under “System
Required time Approx. 15 seconds
Monitor>Print>Log>Printer” and in the report of the print job history.
Supplement/memo It takes approximately 3 seconds before printing starts.
AT-IMG-X Exe img pstn crrct ctrl
LBL-PRNT Output of service label
Lv.1 Details To execute a series of operation of image position correction control
Lv.1 Details To print the service label.
at parts replacement.
Use case When printing the service label Image position correction control is usually executed by the printer
Adj/set/operate method 1) Place A4/LTR paper in Cassette 1. engine at the specified timing according to operating condition and
2) Select the item, and then press OK key. environmental variation.
Required time Approx. 60 seconds Use case - When removing the Drum Unit
Supplement/memo It takes approximately 15 seconds before printing starts. - When releasing the ITB pressure
D-PRINT Output of service mode (DISPLAY) Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To output items displayed by DISPLAY in the service mode . Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK!
Items output by P-PRINT, LBL-PRNT and HIST-PRT and ALARM are Required time Approx. 95 seconds
excluded. USBH-PRT Output of USB device information report
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Lv.1 Details To output information of the connected USB device in the form of a
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! report.
Required time Approx. 45 seconds

8-158
8
8
8-159
COPIER>FUNCTION>MISC-P ■■SYSTEM
ITB-INIT Initial adjustment of ITB Steering
Lv.1 Details To make initial adjustment of reference position for the ITB Steering
COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM
at initial installation or replacement of the ITB-related service parts. DOWNLOAD Shift to download mode
Use case - At installation Lv.1 Details To make the machine enter the download mode and wait for a
- When replacing the ITB-related service parts command.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Perform downloading by SST.
Caution Be sure to close all covers before execution. Use case At upgrade
Display/adj/set range In processing: ACTIVE, At normal termination: OK, At abnormal Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
termination: NG 2) Perform downloading by SST.
Required time Approx. 1 minute Caution Do not turn OFF the power before HOLD is displayed.
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> MISC> ITB-POS Display/adj/set range When waiting for a command: STAND-BY/STNDBY, In
communication: CONNECTED, Communication terminated: HOLD
T-8-45
Supplement/memo SST: Service Support Tool
CHK-TYPE Specify HD-CLEAR/HD-CHECK partition No.
Lv.1 Details To specify the partition number of the HDD to execute HD-CLEAR/
HD-CHECK.
Use case When executing HD-CLEAR/HD-CHECK
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
0: Entire HDD
1: Image accumulation area
2: Universal file storage area
3: PDL file storage area
4: Program file storage area
5: MEAP application
6: Address book transfer setting
7: MEAP storage data
8: System log storage area
9: Advanced Box area
10: Area for distribution server
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> HD-CLEAR, HD-CHECK
Supplement/memo Universal file: Management information of user setting data, various
log data, PDL spool data, and image data, etc.
HD-CHECK Entire HDD check and recovery
Lv.1 Details To check the entire HDD and execute recovery processing.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Caution Be sure to execute this item after CHK-TYPE.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 4
0: Sector check of the entire HDD and recovery
1: Image accumulation area
2: Universal file storage area
3: PDL file storage area
4. Program file storage area
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> CHK-TYPE

8-159
8
8
8-160
COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM COPIER>FUNCTION>SYSTEM
HD-CLEAR Initialization of specified partition DSRAMBUP Backup of DC Controller PCB SRAM
Lv.1 Details To initialize the HDD partition specified by CHK-TYPE. Lv.2 Details To back up the setting data in SRAM of the DC Controller PCB.
Use case When initializing the HDD partition Use case When replacing the DC Controller PCB for troubleshooting at the
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. time of trouble occurrence
Caution Be sure to execute this item after CHK-TYPE. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range Top 2 digits: Progress ratio (%, Returns to “00” at termination) Caution During operation, the setting data changes by manual or automatic
Last 2 digits: Result at termination (00: Normally finished, Others: adjustment. When backup data which has been left for a long period
Abnormally finished) of time is restored, it is overwritten by the old setting data and the
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> CHK-TYPE new data is deleted.
DEBUG-1 Setting of log type and save timing Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> DSRAMRES
Lv.2 Details To set the types of logs to be stored and the timing to store logs in DSRAMRES Restore of DC Controller PCB SRAM
the HDD. Lv.2 Details To restore the setting data which has been backed up in SRAM of
Logs are used to analyze the cause of a trouble. the DC Controller PCB.
Use case When analyzing the cause of a trouble Use case When replacing the DC Controller PCB for troubleshooting at the
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. time of trouble occurrence
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Change the setting value in accordance with the instructions from Caution During operation, the setting data changes by manual or automatic
the Quality Support Division. adjustment. When backup data which has been left for a long period
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 of time is restored, it is overwritten by the old setting data and the
0: Save PLOG at detection of Reboot/Exception new data is deleted.
1: Save PLOG at detection of Reboot/Exception/Encode Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> DSRAMBUP
2: Save SUBLOG at detection of Reboot/Exception/Encode RSRAMBUP Backup of Reader Controller PCB SRAM
3: Save SUBLOG in overwrite mode at detection of Reboot/ Lv.2 Details To back up the setting data in SRAM of the Reader Controller PCB.
Exception/Encode Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB for troubleshooting at the
Default value 3 time of trouble occurrence
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> DEBUG-2 (Level 2) Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Supplement/memo PLOG can be printed by COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> Caution During operation, the setting data changes by manual or automatic
DEBUG-2. adjustment. When backup data which has been left for a long period
SUBLOG cannot be printed. (It should be uploaded from SST/USB.) of time is restored, it is overwritten by the old setting data and the
DEBUG-2 Output of log saved on HDD new data is deleted.
Lv.2 Details To print the PLOG saved in HDD by COPIER> FUNCTION> Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> RSRAMRES
SYSTEM> DEBUG-1. (A4: Approx. 20 sheets) RSRAMRES Restore of Reader Controller PCB SRAM
SUBLOG is not printed. It should be uploaded from SST. Lv.2 Details To restore the setting data which has been backed up in SRAM of
Use case When printing PLOG the Reader Controller PCB.
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key. Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB for troubleshooting at the
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. time of trouble occurrence
Display/adj/set range During operation: ACTIVE, When operation finished normally: OK! Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> DEBUG-1 (Level 2) Caution During operation, the setting data changes by manual or automatic
adjustment. When backup data which has been left for a long period
of time is restored, it is overwritten with new setting data and the old
data is deleted.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> SYSTEM> RSRAMBUP
REBOOT Reboot of host machine
Lv.2 Details To reboot the host machine.
Use case For customization
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
T-8-46

8-160
8
8
8-161
OPTION COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
SENS-CNF Setting of original detection size
■■FNC-SW Lv.2 Details To set original detection size according to AB configuration/Inch
configuration/A configuration.
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW Select 1 (Inch configuration) for Inch configuration/A configuration
MODEL-SZ Fixed magnifictn & DADF orgnl dtct size machine.
Lv.1 Details To set the fixed magnification ratio display and the original detection Use case When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
size with DADF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
It is set automatically at the time of installation of the Reader 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
according to the location. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Use case Upon user’s request 0: AB configuration, 1: Inch configuration
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. CONFIG Set country/area/lang/location/ppr size
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 Lv.1 Details To set the country/region, language, location, paper size
0: AB configuration (6R5E) for Japan, 1: Inch configuration (5R4E) configuration for multiple system software in HDD.
for North/Middle/South America, 2: A configuration (3R3E) for Use case Upon user’s request
Europe, 3: AB/Inch configuration (6R5E) for Asia, Oceania, South Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the setting item.
America 2) Switch with +/- key, and then press OK key.
Default value The default differs according to the location. 3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
SCANSLCT ON/OFF of scan area calculate function Display/adj/set range XX YY.ZZ.AA
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of the function to calculate scanning area from the XX: Country/region
specified paper size. JP: Japan, US: United States, GB: England, FR: France, DE:
When the paper size is larger than the original size, selecting ON Germany, IT: Italia, AU: Australia, SG: Singapore, NL: Netherlands,
reduces productivity because the scanning area gets larger. KR: Korea, CN: China, TW: Taiwan, ES: Spain, SE: Sweden, PT:
Use case When matching the scanning area with the paper size Portugal, NO: Norway, DK: Denmark, FI: Finland, PL: Poland, HU:
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Hungary, CZ: Czech, SI: Slovenia, GR: Greek, EE: Estonia, RU:
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Russia, AD: Andorra, AL: Albania, AM: Armenia, AR: Argentine, AT:
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Austria, BA: Bosnia Herzegovina, BE: Belgium, BG: Bulgaria, BO:
0: OFF (calculated from the detected original size) Bolivia, BR: Brazil, CA: Canada, CH: Switzerland, CL: Chile, CY:
1: ON (calculated from the specified paper size) Cyprus, HR: Croatia, ID: Indonesia, IE: Ireland, IL: Israel, IN: India,
Default value 0 IS: Iseland, LU: Luxembourg, LV: Latvia, MX: Mexico, MY: Malaysia,
DH-SW ON/OFF of auto D-half control NZ: New Zealand, PE: Peru, PH: Philippine, PY: Paraguay, RO:
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of auto D-half control. Romania, SK: Slovakia, TH: Thailand, TR: Turkey, UA: Ukraine, UY:
Execution interval can be set by COPIER> OPTION> IMG-MCON> Uruguay, VE: Venezuela, VN: Vietnam
DH-TMG. YY: Language (fixed, e.g. ja: Japanese)
ZZ: Location (fixed, e.g. 00: CANON)
Use case - When D-half-related failure occurs/when identifying the cause of
AA: Paper size configuration (00: AB configuration, 01: Inch
D-half-related failure
configuration, 02: A configuration, 03: Inch/AB configuration)
- Upon user’s request
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> FNC-SW> MODEL-SZ
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Be sure to set the value back to 1 (ON) after servicing.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 1
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> IMG-MCON> DH-TMG

8-161
8
8
8-162
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
W/SCNR Setting of Reader Unit installation ORG-LDR Spcl ppr size set in DADF: LDR: Reader
Lv.1 Details To set installation of the Reader Unit. Lv.2 Details To set the size of special paper (LDR configuration) that cannot be
1 (installed) is automatically selected once the Reader Unit is recognized in DADF stream reading mode.
detected at the start of the machine. Use case - Upon user’s request
Use case When installing/removing the Reader Unit - When picking up special paper size original from DADF
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Caution For outside Japan only
0: Not installed, 1: Installed Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value According to the setting at shipment 0: LEDGER-R, 1: Argentine LETTER
ORG-LGL Special paper size set in DADF mode: LGL Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To set the size of special paper (LGL configuration) that cannot be ORG-B5 Special paper size set in DADF mode: B5
recognized in DADF stream reading mode. Lv.2 Details To set the size of special paper (B5) that cannot be recognized in
Use case - Upon user’s request DADF stream reading mode.
- When picking up special paper size original from DADF Use case - Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. - When picking up special paper size original from DADF
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 10 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: LEGAL-R, 1: FOOLSCAP-R, 2: OFICIO-R, 3: FOLIO-R, 4: Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Australian FOOLSCAP-R, 5: Ecuador OFICIO-R, 6: Bolivia 0: B5, 1: Korean government office paper
OFICIO-R, 7: Argentine OFICIO-R, 8: Argentine LEGAL-R, 9: Default value 0
Government LEGAL-R, 10: Mexico OFICIO-R INTROT-1 Set ini/last rotation auto adj exe intvl
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To set the paper interval to execute process auto adjustment (analog
ORG-LTR Special paper size set in DADF mode: LTR patch sequence, etc.) at initial/last rotation.
Lv.2 Details To set the size of special paper (LTR configuration) that cannot be As the value is incremented by 1, the interval is increased by 500
recognized in DADF stream reading mode. sheets. When 0 is specified, the control is not executed.
Use case - Upon user’s request Use case When matching the use environment of the user.
- When picking up special paper size original from DADF Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Caution Increasing the number of sheets (widening the interval) causes
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 higher frequency of image failure.
0: LETTER, 1: EXECUTIVE, 2: Argentine LETTER, 3: Government Display/adj/set range 50 to 1000
LETTER Unit 1 sheet
Default value 0 Default value 100
ORG-LTRR Spcl ppr size set in DADF: LTRR: Reader
Lv.2 Details To set the size of special paper (LTR-R configuration) that cannot be
recognized in DADF stream reading mode.
Use case - Upon user’s request
- When picking up special paper size original from DADF
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution For outside Japan only
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3
0: LTR-R, 1: G-LTR-R, 2: A-LTR-R, 3: EXECUTIVE-R
Default value 0

8-162
8
8
8-163
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
INTROT-2 Set of last rotation auto adj exe intvl MODELSZ2 Ppr size dtct global support in bookmode
Lv.1 Details To set the paper interval to execute auto adjustment (potential Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF for global support of document size detection in
control, patch potential control, D-max control, D-half control) at last copyboard reading mode.
rotation. Use case Upon user’s request (mixed media original with AB/Inch
As the value is incremented by 1, the paper interval is increased by 1 configuration)
sheet. When 0 is specified, the control is not executed. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When matching the use environment of the user. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Caution - Do not use this at the normal service.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. - The Document Size Sensor (Photo Sensor) is additionally required
Caution Increasing the number of sheets (widening the interval) causes to correctly detect the document size when the original consists of
higher frequency of image failure. mixed media (AB/Inch configuration).
Display/adj/set range 50 to 1000 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Unit 1 sheet 0: Detected with detection size according to location, 1: Detected
Default value 500 with AB/Inch mixed media.
INTROT-T Set of auto adjustment standby interval Default value 0
Lv.1 Details To set the continuous standby time until execution of auto DELV-FAN ON/OFF of condensation prevention mode
adjustment. Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of condensation control mode.
When the standby condition continues more than the specified time, When “1: ON” is set, internal and external temperatures are
the Photosensitive Drum starts idle rotation for 30 seconds. compared, and if needed, turn ON the Process Cartridge Fan (Front)
As the value is incremented by 1, the time gets 1 hour longer. (FM10).
The auto adjustment during standby is available when AUTO-DH is 1: Use case When condensation occurs
ON. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case - When image smear occurs 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
- When adjusting time for warm-up rotations or rotation to be Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
performed first time for the day 0: OFF, 1: ON
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. SVMD-ENT Setting of entry method to service mode
Caution If the value is too large, flip of the Drum Cleaning Blade may occur. Lv.2 Details To set the way to get in service mode to prevent information leak.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 10 Use case As needed
Unit 1 hour Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 2 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> IMG-DEV> AUTO-DH Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
BK-4CSW ON/OFF simple full clr mode at photomode 0: [Settings/Registration] - Pressing [2] and [8] at the same time -
Lv.2 Details 3.5mm pitch unevenness may occur when printing the solid black [Settings/Registration]
image with using B&W mode in Text/Photo Printout Mode. This is 1: [Settings/Registration] - Pressing [4] and [9] at the same time -
because the ITB slips due to the rotation speed difference between [Settings/Registration]
the ITB and the Photosensitive Drum. Default value 0
In such a case, set whether to use the simple full color mode that
creates black with using a small amount of Y, M and C toner.
In Text/Photo/Map Mode, it is printed in B&W mode.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0

8-163
8
8
8-164
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
FXWRNLVL Set Fixing Film life display thresholdVL ORG-A4R Special paper size set in DADF mode: A4R
Lv.2 Details To set the threshold value to display the life of Fixing Film. Lv.2 Details To set the size of special paper (A4R) that cannot be recognized in
This item is enabled when the value at the following is set to “1” DADF stream reading mode.
(default: 0): COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> FXMSG-SW (ON/OFF When picking up A4R size original from the DADF of the Inch/AB
of Fixing Assembly replacement message) configuration models, the size is converted into the specified size so
The life judgment counter is stored in the DC Controller. It is not that an image can be formed properly.
possible to change or check the counter value. Use case - Upon user’s request
Use case To prevent the fixing failure caused by the continuous use of Fixing - When picking up special paper size original from DADF
Film that exceeds the life. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 0: A4R, 1: FOLIO-R
0: Alarm message not displayed Default value 0
1: Alarm message displayed when the life judgment counter reaches PDF-RDCT PDF reduction set at forwarding
the specified value Lv.2 Details To set whether to reduce the image for transmission when converting
2, 3: Not used the image received by IFAX into PDF for e-mail/file transmission.
Default value 0 Use case Upon user’s request
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> FXMSG-SW Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
BASE-SW Model switch set from MEAP-Full to Base 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To switch from the MEAP-Full model to the Base model. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Switch this mode in the case of restricting the operation of MEAP 0: Following the current setting, 1: Image reduction
application for trouble analysis. Default value 0
Use case When trouble that caused by MEAP application occurs REBOOTSW Restart setting at E240 error occurrence
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.2 Details To set whether to reboot in the case of E240 error.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. In the case of E240 error, the machine is automatically rebooted due
Caution Switch from the Base model to the MEAP-Full model is not available. to the possibility of continuous operation of the drive system while
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 the spooled print job is cleared.
0: OFF (Base model), 1: ON (Full model) Print job can be obtained if selecting the setting not to reboot.
Default value Depending on the setting of option bit (MeapModelBIT). Use case Upon user’s request
KSIZE-SW Set of Chinese paper (K-size) support Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.2 Details To set to detect/display the Chinese paper (K size paper: 8K, 16K). 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Use case When using K size paper Caution - Do not use this at the normal service.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. - Be sure to get approval from the user by telling the possibility of
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. continuous operation of the drive system in the case of E240 error.
Caution Go through the following: COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > MODEL- Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
SZ; and if MODEL-SZ is “0: AB configuration”, this mode is enabled. 0: Rebooted, 1: Not rebooted
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 0
0: Not supported, 1: Supported Supplement/memo E240 error: Communication error between the Main Controller and
Default value 0 the DC Controller.
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> FNC-SW> MODEL-SZ
Supplement/memo 8K paper: 270 x 390 mm, 16K paper: 270 x 195 mm

8-164
8
8
8-165
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
SJB-UNW Reserve upper limit of secure print job COMP-PRT Img proc memory allocate at job conflict
Lv.2 Details To set the upper limit for the number of reserved jobs in secure print Lv.2 Details When making 2 or more composition prints (page number, number
job. of copies, stamp, date, booklet, watermark), memory for image
Use case Upon user’s request processing is allotted preferentially to print jobs.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Meanwhile, memory for image processing of scan/send and PDL
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. input becomes insufficient depending on the options and document
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 size, and these jobs might be unprocessed until composition prints
0: 50 jobs, 1: 90 jobs are finished.
Default value 0 If these jobs are interfered each other, image processing can be put
forward little by little by allotting memory equally to each job.
WEBV-SW ON/OFF of WebDAV function
Use case Upon user’s request
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of WebDAV function.
OFF setting can reduce memory use of the machine. In addition, the Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
following WebDAV-related items are hidden in user mode. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
- Settings/Registration> Set Destination> Register Destinations> Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Register New Dest.> File> Protocol> WebDAV 0: Print priority, 1: Equal allocation
- Settings/Registration> Function Settings> Send> Common Default value 0
Settings> Use Divided Chunk Send for WebDAV TX ARCDT-SW ON/OFF of ARCDAT control
Use case When reducing memory use of the machine Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF of ARCDAT control.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When “1: OFF” is set, the result of ARCDAT control is not reflected to
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. LUT.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 When the hue variation occurs in the case of failure value displayed
0: ON, 1: OFF in COPIER> DISPLAY> HT-C, turn OFF the ARCDAT control once
Default value 0 and check the hue.
If hue variation is alleviated, analyze the cause of ARCDAT control
Related user mode Settings/Registration> Set Destination> Register Destinations>
error (developer, Patch Sensor, etc.).
Register New Dest.> File> Protocol> WebDAV
Settings/Registration> Function Settings> Send> Common Settings> Use case When hue variation occurs
Use Divided Chunk Send for WebDAV TX Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Supplement/memo WebDAV function is equipped as standard with the machine. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
CARD-RNG Card number setting (department number) Caution Make sure to set “0: ON” again when ARCDAT control recovers.
Lv.2 Details To set the number of cards (departments) that can be used with the Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Card Reader. 0: ON, 1: OFF
Use case When setting the number of cards (departments) Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> HT-C
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. SJOB-CL Set of scan job canceling by logout
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1000 Lv.1 Details To set whether to cancel the scan job in operation by logout of the
Default value 1000 user.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution - The job in scanning operation cannot be canceled.
- Cancel by logout is kept in the log.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Default value 0
Supplement/memo Scan job: A job after the scanning operation is completed.

8-165
8
8
8-166
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
PT-W-SET Set toner band width at ini rotn: transp UNLMTBND Over 400 binders print job support set
Lv.2 Details To set the toner band width that is created on the ITB at the initial Lv.1 Details To set whether to support print job that exceeds 400 binders.
rotation when feeding the transparency. With the setting to support, the machine makes print by sharing
As the value is incremented by 1, the toner band width is increased binders according to job attribution.
by 10mm. Select “1: Not supported” if the user does not print job* with large
When the value is increased, image failure due to Transfer Cleaning quantity of binders.
Blade bound is reduced when feeding the transparency. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When image failure due to Transfer Cleaning Blade bound occurs on 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
transparency Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 0: Automatic setting (when the print server is not connected: no
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. support; When the print server is connected: supported)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 10 1: Not supported
Unit 10 mm Default value 0
Default value 5 Supplement/memo * : A job that requires finishing (such as stapling) in one job. Does not
DELV-FN2 ON/OFF of Delivery Fan apply in the case of executing finishing with multiple sets of output.
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of the Delivery Fan 2 (FM9) at a 1-sided job. MIBCOUNT Scope range set of Charge Counter MIB
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.2 Details To set the range of counter information that can be obtained as MIB
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. (Management Information Base).
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: OFF, 1: ON 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
USB-RCNT Auto connect set at USB device disconnct 0: All charge counters are obtained, 1: Only displayed counter* is
Lv.2 Details To set to enable/disable automatic connection when the USB device obtained, 2: All charge counters are not obtained
is disconnected. * : Counter specified by the following: COPIER > OPTION > USER >
With the setting to disable automatic connection, USB device cannot COUNTER 1 to 6
be used if disconnecting and then connecting the USB device. To Default value 0
enable connection again, the power needs to be turned OFF/ON. Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> USER> COUNTER1 to 6
With the setting to enable automatic connection, connect again after MEAP-PRI Setting of MEAP task priority
disconnecting, and then connecting the USB device again. Lv.2 Details Selecting ON increases MEAP task priority.
Use case Upon user’s request Use case When improving processing performance of MEAP
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution With the setting to enable automatic connection, disconnecting of 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
area makes automatic connection of all USB devices if there is USB 0: OFF, 1: ON
hub. Default value 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 CNTR-SW Init of parts counter replacement timing
0: No automatic connection, 1: Automatic connection Lv.1 Details To return the estimated life of parts counter to the initial value.
Default value 0 Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0: Returned to the initial value
Default value 0

8-166
8
8
8-167
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
W/RAID Setting of RAID Board installation BRWS-FAV Set of service browser favorite register
Lv.1 Details To set installation condition of RAID Board (HDD Mirroring Kit). Lv.2 Details To set whether to allow registration of favorites in the browser for
Select “1: Installed” when installing the RAID Board. Select “0: Not service.
installed” when removing the RAID Board. When 1 is set, favorites in the browser for service can be edited, and
Use case When installing/removing RAID Board any URLs can be accessed.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When service engineers edit favorites in the browser for service
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: Not installed, 1: Installed Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
PSWD-SW Password type set to enter service mode Default value 0
Lv.1 Details To set the type of password that is required to enter when getting into PSCL-MS Set auto gradation adj operation: heavy
service mode. Lv.1 Details To set at which speed (1/1 speed, 1/2 speed, or 1/3 speed) PASCAL
2 types are available: one for “service technician” and the other for control and D-half control are executed at auto gradation adjustment.
“system administrator + service technician”. When “2” is set, they are executed for the lastly used speed only.
When selecting the type for “system administrator + service Required time for auto gradation adjustment is short while it takes
technician”, enter the password for service technician after the time to switch to other speed.
password entry by the user’s system administrator. This is suitable for the users who frequently use a specific paper
Use case Upon request from the user who concerns security type.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When “3” is set, they are executed for all speeds simultaneously.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Required time for auto gradation adjustment is long (approx. 3
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 minutes) while it is quick to switch to other speed. This is suitable for
0: No password, 1: Service technician, 2: System administrator + the users who use various paper types.
service technician
Default value 0 Use case When setting the speed according to the materials used by the user
SM-PSWD Password setting for service technician Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.2 Details To set password for service technician that is used when getting into 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
service mode. Display/adj/set range 2 to 3
Use case When password is required to get into service mode 2: Lastly used speed, 3: All speeds
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 2
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. DMX-DISP ON/OFF auto grdtn adj D-max PASCAL ctrl
Caution Be sure to select 1 or 2 with PSWD-SW in advance. Lv.1 Details To set whether to execute D-max PASCAL control at full adjustment
Display/adj/set range 1 to 99999999 of auto gradation adjustment.
When “0: ON” is set, D-max PASCAL control and PASCAL control
Default value 11111111
are executed. Four A4-size sheets are used for test prints (One for
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> FNC-SW> PSWD-SW
D-max PASCAL control and three for PASCAL control)
RPT2SIDE Set of report 1sided/2-sided output
When “1: OFF” is set, PASCAL control (gradation adjustment) only is
Lv.1 Details To set whether to use 1-sided or 2-sided for report output of service executed. Three A4-size sheets are used for test prints (for PASCAL
mode. control).
Use case When making 2-sided report output to reduce the number of output Use case When making the setting according to the usage of the user
pages
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 0: ON, 1: OFF
0: 1-sided, 1: 2-sided
Default value 0
Default value 1
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> P-PRINT

8-167
8
8
8-168
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
STND-PNL Set of 3-D Control Panel installation CDS-MEAP Set to allow MEAP install by admin
Lv.2 Details [Not used] To set whether the 3-D Control Panel is installed. Lv.1 Details To set whether to permit the user (administrator) to install MEAP
When the 3-D Control Panel is installed, set “1: Installed”. applications and enable iR options from CDS.
Use case At installation of the 3-D Control Panel When “1: Enabled” is set, Updater can be activated from the user
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. mode.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When allowing the administrator to install MEAP applications and
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 enable iR options from CDS
0: Not installed, 1: Installed Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
INVALPDL Disable of PDL license Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Lv.1 Details To disable the registered PDL license. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
When “1: Disabled” is set, PDL is disabled even if a PDL license Default value 1
is registered. This is set to the machines installed at convenience Supplement/memo CDS: Contents Delivery System
stores, which do not allow PDL to be used. CDS-UGW Set to allow firmware update from UGW
Use case When prohibiting the use of PDL Lv.1 Details To set whether to permit update of the firmware from the UGW
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. server.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. When “1: Enabled” is set, Updater accepts the operation from the
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 UGW server in cooperation with CDS.
0: Registered PDL license is enabled, 1: Disabled Use case When allowing update of the firmware from the UGW server
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
IMGCNTPR Setting of image quality mode 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To set the image quality mode. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
The counter priority mode is applied when 1 is set, and the image 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
quality priority mode is applied when 0 is set. Default value 0
Use case Upon user’s request Supplement/memo CDS: Contents Delivery System
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. LOCLFIRM Set to allow firmware update by file
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.1 Details To set whether to permit the user (administrator) to update the
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 firmware from the remote UI using a local file.
0: Image quality priority mode, 1: Counter priority mode This update is executed as a measure for vulnerability in emergency
Default value 0 situations.
CDS-FIRM Set to allow firmware update by admin Use case When allowing the administrator to update the firmware using a file
Lv.1 Details To set whether to permit update of the firmware by user Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
(administrator). 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
When “1: Enabled” is set, Updater can be activated from the user Default value 1
mode. RSHDW-SW ON/OFF of remote shutdown
Use case When allowing the administrator to update the firmware Lv.1 Details A shared multi-function machine is not likely to be shut down at
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. power failure. Set ON/OFF of the remote shutdown function to
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. prevent accident.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 When “1: ON” is set, the machine can be shut down from the remote
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled shutdown menu displayed in the remote UI.
Default value 1: Europe, 0: Other than Europe Use case When preventing an accident at specified power-off time.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0

8-168
8
8
8-169
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW
MC-FANSW Setting of Controller Fan control ATUDILOG ON/OFF of UDI log record
Lv.1 Details To set full speed/half speed to fan control of the Controller Fan 1 and Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of UDI log record mode.
2. UDI log file is normally written in HDD file, but it is deleted at start-up
When “1: Full speed” is set, the heat exhaust efficiency is enhanced. so the UDI log is not recorded.
Use case - When HDD damage occurs multiple times When 1 is set, UDI log is recorded in HDD at job assignment, and is
- When the machine is installed in high temperature environment in written out with sub log when obtaining it with USB memory (it can
which HDD damage is likely to occur be also obtained from SST).
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When investigation is not possible with only sub log at the time of
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. trouble occurrence
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: Half speed, 1: Full speed 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Caution Be sure to get approval from the user by telling that third party other
BXNUPLOG ON/OFF of Nup log at Inbox print than Canon cannot recover the original document and image from
Lv.2 Details To set whether to keep Nup log at Inbox print. UDI log.
Use case When keeping Nup log at Inbox print Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 0: OFF, 1: ON
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 0
0: OFF, 1: ON FAX-INT Set FAX RX print interruption oprtn mode
Default value At normal service: 0, At customization: 1 Lv.2 Details To set the mode performing interruption operation of FAX reception
BUSI-SW Setting of customized function print automatically.
Lv.1 Details To set the function in accordance with the customized specification. Use case Upon user’s request
Use case When installing the customized machine Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Normal, 1: Interruption operation mode
0: Standard, 1: Customization
Default value 0
Default value 0
PDL-Z-LG Setting of draw algorithm
SDLMTWRN Cpcty warn dis ON/OFF at E-mail/I-Fax TX
Lv.1 Details To switch the draw algorithm of the iR C Series and the iR-ADV C
Lv.1 Details To set whether to display the warning message when sending data
Series to obtain output the user expects.
that exceeds the upper limit value for the transmission data size via
When 0 (FURUYA mode) is set, image is output as displayed on the
E-mail/I-Fax.
screen by the new algorithm adopted from the iR-ADV C Series.
Use case For customization
Pseudo outline (boundary for processing divided graphics separately)
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
occurred with the iR C Series does not occur. However, when PDL
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 job with special data structure is sent, output the user expects may
0: OFF, 1: ON not be obtained.
Default value 0 When 1 (FLAG mode) is set, the draw algorithm adopted by the
Related user mode Function Settings> Send> E-Mail/I-Fax Settings> Maximum Data conventional iR C Series is used. Output equivalent to that of the
Size for Sending iR C Series can be obtained; however, draw-related phenomenon
JLK-PWSC ON/OFF of PCAM password auth doc scan occurred with the series occurs.
Lv.2 Details To set whether to scan the PCAM password authentication document Use case Upon user’s request
with the MEAP application. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When scanning the PCAM password authentication document 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Caution Do not use setting value 2 and 3.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 3
0: OFF, 1: ON 0: FURUYA mode, 1: FLAG mode, 2,3: For R&D use
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-169
8
8
8-170
COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW ■■DSPLY-SW
CDS-LVUP Set to allow CDS periodical update
Lv.1 Details To set whether to permit periodical update by CDS.
COPIER > OPTION > DSPLY-SW
When 0 is set, the user administrator/service technician can set the UI-COPY Display/hide of copy screen
periodical update function from the user mode/service mode. With Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the copy function.
this setting, Updater performs periodical update. Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled 0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value The value differs according to the location. Default value 1
Supplement/memo CDS: Contents Delivery System UI-BOX Display/hide of Inbox screen
UA-OFFSW ON/OFF of unified auth function Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the Inbox function.
Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF of the Unified Authentication function. Use case Upon user’s request
Set 0 when not preferring to use the Unified Authentication function Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
because of security concern. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Use case Upon user’s request (not to use the Unified Authentication function) Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 0: No Inbox function (Storing is not available even with PDL to
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Inbox.)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 1: Inbox function is active
0: ON, 1: OFF 2: Inbox function is active (with limitation; Storing is available with
Default value 0 PDL to Inbox despite no display on the Control Panel/remote UI)
MIB-NVTA RFC-compatible character stringMIB write Default value 1
Lv.1 Details As default, MIB object which NVT-ASCII can be written exists in Related user mode Preferences > Display Settings > Store Location Display Settings >
order to link with LUI entry value. This violates RFC order, so a Mail Box
problem like garbled 2-byte characters may occur in the SNMP UI-SEND Display/hide of send screen
monitoring system, such as the 3rd vendor’s MPS. Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the SEND function.
Whether non-RFC-compatible character strings are written in MIB Use case Upon user’s request
can be set using this mode. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
When 1 is set, only the character strings which are strictly compatible 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
with RFC are written. (Writing operation is executed from the SNMP Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
manager.) LUI is not linked. 0: Hide, 1: Display
Use case Upon user’s request (operation with RFC-compatible system) Default value 1
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. UI-FAX Display/hide of FAX screen
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the FAX function.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 Use case Upon user’s request
0: Compatible in a conventional manner, 1: RFC-compatible, 2 to 3: Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Not used 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Supplement/memo RFC: Document of internet-related technical standards 0: Hide, 1: Display
NVT-ASCII: Network Virtual Terminal-ASCII Default value 1
MIB-EXT [Not used]
T-8-47

8-170
8
8
8-171
COPIER > OPTION > DSPLY-SW COPIER > OPTION > DSPLY-SW
T-LW-LVL Dis timing of toner level warning mssg FXMSG-SW ON/OFF of Fixing Assembly replace mssg
Lv.2 Details To set the threshold value of residual toner in the hopper. Lv.2 Details To set whether to display the message prompting the replacement of
When the residual toner level becomes lower than the threshold, a Fixing Assembly on the Control Panel when the life judgment counter
warning message of “Toner is low. Replacement not yet needed.” is reaches the specified value.
displayed on the Control Panel. When “1” (default: 0) is set in FXMSG-SW and also “1” (default: 0) is
When the value is incremented by 1, the threshold is increased by set in COPIER> OPTION> FNC-SW> FXWRNLVL, the life of Fixing
1%. As the smaller value is set, the message timing to be displayed Assembly is detected.
becomes earlier. When the Fixing Assembly reaches the end of life, the Fixing
Use case - Upon user’s request Assembly replacement message: “Prepare new fixing roller. Call
- At the timing that the service engineer visits to the customer, etc. service representative.” is displayed.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When the message is displayed, go through the following procedure.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 1) After turning OFF the main power switch, replace the Fixing Film
Display/adj/set range 5 to 100 Unit+Pressure Roller and Fixing Assembly.
Unit 1% 2) After turning ON the main power switch, execute COPIER>
FUNCTION> CLEAR> CNT-DCON.
Default value Europe: 5, Other than Europe: 10
3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> TNR-WARN
NWERR-SW OFF/ON of network-related error display
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.2 Details To set OFF/ON of network-related error message display.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
When setting “0: OFF” while the machine is not connected to
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
network, the error message “Check the network connection.” is not
0: OFF, 1: ON
displayed.
Default value 0
Use case When using the machine as a copy machine
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> FNC-SW> FXWRNLVL
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEAR> CNT-DCON
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
MEAP-DSP Screen switch set from MEAP to standard
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Lv.2 Details To set to enable/disable switching from MEAP screen to the standard
0: OFF, 1: ON
screen (COPY/SEND/Mail Box screen, etc). (Setting to display/hide
Default value 1: Normal model, 0: Self-copy model
the arrow mark on MEAP screen)
UISW-DSP ON/OFF of user screen switch display
In the case of an error/jam/alarm, the screen is switched to the
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of the switch to change the standard screen and standard screen to display warning even if disabling this mode.
simple screen for the users.
Use case Upon user’s request
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0
Default value 1
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> ANIM-SW
T-CRG-SW ON/OFF of Toner Cntner rplce user mode
Supplement/memo If disabling the switch with ANIM-SW, the screen will not be switched
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the Toner Container replacement to the standard screen even in the case of an error/jam/alarm.
screen in user mode.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0
Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Maintenance> Replace Specified Toner

8-171
8
8
8-172
COPIER > OPTION > DSPLY-SW COPIER > OPTION > DSPLY-SW
ANIM-SW Screen switch set from MEAP to warning UI-EPRNT Display/hide of extended print screen
Lv.2 Details To set to enable/disable switching from MEAP screen to the error/ Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the extended print screen (print
jam screen. screen for print server).
If disabling this mode, the screen will not be switched to the warning Use case Upon user’s request
screen in the case of an error/jam/alarm, and a message is appeared Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
on the MEAP screen indicating to contact the service person. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 0: Hide, 1: Display
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 1
0: Enabled, 1: Disabled (No display of warning screen) UI-WEB Display/hide of Web browser screen
Default value 0 Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the Web browser screen.
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> MEAP-DSP Use case Upon user’s request
Supplement/memo If just disabling the switch with MEAP-DSP, the screen is switched to Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
the standard screen in the case of an error/jam/alarm. If disabling the 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
switch with ANIM-SW, the screen will not be switched to the standard Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
screen and a warning is appeared on MEAP screen. 0: Hide, 1: Display
UI-PRINT Display/hide of print job screen Default value 1
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the print job screen. UI-HOLD Display/hide of hold job screen
Use case Upon user’s request Lv.2 Details To set whether to display the hold job screen on the Control Panel.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case Upon user’s request
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: Hide, 1: Display
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3
Default value 1 0: Hide (POD function OFF, JAL OFF)
IMGC-ADJ Dis/hide of img adj item in user mode 1: Display (POD function ON, JAL OFF)
Lv.1 Details To set whether to display or hide the item relating to image 2: Hide (POD function OFF, JAL ON)
adjustment in user mode. 3: Hide (POD function OFF, JAL ON)
When selecting display setting, detailed image adjustment procedure Default value 0
will be displayed only for the duplicated paper specified with the TNR-WARN ON/OFF of toner alarm display
following settings: Preferences> Paper Settings> Set Paper Type
Lv.1 Details To set whether to display the toner alarm screen.
Management.
When “1” is set, the toner alarm is not displayed until the toner runs
Use case As needed out.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When preferring to hide the alarm until the toner runs out
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: Hide, 1: Display
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0 0: ON, 1: OFF
Related user mode Preferences> Paper Settings> Set Paper Type Management Default value Other than USA: 0, For USA: 1
UI-RSCAN Display/hide of remote scan screen Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> T-LW-LVL
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the remote scan screen on the
Control Panel.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value 1

8-172
8
8
8-173
COPIER > OPTION > DSPLY-SW COPIER > OPTION > DSPLY-SW
RMT-CNSL ON/OFF of MEAP console screen UI-MOBP Display/hide of mobile print
Lv.1 Details Selecting “1: ON” enables to obtain log for Function Composer on Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide “Mobile Print” in the main menu.
console screen. Use case Upon user’s request
Use case When obtaining log for Function Composer Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 0: Hide, 1: Display
0: OFF, 1: ON Default value 1
Default value 0 FCOT-DSP ON/OFF of FCOT priority mode in usermode
UI-SBOX ON/OFF of Advanced Box screen display Lv.1 Details To set whether to display “Color/Black Priority for First Print Time” in
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of the Advanced Box screen on the Control Panel. the user mode.
Use case When not displaying the Advanced Box screen on the Control Panel When 1 is set, the home position of the Primary Transfer Rollers for Y,
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. M, C can be switched.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When setting “Color/Black Priority for First Print Time” in the user
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 mode
0: OFF, 1: ON Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0: Europe, 1: Other than Europe 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Related user mode Preferences > Display Settings > Store Location Display Settings > Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Advanced Box / Network 0: OFF, 1: ON
UI-MEM ON/OFF of memory media screen display Default value 1
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of the memory media screen display on the Control Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Action> Color/Black Priority for
Panel. First Print Time
Use case When not displaying the memory media screen on the Control Panel UI-CUSTM ON/OFF of Quick Menu screen display
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of the Quick Menu screen on the Control Panel.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When not displaying the Quick Menu screen on the Control Panel
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: OFF, 1: ON 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Related user mode Preferences > Display Settings > Store Location Display Settings > 0: OFF, 1: ON
Memory Media Default value 1
UI-NAVI Dis/hide of introduce to useful features CNTCNFSW ON/OFF of Counter Check screen display
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide “Introduction to Useful Features” in Lv.1 Details To set whether to display the Counter Check screen.
the main menu. When 1 is set, the Counter Check screen can be displayed. The
Use case Upon user’s request setting value automatically returns to 0 (OFF) when the screen is
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. closed.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When checking the counter at servicing
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: Hide, 1: Display Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 1 0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0
T-8-48

8-173
8
8
8-174
■■NETWORK COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK
SMTPRXPN Setting of SMTP reception port number
COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK Lv.2 Details To set SMTP reception port number.
RAW-DATA Setting of received data print mode Use case Upon user’s request
Lv.2 Details To set print mode for the received image data. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
This item is used to identify the cause whether it’s due to image data 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
or image processing in the case of trouble with received image.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
Use case When received image trouble occurs
Default value 25
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
POP3PN Setting of POP3 reception port number
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.2 Details To set POP3 reception port number.
Caution Be sure to set the value back to “0: normal print operation” after
Use case Upon user’s request
recovering from the trouble.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: Normal print operation, 1: Print with original data without image
processing Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
Default value 0 Default value 110
RMT-LANG Language setting of remote UI FTPTXPN Specification of SEND port (FTP) number
Lv.2 Details To set the language on remote UI. Lv.2 Details To specify address port (FTP) number for SEND.
Use case Upon user’s request Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Switch with +/- key, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range ja/en/de/fr/it/es Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
ja: Japanese, en: English, de: German, fr: French, it: Italian, es: Default value 21
Spanish STS-PORT ON/OFF of TOT sync status comctn port
IFAX-LIM No. of max print lines at IFAX reception Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF for Inquiry/Response (sync)-mode status
Lv.2 Details To set the maximum number of lines for e-mail text to be printed communication port with T.O.T.
when receiving IFAX. Select “1: ON” in the case of connecting the PC and the machine
Setting of this item can prevent endless printing of the attached file with the cross cable while Service NAVI is used.
data in the case of receiving an error e-mail or failure in interpretation Use case When the Service NAVI is used
of the context. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Selecting 0 prints the header/footer in 1 sheet when receiving e-mail 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
text without attached file. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Use case When preventing endless print in the case of failure in reception 0: OFF, 1: ON
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> CMD-PORT
Display/adj/set range 0 to 999 Supplement/memo T.O.T: TUIF over TCP. Communication protocol to be used for
0: E-mail text not printed, 999: Unlimited communication with the built-in application (UI) and the internal
Default value 500 application such as COPY/ SEND/ BOX, etc. (Canon’s own protocol).
SMTPTXPN Setting of SMTP TX port number
Lv.2 Details To set SMTP transmission port number.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
Default value 25

8-174
8
8
8-175
COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK
CMD-PORT ON/OFF TOTasync command comctn port NS-NTLM Limit NTLM auth method at SMTP auth
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF for asynchronous command communication port with Lv.2 Details To restrict use of NTLM authentication method at the time of SMTP
T.O.T. authentication.
Select “1: ON” in the case of connecting the PC and the machine Use case Upon user’s request
with the cross cable while Service NAVI is used. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When the Service NAVI is used 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 0: SMTP server-dependent, 1: Not used
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 0
0: OFF, 1: ON Supplement/memo SMTP authentication: Protocol in which user authentication
Default value 0 function is added to SMTP, which is the protocol to be used
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> STS-PORT for e-mail transmission. At the time of e-mail transmission, this
Supplement/memo T.O.T: TUIF over TCP. Communication protocol to be used for protocol executes authentication of the user account and the
communication with the built-in application (UI) and the internal password between the SMTP server and the user to approve e-mail
application such as COPY/ SEND/ BOX, etc. (Canon’s own protocol). transmission only when it’s authenticated.
NS-CMD5 Limit CRAM-MD5 auth method at SMTP auth NS-PLNWS Limit clear text auth at SMTP auth encry
Lv.2 Details To restrict use of CRAM-MD5 authentication method at the time of Lv.2 Details To restrict use of PLAIN/LOGIN authentication, which is clear text, at
SMTP authentication. the time of SMTP authentication under the environment where the
Use case Upon user’s request communication packet is encrypted.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case Upon user’s request
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: SMTP server-dependent, 1: Not used Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0 0: SMTP server-dependent, 1: Not used
Supplement/memo SMTP authentication: Protocol in which user authentication Default value 0
function is added to SMTP, which is the protocol to be used Supplement/memo SMTP authentication: Protocol in which user authentication
for e-mail transmission. At the time of e-mail transmission, this function is added to SMTP, which is the protocol to be used
protocol executes authentication of the user account and the for e-mail transmission. At the time of e-mail transmission, this
password between the SMTP server and the user to approve e-mail protocol executes authentication of the user account and the
transmission only when it’s authenticated. password between the SMTP server and the user to approve e-mail
NS-GSAPI Limit GSSAPI auth method at SMTP auth transmission only when it’s authenticated.
Lv.2 Details To restrict use of GSSAPI authentication method at the time of SMTP NS-PLN Limit plain txt auth at SMTPauth noencry
authentication. Lv.2 Details To restrict use of PLAIN/LOGIN authentication, which is plain text, at
Use case Upon user’s request the time of SMTP authentication under the environment where the
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. communication packet is not encrypted.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case Upon user’s request
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: SMTP server-dependent, 1: Not used 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Supplement/memo SMTP authentication: Protocol in which user authentication 0: SMTP server-dependent, 1: Not used
function is added to SMTP, which is the protocol to be used Default value 0
for e-mail transmission. At the time of e-mail transmission, this Supplement/memo SMTP authentication: Protocol in which user authentication
protocol executes authentication of the user account and the function is added to SMTP, which is the protocol to be used
password between the SMTP server and the user to approve e-mail for e-mail transmission. At the time of e-mail transmission, this
transmission only when it’s authenticated. protocol executes authentication of the user account and the
password between the SMTP server and the user to approve e-mail
transmission only when it’s authenticated.

8-175
8
8
8-176
COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK
NS-LGN Limit LOGIN authentication at SMTP auth DA-CNCT Connection setting of WPGW
Lv.2 Details To restrict use of LOGIN authentication at the time of SMTP Lv.2 Details To set WPGW connection.
authentication. Use case This mode is used for the Japanese models only and not used with
Use case Upon user’s request overseas models (outside Japan)
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Caution Go through the following: COPIER > OPTION > ACC > COIN; and
0: SMTP server-dependent, 1: Not used if the setting value for COIN is changed from 0/1/2 to 3 (select DA
Default value 0 charge), the value is automatically turns 1.
Supplement/memo SMTP authentication: Protocol in which user authentication Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
function is added to SMTP, which is the protocol to be used 0: OFF, 1:ON
for e-mail transmission. At the time of e-mail transmission, this Default value 0
protocol executes authentication of the user account and the Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> ACC> COIN
password between the SMTP server and the user to approve e-mail Supplement/memo WPGW: Workplace Gateway
transmission only when it’s authenticated. CHNG-STS Set of TOT status connection port number
MEAP-PN HTTP port No.setting of MEAP application Lv.2 Details To set the port number for status connection with T.O.T.
Lv.2 Details To set HTTP port number of MEAP application. Use case When the Service NAVI is used
Use case Upon user’s request Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 1 to 65535
Caution Do not specify port 8080 when the Print Server is connected. Default value 20010
Otherwise, you cannot browse the device RUI in which MEAP Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> STS-PORT
authentication application is running (Port 8080 is reserved for
CHNG-CMD Set of TOT command connection port No.
redirection of EFI controller to the iR side.)
Lv.2 Details To set the port number for command connection with T.O.T.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
Use case When the Service NAVI is used
Default value 8000
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
DA-PORT Port setting with DA
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.2 Details To set the communication port when DA is installed.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 65535
Select ON when DA is installed.
Default value 20000
Use case When DA is installed (This mode is used for the Japanese models
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> CMD-PORT
only and not used with overseas models (outside Japan))
MEAP-SSL HTTPS port setting of MEAP
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.2 Details To set the port of HTTPS server in the case of using SSL with HTTP
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
of MEAP.
Caution When going through the following: COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK>
Use case When specifying the setting of HTTPS port for MEAP
DA-CNCT, and selecting 1 for DA-CNCT, the following item is also
ON: Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> STS-PORT, CMD-PORT, DA- 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
PORT Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 8443
0: OFF, 1: ON (When installed)
Default value 0
Supplement/memo DA: Digital Accessory

8-176
8
8
8-177
COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK
LPD-PORT Setting of LPD port number WUEV-RTR Setting of sleep notification range
Lv.2 Details To set the LPD port number. Lv.2 Details To set the number of available routers to the target for sleep
Use case Upon user’s request notification.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case Upon user’s request
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 65535 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 515 Caution This is active when COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> WUEV-SW is
Supplement/memo LPD port: Network port for TCP/IP communication when making set to 0: Notified.
prints through network. Display/adj/set range 0 to 254
WUEV-SW Setting of sleep notification execution Default value 3
Lv.2 Details To set whether to notify the sleep mode to the application Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> WUEV-SW
(imageWARE, etc) on the network when shifting to/recovering from WUEN-LIV Recovery time setting after sleep notice
the sleep mode. Lv.2 Details To set the time from the sleep start from network without job
Use case Upon user’s request assignment until the mode is shifted to the sleep mode.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When setting the startup time after sleep notification
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: Notified, 1: Not notified Display/adj/set range 1 to 600
Default value 0 Unit 1 second
WUEV-INT Setting of sleep notification interval Default value 15
Lv.2 Details To set the interval of sleep notification. DHCP-12 ON/OFF of DHCP-option 12 request
Use case Upon user’s request Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of inquiry on the host name (Option 12) which uses
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Option 55 of DHCP.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Selecting OFF can prevent DHCP packet from including Option 12 or
Caution This is active when COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> WUEV-SW is Option 81 under the packet-monitoring network environment.
set to 0: Notified. Use case Upon user’s request
Display/adj/set range 60 to 65535 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Unit 1 second 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 600 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> WUEV-SW 0: OFF, 1: ON
WUEV-POT Port number setting for sleep notice Default value 1
Lv.2 Details To set port number of the PC to notify the sleep mode. Supplement/memo DHCP: Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution This is active when COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> WUEV-SW is
set to 0: Notified.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 65535
Default value 11427
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> WUEV-SW

8-177
8
8
8-178
COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK
DHCP-81 ON/OFF IPaddress dynamic chng in DHCP-81 DNSTRANS Setting of DNS transfer priority
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF for dynamic change of IP address by Option 81 of Lv.1 Details To set priority order of the protocol (IPv4/IPv6) to be used for DNS
DHCP. query.
Selecting OFF can prevent DHCP packet from including Option 12 or In the case of using both IPv6 and IPv4 while the DNS server
Option 81 under the packet-monitoring network environment. supports IPv4, it takes time because of timeout when executing DNS
Selecting ON enables dynamic change of IP address by Option 81 of query with priority on IPv6.
DHCP in the case that the dynamic DNS setting is ON in user mode. Giving priority on query by IPv4 can shorten the time.
Use case Upon user’s request Use case When it takes time to execute DNS query with priority on IPv6
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. because the DNS server supports IPv4
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution Be sure to set ON for the dynamic DNS setting in user mode to 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
enable dynamic change of IP address. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 0: IPv4, 1: IPv6
0: OFF, 1: ON Default value 1
Default value 1 PROXYRES Setting of proxy response to Windows
Supplement/memo DHCP: Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol Lv.2 Details To set whether to provide proxy response or return the device status
IFX-CHIG Set operation by IFAX recv mail content when an inquiry is received via Windows while the device is in sleep
Lv.1 Details To set the number of characters for the IFAX received mail content, mode.
so that the mail is not printed/forwarded when the characters in the Use case When executing status response for query from Windows correctly
text is less than the number of specified characters. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
This machine can output blank paper because some senders send 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
e-mail text consists of linefeed codes only. In such case, specify 2 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
(number of characters) so that there will be no output of blank paper. 0: No proxy response, 1: Proxy response
In the case of specifying any number other than 0, header/footer is Default value 1
printed/forwarded in 1 sheet only if the e-mail (body) text is less than WOLTRANS Setting of sleep recovery protocol
the specified value while no TIFF file is attached. Lv.1 Details To set the protocol for recovery from sleep mode according to the
As the value is incremented by 1, the number of target characters in value of WOL (Wake On LAN) trans.
e-mail body text is increased by 1 character. Reception of a specific network packet is one of the requirements for
Use case When reducing print of blank paper due to e-mail received by IFAX. the device to recover from sleep mode.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When the number of network protocols supported by the device
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. increases, the types of network packets which activate recovery from
Caution Be sure to get approval from the user by telling that there will be no sleep mode vary. However, there is a possibility that the existing
print of e-mail (body) text if the number of characters is less than the network protocol is actually used.
specified value. Select the type of network packet which activates recovery from
Display/adj/set range 0 to 999 sleep mode according to the environment where the device is used.
0: E-mail (body) text is not ignored. Use case When selecting protocol for sleep recovery
Unit 1 character Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Supplement/memo 1 Japanese Kanji character is calculated as 2 bytes, and the control Display/adj/set range 1 to 3
codes (such as linefeed code, etc) are included in the number of 1: WSD and SNMP, 2: WSD and CPCA, 3: CPCA and SNMP
characters. Default value 1

8-178
8
8
8-179
COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK
802XTOUT Set of IEEE802.1X authentication timeout IKEINTVL Setting of IKE retry interval
Lv.1 Details To set timeout value for IEEE802.1X authentication. Lv.1 Details To set retry interval in the case of no response from the
If the device executes 802.1X authentication, change the wait time communication target at the time of IKE packet transmission.
for response from the authentication server. Use case Upon user’s request
Use case When response from the authentication server is slow/fast Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 1 to 10
Display/adj/set range 10 to 120 Unit second
Unit second Default value 5
Default value 30 Supplement/memo IKE: Internet Key Exchange
IKERETRY Setting of IKE retry times IPSDEBLV Setting of IPSec debug level
Lv.1 Details To set the number of retries in the case of no response from the Lv.2 Details For R&D use
communication target at the time of IKE packet transmission. SP-LINK Mode setting at 1W sleep
Use case Upon user’s request Lv.1 Details Switch to execute 10base-T standby as default to realize the standby
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. power 1W in sleep mode.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When shifting to sleep mode after negotiation (same as conventional
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 machines)
Default value 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Supplement/memo IKE: Internet Key Exchange 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
SPDALDEL Initialization of SPD value Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Lv.2 Details To initialize all the SPD values that is under management. 0: Shift to sleep mode with 10base-T
SPD values can be initialized without clearing SRAM. 1: Shift to sleep mode after negotiation
Use case At the time of SPD value mismatch when IPSec Board is added Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. AFS-JOB Set of FAX server job reception port
2) Turn OFF and then ON the main power supply. Lv.1 Details To set the reception port of the fax server to which a fax client sends
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 jobs.
0: OFF, 1: ON Use case When changing the job reception port of the fax server
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Supplement/memo SPD: Database that manages SA (Security Association). 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
SPD value is managed when IPSec Board is used. Normally, SRAM Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
needs to be cleared in the case of mismatch in SPD value. Default value 20317
NCONF-SW ON/OFF of Network Configurator function Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> AFC-EVNT
Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF of Network Configurator function. AFC-JOB Set of FAX client job sending port
If the user does not use the function, select OFF to prevent remote Lv.1 Details To set the port of a fax client from which jobs are sent to the fax
attack through network. server.
Use case Upon user’s request Use case When changing the job sending port of a fax client
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 20317
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> AFS-JOB, AFC-EVNT
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 1
Supplement/memo Network Configurator function is a function to be used for
communication with NetSpot Device Installer, etc., and the network
setting can be changed from the remote.

8-179
8
8
8-180
COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK
AFC-EVNT Set of FAX client event reception port IPTBROAD Set to allow broad/multi cast TX
Lv.1 Details To set the event notification reception port of a fax client. Lv.1 Details To set whether to permit transmission of broadcast packets and
Use case When changing the event notification reception port of a fax client multicast packets.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Transmission of broadcast packets and multicast packets is
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. permitted without specifying an exception address. It is permitted
Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535 within the device even if it is rejected in the default setting of the
Default value 29400 IPv4/v6 transmission filter.
Set “1: Disabled” when the user does not want to send them.
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> AFS-JOB
Use case Upon user’s request
ILOGMODE Setting of Firewall range
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To set all protocols or TCP/UDP/ICMP unicast as the target of
Firewall. Display/adj/set range 0 to 5
When 0 is set, the machine responds to ARP, ICMP multicast and 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled, 2 to 5: Not used
broadcast which have no direct relation, and consequently the Default value 0
number of logs is increased. PFWFTPRT Setting of IP Filter FTP
When 1 is set, the machine filters TCP, UDP and ICMP unicast only. Lv.1 Details When FTP SEND is executed using an IP filter by which packets
Use case Upon user’s request from a specific remote PC are rejected, SYN is returned to the port
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 113 if the PC supports authentication of the FTP port 113. However,
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. since the IP filter blocks the packets, the block logs are increased
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 and the performance is lowered.
0: All protocols support mode When 1 is set, RST is returned to the port 113 without blocking
1: TCP/UDP/ICMP unicast support mode packets.
2, 3: Not used Use case When executing FTP SEND against the OS which supports
Default value 0 authentication of the FTP port 113 while the IP filter is enabled
ILOGKEEP Setting of IP Filter log time Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To set the retention time from the log time blocked by IP Filter.
When access is made again from a same address which was Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
blocked by IP Filter before, if it is within the retention time from the 0: OFF, 1: ON
previous log time, its log is not recorded. Default value 0
If access is frequently made from a same IP address, the log record PRNIPBLK ON/OFF of IP range setting function
of the UI might be filled with its logs. If the user considers that a Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF of IP range setting function (only at reception and
single log for a same IP address is enough, set the longer retention print job).
time. When 1 is set, the following are displayed in the user mode.
Use case Upon user’s request Preferences> Network > TCP/IP Settings > IPv4 Settings > IP
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Address Range Settings
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Preferences> Network > TCP/IP Settings > IPv6 Settings > IP
Display/adj/set range 0 to 48 Address Range Settings
0: 1 minute (special mode) Use case When using the IP address block function
1 to 48: 1 hour to 48 hours Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0
Related user mode Preferences> Network > TCP/IP Settings > IPv4 Settings > IP
Address Range Settings
Preferences> Network > TCP/IP Settings > IPv6 Settings > IP
Address Range Settings

8-180
8
8
8-181
COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK
IPMTU Setting of MTU size
Lv.1 Details To set MTU size of network packet.
This item is used when performing SEND communication between
locations connected with Ethernet in a field environment where MTU
black hole problem occurs.
Use case When MTU black hole problem occur
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 10
1: 600 byte, 2: 700 byte, ..., 9: 1400 byte, 10: 1500 byte
Unit 100 byte
Default value 10
DDNSINTV Set of DDNS periodical update interval
Lv.1 Details DNS registration is executed only once at start-up with the current
iR, so the registered contents are deleted in an environment where
the DNS server settings are deleted at intervals.
To set the interval of DDNS periodical update for not deleting the
registered contents.
Use case When the DNS server settings are deleted at intervals
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 48
0: No periodical update, 1: 1-hour interval, 2: 2-hour interval, ..., 47:
47-hour interval, 48: 48-hour interval
Unit 1 hour
Default value 24
T-8-49

8-181
8
8
8-182
■■SOUND ■■ENV-SET
COPIER > OPTION > SOUND COPIER > OPTION > ENV-SET
DRM-RTIM Set exe interval drum line prev sequence ENVP-INT Temp, humid &Fix Film temp log get cycle
Lv.2 Details To set the time interval to rotate the Photosensitive Drum at standby Lv.1 Details To set the cycle to obtain log of the temperature and humidity inside
or sleep mode. the machine and the surface temperature of the Fixing Film.
When a device is left for a long period of time, a drum pitch line As the value is incremented by 1, the cycle is increased by 1 minute.
occurs. To prevent this, rotate the Photosensitive Drum at the Obtained log can be displayed by selecting the following: COPIER >
specified interval for 300 msec only. DISPLAY > ENVRNT
As the value is incremented by 1, the interval is extended by 5 Use case At trouble analysis
minutes. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
If users do not care about the drum pitch line or they want to reduce 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
the rotation interval, increase the value. Display/adj/set range 0 to 480
Use case Extend the interval for the users who do not care about the drum Unit 1 minute
pitch line after the machine is left or who want to reduce the number Default value 60
of start-up.
Related service mode COPIER> DISPLAY> ENVRNT
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
DRY-CISU ON/OFF of condensation prevention mode
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF of condensation mode.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 12
When droplets are appeared on the Scanner Unit due to
0: Not executed
condensation and image failure or E225 occurs, set “1: ON”.
Unit 5 minutes By selecting 1, the Scanner Unit (paper front) stops the fan for
Default value 3 15 seconds and the Scanner Unit (paper back) lights LED for 30
T-8-50 seconds from the next startup.
Use case When droplets are appeared on the Scanner Unit due to
condensation and image failure or E225 occurs
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF (Normal mode), 1: ON (Anti-condensation mode)
Default value 0
T-8-51

8-182
8
8
8-183
■■CLEANING ■■FEED-SW
COPIER > OPTION > CLEANING COPIER > OPTION > FEED-SW
OHP-PTH Set of ITB clean transp threshold value EVLP-SPD Envelope feeding speed setting
Lv.2 Details To set the number of sheets for ITB cleaning interval to be executed Lv.1 Details To set the envelope feeding speed.
when feeding transparency. By feeding an envelop at 1/2 speed (default) in the case of a high
When a large number of transparencies is fed, surface active agent humidity environment, the glue flap may adhere at the time of fixing.
adheres to the ITB, and consequently the transfer efficiency is As a result of that, the envelop may not be opened.
lowered. To prevent the image failure, patches are created on the By setting to 1/1 speed, adhesion can be prevented, but fixing might
ITB and surface active agent is removed together with the toner per be deteriorated in a low humidity environment.
30 sheets at paper interval and per 22 sheets at last rotation. Use case When a glue flap of envelop adheres
As the value is incremented by 1, the number of sheets for cleaning Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
interval at paper interval and at last rotation is increased by 1 sheet. Caution The fixing is deteriorated by setting 1/1 speed in a low humidity
When using the transparency that tends to cause the adherence of environment.
surface active agent, decrease the value so that the image failure Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
can be alleviated. 0: 1/2 speed, 1: 1/1 speed
When the value is increased, the downtime and the toner
Default value 0
consumption can be reduced; however, image failure may occur.
EVLP-FS Setting of fixing speed with envelop
Use case When an image failure occurs due to lowering of the transfer
Lv.2 Details To set fixing speed when feeding envelop.
efficiency
As the value is incremented by 1, the fixing speed changes by 0.1%.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Decrease the value when thin line displacement occurs on trailing
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
edge of envelop, and increase the value when wrinkles occur.
Display/adj/set range -15 to 15
Use case When thin line displacement or wrinkles occur on trailing edge while
Unit Number of sheets feeding envelop
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> CLEANING> TBLT-CLN Caution Be sure to change the value little at a time because when setting an
ITBB-TMG Setting of ITB cleaning sheet interval extreme value, phenomenon opposite to thin line displacement or
Lv.1 Details To set the paper interval to execute the ITB cleaning. wrinkles occur.
As the value is increased, downtime and toner consumption amount Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
are reduced while an image failure may occur due to soiled ITB. Unit 0.1 %
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
TFL-RTC Set delvry dest at rcvry after tray full
Display/adj/set range 0 to 10
Lv.1 Details To select the delivery destination for a job with multiple pages after
0: Not executed
recovering the Delivery Tray that reaches the full level.
Unit 100 sheets When 0 (default) is set, a job is output from the delivery destination
Default value 1 again from which the last job was delivered.
T-8-52 When 1 is set, a job is output from the delivery destination which
priority is set as high at “Output Tray Settings” in user mode.
Use case When changing the delivery tray
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Output from the tray from which the last job was output.
1: Output from the delivery destination which priority is high among
the delivery trays.
Default value 0
Related user mode Function Settings> Common> Paper Output Settings> Output Tray
Settings

8-183
8
8
8-184
COPIER > OPTION > FEED-SW ■■IMG-SPD
USZ-FEED ON/OFF Job set/Pckup Cst ppr size chck
Lv.1 Details To set whether to check if the paper size set for the job matches the
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-SPD
paper size set on the Pickup Cassette. FX-D-TMP Set small ppr down sequence start temp
When 1 is set, papers are picked up without checking even user Lv.1 Details To set the temperature to start the down sequence control for the
defined size papers that differ from the job setting size are set on the small size paper (smaller than A4R in width direction).
Pickup Cassette. As the value is incremented by 1, the temperature is increased by 5
Use case When forcibly picking up papers even the paper size setting differs deg C from the initial setting temperature.
between a job and the Pickup Cassette Use case When improving the hot offset and the productivity at the paper edge
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: ON, 1: OFF Display/adj/set range -4 to 4
Default value 0 -4: -20 deg C, -3: -15 deg C, -2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1:
5 deg C, 2: 10 deg C, 3: 15 deg C, 4: 20 deg C
T-8-53
Unit 5 deg C
Default value 0
FIX-ROT Idle rotn end temp after small ppr feed
Lv.1 Details When feeding the small size paper following the large size paper on
the Fixing Assembly, the temperature at both edges of Fixing Film is
higher than the center. To prevent the fixing offset or paper wrinkle,
it idles until the temperature becomes the specified value after the
small size paper is fed.
This item is to set the temperature to finish the idle rotation.
As the value is incremented by 1, the temperature is increased by 5
deg C from the initial setting value.
The temperature is detected by the Sub Thermistor 1 and 2.
Use case When improving the hot offset and the productivity at the paper edge
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: 5 deg C, 2: 10 deg C
Unit 5 deg C
Default value 0

8-184
8
8
8-185
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-SPD COPIER > OPTION > IMG-SPD
MXSPDSEL SPD/Q’ty priority in mixed width:Reader ARC-INT2 Set ARCDAT exe interval: last rotation
Lv.1 Details To set whether to give priority to speed or image quality when Lv.2 Details To set the number of sheets which ARCDAT control is not executed,
feeding the paper with different width. from the start of a job.
When “0: Image quality priority” is set, idle rotation is performed at ARCDAT control which is supposed to be executed during the
different width mixed print and the number of registration is increased specified number of sheets is executed at last rotation of the previous
so that the image quality can be maintained while the productivity is job. Since the number of interruptions during a job is reduced, the
reduced. productivity is enhanced.
When “1: Speed priority” is set, the productivity does not reduce However, the number of times of ARCDAT control executed at last
while skew may occur even same width. rotation might be increased depending on the print conditions.
Actual setting value is calculated by dividing the entry value by 0.9
Use case When skew occurs at different width mixed print and rounding up after the decimal points. (e.g.: If an entry value is
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 25, setting value will be 28.)
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Caution Do not set a larger value than ARC-INT1.
0: Image quality priority, 1: Speed priority Display/adj/set range 5 to 1000
Default value 1 Unit 1 sheet
ARC-INT1 Set of ARCDAT interruption interval Appropriate target value 25
Lv.2 Details To set the number of sheets as the intervals at which ARCDAT Default value 25
control is executed. Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> IMG-LSR> ARC-INT1
When the number of sheets reaches the specified value, ARCDAT T-8-54
control is executed by interrupting an ongoing job.
If the value is too large, the density of image becomes different
before and after the interruption.
If the value is too small, the productivity is lowered.
Actual setting value is calculated by dividing the entry value by 0.9
and rounding up after the decimal points. (e.g.: If an entry value is
100, setting value will be 112.)
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 5 to 1000
Unit 1 sheet
Appropriate target value 100
Default value 100
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> IMG-LSR> ARC-INT2

8-185
8
8
8-186
■■IMG-RDR COPIER > OPTION > IMG-RDR
DF2DSTL1 DADF dust dtct lvl adj at ppr intvl:bck
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-RDR Lv.1 Details To adjust dust detection level with dust detection correction control
DFDST-L1 DADF mode dust dtct level adj: ppr intvl that is executed at paper interval by the Scanner Unit (paper back) in
Lv.1 Details To adjust dust detection level with dust detection correction control DADF mode.
that is executed at paper interval in DADF mode. Reduce the value in the case of frequent display of cleaning
Reduce the value in the case of frequent display of cleaning instruction at the time of dust detection. As the value is smaller, the
instruction at the time of dust detection. As the value is smaller, the dust is less detected.
dust is less detected. Increase the value in the case of black lines. As the value is larger,
Increase the value in the case of black lines. As the value is larger, the small dust is more likely detected.
the small dust is more likely detected. Use case - When black line occurs due to dust
Use case - When black line occurs due to dust - Upon user’s request
- Upon user’s request Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Caution When increasing the value too much, the cleaning instruction screen
Caution When increasing the value too much, the cleaning instruction screen may appear too often since even small dust that will not be appeared
may appear too often since even small dust that will not be appeared on the image can be detected.
on the image can be detected. When reducing the value too much, black lines may appear on the
When reducing the value too much, black lines may appear on the image.
image. Display/adj/set range 1 to 255
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Default value 200
0: OFF Supplement/memo Black lines can appear on the image if there is dust. With dust
Default value 0 detection correction control, the image is corrected to prevent black
Supplement/memo Black lines can appear on the image if there is dust. With dust lines once dust is detected.
detection correction control, the image is corrected to prevent black DF2DSTL2 Adj DADF dust dtct level at job end:bck
lines once dust is detected. Lv.1 Details To adjust dust detection level with dust detection correction control
DFDST-L2 DADF mode dust dtct level adj: after job that is executed by the Scanner Unit (paper back) after the job is
Lv.1 Details To adjust dust detection level with dust detection correction control completed in DADF mode.
that is executed after the job is completed in DADF mode. Reduce the value in the case of frequent display of cleaning
Reduce the value in the case of frequent display of cleaning instruction at the time of dust detection. As the value is smaller, the
instruction at the time of dust detection. As the value is smaller, the dust is less detected.
dust is less detected. Increase the value in the case of black lines. As the value is larger,
Increase the value in the case of black lines. As the value is larger, the small dust is more likely detected.
the small dust is more likely detected. Use case - When black line occurs due to dust
Use case - When black line occurs due to dust - Upon user’s request
- Upon user’s request Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Caution When increasing the value too much, the cleaning instruction screen
Caution When increasing the value too much, the cleaning instruction screen may appear too often since even small dust that will not be appeared
may appear too often since even small dust that will not be appeared on the image can be detected.
on the image can be detected. When reducing the value too much, black lines may appear on the
When reducing the value too much, black lines may appear on the image.
image. Display/adj/set range 1 to 255
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255 Default value 200
0: OFF Supplement/memo Black lines can appear on the image if there is dust. With dust
Default value 0 detection correction control, the image is corrected to prevent black
Supplement/memo Black lines can appear on the image if there is dust. With dust lines once dust is detected.
detection correction control, the image is corrected to prevent black T-8-55
lines once dust is detected.

8-186
8
8
8-187
■■IMG-MCON COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON
PRN-FLG Select of image area flag (PDL image)
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON Lv.2 Details To set the image area flag for the image processing which is
PASCAL Use/no use of auto gradation adj data performed when a PDL image fails to be compressed at a specified
Lv.1 Details To set to use/not to use the gradation adjustment data gamma LUT compression rate.
that is generated by auto gradation adjustment (Full/Quick Adjust) If an image fails to be compressed at a specified compression rate,
control. the following operations are performed as default:
Selection is available as to whether to use gamma LUT at the time of - Processing to prioritize reproduction of text
image formation. - Replacing Bk color to black plain color
Use case When PASCAL-related failure occurs/when identifying the cause of Set 1 when moire occurs or jaggy is significant.
PASCAL-related failure Set 2 when not preferring to replace Bk color with black plain color.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case - When moire occurs or jaggy is significant in case of printing an
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. image containing many halftone dots or photos
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 - When avoiding to replace Bk color with black plain color
0: Initial LUT is used. (Automatic gradation adjustment is not used.) Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
1: Auto gradation adjustment is used. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2 to 3: Not used Caution This setting trades off with reproducibility of text.
Default value 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
SCR-SLCT Halftone process in Photo Printout mode 0: High screen ruling, gray compensation LUT
Lv.2 Details To set halftone process (error diffusion, screen 2 types) in Photo 1: Error diffusion, gray compensation LUT
Printout mode when making a copy. 2: High screen ruling, normal LUT
Change the setting if the copy image has a problem with the initial Default value 0
setting (Low screen ruling). SCN-FLG Select of image area flag (copy image)
Select 0 (error diffusion) in the case of moire (suitable for character Lv.2 Details To set the image area flag for the image processing which is
reproduction). performed when a scanned image fails to be compressed at a
Select 2 (High screen ruling) in the case of rough dots. specified compression rate.
Use case When moire image or rough dots occurs on copy image If an image fails to be compressed at a specified compression rate,
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. processing to prioritize reproduction of text is performed by default.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Set 1 when an image contains many halftone photos.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 Set 2 when an image contains many printed photos.
0: Error diffusion, 1: Low screen ruling, 2: High screen ruling Use case When copying an image which contains many halftone dots and
Default value 1 photos
Related user mode Function Settings> Copy> Photo Printout Mode Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
TMC-SLCT Setting of error diffusion coefficient 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.2 Details To set coefficient to be used for error diffusion process. Caution This setting trades off with reproducibility of text.
Specify according to the level of granularity and dot stability. Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 0: Text
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 1: Halftone photo image
Display/adj/set range 0: Small granularity/low dot stability 2: Printed photo
1: Small granularity/low dot stability (color mode), Large granularity/ Default value 0
high dot stability (B&W mode)
2: Large granularity/high dot stability
Default value 2

8-187
8
8
8-188
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON
TMIC-BK ON/OFF of TMIC Bk_LUT end edge correct MIX-FLG Set image composition image processing
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of the trailing edge adjustment of Bk_LUT for PDL Lv.2 Details To set the image processing which is performed when an image
and for copy which are used by TMIC. fails to be compressed at a specified compression rate by the Main
When the trailing edge adjustment is set to ON, the density of the Controller upon image composition.
high density area becomes high, and consequently text and thin Use case When an image processing failure occurs
lines become clear. While an image becomes clear, the hue of the Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
gradation area of photos, etc. is changed. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Use case When thin lines are partly missing or characters are faded Display/adj/set range 0 to 3
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 0: Equivalent to PDL text mode (Black text is reproduced with 4
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. colors. Error diffused image. The hue of the photo area is more vivid
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 than 2.)
0: ON for PDL, OFF for copy 1: Equivalent to PDL photo mode (Black text is reproduced with 4
1: OFF for PDL, OFF for copy colors. Screen processed image.)
2: ON for PDL, ON for copy 2: Equivalent to scanned text mode (Black text is reproduced with
3: OFF for PDL, ON for copy black plain color. Error diffused image. The hue of the photo area
Default value 2 might be different from 0.)
DH-MODE Set ptch data at Dhalf except full crrct 3: Equivalent to scanned photo mode (Black text is reproduced with
Lv.2 Details To set whether to use the high-density patch data that has been black plain color. Screen processed image.)
scanned by D-half control of full correction at the time of D-half Default value 0
control other than full correction. REPORT-Z Set of report print image processing
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.1 Details To set the image processing which is performed when printing a
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. report.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Use case When there is a request for image improvement
0: Used, 1: Not used Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
DH-TMG Set of auto D-half control exe interval Display/adj/set range 0 to 3
Lv.2 Details To set the paper interval to execute auto D-half control. 0: Equivalent to PDL text mode (Black text is reproduced with 4
D-half control is executed at the time of last rotation after completion colors. Error diffused image. The hue of the photo area is more vivid
of job with specified number of sheets. than 2.)
This item is enabled when “1: ON” is set in COPIER> OPTION> 1: Equivalent to PDL photo mode (Black text is reproduced with 4
FNC-SW> DH-SW. colors. Screen processed image.)
Use case Upon user’s request 2: Equivalent to scanned text mode (Black text is reproduced with
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. black plain color. Error diffused image. The hue of the photo area
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. might be different from 0.)
3: Equivalent to scanned photo mode (Black text is reproduced with
Display/adj/set range 500 to 2000
black plain color. Screen processed image.)
Unit 1 sheet
Default value 0
Default value 1000
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> FNC-SW> DH-SW

8-188
8
8
8-189
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON
IFXEML-Z Set clr iFAX,mail recv print img process REDU-CNT Set toner deposit amount limt at clr adj
Lv.1 Details To set the image processing which is performed when printing color Lv.2 Details To set whether to limit the toner deposit amount at color adjustment
iFAX or received mail. (color balance, fine adjustment of density).
Use case When there is a request for image improvement When 1 is set, the color adjustment value is reflected to an image
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. precisely, but toner scattering in the Transfer Assembly and Fixing
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Assembly might occur, and paper might wind around the Fixing
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 Assembly.
0: Equivalent to PDL text mode (Black text is reproduced with 4 When COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> IMGC-ADJ is set to 1, this
colors. Error diffused image. The hue of the photo area is more vivid setting can be also made in the user mode.
than 2.) Use case - Upon user’s request
1: Equivalent to PDL photo mode (Black text is reproduced with 4 - When reflecting the color adjustment value to an image precisely
colors. Screen processed image.) Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2: Equivalent to scanned text mode (Black text is reproduced with 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
black plain color. Error diffused image. The hue of the photo area Caution When 1 is set, toner scattering in the Transfer Assembly and Fixing
might be different from 0.) Assembly might occur, and paper might wind around the Fixing
3: Equivalent to scanned photo mode (Black text is reproduced with Assembly.
black plain color. Screen processed image.) Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0 0: Toner deposit amount is limited to the specified amount.
BMLNKS-Z Set BMLinkS reception print img process 1: Toner deposit amount is not limited.
Lv.1 Details To set the image processing which is performed when printing Default value 1
received BMLinkS. Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> IMGC-ADJ
Use case When there is a request for image improvement Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Density Adjustment
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Mode
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. VP-ART Setting of line art processing
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 Lv.2 Details To make a setting for outline processing for line art on scalable PDF.
0: Equivalent to PDL text mode (Black text is reproduced with 4 In the outline processing, a binary image outline is extracted in the
colors. Error diffused image. The hue of the photo area is more vivid field which is recognized as line art, and is converted into vector
than 2.) data.
1: Equivalent to PDL photo mode (Black text is reproduced with 4 Specify whether to convert the binary image outline into vector data
colors. Screen processed image.) or to recognize it as one line (as a thin line). For the thin line, the line
2: Equivalent to scanned text mode (Black text is reproduced with width can be specified.
black plain color. Error diffused image. The hue of the photo area Change this value when you want to obtain an output of a wide-width
might be different from 0.) line as one line rather than as an outline (when you want to prioritize
3: Equivalent to scanned photo mode (Black text is reproduced with edit operation as a line rather than image quality).
black plain color. Screen processed image.) Use case Upon user’s request
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Supplement/memo BMLinkS (Business Machine Linkage Service): An integrated 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
network OA device interface Display/adj/set range 0 to 99
Default value 1

8-189
8
8
8-190
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON
VP-TXT Setting of character vectorization REGM-SEL Adj of fine-line density correction
Lv.2 Details To make a setting of vector conversion processing for text on Lv.2 Details To adjust the line and text density which is set in the thin line density
scalable PDF. adjustment UI.
In the vector conversion processing, a binary image outline is Set 4 if density is too low even though +2 is set in the thin line
extracted in the field which is recognized as text, and is converted density adjustment UI.
into vector data. Set 0 if density is too high even though -2 is set in the thin line
In regular vector conversion, function approximation is not used for density adjustment UI.
small text because the image quality is not changed. Use case When line and text adjusted by thin line density adjustment is too
When the value is changed, function approximation processing is dark or too light in the case of 1200 dpi print
executed for small text, which realizes smooth text although the Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
image quality is changed. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Change this value when you want to prioritize smoothness in small Display/adj/set range 0 to 4
text. Default value 2
Use case Upon user’s request Supplement/memo REGM-SEL: REos GaMma SELect
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. SCR-SW Set of low screen ruling dither
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To set the dithering method for low screen ruling.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99 When changing the value, confirm the change by setting “1: Low
Default value 1 screen ruling” in COPIER> TEST> PG> TXPH.
PASCL-TY Paper setting for auto gradation adj Use case Upon user’s request (Dot dithering is used)
Lv.2 Details Auto gradation adjustment is normally executed with the Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
recommended paper specified for each location. However, if you 2) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation (Full Adjust).
want to change the paper type, use this setting to change the paper Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
type. 0: Line dithering, 1: Dot dithering
Use case When executing the auto gradation adjustment using a paper other Default value 0
than the recommended paper type
Related service mode COPIER> TEST> PG> TXPH
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Do not change the setting in the normal operation.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 3
1: CS-814 (Except for USA and EU. Mainly for Japan)
2: Hammermill (For USA)
3: Mondi (For EU)
Default value The value differs according to the location.
P-ALPHA [Not used]
AST-SEL Adj of advanced smoothing effect
Lv.2 Details To adjust the smoothing effect which is set in the advanced
smoothing UI.
Set 3 if no smoothing effect is obtained even though Strong is set in
the advanced smoothing UI.
Set 0 if too much effect is obtained even though Weak is set in the
advanced smoothing UI.
Use case When image failures (jaggy, moire) occur
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3
Default value 2
Supplement/memo AST: Advanced Smoothing Technology

8-190
8
8
8-191
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON COPIER > OPTION > IMG-MCON
ERS-SEL1 Set 1200 dpi ERS process:PS Expnsn Kit ERS-SEL2 Set 1200 dpi ERS process: print server
Lv.1 Details To change the ERS processing when the hue of patterned graphics Lv.1 Details To change the ERS processing when the hue of patterned graphics
is changed according to phase in the case of making 1200-dpi output is changed according to phase in the case of making 1200-dpi output
with the PS Expansion Kit installed. through connection to the print server.
The processing is changed only for graphics and images, and ERS Set 1 when the aforementioned symptom occurs.
weighting processing is performed to characters even if the setting is Set 3 if the proportion of small characters is distorted after 1 is set.
changed. Set 5 if the color of graphics is not stabilized after 1 or 3 is set. In this
Set 1 when the aforementioned symptom occurs. setting, however, a thin line of a single line disappears.
Set 3 if the proportion of small characters is distorted after 1 is set. Use case When the hue is changed according to phase when making 1200-dpi
Set 5 if the color of graphics is not stabilized after 1 or 3 is set. In this output
setting, however, a thin line of a single line disappears. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When the hue is changed according to phase when making 1200-dpi 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
output Display/adj/set range 0 to 5
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. The following processing are performed to characters, graphics, and
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. images respectively:
Display/adj/set range 0 to 7 0: ERS (weighting), Max skipping, simple skipping
The following processing are performed to graphics and images 1: ERS (average), ERS (average), simple skipping
respectively: 2: ERS (average), ERS (average), ERS (average)
0: Max skipping, simple skipping 3: ERS (weighting), ERS (weighting), simple skipping
1: ERS (average), simple skipping 4: ERS (weighting), ERS (weighting), ERS (weighting)
2: ERS (average), ERS (average) 5: ERS (weighting), simple skipping, simple skipping
3: ERS (weighting), simple skipping Appropriate target value 0
4: ERS (weighting), ERS (weighting) Default value 0
5: Simple skipping, simple skipping CL-RDCTN High compress PDF TX clr reduct mode
6, 7: Not used Lv.1 Details To set whether to execute the color reduction processing mode at
Appropriate target value 0 high compression PDF (text mode) transmission.
Default value 0 Set 1 when image quality is deteriorated at high compression PDF
(text mode) transmission. Image quality is improved by executing the
color reduction processing mode.
Use case Upon user’s request (improvement of image quality)
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0
T-8-56

8-191
8
8
8-192
■■IMG-DEV COPIER > OPTION > IMG-DEV
DVTGT-K Set ATR Sensr (Bk) gain value offset
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-DEV Lv.2 Details To actually correct the T/D ratio by setting the offset to the gain value
DRM-IDL Set first idle rotn time in HH Ev of ATR Sensor (Bk).
Lv.1 Details To set the idle rotation time to be performed first time for the day in As the value is increased (increasing the T/D ratio), the screw pitch
an HH (high temperature and high humidity) environment. unevenness is alleviated; however, fogging may occur.
Use case When coarseness occurs on the image first time for the day If the value is changed, the target value for T/D ratio is also changed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. so that the toner ejection sequence needs to be forcibly executed to
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. stabilize the T/D ratio.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 The value returns to 0 when the Process Unit is replaced.
0: OFF, 1: ON (HH environment only), 2: ON (all environments) Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
DEVL-VTH Set toner ejectn image duty threshold VL Caution When the value is changed, execute the toner ejection sequence.
Lv.2 Details To set the threshold value of the image duty, which is the condition to Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
perform the low duty toner ejection sequence. Default value 0
As the value is larger, coarseness is decreased, but productivity is DVTGT-Y Set ATR Sensr (Y) gain value offset
lowered and toner consumption is increased. Lv.2 Details To actually correct the T/D ratio by setting the offset to the gain value
As the value is smaller, productivity and toner consumption are of ATR Sensor (Y).
improved, but coarseness is worsened. As the value is increased (increasing the T/D ratio), the screw pitch
Use case When printing low duty (low image ratio) images, unevenness is alleviated; however, fogging may occur.
- graininess (coarseness) occurs If the value is changed, the target value for T/D ratio is also changed
- low productivity or high toner consumption is pointed out by the so that the toner ejection sequence needs to be forcibly executed to
user stabilize the T/D ratio.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. The value returns to 0 when the Process Unit is replaced.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -1 to 2 Caution When the value is changed, execute the toner ejection sequence.
-1: -1 %, 0: 0 %, 1: +1 %, 2: +2 % Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> IMG-DEV> DEVL-PTH DVTGT-M Set ATR Sensr (M) gain value offset
INTPPR-1 Set Wire clean interval in ppr interval Lv.2 Details To actually correct the T/D ratio by setting the offset to the gain value
Lv.2 Details To set the paper interval for automatic cleaning of the Primary of ATR Sensor (M).
Charging Wire and Pre-transfer Charging Wire. As the value is increased (increasing the T/D ratio), the screw pitch
Display/adj/set range 50 to 1000 unevenness is alleviated; however, fogging may occur.
Unit 1 sheet If the value is changed, the target value for T/D ratio is also changed
Default value 200 so that the toner ejection sequence needs to be forcibly executed to
stabilize the T/D ratio.
The value returns to 0 when the Process Unit is replaced.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution When the value is changed, execute the toner ejection sequence.
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
Default value 0

8-192
8
8
8-193
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-DEV COPIER > OPTION > IMG-DEV
DVTGT-C Set ATR Sensr (C) gain value offset PCHINT-V Adj ATR patch VD counter total VL intvl
Lv.2 Details To actually correct the T/D ratio by setting the offset to the gain value Lv.2 Details To adjust the interval of the total video counter value which patch
of ATR Sensor (C). detection is performed by ATR control.
As the value is increased (increasing the T/D ratio), the screw pitch If the hue variation is significant, decrease the value.
unevenness is alleviated; however, fogging may occur. To reduce the downtime, increase the value.
If the value is changed, the target value for T/D ratio is also changed Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
so that the toner ejection sequence needs to be forcibly executed to 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
stabilize the T/D ratio. Display/adj/set range 0 to 5
The value returns to 0 when the Process Unit is replaced. Default value 2
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. DELV-THY Set of Y toner ejection exe image ratio
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.2 Details To set the threshold value of average image ratio to execute Y toner
Caution When the value is changed, execute the toner ejection sequence. ejection.
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3 As the value is incremented by 1, the ratio is increased by 1%.
Default value 0 Increase the value when fogging occurs at a large volume printing of
DEVL-PTH Set sheet threshold VL of toner ejection low duty image.
Lv.1 Details To set the threshold value of time interval, which is the condition to Decrease the value when users care about the amount of waste
perform the low duty toner ejection sequence. toner compared to the low duty image output.
As the value is smaller, coarseness is decreased, but productivity is Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
lowered and toner consumption is increased. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
As the value is larger, productivity and toner consumption are Display/adj/set range 0 to 10
enhanced, but coarseness is worsened. 0: 0%, 1: 1%, 2: 2%, 3 to 10: Not used
Use case While printing low duty (low image ratio) images, Default value 2
- graininess (coarseness) occurs DELV-THC Set of C toner ejection exe image ratio
- low productivity or high toner consumption is pointed out by the Lv.2 Details To set the threshold value of average image ratio to execute C toner
user ejection.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. As the value is incremented by 1, the ratio is increased by 1%.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Increase the value when fogging occurs at a large volume printing of
Caution Do not use this when the machine is operating correctly. low duty image.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 Decrease the value when users care about the amount of waste
0: 100 seconds, 1: 200 seconds, 2: 300 seconds toner compared to the low duty image output.
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> IMG-DEV> DEVL-VTH 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
PCHINT-1 ATR patch ppr interval adj (1st limit) Display/adj/set range 0 to 10
Lv.2 Details To adjust the paper interval which patch detection is performed by 0: 0%, 1: 1%, 2: 2%, 3 to 10: Not used
ATR control. (1st limit) Default value 2
If the hue variation is significant, decrease the value.
To reduce the downtime, increase the value.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 5
Default value 2

8-193
8
8
8-194
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-DEV COPIER > OPTION > IMG-DEV
DELV-THM Set of M toner ejection exe image ratio PAP-W-EN Solid image uneven dens reduction mode
Lv.2 Details To set the threshold value of average image ratio to execute M toner Lv.1 Details [Not used] If developer to supply to the Developing Cylinder is not
ejection. even, uneven density occurs on the solid image. To make developer
As the value is incremented by 1, the ratio is increased by 1%. even, enlarge the image interval to secure the rotation time of the
Increase the value when fogging occurs at a large volume printing of Toner Feed Screw.
low duty image. As the value is increased, the image interval (paper interval) is
Decrease the value when users care about the amount of waste widen.
toner compared to the low duty image output. If uneven density is seen, such as darker left edge on the solid
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. image, increase the value.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When uneven density occurs on solid image
Display/adj/set range 0 to 10 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: 0%, 1: 1%, 2: 2%, 3 to 10: Not used 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 2 Display/adj/set range 0 to 10
DELV-THK Set of Bk toner ejection exe image ratio Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To set the threshold value of average image ratio to execute Bk toner PTN-LVL Grass-like line level setting
ejection. Lv.1 Details To change the potential as a countermeasure against grass-like line.
As the value is incremented by 1, the ratio is increased by 1%. As the value is increased, the grass-like line is alleviated; however,
Increase the value when fogging occurs at a large volume printing of toner consumption increases.
low duty image. Increase the value when grass-like line occurs at HT output on the
Decrease the value when users care about the amount of waste image lead edge.
toner compared to the low duty image output. Decrease the value if users do not output HT on the image leading
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. edge or they do not care about grass-like line and also, they want to
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. reduce the toner consumption.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 10 Use case When grass-like line occurs at image leading edge HT
0: 0%, 1: 1%, 2: 2%, 3 to 10: Not used Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 2 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
ADJ-VPP Adj of developing AC bias Vpp Display/adj/set range -1 to 1
Lv.2 Details To adjust Vpp of the developing AC bias. Default value 0
Ring marks are alleviated when the value is decreased in the - DMX-OF-Y Adjustment of Y color D-max setting
direction, and white spots are alleviated when the value is increased Lv.2 Details When adjusting D-max control setting in case that density of solid
in the + direction. area on yellow color image is not appropriate even performing auto
Use case When image failures (ring marks, white spots) occur gradation adjustment.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value
press OK key. when the density is high.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When density of solid area on an image is not appropriate even
3) Execute Auto Adjust Gradation > Full Adjust. performing auto gradation adjustment
Caution When the value is decreased too much in the - direction, density Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
might be lowered. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -2 to 0 3) Execute auto gradation adjustment.
Default value Caution Be sure to execute auto gradation adjustment (full adjustment) after
the setting is done.
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
Default value 0

8-194
8
8
8-195
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-DEV ■■IMG-TR
DMX-OF-M Adjustment of M color D-max setting
Lv.2 Details When adjusting D-max control setting in case that density of solid
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-TR
area on magenta color image is not appropriate even performing 2TR-RVON ON/OFF end edge white spot crrct scrn
auto gradation adjustment. Lv.2 Details To set whether to display the screen to set ON/OFF of the paper
Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value trailing edge weak bias in user mode.
when the density is high. When 1 is set, trailing edge white spot correction screen is displayed
Use case When density of solid area on an image is not appropriate even in user mode. If ON is set in this screen, weak bias is applied to
performing auto gradation adjustment the paper trailing edge, and white spots at the trailing edge are
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. alleviated.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case Upon user’s request (when white spots occur at the trailing edge)
3) Execute auto gradation adjustment. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution Be sure to execute auto gradation adjustment (full adjustment) after 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
the setting is done. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3 0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0 Default value 0
DMX-OF-C Adjustment of C color D-max setting Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> IMGC-ADJ
Lv.2 Details When adjusting D-max control setting in case that density of solid Related user mode Adjustment/ Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Tail End White
area on cyan color image is not appropriate even performing auto Patch Correct
gradation adjustment. ITB-TYPE Setting of ITB thickness
Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value Lv.2 Details To set thickness of the ITB to be used.
when the density is high. Setting value of the primary transfer current differs depending on the
Use case When density of solid area on an image is not appropriate even thickness of ITB.
performing auto gradation adjustment Use case When replacing the ITB
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Caution After the setting is changed, execute the following procedures.
3) Execute auto gradation adjustment. 1) Service mode: COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> INTR-EX
Caution Be sure to execute auto gradation adjustment (full adjustment) after 2) User mode: Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto
the setting is done. Adjust Gradation> Full Adjust
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3 Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Default value 0 0: Thick (old belt)
DMX-OF-K Adjustment of Bk color D-max setting 1: Thin (new belt) + old Primary Transfer Roller (8 mm shaft dia.)
Lv.2 Details When adjusting D-max control setting in case that density of solid 2: Thin (new belt) + new Primary Transfer Roller (6 mm shaft dia.)
area on black color image is not appropriate even performing auto Default value 1
gradation adjustment. Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> INTR-EX
Increase the value when the density is low and decrease the value Related user mode Adjustment/Maintenance> Adjust Image Quality> Auto Adjust
when the density is high. Gradation> Full Adjust
Use case When density of solid area on an image is not appropriate even T-8-58
performing auto gradation adjustment
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
3) Execute auto gradation adjustment.
Caution Be sure to execute auto gradation adjustment (full adjustment) after
the setting is done.
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
Default value 0
T-8-57

8-195
8
8
8-196
■■IMG-FIX COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX
TMP-TBL3 Setting of fixing control temp: heavy 2
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for heavy paper 2 (164
AUTO-DH ON/OFF of Drum clean at warm-up rotation to 209 g/m2).
Lv.1 Details To set OFF/ON of the Photosensitive Drum cleaning at warm-up As the value is increased by 1, the control temperature is increased
rotations. by 5 deg C.
When setting “1: ON”, set the cleaning time in increments of 1 Increase the value when the fixing failure occurs.
second with D-CLN-TM. Decrease the value when the fixing offset occurs.
Use case When image smear occurs in a HH environment Use case When the offset or fixing failure occurs on heavy paper 2
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
0: OFF, 1: ON (HH environment only), 2: ON (all environments) -2: -10 deg C, -1: -10 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C
Default value 0 Unit 5 deg C
FX-S-TMP Setting of ITOP control temp: plain ppr Default value 0
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for plain paper (64 to TMP-TBL4 Setting of fixing control temp: heavy 3
81g/m2) in 1/1 speed. Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for heavy paper 3 (210
As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is to 256 g/m2).
increased by 5 deg C. As the value is increased by 1, the control temperature is increased
Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading by 5 deg C.
edge on plain paper Increase the value when the fixing failure occurs.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Decrease the value when the fixing offset occurs.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When the offset or fixing failure occurs on heavy paper 3
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: 5 deg C, 2: 10 deg C 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Unit 5 deg C Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
Default value 0 -2: -10 deg C, -1: -10 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C
TMP-TBL2 Setting of fixing control temp: heavy 1 Unit 5 deg C
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for heavy paper 1 (106 Default value 0
to 163 g/m2). TMP-TBL5 Setting of fixing control temp: thin ppr
As the value is increased by 1, the control temperature is increased Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for thin paper (52 to 63
by 5 deg C. g/m2).
Increase the value when the fixing failure occurs. As the value is increased by 1, the control temperature is increased
Decrease the value when the fixing offset occurs. by 5 deg C.
Use case When the offset or fixing failure occurs on heavy paper 1 Increase the value when the fixing failure occurs.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Decrease the value when the fixing offset occurs.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When the offset or fixing failure occurs on thin paper
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -10 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Unit 5 deg C Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
Default value 0 -2: -10 deg C, -1: -10 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C
Unit 5 deg C
Default value 0

8-196
8
8
8-197
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX
TMP-TBL6 Setting of fixing control temp: envelope FXS-TMP4 Setting of ITOP control temp: heavy 3
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for envelope. Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for heavy paper 3 (210
As the value is increased by 1, the control temperature is increased to 256 g/m2).
by 5 deg C. As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is
Increase the value when the fixing failure occurs. increased by 5 deg C.
Decrease the value when the fixing offset occurs. Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading
Use case When the offset or fixing failure occurs on envelope edge on heavy paper 3
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -10 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C -2: -15 deg C, -1: -7 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C
Unit 5 deg C Unit 5 deg C
Default value 0 Default value 0
FXS-TMP2 Setting of ITOP control temp: heavy 1 FXS-TMP5 Setting of ITOP control temp: thin ppr
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for heavy paper 1(106 Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for thin paper.
to 163 g/m2). As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is
As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is increased by 5 deg C.
increased by 5 deg C. Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading
Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading edge on thin paper
edge on heavy paper 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 -2: -15 deg C, -1: -7 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C
-2: -15 deg C, -1: -7 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C Unit 5 deg C
Unit 5 deg C Default value 0
Default value 0 FXS-TMP6 Setting of ITOP control temp: envelope
FXS-TMP3 Setting of ITOP control temp: heavy 2 Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for envelope.
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for heavy paper 2 (164 As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is
to 209 g/m2). increased by 5 deg C.
As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading
increased by 5 deg C. edge on envelope
Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
edge on heavy paper 2 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. -2: -10 deg C, H1436-1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 deg C
-2: -15 deg C, -1: -7 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C Unit 5 deg C
Unit 5 deg C Default value 0
Default value 0

8-197
8
8
8-198
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX
FXST2-N2 Set plain paper ITOP standby time: LL ev TMP-TBL7 Fixing control temperature setting: pln2
Lv.1 Details To set the time for initial rotation when feeding the plain paper 1/plain Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for plain paper 2 (82 to
paper 2 in 18 deg C or lower temperature. 105 g/m2).
Increase the value when the fixing failure occurs. As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is
Use case When a fixing failure occurs in LL environment increased by 5 deg C.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Increase the value when fixing failure occurs.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Decrease the value, when fixing offset occurs.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 20 Use case When offset/fixing failure occurs on plain paper 2
Unit 1 second Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
FXST2-UH Set heavy ppr ITOP standby time: LL ev Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
Lv.1 Details To set the time for initial rotation when feeding the heavy paper 1/2/3 -2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C
in 18 deg C or lower temperature. Unit 5 deg C
Increase the value when the fixing failure occurs. Default value 0
Use case When a fixing failure occurs in LL environment TMP-TBL8 Fixing control temperature set: transp
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for transparency.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is
Display/adj/set range 0 to 30 increased by 5 deg C.
Unit 1 second Increase the value when fixing failure occurs.
Decrease the value, when fixing offset occurs.
Default value 0
Use case When offset/fixing failure occurs on transparency
FN-ENTMP Set of Fixing Cooling Fan ON/OFF temp
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To set the ON/OFF temperature of Fixing Cooling Fan (Front/Rear).
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
As the value is incremented by 1, the temperature is increased by 5
deg C. Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C
Use case When fixing offset/fixing failure occurs at the edge of small size
paper Unit 5 deg C
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. TMP-TBL9 Fixing control temperature setting:coat1
Display/adj/set range -4 to 4 Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for coated paper 1 (106
-4: -20 deg C, -3: -15 deg C, -2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: to 163 g/m2).
5 deg C, 2: 10 deg C, 3: 15 deg C, 4: 20 deg C As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is
Unit 5 deg C increased by 5 deg C.
Increase the value when fixing failure occurs.
Default value 0
Decrease the value, when fixing offset occurs.
FLYING ON/OFF of flying start temperature ctrl
Use case When offset/fixing failure occurs on coated paper 1
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of flying start temperature control.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
When “1” is set, the flying start temperature control is not executed.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
This is more life-conscious for Fixing Assembly compared to “0”.
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
Use case When preferring to extend the life of Fixing Assembly. However,
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C
setting of “1” does not mean that the life of Fixing Assembly is always
extended. Unit 5 deg C
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution When “1” is set, FPOT is reduced.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: ON, 1: OFF
Default value 0

8-198
8
8
8-199
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX
TMP-TB10 Fixing control temperature setting:coat2 FXS-TM10 Setting of ITOP control temp: coat2
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for coated paper2 (164 Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for coated paper 2 (164
to 209 g/m2). to 209 g/m2).
As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is
increased by 5 deg C. increased by 5 deg C.
Increase the value when fixing failure occurs. Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading
Decrease the value, when fixing offset occurs. edge on coated paper 2
Use case When offset/fixing failure occurs on coated paper 2 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 -2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: 5 deg C, 2: 10 deg C
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C Unit 5 deg C
Unit 5 deg C Default value 0
Default value 0 FXS-TMP9 Setting of ITOP control temp: coat1
FXS-TMP7 Setting of ITOP control temp: plain ppr2 Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for coated paper 1 (106
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for plain paper 2 (82 to to 163 g/m2).
105 g/m2). As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is
As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is increased by 5 deg C.
increased by 5 deg C. Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading
Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading edge on coated paper 1
edge on plain paper 2 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range -2 to 2
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 -2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: 5 deg C, 2: 10 deg C
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: 5 deg C, 2: 10 deg C Unit 5 deg C
Unit 5 deg C Default value 0
Default value 0 THIN-LP Set of fixing arch ctrl with thin paper
FXS-TMP8 Setting of ITOP control temp: transp Lv.2 Details To set the arch control method between the secondary transfer and
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for transparency. fixing when feeding thin paper (52g/m2).
As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is Normally, the arch control is executed at the point where arch on the
increased by 5 deg C. trailing edge of paper is small.
Use case When uneven gloss occurs in the area that is 94mm from the leading When 1 is set in the case that an image failure (crepe mark) occurs
edge on transparency with thin paper, the control is always executed at the point where the
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. arch on a paper is large while feeding thin paper.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When an image failure (crepe mark) occurs with thin paper
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: 5 deg C, 2: 10 deg C Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Unit 5 deg C 0: Arch control at the point where arch is small, 1: Arch control to
Default value 0 make the arch large with thin paper
Default value 0

8-199
8
8
8-200
COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX COPIER > OPTION > IMG-FIX
TMP-TB11 Fixing control temperature:Recycled ppr FXTBL-SW Set fixing temp control table: Plain 1
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of fixing control temperature for recycled paper (52 Lv.2 Details To set the fixing temperature control table for plain paper 1 (64 to
to 105g/m2). 81g/m2).
As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is When mottled image occurs on the plain paper 1 regardless of
increased by 5 deg C. appropriate temperature of the Fixing Assembly, set 1. When plain
Increase the value when a fixing failure occurs. paper 1 is fed, the fixing temperature control table for recycled paper
Decrease the value when fixing offset occurs. is applied. However, for the fixing control temperature and ITOP
Use case When offset/fixing failure occurs on recycled paper control temperature, the offset setting for plain paper 1 (TEMP-TBL
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. and FX-S-TMP) is reflected.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When mottle image occurs on the plain paper while the Fixing
Display/adj/set range -3 to 2 Assembly is hot, the fixing temperature control table for plain paper 1
-3: -15 deg C, -2: -10 deg C, -1: -10 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: is switched to the one for recycled paper.
+10 deg C Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Unit 5 deg C Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0 0: For plain paper 1, 1: For recycled paper
FXS-TM11 ITOP control temperature:Recycled ppr Default value 0
Lv.1 Details To set the offset of ITOP control temperature for recycled paper (52 Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> CUSTOM> TEMP-TBL
to 105g/m2). COPIER> OPTION> IMG-FIX> FX-S-TMP
As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is T-8-59
increased by 5 deg C.
Increase the value when a fixing failure occurs on the leading edge
of paper.
Decrease the value when uneven gloss occurs on the leading edge
(94mm).
Use case - When a fixing failure occurs on the leading edge of paper
- When uneven gloss occurs on the leading edge (94mm)
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range -3 to 2
-3: -15 deg C, -2: -10 deg C, -1: -10 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2:
+10 deg C
Unit 5 deg C
Default value 0

8-200
8
8
8-201
■■CUSTOM COPIER > OPTION > CUSTOM
ABK-TOOL Allow access from address book mntc tool
COPIER > OPTION > CUSTOM Lv.1 Details To set whether to accept import from the address book maintenance
TEMP-TBL Fixing control temperature setting: pln1 tool.
Lv.1 Details To set the fixing control temperature for plain paper 1 (64 to 81 g/ Use case When executing import from the address book maintenance tool
m2). Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
As the value is incremented by 1, the control temperature is 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
increased by 5 deg C.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Increase the value when fixing failure occurs.
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Decrease the value, when fixing offset occurs.
Default value 0
Use case When offset/fixing failure occurs on plain paper 1.
Supplement/memo Address book maintenance tool: Tool provided from CMJ.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value (switch negative/positive by -/+ key) and
DEV-SP1 Device special settings 1
press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.2 Details To execute the device special settings.
Display/adj/set range -2 to 2 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
-2: -10 deg C, -1: -5 deg C, 0: 0 deg C, 1: +5 deg C, 2: +10 deg C 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Unit 5 deg C Caution Change the setting value in accordance with the instructions from
the Quality Support Division.
Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 00000000 to 11111111
SC-L-CNT Set large paper jdgmt reference at scan
Unit bit
Lv.1 Details To set the judgment reference of the scan counter as to which to use
B4 or LTR to determine large size. Default value 00000000
The threshold is determined by the combination with the setting of DEV-SP2 Device special settings 2
B4-L-CNT. Lv.2 Details To execute the device special settings.
SC-L-CNT=0, B4-L-CNT=0: paper exceeding B4 is determined as Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
large size, paper with B4 or smaller is determined as small size. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
SC-L-CNT=0, B4-L-CNT=1: paper with B4 or larger is determined as Caution Change the setting value in accordance with the instructions from
large size, paper smaller than B4 is determined as small size. the Quality Support Division.
Use case As needed Display/adj/set range 00000000 to 11111111
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Unit bit
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 00000000
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 DEV-SP3 Device special settings 3
0: B4 size, 1: LTR size Lv.2 Details To execute the device special settings.
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> USER> B4-L-CNT 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
SCANTYPE Switch of DADF + Reader Caution Change the setting value in accordance with the instructions from
Lv.1 Details To switch to a different type DADF + Reader Unit. the Quality Support Division.
Use case At installation Display/adj/set range 00000000 to 11111111
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Unit bit
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 00000000
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 DEV-SP4 Device special settings 4
0: Reverse Duplex ADF+Reader, 1: 1-Path Duplex ADF+Reader Lv.2 Details To execute the device special settings.
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Change the setting value in accordance with the instructions from
the Quality Support Division.
Display/adj/set range 00000000 to 11111111
Unit bit
Default value 00000000

8-201
8
8
8-202
COPIER > OPTION > CUSTOM COPIER > OPTION > CUSTOM
DEV-SP5 Device special settings 5 USEUPTNR Set Toner Container use-up mode
Lv.2 Details To execute the device special settings. Lv.1 Details To set operation when Toner Container is used up.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When the machine is slanted, it is judged that toner in the Toner
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Container is empty before actual life.
Caution Change the setting value in accordance with the instructions from When 2 is set, the Toner Container Motor is driven longer than when
the Quality Support Division. setting to 1, so toner in the Toner Container can be used up more.
Display/adj/set range 00000000 to 11111111 Use case Upon user’s request
Unit bit Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 00000000 Caution When high duty image is printed frequently, downtime may occur.
DEV-SP6 Device special settings 6 Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Lv.2 Details To execute the device special settings. 0: Not used, 1: 50 turns, 2: 80 turns
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. T-8-60

Caution Change the setting value in accordance with the instructions from
the Quality Support Division.
Display/adj/set range 00000000 to 11111111
Unit bit
Default value 00000000
DEV-SP7 Device special settings 7
Lv.2 Details To execute the device special settings.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Change the setting value in accordance with the instructions from
the Quality Support Division.
Display/adj/set range 00000000 to 11111111
Unit bit
Default value 00000000
DEV-SP8 Device special settings 8
Lv.2 Details To execute the device special settings.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Change the setting value in accordance with the instructions from
the Quality Support Division.
Display/adj/set range 00000000 to 11111111
Unit bit
Default value 00000000

8-202
8
8
8-203
■■USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
COUNTER3 Setting of software counter 3
COPIER>OPTION>USER Lv.1 Details To set counter type for software counter 3 on the Counter Check
COPY-LIM Setting of upper limit for copy screen.
Lv.1 Details To set the upper limit value for copy. Use case Upon user/dealer’s request
Use case Upon user’s request Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 999
Display/adj/set range 1 to 9999 0: Not registered
Default value 999 Default value The value differs according to the location.
SLEEP Setting of auto sleep function COUNTER4 Setting of software counter 4
Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF of auto sleep function. Lv.1 Details To set counter type for software counter 4 on the Counter Check
Use case Upon user’s request screen.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case Upon user/dealer’s request
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: OFF, 1: ON Display/adj/set range 0 to 999
Default value 1 0: Not registered
Supplement/memo Transfer time to sleep mode is set in the user mode (Preferences> Default value The value differs according to the location.
Timer/Energy Settings> Auto Sleep Time). COUNTER5 Setting of software counter 5
SIZE-DET ON/OFF of original size detect function Lv.1 Details To set counter type for software counter 5 on the Counter Check
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of original size detection function. screen.
Use case Upon user’s request (glare of the scan lamp, etc) Use case Upon user/dealer’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 999
0: OFF, 1: ON 0: Not registered
Default value 1 Default value 0
COUNTER1 Display of software counter 1 COUNTER6 Setting of software counter 6
Lv.1 Details To display counter type for software counter 1 on the Counter Check Lv.1 Details To set counter type for software counter 6 on the Counter Check
screen. screen.
Use case Upon user/dealer’s request Use case Upon user/dealer’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution Display only. No change is available. Display/adj/set range 0 to 999
Display/adj/set range 0 to 999 0: Not registered
0: Not registered Default value 0
Default value The value differs according to the location.
COUNTER2 Setting of software counter 2
Lv.1 Details To set counter type for software counter 2 on the Counter Check
screen.
Use case Upon user/dealer’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 999
0: Not registered
Default value The value differs according to the location.

8-203
8
8
8-204
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
DATE-DSP Setting of data/time display format TRY-STP Stop setting at finisher tray full
Lv.2 Details To set date/time display format according to the country or region. Lv.2 Details To set to stop/continue output at the time of tray full detection of the
After the display format is set with this mode, the order of date is Finisher.
reflected to the followings: Preferences > Timer/Energy Settings > Use case Upon user’s request
Date/Time Settings, and report output. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case Upon user’s request 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 0: At tray full detection, 1: Height detection only
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 Default value 0
0: YYMM/DD, 1: DD/MMYY, 2: MM/DD/YY MF-LG-ST Dis/hide of long strip mode
Default value The value differs according to the location. Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the [Long Original] button.
Related user mode Preferences > Timer/Energy Settings > Date/Time Settings When 1 is set, [Long Original] button is displayed in Copy > Options
MB-CCV Control card usage limit for Mail Box screen and the long strip paper becomes available.
Lv.2 Details To restrict use of control card for Mail Box.
Use case Upon user’s request Use case Upon user’s request. (use of long strip original or long strip paper)
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Caution Long strip paper is ejected from Secondary Delivery Mouth (excluding
0: Unlimited, 1: Limited delivery from Inner Finisher).
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
CONTROL Charge setting of PDL job 0: Hide, 1: Display
Lv.1 Details To set charge count transmission of PDL job to the connecting Default value 0
charging management device (coin manager or non-Canon-made Related user mode Copy > Options
control card). CNT-DISP Display/hide of serial No.
Use case Upon user’s request Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the serial No. on the Counter Check
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. screen.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When setting to display/hide serial No. on the Counter Check screen
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: No charge, 1: Charge 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
B4-L-CNT Count setting of B4 size 0: Display, 1: Hide
Lv.1 Details To set B4 count with software counter 1 to 8 as to whether B4 is Default value 0
counted as large size or small size. COPY-JOB Setting of copy job reservation
Selecting 1 counts B4 or larger size paper as large size while paper Lv.1 Details To set to enable/disable copy job reservation when the Card Reader/
smaller than B4 size as small size. Coin Manager is used.
Use case Upon user’s request Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Small size, 1: Large size 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
Default value 0 Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> CUSTOM> SC-L-CNT

8-204
8
8
8-205
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
OP-SZ-DT Orgnl size dtct ON/OFF at copyboard open JOB-INVL Job intvl setting at interruption copy
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of original size detection while the Copyboard is Lv.2 Details To set output interval between jobs at the time of interruption copy.
opened. Sorting is difficult after interruption copy because of the continuous
When “0: OFF” is set, enter original size manually from the Control output of the next job. Paper interval becomes longer when starting
Panel. pickup for the next job after the last sheet of the previous job is
When “1: ON” is set, original size is detected automatically. delivered.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case Upon user’s request
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: OFF, 1: ON Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Default value 0 0: Continuous output of the interruption copy and the next job
NW-SCAN Setting of network scan function usage 1: Starting pickup for the next job after the interruption copy is
Lv.2 Details To set to enable/disable use of network scan function. delivered all.
Use case Upon user’s request 2: Starting pickup for the next job after the previous job is delivered
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. all. (For all jobs)
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 0
Caution - Do not use this mode in Japan. LGSW-DSP ON/OFF of “Log display ON/OFF setting”
- For PS/PCL machines for overseas (outside Japan), fix the setting Lv.2 Details [Not used] To set whether to display “Management Settings> Device
value as 1. For others, permit the use. Management> Display Log” in user mode.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 When “1: ON” is set, “Display Log” is displayed in the “Device
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Management” screen. When ON is set, the logs of each job are
HDCR-DSP Setting of HDD complete delete method displayed in “System Status.”
When “0: OFF” is set, “Display Log” is not displayed in the “Device
Lv.2 Details To set data deletion method of HDD data complete deletion function.
Management” screen, and the logs of each job are not displayed
Use case When switching the deletion method in HDD data complete deletion
either.
mode
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: OFF, 1: ON
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Related user mode Management Settings> Device Management> Display Log
Display/adj/set range 1 to 4
TAB-ROT Set of landscape img rotn at PDL:tab ppr
1: 1-time deletion with 0 data, 2: 1-time deletion with random data, 3:
3-time deletion with random data, 4: DOD Lv.1 Details To set whether to rotate landscape image by 180 degrees when PDL
print is made on tab paper.
Default value 1
When “1: Rotated” is set, image is rotated.
Supplement/memo HDD data complete deletion function: a function to completely delete
Use case Upon user’s request
data in HDD by overwriting with 0 (null) data or random data to the
file data when logically deleting file on HDD (deleting management Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
information data). 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Not rotated, 1: Rotated
Default value 0

8-205
8
8
8-206
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
PR-PSESW Display/hide of output Stop button PCL-COPY Set of PCL COPIES command control method
Lv.1 Details To set whether to display or hide [Stop] button on the Status Monitor Lv.2 Details To set the binder control method of COPIES command with PCL.
screen. Select whether to use the control method of Canon-made PCL or
Use case - Upon user’s request. use the same control method of non-Canon-made PCL.
- When promptly stopping the print job in operation or under Use case Upon user’s request
reservation Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 0: Control method of Canon-made PCL (following the value of
0: Hide, 1: Display COPIES command that is specified for each page to control on a
Default value 0 page basis)
IDPRN-SW Charge target job set of dept mngm cntr 1: Control method of non-Canon-made PCL (handling the value
Lv.1 Details To set the job type that advances the department management of COPIES command, which is specified for page 1 at the time of
counter. Collate mode, as bind figure while the value of COPIES command
Use case Upon user’s request for the next page or later is invalid. Same control applies as Canon-
made PCL at the time of Non Sorted mode)
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2 to 65535: For future use
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: CNT-SW Set default dis items on charge counter
PRINT category: Box Print, Report Print, Send Local Print, PDL Print Lv.1 Details To set default display items of the charge counter on the Counter
COPY category: COPY Check screen.
1: Use case Upon user’s request
PRINT category: Report Print, Send Local Print, PDL Print Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
COPY category: COPY, Box Print 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
P-CRG-LF Set of operation at Developing Unit life 0:
Lv.2 Details To set the operation when Developing Unit reaches its life. Counter 1 - Total 1: 101
When 1 is set, Developing Unit which reached its life cannot be Counter 2 - Total (Black 1): 108
used. Counter 3 - Copy (Full Color + Single Color/1): 232
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Counter 4 - Total A (Full Color + Single Color1): 149
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 1:
Counter 1 - Total 2: 102
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Counter 2 - Copy (Full Color + Single Color/2): 231
0: Developing Unit does not stop, 1: Developing Unit stops
Counter 3 - Total A (Full Color + Single Color/2): 148
Default value 0
Counter 4 - Copy (Black 2): 222
CPRT-DSP ON/OFF of [Print Charge Log] button
Counter 5 - Total A (Black 2): 133
Lv.1 Details To set whether to display the [Print Charge Log] button to print the
Default value 0
charge logs on the charge log screen in user mode.
When “1: ON” is set, the button is displayed in Management
Settings> Charge Management> Charge Log Screen.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0
Related user mode Management Settings > Charge Management > Charge Log

8-206
8
8
8-207
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
TAB-ACC ON/OFF of auto cassette change: Tab ppr DFLT-CPY Setting of color mode for copy
Lv.1 Details To set to enable/disable auto cassette change when tab paper runs Lv.1 Details To set the default color mode for copy operation.
out. Use case Upon user’s request
Use case Upon user’s request Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Caution Be sure to instruct the user to thoroughly comply the following: 0: Based on Auto/ACS/Printer Driver settings, 1: Color mode, 2: B/W
- Use tab paper with the same number of tabs. mode
- Set tab paper. Default value Europe: 2, Other than Europe: 0
Be sure to comply the above; otherwise, proper print is not available Related user mode Function Settings> Copy> Select Color Settings for Copy> Use Auto
and it can cause soil inside the machine because of toner. (Color/Black) Selection
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 DFLT-BOX Set of color mode for box print
0: OFF, 1: ON Lv.1 Details To set the default color mode for box print operation.
Default value 0 Use case Upon user’s request
BCNT-AST Set of box print charge target job Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To set the job type that advances the count in box print with NE 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Controller (ASSIST). Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Use case When switching the job type that is subject to counting of the box 0: Based on Auto/ACS/Printer Driver settings, 1: Color mode, 2: B/W
print with NE Controller mode
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value Europe: 2, Other than Europe: 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Related user mode Function Settings> Copy> Select Color Settings for Copy> Use Auto
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 (Color/Black) Selection
0: PDL job, 1: Copy job DOC-REM Dis/hide of original removal message
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To set whether to display or hide the message to remove original
PRJOB-CP Set count TX at RX/report print when scanning with DADF without opening/closing DADF after
Lv.2 Details To set to enable/disable a page-basis count pulse transmission to the scanning with the copyboard.
charging management device at the time of reception print or report Use case Upon user’s request
print. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case Upon user’s request 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 0: Hide, 1: Display
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 0
0: No transmission, 1: Transmission DPT-ID-7 Password entry set at dept ID reg/auth
Default value 0 Lv.2 Details To set whether to require a password entry at the time of registration/
Supplement/memo Charging management device: Coin manager, Non-Canon-made authentication of department ID.
control card With the setting to require entry, entry of 7-digit password is required
as well as entry of department ID.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Department ID only, 1: 7-digit (password) entry
Default value 0

8-207
8
8
8-208
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
RUI-RJT Connct set at invalid auth from remoteUI FREG-SW Dis/hide of MEAP counter free rgst area
Lv.2 Details To set to disconnect HTTP port when the machine receives invalid Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the free register area of MEAP
authentication from remote UI 3 times. counter for SEND
Use case Upon user’s request Use case At trouble analysis
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Caution - Do not use this at the normal service.
0: Continued connection, 1: Disconnected - Take necessary action in accordance with the instructions from the
Default value 0 Quality Support Division.
SND-RATE Set compress ratio at SEND high compress Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Lv.2 Details To set the compression ratio when the data compression ratio for 0: Hide, 1: Display
SEND (transmission) is set to “High Compression”. Default value 0
As the value is larger, the compression ratio is higher (the file size Supplement/memo Individual count-up (counter advance) of MEAP application is
becomes small). available in the free register area of MEAP counter.
Use case When making the transmission file size smaller IFAX-SZL Setting of IFAX send size limit
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.2 Details To set for restricting data size at the time of IFAX transmission that
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. does not go through the server.
Caution As the value is too large, an image is deteriorated. With the setting to restrict the data size, there will be #830 error in
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 the case of sending data that exceeds the upper limit value.
0: Compression ratio 1/16, 1: Compression ratio 1/20, 2: In the case that the data goes through the server, the size of
Compression ratio 1/24 transmission data is always restricted.
Default value 0 Use case Upon user’s request
Related user mode Function Settings > Send > Common Settings > Data Compression Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Ratio 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
CTM-S06 Set of password delete from export file Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Lv.2 Details To set to delete password for file transmission address from export 0: Limited, 1: Not limited (Restriction applies when data goes through
file. the server.)
With the setting to delete password, the password of file transmission Default value 1
target is deleted at the time of export of address book data from Related user mode Function Settings > Send > E-Mail/I-Fax Settings > Maximum Data
remote UI. Size for Sending
Use case - Upon user’s request Supplement/memo Specify the upper limit value for transmission data size in user mode.
- When avoiding information leak
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Password is retained, 1: Password is deleted.
Default value 1

8-208
8
8
8-209
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
IFAX-PGD Set page split TX at IFAX Simple mode TX PRNT-POS ON/OFF of all pauses at error job cancel
Lv.2 Details To set to enable/disable split-data transmission on a page basis in Lv.2 Details To set whether to pause the print operation of following jobs when
the case that the transmission size in IFAX Simple mode exceeds a job is cancelled due to an error inside the machine (#037, etc.)
the upper limit value. except service calls during PDL print.
Use case Upon user’s request Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution In the case to enable split-data transmission, be sure to get approval Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
from the user by explaining the following: 0: OFF, 1: ON
- No guarantee for page order on the reception side Default value 0
- There is a possibility of interruption of other received jobs between AFN-PSWD Access limit setting to user mode
pages Lv.2 Details To set to restrict password entry when accessing to the user mode.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 With this setting is enabled, password entry of system administrator
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled is required after pressing Settings/Registration key.
Default value 0 Use case Upon user’s request
Related user mode Function Settings > Send > E-Mail/I-Fax Settings > Maximum Data Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Size for Sending 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Supplement/memo Specify the upper limit value for transmission data size in user mode. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
MEAPSAFE Setting of MEAP safe mode 0: Password is not required, 1: Password is required
Lv.2 Details To set safe mode for MEAP platform. Default value 0
MPSF is displayed on the Control Panel in safe mode. PTJAM-RC Auto reprint setting at PDL print jam
In safe mode, MEAP application is stopped while just the system Lv.2 Details To set to automatically restart printing after jam recovery that occurs
application, which starts with initial state, is activated. This mode with PDL print.
enables obtaining log for cause analysis of MEAP failure. Use case Upon user’s request
Use case Perform system recovery processing when MEAP platform fails to Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
be activated due to resource confliction between MEAP applications, 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
service registration or use order
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 0: Not automatically reprinted, 1: Automatically reprinted
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
PDL-NCSW Card mngm setting for PDL print job
0: Normal mode, 1: Safe mode
Lv.2 Details To set to make PDL print job to be subject to card management by
Default value 0
the Card Reader.
TRAY-FLL Set of target tray for tray full notice With the setting to enable this mode, PDL print is available only
Lv.2 Details To set the tray which is the target of an output tray full notification. when the card ID of the card inserted to the Card Reader matches
Use case Upon user’s request the department ID.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case Upon user’s request
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
0: All trays to which paper can be output, 1: All trays which are Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
specified as the dedicated trays 0: PDL print is available with no card inserted.
Default value 0 1: PDL print is available only when the card ID matches the
department ID when the card is inserted.
Default value 0

8-209
8
8
8-210
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
SLP-SLCT Usage setting of network applications CNCT-RLZ Setting of connection serialize function
Lv.2 Details With the setting to use network-related application, the machine can Lv.2 Details Connection serialize is a function to assure job grouping function of
be recovered through network because it does not move to sleep imageWARE Output Manager Select Edition V1.0.
mode 1. The setting to enable this mode can avoid job rearrangement
For this machine to recover from sleep mode 1 through network, because the machine does not receive job data from other
a particular packet needs to be received; however, the existing connection until it completes job data reception from the current
network-related application does not send this packet. connection.
With the setting not to use the network-related application, this Use case Upon user’s request
machine cannot recover from sleep mode 1 through network when it Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
gets into sleep mode 1. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Use case Upon user’s request Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 0: OFF, 1: ON
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Default value 0
Caution Do not use this at the normal service. Supplement/memo Connection: Connection to be established through network between
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 multiple hosts (PC, etc).
0: Not used (Shift to sleep mode 1 is available.) Job grouping function: A function of imageWARE Output Manager
1: Used (Shift to sleep mode 1 is not available.) Select Edition V1.0 to prevent job interruption from other PC by
Default value 0 group job (sending multiple jobs in 1 session at job transmission).
Supplement/memo Network-related application: NetSpot Accountant, imageWARE COUNTER7 Setting of software counter 7
PS-MODE Compatible mode setting at PS usage Lv.1 Details To set counter type for software counter 7 on the Counter Check
Lv.2 Details To set for compatibility with existing machine regarding image screen.
process or print specification with PS print. Use case Upon user’s request
Selecting 1 enables to have the print result equivalent to that of Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
iR2200/2800/3300 series while selecting 2 enables to have the print 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
result equivalent to that of iR105 series. Display/adj/set range 0 to 999
Use case At replacement 0: Not registered
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. COUNTER8 Setting of software counter 8
Display/adj/set range 0 to 65535 Lv.1 Details To set counter type for software counter 8 on the Counter Check
0: No use of compatibility mode with PS screen.
1: PS Type3 halftone command existing compatibility (Order of Use case Upon user’s request
growing dither is opposite.) Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2 to 65535: Spare 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 999
0: Not registered
Default value 0
2C-CT-SW Set of color counter at 2-color mode
Lv.2 Details To set whether to use the mono color counter or full color counter for
count-up in 2-color mode.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Mono color counter, 1: Full color counter
Default value 0 (Japan)/1 (Others)

8-210
8
8
8-211
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
JA-FUNC ON/OFF of job archive function LDAP-SW Retrieval condition set for LDAP server
Lv.2 Details To set ON/OFF of job archive function. Lv.1 Details To set the condition to search e-mail address, etc. from LDAP server.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When specifying condition to search e-mail address, etc. from LDAP
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. server
Caution Changing this mode is not available in service mode, but only Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
reference is available. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
This mode can be set only with the MEAP program that supports job Display/adj/set range 0 to 5
archive. 0: Includes the next, 1: Not include the next, 2: Equivalent to the
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 next, 3: Not equivalent to the next, 4: Starts with the next, 5: Finishes
0: OFF, 1: ON with the next
Default value 0 Default value 4
JA-JOB Setting of job archive target job Supplement/memo LDAP (Lightweight Directory Access Protocol): Registering LDAP
Lv.2 Details To set the job type subject to job archive. server enables to search e-mail address, etc. from LDAP server and
With the job archive function enabled, archive operation is executed the result can be registered in the Address Book, etc. Registration is
when executing the target job. available by the following: Set Destination > Register LDAP Server
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. FROM-OF Deletion of mail sender’s address
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.1 Details To set whether to delete the sender’s address (From) at the time of
Caution Changing this mode is not available in service mode, but only e-mail transmission.
reference is available. Use case Upon user’s request
This mode can be set only with the MEAP program that supports job Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
archive. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0: N/A, 3: Limited to FAX/IFAX, 0xFFFFFFFF: All jobs Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0 0: Retained, 1: Deleted
Related service mode COPIER > OPTION > USER > JA-FUNC Default value 0
JA-RESTR Setting of job archive limit items DOM-ADD Additional entry of mail destn domain
Lv.2 Details To set restriction items for job archive specification. Lv.2 Details To set to automatically add the domain specified in user mode to the
With job archive function enabled, follow the setting to execute sending address (To) entered at the time of e-mail transmission.
operation to restrict specification. If specifying “xxx.com” as a domain in user mode in advance, just
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. entering “aaa” enables to display “[email protected]” when sending
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. e-mail.
Caution Changing this mode is not available in Service Mode, but reference Use case Upon user’s request
is available (in Service mode). Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
This mode is available only with the MEAP program that supports job 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
archive. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 0: Not added, 1: Added
0: OFF, 1: ON Default value 0
32 specification restrictions with Bit definition
Bit0: Function to obtain image file (0: OFF, 1:ON)
Bit1: Function to compose form registration (0: OFF, 1: ON)
Bit2: Function to edit document (0:OFF, 1: ON)
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER > OPTION > USER > JA-FUNC

8-211
8
8
8-212
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
SPEAKER Dis/hide to switch speaker/headphone MAIL-OF Mail send prohibition to entered address
Lv.1 Details [Not used] To set whether to display or hide “Voice Guidance from Lv.1 Details To set to prohibit the e-mail transmission to entered address.
Speaker” on the Voice Mode Setting screen in user mode. E-mail transmission is not available by entering the address because
Use case Upon user’s request of no “E-Mail” display on the transmission screen.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. The addresses already registered in the Address Book can be
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. selected, but even if a job is sent, it is to be a transmission error. (End
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 code #762 is displayed.)
0: Hide, 1: Display Use case Upon user’s request
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Related user mode Settings/Registration> Preferences> Accessibility> Voice Mode 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Setting> Voice Guidance from Speaker Caution - The addresses already registered in the Address Book can be
Supplement/memo “Voice Mode Setting” in user mode is displayed only when the Voice selected, but it is to be a transmission error. Therefore, be sure to
Guidance Kit is installed. receive approval from the user in advance to delete the address. Set
FILE-OF File send prohibition to entered address the transmission prohibition after deleting the address.
- When #762 is displayed without executing the procedure above,
Lv.1 Details To set to prohibit the file transmission to entered address.
explain the user that it is different from the description in the User’s
File transmission is not available by entering the address because of
Guide.
no “File” display on the transmission screen.
The addresses already registered in the Address Book can be Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
selected, but even if a job is sent, it is to be a transmission error. (End 0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
code #762 is displayed.) Default value 0
Use case Upon user’s request IFAX-OF IFAX send prohibition to entered address
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.1 Details To set to prohibit the IFAX transmission to entered address.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. IFAX transmission is not available by entering the address because
Caution - The addresses already registered in the Address Book can be of no “I-Fax” display on the transmission screen.
selected, but it is to be a transmission error. Therefore, be sure to The addresses already registered in the Address Book can be
receive approval from the user in advance to delete the address. Set selected, but even if a job is sent, it is to be a transmission error. (End
the transmission prohibition after deleting the address. code #762 is displayed.)
- When #762 is displayed without executing the procedure above, Use case Upon user’s request
explain the user that it is different from the description in the User’s Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Guide. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Caution - The addresses already registered in the Address Book can be
0: Enabled, 1: Disabled selected, but it is to be a transmission error. Therefore, be sure to
Default value 0 receive approval from the user in advance to delete the address. Set
the transmission prohibition after deleting the address.
- When #762 is displayed without executing the procedure above,
explain the user that it is different from the description in the User’s
Guide.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Enabled, 1: Disabled
Default value 0

8-212
8
8
8-213
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
LDAP-DEF Initial condtn set of LDAP server search FREE-DSP Display/hide of charge disable screen
Lv.1 Details To set initial condition for search target attribute that is specified at Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the Use Charge Management
the time of LDAP server Details search. screen for switching between charge and no charge.
Use case Upon user’s request The hardware switch for switching charge/no charge in the Coin
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Manager enables the mode in which all the services are available
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. for free (store manager mode) by temporarily releasing the charging
Display/adj/set range 0 to 6 system.
0: Name, 1: E-mail, 2: FAX, 3: Organization, 4: Organization unit, 5: Even without the hardware switch, the mode can be switched
No registration 1 (any setting), 6: No registration 2 (any setting) with the software switch when it is set to display the Use Charge
Default value 0 Management screen in Settings/Registration.
Related service mode COPIER > OPTION > USER > LDAP-SW Use case When enabling all the services to be provided for free by temporarily
releasing the charging system
JA-DPI Dis of job archive record resolution
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.2 Details To display the resolution of images for job archives recorded in jobs
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
other than FAX reception and IFAX reception, etc.
Only display is available in service mode. The setting is available Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
only in the MEAP applications which support job archiving. 0: Hide, 1: Display
Use case Upon user’s request Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Related user mode Management Settings > Charge Management > Use Charge
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Management
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 TNRB-SW Setting of Toner Cntner counter display
0: No conversion, 1: 100 x 100 dpi, 2: 200 x 200 dpi, 3: 300 x 300 dpi Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the Toner Container counter on the
Default value 3 Counter Check screen.
JA-COMPR Dis of job archive record compress ratio Use case When not showing the screen to users
Lv.2 Details To display the compression ratio of images for job archives recorded Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
in jobs other than FAX reception and I-Fax reception, etc. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Only display is available in service mode. The setting is available Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
only in the MEAP applications which support job archiving. 0: Hide, 1: Display (Toner Container counter only), 2: Display (Toner
Use case Upon user’s request Container counter + ejection counter)
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value Countries other than USA: 0, USA: 2
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. CLR-TIM Set of HDD Encry Kit data delete timing
Display/adj/set range 0 to 5 Lv.2 Details To set the timing to completely delete the data when HDD Encryption
0: No conversion, 1: Compression ratio 1/4, 2: Compression ratio Kit is used.
1/8, 3: Compression ratio 1/16, 4: Compression ratio 1/32, 5: Selecting 0 may reduce the job processing speed because page
Compression ratio 1/64 data that has been already processed is deleted while the other job
Default value 3 is in process, causing overload to CPU and HDD access.
Selecting 1 improves the job processing speed because the process
is executed after a job is completed.
Use case Upon request to improve the job processing speed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: During job process, 1: After the job is completed
Default value 0

8-213
8
8
8-214
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
JA-FORMT Display of job archive record format SNMP-COU Inside comty name SNMP access limit:user
Lv.2 Details To display the format of images for job archives recorded in jobs Lv.2 Details To restrict SNMP access by the community name (user right) that is
other than FAX reception and IFAX reception, etc. kept internally.
Whether the images processed by Packet JPEG are recorded in This machine internally retains the community name (user right)
Packet JPEG, or converted into Raster JPEG and then recorded is other than the SNMP community name that is specified in user
displayed. mode. Canon-made utility software, such as NetSpot, uses this
Only display is available in service mode. The setting is available community name.
only in the MEAP applications which support job archiving. Because of security concern, select 0/1 in the case to restrict SNMP
Use case Upon user’s request access with the internal community name.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When restricting SNTP access with the community name (user right)
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. that is retained internally
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: Packet JPEG, 1: Raster JPEG 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
HDCR-DSW Dis/hide of HDD complete delete ON/OFF 0: OFF, 1: Read only, 2: Read/Write
Lv.1 Details To set whether to display or hide “Hard Disk Data Complete Deletion” Default value 2
in user mode. Related user mode Preferences > Network > SNMP Settings > Community Name 2
With this setting, HDD data complete deletion function is available Settings
with ON/OFF button on the screen. BWCL-DSP ON/OFF of color/B&W selection screen
Use case Upon user’s request Lv.2 Details [Not used] To set whether to display the color/B&W selection screen
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. to select the default of the color mode.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case When displaying the color mode default selection screen
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: Hide, 1: Display 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Related service mode COPIER > OPTION > NETWORK > SSH-SW (level 2) 0: OFF, 1: ON
Related user mode Management Settings > Data Management > HDD Data Complete Default value 0
Deletion > Hard Disk Data Complete Deletion STPL-MAX Set of max number of sheets for staple
SNMP-COA Inside comty name SNMPaccess limit:admin Lv.2 Details To set the maximum number of sheets to be stapled in the Finisher.
Lv.2 Details To restrict SNMP access by the community name (administrator When “1: 60 sheets” is set, the stapling capacity becomes 60 sheets.
right) that is kept internally. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
This machine internally retains the community name (administrator 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
right) other than the SNMP community name that is specified in Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
user mode. Canon-made utility software, such as NetSpot, uses this 0: 50 sheets, 1: 60 sheets
community name. Default value 0
Because of security concern, select 0/1 in the case to restrict SNMP
access with the internal community name.
Use case When restricting SNTP access with the community name
(administrator right) that is retained internally
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
0: OFF, 1: Read only, 2: Read/Write
Default value 2
Related user mode Preferences > Network > SNMP Settings > Community Name 1
Settings

8-214
8
8
8-215
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
USBK-DSP ON/OFF user mode item for USB keyboard USBH-DSP Display/hide of USB host usage
Lv.2 Details [Not Used] To set ON/OFF of “Use MEAP Driver for USB Input Lv.2 Details To set whether to display “Preferences > External Interface > USB
Device” display in user mode. Settings > Use USB Host”.
When using the USB keyboard, it is necessary to specify either of By selecting “1: Display”, whether to use USB host on USB setting
the followings for USB keyboard. (It is not possible to use the USB screen can be selected.
keyboard for both.) Use case When switching to display or hide “Use USB Host” on USB setting
- Use the keyboard for some MEAP applications which screen
independently support the USB keyboard (including Card Reader of Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
the keyboard emulator type). 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
- Use the keyboard for MEAP applications which do not support the Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
LUI and USB keyboard. 0: Hide, 1: Display
When “1: ON” is set, user mode items are enabled, and the settings Default value 0
to use the USB keyboard for the LUI and MEAP applications
Related user mode Preferences > External Interface > USB Settings > Use USB Host
become available. Meanwhile, there is a possibility that the MEAP
USBM-DSP Dis/hide of USB ex-memory device driver
applications which support the USB keyboard (including Card
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display “Preferences > External Interface > USB
Reader of the USB emulation type) might not operate.
Settings > Use MEAP Driver for USB External Device”.
Use case When using the USB keyboard for the MEAP applications which do
By selecting “0: Hide”, the item is not displayed, and the user
not support the LUI and the USB keyboard for customization etc.
administrator cannot change the setting of the MEAP driver for the
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
USB external memory device.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Use case When prohibiting the user administrator to change the setting of
Caution Do not use this setting except for customization.
“Use MEAP driver for USB external device”, set 0 after the specified
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 setting is completed.
0: OFF, 1: ON
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Related user mode Preferences> External Interface> USB Settings> Use MEAP Driver Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
for USB Input Device 0: Hide, 1: Display
SCALL-SW Display/hide of repair request button Default value 1
Lv.1 Details [Not used] (For expansion) Related user mode Preferences> External Interface> USB Settings> Use MEAP Driver
To set whether to display or hide the repair-request button on the for USB External Device
Control Panel.
USBI-DSP Dis/hide of USB input device driver set
Use case When the sales company supports service by the repair-request
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display “Preferences > External Interface > USB
button
Settings > Use MEAP Driver for USB Input Device”.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. By selecting “0: Hide”, the item is not displayed, and the user
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. administrator cannot change the setting of the MEAP driver for the
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 USB input device.
0: Hide, 1: Display Use case When prohibiting the user administrator to change the setting of “Use
Default value 0 MEAP Driver for USB Input Device”, set 0 after the specified setting
SCALLCMP Set of repair request complete notice is completed.
Lv.1 Details [Not used] (For expansion) Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
With this setting enabled, a notification of repair completion is sent 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
to UGW server to clear the repair-request status that is retained Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
internally. 0: Hide, 1: Display
Use case Service technician uses this mode after completing repair Default value 1
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Related user mode Preferences > External Interface > USB Settings > Use MEAP Driver
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. for USB Input Device
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Default value 0

8-215
8
8
8-216
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
CTCHKDSP Display/hide of counter print JA-DFAX Setting of direct fax transmission: SAM
Lv.1 Details To set whether to display or hide “Print List” on the Counter Check Lv.2 Details To set the direct fax transmission when iW SAM is enabled.
screen. When 1 is set, the direct fax transmission is enabled.
Model name, model number information, counter check date and Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
counter information can be output as a total count management Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
report. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Use case Upon user’s request Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. JA-REP Setting of TX Report with image: SAM
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.2 Details To set the TX Report with image when iW SAM is enabled.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 When 1 is set, the TX Report with image is enabled.
0: Hide, 1: Display Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
Default value 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
USBR-DSP Dis/hide of USB infrared device driver 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display “Preferences > External Interface > USB Default value 0
Settings > Use MEAP Driver for USB Infrared Device.” JA-FREP Setting of Fax TX Report with image: SAM
Use case When prohibiting the user administrator to change the setting of Lv.2 Details To set the Fax TX Report with image when iW SAM is enabled.
“Use MEAP Driver for USB Infrared Device,” set 0 after the specified When 1 is set, the Fax TX Report with image is enabled.
setting is completed. Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 0
0: Hide, 1: Display
JA-BOX Setting of Inbox document operation: SAM
Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To set the operation for Inbox document at the time of iW SAM
Related user mode Preferences > External Interface > USB Settings > Use MEAP Driver When 1 is set, the Inbox document can be operated.
for USB Infrared Device
Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
POL-SCAN Dis/hide of Rights Management Server set
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Lv.1 Details When “1: Display” is set, the Rights Management Server function 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
screen is displayed.
Default value 0
While the Rights Management Server function is a standard feature,
JA-FORM Setting of image composition: SAM
it is possible to hide if not necessary.
Lv.2 Details To set the image composition when iW SAM is enabled.
Use case Upon user’s request
When 1 is set, the image composition is enabled.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value 0
Default value 1: Japan, 0: Others
JA-PREV Setting of preview page deletion: SAM
JA-SBOX Setting of linking with Advanced Box:SAM
Lv.2 Details To set whether a page is deleted from the scan preview screen at the
Lv.2 Details To set the link with Advanced Box when iW SAM is enabled.
time of iW SAM
When 1 is set, linking with Advanced Box is enabled.
When 1 is set, a page is deleted from the scan preview screen.
Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Default value 0
Default value 0

8-216
8
8
8-217
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
JA-PULL Setting of network scan: SAM JA-WEB Setting of Inbox document upload: SAM
Lv.2 Details To set the network scan when iW SAM is enabled. Lv.2 Details To set the Inbox document upload with the Web browser at the time
When 1 is set, the network scan is enabled. of iW SAM.
Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM When 1 is set uploading to the Inbox document with the Web
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Browser is enabled.
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
JA-PDLB Set of printer driver multi box save:SAM 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.2 Details To set whether a document can be simultaneously saved to multiple Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Inboxes from the printer driver at the time of iW SAM. 0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
When 1 is set, a document can be saved to multiple Inboxes from Default value 0
the printer driver. CS-ACC Set Pickup Cassette switch in color mode
Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM Lv.1 Details To change “Paper Drawer Auto Selection On/Off” in user mode to
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 switch of Pickup Cassette in color mode.
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled When 1 is set, the meaning of ON/OFF of “Paper Drawer Auto
Default value 0 Selection On/Off” screen changes.
JA-JOBK Setting of job merge allowance:SAM ON: Pickup Cassette that can be selected when color mode is other
Lv.2 Details To set whether merging jobs is allowed when iW SAM is enabled. than “B&W”
When 1 is set, jobs can be merged. OFF: Pickup Cassette that can be selected when color mode is
“B&W”
Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
Use case When switching the Pickup Cassette in color mode
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Same as conventional machines, 1: Pickup Cassette switch in
Default value 0
color mode
JA-JDF Setting of JDF: SAM
Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To set the use of JDF when iW SAM is enabled.
Related user mode Function Settings > Common > Paper Feed Settings > Paper Drawer
When 1 is set, JDF can be used.
Auto Selection On/Off
Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
EXP-CRYP Confdntial encrypt ON/OFF:add book exprt
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Lv.1 Details To set whether to encrypt the confidential part (password part) in the
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Address Book when exporting the Address Book and device settings
Default value 0
via RUI.
JA-RUI Setting of Inbox document access: SAM
When 0 is set, the confidential part in the Address Book is exported
Lv.2 Details To set the Inbox document access from remote UI at the time of iW without encryption.
SAM
Use case When there is a need to export password without encryption because
When 1 is set, accessing to the Inbox document from remote UI is
of operation and tool
enabled.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When the operation restriction is cleared at the time of iW SAM
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Caution Be sure not to allow the user to execute export without encryption
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
because of security concern.
Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 1

8-217
8
8
8-218
COPIER>OPTION>USER COPIER>OPTION>USER
SLEEP1SW Power supply when shifting to SLEEP1 EZY-SCRP ON/OFF of secure print simple auth
Lv.1 Details When shifting to SLEEP1 mode, the power stops to be supplied, so it Lv.1 Details To set whether to conduct secure print by simple authentication.
takes time to activate after a job is received. When 1 is set, secured print, encryption secured print and inbox print
When 1 is set, the power keeps to be supplied even after shifting to are received, but the normal print jobs are cancelled.
SLEEP1 mode, so the activation of job processing becomes earlier. If the password “3758211” is entered at job sending, authentication
Use case Upon user’s request (when job processing after shifting to SLEEP1 by entering the password on the Control Panel is not required. If the
is slow) password is not entered at job sending, authentication by entering
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. the password on the Control Panel is necessary at job output.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. In addition, the following selection is added as auto deletion time of
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 secure job: 10 minutes, 20 minutes, 30 minutes
0: OFF, 1: ON Use case Upon user’s request
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
AUT-SLCT ON/OFF of secure job auto selection 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Lv.1 Details To set whether to automatically select all jobs with the same user Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
name in the secure print screen. 0: OFF, 1: ON
When user authentication is not conducted, convenience is improved Default value 0
by setting 1. DMN-MTCH ON/OFF of secure print domain judgment
Use case Upon user’s request Lv.1 Details To set whether to display only the job which matches the domain in
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. the “My Job Status” screen of the secure print.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. When 1 is set, only the job which matches the user name and
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 domain name is displayed in the “My Job Status” screen, so the job
0: OFF, 1: ON which does not match the domain is not displayed.
Default value 0 Use case Upon user’s request
CNCL-ATH ON/OFF of auth at secure job stop Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To set whether to conduct authentication when stopping a secure job 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
in the secure print screen. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
When 0 is set, pressing [Stop] button deletes the secure job 0: OFF, 1: ON
immediately. Default value 1
By setting 1 when user authentication is not conducted, the Supplement/memo In the “My Job Status” screen, the job is displayed when login service
authentication screen is displayed and only the jobs which is used. Only the job of user who logs in is displayed.
authentication was succeeded are deleted, so security for the secure T-8-61
job is enhanced.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0

8-218
8
8
8-219
■■CST COPIER>OPTION>CST
Lv.1 Details To set the size for Envelope Cassette ENV1.
COPIER>OPTION>CST Use case When specifying the size for Envelope Cassette
U1-NAME Dis/hide of ppr name in ppr size groupU1 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide paper name at paper size group U1 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
detection. Display/adj/set range 21 to 25
Use case Upon user’s request 21: ISO-C5, 22: COM10, 23: MONARCH, 24: DL, 25: ISO-B5
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 23
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value 0
U2-NAME Dis/hide of ppr name in ppr size groupU2
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide paper name at paper size group U2
detection.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value 0
U3-NAME Dis/hide of ppr name in ppr size groupU3
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide paper name at paper size group U3
detection.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value 0
U4-NAME Dis/hide of ppr name in ppr size groupU4
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide paper name at paper size group U4
detection.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value 0
ENV1 Setting of Envelope Cassette ENV1 size

8-219
8
8
8-220
COPIER>OPTION>CST COPIER>OPTION>CST
ENV2 Setting of Envelope Cassette ENV2 size CST3-P1 Setting of Cassette 3 paper size
Lv.1 Details To set the size for Envelope Cassette ENV2. Lv.1 Details To set the paper size used in Cassette 3.
Use case When specifying the size for Envelope Cassette Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Display/adj/set range 21 to 25 0: A5R, 1: STMTR
21: ISO-C5, 22: COM10, 23: MONARCH, 24: DL, 25: ISO-B5 Default value USA: 1, Countries other than USA: 0
Default value 22 Related user mode Preferences> Paper Settings> A5R/STMTR Paper Selection
CST1-P1 Setting of Cassette 1 paper size CST3-P2 Setting of Cassette 3 paper size
Lv.1 Details To set the paper size used in Cassette 1. Lv.1 Details To set the paper size used in Cassette 3.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: A5R, 1: STMTR 0: B5, 1: EXEC
Default value USA: 1, Countries other than USA: 0 Default value USA: 1, Countries other than USA: 0
Related user mode Preferences> Paper Settings> A5R/STMTR Paper Selection Related user mode Preferences> Paper Settings> B5/EXEC Paper Selection
CST1-P2 Setting of Cassette 1 paper size CST4-P1 Setting of Cassette 4 paper size
Lv.1 Details To set the paper size used in Cassette 1. Lv.1 Details To set the paper size used in Cassette 4.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: B5, 1: EXEC 0: A5R, 1: STMTR
Default value USA: 1, Countries other than USA: 0 Default value USA: 1, Countries other than USA: 0
Related user mode Preferences> Paper Settings> B5/EXEC Paper Selection Related user mode Preferences> Paper Settings> A5R/STMTR Paper Selection
CST2-P1 Setting of Cassette 2 paper size CST4-P2 Setting of Cassette 4 paper size
Lv.1 Details To set the paper size used in Cassette 2. Lv.1 Details To set the paper size used in Cassette 4.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: A5R, 1: STMTR 0: B5, 1: EXEC
Default value USA: 1, Countries other than USA: 0 Default value USA: 1, Countries other than USA: 0
Related user mode Preferences> Paper Settings> A5R/STMTR Paper Selection Related user mode Preferences> Paper Settings> B5/EXEC Paper Selection
CST2-P2 Setting of Cassette 2 paper size CST1-U1 Set cst 1 oversea special ppr category 1
Lv.1 Details To set the paper size used in Cassette 2. Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 1 used in Cassette 1.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 43
0: B5, 1: EXEC 0: A4-R/LTR-R, 1 to 23: Not used, 24: FLSC, 25: A-FLS, 36: Not
Default value USA: 1, Countries other than USA: 0 used, 27: E-OFI, 28 to 29: Not used, 30: A-LTRR, 31 to 32: Not used,
Related user mode Preferences> Paper Settings> B5/EXEC Paper Selection 33: A-LGL, 34: G-LGL, 35: Not used, 36: A-OFI, 37: M-OFI, 38 to 41:
Not used, 42: FA4, 43: Not used
Default value 0

8-220
8
8
8-221
COPIER>OPTION>CST COPIER>OPTION>CST
CST1-U2 Set cst 1 oversea special ppr category 2 CST2-U3 Set cst 2 oversea special ppr category 3
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 2 used in Cassette 1. Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 3 used in Cassette 2.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 34 Display/adj/set range 0 to 31
0: 16K-R, 1 to 22: Not used, 23: K-LGL-R, 24 to 31: Not used, 32: 0: B4/B5/LTR/16K, 1 to 21: Not used, 22: K-LGL, 23 to 28: Not used,
G-LTRR, 33 to 34: Not used 29: A-LTR, 30: Not used, 31: G-LTR
Default value 0 Default value 0
CST1-U3 Set cst 1 oversea special ppr category 3 CST2-U4 Set cst 2 oversea special ppr category 4
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 3 used in Cassette 1. Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 4 used in Cassette 2.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 31 Display/adj/set range 0 to 28
0: B4/B5/LTR/16K, 1 to 21: Not used, 22: K-LGL, 23 to 28: Not used, 0: LGL, 1 to 27: Not used, 28: B-OFI
29: A-LTR, 30: Not used, 31: G-LTR Default value 0
Default value 0 CST3-U1 Set cst 3 oversea special ppr category 1
CST1-U4 Set cst 1 oversea special ppr category 4 Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 1 used in Cassette 3.
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 4 used in Cassette 1. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 43
Display/adj/set range 0 to 28 0: A4-R/LTR-R, 1 to 23: Not used, 24: FLSC, 25: A-FLS, 36: Not
0: LGL, 1 to 27: Not used, 28: B-OFI used, 27: E-OFI, 28 to 29: Not used, 30: A-LTRR, 31 to 32: Not used,
Default value 0 33: A-LGL, 34: G-LGL, 35: Not used, 36: A-OFI, 37: M-OFI, 38 to 41:
CST2-U1 Set cst 2 oversea special ppr category 1 Not used, 42: FA4, 43: Not used
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 1 used in Cassette 2. Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. CST3-U2 Set cst3 overseas special ppr category 2
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 2 used in Cassette 3.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 43 Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: A4-R/LTR-R, 1 to 23: Not used, 24: FLSC, 25: A-FLS, 36: Not 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
used, 27: E-OFI, 28 to 29: Not used, 30: A-LTRR, 31 to 32: Not used, Display/adj/set range 0 to 34
33: A-LGL, 34: G-LGL, 35: Not used, 36: A-OFI, 37: M-OFI, 38 to 41: 0: 16K-R, 1 to 22: Not used, 23: K-LGL-R, 24 to 31: Not used, 32:
Not used, 42: FA4, 43: Not used G-LTRR, 33 to 34: Not used
Default value 0 Default value 0
CST2-U2 Set cst 2 oversea special ppr category 2 CST3-U3 Set cst3 overseas special ppr category 3
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 2 used in Cassette 2. Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 3 used in Cassette 3.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 34 Display/adj/set range 0 to 31
0: 16K-R, 1 to 22: Not used, 23: K-LGL-R, 24 to 31: Not used, 32: 0: B4/B5/LTR/16K, 1 to 21: Not used, 22: K-LGL, 23 to 28: Not used,
G-LTRR, 33 to 34: Not used 29: A-LTR, 30: Not used, 31: G-LTR
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-221
8
8
8-222
COPIER>OPTION>CST ■■ACC
CST3-U4 Set cst3 overseas special ppr category 4
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 4 used in Cassette 3.
COPIER>OPTION>ACC
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. COIN Setting of charge management
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.1 Details To set charging management method.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 28 Use case At installation of Coin Manager
0: LGL, 1 to 27: Not used, 28: B-OFI Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
CST4-U1 Set cst4 overseas special ppr category 1 Caution In case of setting “”3””, if “”0 to 2”” is changed to “”3””, the following
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 1 used in Cassette 4. items are automatically set. After making a change, even though “”3””
is set to “”0 to 2”” again, they will not be restored.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
- COPIER> OPTION> USER> CONTROL, AFN-PSWD = 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
- COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> DA-CNCT = 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 43
- COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> UI-BOX, UI-SEND, UI-FAX = 0
0: A4-R/LTR-R, 1 to 23: Not used, 24: FLSC, 25: A-FLS, 36: Not
- IE Settings> IE Function Priority = ON
used, 27: E-OFI, 28 to 29: Not used, 30: A-LTRR, 31 to 32: Not used,
- Preferences> Network> TCP/IP Settings> IPv4 Settings> IP
33: A-LGL, 34: G-LGL, 35: Not used, 36: A-OFI, 37: M-OFI, 38 to 41:
Address Range Settings> RX/Print Range: Permit IPv4 Address =
Not used, 42: FA4, 43: Not used
ON
Default value 0 - Preferences> Network> TCP/IP Settings> IPv6 Settings> IP
CST4-U2 Set cst4 overseas special ppr category 2 Address Range Settings> RX/Print Range: Permit IPv6 Address =
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 2 used in Cassette 4. ON
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. - Preferences> Network> TCP/IP Settings> FTP Print Settings>
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use FTP Printing = OFF
Display/adj/set range 0 to 34 - Preferences> Network> TCP/IP Settings> IPP Print Settings = ON
0: 16K-R, 1 to 22: Not used, 23: K-LGL-R, 24 to 31: Not used, 32: - Preferences> Network> SMB Server Settings> SMB Printer
G-LTRR, 33 to 34: Not used Settings> Use SMB =ON
Default value 0 - Function Settings> Send> E-Mail/I-Fax Settings> Communication
CST4-U3 Set cst4 overseas special ppr category 3 Settings> SMTP RX, POP = OFF
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 3 used in Cassette 4.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. In case of setting “”4””, if “”0 to 2”” is changed to “”4””, the following
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. items are automatically set. After making a change, even though “”4””
Display/adj/set range 0 to 31 is set to “”0 to 2”” again, they will not be restored.
0: B4/B5/LTR/16K, 1 to 21: Not used, 22: K-LGL, 23 to 28: Not used, - COPIER> OPTION> USER> AFN-PSWD = 1
29: A-LTR, 30: Not used, 31: G-LTR - COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> UI-BOX, UI-SEND, UI-FAX, UI-
RSCAN, UI-EPRNT, UI-HOLD = 0
Default value 0
- Management Settings>Device Management> Display Log=OFF
CST4-U4 Set cst4 overseas special ppr category 4
Display/adj/set range 0 to 7
Lv.1 Details To set the overseas special paper category 4 used in Cassette 4.
0: No charge
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 1: Charge with Coin Manager
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2 Charge with remote counter
Display/adj/set range 0 to 28 3: Charge with DA (only in Japan)
0: LGL, 1 to 27: Not used, 28: B-OFI 4: Charge with this machine itself
Default value 0 5: New SC mode
T-8-62 6: External charge mode 6
7: External charge mode 7
Default value 0

8-222
8
8
8-223
COPIER>OPTION>ACC COPIER>OPTION>ACC
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> USER> CONTROL OUT-TRAY Set of Third Delivery Tray installation
COPIER> OPTION> NETWORK> DA-CNCT Lv.1 Details To set whether the Third Delivery Tray is installed.
COPIER> OPTION> DSPLY-SW> UI-BOX, UI-SEND, UI-FAX When the Third Delivery Tray is installed, set “1”.
COPIER> OPTION> ACC> PDL-THR Use case When installing the Third Delivery Tray
Related user mode Function Settings > Send > E-Mail/I-Fax Settings > Communication Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Settings 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Preferences> Network > TCP/IP Settings > DNS Settings > FTP Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Print Settings 0: Not installed, 1: Installed
Preferences> Network > TCP/IP Settings > DNS Settings > IPP Print Default value 0
Settings
CC-SPSW Support setting of control card I/F
Supplement/memo Control card can be used with “0: No charge”.
Lv.2 Details To set support level for control card (CCIV/CCV) interface.
DA: Digital Accessory
To keep processing performance of printer engine, select “1: Priority
DK-P Setting of Paper Deck paper size on speed”.
Lv.1 Details To set the paper size used in the Paper Deck. To correctly stop the output by the upper limit number of sheets,
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. select “2: Priority on upper limit number of sheets”.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Use case Upon user’s request (when connecting to the external counter
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 management system using the control card interface)
0: A4, 1: LTR, 2: Not used Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
CARD-SW Screen set when Coin Manager connected Caution With priority on speed, output cannot be correctly stopped by the
Lv.1 Details To set coin or card that the user is urged to insert on the Control upper limit number of sheets.
Panel when the Coin Manager is connected. With priority on the upper limit number of sheets, processing
Use case Upon user’s request performance of the printer engine is decreased depending on pickup
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. location.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 0: No support, 1: Priority on speed, 2: Priority on upper limit number
0: Coin, 1: Card, 2: Coin and card, 3: Card (for customization) of sheets
Default value 0 Default value 0
STPL-LMT Set Number of sheets for saddle stitch USB-MSK Limit for USB host using cannel
Lv.2 Details To set the number of sheets for saddle stitch Lv.1 Details To set the channel that cannot use the USB host.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 0 to 2
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 0: Not limited, 1: CH 1, 2: Not used
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 Display/adj/set range 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 3 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
SC-TYPE Set of Coin Manager support machine Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To set the machine that supports the Coin Manager. UNIT-PRC Setting of Coin Manager currency unit
Use case Upon user’s request Lv.2 Details To set currency unit to be handled with Coin Manager
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case At installation of Coin Manager
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Caution Do not use this setting for the machines other than the ones that 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
support the Coin Manager. Display/adj/set range 0 to 6
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 0: Japanese yen, 1: Euro, 2: Pound, 3: Swiss Franc. 4: Dollar, 5: No
0: Machine installed in convenience stores, 1: Self-operated copy currency unit (no fractional unit), 6: No currency unit (with fractional
machine unit)
Default value 0 Default value 0

8-223
8
8
8-224
COPIER>OPTION>ACC COPIER>OPTION>ACC
IN-TRAY Set of Second Delivery Tray installation MAX-PRC Set of Coin Manager maximum price
Lv.1 Details To set whether the Second Delivery Tray is installed. Lv.1 Details To set the maximum amount to be handled with Coin Manager.
When the Second Delivery Tray is installed, set “1”. Enter 8800 when specifying 8800 Japanese yen as the maximum
Use case When installing the Second Delivery Tray amount to be handled with the Coin Manager that supports Japanese
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. yen.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. In the case to specify 1 to 4 (Euro/Pound/Swiss Franc/Dollar) by
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 going through the following: COPIER> OPTION> ACC> UNIT-PRC,
0: Not installed, 1: Installed entry is in fractional unit. Entry of 50 indicates 50 cents ($ 0.50).
Default value 0 Use case At installation of Coin Manager
DA-PUCT Set pickup/delivery comctn at DA charge Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.2 Details When a pickup and delivery notification error occurs due to network 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
failure, etc., the print operation might be done without charging. Caution This mode is enabled when selecting 4 for the following: COPIER>
This is to set the number of sheets that can be fed after the machine OPTION> ACC> COIN.
receives Ack single from DA. Display/adj/set range 0 to 9999
When the value is decreased, the number of prints to be made Unit According to the setting value by the following: COPIER> OPTION>
without charging is decreased, but the productivity might be lowered. ACC> UNIT-PRC.
When the value is increased, the productivity is not lowered, but the Default value 8800
number of prints to be made without charging is increased. Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> ACC> COIN, UNIT-PRC
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Supplement/memo As for charging amount, it causes an error if specifying the value that
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. is larger than the maximum currency unit with Settings/Registration
Caution As the smaller value is set, the number of prints to be made without mode.
charging is decreased, but the productivity might be lowered. MIC-TUN Manual adj of voice recognize microphone
Display/adj/set range 2 to 10 Lv.1 Details To manually adjust the sound receiving level (sensitivity) of the
Default value 6 connected voice recognition microphone.
Supplement/memo DA: Digital Accessory Microphone sensitivity is automatically tuned in user mode; however,
MIN-PRC Set of Coin Manager minimum price adjust it manually as needed.
Lv.1 Details To set the minimum amount to be handled with Coin Manager. Use case When the sensitivity of microphone is not improved by auto tuning
Enter 10 when specifying 10 Japanese yen as the minimum amount Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
to be handled with the Coin Manager that supports Japanese yen. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
In the case to specify 1 to 4 (Euro/Pound/Swiss Franc/Dollar) by Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
going through the following: COPIER> OPTION> ACC > UNIT-PRC, Default value 128
entry is in fractional unit. Entry of 50 indicates 50 cents ($ 0.50). Related user mode Preferences > Accessibility > Voice Navigation Settings > Tune
Use case At installation of Coin Manager Microphone
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution This mode is enabled when selecting 4 for the following: COPIER >
OPTION > ACC > COIN.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 9999
Unit According to the setting value by the following: COPIER> OPTION>
ACC> UNIT-PRC.
Default value 10
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> ACC> COIN, UNIT-PRC
Supplement/memo As for the charging amount, it causes an error if specifying the
value that is smaller than the minimum currency unit with Settings/
Registration mode.

8-224
8
8
8-225
COPIER>OPTION>ACC COPIER>OPTION>ACC
SRL-SPSW Setting of Serial I/F Kit support CR-TYPE Setting of Card Reader
Lv.1 Details To set the support level of the Serial Interface Kit. Lv.1 Details To set the model of the Card Reader.
To keep processing performance of printer engine, select “1: Priority Set 1 in the case of connecting the Card Reader-C1. It operates
on speed”. even 0 is set, but recognition rate decreases.
To correctly stop the output by the upper limit number of sheets, Use case When connecting the Card Reader-C1
select “2: Priority on upper limit number of sheets”. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case At installation of Serial Interface Kit 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 0: Card Reader-F1, 1: Card Reader-C1
Caution With priority on speed, output cannot be correctly stopped by the Default value 0
upper limit number of sheets. T-8-63
With priority on the upper limit number of sheets, processing
performance of the printer engine is decreased depending on pickup
location.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
0: No support, 1: Priority on speed, 2: Priority on upper limit number
of sheets
Default value 0
CC-EXT Set of information output at CCV control
Lv.1 Details To set the information output of large/small paper size and color/
B&W at CCV control.
Use case When installing a machine which requires the information on large/
small paper size and color/B&W
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Not output, 1: Output
Default value 0
PDL-THR Normal PDL print set in ex-charge mode
Lv.2 Details To set the normal PDL print process when the external charge mode
6/7 is set in COIN.
As the value is set to “0”, a job is canceled and “0” is set, a job is
executed.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Cancel, 1: Execute
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> OPTION> ACC> COIN

8-225
8
8
8-226
■■INT-FACE COPIER>OPTION>INT-FACE
NWCT-TM Timeout setting of network connection
COPIER>OPTION>INT-FACE Lv.2 Details To set the time to keep network connection between this machine
IMG-CONT Connection setting of print server and the PC application (keep-alive setting).
Lv.1 Details To set connection with print server. As the value is incremented by 1, the time is increased by 1 minute.
Use case At installation Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 1 to 5
Display/adj/set range 0 to 5 Unit 1 minute
0: Normal mode (Print server not connected), 1, 2: Not used, 3: Print Default value 5
server connected, 4, 5: Not used Supplement/memo Expected PC application: Network print application, E-mail function,
Default value 0 cascade copy, MEAP network application, etc.
AP-OPT Output set of appli with print server CNT-TYPE Connection setting of print server
Lv.2 Details To set whether to permit output from the application (PrintMe) Lv.1 Details To switch print server to be connected.
equipped with print server. Specify print server with EFI controller ID.
Use case Upon user’s request Use case At installation of print server
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2 Display/adj/set range 1 to 999
0: Permits the specified account only, 1: Permits, 2: Permits the 443: ColorPASS-GX300, 444: imagePASS-B1
specified department ID only Default value 1
Default value 0
T-8-64
AP-ACCNT Job dept ID set of appli w/ print server
Lv.2 Details To set department ID to the print job from the application (PrintMe)
equipped with print server.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 9999999
Default value 0
AP-CODE Set output pass code from print server
Lv.2 Details To set the pass code for output from print server.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 9999999
Default value 0

8-226
8
8
8-227
■■LCNS-TR COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-SPDF Installation state dis of Searchable PDF
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Searchable PDF when transfer is
ST-SEND Installation state dis of SEND function disabled.
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of SEND function when transfer is Use case When checking whether Searchable PDF is installed
disabled. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-SPDF.
Use case When checking whether SEND function is installed 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-SEND. When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. displayed under TR-SPDF.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
displayed under TR-SEND. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! TR-SPDF Trns license key dis of Searchable PDF
Default value 1 Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Searchable PDF when transfer
TR-SEND Trns license key dis of SEND function is disabled.
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use SEND function when transfer is Use case - When replacing HDD
disabled. - When replacing the device
Use case - When replacing HDD Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-SPDF.
- When replacing the device 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-SEND. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-SPDF.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. Caution This mode is enabled when SEND function is installed.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-SEND. Display/adj/set range 24 digits
Display/adj/set range 24 digits ST-EXPDF Instal state of Encry PDF + Searchbl PDF
ST-ENPDF Installation state dis of Encryption PDF Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Encryption PDF + Searchable PDF
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Encryption PDF when transfer is when transfer is disabled.
disabled. Use case When checking whether Encryption PDF + Searchable PDF is
Use case When checking whether Encryption PDF is installed installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-ENPDF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-EXPDF.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-ENPDF. displayed under TR-EXPDF.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 0
TR-ENPDF Trns license key dis of Encryption PDF TR-EXPDF Trns lcns key of Encry PDF+Searchbl PDF
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Encryption PDF when transfer Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Encryption PDF + Searchable
is disabled. PDF when transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-ENPDF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-EXPDF.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-ENPDF. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-EXPDF.
Caution This mode is enabled when SEND function is installed. Caution This mode is enabled when SEND function is installed for Japan.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits

8-227
8
8
8-228
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-PDFDR Install state dis of Direct Print PDF ST-BRDIM Install state dis: PCL Barcode Printing
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Direct Print PDF when transfer is Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Barcode Printing for PCL when transfer
disabled. is disabled.
Use case When checking whether Direct Print PDF is installed Use case When checking whether Barcode Printing for PCL is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PDFDR. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-BRDIM.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-PDFDR. displayed under TR-BRDIM.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 0
TR-PDFDR Trns lcns key dis of Direct Print PDF TR-BRDIM Trns lcns key dis: PCL Barcode Printing
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Direct Print PDF when transfer Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Barcode Printing for PCL when
is disabled. transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PDFDR. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-BRDIM.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-PDFDR. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-BRDIM.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits
ST-SCR Install state dis of Encry Secure Print ST-VNC Install state dis of Remote Oprtr Soft
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Encrypted Secure Print when transfer Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Remote Operators Software when
is disabled. transfer is disabled.
Use case When checking whether Encrypted Secure Print is installed Use case When checking whether Remote Operators Software is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-SCR. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-VNC.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-SCR. displayed under TR-VNC.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 0
TR-SCR Trns license key dis of Encry Secure Pnt TR-VNC Trns lcns dis of Remote Operators Soft
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Encrypted Secure Print when Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Remote Operators Software
transfer is disabled. when transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-SCR. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-VNC.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-SCR. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-VNC.
Caution This mode is enabled when there is “3DES+USH-H” Board. Display/adj/set range 24 digits
Display/adj/set range 24 digits
ST-HDCLR [Not used]
TR-HDCLR [Not used]

8-228
8
8
8-229
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-WEB Install state dis of Web Access Software ST-TRSND Install state dis of Trial SEND function
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Web Access Software when transfer is Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Trial SEND function when transfer is
disabled. disabled.
Use case When checking whether Web Access Software is installed Use case When checking whether Trial SEND function is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-WEB. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-TRSND.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-WEB. displayed under TR-TRSND.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 0
TR-WEB Trns license key dis of Web Access Soft TR-TRSND Trns lcns key dis of Trial SEND function
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Web Access Software when Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Trial SEND function when
transfer is disabled. transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-WEB. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-TRSND.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-WEB. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-TRSND.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits
ST-HRPDF Install state dis of High Compress PDF ST-WTMRK Install state dis of Secure Watermark
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of High Compression PDF when transfer Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Secure Watermark when transfer is
is disabled. disabled.
Use case When checking whether High Compression PDF is installed Use case When checking whether Secure Watermark is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-HRPDF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-WTMRK.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-HRPDF. displayed under TR-WTMRK.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 1 Default value 0
TR-HRPDF Trns lcns key dis of High Compress PDF TR-WTMRK Trns license key dis of Secure Watermark
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use High Compression PDF when Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Secure Watermark when
transfer is disabled. transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-HRPDF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-WTMRK.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-HRPDF. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-WTMRK.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits

8-229
8
8
8-230
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-TSPDF Install state dis of Time Stamp PDF: JP ST-DVPDF Install state dis of Device Sign PDF
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Time Stamp PDF (JP only) when Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Device Signature PDF when transfer is
transfer is disabled. disabled.
Use case When checking whether Time Stamp PDF (JP only) is installed Use case When checking whether Device Signature PDF is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-TSPDF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-DVPDF.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-TSPDF. displayed under TR-DVPDF.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 0
TR-TSPDF Trns lcns key dis of Time Stamp PDF: JP TR-DVPDF Trns lcns key dis of Device Sign PDF
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Time Stamp PDF (JP only) Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Device Signature PDF when
when transfer is disabled. transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-TSPDF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-DVPDF.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-TSPDF. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-DVPDF.
Caution This mode is enabled when SEND function is installed. Caution This mode is enabled when SEND function is installed.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits
ST-USPDF Install state dis of Dgtl User Sign PDF ST-SCPDF Install state dis of Trace & Smooth PDF
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Digital User Signature PDF when Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Trace & Smooth PDF when transfer is
transfer is disabled. disabled.
Use case When checking whether Digital User Signature PDF is installed Use case When checking whether Trace & Smooth PDF is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-USPDF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-SCPDF.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-USPDF. displayed under TR-SCPDF.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 0
TR-USPDF Trns lcns key dis of Dgtl User Sign PDF TR-SCPDF Trns lcns key dis of Trace & Smooth PDF
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Digital User Signature PDF Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Trace & Smooth PDF when
when transfer is disabled. transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-USPDF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-SCPDF.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-USPDF. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-SCPDF.
Caution This mode is enabled when SEND function is installed. Caution This mode is enabled when SEND function is installed.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits

8-230
8
8
8-231
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-AMS Install state dis of Access Management System ST-PS Install state display of PS function
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Access Management System when Lv.2 Details To display installation state of PS function when transfer is disabled.
transfer is disabled. Use case When checking whether PS function is installed
Use case When checking whether Access Management System is installed Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PS.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-AMS. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is displayed under TR-PS.
displayed under TR-AMS. Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Default value 0
Default value 0 TR-PS Transfer license key dis of PS function
TR-AMS Trns lcns key dis of Access Management System Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use PS function when transfer is
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Access Management System disabled.
when transfer is disabled. Use case - When replacing HDD
Use case - When replacing HDD - When replacing the device
- When replacing the device Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PS.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-AMS. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-PS.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-AMS. Display/adj/set range 24 digits
Display/adj/set range 24 digits ST-PCL Install state display of PCL function
ST-ERDS Install state dis: E-RDS 3rd Pty Expnsn Lv.2 Details To display installation state of PCL function when transfer is disabled.
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of E-RDS 3rd Party Expansion when Use case When checking whether PCL function is installed
transfer is disabled. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PCL.
Use case When checking whether E-RDS 3rd Party Expansion is installed 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-ERDS. When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. displayed under TR-PCL.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
displayed under TR-ERDS. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! TR-PCL Transfer license key dis of PCL function
Default value 0 Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use PCL function when transfer is
Supplement/memo E-RDS 3rd Party Expansion: A function to send charge counter to disabled.
the third party’s charge server. Use case - When replacing HDD
TR-ERDS Trns lcns key dis: E-RDS 3rd Pty Expnsn - When replacing the device
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use E-RDS 3rd Party Expansion Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PCL.
when transfer is disabled. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
Use case - When replacing HDD The transfer license key is displayed under TR-PCL.
- When replacing the device Display/adj/set range 24 digits
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-ERDS.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-ERDS.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits
Supplement/memo E-RDS 3rd Party Expansion: A function to send charge counter to
the third party’s charge server.

8-231
8
8
8-232
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-PSLI5 Install state dis:PS/LIPS4/LIPS LX: JP ST-LIPS4 Install state display of LIPS4 func: JP
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of PS/LIPS4/LIPS LX function (JP only) Lv.2 Details To display installation state of LIPS4 function (JP only) when transfer
when transfer is disabled. is disabled.
Use case When checking whether PS/LIPS4/LIPS LX function (JP only) is Use case When checking whether LIPS4 function (JP only) is installed
installed Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-LIPS4.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PSLI5. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is displayed under TR-LIPS4.
displayed under TR-PSLI5. Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Default value 0
Default value 0 TR-LIPS4 Trns license key dis of LIPS4 func: JP
TR-PSLI5 Trns lcns key dis:PS/LIPS4/LIPS LX: JP Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use LIPS4 function (JP only) when
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use PS/LIPS4/LIPS LX function (JP transfer is disabled.
only) when transfer is disabled. Use case - When replacing HDD
Use case - When replacing HDD - When replacing the device
- When replacing the device Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-LIPS4.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PSLI5. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-LIPS4.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-PSLI5. Display/adj/set range 24 digits
Display/adj/set range 24 digits ST-PSPCL Install state dis of PS/PCL function
ST-LIPS5 Install state dis:LIPS LX/LIPS4 func: JP Lv.2 Details To display installation state of PS/PCL function when transfer is
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of LIPS LX/LIPS4 function (JP only) when disabled.
transfer is disabled. Use case When checking whether PS/PCL function is installed
Use case When checking whether LIPS LX/LIPS4 function (JP only) is installed Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PSPCL.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-LIPS5. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is displayed under TR-PSPCL.
displayed under TR-LIPS5. Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Default value 0
Default value 0 TR-PSPCL Transfer license key dis of PS/PCL func
TR-LIPS5 Trns lcns key dis:LIPS LX/LIPS4 func: JP Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use PS/PCL function when transfer
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use LIPS LX/LIPS4 function (JP is disabled.
only) when transfer is disabled. Use case - When replacing HDD
Use case - When replacing HDD - When replacing the device
- When replacing the device Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PSPCL.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-LIPS5. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-PSPCL.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-LIPS5. Display/adj/set range 24 digits
Display/adj/set range 24 digits

8-232
8
8
8-233
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-PCLUF Install state dis of PCL/UFR II function ST-PSPCU Install state dis of PS/PCL/UFR II func
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of PCL/UFR II function when transfer is Lv.2 Details To display installation state of PS/PCL/UFR II function when transfer
disabled. is disabled.
Use case When checking whether PCL/UFR II function is installed Use case When checking whether PS/PCL/UFR II function is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PCLUF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PSPCU.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-PCLUF. displayed under TR-PSPCU.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 0
TR-PCLUF Trns license key dis of PCL/UFR II func TR-PSPCU Trns lcns key dis of PS/PCL/UFR II func
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use PCL/UFR II function when Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use PS/PCL/UFR II function when
transfer is disabled. transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PCLUF. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PSPCU.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-PCLUF. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-PSPCU.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits
ST-PSLIP Install state dis of PS/LIPS4 func: JP ST-LXUFR Install state dis of UFR II function
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of PS/LIPS4 function (JP only) when Lv.2 Details To display installation state of UFR II function when transfer is
transfer is disabled. disabled.
Use case When checking whether PS/LIPS4 function (JP only) is installed Use case When checking whether UFR II function is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PSLIP. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-LXUFR.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-PSLIP. displayed under TR-LXUFR.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 1
TR-PSLIP Trns license key dis of PS/LIPS4 func:JP TR-LXUFR Trns license key dis of UFR II function
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use PS/LIPS4 function (JP only) Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use UFR II function when transfer
when transfer is disabled. is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-PSLIP. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-LXUFR.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-PSLIP. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-LXUFR.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits

8-233
8
8
8-234
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-HDCR2 Install state dis:HDD Init All Data/Set ST-MOBIL Install state dis of Mobile Link func:JP
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of HDD Initialize All Data/Settings when Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Mobile Link function (JP only) when
transfer is disabled. transfer is disabled.
Use case When checking whether HDD Initialize All Data/Settings is installed Use case When checking whether Mobile Link function (JP only) is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-HDCR2. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-MOBIL.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-HDCR2. displayed under TR-MOBIL.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 0
TR-HDCR2 Trns lcns key dis:HDD Init All Data/Set TR-MOBIL Trns lcns key dis of Mobile Link func:JP
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use HDD Initialize All Data/Settings Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Mobile Link function (JP only)
when transfer is disabled. when transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-HDCR2. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-MOBIL.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-HDCR2. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-MOBIL.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits
ST-USB-M Install state dis: Print/Save from USB ST-JBLK Install state dis of Document Scan Lock
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Print/Save from USB when transfer is Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Document Scan Lock when transfer is
disabled. disabled.
Use case When checking whether Print/Save from USB is installed Use case When checking whether Document Scan Lock is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-USB-M. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-JBLK.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-USB-M. displayed under TR-JBLK.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0 Default value 0
TR-USB-M Trns License key dis:Print/Save from USB TR-JBLK Trns lcns key dis of Document Scan Lock
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Print/Save from USB when Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Document Scan Lock when
transfer is disabled. transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device - When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-USB-M. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-JBLK.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-USB-M. The transfer license key is displayed under TR-JBLK.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits Display/adj/set range 24 digits

8-234
8
8
8-235
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-AFAX Installation state dis of Remote Fax ST-OOXML Install state dis of Office Open XML
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Remote Fax when transfer is disabled. Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Office Open XML when transfer is
Use case When checking whether Remote Fax is installed disabled.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-AFAX. Use case When checking whether Office Open XML is installed
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-OOXML.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
displayed under TR-AFAX. When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! displayed under TR-OOXML.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
TR-AFAX Transfer license key dis of Remote Fax Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Remote Fax when transfer is TR-OOXML Trns lcns key dis of Office Open XML
disabled. Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Office Open XML when transfer
Use case - When replacing HDD is disabled.
- When replacing the device Use case - When replacing HDD
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-AFAX. - When replacing the device
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-OOXML.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-AFAX. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits The transfer license key is displayed under TR-OOXML.
ST-REPDF Install state dis:Reader Extensions PDF Display/adj/set range 24 digits
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Reader Extensions PDF when transfer ST-XPS Install state dis of Direct Print XPS
is disabled. Lv.2 Details To display installation state of Direct Print XPS when transfer is
Use case When checking whether Reader Extensions PDF is installed disabled.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-REPDF. Use case When checking whether Direct Print XPS is installed
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-XPS.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
displayed under TR-REPDF. When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK! displayed under TR-XPS.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
TR-REPDF Trns lcns key dis:Reader Extensions PDF Default value 0
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Reader Extensions PDF when TR-XPS Trns lcns key dis of Direct Print XPS
transfer is disabled. Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key to use Direct Print XPS when transfer
Use case - When replacing HDD is disabled.
- When replacing the device Use case - When replacing HDD
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-REPDF. - When replacing the device
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-XPS.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-REPDF. 2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits The transfer license key is displayed under TR-XPS.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits

8-235
8
8
8-236
COPIER>OPTION>LCNS-TR
ST-2600 Instal state dis: IEEE2600.1 scrty func
Lv.2 Details To display installation state of the IEEE2600.1 security function when
transfer is disabled.
Use case When checking whether the IEEE2600.1 security function is installed
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-2600.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
When installation has been completed, the transfer license key is
displayed under TR-2600.
Display/adj/set range When operation finished normally: OK!
Default value 0
TR-2600 Trn lcns key dis: IEEE2600.1 scrty func
Lv.2 Details To display transfer license key of the IEEE2600.1 security function
when transfer is disabled.
Use case - When replacing HDD
- When replacing the device
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select ST-2600.
2) Enter 0, and then press OK key.
The transfer license key is displayed under TR-2600.
Display/adj/set range 24 digits
T-8-65

8-236
8
8
8-237
TEST COPIER>TEST>PG
Lv.1 Details To adjust Y color density when performing test print (TYPE=5).
■■PG As the value is increased, the density becomes higher.
Use case At test print (TYPE=5)
COPIER>TEST>PG Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
TYPE Test print Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Lv.1 Details To execute the test print. DENS-M Adj of M color density at test print
Use case At trouble analysis Lv.1 Details To adjust M color density when performing test print (TYPE=5).
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. As the value is increased, the density becomes higher.
Test print is executed. Use case At test print (TYPE=5)
Caution Be sure to return the value to 0 after the test print output. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 100 Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
0: Image from CCD (normal print) DENS-C Adj of C color density at test print
1 to 3: For R&D use Lv.1 Details To adjust C color density when performing test print (TYPE=5).
4: 16 gradations As the value is increased, the density becomes higher.
5: Halftone for all areas Use case At test print (TYPE=5)
6: Grid
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
7 to 9: For R&D use
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
10: MCYBk horizontal line
11: For R&D use DENS-K Adj of Bk color density at test print
12: YMCBk 64 gradations Lv.1 Details To adjust Bk color density when performing test print (TYPE=5).
13: For R&D use As the value is increased, the density becomes higher.
14: Full color 16 gradations Use case At test print (TYPE=5)
15 to 100: For R&D use Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Required time Several seconds COLOR-Y Y color output setting at test print
TXPH Setting of test print image mode Lv.1 Details To make a setting of Y color output for test print.
Lv.1 Details To set the image mode at the time of test print output. The setting is applied to all types.
This mode is enabled for test print only. When setting “COLOR-Y” to 1 and other items to “0”, a single Y color
Use case At trouble analysis is output.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case At test print
Display/adj/set range 0 to 6 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
0: Error diffusion Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
1: Low screen ruling screen (approx. 133 to 190 lines) 0: Not output, 1: Output
2: High screen ruling screen (approx. 200 to 268 lines) COLOR-M M color output setting at test print
3: Copy screen (approx. 220 lines) Lv.1 Details To make a setting of M color output for test print.
4: REOS screen (no screen structure) The setting is applied to all types.
5 to 6: Not used When setting “COLOR-M” to 1 and other items to “0”, a single M
THRU Image correction table use at test print color is output.
Lv.1 Details To set whether to use the image correction table at the time of test Use case At test print
print output. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case At trouble analysis Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. 0: Not output, 1: Output
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Used, 1: Not used
DENS-Y Adj of Y color density at test print

8-237
8
8
8-238
COPIER>TEST>PG COPIER>TEST>PG
COLOR-C C color output setting at test print PG-QTY Setting of PG output quantity
Lv.1 Details To make a setting of C color output for test print. Lv.1 Details To set the number of sheets for PG output.
The setting is applied to all types. Use case At trouble analysis
When setting “COLOR-C” to 1 and other items to “0”, a single C color Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
is output. Display/adj/set range 1 to 999
Use case At test print Unit 1 sheet
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 FINISH Accessory processing function test print
0: Not output, 1: Output Lv.1 Details To execute the test print relating to accessory processing function.
COLOR-K Bk color output setting at test print Use case When checking operation of accessory processing function
Lv.1 Details To make a setting of Bk color output for test print. Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the number of sheets for PG-QTY, and then press OK key.
The setting is applied to all types. 2) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
When setting “COLOR-K” to 1 and other items to “0”, a single Bk 3) Press Start button.
color is output. The machine outputs a test print.
Use case At test print Display/adj/set range
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Related service mode COPIER> TEST> PG> PG-QTY
0: Not output, 1: Output
T-8-66
F/M-SW Setting of PG full color/mono color
Lv.1 Details To set for the output in full color/monochrome color with PG.
Use case When separating (identifying) the cause whether it’s due to color or
monochrome.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Full color, 1: Monochrome color
PG-PICK Setting of test print pickup cassette
Lv.1 Details To set the pickup cassette for test print output.
Use case At trouble analysis
At test print output
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 1 to 8
1: Cassette1, 2: Cassette2, 3: Cassette3, 4: Cassette4, 5: Paper
Deck, 6: Multi-purpose Tray, 7 to 8: Not used
2-SIDE Setting of PG 2-sided mode
Lv.1 Details To set 1-sided/2-sided print for PG output.
Use case At trouble analysis
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: 1-sided, 1: 2-sided
Default value 0

8-238
8
8
8-239
■■NETWORK COPIER>TEST>NETWORK
BML-DISP Set System Monitor scrn: BMlinks support
COPIER>TEST>NETWORK Lv.2 Details To set whether to only display the device configuration in the System
PING Network connection check Monitor screen when supporting BMlinks.
Lv.1 Details To check connection between this machine and TCP/IP network. When the setting is switched, the Status and Log are not displayed.
Use case - When checking network connection at the time of installation Use case When supporting BMlinks
- At network connection failure Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Turn OFF the main power switch. Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
2) Connect the network cable to this machine, and then turn ON the 0: Ordinary System Monitor screen
main power switch. 1: Screen in which only the device configuration is displayed
3) Inform the system administrator at user's site that installation of Default value 0
this machine is complete, and ask for network setting.
IPV6-ADR Setting of PING send address (IPv6)
4) Ask the system administrator to check the network connection,
Lv.1 Details To set the IPv6 address to send PING.
and check the remote host address of PING transmission target.
When PING is sent to this address by COPIER> TEST> NETWORK>
5) Select the item and enter the remote host address, and then press
PING-IP6, the network connection condition in the IPv6 environment
OK key and Start key.
can be checked.
OK: Connection is normal. Checking procedure is complete.
NG: Connection failed. Go to step 6) if the cable connection is OK. In Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
case of cable connection failure, connect again and then go to step 5). Caution - Enter a consistent character string as an address of IPv6.
6) Select the item and enter loopback address, and then press OK - Enter an address within 39 characters including hexadecimal
key and Start key. numbers (0-9, a-f) and a separator (:).
OK: TCP/IP setting of this machine is normal. Go to step 7) to check Related service mode COPIER> TEST> NETWORK> PING-IP6
NIC. PING-IP6 PING transmission to IPv6 address
NG: TCP/IP setting of this machine has failure. Go to step 3) to Lv.1 Details To send PING to the address specified by IPV6-ADR.
check the setting again. The network connection condition in the IPv6 environment can be
7) Select the item and enter the local host address, and then press checked.
OK key. Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
OK: Network setting of this machine and NIC are normal. Inform the Related service mode COPIER> TEST> NETWORK> IPV6-ADR
system administrator that the trouble is due to network environment IPSECPOL Polling test of IPSec Encryption Board
and ask for countermeasure. Lv.1 Details To execute polling test of IPSec Encryption Board.
NG: Connection failure/fault with NIC. Check connection of NIC/ To check whether a hardware failure has occurred.
replace NIC. Use case When checking whether a hardware failure has occurred to the
Display/adj/set range 0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255 IPSec Encryption Board
At normal state: OK Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
At failure occurrence: NG
Display/adj/set range At normal state: OK
Supplement/memo - Remote host address: IP address of PC terminal in network. At failure occurrence: NG (0: The board cannot be recognized. 1: An
- Loopback address: 127.0.0.1. Checking TCP/IP of this machine is error occurred to the result.)
available because the signal is returned before NIC.
Required time Approx. 3 minutes
- NIC: Network interface board
IPSECINT Interrupt test of IPSec Encryption Board
- Local host address: IP address of this machine
Lv.1 Details To execute the interrupt test of IPSec Encryption Board.
To check whether a hardware failure has occurred.
Use case When checking whether a hardware failure has occurred to the
IPSec Encryption Board
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range At normal state: OK
At failure occurrence: NG (0: The board cannot be recognized. 1: An
error occurred to the result.)
Required time Approx. 3 minutes
T-8-67

8-239
8
8
8-240
COUNTER COPIER>COUNTER>TOTAL
2-SIDE 2-sided copy/print counter
■■TOTAL Lv.1 Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the machine
according to the charge counter at 2-sided copy/print.
COPIER>COUNTER>TOTAL Large size: 1, small size: 1
SERVICE1 Service-purposed total counter 1 A blank sheet is not counted.
Lv.1 Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the machine. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Large size: 1, small size: 1 SCAN Scan counter
A blank sheet is not counted. Lv.1 Details To count the number of scan operations according to the charge
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 counter when the scanning operation is complete.
SERVICE2 Service-purposed total counter 2 Large size: 1, small size: 1
Lv.1 Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the machine. Adj/set/operate method When the counter is cleared
Large size: 2, small size: 1 Select the item, and then press Clear key.
A blank sheet is not counted. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 T-8-68
COPY Total copy counter
Lv.1 Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the machine.
Large size: 1, small size: 1
A blank sheet is not counted.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
PDL-PRT PDL print counter
Lv.1 Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the machine
according to the charge counter at PDL print.
Large size: 1, small size: 1
A blank sheet is not counted.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
FAX-PRT FAX reception print counter
Lv.1 Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the machine
according to the charge counter at FAX reception.
Large size: 1, small size: 1
A blank sheet is not counted.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
BOX-PRT Inbox print counter
Lv.1 Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the machine
according to the charge counter at Inbox print.
Large size: 1, small size: 1
A blank sheet is not counted.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
RPT-PRT Report print counter
Lv.1 Details To count up when the paper is delivered outside the machine
according to the charge counter at report print.
Large size: 1, small size: 1
A blank sheet is not counted.

Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999

8-240
8
8
8-241
■■PICK-UP ■■FEEDER
COPIER>COUNTER>PICK-UP COPIER>COUNTER>FEEDER
C1 Cassette 1 pickup total counter FEED DADF original pickup total counter
Lv.1 Details Large size: 1, Small size: 1 Use case When checking the total counter of original pickup by DADF
Unit Number of sheets Unit Number of sheets
C2 Cassette 2 pickup total counter DFOP-CNT DADF hinge open/close counter
Lv.1 Details Large size: 1, Small size: 1 Use case When checking the DADF hinge open/close counter
Unit Number of sheets Unit Number of times
C3 Cassette 3 pickup total counter T-8-70
Lv.1 Details Large size: 1, Small size: 1
Unit Number of sheets
C4 Cassette 4 pickup total counter
Lv.1 Details Large size: 1, Small size: 1
Unit Number of sheets
MF Multi-purpose Tray pickup total counter
Lv.1 Details Large size: 1, Small size: 1
Unit Number of sheets
DK Deck pickup total counter
Lv.1 Details Large size: 1, Small size: 1
Unit Number of sheets
2-SIDE 2-sided pickup total counter
Lv.1 Details Large size: 1, Small size: 1
Unit Number of sheets
T-8-69

8-241
8
8
8-242
■■JAM ■■MISC
COPIER>COUNTER>JAM COPIER>COUNTER>MISC
TOTAL Printer total jam counter T-SPLY-Y Y toner supply counter
Use case When checking the total jam counter of printer Lv.1 Details Number of Y color toner supply blocks.
Unit Number of times Counted for every one rotation of Toner Stirring Screw.
FEEDER Feeder total jam counter Use case When checking the usage status of toner
Use case When checking the total jam counter of feeder Unit Number of blocks
Unit Number of times Default value 0
SORTER Finisher total jam counter T-SPLY-M M toner supply counter
Use case When checking the total jam counter of finisher Lv.1 Details Number of M color toner supply blocks.
Unit Number of times Counted for every one rotation of Toner Stirring Screw.
2-SIDE Duplex Unit jam counter Use case When checking the usage status of toner
Use case When checking the jam counter of Duplex Unit Unit Number of blocks
Unit Number of times Default value 0
MF Multi-purpose Tray jam counter T-SPLY-C C toner supply counter
Use case When checking the jam counter of Multi-purpose Tray Lv.1 Details Number of C color toner supply blocks.
Unit Number of times Counted for every one rotation of Toner Stirring Screw.
C1 Right Deck jam counter Use case When checking the usage status of toner
Use case When checking the jam counter of machine’s Right Deck Unit Number of blocks
Unit Number of times Default value 0
C2 Left Deck jam counter T-SPLY-K Bk toner supply counter
Use case When checking the jam counter of machine’s Left Deck Lv.1 Details Number of Bk color toner supply blocks.
Unit Number of times Counted for every one rotation of Toner Stirring Screw.
C3 Cassette 3 pickup jam counter Use case When checking the usage status of toner
Use case When checking the jam counter of machine’s Cassette 3 Unit Number of blocks
Unit Number of times Default value 0
C4 Cassette 4 pickup jam counter ALLPW-ON Number of DCON PCB power-on times
Use case When checking the jam counter of machine’s Cassette 4 Lv.1 Details Number of power-on times (Non-all-night Power Unit).
To count up when power is turned ON (Non-all-night Power Unit).
Unit Number of times
Use case When checking the usage status of the product
DK POD Deck Lite jam counter
Unit Number of times
Use case When checking the jam counter of POD Deck Lite
HDD-ON Number of HDD start-up times
Unit Number of times
Lv.1 Details To count up at HDD start-up.
T-8-71
Use case When checking the usage status of the product
Unit Number of times
ST-NDL Staple needle counter: Fin-A1/C1
Lv.1 Details To count the use of the staple needle.
Unit Number of times
ENT-PTH Entrance paper path counter: Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details Entrance paper path counter
Unit Number of sheets
TRAY-CHA Tray change counter: Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details Tray change counter
Unit Number of times
PUNCH [Not used]

8-242
8
8
8-243
COPIER>COUNTER>MISC ■■JOB
PUN-CAB Punch Unit Cable counter: Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details Punch Unit Cable counter
COPIER>COUNTER>JOB
Unit Number of times DVPAPLEN Average paper length of job
PUN-WST Punch waste counter: Fin-C1 Lv.1 Details Average paper length in the period from when the printer engine
starts printing operation to when it stops the operation.
Lv.1 Details Punch Unit punch waste counter
Since the printer engine considers small jobs that are executed
SADDLE [Not used]
continuously as a large job, the average paper length affects
SDL-STPL [Not used] calculation of the life.
SDL-NDL Saddle staple needle counter: Fin-C1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Lv.1 Details To count the use of the Saddle staple needle. Unit mm
Unit Number of times DVRUNLEN Average distance of job
ESC-PTH [Not used] Lv.1 Details Average running distance in the period from when the printer engine
SUC-A-Y For R&D use starts printing operation to when it stops the operation.
SUC-A-M For R&D use Since the printer engine considers small jobs that are executed
SUC-A-C For R&D use continuously as a large job, the average running distance affects
SUC-A-K For R&D use calculation of the life.
SUC-L-Y For R&D use Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
SUC-L-M For R&D use Unit mm
SUC-L-C For R&D use T-8-73
SUC-L-K For R&D use
T-8-72

8-243
8
8
8-244
■■DRBL-1 COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-1
PT-DRM Bk Photosensitive Drum parts counter
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-1 Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
T/S-UNIT Transfer Separation Guide parts counter 2nd line: Estimated life
Lv.1 Details Transfer Separation Guide Unit Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
2nd line: Estimated life To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
then press OK key.
Default value 0
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
DV-UNT-C Developing Assembly (C) parts counter
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Default value 0 2nd line: Estimated life
T-CLN-BD ITB Cleaning Blade parts counter Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Lv.1 Details ITB Cleaning Blade Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
2nd line: Estimated life then press OK key.
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
DV-UNT-Y Developing Assembly (Y) parts counter
then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
2nd line: Estimated life
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
TR-BLT ITB parts counter To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement then press OK key.
2nd line: Estimated life Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. DV-UNT-M Developing Assembly (M) parts counter
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
then press OK key.
2nd line: Estimated life
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Default value 0 To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
2TR-ROLL Sec Transfer Outer Roller parts counter then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details Secondary Transfer Outer Roller Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
2nd line: Estimated life
DV-UNT-K Developing Assembly (Bk) parts counter
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. 2nd line: Estimated life
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 then press OK key.
Default value 0 Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Supplement/memo This is commonly used as operator maintenance parts counter. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999

8-244
8
8
8-245
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-1 COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-1
C1-SP-RL Cassette1 Separation Roller prts counter M-SP-RL Multi-purpose Tray Sprtn Roll prts cntr
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Lv.1 Details Multi-purpose Tray Separation Roller
2nd line: Estimated life 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts 2nd line: Estimated life
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
then press OK key. To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
C1-FD-RL Cassette1 Feed Roller parts counter Default value 0
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement M-FD-RL Multi-purpose Tray Feed Roll prts cntr
2nd line: Estimated life Lv.1 Details Multi-purpose Tray Feed Roller
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. 2nd line: Estimated life
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 then press OK key.
Default value 0 Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
C2-SP-RL Cassette2 Separation Roller prts counter Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Default value 0
2nd line: Estimated life FX-LW-RL Pressure Roller parts counter
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. 2nd line: Estimated life
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 then press OK key.
Default value 0 Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
C2-FD-RL Cassette2 Feed Roller parts counter Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Default value 0
2nd line: Estimated life FX-UNIT Fixing Assembly parts counter
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. 2nd line: Estimated life
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 then press OK key.
Default value 0 Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0
FX-UP-FR [Not used]

8-245
8
8
8-246
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-1 COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-1
FX-LW-BR Fixing Bearing parts counter PT-DR-M Drum Motor (M) drive sheets counter
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
2nd line: Estimated life 2nd line: Estimated life
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
then press OK key. then press OK key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0 Default value 0
WST-TNR Waste Toner Container parts counter PT-DR-C Drum Motor (C) drive sheets counter
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
2nd line: Estimated life 2nd line: Estimated life
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
then press OK key. then press OK key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0 Default value 0
TN-FIL1 Toner Filter parts counter TR-ROLK Primary Transfer Roller(Bk) parts counter
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Lv.1 Details Due to the engagement/disengagement of the Roller, Bk Roller
2nd line: Estimated life counter is advanced separately from Y/M/C Roller
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. 2nd line: Estimated life
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 then press OK key.
Default value 0 Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
PT-DR-Y Drum Motor (Y) drive sheets counter Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Default value 0
2nd line: Estimated life Related service mode COPIER> COUNTER> DRBL-1> TR-ROLC
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts TR-ROLC Primary Transfer Roller(Y/M/C) parts counter
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Lv.1 Details Due to the engagement/disengagement of the Roller, Y/M/C Roller
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and counter is advanced separately from Bk Roller
then press OK key. 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. 2nd line: Estimated life
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
then press OK key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0
Related service mode COPIER> COUNTER> DRBL-1> TR-ROLK
T-8-74

8-246
8
8
8-247
■■DRBL-2 COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2
DF-SP-RL Separation Roller prts counter: D-Reader
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2 Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
DF-PU-RL Pickup Roller parts counter: All Reader 2nd line: Estimated life
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
2nd line: Estimated life Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. then press OK key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Unit Number of sheets
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Default value 0
Unit Number of sheets Supplement/memo Regardless of the read mode (1-sided/2-sided), the counter is
Default value 0 advanced every time a sheet is fed.
Supplement/memo Regardless of the read mode (1-sided/2-sided), the counter is LNT-TAP1 Dust-collecting counter: All Reader
advanced every time a sheet is fed. Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
DF-SP-PD Pickup Separation Pad parts cntr: Reader 2nd line: Estimated life
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
2nd line: Estimated life Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. then press OK key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Unit Number of sheets
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Default value 0
Unit Number of sheets Supplement/memo Regardless of the read mode (1-sided/2-sided), the counter is
Default value 0 advanced every time a sheet is fed.
Supplement/memo Regardless of the read mode (1-sided/2-sided), the counter is LNT-TAP2 Dust-colleting Type E counter: D-Reader
advanced every time a sheet is fed. Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
DF-FD-RL Feed Roller1 parts counter: D-Reader 2nd line: Estimated life
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
2nd line: Estimated life Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. then press OK key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
then press OK key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Unit Number of sheets
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Default value 0
Unit Number of sheets Supplement/memo Regardless of the read mode (1-sided/2-sided), the counter is
Default value 0 advanced every time a sheet is fed.
Supplement/memo Regardless of the read mode (1-sided/2-sided), the counter is
advanced every time a sheet is fed.

8-247
8
8
8-248
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2 COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2
STAMP Stamp parts counter: All Reader PD-SP-RL Separation Roller parts counter: Deck
Lv.1 Details To display the parts counter and the estimated life of DADF Stamp. Lv.1 Details Separation Roller of Paper Deck/POD Deck Lite/Multi Deck (Upper)
1st line: Number of sheets fed after the previous replacement 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
2nd line: Estimated life to be entered by operator 2nd line: Estimated life
Use case At replacement Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, and then enter the To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
estimated life. then press OK key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Unit Number of sheets Unit Number of sheets
Default value 0 Default value 0
DF-HNG-L Left Hinge parts counter: All Reader PD-FD-RL Feed Roller parts counter: Deck
Lv.1 Details To display the parts counter and the estimated life of DADF Hinge Lv.1 Details Feed Roller of Paper Deck/POD Deck Lite/Multi Deck (Upper)
Unit (Left). 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
1st line: Number of sheets fed after the previous replacement 2nd line: Estimated life
2nd line: Estimated life to be entered by operator Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Use case At replacement Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
To change the estimated life: Select the item, and then enter the then press OK key.
estimated life. Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Unit Number of sheets
Unit Number of sheets Default value 0
Default value 0 C3-SP-RL Cassette3 Separation Roller prts counter
Supplement/memo The counter is advanced every time it is opened/closed. Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
PD-PU-RL Pickup Roller parts counter: Deck 2nd line: Estimated life
Lv.1 Details Pickup Roller (Front/Rear) of Paper Deck/POD Deck Lite/Multi Deck Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
(Upper) Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
2nd line: Estimated life then press OK key.
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Default value 0
then press OK key. C3-FD-RL Cassette3 Feed Roller parts counter
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 2nd line: Estimated life
Unit Number of sheets Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
then press OK key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0

8-248
8
8
8-249
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2 COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2
C4-SP-RL Cassette4 Separation Roller prts counter SADDLE Saddle feed path parts counter: Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
2nd line: Estimated life 2nd line: Estimated life
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
then press OK key. then press OK key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0 Unit Number of times
C4-FD-RL Cassette4 Feed Roller parts counter Default value 0
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement SDL-STPL Saddle Stapler parts counter: Fin-C1
2nd line: Estimated life Lv.1 Details Saddle Stapler Unit
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. 2nd line: Estimated life
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
then press OK key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 then press OK key.
Default value 0 Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
SORT Sort path parts counter Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Unit Number of times
2nd line: Estimated life Default value 0
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts PUNCH Puncher parts counter: Fin-C1
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Lv.1 Details To count the number of punching in the Inner Puncher
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
then press OK key. 2nd line: Estimated life
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Unit Number of sheets To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Default value 0 then press OK key.
FIN-STPR Stapler parts counter: Fin-A1/C1 Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Lv.1 Details Stapler Unit Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement Unit Number of times
2nd line: Estimated life Default value 0
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts FN-BFFRL Buffer Roller parts counter: Fin-C1
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and 2nd line: Estimated life
then press OK key. Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
Unit Number of times then press OK key.
Default value 0 Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0

8-249
8
8
8-250
COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2 COPIER>COUNTER>DRBL-2
ENT-STC Inlet Sttc Chg Elim prts cntr: Fin-A1/C1 OFST-RL Offset Roller parts counter: Fin-A1
Lv.1 Details Inlet Static Charge Eliminator Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement 2nd line: Estimated life
2nd line: Estimated life Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and then press OK key.
then press OK key. Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Unit Number of sheets
Default value 0 Default value 0
CENT-STC Swng Guide Inside Sttc Chg Elim: Fin-A1 RET-RL Return Roller parts counter: Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details Swing Guide Inside Static Charge Eliminator Lv.1 Details Paper Return Roller (Front/Rear)
1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
2nd line: Estimated life 2nd line: Estimated life
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
then press OK key. then press OK key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0 Default value 0
BACK-ROL Return Roller parts counter: Fin-A1 SWG-STC Swng Guide Inside Sttc Chg Elim: Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details Paper Return Roller (Front/Rear) Lv.1 Details Swing Guide Inside Static Charge Eliminator
1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
2nd line: Estimated life 2nd line: Estimated life
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key. Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
then press OK key. then press OK key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement. Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999 Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Default value 0 Default value 0
DL-STC Stack Wall Sttc Elim prts cntr:Fin-A1/C1 T-8-75
Lv.1 Details 1st line: Total counter value from the previous replacement
2nd line: Estimated life
Use case When checking the consumption level of parts/replacing the parts
Adj/set/operate method To clear the counter value: Select the item, and then press Clear key.
To change the estimated life: Select the item, enter the value, and
then press OK key.
Caution Clear the counter value after replacement.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 99999999
Unit Number of sheets
Default value 0

8-250
8
8
8-251
■■T-CNTR ■■V-CNTR
COPIER>COUNTER>T-CNTR COPIER>COUNTER>V-CNTR
YELLOW Y Toner Container counter TOTAL Video count total counter
Lv.1 Details To count up in the unit of 0.1 Y color Toner Container consumed. Lv.1 Details To display distribution of total video count for each color.
Use case When checking the consumption volume of Toner Container Small size: 1, Large size: 1
MAGENTA M Toner Container counter Use case When checking distribution of video count
Lv.1 Details To count up in the unit of 0.1 M color Toner Container consumed. YELLOW Video count Y counter
Use case When checking the consumption volume of Toner Container Lv.1 Details To display distribution of yellow video count.
CYAN C Toner Container counter Small size: 1, Large size: 1
Lv.1 Details To count up in the unit of 0.1 C color Toner Container consumed. Use case When checking distribution of video count
Use case When checking the consumption volume of Toner Container MAGENTA Video count M counter
BLACK Bk Toner Container counter Lv.1 Details To display distribution of magenta video count.
Lv.1 Details To count up in the unit of 0.1 Bk color Toner Container consumed. Small size: 1, Large size: 1
Use case When checking the consumption volume of Toner Container Use case When checking distribution of video count
T-8-76 CYAN Video count C counter
Lv.1 Details To display distribution of cyan video count.
Small size: 1, Large size: 1
Use case When checking distribution of video count
BLACK Video count Bk counter
Lv.1 Details To display distribution of black video count.
Small size: 1, Large size: 1
Use case When checking distribution of video count
T-8-77

8-251
8
8
8-252
■■V2-CNTR ■■LF
COPIER>COUNTER>V2-CNTR COPIER>COUNTER>LF
TOTAL Video count total counter Y-DRM-LF Display of Drum Unit (Y) life
Lv.1 Details To display distribution of total video count for each color. Lv.1 Details To display how much the Drum Unit (Y) is close to the end of life in
Small size: 1, Large size: 2 % (percentage).
Use case When checking distribution of video count When a new part is set, the value becomes 0%.
YELLOW Video count Y counter Use case When checking the life of Drum Unit
Lv.1 Details To display distribution of yellow video count. Display/adj/set range 0 to 100
Small size: 1, Large size: 2 Unit %
Use case When checking distribution of video count Default value 0
MAGENTA Video count M counter M-DRM-LF Display of Drum Unit (M) life
Lv.1 Details To display distribution of magenta video count. Lv.1 Details To display how much the Drum Unit (M) is close to the end of life in
Small size: 1, Large size: 2 % (percentage).
Use case When checking distribution of video count When a new part is set, the value becomes 0%.
CYAN Video count C counter Use case When checking the life of Drum Unit
Lv.1 Details To display distribution of cyan video count. Display/adj/set range 0 to 100
Small size: 1, Large size: 2 Unit %
Use case When checking distribution of video count Default value 0
BLACK Video count Bk counter C-DRM-LF Display of Drum Unit (C) life
Lv.1 Details To display distribution of black video count. Lv.1 Details To display how much the Drum Unit (C) is close to the end of life in
Small size: 1, Large size: 2 % (percentage).
Use case When checking distribution of video count When a new part is set, the value becomes 0%.
T-8-78 Use case When checking the life of Drum Unit
Display/adj/set range 0 to 100
Unit %
Default value 0
K-DRM-LF Display of Drum Unit (Bk) life
Lv.1 Details To display how much the Drum Unit (Bk) is close to the end of life in
% (percentage).
When a new part is set, the value becomes 0%.
Use case When checking the life of Drum Unit
Display/adj/set range 0 to 100
Unit %
Default value 0
T-8-79

8-252
8
8
8-253

FEEDER RDSN-RCV
FEEDER>DISPLAY
Display of Lead Sensor reception voltage
Lv.1 Details To display the light-receiving voltage value for the Lead Sensor.
DISPLAY Use case When jams frequently occur
Adj/set/operate method Remove and insert the paper at the sensor position, and check the
value at presence/absence of the paper.
FEEDER>DISPLAY
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
FEEDSIZE Dis of original size detected by DADF
Appropriate target value At the presence of paper: 123 or lower, At the absence of paper: 179
Lv.1 Details To display the original size detected by DADF.
or higher
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
DRSN-LMN Dis of Delivery Sensor emit voltg
TRY-WIDE Distance of Original Width Detect Slider
Lv.1 Details To display the light-emitting voltage value for the Delivery Sensor.
Lv.1 Details To display the distance between the Original Width Detection Sliders.
Use case When jams frequently occur
Use case At original size detection error
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
Adj/set/operate method Check whether the value matching the slide position is displayed
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
when the Original Width Slider is moved to the specified size width
position. Appropriate target value Approx. 113
Display/adj/set range 0 to approx. 2970 DRSN-RCV Dis of Delivery Sensor recv voltg
Unit 0.1 mm Lv.1 Details To display the light-receiving voltage value for the Delivery Sensor.
SPSN-LMN Dis of Post-sprtn Sensr emission voltage Use case When jams frequently occur
Lv.1 Details To display the light-emitting voltage value for the Post-separation Adj/set/operate method Remove and insert the paper at the sensor position, and check the
Sensor. value at presence/absence of the paper.
Use case When jams frequently occur Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only) Appropriate target value At the presence of paper: 123 or lower, At the absence of paper: 179
or higher
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
T-8-80
Appropriate target value Approx. 113
SPSN-RCV Dis of Post-sprtn Sensr recv voltage
Lv.1 Details To display the light-receiving voltage value for the Post-separation
Sensor.
Use case When jams frequently occur
Adj/set/operate method Remove and insert the paper at the sensor position, and check the
value at presence/absence of the paper.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Appropriate target value At the presence of paper: 123 or lower, At the absence of paper: 179
or higher
RDSN-LMN Dis of Lead Sensor emission voltage
Lv.1 Details To display the light-emitting voltage value for the Lead Sensor.
Use case When jams frequently occur
Adj/set/operate method N/A (Display only)
Display/adj/set range 0 to 255
Appropriate target value Approx. 113

8-253
8
8
8-254
ADJUST FEEDER>ADJUST
LA-SPD2 Fine adj of DADF image magnifictn: back
FEEDER>ADJUST Lv.1 Details To adjust the image magnification in vertical scanning direction for
DADF scanning.
DOCST Adj of DADF img lead edge margin: front
As the value is incremented by 1, the image is reduced by 0.1% in
Lv.1 Details To adjust the margin at the leading edge of the image for DADF
vertical scanning direction. (The feeding speed increases, and the
scanning.
image is reduced.)
Execute when the output image after DADF installation is dislocated.
Use case - When installing DADF
Enter the value of service label when Reader Controller PCB is
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
replaced/RAM data is cleared.
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin at the leading edge of Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
the image is decreased by 0.1mm. (The image moves in the direction Display/adj/set range -20 to 20
of the leading edge of the sheet.) Unit 0.10%
Use case - When installing DADF Default value 0
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data ADJMSCN1 Zoom adj in 2-sided horz scan way: front
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.1 Details To make a fine adjustment of the front side image magnification in
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 horizontal scanning direction at the time of DADF duplex scanning.
Unit 0.1 mm As the value is incremented by 1, the image is reduced by 0.1% in
Default value 0 horizontal scanning direction.
LA-SPEED Fine adj of DADF image magnifictn: front Use case When a displacement occurs to the front/back side image
magnification at the time of duplex scanning
Lv.1 Details To adjust the image magnification in vertical scanning direction for
DADF scanning. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
As the value is incremented by 1, the image is reduced by 0.1% in Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
vertical scanning direction. (The feeding speed increases, and the Unit 0.10%
image is reduced.) Default value 0
Use case - When installing DADF ADJMSCN2 Zoom adj in 2-sided horz scan way: back
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Lv.1 Details To make a fine adjustment of the back side image magnification in
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. horizontal scanning direction at the time of DADF duplex scanning.
Display/adj/set range -30 to 30 As the value is incremented by 1, the image is reduced by 0.1% in
Unit 0.10% horizontal scanning direction.
Default value 0 Use case When a displacement occurs to the front/back side image
DOCST2 Adj of DADF img lead edge margin: back magnification at the time of duplex scanning
Lv.1 Details To adjust the margin at the leading edge of the image for DADF Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
scanning. Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Execute when the output image after DADF installation is dislocated. Unit 0.10%
Enter the value of service label when Reader Controller PCB is Default value 0
replaced/RAM data is cleared. ADJSSCN1 Zoom adj in 2-sided vert scan way: front
As the value is incremented by 1, the margin at the leading edge of Lv.1 Details To make a fine adjustment of the front side image magnification in
the image is decreased by 0.1mm. (The image moves in the direction vertical scanning direction at the time of DADF duplex scanning.
of the leading edge of the sheet.) As the value is incremented by 1, the image is reduced by 0.1% in
Use case - When installing DADF vertical scanning direction.
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data Use case When a displacement occurs to the front/back side image
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. magnification at the time of duplex scanning
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Unit 0.1 mm Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Default value 0 Unit 0.10%
Default value 0

8-254
8
8
8-255
FEEDER>ADJUST FUNCTION
ADJSSCN2 Zoom adj in 2-sided vert scan way: back
Lv.1 Details To make a fine adjustment of the back side image magnification in FEEDER>FUNCTION
vertical scanning direction at the time of DADF duplex scanning.
SENS-INT Initialization of DADF Sensors
As the value is incremented by 1, the image is reduced by 0.1% in
Lv.1 Details To initialize DADF Sensors.
vertical scanning direction.
Use case When replacing Reader Controller PCB / Post-separation Sensor 1
Use case When a displacement occurs to the front/back side image
(SR2) / Post-separation Sensor 2 (SR3) / Post-separation Sensor 3
magnification at the time of duplex scanning
(PCB2) / Registration Sensor (PCB3) / Lead Sensor 1 (PCB4) / Lead
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Sensor 2 (SR5)
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Unit 0.10%
MTR-CHK Specifying DADF Operation Motor
Default value 0
Lv.1 Details To specify the DADF Motor to operate.
T-8-81 The motor is activated by MTR-ON.
Use case At operation check
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 9
0: Pickup Motor (M1), 1: Feed Motor (M2), 2: Registration Motor (M3),
3: Read Motor (M4), 4: Delivery Motor (M5), 5: Disengagement Motor
1 (M6), 6: Disengagement Motor 2 (M7), 7: Tray Lifter Motor (M8), 8:
Glass Shift Motor (M9), 9: Pickup Roller Unit Lifter Motor (M10)
Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> MTR-ON
TRY-A4 Adj of DADF Tray width detect ref 1: A4
Lv.1 Details To automatically adjust the paper width detection reference point 1
for the DADF Tray. (A4)
Use case - When replacing the Original Width Volume (VR)
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
TRY-A5R Adj of DADF Tray width detect ref 2: A5R
Lv.1 Details To automatically adjust the paper width detection reference point 2
for the DADF Tray. (A5R)
Use case - When replacing the Original Width Volume (VR)
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
TRY-LTR Adj of DADF Tray width detect ref 1: LTR
Lv.1 Details To automatically adjust the paper width detection reference point 1
for the DADF Tray. (LTR)
Use case - When replacing the Original Width Volume (VR)
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
TRY-LTRR Adj of DADF Tray width detect ref2: LTRR
Lv.1 Details To automatically adjust the paper width detection reference point 2
for the DADF Tray. (LTRR)
Use case - When replacing the Original Width Volume (VR)
- When replacing the Reader Controller PCB/clearing RAM data
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.

8-255
8
8
8-256
FEEDER>FUNCTION FEEDER>FUNCTION
FEED-CHK Specifying DADF individual feed mode FAN-ON Operation check of DADF Fan
Lv.1 Details To specify the feed mode for DADF. Lv.1 Details To start operation check for the fan specified by FAN-CHK.
Feed operation is activated by FEED-ON. Use case At operation check
Use case At operation check Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key. The fan operates for approximately 5 seconds and automatically
Display/adj/set range 0 to 3 stops.
0: 1-sided pickup/delivery operation 2) Press OK key.
1: 2-sided pickup/delivery operation The operation check is completed.
2: 1-sided pickup/delivery operation (with stamp) Caution Press OK key again after execution. It stops automatically after
3: 2-sided pickup/delivery operation (with stamp) approx. 5 sec; however, it does not finish unless OK key is pressed
Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> FEED-ON (STOP screen does not appear.)
CL-CHK Specifying DADF Operation Clutch Required time Approx. 5 seconds
Lv.1 Details To specify the DADF Clutch to be operated. Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> FAN-CHK
The Clutch is activated by CL-ON. SL-CHK Specifying DADF Operation Solenoid
Use case At operation check Lv.1 Details To specify the DADF solenoid to be operate.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key. The solenoid is activated by SL-ON.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Use case At operation check
0: Clutch (CL1), 1: Clutch (CL2) Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> CL-ON Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
CL-ON Operation check of DADF Clutch 0: Disengagement Solenoid (SL1)
Lv.1 Details To start operation check for the Clutch specified by CL-CHK. 1: Stamp Solenoid (SL2)
Use case At operation check Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> SL-ON
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key. SL-ON Operation check of DADF Solenoid
The clutch operates for approximately 5 seconds and automatically Lv.1 Details To start operation check for the solenoid specified by SL-CHK.
stops. Use case At operation check
2) Press OK key. Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
The operation check is completed. The unit operates for approximately 5 seconds and automatically
Caution Press OK key again after execution. It stops automatically after stops.
approx. 5 sec; however, it does not finish unless OK key is pressed 2) Press OK key.
(STOP screen does not appear.) The operation check is completed.
Required time Approx. 5 seconds Caution Be sure to press the OK key again after execution. The operation
Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> CL-CHK automatically stops after approximately 5 seconds, but is not
FAN-CHK Specifying DADF Operation Fan completed unless the OK key is pressed (STOP is not displayed).
Required time Approx. 5 seconds
Lv.1 Details To specify the DADF Fan to be operated. Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> SL-CHK
The fan is activated by FAN-ON.
Use case At operation check
Adj/set/operate method Enter the value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Motor Driver Cooling Fan (FM1)
1: Read Motor Cooling Fan (FM2)
Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION>FAN-ON

8-256
8
8
8-257
FEEDER>FUNCTION
MTR-ON Operation check of motor
Lv.1 Details To start operation check for the motor specified by MTR-CHK.
Use case At operation check
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
The unit operates for approximately 5 seconds and automatically
stops.
2) Press OK key.
The operation check is completed.
Caution Be sure to press the OK key again after execution. The operation
automatically stops after approximately 5 seconds, but is not
completed unless the OK key is pressed (STOP is not displayed).
Required time Approx. 5 seconds
Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> MTR-CHK
ROLL-CLN Rotation of DADF Rollers
Lv.1 Details To rotate for cleaning the DADF Rollers.
Clean the roller by putting the lint-free paper moistened with alcohol
while it is rotating.
Use case At roller cleaning
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
2) Clean the rotating rollers with lint-free paper moistened with
alcohol.
3) Press OK key.
The rollers stop.
FEED-ON Operation check of DADF individual feed
Lv.1 Details To start operation check for the feed mode specified by FEED-CHK.
Use case At operation check
Adj/set/operate method Select the item, and then press OK key.
Related service mode FEEDER> FUNCTION> FEED-CHK
T-8-82

8-257
8
8
8-258

SORTER STP-R1
SORTER>ADJUST
Adj rear staple pstn (45deg)(A4): Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details To adjust the one rear staple position on the A4 size paper.
ADJUST As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves to the
rear side by 0.49 mm.
Use case When misalignment occurs at the rear staple position on A4 size
SORTER>ADJUST
paper
PNCH-HLE Adj of punch hole pstn from paper edge
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the length from the paper edge to the punch hole.
Display/adj/set range -6 to 6
As the value is incremented by 1, the punch hole moves by 1 mm.
Unit 0.49 mm
+:
-: Appropriate target value 0
Use case Upon user’s request Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key. STP-R2 Adj rear staple pstn (45deg)(LTR):Fin-C1
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch. Lv.1 Details To adjust the one rear staple position on the LTR paper.
Display/adj/set range -4 to 2 As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves to the
rear side by 0.49 mm.
Unit 1 mm
Use case When misalignment occurs at the rear staple position on LTR size
Default value 0
paper
STP-F1 Adj frt staple pstn (45deg)(A4): Fin-C1
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Lv.1 Details To adjust the one front staple position on the A4 size paper.
Display/adj/set range -6 to 6
As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves to the
rear side by 0.49 mm. Unit 0.49 mm
Use case When misalignment occurs at the front staple position on A4R size Appropriate target value 0
paper Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. STP-2P Adj front/rear 2-staple position: Fin-A1
Display/adj/set range -6 to 6 Lv.1 Details To adjust the front/rear 2-staple position on Finisher.
Unit 0.49 mm As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves by
0.1mm.
Appropriate target value 0
+: Toward front
Default value 0
-: Toward rear
STP-F2 Adj frt staple pstn (45deg)(LTR): Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details To adjust the one front staple position on the LTR size paper. Use case When the front/rear 2-staple position is displaced
As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves to the
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
rear side by 0.49 mm.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Use case When misalignment occurs at the front staple position on LTR size
Display/adj/set range -25 to 25
paper
Unit 0.1 mm
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
SDL-STP Adj of saddle staple position:Fin-C1
Display/adj/set range -6 to 6
Lv.1 Details To adjust the staple position for saddle stitching..
Unit 0.49 mm
As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves
Appropriate target value 0 downward by 0.5 mm.
Default value 0 Use case When misalignment occurs at the fold position and the staple
position for saddle stitching
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -3 to 3
Unit 0.5 mm
Appropriate target value 0
Default value 0

8-258
8
8
8-259
SORTER>ADJUST SORTER>ADJUST
SDL-ALG Adj of saddle alignment position: Fin-C1 STP-F4 Adj LTRR frt stpl pstn (<45 deg): Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details To adjust the travel length of the Alignment Plate for saddle stitching. Lv.1 Details To adjust the one front staple position on the LTRR size paper.
As the value is incremented by 1, the alignment position moves in As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves to the
the push-in direction by 0.5 mm. rear side by 0.49mm.
Use case When misalignment occurs during the saddle stitching Use case When misalignment occurs at the front staple position on LTRR size
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. paper
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Unit 0.5 mm Display/adj/set range -6 to 6
Appropriate target value 0 Unit 0.49 mm
Default value 0 Appropriate target value 0
ST-ALG1 Adj Stacker A4 size align pstn: Fin-C1 Default value 0
Lv.1 Details To adjust the A4 size paper alignment position. STP-R3 Adj A4R rear stpl pstn (<45 deg): Fin-C1
As the value is incremented by 1, the travel length of the Alignment Lv.1 Details To adjust the one rear staple position on the A4R size paper.
Plate is increased by 0.42mm. As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves to the
Use case When misalignment occurs in A4 size paper rear side by 0.49mm.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When misalignment occurs at the rear staple position on A4R size
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10 paper
Unit 0.42 mm Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Appropriate target value 0 Display/adj/set range -6 to 6
Default value 0 Unit 0.49 mm
ST-ALG2 Adj Stacker LTR size align pstn: Fin-C1 Appropriate target value 0
Lv.1 Details To adjust the LTR size paper alignment position. Default value 0
As the value is incremented by 1, the travel length of the Alignment STP-R4 Adj LTRR rear stpl pstn (<45 deg):Fin-C1
Plate is increased by 0.42mm. Lv.1 Details To adjust the one rear staple position on the LTRR size paper.
Use case When misalignment occurs in LTR size paper As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves to the
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. rear side by 0.49mm.
Display/adj/set range -10 to 10 Use case When misalignment occurs at the rear staple position on LTRR size
Unit 0.42 mm paper
Appropriate target value 0 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -6 to 6
STP-F3 Adj A4R frt stpl pstn (<45 deg): Fin-C1 Unit 0.49 mm
Lv.1 Details To adjust the one front staple position on the A4R size paper. Appropriate target value 0
As the value is incremented by 1, the staple position moves to the Default value 0
rear side by 0.49mm. SW-UP-RL Adj of Swing Roller falling pstn: Fin-C1
Use case When misalignment occurs at the front staple position on A4R size Lv.1 Details To adjust the Swing Roller down position.
paper As the value is incremented by 1, the Swing Roller down position
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. moves downward by 0.2mm.
Display/adj/set range -6 to 6 Use case When paper fails to be transported to the Processing Tray and
Unit 0.49 mm misalignment occurs
Appropriate target value 0 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -17 to 33
Unit 0.2 mm
Appropriate target value 0
Default value 0

8-259
8
8
8-260
SORTER>ADJUST SORTER>ADJUST
PUN-V-RG [Not used] THC-PUSH Setting heavy ppr out prev mode:Fin-C1
PRCS-RET Adj Process Tray return amount: Fin-C1 Lv.1 Details Set 1 when the already stacked paper is pushed out at the time of
Lv.1 Details To adjust the pull-back amount of the paper on the Processing Tray. heavy paper delivery.
As the value is incremented by 1, the pull-back amount is decreased When 1 is set, the Stack Tray moves down temporarily before the
by 1.4mm. heavy paper is delivered to the Processing Tray if the leading sheet
Use case When the paper is bent in the Processing Tray is heavy paper.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Use case When the already stacked paper is pushed out at the time of heavy
Display/adj/set range 0 to 5 paper delivery
Unit 1.4 mm
Appropriate target value 0 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
UP-CL Setting of upward curl prev mode: Fin-C1 0: OFF, 1: ON
Lv.1 Details Set 1 when upward curl occurs on the paper delivered to the Stack Default value 0
Tray, and paper leaning due to the curl occurs. OFST-STC Set poor offset stack prev mode:Fin-C1
Use case When upward curl occurs on the paper delivered to the Stack Tray, Lv.1 Details Set 1 when paper is not appropriately stacked in the small-size offset
and paper leaning due to the curl occurs mode.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When 1 is set, buffer operation is not performed in the small-size
offset mode.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON Use case When paper is not appropriately stacked in the small-size offset
mode
Default value 0
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
DW-CL Setting downward curl prev mode: Fin-C1
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
Lv.1 Details Set 1 when downward curl occurs on the paper delivered to the
0: OFF, 1: ON
Stack Tray, and papers are not stacked accurately.
Default value 0
Use case When downward curl occurs on the paper delivered to the Stack
Tray, and papers are not stacked accurately THN-STC Set poor thin ppr stack prev mode:Fin-C1
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Lv.1 Details Set 1 when thin paper is not appropriately stacked.
When 1 is set, the stacking condition of thin paper improves.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON Use case When thin paper is not appropriately stacked
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
THC-CL Setting heavy ppr curl prev mode:Fin-C1 Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Lv.1 Details Set 1 when upward curl occurs at the time of heavy paper delivery.
When 1 is set, the amount of Stack Tray descension for stack Default value 0
delivery increases. The paper surface detection is performed for STP-P-CH Set stpl stack displace prev mode:Fin-C1
every sheet, not for every 5 sheets. Lv.1 Details Set 1 when the paper on the top is misaligned in the staple delivery
Use case When upward curl occurs at the time of heavy paper delivery mode.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. When 1 is set, paper stack alignment operation is executed twice
immediately before stapling.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON Use case When the paper on the top is misaligned in the staple delivery mode
Default value 0 Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0

8-260
8
8
8-261
SORTER>ADJUST SORTER>ADJUST
TRY-NIS Set tray switch noise reduct mode:Fin-C1 SDL-ALM Set sddl full stack alarm mode: Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details Set 1 when the operation noise at the time of switching the Stack Lv.1 Details Set 1 when disabling the stack full alarm for saddle stitching.
Tray is loud. Use case When disabling the stack full alarm for saddle stitching
When 1 is set, the Stack Tray rise operation becomes slow. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When the operation noise at the time of switching the Stack Tray is Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
loud 0: OFF, 1: ON
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Default value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 SFT-AMT1 Adj shft amnt of Shft Roll (frt): Fin-A1
0: OFF, 1: ON Lv.1 Details To adjust the front shift amount of the Shift Roller.
Default value 0 As the value is incremented by 1, the Shift Roller moves toward the
TRY-SU Set tray switching speedup mode: Fin-C1 guide by 0.1 mm.
Lv.1 Details Set 1 when the Stack Tray switching time is long. Use case When the front shift amount of the paper is inappropriate
When 1 is set, the Stack Tray rise speed becomes fast. Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Use case When the Stack Tray switching time is long Display/adj/set range 0 to 50
Unit 0.1 mm
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Appropriate target value 0
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Default value 0
0: OFF, 1: ON SFT-AMT2 Adj shft amnt of Shft Roll(Rear): Fin-A1
Default value 0 Lv.1 Details To adjust the rear shift amount of the Shift Roller.
FIN-NIS Set tray drive noise reduct mode: Fin-C1 As the value is incremented by 1, the Shift Roller moves toward the
Lv.1 Details Set 1 when the Finisher operation noise is loud. guide by 0.1 mm.
When 1 is set, the initial Finisher operation is minimized. Use case When the rear shift amount of the paper is inappropriate
Use case When the Finisher operation noise is loud Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Unit 0.1 mm
0: OFF, 1: ON Appropriate target value 0
Default value 0 Default value 0
1SHT-SHF Set 1-sheet Offset+Collate: Fin-C1 STP-NTN Adj of Staple Needle pitch (A4): Fin-A1
Lv.1 Details Set 1 when setting Offset and Collate for 1-sheet document. Lv.1 Details To adjust the pitch between needles for 2-point stapling.
Use case When setting Offset and Collate for 1-sheet document As the value is incremented by 1, the pitch between needles
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key. becomes wider by 0.27 mm.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 Use case When the pitch between needles for 2-point stapling is inappropriate
0: OFF, 1: ON Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Default value 0 Display/adj/set range -8 to 8
SDL-SWCH Sddl stack capacity switch mode:Fin-C1 Unit 0.27 mm
Lv.1 Details Set 1 when increasing the stacking capacity for saddle stitching. Appropriate target value 0
When 1 is set, the stacking capacity increases over the upper limit. Default value 0
Use case When increasing the stacking capacity for saddle stitching
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0

8-261
8
8
8-262
SORTER>ADJUST FUNCTION
INSTP-F1 Adj of front staple position: Fin-A1
Lv.1 Details To adjust the paper pull-in amount of the Gripper at the time of front SORTER>FUNCTION
1-point stapling.
FIN-CON Controller PCB RAM clear: Fin-C1
As the value is incremented by 1, the paper pull-in amount is
Lv.1 Details To execute the RAM clear of Finisher Controller PCB to delete all the
increased by 0.1 mm.
adjustment contents and counter information.
Use case When misalignment occurs at the front staple position
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Select the item, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50 2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Unit 0.27 mm Caution - Output the service mode setting values by P-PRINT before
Appropriate target value 0 execution. After execution, enter the necessary setting values.
Default value 0 - RAM clear is executed after the main power is turned OFF/ON.
INSTP-R1 Adj of rear staple position: Fin-A1 Related service mode COPIER> FUNCTION> MISC-P> P-PRINT
Lv.1 Details To adjust the paper pull-in amount of the Gripper at the time of rear T-8-84
1-point stapling.
As the value is incremented by 1, the paper pull-in amount is
increased by 0.1 mm.
Use case When misalignment occurs at the rear staple position
Adj/set/operate method Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
Display/adj/set range -50 to 50
Unit 0.27 mm
Appropriate target value 0
Default value 0
T-8-83

8-262
8
8
8-263
OPTION
SORTER>OPTION
BLNK-SW Set Saddle Finisher fold position margin
Lv.1 Details To set the margin width of fold position on Saddle Finisher.
Use case When changing the margin width of fold position
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Normal, 1: Wider
Default value 0
BUFF-SW ON/OFF of buffer operation: Fin-C1
Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF of buffer operation in the Finisher.
When misalignment occurs, set 1 to 2.
When 1 is set, buffer operation is not performed for all jobs.
Alignment performance is improved, but productivity decreases.
When 2 is set, buffer operation is not performed only for non-binding
jobs. Since buffer operation is performed for binding jobs, productivity
improves, but alignment performance decreases.
Use case When misalignment of paper stack occurs (misalignment of 3 sheets
at the lowest part of the stack in case of the side stitch, and 3 sheets
at the middle of the stack in case of saddle stitch)
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Caution When the buffer operation is set to OFF, productivity decreases.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 2
0: ON, 1: OFF, 2: OFF for non-binding job only
Default value 0
Supplement/memo This setting can be also made with DIP switch of the Finisher. For
details, refer to the Service Manual for Finisher.
STCR-DWN Set occasional misalign prev mode:Fin
Lv.1 Details When misalignment in feed direction occurs at approx. every 30
sheets for thin/plain paper (105g/m2 and less), set 1.
Use case When misalignment in feed direction occurs occasionally for thin/
plain paper
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON
Default value 0
T-8-85

8-263
8
8
8-264

BOARD TR-DSP
BOARD>OPTION
Hide/dis of toner reduction function
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the toner reduction function.
OPTION Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
BOARD>OPTION
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
MENU-1 Hide/dis of printer setting menu level 1
0: Hide, 1: Display
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the level 1 of printer setting menu.
Default value 0
Use case Upon user’s request
Supplement/memo The toner reduction function is constantly enabled as default. Toner
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
color is limited to 2.1 colors when genuine Canon profile is used, but
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
it may become 2.1 colors or more when a custom profile is used for
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1 PS data. Therefore, it is limited to 2.1 colors by the toner reduction
0: Hide, 1: Display function.
Default value 0
T-8-86
MENU-2 Hide/dis of printer setting menu level 2
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the level 2 of printer setting menu.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value 0
MENU-3 Hide/dis of printer setting menu level 3
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the level 3 of printer setting menu.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value 0
MENU-4 Hide/dis of printer setting menu level 4
Lv.2 Details To set whether to display or hide the level 4 of printer setting menu.
Use case Upon user’s request
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: Hide, 1: Display
Default value 0
SURF-OFF UFR board function ON/OFF
Lv.1 Details To set ON/OFF of the function according to the SURF board
connection status.
Adj/set/operate method 1) Enter the setting value, and then press OK key.
2) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
Display/adj/set range 0 to 1
0: OFF, 1: ON

8-264
8
9 Installation

■How to Check this
Installation Procedure

■Things to do Before
Installation

■Points to Note Before
Installation

■Combination Table of
Accessory Installation

■Checking the Contents

■Installation Procedure

9
9
9-2

How to Check this Installation Procedure Things to do Before Installation

When Using the Parts Included in the Package Selecting an Installing Location
A symbol is described on the illustration in the case of using the parts included in the package The installing location needs to meet the following conditions:
of this product. Thus, it is desirable to go over the planned installing location before bringing the machine to
the user's site.
1) There must be a power outlet properly grounded and rated as indicated (+, -10%) for
exclusive use by the machine.
2) Environment of the installation site must be within the range indicated below. Avoid any
Packaged Item area near the faucet, the water heater, the humidifier, or the refrigerator.
F-9-1 • Operation/image assured range: temperature: 15.0 to 30.0 deg C, humidity: 5 to 80%
3) Keep the installation site away from the source of fire, a dusty place, or a place generating
Symbols in the Illustration ammonia gas. In the case of installing this equipment in a place subject to direct sunlight, it
is recommended to hang curtains over the window.
The frequently-performed operations are described with symbols in this procedure.
4) Room odor can be bothering when running the machine for a long time in a poorly-
Screw Connector Harness ventilated room although the ozone amount generated while running this equipment does
not harm human health. Be sure to provide adequate ventilation of the room to keep the
work environment comfortable.
5) The foot of this equipment should be in contact with the floor. This equipment should be
Tighten Remove Connect Disconnect Secure Free kept on the level.
6) The machine must be away from the wall by 100mm or more to secure an enough space
Claw
to perform machine operation.

• Color Image Reader Unit-B2

Insert Remove Push Plug in Turn on 4” (100 mm) ro more

Checking instruction
19 3/4” 19 3/4”

45 5/7” (1,159 mm)


(500 mm) (500 mm)
or more or more

Check Visual Check Sound Check


F-9-2

42 1/8” (1,071 mm)

(500 mm)
or more
19 3/4”
F-9-3

9-2
9
9
9-3
• Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1+Inner Finisher-A1+and Paper Deck Unit-B1
Points to Note Before Installation
4” (100 mm) or more
Take note of the following points when installing this equipment.
19 3/4” 1) Moving this equipment from a low-temperature place to a warm plate can generate
(500 mm) 19 3/4”
or more (500 mm) condensation, resulting in image fault. Thus, when unpacking this equipment, leave it for 2

46 5/8” (1,184 mm)


or more hours or more so that the equipment becomes comfortable with the room temperature.
(Condensation: formation of liquid drops from water vapor on metal surface, and usually
occurs when bringing a metal object from a low-temperature place to a warm place due to
rapidly-cooled surrounding moisture vapor.)
2) The host machine weighs maximum 175kg. It is recommended to lift it with 4 people or
58 1/2” (1,487 mm)

(500 mm)
more. However, if there is a standard to handle a heavy load in each sales company, follow

or more
19 3/4”
50 5/8” (1,284 mm)
it for operation.
Also, make sure to lift the machine with keeping it level at operation.
F-9-4 Because the gravity center is in the rear, lift with care.
• Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1+External 2/3 Hole Puncher-B1+Booklet Finisher-
C1+Buffer Pass Unit-G1+ Paper Deck Unit-B1

4” (100 mm) or more

19 3/4”
(500 mm) 19 3/4”
or more (500 mm)
46 5/8” (1,184 mm) or more

81 1/4” (2,062 mm)


(500 mm)
or more
19 3/4”

4 5/8” (118 mm)


85 7/8” (2,180 mm)

F-9-5
7) Be sure to install this equipment in a well-ventilated place. Do not place this equipment
near the air vent in the room.

9-3
9
9
9-4

Combination Table of Accessory Installation Checking the Contents

Combination of the Options installing to the Right Side NOTE:


• The Touch Pen is attached with the Control Panel.
of the Host Machine • Remove all the parts in the cassette.
• Only for AUS, the Toner Container is installed on the host machine.

NOTE:
• The following table shows the combination of accessories that are set at the right side of
the host machine.
• When setting the accessories indicated in the table, refer to the table below and check the
combination before the setup.
• When installing the USB Device Port-B1, install it before installing the following options.

Utility Tray Voice Guidance Kit Voice Operation Kit Card Reader
Utility Tray - no no yes
Voice Guidance
no - no yes
Kit
Voice Operation
no no - yes
Kit
Card Reader yes yes yes -
T-9-1
yes: Available no: Unavailable

9-4
9
9
9-5

[1] Drum Unit (Bk) X 1 [2] Drum Unit (Color) X 3 [3] Reversal Trail-edge Guide X 1 1 [4] Right Lower Sub Cover X 1 [5] Size Plate X 2

[6] Light Front Cover X 1 [7] Light Grip Cover X 1 [8] Left Grip Cover X 2 [9] Waste Toner Container X 1 [10] Service Book Case X 1

2 [12] Power Cable X 1 3 [13] Environment Heater


Cover X 1

*1 Use only in the case that the cassette pedestal is not installed. F-9-6
*2 The connector has a different shape depending on locations. Other than USA
Use the correct power code to mach the location/area of installation. Make sure not to leave unused power code at the site.
*3 Included in the package in Asia general, Korea, and Taiwan regions

9-5
9
9
9-6
<CD/Guides>
Check the contents against the following
North America EUR SPL/Taiwan AUS Korea China
e-Manual 1 3 (UK, FS, IG) 1 1 1 1
Users Guide - 1 - - - -
Quick Reference 1 - 1 1 1 1
Frequently Asked Questions 1 - 1 1 1 1
Getting Started 1 - 1 1 1 1
Registration for Purchase in USA 1 - - - - -
Drum Unit Warranty 1 - - - - -
Installation Check List 1 - - - - -
Users Guide - 1 - - - -
MEAP Administration Software CD *1 1 1 1 1 1 1
UFR II User Software CD 1 1 1 1 1 1
(Only when Merchandise Code ends with
"005AA", "005AB".and “005AD”.)
PCL User Software CD - 1 - - - -
(Only when Merchandise Code ends with
"005AA", "005AB"and “005AD”.)
PS User Software CD - 1 - - - -
Only when Merchandise Code is
"3614B005AB" , "3615B005AB",
“3614B005AD” and “3615B005AD”.
Maintenance Guide 1 - 1 1 1 1
How to Use the Manuals 1 5 1 1 1 1
(UK, FRA, SPA, ITA, GER)
AMS Kit 1 - - - - -
Register/Update Software Administrator Guide *1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Main Unit Warranty - - - - 1 -
Service Log BOOK - - - - - 1
Chinese Warranty Sheet - - - - - 1
Guarantee Card - - - - - 1
iW MC CD *2 1 1 1 1 1 1
PANTONE Manual CD *2 1 1 1 1 1 1
Blue Angel Notice *2 - 1 - - - -
*1 Supplied with the current machines T-9-2

*2 Supplied with the Upgraded Machines. Mercury code : 3614B003AE, 3614B004AD, 3614B005AD, 3614B006AE, 3614B007AE, 3614B008AE, 3614B010AE, 3614B011AE,
3615B003AE, 3615B004AD, 3615B005AD, 3615B006AE, 3615B007AE, 3615B008AE, 3615B010AE, 3615B011AE
3616B003AE, 3616B004AD, 3616B005AD, 3616B006AE, 3616B007AE, 3616B010AE, 3616B011AE, 3616B008AE
3617B003AE, 3617B004AD, 3617B005AD, 3617B006AE, 3617B007AE, 3617B010AE, 3617B011AE, 3617B008AE

9-6
9
9
9-7

Unpacking

1) Unpack the host machine.

NOTE:
When installing the cassette pedestal,
be sure to place the host machine
on the cassette pedestal. (See the
Installation Procedure of the cassette
pedestal)

2) Hold the 4 grips on the left or right to lift the host machine up, and then put down the machine from the skid.

CAUTION:
• The host machine weighs maximum 175kg. It
is recommended to lift it with 4 people or more.
However, if there is a standard to handle a heavy
load in each sales company, follow it for operation.
Also, make sure to lift the machine with keeping it
level at operation.
• Because the gravity center is in the rear, lift with
care.

Grip Grip

F-9-7

9-7
9
9
9-8

3) Remove all the tapes attached to the host machine.

CAUTION:
Tapes on the Cassette area are peeled
off in later steps.

F-9-8

4) Pull out the Cassette1 and 2, and remove the packing 5) Open the Front Cover and the Right Lower Cover.
NOTE: materials from them.
• When setting up for the copier model, refer
to the "Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1,
Color Image Reader Unit-B1/B2 installation
procedure".
• When setting up for the printer model, refer
to the "Printer Cover - C1" stated in this
procedure.

F-9-10
F-9-9

9-8
9
9
9-9

6) Peel off the Protection Paper. 7) Insert the protrusion in 1 place. While pushing down [A] claw, insert the claw in 2 places, and install the
Right Front Cover 2.

Protection Paper

F-9-11

F-9-12

8) Insert the protrusion in 1 place. While pushing down [A] claw, insert the claw in 3 places, and install the 9) Install the 2 Left Handle Covers.
Right Rear Cover 3. • 1 protrusion each
• 1 claw each

x3
x2

[A]

F-9-13 F-9-14

9-9
9
9
9-10

Installation Procedure

Installing the Drum Unit

1) Remove the ITB Cover. 2) Check that the ITB Sub Pressure Release Lever is positioned in the direction of the arrow and if not, turn it and adjust the
• 2 screws (to loosen) position.

direction
of the arrow

screw
ITB Sub Pressure
Release Lever
F-9-15
F-9-16

3) Turn the ITB Pressure Release Lever in the direction of the arrow, and then fit the projection to the triangle mark on the
plate to release the pressure ITB.

ITB Pressure Release Lever

F-9-17

9-10
9
9
9-11

4) Pull out the Process Unit until it stops.

x2

F-9-18

5) Hold the Developing Assembly with one hand. With the other hand, lift the dummy Drum up vertically and slowly to remove it. (If the dummy Drum is removed, the seal
can be removed simultaneously.)

CAUTION:
If diagonally pulled out, the seal
might be damaged. Be sure to pull
it out flatly in upper direction, and
carefully.
Likely, remove the Drum of each
color.

Dummy Drum

F-9-19

9-11
9
9
9-12

CAUTION: Points to Note when Removing the Dummy Drum


When removing the Dummy Drum, be sure to lift it slowly and vertically.
If lifting it in an oblique direction, the Seal on the Developing Assembly is stressed, and may cause tear of the seal.
If the Developing Seal is torn, remove the torn seal by pulling the end of it in the direction of the arrow. At that time,
be careful not to leave the torn seal in the Developing Assembly.

Rear Side
Seal

Seal

Front Side

F-9-20 F-9-21

6) Hold down the top surface of each Developing Assembly after removing Dummy Drums.
CAUTION: NOTE:
CAUTION: Step 7) to 8) is to install the Drum Unit of
Be sure to pay attention to the below in
each color.
Be sure to hold the upper doing the next procedure.
side of each Developing • Do not touch the Drum area.
Assembly when removing
• Do not make the Cover to be in contact
the seal. Otherwise the
with the Drum area.
cover will be off from its
• Do not make the Drum area disposed of
position.
light for 5 minutes or more.

F-9-22

9-12
9
9
9-13

CAUTION: Points to Note at Drum Installation


• Be sure not to rotate the Drum counterclockwise while taking it out from the Container Box, removing the Drum Cover and installing to
the main body. The Scoop-up Sheet may be flipped, causing toner scattering.
• Be sure not to reinstall the removed Drum Cover; otherwise, the Scoop-up Sheet may be flipped, causing toner scattering.

Drum Cover

F-9-23

F-9-24

7) Unpack the Drum Unit, and remove the cover from the Drum Unit.
• Claws 2pc Cover Dram Unit

CAUTION:
The cover might be stiff, so proceed
with extra care when removing the
cover from the Drum Unit.
x2

Claw

F-9-25

9-13
9
9
9-14

CAUTION: Drum for Color (Green) Drum for Bk (Blue)

Only drum for Bk (blue color)


is specified the color. Drums Position of Drum for Bk
for the 3 colors (green ones),
are not specified the color (Y,
M, C).

Position of Drum for Color


F-9-26

NOTE:
Hold the handles at right and
left of the Drum Unit.

Grip

F-9-27

9-14
9
9
9-15

CAUTION:
If pushing it in the angle, the shutter may
breaks. Thus make sure to install it from
just above.

F-9-28

8) Fit the guide of the Process Unit to the guide of the Drum Unit to install the Drum Unit.

Drum Unit Guide

Process Unit Guide

Drum Unit Guide

Process Unit Guide

F-9-29

9-15
9
9
9-16

9) Check that the 8 LED light-receiving areas of the Drum Unit are not off from the base.

F-9-30

10) Put the Process Unit back to the host machine, and secure with the 2 screws.

CAUTION:
Check that there is no gap between the host machine and the Process Unit, and then secure with the screw.

[A] [A]

F-9-31

9-16
9
9
9-17

CAUTION:
After closing the Process Unit, hold the
edge of each Drum Unit from above as
described below.
If the Drum Unit is not secured, it may
cause the color displacement.

F-9-32

12) Install the ITB Cover, and tighten the 2


11) Turn the ITB Pressure Release Lever in the screws (which have been loosened).
direction of the arrow, and then fit the projection
to the triangle mark on the plate to apply
pressure.

CAUTION:
When pressuring the ITB Pressure
Release Lever, be sure that the Right
Lower Cover is opened first before
pressuring.

F-9-33

9-17
9
9
9-18

13) Release the Waste Toner Lock Lever. 14) Set the Waste Toner Container, and then put the Lever back. 15) Close the Right Lower Cover, the
Right Upper Cover, and the Front
Cover.

F-9-34
F-9-35

Fixing the Machine in Place

<In the case that the pedestal is installed>


1) Move the host machine to installing position, turn the 4 adjusters of the pedestal with screwdriver,
and secure this host machine.

F-9-36

9-18
9
9
9-19
Setting the Environment Heater Switch

CAUTION:
• In case that the setting environment is high humidity environment (*), turn on the Environment Heater Switch.
• When the temperature and humidity of the installation environment are high, image smear is likely to occur.
* This is the case that the value of the absolute water volume in the machine is about 12g or more. Service Mode > COPIER > DISPLAY > ANALOG > ABS-HUM
In case the Environment Heater Switch Cover is included in the package, turn the Environment Heater Switch ON and then install the Environment Heater Switch Cover.

1)Remove the Environment Heater Switch Cover.

CAUTION:
When removing the cover, do not insert
a screwdriver in the oval hole.

F-9-37

2) Turn ON the Environment Heater Switch. 3) Install the Environment Heater Switch Cover.

F-9-38

9-19
9
9
9-20
Turning the Main Power ON / Setting the Toner Container

NOTE:
Only for AUS and CHINA, the Toner Container is installed on the host machine.

1) Connect the power plug of the host machine to the power outlet.
2) Remove the protection sheet on the control panel.
3) Open the switch cover and turn ON the main power switch.

NOTE:
• When turning ON the main power, drum initialization and developing assembly initialization are automatically executed.
• In case of the host machine with the Toner Container, toner refill is executed in a row.
• Even turning OFF the main power during drum initialization, developing assembly initialization and toner refill, they will be re-executed when turning ON the power again.

4) After activation, follow the instruction in the Control Panel, and press the shut down key in the Control Panel.
5) Turn ON the main power switch.
6) Enter the following Service Mode, make sure that the setting value is "1".
• COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > W/SCNR
7) Set the value of the following Service Mode.
COPIER > OPTION > CUSTOM > SCANTYPE
• Setting Value "0" Color Image Reader Unit-B1/ B2
• Setting Value "1" Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1
8) Exit the Service Mode.

NOTE:
• In case of the host machine with the Toner Container, once the machine goes to standby state, drum initialization, developing assembly initialization and toner refill are completed.
• In case of the host machine without the Toner Container, execute the following procedures.

9-20
9
9
9-21

9) Open the Toner Cover. 10) Add check marks to each color displayed on the operation screen, and press [Remove Toner Cartridges]
to open the Toner Replacement Cover.

F-9-39
F-9-40

11) Hold the Toner Container as the figure below, and shake it 12) Remove the Protection Cap of the Toner Container
NOTE: approximately 10 times. while rotating it to the direction of the arrow.
Step 11) to 13) is to install the Toner Container
of each color.

F-9-41
F-9-42

9-21
9
9
9-22

13) Insert the Toner Container all the way in, and close the Toner Exchange Cover. 14) Close the Toner Cover.

NOTE:
• Toner refill will be executed.
• Once the host machine goes to standby
state, drum initialization, developing
assembly initialization and toner refill are
completed.

F-9-43

Turning OFF the Main Power Switch

1) Turn OFF the main power switch of the host machine.


2) Be sure that Control Panel Display and Main Power Lamp are both turned OFF, and then disconnect the power plug.

Setting for K Paper (China only)

Make the following settings for the use of K paper.


1) Enter the service mode (level 2).
2) Change from '0' to '1' in COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > KSIZE-SW.
3) Enter the service mode (level 1).
4) Change from '4' to '0' in COPIER > OPTION > FNC-SW > MODEL-SZ.
5) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.

9-22
9
9
9-23
Cassette Setting

1) Press the Cassette Release Button, and pull out the Cassette 1 and 2
toward the front. 2) Hold the Side Guide Plate Lever, and adjust it to Side Guide Plate
the predefined size. At that time, move the Side
Guide Plate by referring the size index (label) of Rear Edge Guide Plate Lever Side Guide Plate Lever
the sheet size to be set, and fit it to the slot.

3) Hold the Trail Edge Guide Plate Lever, and adjust


it to the predefined size. At that time, move the
Trail Edge Guide Plate by referring the size index
(label) of the sheet size be set, and fit it to the
slot.
Button

Rear Edge Guide Plate

F-9-45
F-9-44

4) Set papers. 6) Cut 2 places of the Size Plate with nippers.


5) Open the cover from which the Size Plate is pushed in.
Cut
Paper
Cover

F-9-47

F-9-46

9-23
9
9
9-24

7) Set the Size Plate in accordance with the size being set. (Lump the Size Plates not in use together 8) Close the cover from which the Size Plate is pushed in, and install the cassette.
and store them at the rear.) 9) Set the other cassette in the same way.
10) If the cassette pedestal is installed, do the same for the cassette of the cassette pedestal as well.

NOTE:
Paper size settings are automatically recognized.

F-9-48

9-24
9
9
9-25
Checking after the Installation Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection
1) In Service Mode, check the result of Drum Unit initialization. In the case that the floor surface is either warped or uneven, execute the following work.
Make sure that the value of the installed color is [0 to 2 ]. 1) Check that the main body is in standby state.
• Service Mode > COPIER > DISPLAY > HV-STS > THCK-Y 2) Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection Service Mode (COPIER > FUNCTION >
• Service Mode > COPIER > DISPLAY > HV-STS > THCK-M MISC-P > ITB-INIT). This service mode will take approx. 2 to 3 minutes.
• Service Mode > COPIER > DISPLAY > HV-STS > THCK-C 3) Check that the value of the following service mode is "-300 to +450".
COPIER > DISPLAY > MISC > ITB-POS
NOTE:
If an error code [E061-xxxx] is displayed on the screen or the value is not appropriate,
If the value is out of the range, be sure to perform the following procedure.
1. Turn OFF the power, refit the Drum Unit and turn On the power again.
2. If the above work does not solve the problem, execute initialization of the Drum Unit • If the value is larger than "+450": lift the left front side of the main body.
for each color in Service Mode. • If the value is smaller than "-300": lift the right front side of the main body.
• Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETY
Execute the ITB Equilibrium Position Detection Service Mode again, and check the value.
• Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETM
• Service Mode > COPIER > FUNCTION > DPC > DRMRSETC
NOTE:
Change in equilibrium position per revolution of the adjuster: 80 to 100

2) Check the result of initialization of developing toner ratio in Service Mode.


Check that each value is within the range of 32 to 68, and then write down the value on the
service label at the rear side of the Front Cover. Auto Adjust Gradation
• Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > DENS > CONT-Y
Execute the auto gradation adjustment to the following 3 modes: [Plain], [Heavy 1/Heavy 2],
• Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > DENS > CONT-M
and [Heavy 3].
• Service Mode > COPIER > ADJYST > DENS > CONT-C
• Service Mode > COPIER > ADJYST > DENS > CONT-K
CAUTION:
When using paper type to which auto gradation adjustment is not executed, image
3) Check the Developing Patch initialization.
failure or damage on the hostmachine may occur.
Check that each value is within the range of 340 to 640, and then write down the value on
the service label at the rear side of the Front Cover.
• Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > DENS > SGNL-Y
• Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > DENS > SGNL-M
■■When "Plain" paper is used
• Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > DENS > SGNL-C 1) Clean the surface of copyboard glass.
• Service Mode > COPIER > ADJUST > DENS > SGNL-K 2) Set A3, A4, 11×17 or LTR paper in the cassette.
3) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Adjustment/Maintenance] > [Adjust Image Quality] > [Auto
NOTE: Adjust Gradation] > [Plain] > [Full Adjust].
Setting the ADF before executing Auto Adjust Gradation. 4) Select the cassette for the test print and press "OK".
Refer to the " After installation setting" in the "the Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1,
Color Image Reader Unit-B1/B2 installation procedure". 5) Then, follow the direction displayed on UI.

9-25
9
9
9-26
■■When "Heavy1/Heavy2" paper is used
1) Clean the surface of copyboard glass.
2) Set the heavy paper in the cassette.
3) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Adjustment/Maintenance] > [Adjust Image Quality] > [Auto
Adjust Gradation] > [Heavy1/Heavy2] > [Full Adjust].
4) Select the cassette for the test print and press "OK".
5) Then, follow the direction displayed on UI.

■■When "Heavy3" paper is used


1) Set the heavy paper on the Multi-purpose Tray.
2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Adjustment/Maintenance] > [Adjust Image Quality] > [Auto
Adjust Gradation] > [Heavy3] > [Full Adjust].
3) Select the cassette for the test print and press "OK".
4) Then, follow the direction displayed on UI.

9-26
9
9
9-27
Adjusting Image Position

NOTE:
The second side of the 2-sided copy mentioned later means the second side in the image formation order.
With this equipment, the second side in the image formation order at the time of 2-sided copy/print is equivalent to the first side of the original.

■■Margin Adjustment (1st side; Mechanical Adjsutment)

1) Make copies using the Cassette 1 and 2, and


check that the left edge margin is 2.5+/-1.5mm. <In Case of Nonstandard>

Feeding direction NOTE:


of paper Adjsutment method is same for both the
image Cassette 1 and 2.
L1

2) Pull out the cassette.


3) Check the 2 scale positions on the adjusting plates.

F-9-49

F-9-50

4) Loosen the 3 fixing screws.

F-9-51

9-27
9
9
9-28

5) Move the adjusting plates back and forth by


referring the scale checked in the step 3). As
moving the adjusting plate toward the rear by
1 scale, the left edge margin becomes 1mm
smaller.

NOTE:
When moving the scale, be sure that
the amount of the value to be moved
are the same for the 2 points.

F-9-52

6) Tighten the fixing screw.


7) Return the cassette to its original position.

9-28
9
9
9-29

NOTE:
When the cassette positions are uneven due to the mechanical adjustment, adjust them by loosening the screw at left side.

F-9-53

8) Make copies using the Cassette 1 and 2, and


check that the left edge margin is 2.5+/-1.5mm.

9-29
9
9
9-30
■■Margin Adjustment (2nd side)

1) Make 2-sided copy from cassette 1, and check 2) If the left margin is out of the specification, change the adjustment value for the left margin on the 2nd side in cassettte 1.
that the left margin is 2.5 -/+ 2.0mm. COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-C1RE; 1 increment of the value reduces the left margin by 0.1mm
3) As for the adjustment value for side registration on the 2nd side in cassette 2, enter the same value as the adjustment value for the left margin on the
Feeding direction
2nd side in cassette 1.
of paper
COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-C2RE
image 4) To make the setting value effective, turn OFF/ON the main power of the Host Machine.
5) Make 2-sided copy from cassette 2, and check that the left margin is 2.5 -/+ 2.0mm.
L1

6) If the margin is out of the specification, change the adjustment value for the left margin on the 2nd side in cassette 2.
COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-C2RE; 1 increment of the value reduces the left margin by 0.1mm.
7) Write down the new adjustment value on the service label.
ADJ-C1RE
F-9-54 ADJ-C2RE
8) Exit from Service Mode.

■■Margin Adjustment with Multi Purpose Tray (1st side; mechanical adjustment)

1) Place paper on the Multi Purpose Tray. See


the label on manual feed area to place paper. <In the case that the left margin is out of specification>
2) Make copy from the Multi Purpose Tray, and 3) Remove paper on the Multi Purpose Tray.
check that the left margin is 2.5 -/+ 1.5mm. 4) Open the Multi Purpose Tray in the condition where the
Multi Purpose Tray Sub Cover is opened.
Feeding direction
of paper
image
L1

F-9-55

F-9-56

9-30
9
9
9-31

5) Loosen the fixing screw for the Multi Purpose Tray Upper Cover.
6) Move the Multi Purpose Tray Upper
Cover back and forth according to the
value confirmed in step 2). Moving the
Multi Purpose Tray Upper Cover to the
rear of this equipment increases the left
margin.
Screw

F-9-58
F-9-57

7) Tighten the fixing screw for the Multi Purpose


Tray Upper Cover.
8) Place paper on the Multi Purpose Tray.
9) Make copy from the Multi Purpose Tray, and
check that the left margin is 2.5 -/+ 1.5mm.

9-31
9
9
9-32
■■Margin Adjustment with Multi Purpose Tray (2nd side)

1) Make 2-sided copy from the manual feed tray, and check that the left margin on the 2nd side is 2.5 -/+ 2.0mm.
2) If the left margin is out of the specification, change the adjustment value for the left margin on the 2nd side from the Multi Purpose Tray.
COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > ADJ-MFRE ; 1 increment of the value reduces the left margin by 0.1mm.
3) To make the setting value effective, turn OFF/ON the main power of the Host Machine.
4) Write down the new adjustment value on the service label.
ADJ-MFRE

■■Lead-edge Margin Adjustment (1st side)

1) Make copy from cassettte 1, and check that 2) Select the following in Service Mode: COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > REGIST
the lead-edge margin is L1 = 4.0 +1.5/-1.0 3) Change the setting value to make adjustment (1 increment of the setting value reduces the lead-
mm. If the lead-edge margin is out of the edge margin by 0.1mm)
specification, go through the following steps to 4) To make the setting value effective, turn OFF/ON the main power of the Host Machine.
make adjustment. 5) Write down the new adjustment value on the service label.
• REGIST
L1

Feeding direction
of paper
image

F-9-59

9-32
9
9
9-33
■■Lead-edge Margin Adjustment (2nd side)

1) Make 2-sided copy from cassette 1, and 2) Select the following in Service Mode: COPIER > ADJUST > FEED-ADJ > REG-DUP1
check that the lead-edge margin on the 2nd 3) Change the setting value to make adjustment (1 increment of the setting value reduces the lead-
side is L1 = 4.0 +1.5/-1.0 mm. If the lead-edge edge margin by 0.1mm)
margin is out of the specification, go through 4) To make the setting value effective, turn OFF/ON the main power of the Host Machine.
the following steps to make adjustment. 5) Write down the new adjustment value on the service label.
• REG-DUP1
L1

Feeding direction
of paper
image

F-9-60

9-33
9
9
9-34
Installing Other Parts

<Service Book Holder>


1) Remove the double-stick tape detachment paper on the rib area of the Service Book Holder, and CAUTION: Do not attach the Service Book Case to the following location:
attach the Service Book Holder to the Pedestal Bottom Plate.
• Inside the machine (inner side of the front cover)
• Anywhere that blocks the louver area
• Anywhere that blocks the grip area

NOTE:
In the case of machine confifuration without the cassette pedestal, attach
the Service Book Case to the Left Cover of this main unit.

F-9-61

<Right Lower Sub Cover 1>


1) Install the Right Lower Sub Cover 1.
(Perform this step in the case that the cassette pedestal is not installed)
• 2 claws

F-9-62

9-34
9
9-35

<Stamp Cartridge in the case of Duplex Color Image Reader Unit-B1>


3) Open the Stamp Cover.
1) Open the ADF.
2) Pull the lever at upper area of the ADF,
and open the cover of the ADF reading
area.

F-9-64
F-9-63

5) Close the Stamp Cover.


4) Using tweezers, install the Stamp 6) Close the cover of the ADF reading area.
Cartridge with its stamp side faces up. 7) Close the ADF.

F-9-65

9-35
9
9-36

<Stamp Cartridge in the case of Color Image Reader Unit-B1>


2) Using tweezers, install the Stamp
1) Open the Feed Cover and the Cartridge with its stamp side faces
Separation Guide of the DADF. up.

Feed Cover Separation Guide F-9-67

F-9-66

3) Close the Feed Cover and the Separation <Reversal Trail-edge Guide>
Guide of the DADF. Install the Reversal Trail-edge Guide to the delivery assembly.
• 2 claws

Reversal Trail-edge Guide

x2

F-9-68

9-36
9
9
9-37
Checking Network Connection ■■Ping Operation Procedure
■■Overview CAUTION:
If the user network environment is TCP/IP, use Ping function to check that the network setting Ping command cannot be executed to Windows Vista PC from the Host Machine.
is properly executed.
To execute Ping command to Windows Vista PC, disable the Fire Wall.Or, execute Ping
If the user network environment is IPX/SPX or Apple Talk, skip this procedure. command to the Host Machine from Windows Vista PC.

■■Checking Network Connection 1) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [IPv4
Settings] > [PING Command].
CAUTION: 2) Enter IP address with numeric keypad on the control panel and press "Start" key.
"Response from the host" is displayed if Ping operation is successful. "No response from
Use the network cable of rank 5e or higher. In addition, use of shield type (STP cable)
is recommended. the host" is displayed if Ping operation fails.

When non-shield type (UTP cable) is used, the surrounding electronic equipments may
be interfered via the network cable. ■■Checking with Remote Host Address
You can check whether the network is connected or not by using remote host address to
1) Turn OFF the main power switch.
execute Ping.
2) Connect the network cable to the host machine and turn ON the main power switch.
Remote host address: IP address of PC terminal that is connected to/works with TCP/IP
3) Inform the system administrator at the installation site that the installation of the host
network environment, which connects to this host machine.
machine is complete, and ask for network connection of the host machine.
1) Inform the system administrator to execute checking of network connection using Ping.
2) Check the remote host address with the system administrator.
NOTE:
Network setting cannot be executed unless logging in as an administrator. 3) Enter the remote host address to PING.
Factory default password is as follows. • "Response from the host": The machine is properly connected to the network.
• System administration division ID: 7654321
• "No response from the host": Execute the following troubleshooting because the
• System administration password: 7654321
machine is not connected to the network.

CAUTION:
Following setting needs to be ON to perform network setting:
• [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [Confirm Network Connection
Set. Changes]
• [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [IPv4
Settings] > [Use IPv4]

4) Turn OFF the main power switch.


5) Turn ON the main power switch.

9-37
9
9
9-38
Troubleshooting of Network ■■Checking Network Function on the Main Controller
Check with the loopback address:
■■Checking Connection of the Network Cable
Select: [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [IPv4
Check that the network cable is properly connected to the Ethernet port. Settings] > [PING Command], and enter the IP address "127.0.0.1" with the numeric keypad
and press the Execute key.
■■Ping Operation Procedure If the display shows "Response from the host", the network of the main controller is properly
functioning.
Ask the network administrator at the user's site to note the IP address of the PC that is
If the display shows "No response from the host", the network function of the main controller
connected to the network.
is faulty.
Select: [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [IPv4
Replace with a main controller that works properly, and the check connection.
Settings] > [PING Command], and enter the IP address of PC with the numeric keypad, and
then press "Execute” key.
If the display shows "Response from the host", the network connection is properly functioning.
If the display shows "No response from the host", go to the next step for another checking.

NOTE:
Checking of IP address of PC is available by the procedure below:
On Windows PC, go through the following: Start > Program > Accessory > Command
Prompt, and enter ipconfig and press the Enter key. IP address information will be
displayed.

■■Checking Network Setting of the Host Machine


Check if the IP address specified on the host machine is correct. Select the following: [Settings/
Registration] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [IPv4 Settings] > [IP Address
Settings], and note the IP address in the IP Address field. Select the following: [Settings/
Registration] > [Preferences] > [Network] > [TCP/IP Settings] > [IPv4 Settings] > [PING
Command], and enter the IP address. If the display shows "Response from the host", the IP
address specified on the host machine is correct. If the display shows "No response from the
host", go to the next step for another checking.

NOTE:
When entering an address by manual operation, set the Subnet Mask according to the
instructions of the user administrator.

9-38
9
9
9-39
Turning OFF the Main Power Switch
Refer to "Turning OFF the Main Power Switch" in Main Unit Installation Procedure.

Installation Procedure

1) Move the Control Panel in the direction of the arrow. 2) Move the Control Panel Mount Cover in the direction of the arrow.
• 1 screw

F-9-69

F-9-70

3) Check the installing position of the 2 Joints (Right). Install them on the L marking side if they are on the H marking side.

F-9-71

9-39
9
9
9-40

4) Place the Printer Cover by fitting to the positioning pins.

F-9-72

5) Fix the Printer Cover.


• 2 screws (Binding; M4x8)
• 1 stepped screw (M4)
USB Cable
CAUTION:
• Align the screw in left side to the emboss
and tighten first.
• Ensure not to pinch the USB cable. x3
(If tighten a screw after removing USB cable,
Stepped Screw
ensure to re-install the USB cable.)

Embosses

F-9-73

9-40
9
9
9-41

6) Install the Reader Fixing Hook B.


• 2 screws (Flat Head; M4x6)
Reader Fixing
7) Install the Reader Fixing Hooks A and C x2 Emboss
Hook A
after adjusting it to the emboss. Reader Fixing Hook B x2
• 2 screws (Binding; M4x8)

Fixing Hook C

F-9-74

10) Return the Control Panel Mount Cover.


8) Install the Top Front Cover. 11) Return the Control Panel.
Top Right Cover
• 2 screws (RS Tightening; M3x8.5)

9) Install the Left Top Cover and Right x6


Top Cover.
• 4 screws (Binding; M4x8)
• 4 rubber caps
Screw
(RS Tightening; M3x8.5)

Top Left Cover Screw Top Front Cover


(RS Tightening; M3x8.5)
F-9-75

9-41
9
9
9-42

Reader Heater Unit (EUR onry)

Checking the contents


Prepare the following parts because each part of the Reader Heater Unit is assigned as service part.

[1] Reader Heater X 1 [2] Flat Screw(M4X4) X 4 [3] Heater Sheet X 1sheet

F-9-76

*: 3 sheets are used in this Installation procedure.

NO. Parts Number. Q'ty


[1] FK2-7164-000 1 pc
[2] XA9-1956-000 4 pc
[3] FC8-6060-000 1 sheet
T-9-3

Turning OFF the power of the Host Machine.


Be sure to refer to How to Disconnect the Main Power in the Host Machine installation.

9-42
9
9
9-43
Installation Procedure

1) Open the ADF or Copyboard Cover. 2) Remove the Reader Right Retainer Cover. 3) Remove the Reader Cable Cover.
• 2 Screws • 2 Screws

x2 x2

F-9-77
F-9-78 F-9-79

4) Remove the Copyboard Glass.

CAUTION:
When removing the Copyboard Glass, be
sure not to touch your finger to the white
plate in the surface and the backside of
the glass. If it is dirty, clean it with lint-
free paper.

F-9-81
F-9-80

9-43
9
9
9-44

5) Align 3 sheets of heater sheet to the marking line, and adhere them.

Marking Line

Heater Sheet
F-9-82

6) Install the Reader Heater.


• 4 Flat Screws (M4)

CAUTION:
Do not scratch the surface of the Guide Shaft.
x4 Reader Heater

Guide Shaft
F-9-83

9-44
9
9
9-45

7) Pass the connector under the rail as shown.

F-9-84

Wire
CAUTION:
Do not scratch surface of the wire and the Scanner Rail.

Scanner Rail

F-9-85

9-45
9
9
9-46

8) Loosen the screw, shift the Harness Guide in the direction of the arrow, pass the harness, and make space [A].

[A]

Screw
F-9-86

9) Pass the harnesses to the claw of the FFC Guide in 4 places.

Claw of the FFC Guide Claw of the FFC Guide


NOTE:
Make sure that the harnesses are securely fixed.
x4

F-9-87

9-46
9
9
9-47

10) Put the harness through the 2 edge saddles and connect the connector. 11) Tighten the screw loosened in step 8) after
adjusting it to the boss.

x2 x2

Edge Saddle Edge Saddle


F-9-88

12) Install the removed covers.


NOTE: • Copyboard Glass
Make sure • Reader Cable Cover
that the • Reader Right Retainer Cover
sheet is
placed on 13) Close the ADF or the Copyboard
the plate. Cover.
14) Insert the power plug of main unit
into a socket.
15) Open the Switch Cover and turn
the main power switch ON.

F-9-89

9-47
9
9
9-48
Checking after the installation

1) Remove the Environment Heater Switch cover.


CAUTION:
When removing a
cover, do not insert
a screwdriver in the
slot.

F-9-90

2) Check that the Environment Heater Switch is ON. 4) Install the Environment Heater 5) Check that the breaker switch in the back of the main 7) Connect the power plug of the host
3) Turn ON, if it was OFF. Switch cover. unit is ON.5) machine to the power outlet.
6) Turn ON, if it was OFF.

F-9-91

F-9-92

9-48
9
9
9-49

Cassette Heater Unit

Checking the Contents (ASIA only)


■■Cassette Heater Unit-37

[1] Cassette Heater Unit x 1  [2] Heater Connector Cover x 1 [3] Wire Saddle x 1 [4] Screw
(W Sems Round End; M3X6) x 1

[5] Screw (P Tight; M3x8) x 1

* Not used with this procedure. F-9-93

Checking the Parts to be Installed (EUR only)


■■Cassette Heater Unit
Prepare the following parts because each part of the Cassette Heater Unit is assigned as service part.

[1] Cassette Heater Unit x 1  [2] Screw


(W Sems Round End; M3X6) x 1

F-9-94
NO. Parts name Parts Number Q'ty
[1] Cassette Heater Unit FM3-8915-000 1 pc.
[2] Screw (W Sems Round End: M3x6) XA9-1016-000 1 pc.
T-9-4

9-49
9
9
9-50
Turning OFF the Main Power Switch
Refer to "Turning OFF the Main Power Switch" in Main Unit Installation Procedure.

Installation Procedure

1) Press the Cassette Release Button to remove the Cassette.


NOTE: (Host Machine: Cassettes 1 and 2, Cassette pedestal: Cassette 3 and 4)
The installation procedure of this product is
not changed either in the host machine t or
the cassette pedestal.

Cassette 1

Cassette 3
Cassette 2

Cassette 4

Cassette Release Cassette Release


Button Button
F-9-95

2) Remove the Heater Connector Cover with a flat-blade screwdriver.


• 1 claw
• 2 protrusions Claw

Protrusions

Heater Connector Cover

F-9-96

9-50
9
9
9-51

3) Fit the claws (3 places) on the Cassette


Heater Unit into the holes on the Base Plate, Cassette Heater Unit
and then, move it toward the front.
• 3 claws Cassette Heater Unit

Caution:
Base Plate
Be sure that the claws are fit into the
holes of the Base Plate properly.
Base Plate

F-9-97

4) Tighten the removed screw (W sems round end; M3X6) with the stubby driver to connect the connector. 5) Install the heater Connector Cover.
(The figure below shows an example of the Cassette Pedestal. Follow the same step as for the host machine.) 6) Install the removed Cassettes.

Connector

F-9-98

9-51
9
9
9-52
Checking After the Installation

1) Remove the Environment Heater Switch Cover.


Caution:
When removing the cover, be
sure not to insert a screwdriver in
the elongate hole.

F-9-99

2) Check that the Environment Heater Switch is ON. 4) nstall the Environment 5) Check that the breaker switch in the back of the main unit is ON. 7) Connect the power plug of the
3) Turn ON, if it was OFF. Heater Switch Cover. 6) Turn ON, if it was OFF. host machine to the power outlet.

F-9-100

F-9-101

9-52
9
9
9-53

Cassette Heater Unit-32

Checking Bundled Components


[3] [6]
[5]
[1]

[8]

[4]

[5] [2]
[11]
[7]

[10]

[9]

F-9-102

[1] Heater unit 1pc.


[2] AC input connector 1pc.
[3] Relay harness unit 1pc.
[4] AC cable 1pc.
[5] Screw (w/ washer) 2pcs.
[6] Cable protection bush 1pc.
[7] Power supply label 1pc.
[8] RS tight screw(M4x8) 2pcs.
[9] Wire saddle 3pcs.(*Only 2 pcs are used for this unit.)
[10] Plug cover 1pc.
[11] Binding screw (M4x4) 1pc.(*Not used for this unit.

Turning OFF the Main Power Switch


Refer to "Turning OFF the Main Power Switch" in Main Unit Installation Procedure.

9-53
9
9
9-54

When installing the heater to the paper deck, take the following precautions:
a. The AC power plug of the host machine must have been removed from the outlet.
b. Install the heater after installing the host machine and paper deck.
c. Use correct screws (lengths and diameters) at correct positions.

Installation Procedure

1) Remove reusable band, and then disconnect the paper deck connector from the host 2) Release the paper deck from the host machine, and then press down the latch plate of the paper deck
machine. housing with your finger to open the housing.

F-9-104

F-9-103

9-54
9
9
9-55

3) Remove three screws, and then detach the right cover of the paper deck in the 4) Remove four screws and two other screw, and then detach the rear
direction of the arrow shown. cover of the paper deck.

x3 x6

F-9-105

F-9-106

5) Remove three screws and one connector, and then detach the front-upper cover. 6) Remove two screws, and then detach the top cover.

x3 x2

x1

F-9-108
F-9-107

9-55
9
9
9-56

7) Attach the supplied cable protection bushing to the hole on 8) Place the heater unit under the top 9) Insert the two hooks of the heater unit into the holes on the top plate of the paper deck, and then
the top panel of the paper deck. panel of the paper deck, and then secure the heater unit to the main body of the paper deck using a screw with toothed washer.
take the connector out of the hole
on the top plate.

x1

F-9-109
F-9-110

10) Attach the heater connector to the panel mount. 11) Remove one screw to remove the blind plate from the power cord mount of the paper deck.

x1

F-9-111 F-9-112

9-56
9
9
9-57
12
12) Install the supplied AC input connector in two steps([A] > [B]). 13) Install the relay harness unit to the rear side panel of the paper deck using the two screws (M4X8),
Install the ground cable using a screw with toothed washer. and then connect the connector.

[A]
[B]
x1 x2

F-9-113
F-9-114

14) Wind the relay harness (one and half turns) around the cable guides on the power 15) Reattach the exterior covers of the paper 16) Manually slide the paper deck to
cord mount, and then connect the connector. deck in the following sequence: the left to place it aside of the host
machine.
[1] Top cover (Take care not to have cables
caught.) (M4X8: 2 pcs.)

[2] Front-upper cover (Insert the connector.)


(M4X8: 3 pcs.)

[3] Rear cover (M3X8: 2 pcs., M4X8: 4 pcs.)

[4] Right cover (M4X8: 3 pcs.)

F-9-115

9-57
9
9
9-58

17) Attach reusable band, and then connect the connector of the paper deck to the back 18) Stick the power supply label to the rear panel of the paper deck.
of the host machine.

F-9-117

F-9-116

19) Remove 1 screw (bind head;M4x4) to detach the plate.

x1

F-9-118

9-58
9
9
9-59

20) Attach two wire saddles to the rear panel of the host machine, and then connect the AC cable connector to the power cord mount of the heater.
Route the AC cable as shown, and then connect the other connector (plug) to the receptacle on the rear panel of the host machine.

F-9-119

21) Fix the supplied plug cover at rear side of the host machine with 1 screw (bind To ensure smooth connection of the heater power connectors, explain to the user that any obstacle that can
head;M4x4) removed at the step 19. prevent the paper deck from opening should not be placed in the hatched area.
[1]: Host machine [2]: Paper deck [A]: Front

x1

[1]

[A] [2]

F-9-120 F-9-121

9-59
9
9
9-60

Utility Tray-A1/A2

Checking the Contents

[1] Utility Tray Unit X 1 [2] Wire Saddle X 5 [3] Screw (TP ; M4x14) X 4 [4] Screw (TP ; M4x10) X 2 [5] Keyboard Table Plate X 1

Use when installing the Included in A2 only


USB Keyboard

[6] Screw (TP; M4x8) X 10

Included in A2 only

F-9-122

9-60
9
9
9-61
Installation Procedure
<In case of Utility Tray A1> <In case of Utility Tray A2>
1) Loosen the 2 screws on the Utility Tray Unit to separate the Mounting Plate and the Utility Tray. 1-1) Loosen the 2 screws, and move the Utility Tray Mounting Plate in the direction of the arrow until
it stops.

Screws

F-9-123
Utility Tray Mounting Plate

F-9-124

1-2) While pulling the [A] part of the Utility Tray, remove the Utility Tray Mounting Plate. 2) Remove the 4 face seals from the Reader Right Cover.

[A] Face Seals


CAUTION:
Be sure not to pull
the [A] part of the
Utility Tray too
much.

F-9-125 F-9-126

9-61
9
9
9-62

3) Install the Mounting Utility Tray Plate.


• 4 screws (TP; M4x10)

x4

F-9-127

4) Install the Utility Tray.


• 2 screws (loosen)
• 2 screws (tighten) (TP; M4 x 10)

x2

F-9-128

9-62
9
9
9-63
When installing the Keyboard

1) Remove the 2 cap covers and install the 5 wire saddles.

Wire Saddle

Cap Cover

F-9-129

9-63
9
9
9-64

Key Switch Unit-A2

Checking the Content

[1] Key Switch Unit x 1 [2] Control Key x 1 [3] Screw (Binding; M4×6) x 1

F-9-130

Turning OFF the power of the Host Machine


Be sure to refer to How to Disconnect the Main Power in the Host Machine installation.

9-64
9
9
9-65
Installation Procedure

1) Open the Right Lower Cover. (Open also the Right 2) Open the Right Rear Cover 1.
Upper Cover in the same time). 3) Remove the Right Rear Cover 1.
• 1 Screw (RS Tightening; M4)
• 2 Screws (TP; M3)
• Claw in 1 place
x3

F-9-131 Claw
F-9-132

4) Remove the Left Rear Cover.


• 2 Rubber caps
• 2 Screw
• Claw in 5 places
x2 Claw
x5

F-9-133

9-65
9
9
9-66

5) Remove the Rear Cover. 6) Remove the Connector Cover.


• 1 Screw
• 2 Rubber caps
• 2 Screws
• Claw in 1 place
x2

Claw

F-9-134 F-9-135

7) Remove the connector of the Cassette Pedestal.(If the Pedestal is not installed, this procedure is not needed.)
• Harness Guide in 6 places
Connector
• 5 Connectors

x6

x5

Guide

F-9-136

9-66
9
9
9-67

8) Remove the Rear Lower Cover.


• 2 Rubber caps
• 2 Screws Hook
• Claw in 2 places
• Hook in 2 places
x2

Claw
x2

Claw

Hook

F-9-137

9) Remove the Right Rear Cover 3. 10) Remove the Right Rear Cover 2.
• Claw in 3 places • 2 Screws

Claw
x3 x2

Claw

F-9-138 F-9-139

9-67
9
9
9-68

11) Remove the Key Switch Bracket. 12) Install the Key Switch Unit to the Key Switch Bracket.
• 2 Screws • 1 Screw (Binding: M4x6)

x2

F-9-141
F-9-140

13) Install the Key Switch Bracket assembled in the previous procedure. 14) Open the Feed Driver PCB.
• 2 Screws (use the screw removed in step 11) • 2 Screws

x2 x2

F-9-142 F-9-143

9-68
9
9
9-69

15) Connect the connector of the host machine with the connector of Key Switch Unit. 16) Put the Feed Driver PCB back in the original position.

F-9-144

17) Cut the [A] part of the removed Right Rear Cover 2 in step 10) with nipper, etc. 18) Reinstall the removed covers and the connectors.
• Right Rear Cover 2
• Right Rear Cover 3
• Rear Lower Cover
• Cconnector of the Cassette Pedestal
[A] • Connector Cover
• Rear Cover
• Left Rear Cover
• Right Rear Cover 1
• Right Lower Cover
• Right Upper Cover

F-9-145

9-69
9
9
9-70
Checking after installation

1) Connect the power plug of the host machine into the outlet.
2) Open the switch cover and turn ON the main power switch.
3) Set the following service mode value to “1”.
[COPIER] > [FUNCTION] > [INSTALL] > [KEY]
4) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
5) Make sure that [Set the control key] is displayed.
6) Insert the Control key into the Key Switch Unit and make sure that the machine is ready for copy.

9-70
9
9
9-71

Voice Operation Kit C1

Checking the Contents

[1] Speaker Unit X 1 [2] Voice Operation Board Unit X 1 [3] DVI Cable X 1 [4] Ring Core X 2 1 [5] Ring Core X 1

2 [6] Cord Guide X 7 3 [7] Wire Saddle X 3 [8] Screw(Binding; M4X20) X 2 1 [9] Screw(Binding; M3X20) X 1 1 [10] Screw(Binding; M4X6) X 1

[11] Screw(TP; M3x6) X 2

*1 : Not used in this Installation procedure. F-9-146

*2 : 1 piece is used in this Installation procedure.


*3 : 2 pieces are used in this Installation procedure.

<CD/Guide>
• Voice Guidance Kit Users Guide
• Voice Operation Kit Users Guide
• Voice Operation Quick Reference Guide
• Voice Guidance Guide CD
• Voice Operation Kit Manual CD
• FCC/IC Instruction Sheet
9-71
9
9
9-72
Points to note when Installing

CAUTION:
The Color Image Reader is necessary to operate this equipment.
When installing the equipment, see the 'Combination Table of Accessory Installation'.

Turning OFF the Host Machine


Be sure to refer to the Host Machine Installation “How to disconnect main power”.

Installation Procedure

1) Open the Right Lower Cover (Open also the Right


Delivery Unit in the same time). 2) Open the Right Rear Cover 1.
3) Remove the Right Rear
Cover 1.
• 1 Screw (RS Tight; M4) x3
• 2 Screws (TP; M3)
• Claw in 1 place

Claw
F-9-147 F-9-148

9-72
9
9
9-73

4) If Reader is installed, remove the Reader Power Cable. 5) Remove the USB cable and Control Panel Communication Cable.
• 2 Connectors Control Panel
• 1 Wire Saddle Communication Cable USB Cable
• 1 Cable Guide
x2
Reader Power x2
Cable

x2 Cable Guide

Wire Saddles

Connectors
F-9-150
F-9-149

6) Remove the 2 screws, open the grip in 2 places.

x2

Grips
F-9-151

9-73
9
9
9-74

7) Hold the grip in 2 places, remove the Main Controller PCB 1 while avoiding the removed harness. 8) Remove the Voice Operation Board Support Plate from the Main Controller Roller PCB 1.
(Do not use the removed Support Voice Operation Board.)
• 2 Screws (removed screw will be
used in step 9))

x2

F-9-152

F-9-153

9) Install the Voice Operation Board Unit in the Main Controller Roller PCB 1.
• 1 Connector
• 2 screws (2 Screws that removed in step 8))
• 2 Screws (TP; M3x6)
x4
NOTE:
Make sure that the connector
is properly installed.

Connector

F-9-154

9-74
9
9
9-75

10) Install the Main Controller PCB 1 to the host machine.

CAUTION:
Lift the handle, insert the Main
Controller PCB 1 until it stops, tilt
x2
the grip and install the 2 screws.
Make sure to tilt the grip slowly on
both sides simultaneously.
Check that the Main Controller
PCB 1 is installed properly.

Grip
F-9-155

11) Install the USB Cable and Control Panel


Communication Cable.
12) If Reader is installed, install the Reader
Power Cable. x2 [A]
NOTE:
Handle the Reader Power Cable
Cable Guide
from the connector side and
Wire Saddles
make a slack at A part.
Bend the Reader Power Cable at
a right angle on B part. [B]

Reader Power Cable

Connectors
F-9-156

9-75
9
9
9-76

13) Remove the Small Cover installed in the Right Rear Cover 1. 14) Cut the [A] part of the Right Rear Cover 1 with nipper, etc.
• 1 Screw [A]
• Claw in 2 places 爪

x2

[A]
F-9-157 F-9-158

15) Install the Right Rear Cover 1. 16) Close the Right Lower Cover and Right Upper Cover. 17) Remove the Rubber Cap, screw, the Cover Seal from the Reader Right Cover.
(Do not use the removed Rubber Cap, screw and Cover Seal.)
NOTE: Cover Seal
Do not close the Right Rear
Cover 1.

Rubber Cap

F-9-159

9-76
9
9
9-77

18) Remove the Speaker Unit (Lower) from the Speaker Unit. 19) Install the Speaker Unit (Lower).
• 2 screws (removed screw • 2 Screws (Binding; M4x20)
will be used in step 20))

x2 Speaker Unit (Lower)


x2

F-9-160

F-9-161

20) Install the Speaker Unit (Upper). 21) Remove the Cord Guide Cover.
• 2 screws (screws that removed in step 18))

x2

F-9-163

F-9-162

9-77
9
9
9-78

22) Peel off the paper liner, and affix the Cord Guide.
23) Peel off the Cover Seal, and install the 2 Wire Saddles.

Cover Seal Wire Saddles


Cord Guide

F-9-164

24) Install the Ring Core to both sides of the DVI Cable, and remove the cap. 25) Connect both sides of the DVI Cable respectively.

Ring Core DVI Cable

Cap

F-9-166
F-9-165

9-78
9
9
9-79

26) Pass the DVI Cable through the hole of the Right Rear Cover 1, and close the cover. 27) Pass DVI Cable to the Cord Guide, and install the cover.
28) Fix the DVI Cable to the Wire Saddle

F-9-167
F-9-168

9-79
9
9
9-80
Setting Check

1) Connect the power plug of the host machine to the power outlet.
2) Open the switch cover and turn ON the main power switch.
3) [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Accessibility] > [Voice Navigation Settings] > and make sure that [Use Voice Navigation] is [ON].
4) [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Accessibility] > [Voice Navigation Settings] > [Voice Navigation at Startup] and make sure that is [Select Mode at Startup] set.
5) [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Accessibility] > [Voice Navigation Settings] > and make sure that [Tune Microphone] is displayed.

Operation Check
■■When using

1) Press Reset Key and Voice Recognition Button for 3 secs or more.
2) In the operation screen [Voice Navigation], select one of the following: [Manual+Vocal Mode/Vocal Mode/Manual Mode], and press OK.
3) The display in Panel Screen, if the display in panel screen is boxed with red frame, “Voice Guidance Kit” is available.

NOTE:
If [Manual Mode] is selected in [Voice Navigation], nothing is going to happen even if Voice Recognition Button is pressed.

If “Voice Guidance Kit” doesn’t properly operate, check the below.


• Enter Service Mode > [COPIER] > [DISPLAY] > [VERSION], and check whether languages to be used for [TTS-JA/TTS-EN/TTS-IT/TTS-FR/TTS-DE] are properly installed.
• Enter Service Mode > [COPIER] > [DISPLAY] > [VERSION], and check whether [ASR-JA/ASR-EN] is properly installed.

■■To stop the use

1) Press the Reset Key for 3 secs or more.

9-80
9
9
9-81

Voice Guidance Kit-F1

Checking the Contents

[1] Speaker Unit (Upper) X 1 [2] Speaker Unit (Lower) X 1 [3] Voice Guidance Board Unit X 1 [4] Speaker Cable X 1 1 [5] Cord Guide X 7

[6] Ring Core X 2 [7] Screw(Binding; M4X20) X 2 2 [8] Screw(Binding; M4X16) X 2 2 [9] Screw(Binding; M3X16) X 1 [10] Screw(Binding; M4X6) X 1

3 [11] Screw(TP; M3X6) X 2

F-9-169

9-81
9
9
9-82

*1: 3 pieces are used in this Installation procedure.


*2: Not used in this Installation procedure.
*3: 2 screws are used in this Installation Procedure.

<CD/GUIDES>
• Voice Guidance kit Users Guide
• Voice Guidance Guide CD
• Sheet: FCC/IC

Points to note when Installing

CAUTION:
The Color Image Reader is necessary to operate this equipment.
When installing the equipment, see the 'Combination Table of Accessory Installation'.

Turning OFF the Host Machine


Be sure to refer to Host Machine Installation “How to disconnect main power”.

9-82
9
9
9-83
Installation Procedure

1) Open the Right Lower Cover. (Open also the Right 2) Open the Right Rear Cover 1.
Delivery Unit in the same time.) 3) Remove the Right Rear Cover 1.
• 1 Screw (RS Tight; M4)
• 2 Screws (TP; M3)
• Claw in 1 place
x3

F-9-170
Claw
F-9-171

4) If reader is installed, remove the Reader Power Cable. 5) Remove the USB Cable and Control Panel Communication Cable.
• 2 Connectors Control Panel
• 2 wire Saddle Communication Cable USB Cable
• 1 Cable Guide
x2
Reader Power x2
Cable

x2 Cable Guide

Wire Saddles

Connectors
F-9-173
F-9-172

9-83
9
9
9-84

6) Remove the 2 screws, and open the grip in 2 places.

x2

Grips
F-9-174

7) Hold the grip in 2 places, remove the Main Controller PCB 1 while avoiding the removed harness. 8) Remove the Voice Operation Board Support Plate from the Main Controller PCB 1. (Do not use the
removed Support Voice Operation Board.)
• 2 Screws (removed screw will be
used in step 9))

x2

F-9-175

F-9-176

9-84
9
9
9-85

9) Install the Voice Guidance Board Unit in the Main Controller PCB 1.
• 1 Connector
• 2 screws (2 Screws that removed in step 8))
• 2 Screws (TP; M3×6)
x4
NOTE:
Make sure that the connector is
installed properly.

Connector

F-9-177

10) Install the Main Controller PCB 1 in the Host Machine.

CAUTION:
Lift the handle, insert the Main Controller
PCB 1 until it stops, tilt the grip and
x2
install the 2 screws.
Make sure to tilt the grip slowly on both
sides simultaneously.
Check that the Main Controller PCB 1 is
installed properly.

Grip
F-9-178

9-85
9
9
9-86

11) Install the USB Cable and Control Panel Communication Cable.
12) If reader is installed, install the Reader Power Cable.

NOTE:
Handle the Reader Power Cable
from the connector side and make x2 [A]
a slack at A part.
Bend the Reader Power Cable at
a right angle on B part.
Cable Guide
Wire Saddles

[B]

Reader Power Cable

Connectors
F-9-179

13) Remove the small cover installed in the Right Rear Cover 1. 14) Cut the [A] part of Right Rear Cover 1 with nipper, etc.
• 1 Screw [A]
• Claw in 2 places 爪

x2

[A]
F-9-180 F-9-181

9-86
9
9
9-87

15) Install the Right Rear Cover 1. 16) Close the Right Lower Cover and the 17) Remove the Rubber Cap, screw, and Cover Seal from the Reader Right Cover. (Do not use the removed
Right Upper Cover. Rubber Cap, screw and Cover Seal.)
NOTE: Cover Seal
Do not close the Right Rear
Cover 1.

Rubber Cap

F-9-182

18) Install the Speaker Unit (lower). 19) Install the Speaker Unit (Upper).
• 2 Screws (Bind; M4x20) • 1 Screw (Bind; M4x6)

x2

F-9-184
F-9-183

9-87
9
9
9-88

20) Install the Ring Core to both sides of the Speaker Cable. 21) Remove the cover of the 3 Cord Guides.

50mm
F-9-186
F-9-185

22) Peel off the paper liner, and affix them in 3 places in the Cord Guide as shown in the figure. 23) Connect both sides of the Speaker Cable respectively.

NOTE:
If this is used together with the
Card Reader-C1.
Use the wire saddle enclosed with
the Card Reader Installation Kit-B1
to the [A] area.

[A]

F-9-187
F-9-188

9-88
9
9
9-89

24) Pass the Speaker Cable through the hole of the Right Rear Cover 1, and close the cover. 25) Pass the Speaker Cable to Cord Guide, and install the 3 Cord Guide covers.

F-9-189 F-9-190

9-89
9
9
9-90
Checking after installation

1) Connect the power plug of the host machine to the power outlet.
2) Open the switch cover and turn ON the main power switch.
3) [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Accessibility] > [Voice Navigation Settings] > and make sure that [Use Voice Navigation] is [ON].
4) [Settings/Registration] > [Preferences] > [Accessibility] > [Voice Navigation Settings] > and make sure that [Voice Guide from Speakers] is displayed.

Operation Check

■■<During use>
1) Press reset key 3 secs or more.
2) Press [Main Menu] in Control Panel.
3) If the display in panel screen is boxed with red frame, “Voice Guidance Kit” is available.

If “Voice Guidance Kit” doesn’t properly operate, check the below.


• Enter Service Mode > [COPIER] > [DISPLAY] > [VERSION], and check whether languages to be used for [TTS-JA/TTS-EN/TTS-IT/TTS-FR/TTS-DE] are properly
installed.

■■<To stop the use>


1) Press the Reset Key for 3 secs or more.

9-90
9
9
9-91

Card Reader-C1/Copy Card Reader-F1

Points to Note at Installation

NOTE:
Although model with the Card Reader-C1 is used for illustration in this procedure, the same
procedure is applied to model with the Copy Card Reader-F1.

CAUTION:
To install the Card Reader-C1, the Card Reader Mounting Kit-B1 is required.
To install the Copy Card Reader-F1, the Card Reader Mounting Kit-B2 is required.

Checking the Contents


■■Card Reader-C1/Copy Card Reader-F1

[1] Card Reader Unit x 1 [2] Screw (RS tight; M4X10) X 1 [3] Toothed washer x 1

F-9-191

9-91
9
9
9-92
■■Card Reader Attachment-B1

[1] Card Reader Mounting Plate [2] Card Reader Mounting Plate [3] Card Reader Relay Unit x 1 [4] Connector Cover x 1 [5] Card Reader External
(front) Unit x 1 (rear) Unit x 1 Relay Harness x 1

[6] Cord Guide x 2 [7] PCB Spacer x 1 [8] Wire Saddle x 1 [9] Screw (TP; M4X12) x 2 [10] Screw (TP; M3X6) x 4

F-9-192

9-92
9
9
9-93
■■Card Reader Attachment-B2

[1] Card Reader Mounting [2] Card Reader Mounting [3] Card Reader Mounting [4] Card Reader Relay [5] Connector Cover X 1
Plate (front) Unit X 1 Plate (rear) Unit X 1 Plate (lower) Unit X 1 Unit X 1

[6] Card Reader External [7] Cord Guide X 2 [8] PCB Spacer X 1 [9] Wire Saddle X 1 [10] Screw (TP; M3x6) X 5
Relay Harness X 1

Use 4 of them

[11] Screw (TP; M4x12) X 2 [12] Screw (Bind; M4x6) X 4

9-93
9
9
9-94
F-9-193

9-94
9
9
9-95
Turning OFF the Host Machine
Refer to the host machine installation [Turning OFF the Main Power].

Installation Procedure

CAUTION:
• When installing this equipment, refer to [Option Installation Combination List] and install it.
• After installing the Card Reader-C1/Copy Card Reader-F1, input the card number to be used in service mode on this equipment: [COPIER] > [FUNCTION] > [INSTALL] > [CARD]; otherwise
the card cannot be recognized even though it is inserted.

1) Open the Right Lower Cover. (Right Upper Cover will 2) Open the Right Rear Cover Unit1.
open simultaneously.) 3) Remove the Right Rear Cover Unit 1.
• 1 Screw (RS tight; M4)
• 2 Screws (TP; M3)
• 1 Claw
x3

F-9-194 Claw
F-9-195

9-95
9
9
9-96

4) When the Reader is installed, remove the Reader Power Cable. 5) Remove the USB Cable and the Control Panel Communication Cable.
• 2 Connectors Control Panel
• 2 Wire Saddles Communication Cable USB Cable
• 1 Cable Guide
x2
Reader Power x2
Cable

x2 Cable Guide

Wire Saddles

Connectors
F-9-197
F-9-196

6) Remove the 2 screws and open the 2 grips.

x2

Grips
F-9-198

9-96
9
9
9-97

7) Hold the 2 grips and remove the Main Controller PCB 1 while 8) Remove the 2 screws and the upper screw of Blanking Cover from the Main
avoiding the removed harness. Controller PCB 1.(Removed screw is used in the procedure 10))

Blanking Cover

x3

F-9-199

F-9-200

9) Remove the screw and remove the PCB Spacer.(Removed screw is used in the procedure 12))

PCB Spacer

F-9-201

9-97
9
9
9-98

10) Install the Card Reader Relay Unit. 11) Install the connector of Card Reader External Relay Harness.
• 3 Screws (screws removed
in step 8))
• 1 Connector
x3

F-9-202 F-9-203

12) Install the Connector Cover.


• 1 screw (screw removed in step 9))

CAUTION:
Install it in the position where the tie-wrap of
Card Reader External Relay Harness is inside
the Connector Cover..

F-9-204

9-98
9
9
9-99

13) Install the Main Controller PCB 1 to the host machine.

CAUTION:
• Lift the handle, insert the Main Controller PCB 1 until it
stops, tilt the grip and install the 2 screws.
x2
• Make sure to tilt the grip slowly on both sides
simultaneously.
• Check that the Main Controller PCB 1 is installed properly.

Grips
F-9-205

14) Install the USB Cable and the Control Panel Communication Cable.
15) When the Reader is installed, install the Reader Power Cable..

NOTE:
Handle the Reader Power Cable from the connector side and
make a slack at A part. x2 [A]
Bend the Reader Power Cable at a right angle on B part.

Cable Guide
Wire Saddles

[B]

Reader Power Cable

Connectors
F-9-206

9-99
9
9
9-100

16) Pass the Card Reader External Relay Harness through the Right Rear Cover 1 and install it.
• 1 Screws (RS tight; M4)
• 2 Screws (TP; M3)
• 1 Claw
• 1 Wire Saddle x3

Wire Saddle

F-9-207

17) Close the Right Rear Cover 1, Right Lower Cover and the Right Upper 18) Remove the Lower Cover of the Card Reader Unit, and change the position of the cable. (Copy
Cover. Card Reader-F1 only)
• 1 Screws
19) Install the Lower Cover of the Card Reader Unit.

Lower Cover

F-9-208

9-100
9
9
9-101

21) Install the Card Reader Unit to the Card Reader Mounting Plate (front) Unit.
20) Remove the Jumper from the connector of Card Reader Unit. • 1 Toothed Washer
(Removed Jumper will not be used.) • 1 Screw (RS tight; M4X10)
• 1 Wire saddle

Wire Saddle

Toothed Washer

F-9-210

F-9-209

22) Remove the 2 Blanking Seal from the Reader Right Cover. 23) Install the Card Reader Installation Plate (rear) to the host machine.
Blanking Seal • 2 Screws (TP;
M4X12)

x2

F-9-211
F-9-212

9-101
9
9
9-102

24) Connect the Card Reader External Relay Harness to the connector of Card Reader Unit.
• 1 Connector
Connector
• 1 Edge Saddle

Edge
Saddle

F-9-213

25) Install the Card Reader Mounting Plate (front) Unit to the Card Reader Mounting Plate (rear). 26) Remove the 2 covers of Cord Guide.
• 4 Screws (TP; M3X6)

CAUTION:
Do not pinch the harness.
x4
6

F-9-215

F-9-214

9-102
9
9
9-103

27) Remove the backing paper of Cord Guide and put it in the 2 places indicated in the figure.
28) Remove the face seal, and install the wire saddle.

Wire saddle

Cord Guide

F-9-216

29) Put the Card Reader External Relay Harness through the 2 places of Cord Guide and install the cover. 31) Connect the Power Plug into the outlet.
30) Fix the Card Reader External Relay Harness with the Wire Saddle. 32) Open the switch cover and turn ON the Main
Power Switch.

F-9-217

9-103
9
9
9-104
Setting After Installation

1) Enter Service Mode, and set the model of the Card Reader.
• Service Mode: COPIER > OPTION > ACC > CR-TYPE
• In the case of Card Reader-C1, select “1”.
• In the case of Copy Card Reader-F1, check that “0” is selected.

2) Enter the following Service Mode


NOTE: 3) Select: [COPIER] > [FUNCTION] > [INSTALL] > [CARD] and enter the card number to be used (1 NOTE:
The number of card (number of to 2001). After setting, if a request arises from
department) can be changed if a • Input the minimum card number to be used by a user. a user and changing the number of
request arises from a user. Make this • 1000 cards from the inputted number can be used. card (number of department), make
setting before the step 3). 4) To enable the setting value, turn OFF/ON the main power switch. a following setting. In that case,
• Change the setting value in service 5) Insert the card with the registered card No. and make sure that it is in standby. the current counter information by
mode (level 2) > [COPIER] > department will be reset.
[OPTION] > [FNC-SW] > [CARD- • Execute in service mode: >
RNG]. [COPIER] > [FUNCTION] > [CLEAR]
• To enable the setting value, turn > [CARD].
OFF/ON the main power switch. • Specify the value in service mode
• After that, go through the procedure (level 2): > [COPIER] > [OPTION] >
from step 2). [FNC-SW] > [CARD-RNG].
• After that, go through the procedure
from step 2).

9-104
9
9
9-105

Copy Tray-J1

Checking the contents

[1] Copy Tray x 1

F-9-218

Turning OFF the host machine


Refer to the host machine installation: “Turning OFF the main power”.

9-105
9
9
9-106
Installation procedure

1) Remove the Right Delivery Frame Cover with flat-blade screwdriver.


• 2 Claws
claw

x2

F-9-219

2) Install the Copy Tray. 3) Connect the Power Plug into the outlet.
• 2 Claws 4) Open the switch cover and turn ON the Main
Power Switch.

F-9-220

9-106
9
9
9-107
Setting after installation

1) Service Mode.
2) Select: [COPIER] > [OPTION] > [ACC] > [OUT-TRAY] and register ”1”.
3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
4) Select: [Settings/Registration] > [Function Settings] > [Common] > [Paper Output Settings] and check that [Delivery Tray Settings] menu is
added.
5) Select either tray B or C to copy, and perform test copy.
6) Check that the paper is output in the Copy Tray.
7) Reset the tray in accordance with the user’s request.

9-107
9
9
9-108

Inner 2-way Tray-F1

Checking the Contents

[1] Inner 2way Tray X1 [2] Insert pin X1 [3] Screw (TP; M3X6) X1 [4] Second Delivery Full
Detection Lever X 1

*Not used in this Installation procedure. F-9-221

Turning Off the Main Power Switch


Refer to "Turning OFF the Main Power Switch" in Main Unit Installation Procedure.

9-108
9
9
9-109
Installation Procedure

1) Release the claw of the Inner 2way Tray Support using flat-blade screwdriver, and release the Inner 2way Tray from the host machine.
2) Turn over the Inner 2way Tray Support and install to the host machine.
• 1 Screw (TP; M3x6)

F-9-222

3) Insert the Inner 2way Tray to 2 slots of the Delivery Assembly, and hook it to the slot of the Inner 2way Tray Support.

NOTE:
Insert the Inner 2way Tray to the
slot of the Delivery Assembly
and hook it to the Second Tray
Support so that boss is inserted
to the Inner Rear Cover 1.

CAUTION:
Check that the Inner 2way Tray
Unit is inserted to the Inner 2way
Tray Support. F-9-223

9-109
9
9
9-110

4) Insert the insert pin into the hole of the In Tray, and fix to the Inner 2way Tray Support. 5) Select copy to the Tray B, and perform test Connect the Power Plug into the outlet.
6) Open the switch cover and turn ON the Main Power Switch.

F-9-224

Setting after installation

1) Service Mode
2) [COPIER] > [OPTION] > [ACC] > [IN-TRAY], and set “1”
3) Turn OFF/ON the main power switch.
4) [Settings/Registration] > [Function Settings] > [Common] > [Paper Output Settings] > [Output Tray Settings], and check that menu is added.
5) Select copy to the Tray B, and perform test copy.
6) Check that a copy is delivered to the Inner 2way Tray.
7) Set the tray in accordance with user’s request.

9-110
9
9
9-111

Additional Memory TypeB (512MB)

Checking the contents

[1] Expansion RAM x 1

F-9-225

Pre-Check

1) Check the memory capacity.


• Service Mode > COPIER > DISAPLAY > ACC-STS > RAM
2) Exit the service mode.

Turning OFF the Host Machine


Refer to the host machine installation: “Turning OFF the main power”.

9-111
9
9
9-112
Installation Procedure

1) Remove the Left Rear Cover. 2) If the Reader is installed, remove the Reader
Communication Cable.
• 2 Rubber Caps
• 2 Screws
Rubber Caps
• 5 Claws
x2
Claws

x5

Rubber Caps

F-9-226
F-9-227

3) Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover. 4) If FAX is installed,disconnect the FAX cable.
• 1 Screw
• 1 Hook hook

Left Rear
Sub Cover
F-9-228 F-9-229

9-112
9
9
9-113

5) Hold the grip and remove the Main Controller PCB 2.


• 2 Screws

x2

Grip
F-9-230

6) Install the Expansion RAM.

F-9-231

9-113
9
9
9-114

7) Install the Main Controller PCB 2.

CAUTION:
• Lift the grip and insert the
Main Controller PCB 2.
x2
When it touches the end,
tilt the grip and install it with
2 screws.
• Make sure to tilt the grip
slowly on both sides
simultaneously.
• Check that the Main
Controller PCB 2 is
Grip
installed properly.
F-9-232

8) Install the removed cover and the cable.


• Connect the FAX cable.(If the FAX is installed.)
• Install the Left Rear Sub Cover.
• Install the Reader Communication Cable (if the Reader is installed).
• Install the Left Reader Cover.
9) Connect the Power Plug to the Outlet.
10) Open the switch cover and turn ON the Main Power Switch.

9-114
9
9
9-115
Checking after installation

1) After adding the Expansion RAM, check that the memory capacity is increased.
• Service mode > COPIER > DISAPLAY > ACC-STS > RAM
2) Exit the service mode.

9-115
9
9
9-116

Expansion Bus-F1/F2, IPSec Board-B2, Wireless LAN Board-B1 Installation Procedure

Points to Note when Installing

CAUTION:
“PCI Bus Expansion Kit-F1/F2” is required to set “IPSec Board-B2” and “Wireless LAN Board-B1”
When using with "Serial Interface Kit-K1" or "Copy Control Interface Kit-A1", install "Serial Interface Kit-K1" or "Copy Control Interface Kit-A1" beforehand.
The following “Removing Main Controller PCB 1”, there are 3 procedures based on the installation combination.

Expansion Bus-F1/F2 IPSec Security Board-B2 Wireless LAN Board-B1 Reference for installation
○ ○ - Be sure to refer to “To install Expansion Bus-F1/F2 and IPSec Board-B2 at the same time”
Be sure to refer to “To install Expansion Bus-F1/F2 and Wireless LAN Board-B1 and IPSec Board-B2 at the
○ - ○
same time”.
Be sure to refer to “To install Expansion Bus-F1/F2 and Wireless LAN Board-B1 and IPSec Board-B2 at the
○ ○ ○
same time”.
T-9-5

9-116
9
9
9-117
Checking the contents
■■Expansion Bus-F1

[1] PCI Bus Expansion PCB X 1 1 [2] Riser Support Plate × 1 [3] PCB Spacer X 3 2 [4] Screw(TP; M3×6) × 5 [5] PCI Riser Support Plate X 1

Included with F2 only

F-9-233
*1 This is used when connecting the “IPSec Board-B2”.
*2 2 out of 5 screws are used.

■■IPSec Board-B2

[1] IPSec PCB × 1 [2] Screw(TP; M3×6) × 2 [3] Wireless LAN Auxiliary Plate ×1

F-9-234

<CD/Guides>
• FCC/IC Instruction Sheet for UAS only

9-117
9
9
9-118
■■Wireless LAN Board-B1

[1] Wireless LAN Board x 1 [2] Bulk Head Unit x 1 [3] PCI Bus Expansion PCB x 1 [4] Wireless LAN Auxiliary Plate x 1

[5] Wireless LAN Support Plate x 1 2 [6] Wireless LAN Support Plate x 1 [7] MFP Antenna x 1 1 [8] Antenna Tape x 1Sheet [9] Wireless LAN Indication Label x 1

[10] Cord Guide(L90) x 3 3 [11] Screw(TP; M3x6) x 5

F-9-235

9-118
9
9
9-119
*1 Be sure to keep the remaining of the 3 sheets of tape, as it might be needed for later use.
*2 Not used.
*3 3 out of 5 screws are used.

<CD/Guides>
• Users Manual
• Wireless LAN User Manual CD
• Sheet: FCC/IC (UAS only)

Turning the Host Machine OFF


Be sure to refer to How to Disconnect the Main Power in the Host Machine installation.

9-119
9
9
9-120
Installation Procedure
■■Removing the Main Controller PCB 1

1) Open the Right Lower Cover (Open also the Right 2) Open the Right Rear Cover 1.
Delivery Unit in the same time). 3) Remove the Right Rear Cover 1.
• 1 Screw (RS Tight; M4)
• 2 Screws (TP; M3)
• Claw in 1 place
x3

F-9-236
Claw
F-9-237

4) If Reader is installed, remove the Reader Power Cable. 5) Remove the USB cable and Control Panel Communication Cable.
• 2 Connectors Control Panel
• 1 Wire Saddle Communication Cable USB Cable
• 1 Cable Guide
x2 x2
Reader Power
Cable

x2 Cable Guide

Wire Saddles

Connectors F-9-239

F-9-238

9-120
9
9
9-121

6) Remove the 2 screws, open the grip in 2 places. 7) Hold the grip in 2 places, remove the Main Controller PCB 1
while avoiding the removed harness.

x2

Grips
F-9-241
F-9-240

9-121
9
9
9-122
■■To install Expansion Bus-F1/F2 and IPSec Board-B2 in the same time

1) Install the PCI Bus Expansion PCB in Riser Support Plate. 2) Remove the 3 screws of the Main Controller PCB 1, and install the 3 PCB Spacers.
• 2 Screws (TP; M3x6) (in the Expansion Bus-F1 contents) • 3 Screws (removed screw will be used in step 3))

x2 x3

F-9-243
F-9-242

3) Install the PCI Bus Expansion PCB by inserting it to the connector of the Main Controller PCB 1. 4) Install the IPSec Security PCB by inserting it to the connector of the PCI Bus Expansion PCB.
• 3 Screws (screws removed in step 2)). • 2 Screws (TP; M3x6) (in the IPSec Board-B2 contents)

x3 x2

F-9-244 F-9-245

9-122
9
9
9-123

5) Install the Main Controller PCB 1 to the host machine.

CAUTION:
Lift the handle, insert the Main
Controller PCB 1 until it stops,
x2
tilt the grip and install the 2
screws.
Make sure to tilt the grip slowly
on both sides simultaneously.
Check that the Main Controller
PCB 1 is installed properly.

Grip
F-9-246

6) Install the USB Cable and Control Panel Communication Cable. 8) Install the Right Rear Cover 1.
7) If Reader is installed, install the Reader Power Cable. 9) Close the Right Lower Cover.
10) Close the Right Upper Cover.
NOTE:
Handle the Reader Power
Cable from the connector x2 [A]
side and make a slack at A
part.
Bend the Reader Power
Cable at a right angle on B Cable Guide
part. Wire Saddles

[B]

Reader Power Cable

Connectors
F-9-247

9-123
9
9
9-124
■■To install the Expansion Bus-F1/F2, Cordless Wireless LAN Board-B1 and IPSec Board-B2 in the same time.

CAUTION: Points to note at


installation
Be sure not to install incorrect
Wireless LAN Support Plate.

F-9-248

CAUTION: Points to note at


installation
For the Bulk Head Unit, be
sure to install the flat surface
of the terminal assembly facing
upward.

F-9-249

9-124
9
9
9-125

1) Install the Bulk Head Unit in the Wireless LAN Support Plate. 2) Install the PCI Bus Expansion PCB (in the Expansion Bus-F1 contents) in the PCI Expansion Support Plate.
• 2 Screws (TP; M3x6) (in the Wireless LAN Board-B1 contents)).
• 2 Screws (TP; M3x6) (in the PCI Bus Expansion PCB
Expansion Bus-F1 contents)

x2
x2 CAUTION: Note when installing
Be sure to install the PCI Bus
Expansion PCB to come under
[A] part of PCI Expansion
Support Plate. [A]

PCI Expansion Support Plate


Wireless LAN Support Plate Bulk Head Unit F-9-251
F-9-250

3) Insert the Wireless LAN Board to the connector of the PCI Bus Expansion PCB, and install it in PCI 4) Remove the Cover Plate from the Main Controller Roller PCB 1 (The removed Cover Plate will not
Expansion Support Plate. be used anymore).
• 1 Screw (TP; M3x6) (in the Wireless LAN Board-B1 contents). • 2 Screws (the removed screw will be used in step 7))

x2

F-9-252
F-9-253

9-125
9
9
9-126

5) Remove the 3 screws of the Main Controller PCB 1, and install the 3 PCB Spacers (in the PCI Bus Expansion Kit Content).
• 3 Screws (the removed screws will be used in step 6)).

x3

F-9-254

6) Install the PCI Expansion Support Plate assembled at step 3) in the Main Controller PCB 1.
• 3 Screws (use the screws removed
in step 5)).

x3
CAUTION:
Do not tuck the Fan Cable when
installing the PCI Expansion
Support Plate.

F-9-255

9-126
9
9
9-127

7) Install the Wireless LAN Support Plate assembled in step 1) in the Main Controller PCB 1.
• 2 Screws (use the screws removed
in step 4))
• 2 Screws (TP; M3x6) (in the Wireless
LAN Board-B1 Contents)
x4

CAUTION:
Do not tuck the Fan Cable when
tightening the screw of Wireless
LAN Support Plate.

F-9-256

8) Insert the terminal of Bulk Head Unit into the indicated position.
NOTE:
NOTE: To install the IPSec Security Board, perform step 9)
Make sure that the terminal to 11). If IPSec Security Board is not to be installed,
is securely settled. perform from step 12.

F-9-257

9-127
9
9
9-128

9) Remove the plate of the IPSec Security PCB. (Removed plate is not used anymore). 10) Turn the IPSec Security PCB (in the IPSec Board-B2 contents) upside down, and install the Wireless LAN
• 2 Screws (Removed screws will be used in step 10)). Auxiliary Plate (in the Wireless LAN Board-B1 content)..
• 2 Screws (use the screws
removed in step 9)). IPSec Security PCB

x2 x2

Wireless LAN
F-9-258
Auxiliary Plate
F-9-259

11) Install the IPSec Security PCB by inserting it to the connector of the PCI Bus Expansion PCB.
• 2 Screws (TP; M3x6) (in the
IPSec Board-B2 contents)

x2

F-9-260

9-128
9
9
9-129

12) Install the Main Controller PCB 1 to the host machine.

CAUTION:
Lift the handle, insert the Main
Controller PCB 1 until it stops,
x2
tilt the grip and install the 2
screws.
Make sure to tilt the grip slowly
on both sides simultaneously.
Check that the Main Controller
PCB 1 is installed properly.

Grip
F-9-261

13) Install the USB Cable and Control Panel Communication Cable. 15) Install the Right Rear Cover 1.
14) If Reader is installed, install the Reader Power Cable. 16) Close the Right Lower Cover.
17) Close the Right Upper Cover.
NOTE:
Handle the Reader Power
Cable from the connector x2 [A]
side and make a slack at A
part.
Bend the Reader Power
Cable at a right angle on B Cable Guide
part. Wire Saddles

[B]

Reader Power Cable

Connectors
F-9-262

9-129
9
9
9-130

18) Affix the Antenna Tape in MFP Antenna, and affix it in the Reader. 19) Remove the cover of the 3 Cord Guide.

CAUTION: Points to note at


[B]
installation
To prevent the MFP Antenna
from being caught by ADF, put it [A]
within 60mm from the back side.
Antenna Tape
Make sure that [A] part overlaps
with [B] line.
60mm
F-9-264

MFP Antenna

F-9-263

20) Peel off the paper liner, and install the Cord Guide.

CAUTION: Points to note at


installation
Be sure to affix the Cord Guide
25 mm from the Right Rear
Cover 1.

Cord Guide

Right Rear Cover 1

25mm

F-9-265 F-9-266

9-130
9
9
9-131

21) Pass the MFP Antenna Cable to the Cord Guide, and 22) Open the Right Rear Cover 1, insert the connector of MFP Antenna to the terminal of the Main Controller PCB 1.
install the Cord Guide Cover.
• 1 Wire Saddle

Connector

Wire saddle
Right Rear Cover 1

F-9-267 F-9-268

.
23) Affix the Wireless LAN Indication Label.

NOTE:
Be sure that the slack of the
MFP Antenna Cable is in the
backside lower part of the
Host Machine.

F-9-269
F-9-270

9-131
9
9
9-132
Checking after installation

When IPSec Security Board has already been installed


1) Insert the Power Plug in the outlet.
2) Turn ON the main power switch.
3) [Settings/Reristration] > [Preference] > [Network] > [Confirm Network Connection Set. Changes ] > turn it [ON].
4) [Settings/Reristration] > [Preference] > [Network] > and select [TCP/IP Settings].
5) Be sure that “IPSec Settings” is displayed.

When Wireless LAN Board has been already installed


1) Insert the Power Plug in the outlet.
2) Turn ON the main power switch.
3) [Settings/Reristration ] > [Preference] > select [External Interface].
4) Be sure that “Extension Card Settings” is displayed.

9-132
9
9
9-133

Combination of HDD Options


HDD When installing the HDD options (5 products indicated below), refer to the pages indicated in the following table.
• 2.5inch/80GB HDD-C1
• 2.5inch/250GB HDD-D1
• Removable HDD Kit-AC1
• HDD Mirroring Kit-D1
• HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit-C1

CAUTION:
When using the mirroring function, be sure to install 2 HDDs of the same capacity.

Reference Pages in the Manual According to Product Combination


Title. Combination of Product Reference Pages
TYPE-1 Option HDD (250GB) p. 9-134 to p. 9-143
TYPE-2* Removable HDD Kit p. 9-144 to p. 9-159
TYPE-3 Option HDD (250GB) + Removable HDD Kit p. 9-160 to p. 9-181
TYPE-4* Option HDD (80GB) + HDD Mirroring Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit p. 9-282 to p. 9-304
TYPE-5 2 Option HDDs (250GB) + HDD Mirroring Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit p. 9-305 to p. 9-328
TYPE-6* Option HDD (80GB) + Removable HDD Kit + HDD Mirroring Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit p. 9-329 to p. 9-360
TYPE-7 2 Option HDDs (250GB) + Removable HDD Kit + HDD Mirroring Kit or HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit p. 9-361 to p. 9-392
TYPE-8* HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit p. 9-182 to p. 9-201
TYPE-9* Removable HDD Kit + HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit p. 9-202 to p. 9-229
TYPE-10 Option HDD (250GB) + HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit p. 9-230 to p. 9-252
TYPE-11 Option HDD (250GB) + Removable HDD Kit + HDD Data Encryption & Mirroring Kit p. 9-253 to p. 9-281
* Use the HDD installed to the machine as standard. T-9-6

9-133
9
9
9-134

[TYPE-1] Option HDD (250GB)

Checking the Contents


The parts with a gray in the contents list will not be used.

[1] HDD Support Pate x 1 [2] HDD x 1 [3] Vibration-prevention [4] Spacersx 4 [5] Grounding Plate x 1
Dumper x 4

[6] Screw (W sems; M3x14) x 4 [7] Screw (TP;M3x6) x 2 [8] Gasket x 1

<CD/GUIDS> F-9-271

• Notice for FCC/IC


• China RoHS Notice 3

9-134
9
9
9-135
Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export List of Data to be Deleted
Data to be Deleted Availability of Backup
Before performing work that will result in the loss of data, inform the system administrator of Information registered in the Address Book Yes
the inevitable loss, asking him to make a backup or export of important data items. Settings made from the Settings/Registration screen Yes *1
Backup or export work must not be performed by the service person because of security Forwarding Settings Yes
considerations. License files for MEAP applications Yes
MEAP applications No
In this Installation Procedure, a series of backup or export procedures are described for
Data saved using MEAP applications Yes *2
reference. Favorite Settings registered in the Copy and Mail Box functions No
Send Function Favorite Settings Yes
Data stored in Mail Boxes or the Advanced Box Yes *3
Scan modes registered in the Send Function No
Unsent documents (documents waiting to be sent with the Delayed Send No
mode)
Image forms stored in the Superimpose Image Yes
MEAP SMS (Service Management Service) password No
(the password will return to its default password if it was changed)
Job logs No
User authentication information registered in the Local Device Yes
Authentication user authentication system of SSO-H (Single Sign-On H)
Registration information for the Network Place No
Key Pair and Server Certificate No
Log information for the IP address/MAC address restriction settings No
Password that is protected by TPM Yes *4
Encryption key that is protected by TPM No
Information for Web browser settings Yes *5
Quick Menu Information Yes
User Information of the Advanced Box Yes
T-9-7

*1; Can only be backed up using the Remote UI.


*2; Depending on the MEAP application.
*3: Only the following data saved in Mail Box/Advanced Box are backed up.
• Mail Box Settings (mail box names, passwords, and auto erase times)
• Files in Mail Box
• Files in Advanced Box
• Forms registered for the Superimpose Image
• Advanced Box URI Transmission Settings
*4; You may not be able to back up, depending on the type of the password.
*5; Only the stored Favorite Settings can be backed up.

9-135
9
9
9-136
List of Data to be Backed Up
Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)
Data to be backed up Reference
Address Book For information on exporting data, see the The data items that have been backed up may be restored when this product has been
Settings/Registration settings "e-Manual > Remote UI". installed. These data items are property of the user, and the restoration work must be
Device Settings (Forwarding Settings, Address performed by the system administrator.
List, Favorite Settings)
The method of restoration is described in the Users Guide. See Table (Data to be backed up)
Printer Settings
in Points to Note About Installation of the Installation Procedure.
Paper Information
Favorite Settings for Web browser See the "e-Manual > Web Access".
(You can select this if web browser (Option) is 1. Procedure to make a backup of Address Book
installed.) 1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
License files for MEAP applications For information on downloading license files, see
the "e-Manual > MEAP".
http://[IP address of the device]/
Data saved by MEAP applications Data saved by MEAP applications may be If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name
able to be backed up, depending on the MEAP and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
application. in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
See the documentation included with the MEAP
application. 2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/
Data stored in Mail Boxes or the Advanced Box See the "e-Manual > Remote UI" to "Setting the Export].
Image forms stored in the Superimpose Image Backup Location for Stored Data ". 3) Click [Address List].
SSO-H (Single Sign-On H) user authentication See the "e-Manual > MEAP". 4) Click [Export].
information
5) Select the save format for Address list, and click [Start Export].
Quick Menu Information See the "e-Manual > Quick Menu".
User Information of the Advanced Box See the "e-Manual > Security". 6) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. Be sure to set
T-9-8 a distinctive name to an export file so that you can recognize it when importing it.

NOTE:
CAUTION: Work to Perform After Installing the Kit Exporting the device settings will export all contents of the address list. In other words,
• When you start using this product, passwords set for Mail Boxes are erased. Set there is no need for a backup unless it needs to be done individually.
these passwords again.
• If you have logged on to the machine using a login service, such as SSO-H (Single
Sign-On H) before using this product, you must select the login service again 2. Device Settings Export Procedure
using SMS (Service Management Service) after restarting the machine. For more 1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
information on using SMS, see the "e-Manual > MEAP". http://[IP address of the device]/
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/
Export].
3) Click [Device Settings (Forwarding Settings, Address List, Favorite Settings)].
4) Click [Export], and then click [Start Export].
5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file.

9-136
9
9
9-137
3. Settings/Registration Export Procedure 6. Backup of MEAP Application
1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI. When a MEAP application has been installed, the data and license that the MEAP application
http://[IP address of the device]/ retains will be deleted. If no MEAP application is installed, there is no need to make a backup.
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name If a MEAP application has a backup function, make a backup of the data peculiar to the
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password MEAP application using this function. With regard to the license, there is a need to stop all
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login]. applications from SMS (Service Management Service), invalidate the license, and download
2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/ the invalid license file.
Export].
3) Click [Settings/Registration]. CAUTION: MEAP Backup Funct ion Using the SST
4) Click [Export], and click [Start Export]. Data that has been backed up using MEAP back of the SST before the use of this
5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. product is started must not be written back to the host machine after the use of this
product is started. Similarly, even if the data that has been backed up after the use
4. Printer Settings Export Procedure of this product is started is written back to the host machine before the use of this
product is started, the machine does not operate. It is necessary to make sure that the
NOTE: implementation conditions for this product are compatible before and after making a
The following items to be exported are the same as the ones which are distributed by backup of data, and the MEAP backup function does not permit making a backup of
device information distribution. data in the course of installing the kit.

1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
http://[IP address of the device]/ The overview of procedures for stop of MEAP applications, Disabling of the license, and
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name download of an Disabled license file is described below. For more information, see the
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password MEAPSMS Administrator Guide.
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/ 7. Stop of MEAP Applications, Disabling, Download of Disabled License Files and
Export]. Uninstallation
3) Click [Printer Settings]. 1) Select the URL given below and access SMS.
4) Click [Export], and click [Start Export]. http://[IP address of the device]:8000/sms/
5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. The default password is MeapSmsLogin. If a user has changed the password, ask the user
to change the password again after the use of this product is started.
5. Paper Information Export Procedure
1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI. CAUTION:
http://[IP address of the device]/ The default password is MeapSmsLogin. If a user has changed the password, ask the
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name user to change the password again after the use of this product is started.
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login]. 2) Click [MEAP Application Management].
2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/ 3) Click [Stop] button of the application you want to stop on the MEAP Application
Export]. Management page.
3) Click [Paper Information]. 4) Click the application of which license has been installed.
4) Click [Export], and click [Start Export]. 5) Click [License Control], and then click [Disable]. Click [Yes] in a confirmation window for
5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. disabling the license.

9-137
9
9
9-138
6) Click [Download] under “Download/delete Disabled License File” item. Following the 9. Backup of User inbox and Advanced Box document data
instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. Set a distinctive name
for the disabled license file so that you can recognize it for which application. After you CAUTION: Backup of "Advanced Box"
download the disabled license file to your PC, click [Delete]. Click [Yes] in a confirmation When setting a SMB server as a backup destination, Advanced Box data saved in a
window for license deletion. large capacity HDD cannot be backed up. The Advanced Box data backed up from the
7) Return to the MEAP Application Management page, click [Uninstall] button of the large capacity HDD cannot be restored to the standard HDD.
application you want to uninstall. Click [Yes] in a confirmation window for uninstallation. If Depending on the system version of the machine, both backup and restoration might
there are several applications, repeat the procedures 1) to 7). not be performed.
8) After the use of this product is started, re-install the application using an application file (jar
file) of each application from SMS and the disabled license file (lic file). The procedure of backup and restoration of a box document data is described below.
Specify the backup destination of a document data:

8. User Authentication Information Registered by SSO-H (Single Sign-ON H) • Backup to SMB server

In the case that the MEAP login application has been changed to SSO-H, there is a need to Select SMB as a backup destination and specify an address, a user name, a password,

make a backup of the user authentication information. and a path to the SMB server to which saved data is backed up.

1) Access the URL given below. • Backup to USB HDD

http://[IP address of the device]:8000/sso/ Select USB HDD as a backup destination and specify a path to the USB HDD folder to

The default password is MeapSmsLogin. If a user has changed the password, ask the user which saved data is backed up.

to change the password again after the use of this product is started.
CAUTION: Data which cannot be backed up

CAUTION: If you back up/restore stored data without restarting the machine after changing the
language displayed on the touch panel display by pressing [Settings/Registration] >
The default password is MeapSmsLogin. If the user has changed the password, ask
[Preferences] from the control panel of the machine, the stored data may not be backed
him/her to change the password again after the use of this product is started.
up/restored properly. For more information on the data that cannot be backed up, see
Points to Note for Installation.
2) Login with the user name and password registered as an administrator in SSO-H.
The default administrator user name and password are as follows:
User Name: Administrator CAUTION:
Password: password
If the language setting in the common specification settings (Settings/Registration) is
3) Click [User Control]. set to ON, 'host address' and 'path to folder' might not be displayed correctly or cannot
4) Put a checkmark to Select All, and then click [Export]. be referred.
5) Leave the file format and character code as defaults and click [Start Export].
6) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file and click [Save].

9-138
9
9
9-139
10. Quick Menu Information Export Procedure
CAUTION:
1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
• Regarding the method of inputting characters, see 'Basic Operations' in the http://[IP address of the device]/
e-Manual. If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name
• A host address can be up to 128 characters in 1 byte or 64 characters in 2 bytes and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
using the 'Kana-Kanji,' 'Katakana,' 'alphanumeric character,' 'mark,' and 'code input' in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
modes. 2) Select Basic Tools > [Quick Menu] > [Export].
• A path to the folder can be up to 255 characters in 1 byte (127 characters in 2 bytes). 3) If the file needs to be encrypted, enter the password after check [Encrypt file]. (The number
• A user name can be up to 128 characters in 1 byte or 64 characters in 2 bytes of characters for the password must be more than 4 but less than 16.)
using the 'Kana-Kanji,', 'Katakana,' 'alphanumeric character,' 'mark,' and 'code input' 4) Click [Export].
modes. 5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file.
• A password can be up to 7 to 48 characters using the 'alphanumeric character' and
'mark (1 byte)' modes. 11. User Information of the Advanced Box Export Procedure
• The voice sound symbol and the semi-voice sound symbol entered in the 'Katakana (1 1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
byte)' mode are counted up as one 1-byte character. http://[IP address of the device]/
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name
[Backup method of User inbox and Advanced Box document data]
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
1) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Backup].
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
2) Select ‘All’ or ‘Changes’ for the backup method.
2) Select Basic Tools > [User Access Control for Advanced Box]. The dialog box to enter the
3) Click [Execute].
user name of administrator and password appears, enter the system administrator ID and
password, and then click [Log In].
CAUTION:
The default administrator user name and password are as follows:
• If any of the host IP address, user name, password, or path to the folder is not
User Name: Administrator
correctly entered, a backup cannot be made.
Password: password
• If you select to encrypt the backup data, the backup process may take longer. 3) Click [Export], and click [Start Export].
4) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file.
[Restoring the backup data of User inbox and Advanced Box document data]
1) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Restore].
2) Click [Display Backup Data]. Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power
3) Select the backup data to restore from the list and then click [Execute]. Check that the main power switch is OFF.
1) Turning off the Main Power Supply Switch of the Host Machine.
CAUTION:
2) Check that the display on the Control Panel and the Main Power Supply Lamp are turned
• If you want to restore encrypted backup data, enter the same password used when off before disconnecting the outlet.
backing up the data.
• Depending on the settings of the machine, the backup data may not be completely
restored, or some documents may be automatically printed.
• Restoration is performed after all of the box data stored in the machine, or
documents that are being sent, received, or stored, are erased.

9-139
9
9
9-140
Installation Procedure

1) Assemble the option HDD (250GB).


• 1 Option HDD
Option HDD
• 1 HDD Support Pate
• 4 Dust-prevention Dumpers
• 4 spacers
• 4 screws (binding with flat washer; M3x14)
HDD Support Plate
x4

Spacer

Vibration-prevention Dumpe

F-9-272

2) Affix the gasket to the place shown in the figure below.


CAUTION:
• Assembling the option HDD, be careful of the installation direction. CAUTION:
• Make sure that the label on the option HDD is facing up. Be sure to place the gasket in contact with the label-free metal surface of the HDD
• Make sure that [A] part of HDD Support Plate is placed at the opposite side of connector. surface.

Label
HDD

Connector side

[A] Connector Gasket Screw hole


F-9-273
F-9-274

9-140
9
9
9-141

3) Open the Right Rear Cover 1. 4) Open the HDD Lid behind the Right Rear Cover 1. 5) Remove the Signal Cable and the Power Cable from the HDD.
• 1 screw

x2
Signal Cable

Power Cable

F-9-275

F-9-277
F-9-276

6) Put the Signal Cable and the Power Cable aside so that thay are not pinched 7) Rmove the HDD Unit by holding it as shown in the figure below.
between the Controller Box and the HDD Unit. • 2 screws

x2

F-9-278

F-9-279

9-141
9
9
9-142

8) Remove the HDD (80GB) installed as standard from the 9) Install the Option HDD (250GB). 10) Install the HDD Unit to the host machine.
removed HDD Unit. (Removed HDD (80GB) will not be used.) • 2 screws (The screw removed in step 8).) 11) Install the Signal Cable and the Power Cable to the
• 2 screws (Removed screw will be used in step 9).) Option HDD.
12) Close the HDD Lid.
13) Close the Right Rear Cover 1.
x2 14) Close the Right Lower Cover.
15) Close the Right Upper Cover.
x2

F-9-281
F-9-280

9-142
9
9
9-143
Installing the System Software Using the SST Execution of Auto Adjust Gradation
The system data stored on the HDD and used to control the host machine will be lost when When this product is installed, the machine initializes its HDD, resetting the data used for
the machine is first started up after installing this product. auto gradation adjustment.
It is important to install the system software used to control the host machine so that the Therefore be sure to execute auto gradation adjustment (full adjust) after installing this kit.
machine may start up properly after installation of this product.
Details follow.
1. Requirements
1) PC
Service support tool in the version that supports this host machine must be installed.
2) Cross Ethernet Cable

2. Preparing for the Installation of the System Software of Host machine


1) If both PC and the machine are on, turn them off.
2) Connect the PC and the machine using an Ethernet cable.
3) Turn on the PC.
4) Start up the machine in download mode (safe mode).

3. Selecting the System Software


1) Set the CD containing the latest system software in the PC on which the SST is used.
2) Start up the SST.
3) Click Register Firmware.
4) Select the drive in which the System Software CD has been set, and click search.
5) Click REGISTER.
6) Click OK.

4. Downloading the System Software


1) Click CONNECT.
2) From the list of machine series, select the appropriate model.
3) Select 'single', and click START.
4) Execute HDD format.
5) After 5 sec from when the power of the host machine is turned OFF, restart the host
machine in download mode of safe mode.
6) When "download mode" is displayed on the control panel, click simple mode start.
7) Click start to execute download.
8) Follow the instruction on the screen and when download is complete, click OK.
9) Exit SST.
10) Check the versions of MN-CONT and LANG etc in service mode.

9-143
9
9
9-144

[TYPE-2] Removable HDD Kit

Checking the Contents


The parts with a gray in the contents list will not be used.

[1] Hinge Shaft Stopper x 2 [2] HDD Handle x 2 [3] HDD Connector Plate x 2 [4] HDD Cover x 2 [5] HDD Blanking Plate x 1

[6] HDD Door Guide x 1 [7] HDD Lock Plate x 1 [8] HDD Lock Plate Shaft x 2 [9] HDD Lid Retainer x 1 [10] Shutdown Caution Label
x1

[11] Connector Fixing Block [12] Conversion Connector [13] Signal Cable [14] IV Cable [15] Power Cable
x2 x2 (660mm ; Red) x 1 (FK2-8453) x 1 (650mm ; FK2-8464) x 1

F-9-282

9-144
9
9
9-145

[16] HDD Drawer Unit x 1 [17] Screw [18] Screw (P Tight ; M3 X 8) x 4 [19] R-HDD Label x 1
(R round head TP; M3 X 6) x 9

F-9-283

Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power


Check that the main power switch is OFF.
1) Turning off the Main Power Supply Switch of the Host Machine.
2) Check that the display on the Control Panel and the Main Power Supply Lamp are turned off before disconnecting the outlet.

Installation Procedure
■■Removing the HDD Unit, Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable

1) Open the Right Lower Cover. (Open the Right Upper


Cover simultaneously.) 2) Open the Right Rear Cover 1.
3) Remove the Right Rear Cover 1.
• 1 screw (RS tight; M4)
• 2 screws (TP; M3) x3
• 1 claw

Claw
F-9-284 F-9-285

9-145
9
9
9-146

4) When the Reader is installed, 5) Remove the USB Cable and the Control Panel Communication Cable.
remove the Reader Power Control Panel
Cable. Communication Cable USB Cable
• 2 connectors x2
• 2 wire saddles Reader Power
• 1 cable guide Cable x2
x2 Cable Guide

Wire Saddles

Connectors
F-9-286 F-9-287

6) Remove the 2 screws, open the grip in 2 places.


7) Hold the 2 Grips, and pull out the Main Controller PCB 1
approximately 10mm toward front.

x2

Grips
F-9-289
F-9-288

9-146
9
9
9-147

8) Remove the Left Rear Cover. 9) When the Reader is installed, remove the Reader Communication Cable.
• 2 rubber caps
• 2 screws
• 5 claws
x2
claw

x5

F-9-290 F-9-291

10) Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover. 11) Remove the Rear Cover.
• 1 screw • 2 rubber caps
• 1 hook Hook • 2 screws
• 1 claw
x2

claw

Left Rear
Sub Cover
F-9-292 F-9-293

9-147
9
9
9-148

12) Open the Controller Box while avoiding the harness.


• 2 screws NOTE:
If the FAX Unit has been
installed, remove the 3 screws
and open the Controller Box
x3
x2 with the FAX Unit.

Harness
Harness

F-9-295
F-9-294

13) Remove the Controller Cover. 14) Remove the Signal Cable
• 11 screws (loosen) Cable Retainer
and the Power Cable. Edge Saddle

CAUTION: x2
Do not remove
the Fan Cable.
Wire Saddles
x4
• 1 edge saddle
• 3 wire saddles
Signal Cable
• 1 cable retainer

Fan Cable
Power Cable

F-9-297

F-9-296

9-148
9
9
9-149

16) Remove the Signal Cable and the Power Cable.


15) Open the HDD Lid.
• 1 scrwe (Removed screw will not be used.) • 2 dege saddles
• 5 wire saddles
• 2 connectors x2
Wire Saddles
NOTE:
Removed Signal Cable
Connectors
and Power Cable will x7
not be used.

Edge Saddl

Signal Power Edge Wire


Cable Cable Saddle Saddle

F-9-299
F-9-298

17) Remove the HDD Unit by 18) Remove the fixed


holding it as shown in the figure HDD from the removed
below. HDD Unit. (Removed
• 2 screws (Removed screw will x2 plate and screw will not x2
not be used.) be used.)
• 2 screws

F-9-301
F-9-300

9-149
9
9
9-150
■■Assembling and Installing the Removable HDD

1) Remove the HDD from the HDD Support Plate. (Use the installed HDD (80GB) removed in "Removing the 2) Install the HDD Connector Plate first, and then HDD to the HDD Support Plate. (HDD and
HDD Unit, Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable" step 18.) screw are the ones removed in step 1).)
• 1 HDD Grounding Plate (If • 4 screws
the HDD Grounding Plate
HDD
is installed, remove it. The
removed HDD Grounding Plate x4 x4
will not be used.)
• 4 screws HDD Connector Plate

HDD

HDD Support Plate


HDD Grounding Plate HDD Support Plate
F-9-302 F-9-303

If there is no gasket with the HDD removed from the host machine, prepare the gasket with the following
CAUTION: part number and perform step 3).
• KE8-1134-030
• Assembling the option HDD, be careful of the installation direction. 3) Affix the gasket to the place shown in the figure below.
• Make sure that the label on the option HDD is facing up.
CAUTION:
• Install it in the position where the HDD connector is placed in the side with screw hole
of HDD Support Plate. (opposite direction compared to the fixed HDD) Be sure to place the gasket in contact with the label-free metal surface of the HDD surface.

Gasket Screw hole

Screw hole

Connector
Label Connector side

Screw hole
HDD
F-9-304

F-9-305

9-150
9
9
9-151

4) Install the Conversion Connector. 5) Fit the 2 bosses of Connector


Fixing Block to the hole of
CAUTION: Conversion Connector and
Boss
Make sure
install it. x2
• 2 screws (P Tight; M3X8)
that there is
no opening CAUTION:
between the Be sure not to tighten
Conversion the screws in wrong
Connector and order. Otherwise,
part of HDD. the Conversion Hole
Connector will not be
secured properly.
F-9-306

F-9-307

CAUTION:
• Be sure to firmly hold the Connector Fixation Block when tightening the screws.
• Be sure to follow the correct order to tighten the screws, otherwise the Conversion Connector may not be connected properly, resulting in poor contact.

F-9-308

9-151
9
9
9-152

6) Install the HDD Cover. 7) Install the HDD Handle.


• 1 claw • 2 screws (TP round end;
• 1 screw M3X6)
(TP round end; M3X6)
CAUTION: x2
CAUTION:
Be sure to use the
Be sure to use the round end screw
round end screw included in the
included in the Removable HDD
Removable HDD Kit as the TP screw.
Kit as the TP screw.
F-9-309

F-9-310

8) Affix the HDD No.1 Label to the handle of the Removable HDD.
9) Write down the serial number of the host machine to the label for recording the number, and affix it to the area indicated in
the figure.

HDD No.

Serial No. XXXXXXXX

F-9-311

9-152
9
9
9-153

10) Install the HDD Door Guide.


• 2 claws

x2

Claws

F-9-312

11) Install the HDD Lock Plate.


CAUTION: • 2 HDD Lock Plate Shafts
• 2 Hinge Shaft Stoppers
Be careful of the installation direction of HDD Lock Plate.

Hinge Shaft Stoppers

HDD Lock
Plate Shaft
HDD Lock
Plate Shaft HDD Lock Plate

F-9-314

F-9-313

9-153
9
9
9-154

12) Adjust the 2 bosses to the hole


Bosses Holes
and install the HDD Lid Retainer.
• 1 screw (TP round end; M3X6)

CAUTION:
Be sure to use the round
end screw included in the
Removable HDD Kit as the
TP screw.

F-9-315

13) Remove the HDD Rear Cover. (Removed HDD Rear Cover will not be used.) 14) Place it in the position where the edge saddle of HDD Drawer Unit is facing up, remove the lower
• 2 screws (Removed screw will be used in step 18) Drawer Cable (Slot.2).
• 2 screws
• 2 springs Drawer Cable
• 2 washers Edge Saddle
x2 (The removed springs and x2
washers will be used in step
17.)

Washer

Spring

Screw
F-9-317
F-9-316

9-154
9
9
9-155

15) Remove the Drawer Cable. 16) Install the IV Cable.


• 2 screws (Removed screw will be used in step 16).) • 2 screws (screw removed in step 15))

x2 x2

F-9-318
F-9-319

17) Install the IV Cable of HDD Drawer Unit.


• 2 screws
• 2 springs
• 2 washers
(Use the parts removed in step 14).) x2 IV Cable

Washer

Spring

Screw
F-9-320

9-155
9
9
9-156

18) Install the HDD Drawer Unit.


• 2 screws (screw removed in step 13))

x2

F-9-321

19) Fix the cable of the Drawer Unit.


• 3 wire saddles
Wire saddles
NOTE: x3
• Close the [A] part of unused wire
saddle and edge saddle.
• Short Signal Cable and Power Cable
will not be used.
[A]
• Fix the unused Signal Cable and the
Power Cable with the wire saddle.

[A]
F-9-322

9-156
9
9
9-157

20) Install the IV Cable. 21) Install the Conroller Cover.


Cable Retainer
• 1 edge saddle Edge Saddle
• 3 wire saddles Caution:
• 2 connectors x2 Be sure that the gaskets on left/right
• 1 cable retainer
side of the Controller Cover are not
protruded.
Wire Saddles
x4

Signal Cable

Power Cable

Connectors

F-9-323

22) Install the HDD Blanking Plate to Slot.1 (left side). 23) Install the HDD to Slot.2 (right side).
• 2 screws (TP round end; M3X6)

CAUTION:
Be sure to use the round
end screw included in the
x2
Removable HDD Kit as the TP
screw.

F-9-325

F-9-324

9-157
9
9
9-158

24) Close the HDD Lid. 26) Affix the Shutdowm Warning Label in the appropriate language on the Right Rear 27) Install the removed cover and the cable.
25) Restore the Controller Box. Cover 1. • Rear Cover
• Left Rear Sub Cover
• Reader Communication Cable (when reader is installed)
• Left Rear Cover
• USB Cable and Control Panel Communication Cable

F-9-326

28) Install the Main Controller PCB 1 to the host machine.

CAUTION:
• Lift the handle, insert the Main
Controller PCB 1 until it stops, tilt
x2
the grip and install the 2 screws.
• Make sure to tilt the grip slowly
on both sides simultaneously.
• Check that the Main Controller
PCB 1 is installed properly.

Grips
F-9-327

9-158
9
9
9-159

29) If Reader is installed, install the Reader Power Cable. 30) Install the Right Rear Cover 1.
31) Close the Right Rear Cover 1, Right Lower
NOTE: Cover, and Right Upper Cover.
32) Insert the power plug into the socket and turn on
Handle the Reader Power Cable from the x2 [A] the main power of the host machine.
connector side and make a slack at A part.
Bend the Reader Power Cable at a right
angle on B part.
Cable Guide
Wire Saddles

[B]

Reader Power Cable

Connectors

F-9-328

9-159
9
9
9-160

[TYPE-3] Option HDD (250GB) + Removable HDD Kit

Checking the Contents


The parts with a gray in the contents list will not be used.

■■Option HDD (250GB)

[1] HDD Support Pate x 1 [2] HDD x 1 [3] Vibration-prevention [4] Spacersx 4 [5] Grounding Plate x 1
Dumper x 4

[6] Screw (W sems; M3x14) x 4 [7] Screw (TP;M3x6) x 2 [8] Gasket x 1

<CD/GUIDS> F-9-329

• Notice for FCC/IC


• China RoHS Notice 3

9-160
9
9
9-161
■■Removable HDD Kit

[1] Hinge Shaft Stopper x 2 [2] HDD Handle x 2 [3] HDD Connector Plate x 2 [4] HDD Cover x 2 [5] HDD Blanking Plate x 1

[6] HDD Door Guide x 1 [7] HDD Lock Plate x 1 [8] HDD Lock Plate Shaft x 2 [9] HDD Lid Retainer x 1 [10] Shutdown Caution Label x 1

[11] Connector Fixing Block x 2 [12] Conversion Connector x 2 [13] Signal Cable [14] IV Cable (FK2-8453) x 1 [15] Power Cable
(660mm ; Red) x 1 (650mm ; FK2-8464) x 1

F-9-330

9-161
9
9
9-162

[16] HDD Drawer Unit x 1 [17] Screw [18] Screw (P Tight ; M3 X 8) x 4 [19] R-HDD Label x 1
(R round head TP; M3 X 6) x 9

F-9-331

<CD/Guide>
• HDD Mirroring Kit-D1 User Documentation
• Notice for FCC/IC
• China RoHS Notice 3

9-162
9
9
9-163
Points to Note Regarding Data Backup/Export List of Data to be Deleted
Data to be Deleted Availability of Backup
Before performing work that will result in the loss of data, inform the system administrator of Information registered in the Address Book Yes
the inevitable loss, asking him to make a backup or export of important data items. Settings made from the Settings/Registration screen Yes *1
Backup or export work must not be performed by the service person because of security Forwarding Settings Yes
considerations. License files for MEAP applications Yes
MEAP applications No
In this Installation Procedure, a series of backup or export procedures are described for
Data saved using MEAP applications Yes *2
reference. Favorite Settings registered in the Copy and Mail Box functions No
Send Function Favorite Settings Yes
Data stored in Mail Boxes or the Advanced Box Yes *3
Scan modes registered in the Send Function No
Unsent documents (documents waiting to be sent with the Delayed Send No
mode)
Image forms stored in the Superimpose Image Yes
MEAP SMS (Service Management Service) password No
(the password will return to its default password if it was changed)
Job logs No
User authentication information registered in the Local Device Yes
Authentication user authentication system of SSO-H (Single Sign-On H)
Registration information for the Network Place No
Key Pair and Server Certificate No
Log information for the IP address/MAC address restriction settings No
Password that is protected by TPM Yes *4
Encryption key that is protected by TPM No
Information for Web browser settings Yes *5
Quick Menu Information Yes
User Information of the Advanced Box Yes
T-9-9

*1; Can only be backed up using the Remote UI.


*2; Depending on the MEAP application.
*3: Only the following data saved in Mail Box/Advanced Box are backed up.
• Mail Box Settings (mail box names, passwords, and auto erase times)
• Files in Mail Box
• Files in Advanced Box
• Forms registered for the Superimpose Image
• Advanced Box URI Transmission Settings
*4; You may not be able to back up, depending on the type of the password.
*5; Only the stored Favorite Settings can be backed up.

9-163
9
9
9-164
List of Data to be Backed Up
Making a Backup of the Data (Reference only)
Data to be backed up Reference
Address Book For information on exporting data, see the The data items that have been backed up may be restored when this product has been
Settings/Registration settings "e-Manual > Remote UI". installed. These data items are property of the user, and the restoration work must be
Device Settings (Forwarding Settings, Address performed by the system administrator.
List, Favorite Settings)
The method of restoration is described in the Users Guide. See Table (Data to be backed up)
Printer Settings
in Points to Note About Installation of the Installation Procedure.
Paper Information
Favorite Settings for Web browser See the "e-Manual > Web Access".
(You can select this if web browser (Option) is 1. Procedure to make a backup of Address Book
installed.) 1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
License files for MEAP applications For information on downloading license files, see
the "e-Manual > MEAP".
http://[IP address of the device]/
Data saved by MEAP applications Data saved by MEAP applications may be If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name
able to be backed up, depending on the MEAP and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
application. in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
See the documentation included with the MEAP
application. 2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/
Data stored in Mail Boxes or the Advanced Box See the "e-Manual > Remote UI" to "Setting the Export].
Image forms stored in the Superimpose Image Backup Location for Stored Data ". 3) Click [Address List].
SSO-H (Single Sign-On H) user authentication See the "e-Manual > MEAP". 4) Click [Export].
information
5) Select the save format for Address list, and click [Start Export].
Quick Menu Information See the "e-Manual > Quick Menu".
User Information of the Advanced Box See the "e-Manual > Security". 6) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. Be sure to set
T-9-10 a distinctive name to an export file so that you can recognize it when importing it.

NOTE:
CAUTION: Work to Perform After Installing the Kit Exporting the device settings will export all contents of the address list. In other words,
• When you start using this product, passwords set for Mail Boxes are erased. Set there is no need for a backup unless it needs to be done individually.
these passwords again.
• If you have logged on to the machine using a login service, such as SSO-H (Single
Sign-On H) before using this product, you must select the login service again 2. Device Settings Export Procedure
using SMS (Service Management Service) after restarting the machine. For more 1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
information on using SMS, see the "e-Manual > MEAP". http://[IP address of the device]/
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/
Export].
3) Click [Device Settings (Forwarding Settings, Address List, Favorite Settings)].
4) Click [Export], and then click [Start Export].
5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file.

9-164
9
9
9-165
3. Settings/Registration Export Procedure 6. Backup of MEAP Application
1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI. When a MEAP application has been installed, the data and license that the MEAP application
http://[IP address of the device]/ retains will be deleted. If no MEAP application is installed, there is no need to make a backup.
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name If a MEAP application has a backup function, make a backup of the data peculiar to the
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password MEAP application using this function. With regard to the license, there is a need to stop all
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login]. applications from SMS (Service Management Service), invalidate the license, and download
2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/ the invalid license file.
Export].
3) Click [Settings/Registration]. CAUTION: MEAP Backup Funct ion Using the SST
4) Click [Export], and click [Start Export]. Data that has been backed up using MEAP back of the SST before the use of this
5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. product is started must not be written back to the host machine after the use of this
product is started. Similarly, even if the data that has been backed up after the use
4. Printer Settings Export Procedure of this product is started is written back to the host machine before the use of this
product is started, the machine does not operate. It is necessary to make sure that the
NOTE: implementation conditions for this product are compatible before and after making a
The following items to be exported are the same as the ones which are distributed by backup of data, and the MEAP backup function does not permit making a backup of
device information distribution. data in the course of installing the kit.

1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
http://[IP address of the device]/ The overview of procedures for stop of MEAP applications, Disabling of the license, and
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name download of an Disabled license file is described below. For more information, see the
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password MEAPSMS Administrator Guide.
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/ 7. Stop of MEAP Applications, Disabling, Download of Disabled License Files and
Export]. Uninstallation
3) Click [Printer Settings]. 1) Select the URL given below and access SMS.
4) Click [Export], and click [Start Export]. http://[IP address of the device]:8000/sms/
5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. The default password is MeapSmsLogin. If a user has changed the password, ask the user
to change the password again after the use of this product is started.
5. Paper Information Export Procedure
1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI. CAUTION:
http://[IP address of the device]/ The default password is MeapSmsLogin. If a user has changed the password, ask the
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name user to change the password again after the use of this product is started.
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login]. 2) Click [MEAP Application Management].
2) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Import/ 3) Click [Stop] button of the application you want to stop on the MEAP Application
Export]. Management page.
3) Click [Paper Information]. 4) Click the application of which license has been installed.
4) Click [Export], and click [Start Export]. 5) Click [License Control], and then click [Disable]. Click [Yes] in a confirmation window for
5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. disabling the license.

9-165
9
9
9-166
6) Click [Download] under “Download/delete Disabled License File” item. Following the 9. Backup of User inbox and Advanced Box document data
instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file. Set a distinctive name
for the disabled license file so that you can recognize it for which application. After you CAUTION: Backup of "Advanced Box"
download the disabled license file to your PC, click [Delete]. Click [Yes] in a confirmation When setting a SMB server as a backup destination, Advanced Box data saved in a
window for license deletion. large capacity HDD cannot be backed up. The Advanced Box data backed up from the
7) Return to the MEAP Application Management page, click [Uninstall] button of the large capacity HDD cannot be restored to the standard HDD.
application you want to uninstall. Click [Yes] in a confirmation window for uninstallation. If Depending on the system version of the machine, both backup and restoration might
there are several applications, repeat the procedures 1) to 7). not be performed.
8) After the use of this product is started, re-install the application using an application file (jar
file) of each application from SMS and the disabled license file (lic file). The procedure of backup and restoration of a box document data is described below.
Specify the backup destination of a document data:

8. User Authentication Information Registered by SSO-H (Single Sign-ON H) • Backup to SMB server

In the case that the MEAP login application has been changed to SSO-H, there is a need to Select SMB as a backup destination and specify an address, a user name, a password,

make a backup of the user authentication information. and a path to the SMB server to which saved data is backed up.

1) Access the URL given below. • Backup to USB HDD

http://[IP address of the device]:8000/sso/ Select USB HDD as a backup destination and specify a path to the USB HDD folder to

The default password is MeapSmsLogin. If a user has changed the password, ask the user which saved data is backed up.

to change the password again after the use of this product is started.
CAUTION: Data which cannot be backed up

CAUTION: If you back up/restore stored data without restarting the machine after changing the
language displayed on the touch panel display by pressing [Settings/Registration] >
The default password is MeapSmsLogin. If the user has changed the password, ask
[Preferences] from the control panel of the machine, the stored data may not be backed
him/her to change the password again after the use of this product is started.
up/restored properly. For more information on the data that cannot be backed up, see
Points to Note for Installation.
2) Login with the user name and password registered as an administrator in SSO-H.
The default administrator user name and password are as follows:
User Name: Administrator CAUTION:
Password: password
If the language setting in the common specification settings (Settings/Registration) is
3) Click [User Control]. set to ON, 'host address' and 'path to folder' might not be displayed correctly or cannot
4) Put a checkmark to Select All, and then click [Export]. be referred.
5) Leave the file format and character code as defaults and click [Start Export].
6) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file and click [Save].

9-166
9
9
9-167
10. Quick Menu Information Export Procedure
CAUTION:
1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
• Regarding the method of inputting characters, see 'Basic Operations' in the http://[IP address of the device]/
e-Manual. If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name
• A host address can be up to 128 characters in 1 byte or 64 characters in 2 bytes and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
using the 'Kana-Kanji,' 'Katakana,' 'alphanumeric character,' 'mark,' and 'code input' in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
modes. 2) Select Basic Tools > [Quick Menu] > [Export].
• A path to the folder can be up to 255 characters in 1 byte (127 characters in 2 bytes). 3) If the file needs to be encrypted, enter the password after check [Encrypt file]. (The number
• A user name can be up to 128 characters in 1 byte or 64 characters in 2 bytes of characters for the password must be more than 4 but less than 16.)
using the 'Kana-Kanji,', 'Katakana,' 'alphanumeric character,' 'mark,' and 'code input' 4) Click [Export].
modes. 5) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file.
• A password can be up to 7 to 48 characters using the 'alphanumeric character' and
'mark (1 byte)' modes. 11. User Information of the Advanced Box Export Procedure
• The voice sound symbol and the semi-voice sound symbol entered in the 'Katakana (1 1) Access the URL given below, and then access Remote UI.
byte)' mode are counted up as one 1-byte character. http://[IP address of the device]/
If the system administrator ID and password are set, a dialog box to enter the user name
[Backup method of User inbox and Advanced Box document data]
and password appears. Enter the system administrator ID in User Name and the password
1) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Backup].
in Password, and then click [Administrator Login].
2) Select ‘All’ or ‘Changes’ for the backup method.
2) Select Basic Tools > [User Access Control for Advanced Box]. The dialog box to enter the
3) Click [Execute].
user name of administrator and password appears, enter the system administrator ID and
password, and then click [Log In].
CAUTION:
The default administrator user name and password are as follows:
• If any of the host IP address, user name, password, or path to the folder is not
User Name: Administrator
correctly entered, a backup cannot be made.
Password: password
• If you select to encrypt the backup data, the backup process may take longer. 3) Click [Export], and click [Start Export].
4) Following the instructions on the window, specify the location to save the file.
[Restoring the backup data of User inbox and Advanced Box document data]
1) Select [Settings/Registration] > [Management Settings] > [Data Management] > [Restore].
2) Click [Display Backup Data]. Check Items when Turning OFF the Main Power
3) Select the backup data to restore from the list and then click [Execute]. Check that the main power switch is OFF.
1) Turning off the Main Power Supply Switch of the Host Machine.
CAUTION:
2) Check that the display on the Control Panel and the Main Power Supply Lamp are turned
• If you want to restore encrypted backup data, enter the same password used when off before disconnecting the outlet.
backing up the data.
• Depending on the settings of the machine, the backup data may not be completely
restored, or some documents may be automatically printed.
• Restoration is performed after all of the box data stored in the machine, or
documents that are being sent, received, or stored, are erased.

9-167
9
9
9-168
Installation Procedure
■■Removing the HDD Unit, Signal Cable and Power Supply Cable

1) Open the Right Lower Cover. (Open the Right Upper


Cover simultaneously.) 2) Open the Right Rear Cover 1.
3) Remove the Right Rear Cover 1.
• 1 screw (RS tight; M4)
• 2 screws (TP; M3) x3
• 1 claw

Claw
F-9-332 F-9-333

4) When the Reader is installed, 5) Remove the USB Cable and the Control Panel Communication Cable.
remove the Reader Power Control Panel
Cable. Communication Cable USB Cable
• 2 connectors x2
• 2 wire saddles Reader Power
• 1 cable guide Cable x2
x2 Cable Guide

Wire Saddles

Connectors
F-9-334 F-9-335

9-168
9
9
9-169

6) Remove the 2 screws, open the grip in 2 places.


7) Hold the 2 Grips, and pull out the Main Controller PCB 1
approximately 10mm toward front.

x2

Grips
F-9-337
F-9-336

8) Remove the Left Rear Cover. 9) When the Reader is installed, remove the Reader Communication Cable.
• 2 rubber caps
• 2 screws
• 5 claws
x2
claw

x5

F-9-338 F-9-339

9-169
9
9
9-170

10) Remove the Left Rear Sub Cover. 11) Remove the Rear Cover.
• 1 screw • 2 rubber caps
• 1 hook Hook • 2 screws
• 1 claw
x2

claw

Left Rear
Sub Cover F-9-341
F-9-340

12) Open the Controller Box while avoiding the harness.


• 2 screws NOTE:
If the FAX Unit has been
installed, remove the 3 screws
and open the Controller Box
x3
x2 with the FAX Unit.

Harness
Harness

F-9-343
F-9-342

9-170
9
9
9-171

13) Remove the Controller Cover. 14) Remove the Signal Cable
• 11 screws (loosen) Cable Retainer
and the Power Cable. Edge Saddle

CAUTION: x2
Do not remove
the Fan Cable.
Wire Saddles
x4
• 1 edge saddle
• 3 wire saddles
Signal Cable
• 1 cable retainer

Fan Cable
Power Cable

F-9-345

F-9-344

16) Remove the Signal Cable and the Power Cable.


15) Open the HDD Lid.
• 1 scrwe (Removed screw will not be used.) • 2 dege saddles
• 5 wire saddles
• 2 connectors
x2
NOTE: Wire Saddles
Removed Signal Cable
and Power Cable will Connectors
not be used. x7

Edge Saddl

Signal Power Edge Wire


Cable Cable Saddle Saddle

F-9-346 F-9-347

9-171
9
9
9-172

17) Remove the HDD Unit by


holding it as shown in the figure
below. (Removed HDD unit will
not be used.) x2
• 2 screws (Removed screw will
not be used.)

F-9-348

9-172
9
9
9-173
■■Installing the Removable HDD Kit

1) Install the HDD Door Guide.


• 2 claws

x2

Claws

F-9-349

2) Install the HDD Lock Plate.


CAUTION: • 2 HDD Lock Plate Shafts
• 2 Hinge Shaft Stoppers
Be careful of the installation direction of HDD Lock Plate.

Hinge Shaft Stoppers

HDD Lock
Plate Shaft
HDD Lock
Plate Shaft HDD Lock Plate

F-9-351

F-9-350

9-173
9
9
9-174

3) Adjust the 2 bosses to the hole and


Bosses Holes
install the HDD Lid Retainer.
• 1 screw (TP round end; M3X6)

CAUTION:
Be sure to use the round
end screw included in the
Removable HDD Kit as the TP
screw.

F-9-352

4) Remove the HDD Rear Cover. (Removed HDD Rear Cover will not be used.) 5) Place it in the position where the edge saddle of HDD Drawer Unit is facing up, remove the lower Drawer Cable
• 2 screws (Removed screw will be used in step 9).) (Slot.2).
• 2 screws

You might also like